Bafour Ba Elective Math Book
Bafour Ba Elective Math Book
ELECTIVE
MATHEMATICS
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
for
By:
BAFFOUR ASAMOAH
CERT „A‟– OTC, Dip(Edu) – UCC, B.Ed (Maths) – UEW, BAT(Admin) – CSUC, BSc (Maths & Stats) - PUC
Copyright© 2018
All rights reserved under copyright law.
No part of this publication may be published, produced or stored on a print or any retrievable media
without approval or authorization.
ISBN : P0002417952
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
In this book, each chapter is broken down into short, manageable sections intended to completely
alleviate or reduce to a large extent, the canker that is termed in Ghanaian context as “Math‟s
Phobia” by providing in its content, concise notes and commentaries with well – illustrated
diagrams on each topic and subtopic of the Senior High Schools and Colleges Syllabuses.
The book reflects the authors experience that students work better from work examples than
abstract discussion of principles, hence the provision of numerous and comprehensive range of
worked examples. A numbered, step-by-step approach to problem solving, trial test and challenge
problems intended to cater for gifted students are greatly featured in this book. Not left out in this
book is “exercises” on each subtopic which contains an extensive selection of Multiple- choice,
Fill-ins, True or False, Essay – type questions similar in standard to the WASSCE questions.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Tackling these exercises is no doubt, an excellent form of revision. Answers to all exercises are also
provided to help students assess their level of progress.
Taking into accounts, full analysis of the pattern and level of difficulty of examination questions,
the last part of the book is “some solved past questions”, in its content.
I also wish to acknowledge the fact that the book is not absolutely free from errors of typing,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
grammar and inaccuracy. These occurred as a result of oversight but not ignorance and
incompetence on the part of the author and editors. These should therefore, not undermine the
credibility of the book, for they say “to err is human”. However, your comments, corrections,
suggestions and criticism are warmly welcomed for consideration and rectification in the next
edition.
Baffour Asamoah
(Baffour Ba)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Equation of Axes or Line of Symmetry
2. Surds………………………………….. 35 – 50 The Minimum and Maximum Points
Meaning and Properties of Surds Quadratic Function f(x) = ax2 + bx+ c in the
A simplified Surd as single Root from f(x) = a(x - h)2 + k
Addition and Subtraction of Surds Quadratic Equations
Multiplication and Division of Surds Word Problems
Rationalizing Denominators Sum and Product of Roots of a Quadratic
Radical Equation Equation
Equality of Surds Forming Quadratic Equations from its roots
The Square Root of an Irrational Number Finding Two Unknowns from the Roots of
the equation
3. Binary Operations………………………51 – 72 Nature of Root of a Quadratic Equation
Involving surds
Combining Two Binary Operators 5. Polynomials………………………. 130 – 153
Truth Set under a given Binary Operation Degree of a polynomial
Table of Binary Operation Types of Polynomials
Properties of Binary Operations Evaluating Polynomials
Identity Element and the Binary table Addition and Subtraction of Polynomials
The Inverse Property Multiplication of Polynomials
The Inverse Element on the Binary Table Opposite of a Polynomial
Word Problems
4. Relations and Functions…………………73 – 129 Division of Polynomials :
Idea of a Relation The Synthetic Method
Relations as Ordered Pairs The Remainder Theorem
Range of a relation Application of Remainder Theorem
Types of Relations Factor Theorem and its Application
Function Notation Using a Combination of the Factor and
Representation of Functions Remainder Theorems to find Unknowns
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Factorials and Combinatorial Numbers Finding the Ratio of Division
Binomial Expansion of (a + b)n and (1 + a)n Gradient of a Line from Two Points, a Linear
Evaluating Expansions of Sums and Equation and from a Linear Graph
Difference Equation of a Line (from two given Points,
Substitution from gradient and a point on the line and from
Related Application the gradient and the intercept on the y – axis)
Unknown Coefficients or an Unknown Index Perpendicular Lines
Selecting a Particular Term Equation of a parallel Line
Sums of Binomial Coefficients The Equation of a Line which Passes through
Negative and Rational Exponents the Point ( , ) and Perpendicular to another
Conditions for Convergence of Binomial Line
Series
Equation of Perpendicular Bisector of a line
Unknowns of Expansions with Rational
Application to Parallelograms
Exponents
Point of Intersection of Two Lines
Perpendicular Distance from a Line
8. Linear Programming…………………202 – 234
Distance between Two Parallel Lines
Inequalities
Slope of Two Lines Which Meet at a Point at
Meaning of - and
a given distance from a given Point.
Basic Interval Notation
Points on the same Side or Opposite sides of a
Solving Linear Inequalities
Line
Graphing Linear Inequality in one variable
Angles between Two Lines
Linear Inequalities in Two variables
Congruencies of a Triangle;
Graph of Linear Inequality in Two Variables
Circle Centres
Systems of Linear Inequalities:
Linear Programming
10. Probability 1…………………………...270 – 300
Graphing the constraints
Equally Likely Events
(Mathematical model)
Complementary Events
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page v
Compound Events Concept of Motion
Coin and a Die Experiments Displacement
Other Related Experiments Equations of Motion
Mutually Exclusive Events: Velocity and Acceleration
Independent and Dependent Events Motion Under Gravity
Conditional Probability Motion along Inclined Planes
Selection with and without Replacement Friction and Coefficient of Friction
Probability and Tree Diagrams Momentum and Impulse
Conservation of (Linear) Momentum:
11. Vectors………………………………...301 – 334 Direct Impact
Velocity and Force Vector Velocity-Time graph
Unit Vector
Unit Vector in the Opposite Direction to a 14. Circles…………………………………..396 – 436
given Vector Equation of a Circle with Center (a, b)
The Dot (scalar) Product and its Properties Equation of a Circle with Center at the Origin
Finding the Constants of a Vector given the The General Equation of a circle
Angle Between two Vectors. Center and Radius, from a given equation
Parallel and Orthogonal Vectors Equation of a Circle given the Diameter
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Sine and Cosine Rules Equation of a Circle through 3 Points
The Triangular Law of Vectors Tangent and Equation of Tangent to a Circle
Relating Free Vectors and Position Vectors Verifying that a Point Lies on a Circle
Applications Finding the Gradient of the Tangent
Parallelogram Law of Vectors Length of a Tangent from an External Point
Position Vector of a Point Dividing a Straight Normal and Equation of a Normal to a Circle
line in a Given Ratio Condition of Tangency
Using Vector Approach to Solve Bearings Points Inside , On or Outside a Circle
Definition of Compb a Intersection of a Circle and a Line
Point of Intersection of Two Circles
12. Statics…………………………………..335 – 372 Equation of Locus
Scalar and Vector Quantities
The Resultant Vector, Parallelogram Law and 15. Parabola……………………………..437 – 443
Triangular Law of Vectors Meaning of a Parabola
Magnitude of the Resultant Vector Standard Equation of a Parabola
Force and Resultant Force Other Forms of the Equation of a Parabola
Laws of Forces Equations of Tangent and Normal to a
Resolution of Forces Parabola
Two forces acting at a point
Law of Polygon of Forces 16. Sequence and Series…………….…….444 – 472
Resultant of Coplanar Forces Arithmetic Progressions
Equilibrium of Forces Finite Arithmetic Sequence
Polygon of Forces Finding the nth Term from Two given Terms
Lami‟s Theorem Inserting Arithmetic Means
Principles of Moments Sum of Arithmetic Series
Finding the Number of Terms or the Common
13. Dynamics……………………………….373 - 395 Difference Given the Sum of Terms
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exponential Equations 1 and 2 Co-function Formulas
Relating Indices and Logarithms Addition and subtraction formulas for sine
Laws of Logarithms and its Application Addition and subtraction formula for Tangent
Logarithmic Expressions Multiple Angles, Half – Angle Identities and
Simplifying / Evaluating Log Expressions formulas
Operations on Logarithms Product to Sums and Differences Formulas
Involving Cubic Equations Sums and Differences to Product Formulas
Substitution Trigonometric Equations 1 and 2
Involving Change of Base Maximum and Minimum values for simple
Complex Logarithmic Equations 1 and 2 Trigonometric equations, Multiples and Sub-
Involving Simultaneous Equations multiples
Logarithmic Functions Involving Quadratic Equations
Word Problems Involving Logarithms Domain and Range of Trigonometric
Experimental Laws Function and Inverse Trigonometric Function.
Application to Other Triangles
18. Trigonometry…………………………..515 – 572
Sine and Cosine Rule, Area of a Triangle
Radian Measure
Trigonometry and Bearings
Relationship Between Radians and Degrees
Graphs of Trigonometric Functions
Changing from Degrees to Radians
Amplitude and a Period
Changing from Radians to Degrees
The expression Rcos (x − α)
Changing Radians to Degrees, Minutes and
Application to solving an equation
Seconds
Finding maximum and minimum values of a
Changing Minutes and Seconds as Decimal
trigonometric function
Degrees
Length of a Circular Arc 19. Limits of a Function…………………...573 – 578
Area of a Circular Sector Limits of Functions at Infinity
Reciprocal Identities Rules for Limits of Functions at Infinity
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Product, Quotient and Chain Rules Combined 22. Permutation and Combination……….675 – 701
Implicit Differentiation Arrangements with and Without Restrictions
Evaluating Implicit Functions at a Point Application to Forming Digits
Application of Differentiation Forming Even, Odd and Multiples of
Evaluating Gradient at a Point Numbers
Equation of a Tangent to a curve at a Point on Circular and Linear Arrangements;
the Curve. Combination and the ( ) notation
Equation of a Tangent at a Curve at the point
Restricted Combination
where the Curve meets the line y = mx + c
Choosing Objects from Two Different Groups
Equation of the Tangent Parallel to the x or y
– axis
23. Probability II………………………..702 – 715
Unknown Coefficients given the value of The Binomial Probability Distribution
Equation of Normal to a Curve A Bernoulli trial
Rates of Change 1 (Linear Kinematics) Permutations and Combinations
Displacement (Position), Velocity and Rings and Roundabouts
Acceleration Combination Probability Formula
Rate of Change 2 Selection Without Replacement
Small Change and Percentage Error
Greatest and Least Values 24. Statistics………………………………..716 – 778
Maxima and Minima Types Sources and Collection of Data
Stationary Points and their Nature Measure of Central Tendencies
Second Derivative test Frequency Diagrams for Ungrouped Data
Application of Maxima and Minima Class Limits and Class Boundaries
Curve Sketching Class Mark and Class Size/Width
21. Integration ………..…………………..638 – 674 Format of a Grouped Frequency Table
Integration of Sum or Difference Mean and Median of a Grouped Data
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The Range and Interquartile Range from Statements and Venn Diagrams
Frequency Distribution Compound Statements
Interquartile and Semi - inter quartile range Implication amd Converse of an Implication
Equivalent Statements
25. Matrices……………………………..779 – 809 The Chain Rule of Implication
Describing a Matrix Truth Tables
A Square Matrix and a Zero Matrix Valid Arguments
Operations on Matrices
Matrix Algebra 28. Correlation and Regression…………837 – 848
The Unit (Identity) Matrix Correlation and Regression Analysis
Solving Problems Involving Identity Univariate and Bivariate Distributions
Matrix Equality The Scatter Diagram
Determinants and inverse of a 2 × 2 matrices Forms of Correlation and Type of Scatter
The Adjoint and Minors of a Matrix Diagrams
Determinant of a 3 × 3 Matrix The Line of Best Fit
Equations Involving Determinants Equation of the Line of Best Fit
Singular Matrix A line of regression of x on y, which gives an
Transpose of a Matrix estimate of x, given a value of y.
Inverse of a 3 × 3 Matrix A line of regression of y on x, which gives an
Word Problems Involving Matrices estimate of y, given a value of x.
Matrix Equation The Least Square Method
Solving Simultaneous Equations Spearman‟s Rank Correlation Coefficient
Cramer‟s Rule
Answers to exercises………………….849 – 857
26. Matrices and Transformations…….…810 – 824
References………………………………858
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
If “b” is not an element of set A, then we say “b set of the months beginning with letter “J”, then
does not belongs to A” mathematically M = {January, June, July}
expressed as “b ∉ A” where the symbol “∉”
means “does not belong to”. 3. Rule or Set Builder Form
In this method, the elements of the set are
Examples of sets used in mathematics are: described by using the variable “x” or any other
N : the set of natural numbers . variable, followed by a colon. The symbol “:”
= {1, 2, 3, 4,…} or” “/” as used in this case is read “such that”.
Thereafter, the property possessed by the
Z : the set of integers . elements is written in braces (called “set of
= {…-3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3,…} all”). For example, P is the set of counting
Q : the set of rational numbers . numbers greater than 12. In set builder notation
or form, P is expressed as:
R : the set of real numbers .
P = {x : x is a counting number greater than
Z+ : the set of positive integers 12}. This is read as “P is the set of elements of
W: the set of all whole numbers. x such that x is a counting number greater than
12.
Representation of Sets
Sets are commonly represented by any of the Likewise, if A is the set of even numbers
following methods: between 6 and 14, then A is written in set
1. Statement form. builder notation as:
2. Tabular or roaster form. A = {x / x is even, 6 < x < 14} or
3. Rule or set builder form. A = {x : x P, 6 < x < 14, P is an even number}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
C = {x : x N and x < 7}
B. Write each in set builder form:
1. A = {16, 25, 36, 39, 64} 4. Infinite Set
2. B = {2, 4, 6, 8, 10} 3. C = {2, 3, 5, 7, 11} It is a set whose element cannot be listed. In
4. D = {1, 3, 5, 7, 9} 5. E = {a, e, i, o, u} other words it a set containing never – ending
elements. For example,
Types of Set A = {x : x N, x > 1}
1. Null Set or Empty Set B = {Set of all prime numbers}
It is a set which does not contain any element.
It is denoted by (read as phi). Sometimes, Cardinal Number of Set
is also denoted by { }. It can be concluded that The total number of elements in a set P, is call
the number of elements in an empty set is 0. An the cardinal number of P, denoted by n(P). For
empty set is therefore an example of a finite. example,
For example, the set of whole numbers less 1. A = {x : x N, x < 5}
than 0. Since there is no whole number less
than 0, the set is said to be a null set. A = {1, 2, 3, 4}
n(A) = 4
Likewise M = {x : x is a composite number
less than 4}. M is an empty set because there is 2. B = {set of elements in the word
no composite number less than 4. {“MATHEMATICS”}
B = {M, A, T, H, E, I, C, S} n(B) = 8
Note:
1. ≠ {0} Note that n ( ) = 0
2. {0} is a set which has one element 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
every element of Q is an element of P. For
example, given that P = {t, h, e} and Q = {e, t, we say Y is a subset of X, i.e. Y⊂X
h}, then A = B or set A and set B are equal sets.
2. If P = {2, 4, 8} and Q = {even counting
Note: numbers less than 12}. What is the relationship
1. Equal sets are always equivalent. between P and Q?
2. Equivalents set may not be equal.
Solution
Disjoint Set P = {2, 4, 8} and Q = {2, 4, 6, 8, 10}
Two sets A and B are said to be disjoint if they Since all the elements of P can be found in Q, P
do not have any element in common. For is a subset of Q. That is P ⊂ Q.
example:
A = {x : x is a prime} 3. P = {x : 20 < x < 30, where is odd} and Q =
B = {x : x is a composite} {23, 29}. Establish a relationship between sets
A and B do not have any element in common. P and Q.
That is A ∩ B = {}
Solution
Joint or Overlapping Set P = {21, 23, 25, 27, 29} and Q = {23, 29}
Two sets A and B are said to be overlapping if Since all the members of Q can be found in P,
they contain at least one element in common. we say Q is a subset of P. i.e. Q⊂P
For eg; A = {a, b, c, d} and B = {a, e, i, o, u}
A and B have the element {a} in common, that Power Set
is A∩B = {a} If A is a set, then the collection or family of all
subsets of A, is called power of A, denoted by
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. If S = {a}, find P(S) ⇒(A∪B) ∪C = A∪ (B∪C)
= {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8}
Solution
If S = {a}, then P(S) = {{a}, } 3. Let X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {2, 3, 5} and
Z = {4, 5, 6}.Verify that:
Union of sets i. X∪Y = Y∪X
The union of two or more sets is a set which ii. (X∪Y) ∪Z = X∪(Y∪Z)
contains a combination of all the elements in
those sets. It is denoted by “∪” Solution
i. X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {2, 3, 5}, Z = {4, 5, 6}.
Worked Examples X∪Y = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5}
1. Let A = {x : x is a natural number and a Y∪X = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5}
factor of 18} and B = {x : x is a natural number X∪Y = Y∪X = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5}
less than 6}. Find A∪B
ii. (X∪Y)∪Z = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}
Solution X∪(Y∪Z) = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}
A = {x : x is a natural number and a factor of (X∪Y)∪Z = X∪(Y∪Z) = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}
18}
A = {1, 2, 3, 6, 9, 18} Intersection of sets
B = {x : x is a natural number less than 6}. The intersection of two or more sets is the set
B = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5} which contains elements which are common to
A∪B = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 18} those sets. It is denoted by “∩”
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution = {3, 6, 12}
P = {multiples of 3 between 1 and 20} v. (A∩C) ∪ (B∩C) = {3} ∪ {6, 12}
P = {3, 6, 9, 12, 15, 18} = {3, 6, 12}
Q = even natural numbers up to 15} vi. (A∪B) = {2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 78, 10, 11, 12}1
1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Difference of Two Sets If is a universal set and A is a subset of ,
If P and Q are two sets, then their difference is then the complement of A is the set of all
given by P – Q or Q – P. elements of , which are not the elements of A.
P – Q means elements of P which are not
elements of Q. For example, if P = {2, 3, 4} Mathematically, the complement of a set A is
and Q = {4, 5, 6}, then P – Q = {2, 3} denoted as .
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution (A∪B)1 = {9, 15}
= {Natural numbers}
= {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 …} A1 = {3, 9, 15}
A = {even natural numbers} B1 = {6, 9, 12, 15, 18}
A = {2, 4, 6, 8, 10} A1 ∩ B1 = {9, 15}
= {1, 3, 5, 7, 9…} ⇒(A∪B)1 = A1 ∩ B1 = {9, 15}
= {x : x is a set of odd natural numbers}
Verifying law 2;
De Morgan‟s Law A∩B = { }
De Morgan‟s law states that: (A∩B)1 = {3, 6, 9, 12, 15, 18}
1. the complement of the union of two sets A A1 = {3, 9, 15}
and B is equal to the intersection of the B1 = {6, 9, 12, 15, 18}
complements of the sets A and B. A1∪B1 = {3, 6, 9, 12, 15, 18}
(A∪B)1 = A1 ∩ B1 ⇒ (A∩B)1 = A1 ∪ B1 = {3, 6, 9, 12, 15, 18}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Consider the sets A = {1, 5, 6, 7}, B = {2, 5, 7, Consider the sets, A = {1, 2, 5, 8, 9}, B = {2,
6} and C = {1, 7, 8, 10} 5, 8, 9, 10} and C = {5, 9, 12, 13}
(A∪B)∪C = {1, 2, 5, 6, 7}∪{1, 7, 8, 10} A ∪ (B ∩ C) = {1, 2, 5, 8, 9} ∪ {5, 9}
= {1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 8, 10} = {1, 2, 5, 8, 9}
A∪ (B∪C) = {1, 5, 6,7}∪{1, 2, 6, 7, 8,10}
= {1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 8, 10} (A ∪ B) ∩ (A ∪ C)
(A∪B)∪C = A∪ (B∪C) = {1, 2, 5, 8, 9, 10} ∩{1, 2, 5, 8, 9, 12, 13}
= {1, 2, 5, 8, 9}
Hence for any three sets A, B and C,
(A∪B)∪C = A∪(B∪C). A ∪ (B ∩ C) = (A ∪ B) ∩ (A ∪ C)
The operation of union of sets is associative. Hence for any three sets A, B and C,
A ∪ (B ∩ C) = (A ∪ B) ∩ (A ∪ C).
Similarly, (A∩B)∩C = {5, 6, 7} ∩{1,7, 8, 10} The union is said to be distributive over
= {7} intersection.
Hence for any three sets A, B and C, A∪B = {1, 3, 5, 15}∪ { 1, 2, 5, 10}
A ∩ (B ∪ C) = (A ∩ B) ∪ (A ∩ C). The = {1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15}
intersection is said to be distributive over the
union. (A – B)∪B = A∪B = {1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= {1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15}
Consider the sets; (A∩B) = {1, 3, 5, 15}∩{ 1, 2, 5, 10}
A = {1, 3, 5, 15}, B = {1, 2, 5, 10} and C ={} = {1, 5}
i. A – B = A∩B1
A – B = {1, 3, 5, 15} - { 1, 2, 5, 10} = {3, 15} (A∪B) – (A∩B) = {1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15} - {1, 5}
A∩B1 = {1, 3, 5, 15} ∩ {3, 15} = {2, 3, 10, 15}
= {3, 15}
(A – B) ∪ (B – A) = (A∪B) – (A∩B) = {2, 3, 10, 15}
A – B = A∩B1 = {3, 5}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Complement laws
(A – B) ∪ (A – C) The union of a set A and its complement A1
A – B = {2, 4, 6, 12, 18, 36} – {4, 6, 8, 12, 24} gives the universal set U, of which A and A1 are
= {2, 18 , 36} subsets of U. That is A∪A1 = U
A – C = {2, 4, 6, 12, 18, 36} – {3, 6, 9, 18}
= {2, 4, 12, 36} Also the intersection of a set A and its
complement A1 gives an empty set. That is
(A – B) ∪ (A – C) = {2, 18, 36}∪{2, 4, 12, 36} A∩A1 = { }
= {2, 4, 12, 18, 36}
A – (B∩C) = (A – B) ∪ (A – C) 2. Double complementation law
{2, 4, 12, 18, 36} = {2, 4, 12, 18, 36} The complement of a complemented set A,
written as (A1)1, gives the set A.
ii. A – (B∪C) = (A – B) ∩ (A – C)
A – (B∪C) 3. Law of empty set and universal sets
= {2, 4, 6, 12, 18, 36} – {3, 4, 6, 8, 9, 12 , 18, 24} The complement of the universal set gives an
= {2, 36} empty set and the complement of the empty set
gives the universal set. That is ∪1 = and 1
=∪
(A – B) ∩ (A – C)
A – B = {2, 4, 6, 12, 18, 36} – {4, 6, 8, 12, 24} Worked Examples
= { 2, 18 , 36} Let D(n) denotes the factors of a natural
A – C = {2, 4, 6, 12, 18, 36} –{3, 6, 9, 18} number n, including n itself but 1.
= {2, 4, 12, 36} e.g. D(8) = {2, 4, 8}.
(A – B) ∩ (A – C) = {2, 36} i. List the elements of D(12) and D(18)
ii. Find the integer, r such that;
iii. If P = D(8) ∪ [D(12) ∩ D(18)] and B. Find the complement of the following sets
Q = [D(8) ∪ D(12)]∩,D(8)∪D(18)] if the universal set is the set of natural
numbers;
Solution 1. {x : x is a prime number}
i. D(12) ={2, 3, 4, 6, 12} 2. {x : x is a multiple of 2}
D(18) = {2, 3, 6, 9, 18} 3. {x : x ≥ 100}
4. {x : x N, 5x + 1 > 20}
ii. D(12) ∩ D(18) = D(r)
{2, 3, 4, 6, 12} ∩ {2, 3, 6, 9, 18} = D(r) C. Let A, B and C be the subset of the universal
{2, 3, 6} = D(r) set U. For each of the following statements,
But D(6) ={2, 3, 6} determine whether it is true or not.
⇒ D(r) = D(6) = {2, 3, 6} i. A – B = A1∩B
r=6 ii. (A∪B) ∩ C = A∪(B∩C)
iii. (A1∪B1) ∩ B = B – A
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. P = D(8) ∪ [D(12) ∩ D(18)]
P = {2, 4, 8} ∪ {2, 3, 6} Challenge Problems
P = {2, 3, 4, 6, 8} The universal set is the set of integers p such
that 10 ≤ p ≤ 100.
Q = [D(8) ∪ D(12)]∩[D(8)∪D(18)] A = {p : p divided by 12 leaves a remainder 5}.
D(8) ∪ D(12) = {2, 4, 8}∪{2, 3, 4, 6, 12} B = {p : p divided by 16 leaves a remainder 5}.
= {2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 12} Four positive integers a, b, c and d are such
D(8) ∪ D(18) = {2, 4, 8} ∪{2, 3, 6, 9, 18} that:
= {2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 9, 18} a = 12c + 5
Q = {2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 12}∩ {2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 9, 18} b = 16d + 5
Q = {2, 3, 4, 6, 8} a + b = 78
Find a and b.
P = Q = {2, 3, 4, 6, 8}
Illustration of Diagrams
Exercises 1.3 A. Joint Sets
A. Let U = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10}; U
A B
A = {1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10};
B = {1, 3, 5, 7, 8, 9}.
Find:
1. B1 2. A1
3. A1∪ B1 4. A1 ∩ B1 The shaded regions represent A∪B.
5. (A∪ B)1 The non-shaded region represents (A∪B) 1
3. 3. A B U
A B U
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. A B U
4. A B U
5. U
C. Subsets (B ⊂ A)
A B
1. U
A
B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A1∩B1 = (AUB)1. That is outside A or B or
Solution
both
Let A represent people who like cold drink
and B represent people who like hot drink
D. Single Sets
n(A∪B) = 60, n(A) = 27, n(B) = 42
1. U
A n(A∪B) = n(A) + n(B) – n(A∩B)
= 27 + 42 – 60
= 69 – 60 = 9
Therefore, 9 people like both drinks.
The shaded region is AI.
4. There are 35 students in Art class and 57
The non-shaded region is A.
students in Business class. Find the number of
students who are in Art or Business class;
Word Problems
i. when two classes meet at different hours and
1. Let A and B be two finite sets such that n(A)
12 students are enrolled in both activities.
= 20, n(B) = 28 and n(AUB) = 36. Find n(A∩B).
ii. when two classes meet at the same hour.
Solution
Solution
n(AUB) = n(A) + n(B) – n(A∩B)
i. Let A represent students in Arts class and B
n(A∩B) = n(A) + n(B) – n(AUB)
represent students in Business class.
= 20 + 28 – 36 = 12
When two classes meet at different hours and
12 students are enrolled in both activities.
2. If n(A – B) =18, n(A∪ B) = 70 and n(A∩B) =
n(A) = 35, n(B) = 57, n(A∩B) = 12
25, then find n(B).
⇒ n(AUB) = n(A) + n(B) – n(A∩B)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A only = 10
Solution B only = 20 15
A = {persons who speak English}
B = {persons who speak French} E = A only + B only + A∩B + (A∪ B)1
A – B = {persons who speak English and not 50 = 10 + 5 + 20 + (A∪ B)1
French} (A∪B)1 = 50 – 10 – 5 – 20 = 15
B – A = {persons who speak French and not
English} b. From the diagram;
A∩B ={persons who speak both English and A∪B = 10 + 5 + 20 = 35
French}
Alternatively;
n(A) = 72, n(B) = 43 , n(AUB) = 100 A∪B = A + B – (A∩B)
n(A∩B) = n(A) + n(B) – n(AUB) = 15 + 25 – 5 = 35
= 72 + 43 – 100
= 15 people A∩B1 = 10
The umber of people who speak both English 7. A and B are two sets and the numbers of
and French is 15. elements are shown in the diagram below;
A B
ii. The number of people speaking English
only; 14 + x x 3x
n(A) = n(A – B ) + n(A∩B)
⇒ n(A – B) = n(A) – n(A∩B)
= 72 – 15 Given that n (A) = n (B), calculate:
= 57 people i. x ii. n(A∪ B)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
visited;
Exercises 1.4 a. Accra or Kumasi.
1. M = {x : x is an integer and 2 ≤ x ≤ 20} b. Kumasi but not Accra.
N = {Prime numbers less than 30} c. Only one of the two cities.
a. Draw a Venn diagram and illustrate the d. neither city.
information above.
b. Copy and complete the statement: 6. Draw a Venn diagram of two sets and .
i. M∩N = {…} ii. (M∩N)1 = {…} Given that / / = 15, / / = 20, / ∪ / = 25 and
/ / = 50;
2. In a group of 100 customers at a shopping a. Insert the number of elements to each of the
mall, 80 of them ordered Milo and 72 of them four regions.
ordered Nido. 60 customers ordered both Milo b. Hence find / ∩ / and / ∪Q1/.
and nido;
a. How many customers ordered Milo but not 7. Let the universal set be E = {whole numbers
Nido? less than 20} and let A = {squares less than 20},
b. How many customers ordered Nido but not B = {even number less than 20} and C = {odd
Milo? squares less than 20}
c. How many customers ordered neither of the a. Draw A and C on a Venn diagram, and place
two? the numbers in the correct regions.
b. Draw B and C on a Venn diagram, and place
3. At a certain automotive shop, 50 cars were the numbers in the correct regions.
inspected. 23 of them needed brakes, 34 of c. Shade A∩B on a Venn diagram, and place the
them needed exhaust system? numbers in the correct region.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
P Three set problem arises when a number of
10 + 2x x 5x –8 people are made to choose between three items.
The choice could be for one item only, two
items only, all the three items or none of the
Given that n (P) = n ( ), calculate: three items.
i. n(P ∩Q) ii. n( ) iii. n(P∪ )
Diagrams for Three Sets
10. In an examination, x pupils take the history A. Shading One Region
paper and 3x pupils take the mathematics paper. 1.
Given that 6 pupils take both papers, illustrate U
A B
the data on a Venn diagram indicating the
number of pupils in each region. If the number C
of pupils taking the examination is 46, find x.
The shaded region is A∩B∩C
B. Use true or false for the following;
1. If two sets are equal, they are also 2.
equivalent. U
A B
2. 4 {x : 4 < x ≤ 10
3. An empty set is a finite set C
4. If P = {x : x = 2n, n N} and Q = {x : x = 2n
+ 1, n N}, then P and Q are disjoint sets
The shaded region represents A only
5. A = {x : x is a factor of 24} and B = {x : x is
= A∩B1∩C1 = A∩ (B∩C)1
a multiple of three less than 30}, then P and Q
are overlapping sets
4. 2. U
U B
A B A
C
C
The shaded region represents C only The shaded region represents B∩ (A∪C)
= A1∩B1∩C = (AUB)1∩C
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. U
B. Shading Two Regions A B
1. U
A B C
C
The shaded region represents C∩ (A∪B)
5. U
3. U A B
A B
C C
The shaded region represents A∩C The shaded region represents (B∪C) ∩A1
7. U
A B The shaded regions represent exactly one item
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solving Problems Involving Three Overlapping Sets
U U
B B
A A
I x
III IV (A∩C) - x (B∩C) - x
Fig. I Fig. II
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
9. Number of people in set B only = B ∩ (A1∩C1) = VI
10. Number of people in set C only = C ∩ (A1∩B1) = VII
11. Number of people who do not like any of the three = n(A∪B∪C)1 = VIII
12. Number of people in two or more sets = (II + III + IV + I) = (at least 2 sets) :
= n(A∩B) + n(A∩C) + n(B∩C) – 2n(A∩B∩C)
13. n(A) = V+ I + II + III
14. n (B) = I + II + IV + VI
15. n(C) = I + III + IV + VII
16. n(A∩B) = I + II
17. n(A∩C) = I + III
18. n(B∩C) = I + IV
Note: Questions must be carefully read in order to place values at their respective regions in the
diagram. Any region without a given value must be represented by a preferred variable.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A B
2
10 B = 31 7 14 12
15
9 14 6
How many students study: 20
i. Art and Biology but not Chemistry 19 C
ii. Biology but not Art
iii. Chemistry but neither Art nor Biology
1. How many students do not like either A or
iv. Biology and Chemistry
B?
v. Art or Chemistry (or both)?
2. How many students like B or C?
vi. Art or Chemistry but not both?
3. How many students like both A and C but
vii. Neither Arts nor Biology nor Chemistry
not B?
vii. How many students are in the class?
4. How many students only like A?
5. How many students do not like either B or
Solution
C?
i. n(Art and Biology but not Chemistry) = 3
6. How many students like A or C but not B?
ii. n(Biology but not Art) = 2 + 6 = 8 7. How many students like B or C but not A?
8. How many students like A or C?
iii. n(Chemistry but neither Art nor Biology) = 9. How many students like A and C?
12 10. How many students do not like A and B?
iv. n(Biology and Chemistry)
= 20 + 6 = 26 Solution
1. (A∪B)1 = 19 + 29 = 39
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
b. Find the number of students who have not
9
14 12 enrolled in any of the classes.
15 17 13
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
In each case, substitute the given values (or b + 7 = 30
without if not given) in their respective regions b = 30 – 7 = 23
and find n(A∪B∪C) = n(U).
For set V;
Worked Examples c + 9 – 4 + 4 + 6 – 4 = 40
1. Workers are grouped by their areas of c + 11 = 40
expertise, and are placed on at least one team. c = 40 – 11 = 29
20 are on the marketing team, 30 are on the
sales team, and 40 are on the vision team. 5 Now,
workers are on both the marketing and sales x = a + b + c + (9 – 4) + 4 + (6 – 4) + (5 - 4)
team, 6 workers are on both the sales and
Substitute the values of a, b and c;
vision teams, 9 workers are on both marketing
and vision teams and 4 workers are on all the x = 10 + 23 + 29 + 5 + 4 + 2 + 1
three teams. How many works are there in x = 74
U(x)
total?
S(30)
M(20)
Solution 1 23
10
Let U ={Total number of workers} 4 2
5
M = {marketing team}
29
S = {sales team}
V(40)
V = {vision team}
n(U) = ?, n(S) = 30, n(V) = 40, n(M∩S) = 5,
n(S ∩V) = 6, n(M∩V) = 9.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
For set M,
three items (Complement) f + 40 – x + x + 50 – x = 120
f = 30 + x …………… (1)
In each case, substitute the known values and
workout for n(A∩B∩C) For set P,
g + 40 – x + x + 30 – x = 90
Worked Examples g = 20 + x …………….( 2)
1. In a survey of 200 students of a school, it
For set C,
was found that 120 study Mathematics, 90
h + 50 – x + x + 40 – x = 70
study Physics and 70 study Chemistry, 40
h = -10 + x …………… (3)
study Mathematics and Physics, 30 study
Physics and Chemistry, 50 study Chemistry
For three sets M, P and C, n(M∪P∪C)
and Mathematics and 20 study none of these
= (I + II + III + IV + V + VI + VII + VIII)
subjects.
= x + 40 – x + 50 – x + 30 – x + f + g +h + 20
a. Find the number of students who study all
three subjects.
By substitution,
b. How many students study;
200 = x + 40 – x + 50 – x + 30 – x + 30 + x
i. Physics only? ii. Chemistry only?
+ 20 + x – 10 + x + 20
Solution 200 = 180 + x
Let U = {Students in the school}
x = 200 – 180
M = {Mathematics students}
P = {Physics students} x = 20
C = {Chemistry students}
a 23 - n b
Covering set C,
70 + f + 40 – x + g + 20 = 200 n 18 - n
20 - n
But f = 30 + x and g = 20 + x
c
H = 44
By substitution,
70 + 30 + x + 40 – x + 20+ x + 20 = 200
180 + x = 200 Method I
x = 200 – 180 For set T,
a + 23 – n + n + 20 – n = 56
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x = 20
a = 56 – 23 – 20 + n
b. i. n(P) only = g = 20 + x, but x = 20 a = 13 + n……………………..(1)
= 20 + 20
= 40 For set F,
b + 23 – n + n + 18 – n = 67
ii. n(C) only = h = - 10 + x, but x = 20 b = 67 – 23 – 18 + n
= - 10 + 20 b = 26 + n……………………..(2)
= 10
For set H,
2. In a certain school , there are 118 boys in c + 18 – n + n + 20 – n = 44
form three. Of these, 56 play table – tennis, 67 a = 44 – 18 – 20 + n
play football and 44 play hockey. 23 play table a = 6 + n……………………..(1)
tennis and football, 18 play football and
hockey, and 20 play hockey and table tennis. For three sets T, F and H, n(T∪F∪H)
Everybody play at least one game and n boys = (I + II + III + IV + V + VI + VII + VIII)
play all the three. Express these facts in a Venn = n + 23 – n + 18 – n + 20 – n + a + b + c
diagram and hence find the value of n.
By substitution,
Solution 118 = n + 23 – n + 18 – n + 20 – n + 13 + n +
Let U = {Boy in form three} 26 + n + 6 + n
T = {Boys who play table tennis} 118 = 106 + n
H = { Boys who play hockey} x = 118 – 106
F = { Boys who play football} x = 12
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
n = 12
a + p + q + x + b + r + c = 60
2. In the city of Kwadaso, 60 people own cats, a + b + c + p + q + r + x = 60
dogs or rabbits. If 30 people owned cats, 40
Substitute a, b and c;
owned dogs, 10 owned rabbits and 12 owned
30 – x – p – q + 40 – x – q – r +10 – x – p – r +
exactly two of the three types of pet. How
x + p + q + r = 60
many people own all the three?
80 – 2x – 2p – 2q – 2r + p + q + r = 60
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
n(B∩C) only = r, n(A∩B ∩ C) = x
n(A∪B ∪ C) = 75 Worked Examples
1. In a competition, a school awarded medals in
U(75)
different categories. 36 medals in dance, 12
B
A medals in dramatics and 18 medals in music. If
q 3 these medals went to a total of 45 students and
3
x r only 4 persons got medals in all the three
p
categories, how many received medals in
2
C exactly two of these categories?
Solution
A1 = r + 3 + 2
Method 1:Without the Venn diagram
A1 = 15
A = {persons who get medals in dance}
⇒ r + 3 + 2 = 15
B = {persons who get medals in dramatics}
r = 15 – 2 – 3 = 10
C = {persons who get medals in music}
n(A) = 36, n(B) =12 , n(C) =18
B1 = p + 3 + 2 = 10
n(A∪B∪C) = 45
⇒ p + 3 + 2 = 10
n(A∩B∩C) = 4
p = 10 – 2 – 3 = 5
Exactly two of the three sets A, B and C
C1 = q + 3 + 3= 34
= n(A∩B) + n(B∩C) + n(A∩C) – 3n(A∩B∩C)
⇒ q + 3 + 2 = 34
= n(A∩B) + n(B∩C) + n(A∩C) – 3 (4)……(1)
q = 34 – 3 – 3 = 28
n(A∪B∪C) = n(A) + n(B) + n(C) – n(A∩B) –
n(B∩C) – n(A∩C) + n(A∩B∩C)
n(A∪B ∪ C) = 75
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and C. If 60 students took A, 40 students took
n(ABUC) = 45, n(A∩B∩C) = 4
1
B, 20 students took C and 5 students took all
n(A∪B∪C) = { } the three, how many students took exactly two
U(45)
B(12) courses?
A(36)
a q b
Solution
p 4 r
Let U = {Students}
c A = {Students studying course A}
C(18)
b + q + r + 4 = 12 B(40)
A(60)
b = 12 – 4 – q – r q b
a
b = 8 – q – r ……………(2)
p 5 r
For set C, c
C(20)
c + p + r + 4 = 18
c = 18 – 4 – p – r
For set A,
c = 14 – p – r ……………(3) a + p + q + 5 = 60
a = 60 – 5 – p – q
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 27
a = 55 – p – q ……………(1) which represents the complement of the three
sets can be calculated.
For set B,
b + q + r + 5 = 40 Worked Examples
b = 40 – 5 – q – r 1. a. The Venn diagram below shows choices
b = 35 – q – r ……………(2) of subject by 40 students. 18 chose Chemistry
(C), 20 chose Physics (P) and 15 chose Biology
For set C, (B), 2 chose Chemistry only, 8 chose Physics
c + p + r + 5 = 20 only and1 chose Biology only, 4 chose all
c = 20 – 5 – p – r subjects. Find the number of students who
c = 15 – p – r ……………(3) chose none of the three subjects.
U= 40
Now, C = 18 P = 20
a + p + q + 5 + b + r + c = 90 x
2 8
a + b + c + p + q + r + 5 = 90 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Substitute a, b and c; y 1 B = 15
55 – p – q + 35 – q – r +15 – p – r + 5+ p + q
+ r = 90 Solution
110 + p + q + r = 90 Let x be the number of students who chose P
p + q + r = 110 – 90 and C only
p + q + r = 20 Number of students who offer Physics and
Biology only;
Therefore, the number of students who took
= 20 – (8 + x + 4)
exactly two courses = 20
=8–x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Let U ={Adults}
Now, solving for x;
A = {Adult belonging to A}
p + q + r + 2 + a + b + c + x = 20…..(ii)
B = {Adult belonging to B}
C = {Adult belonging to C}
But from eqn (i);
n(U) = 20, n(A) = 5, n(B) = 7, n(C) = 9,
p+q+r=3
n(A∩B) + n(B ∩C) + n(A∩C) = 3.
⇒3 + 2 + a + b + c + x = 20
n(A∩B∩C) = 2, n(A∪B∪C)1 = x
U(20) Substitute the values of a, b and c in
B(7) 3 + 2 + a + b + c + x = 20
A(5)
q b ⇒ 5 + (3 – p – q) + (5 – q – r) + (7 – p – r) + x
a
= 20
2 r
p (3 – p – q) + (5 – q – r) + (7 – p – r ) + x = 15
c 15 – 2p – 2q – 2r + x = 15
x C(9)
x = 15 – 15 + 2p + 2q + 2r
x = 2(p + q + r)
For set A,
x = 2(3) = 6
a+p+q+2=5
a=5–2–p–q
Type 6
a = 3 – p – q ……………(1)
Finding one or only one intersection
For set B, Worked Examples
b+q+r+2=7 1. Each student in a class of 40 plays at least
b=7–2–q–r one indoor game; chess, carom and scrabble.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
n(A∪B∪C) = 40, n(A∩B∩C) = 4
n(A∪B∪C)1 = 0 Method 2 : Without Venn diagram
U(40) Let A = {students who play chess}
B(20) B = {students who play scrabbles}
A(18)
3 b C = {students who play carom}
a
n(A) = 18, n(B) =20 , n(C) =27
x 4 8
n(A∩B) = 7, n(C∩B) = 12, n(A∩B∩C) = 4
c n(A∪B∪C) = 40, n(A∪B∪C)1 = 0
C(27)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a. fanta, b. coke,
c. at least one soft drink, d. one soft drink, ii. a. Number of students who liked Fanta;
e. none of the drinks. = 8 + 6 = 14
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
≤ x ≤ 20}. The sets A, B, C are defined by A =
b. n(R1∩F∩K1) = 2 + 3 + 9 + y = 16 {p : p is a multiple of }; B = {q : q is a multiple
y + 14 = 16 of 3}; C = { r : r is a multiple of 9}
y = 16 – 14 = 2 i. List the elements of :
a. A∩ C b. A∩B∩C1 c. B ∩ A1∩ C1
c. n(R1∩F1∩K) = 5 + 3 + 9 + z = 21 ii. Illustrate the relationship of A, B and C in a
z + 17 = 21 Venn diagram and list in each region the
z = 21 – 17 numbers which it contains.
z=4
4. A survey of 85 students asked them about
d. n(R∩F∩K) = x + 2 + 3 + 5 + 9 + y + z = a the subject they liked to study. Thirty – five
x + y + z + 19 = a students liked mathematics, thirty – seven liked
history and 26 liked physics. 20 liked
But x = 2, y = 2 and z = 4 mathematics and history, 14 liked mathematics
a = 2 + 2 + 4 + 19 and physics, and 3 liked history and physics. 2
a = 27 students liked all the three subjects.
a. How many of these students like
Exercises 1.6 mathematics or physics?
1. In a region of mixed farming, farms keep b. How many of these students did not like any
pigs, cattle or sheep. There are 77 farms of the three subjects?
altogether. 19 farms keep only pigs, 8 keep c. How many of the students liked mathematics
only cattle and 13 keep only sheep. 13 keep and history but not physics?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
b. Indonesian only. she compared the roster, she saw that E and M
c. none of the languages. had 9 names in common, E and S had 7, and M
d. at least one language and S had 10. She also saw that 4 names were
e. either one or two of the three languages. on all 3 rosters. If the roster for Mrs. Blay 3
classes are combined with no student‟s name
7. In a class of 40 students, 17 has ridden an listed more than once, how many will be on the
air plane, 28 have ridden a boat, 10 has ridden a combined roster.
train, 12 have ridden both an airplane and a
boat, 3 have ridden a train only, and 4 have 11. A form three science class contains 50
ridden an airplane only. Some students of the students all of whom take Mathematics. 18
class have not ridden any of the three modes of study Chemistry, 17 study Biology and 24
transportation and an equal number have taken study Physics. Of those taken three subjects 5
all the three. study physics and chemistry, 7 study Physics
a. How many students have used all three and biology and 6 study Chemistry and
modes of transportation? biology, while 2 take all four subjects.
b. How many students have taken only the a. Draw a Venn diagram to illustrate this
boat? information.
b. Use your diagram to find:
8. In a consumer survey, 85% of those i. how many students study only mathematics.
surveyed liked at least one of the three ii. how many students study only twos subjects.
products; 1, 2 and 3. 50% of those asked like
product 1, 30% liked product 2 and 20% liked 12. The number of farmers growing rice, maize
product 3. If 5% of the people are in the survey and yams is illustrated in the diagram below:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
vii. How many grow rice and maize but not the courses and 1 employee has taken all three
yam? of the courses. How many of the 50 employees
viii. How many grow at least one of the three have taken none of courses?
crops.
Meaning of Surds 8. √ – √ ≠ √
A surd is defined as the root of a number that √ – √ ≠ √ since √ = √
cannot be reduced to a whole number. For (undefined)
example, √ and √8 = 2 are not surds,
as the respective answer is a whole number. On Exercises
the other hand, √ (on A. Show whether statements are true or not.
calculator) is a surd because the answer is 1. √ + √ = √
irrational. Other examples of surds are√ , √ , 2. √ – √ = √
√ .
B.1. Prove that √ √ = √ for all positive
Properties of Surds numbers a and b.
1. √ ×√ = (√ ) = a Hint: Consider (√ √ ) = (√ )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
e.g.√ ×√ = (√ ) = 5 √
2. Prove that = √ for a 0 and > 0.
√
√
e.g. =√ =√ A simplified Surd as Single Root
√
Surds of the form a√ are said to be in their
4. a × √ = a√ simplest form. Such surds can be expressed as
single surd by going through the steps below:
e.g. 5 × √ = 5√
1. Find the square of the coefficient of the root
sign to obtain a perfect square. That is in a√ ,
5. a√ × c√ = a √
find a2
e.g. 2√ × 3√ = 2 × 3√ = 6√
II. Put the perfect square obtained in a root and
multiply by the surd. That is:√ ×√ .
6. a√ × c√ = a (√ ) = acb III. Simply and express the product as a single
e.g. 2√ × 5√ = 2 × 5(√ ) = 2 × 5 × 3 = 30 root. a√ =√ ×√ .
7. √ + √ ≠ √ Worked Examples
e.g. √ + √ ≠ √ since √ ≠5 Express 5√ as a single root.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked Examples
√ – √ +√ = k√ .
1. Add √ + √
5√ – 10√ + 7√ = k√ .
Solution (5 – 10 + 7) √ = k√
√ + √ = (3 + 4 )√ = 7√ 2√ = k√
⇒k=2
2. Simplify √ + √
k2 = 22 = 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Simplify 1. Simplify √ 8 × √
Solution Solution
√ Method 1
= × √88
√ 8×√
= ×√ ×√ =√ ×√
= ×2×√ =√ ×√ ×√ ×√
= ×√ = 3√ × 2√
√
= (3 × 2 ) √ ×√
= = 6√
3. √ Method 2
√ 8×√
=√
Solution
=√
√
√ =√ = = =√ ×√
√
= 6√
Exercises 2.2
Simplify the following: Exercises 2.3
√ √ √ Simplify the following expressions:
A. 1. 2. 3.
√ √ √ 1. √ × √ 4. √ × √
√ √ √
4. 5. 6. 2. 4√ × 2√ 5. √
√ √ √
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Expansion of the form a(b + c)
a(b + c) = ab + bc
2. (a – b)(c – d)
Worked Examples = a(c – d ) – b (c – d )
Simplify the following: = ac – ad – bc + bd
1. √ (√ + √ )
2. √ (√ + √ ) Worked Examples
3. √ (√ – √ ) 1. Multiply ( 2 + √ ) ( 5 – 4 √ )
Solution Solution
1. √ (√ + √ ) (2 + √ ) ( 5 – 4 √ )
=√ ×√ +√ ×√ ) = 2 (5 – 4 √ ) + √ (5 – 4 √ )
=√ +√ = (2)(5) – (2 )(4√ ) + (√ ) (5) – (√ ) (4√ )
= 10 – 8√ + 5√ – 4 × 3
2. √ (√ + √ ) = 10 – 8√ + 5√ – 12
=√ ×√ +√ ×√ ) = 10 – 12 – 8√ + 5√
=√ +√ = –2 – 3√
3. √ (√ – √ ) 2. (4 + √ ) (2 +√ )
=√ ×√ –√ ×√ ) = 4 (2 +√ ) + √ (2 +√ )
=√ –√ = (4)(2) + (4) (√ ) + (2) (√ ) + (√ ) (√ )
=√ –√ ×√ = 8 + 4√ + 2√ + 7
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. (7 + √ )2
Worked Examples = 72 + 2(7)(√ ) + (√ )
1. Multiply (2 – √ ) (2 + √ ) = 49 + 14√ + 3
= 52 + 14√
Solution
Method 1 Method 2
(2 – √ ) (2 + √ ) (7 + √ )(7 + √ )
= (2)2 – ( √ )2 = 7(7 + √ ) + √ (7 + √ )
=4–5 = (7)(7) + (7)(√ ) + (7)(√ ) + (√ ) (√ )
= -1 = 49 + 14√ + 3
= 52 + 14√
Method 2
(2 – √ ) (2 + √ ) 2. (2 + √ )2
= 2 (2 + √ ) – √ (2 + √ )
= 22 + 2(2)(√ ) + (√ )
= (2)(2) + (2)(√ ) – (2)(√ ) – (√ ) (√ )
= 4 + 4√ + 5
=4–5
= 9 + 4√
= -1
Exercises 2.6 3. (6 – 3√ )2
Expand and simplify: = 62 – 2(6)( √ ) + ( √ )
1. (√ + 4) (√ - 4) =36 – 36√ + (9)(5)
2. (1 + √ ) (1 – √ ) = 36 – 36√ + 45
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 39
= 36 + 45 – 36√ Worked Examples
= 81 – 36√ Simplify the following:
√ √ √ √
1. 2. 3. 4.
√ √ √ √ √
4. Express (2 – √ )2 in the form a + b √ ,
where a, b, c Z Solution
√ √ √ √
1. = × = × =
Solution √ √ √ √ √ √ √
√ √ √
(2 – √ )2 2. = =√
√ √
2
= (2) – 2(2)(√ ) + (√ ) 3.
√
=
√ √
=√ =√ = 2√
√ √
= 4 – 4√ + 3
√ √ √ √
= 4 + 3 – 4√ 4. = = =
√ √ √ √ √
= 7 – 4√
⇒ a = 7, b = - 4 and √ = √ Type 2
1. Write the following in simplest radical form
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. (√ – √ )2 a + b√ , where a , b Q, n Z
√ √
= (√ )2 – 2(√ )(√ ) + (√ ) a. b.
= x – 2√ + 10
Solution
√
Exercises 2.7 a.
Simplify: √ √ √
= + =2+ =2+ =2+√
1. ( 1 – 2 √ )2 2. (√ – √ )2
⇒ a = 2, b = 1 and n = 2
3. (5√ + 3√ )2 4. (3√ – √ )2
5. Express (7 + √ )2 – (7 – √ )2 in the form
√
k√ , k N b.
√ √ √ √
= + =2+ =2+ =2+
Division of Surds
=2+√
Type 1
√
⇒ a = 2, b = 1 and n = 2
If a is divisible by b, then = √ , where √ is
√
√ Exercises 2.8
a simplified surd. e.g. =√ ,
√
A. Simplify:
√
Type 2 1. 2. 15√ ÷ 3√
√
√ √ 3. √ ÷√ 4. √ ÷√
If a is not divisible by b, then = , where k
√ √
√ √ √
≠ 0. e.g. = = B. Write in simplest radical form a + b√ ,
√ √ √
Solution
Rationalizing Denominators
√ √
Rationalizing the denominator of a surd is the 1. = × =
√ √ √
act of getting rid of any surd in the
√ √ √
denominator. Usually, the word “simplify” is 2.
√
=
√
×
√
= =
used in place of rationalizes.
√ √ √ √
3. = × =
√ √ √
Type 1 : Surds of the form: √ √ √ √ √
√
4. = × = =
If the denominator of a surd of the form: √ √ √
√
√ √ √ √ √
(simple surd) is irrational, it has to be made 5. = = =
√ √ √ √ √
rational through the process called
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Now rationalize the denominator:
rationalizing the denominator.
√ √ √ √
= × = =
√ √
Steps:
I. In , identify √ , as the irrational Exercises 2.9
√
denominator. A. Simplify the following:
II. Multiply the numerator and the denominator √ √
1. 2. 3. 4. √. /
√ √ √ √
of the fraction by (meaning the same value is
√
√ √
maintained since
√
= 1). That is:
√
×
√
B. 1. Express – in the form k √
√ √
III. Multiply numerators and denominators, not
forgetting the fact that √ × √ = b 2. simplify
√
–
√
–
√
√ √ √ √ √ √ √ √
That is : × =
√ √
IV. The denominator of the R.H.S. is now a √
3. If a = , find the value of a2 +
rational number, hence, the process is
completed.
√ √ √ √
4. If x = and y = , find the value of
√ √ √ √ √
√
= x2 + y2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Rationalize and simplify: =
√ √
1. 2. 3. 4. =
√
√ √ √ √ √ √
Solution √
4.
1. √ √
√ √ √ √
√ = ×
= × √ √ √ √
√ √
√ (√ √ )
( √ ) =
= (√ √ )(√ √ )
( √ )( √ )
(√ )(√ ) (√ )(√ )
√ =
= (√ ) (√ )
(√ )
√ √
√ =
=
√ √ √
= =
= - 6 + 3√
5. Write the following in the form a + b√
2. √ √
√ √ a. b. c.
√ √ √
√ √
= ×
√ √ √ √
(√ √ )
Solution
=( √
√ √ )(√ √ a. = ×
√ √ √
√ √
=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=
√ L. H. S = R.H. S
=
√
– =2
√ √
= –
√
= – Exercises 2.10
A. Rationalize each denominator and
√ √ √ simplify if possible:
c. = ×
√ √ √ 1. 2. 3.
√ √ √
( √ )( √ )
=( 4. 5. 6.
√ )( √ ) √ √ √ √ √
( √ ) √ ( √ ) 7. 8. 9.
= √ √ √
( √ ) √ ( √ )
√ √ √
7.
√ √
8.
√
9.
√
2. Simplify –
√ √
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1.
√
–
√
2. + –
√ √ √ √ √ √
√ √ √
3. – 4.
√ √
–
√ √ =. /– = – =
√ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √ √
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0 = x2 – 6x + 3x + 9 – 27
Worked Examples
0 = x2 – 3x – 18
1. Solve x – 5 = √
(x – 6) (x + 3) = 0 (Solving by factorization)
x - 6 = 0 or x + 3 = 0
Solution
x = 6 or x = -3
x–5=√
Check
Using the principle of squaring;
When x = 6;
( – ) = (√ ) 3+√ =x
(x – 5) (x – 5) = x+ 7 3+√ ( ) =6
x2 – 10x + 25 = x + 7
3+√ =6
x2 – 11x + 10 = 0
3+3=6
(x – 9) (x – 2) = 0 (Solving by factorization)
6 = 6 (TRUE)
x – 9 = 0 or x – 2 = 0
x = 9 or x = 2 When x = -3
3+√ =x
Check
3+√ ( ) = -3
x–5=√
When x = 9, 3 + √ = -3
⇒9 – 5 = √ 3 + 6 = -3
9 = -3 (FALSE)
4=√
Therefore, the solution set is 6.
4 = 4 (TRUE)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(√ ) = (√ )
3x + 5 = x – 1 1. √ =√
3x – x = -1 – 5 2. √ =√
2x = - 6 3. √ =√
x = -3 4. √ =√
5. √ +x=7
5. Solve √ 8=x 6. √ + 1 = 2√
Solution C. Solve:
√ 8=x 1. √ = 2x
(√ 8) = ( ) 2. √ =x
3x + 18 = x2 3. √ =3
x2 – 3x – 18 = 0 4. √ =4
(x – 6) (x + 3) = 0 (Solving by factorization)
5. √ =x
x = 6 or x = -3
6. √ =x
Check 7. √ =x
When x = 6, R.H.S = 6 8. √ = 2x
√ 8=6 9. √ – √ =3
√ ( ) 8=6
Type 2
√ 8 8=6 This is usually an equation involving operation
√ = 6 (TRUE) of two different radicals. Eg. √ +√ =3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(√ ) =( – √ ) x2 – 11x + 18 = 0
2
x + 2 = 3 – (2) (3) √ + (√ ) (x2 – 2x) – (9x + 18) = 0 (Solving by factorization)
x+2 =9–6√ + x–1 x (x – 2) – 9 (x – 2) = 0
x–x +2 -9+1 = –6√ (x – 2) (x – 9) = 0
-6 = – 6 √ x = 2 or x = 9
1= √
Check;
= (√ )
When x = 2, R.H.S = 1
1=x–1
x=1+1 √ –√ ( ) =1
x=2 √ –√ =1
3 – 2 = 1 (TRUE)
Check:
When x = 2; R.H.S = 3 When x = 9, R.H.S = 1
√ +√ =3 √ –√ ( ) =1
√ +√ =3 √ –√ =1
2 + 1 = 3 (TRUE) 4–5=1
Therefore, the solution set is x = 2 -1 = 1 (FALSE)
Therefore, the solution set is x = 2
2. Solve √ +√ =1
3. Solve √ – √ =1
Solution
√ –√ =1 Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
of x and y.
x = 1 or x = 5
Solution
Check;
x–3+√ = -1 + √
When x = 1, R.H.S = 1
x – 3 = -1 and √ =√
√ – √ =1
x = -1 + 3 = 2
√ ( ) – √ ( ) =1
√ =√
√ – √ =1
2–1=1 (√ ) = (√ )
1 = 1 (TRUE) y+2=5
y=5–2
When x = 5, R.H.S = 1 y=3
√ –√ =1 (x, y) = (2, 3)
√ ( ) –√ ( ) =1
Exercises 2.13
√ –√ = 1
A. Solve for x and y given that they are
4–3=1
rational:
1 = 1 (TRUE)
Therefore, the solution set is x = 1 or x = 5 1. x + y√ = 3 + 2 √
2. -x + y√ = 11 – 3 √
Exercises 2.12B 3. x + y√ = -3 √
Solve the following: 4. 15 - 4√ = x + y√
1. √ –√ =1 5. + √
2. √ –√ =2 6. + y√ = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
b=7–a
the following in simplest radical form:
1. (3 + √ )3 2. (√ + √ )3 Substitute b = 7 – a into eqn (2)
a(7 – a) = 12
The Square Root of an Irrational Number 7a – a2 = 12
Consider the square of; a2 – 7a + 12 = 0
(√ + √ )2 = a + 2√ + b, where a and b are (a – 3) (a – 4) = 0
positive rational numbers. ⇒ a = 3 or a = 4 and b = 4 or b = 3
(√ + √ )2 = a + 2√ + b The required number is (√ +√ ) or
= (a + b) + 2√ (√ + √ ) = (2 + √ ),
= (a + b) + √ ⇒√ √ = (2 + √ ),
⇒ a = 12 or a = 6 and b = 6 or b = 12 √
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
√ √
or
√ 8 √ = (√ – √ )
√ √
= ( √ –√ ) + or –
From (1)
2. Express as rational denominator.
m = 12 – n √
Definition Now;
The word “binary” means composed of two 49 * 2 = 49 + 2 + 2(49)(2)
pieces. A binary operation is simply a rule for = 49 + 2 + 196
combining two values to create a new value. = 247
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Example of a binary operation is a ♦ b = 2ab – a ⋄ b = a2 – 2ab, where a, b R.
a, defined under a given set. (3 ⋄ 5) ⋄ (5 ⋄ 3)
ii. (8 * 4) * 2
3. Let a * b = , a + b ≠ 0, and a, b R, find;
Evaluate bracket first;
(5 * 4) = 5 + 4 + 2(5)(4) i. 7 * 4 ii. (4 * 7) * 5 iii. (4 * 7) * (7 * 5)
= 5 + 4 + 40
= 49 Solution
i. a * b = ,
(5 * 4) * 2 = 49 * 2 ( )( )
7*4= =
( )( )
(7 * 5) = = *√ . / + (√ ) – 2. / (√ )
√ √ √
+ 3 – 2. / (√ )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=
√ √
(4 * 7) * (7 * 5) = * = +3–1=
⁄ ⁄ ⁄ ii..√ / * .√ /
* = = = √ √
⁄ ⁄ ⁄
* = . / + . / – 2. / . / = 6.14
4. x * 4 denotes the integer part when x is
divided by 4 and y ○ 7 denotes the remainder 2. The binary operation ○ is defined on the set
when y is divide by 7. Calculate 81 * 4 and 117 of no zero real number by a ○ b = ab – .
○ 7.
i. Evaluate (1 + √ ) ○ (2 – √ ), giving your
Solution answer in the form x + y √
x * 4 denotes the integer part when x is divided
Solution
by 4.
a ○ b = ab –
81 * 4 = = 20 = 20
(1 + √ ) ○ (2 – √ )
√
y ○ 7 denotes the remainder when y is divided = (1 + √ )(2 – √ ) -
√
by 7. √ √
= 2 – √ + 2√ – 2 – ×
117 ○ 7 = = 16 = 5 √ √
( √ )( √ )
= 2√ – √ – ( √ )( √ )
Involving surds √ √
=√ –
1. The operation * is defined on the set of real (√ )
numbers by p * q = p2 + q2 – 2pq, where p, q R =√ –
√
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
definitions. iv. (2 * 3) ○ (2 * 5)
2. Perform the brackets first before you ( )( )
2*3= =
combine the second operator.
( )( )
Worked Examples 2*5= =
1. Let a ○ b = a2 – 2ab, where a, b R and
a*b= , a + b ≠ 0, and a, b R, evaluate; (2 * 3) ○ (2 * 5) = ○
i. 2 ○ (3 * 5) ○ = . / - 2. / . /
ii. (2○ 3) * (2 ○ 5)
iii. 2 * (3 ○ 5) = –
iv. (2 * 3) ○ (2 * 5) =
= +. /=
ii. p q
i. Simplify of a cake
p q= –
ii. Evaluate:
= – = – = =– a. b.
⁄ ⁄
iii. Use your answers in i. and ii. to suggest a
⁄ property for the operation
iii. = =–
⁄ iv. Evaluate:
a. ( ) b. ( )
b. From p * q = , v. Evaluate
By substitution,
+ = Truth Set under a Given Binary Operation
⁄ ⁄
1. Identify the binary operation and its
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= definition.
⁄
By cross multiplication
Worked Examples
(p + q) (q – p) = (pq)(pq)
1. A binary operation is defined on the set of
p2 – q2 = p2q2…………..(1)
rational numbers Q, a* b = a + b + 2ab. Find
the value of z if z * 3 = 9
But p q= –
Solution
2 2
p q = – = a* b = a + b + 2ab.
z * 3 = z + 3 + 2(z) (3)
From eqn (1); = z + 3 + 6z
p2 – q2 = p2q2 = 7z + 3
p2 q2 = =1
But z * 3 = 9
⇒ z
Exercises 3.1 7z = 9 – 3
1. Suppose a * b = 3a + 2b, find √ * √ 7z = 6
z=
2. In this question “ of a cake” means the
fraction of a cake formed by taking of a cake 2. Let a ⋄ b = a2 – 2ab, where a, b R. Find a
if a ⋄ 4 = 9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a * 3 = 19 k=
a * 3 = 3a + a + 3
k=2
= 4a + 3
⇒ 4a + 3 = 19
ii. k * 8 = 12 * 3
4a = 19 – 3
=
4a = 16
a=4 =
( a * 3) + (2 * a) = 4m =3
Substitute a = 4 k–8=3×8
(4 * 3) + (2 * 4) = 4m k – 8 = 24
[(4)(3) + 4 + 3] + [(2) (4) + 2 + 4] = 4m k = 24 + 8
(12 + 7) + (8 + 6) = 4m k = 23
19 + 14 = 4m
33 = 4m
6. x * y denotes . Given that a * b = 4b * a,
m=
find the two possible values of a * b.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3 * y = 2(3) – y II. If there is n number of elements in the set,
=6–y prepare n × n square table
III. Place the operator at the top left corner of
y * (6 – y) = 2y – (6 – y) the table
2y – 6 + y = 6 IV. Occupy the first row and column of the
3y = 12 table with the elements of the given set as
y=4 shown below;
* n1 n2 n3
Exercises 3.2
n1
1. The operation * on the integers a and b is
n2
defined by a * b = ab + b. Find x given that n3
4*x=x*4
IV. Operate each element of the first row
2. The operation ○ is defined over the set of against each element of the second row under
real numbers, R, by a ○ b = a + b2. Find: the binary definition and record your answers in
a. (3 ○ 2) ○ 5 the cells or boxes until it is completed.
b. k if 3 ○ k = 7
Worked Examples
3. A binary operation * is defined on R, the set 1. The operation ‡ is defined on the set R of
real numbers by p*q = p2 + 2pq. Find; real numbers by x ‡ y = x2 + y2 – 4
i. 3 * 5 ii. 5 * 3 a. Copy and complete the table below for the
iii. (3 * 5) * (5 *3) iv. p if p * 4 = 9 operation ‡ on the set M = {1, 2, 3, 4}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2 ‡ 1 = 22 + 12 – 4 = 1 3*3= , R9
2 ‡ 3 = 22 + 32 – 4 = 9 3*7= , R1
3 ‡ 3 = 32 + 32 – 4 = 14
4‡ 2 = 42 + 22 – 4 = 16
7*1= , R7
4 ‡ 3 = 42 + 32 – 4 = 21
7*3= , R1
‡ 1 2 3 4 7*7= , R9
1 2 1 6 13
2 1 4 9 16
3 6 9 14 21 * 1 3 7
4 13 16 21 28 1 1 3 7
3 3 9 1
b. From the table; 7 7 1 9
i. 2 ‡ 4 = 16 and 4 ‡ 2 = 16
Exercises 3.3
ii. 2 ‡ 4 = 4 ‡ 2 = 16. 1. A binary operation * is defined on the set R by
The operation ‡ is commutative because it is a * b = the remainder when ab is divided by 4.
symmetrical along the leading diagonal. a. Draw a table for * on the set S = {0, 1, 2, 3}
b. Use your table to find:
iii. From the table (1‡ 2) = 1
(1 ‡ 2) ‡ 4 = 1 ‡ 4 = 13 i. 3 * 3 ii. (1 * 3) * 3 iii. (3 * 2) * (1 * 2)
2. Let S = {1, 3, 7}. The operation * is defined 2. 1. A binary operation * is defined on the set
on x as follows: For all a, b S, a * b is the R by a * b = the remainder when a + b is
remainder when the results of multiplying a by divided by 5. Draw a table for * on the set S =
{1, 2, 3, 4}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
*b=b*a ⇒a*b=b*a
Therefore , the operation * is commutative
Worked Examples
1. If a * b = a + b + ab, show whether the The Commutative Property on a Table
operation * is commutative or not.
A binary operation, * defined over a set S, is
Solution said to be commutative if;
The operation * is commutative if; 1. A table of values constructed is symmetrical
a*b=b*a about the leading diagonal.
a * b = a + b + ab
Consider the table below;
b * a = b + a + ba
a + b + ab = b + a + ba * e f g h
Therefore a * b = b * a e e f g h
The operation * is commutative f f f h h
g g h g h
2. Let a * b = a + 2b be defined over the set of h h h h h
real numbers R. Verify whether or not, * is
commutative. It can be seen that the table is symmetrical
about the leading diagonal. That is to say that
Solution each set of entries is a “reflection” of the other
For the operation to be commutative, in the leading diagonal. Therefore the
a*b=b*a operation* is said to be commutative.
a * b = a + 2b
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Set M = { 1, 2, 3, 4}
R. H.S: a ○ (b ○ c) = (ab + a + b) ○ c
* 1 2 3 4 Let ab + a + b = n
1 -2 -1 0 1 ⇒ (a ○ b) ○ c = n ○ c
2 -1 0 1 3
3 0 1 2 3 By substitution,
4 1 2 3 4 (a ○ b) ○ c =(ab + a + b) c + (ab +a + b) + c
= abc + ac + bc + ab + a + b + c
The operation * is commutative because the = a + b + c + ab + bc + ac + abc
table is symmetrical about the leading diagonal Comparing L.H.S results to R.H.S results, it is
seen that a ○ (b ○ c) = (a ○ b) ○ c
Alternatively, Therefore, the operation ○ is associative.
From the table;
2 * 3 = 1 and 3 * 2 = 1 2. The operation * is defined on the set Q, of
⇒2 * 3 = 3 * 2 = 1 rational numbers by a * b = , a + b ≠ 0.
Therefore, the operation is commutative. Show whether * is associative or not.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= a + ab + abc
a*. / ……………………(3)
Consider the R. H. S
Let . /=y (a * b) * c
By the definition;
By definition; a * b = a + ab
a*y= ……………….(4) Let (a * b) = y
⇒ y = a + ab
y * c = y + yc
Substitute y = . / in eqn (4)
. ⁄ / Substitute y = a + ab
a*. / =
. ⁄ / ⇒ (a * b) * c = a + ab + (a + ab)c
⁄ = a + ab + ac + abc
=
⁄
= L. H. S ≠ R.H.S
a + ab + abc ≠ a + ab + ac + abc
L.H.S. = R. H. S. Therefore , the operation * is associative.
(a * b) * c = a * (b * c) = 4. The binary operation ○ is defined on the set
Therefore, the operation * is associative. of real numbers by x ○ y = x2 – y. Show
whether or not ○ is associative.
3. The operation * is defined on the set Q, of
rational numbers by a * b = a + ab. Show Solution
whether * is associative or not. x ○ y = x2 – y
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
complete the table below for * to the nearest
= x2 – y2 + z
whole number.
L.H.S ≠ R. H. S
* 1 2 3 4 5
x4 – 2x2y + y2 – z ≠ x2 – y2 + z
1 1
Therefore, the operation ○ is not associative.
2 1 1 1
3 1 1 2 2
Associative Property on the Table 4 1 1 2 2
Consider the table below for the operation ○ 5 1 1 1 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Therefore, from the table, * is associative. (2 * 4) * 6
= 3 * 6 (Not defined on the table)
2. i. Copy and complete the table below for
⇒2 * ( 4 * 6) ≠ (2 * 4) * 6
operation * defined by a * b = ( 2b – a) on the
Therefore, the operation * is not associative.
set P = {2, 4, 6, 8}
Exercise 3.4
* 2 4 6 8
A. 1. The binary operation * is defined on Z by
2 1 3 5
4 2 4 6 x * y = 1 – 2xy. Show that * is commutative and
6 1 3 associative.
8 2 4
2. The operation * on R is defined by a * b =
ii. From the table, show whether or not * is ( )
associative. a. Simplify the right hand side and calculate:
– 5 * (– 1) and *0
Solution
b. Prove that the operation * is commutative
a * b = ( 2b – a) if * is a binary operation on Q. Find if a * b =
P = {2, 4, 6, 8} a2 + b2 is commutative and associative.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
operation * is defined over S. If a * b always
gives an answer which is also in S, then the set * is closed under A in each of the following;
S is said to be closed with respect to *. That is a i. 1 * 2 ii. 3 * 4
* b S, a, b S, the * is said to be closed.
Solution
Worked Examples i. x * y = 3x – xy.
1. The operation ○ is defined on the set K = {2, But x = 1 and y = 2
4, 6} by a ○ b = 1 * 2 = 3(1) – (1)(2)
=3–2
i. Draw a table for ○ on the set K.
=1
ii. Determine whether or not the operation ○ is
1 * 2 = 1 A, therefore set A is closed under
closed on K.
the operation*
iii. Find the truth set of 2 ○ 4 = 4 ○ x
ii. x * y = 3x – xy
Solution 3 * 4 = 3(3) – (3)(4)
K = {2, 4, 6} = 9 – 12
a○b= =-3
2○2= =2 2○4= =4
3 * 4 = - 3 ∉ A, therefore set A is not closed
2○6= =6 4○2= =4 under the operation*
4○4= =4 4○6= =4
Exercises 3.5
6○2= =2 6○4= =4
1. The binary operation ○ is defined as:
6○6= =6 x○ y = x + y + 2xy.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
following; a ○ a = a + a – aa…………………(2)
i. 5 * 6 ii. 5 * 8 iii. 7 * 9 iv. 6 * 9
eqn (1) = eqn(2)
The Distributive Property a + a – aa = -3
If a, b and c are three members of the set of real 2a – a2 = -3
numbers, R and the binary operations * and ○ a2 – 2a - 3 = 0
are defined over S, then * is distributive over ○
if a * (b ○ c) = (a * b) ○ (a * c) Solving by factorization;
(a + 1) (a – 3) = 0
However, if a * (b ○ c) ≠ (a *b) ○ ( a * c), then a + 1 = 0 or a – 3 = 0
* is not distributive over ○ a = -1 or a = 3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
over the set, R, of real numbers by a * b = a –
2b and a ○ b = a + b + ab, where a, b R. Some binary operations may have identity
i. Find the values of 3 * - 5 , - 5 * 3: elements under some given sets. Let the
ii. Is the operation commutative on R? identity element of the binary operation be e,
iii. Determine whether or not 4 ○ (3 * - 5) = (4○ and x be a member of a set S. If * is defined
3) * (4 ○ – 5. over the set S, then we can equally say that
iv. Is the operation ○ distributive over *? x * e = x or e * x = x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a * e = a…………………..(1)
Solution
a * e = ae……………….(2)
x ○ y = xy + x + y
x ○ e = x………………………(1)
eqn (1) = eqn (2);
x ○ e = xe + x + e……………..(2)
a = ae
eqn(1) = eqn(2); 4a = ae
⇒xe + x + e = x e=
Worked Examples
Put y = 0 in eqn (1);
1. The combination table for the set S = {a, b,
ax – b(0) = a
ax = a c, d}under the operation * is given below.
x=
* a b c d
x=1 a b c a d
The identity element is (1, 0)
b c d b a
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
c a b c d
Exercises 3.7
d d a d c
A. Find the identity element of ecah.
1. a * b = 3ab 2. a * b = a + b + 1
State the identity element.
3. a * b = ab + 1
Solution
B. 1. An operation * on gthe set of real
( )
From the table,
numbers is define by a * b = – 1 for all a*c=c*a=a
a, b R. What is the identity element in R b*c=c*b=b
under * c*c=c
d*c=c*d=a
2. What is the identity element for a * b = (a – Therefore, c is the identity element.
b) 2 for all a, b Q
Method 2
3. Let * be a binary operation defined on the set Consider the third row :
Z of integers by a * b = a + b – 5 for all a, b Z.
i. Show that * is commutative and associative. c a b c d
ii. Find the identity element if it exist.
Compared to the main set S = {a, b, c, d}, the
4. Let * be a binary operation defined on N × arrangements are the same (orderly). Hence, c
N, by (a, b) * (c, d) = (ac, bd). is the identity element.
i. Show that * is commutative and associative.
ii. Find the identity element for * 2. The operation * is defined on the set S = {0,
1, 2, 3, 4} by a * b = /a – b/, where /x/ means
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4 4 3 2 1 0
5. Define a binary operation * on A = {1, 2, 3,
From the table, observe that a * 0 = 0 * a = a, 4, 5 as a * b = ab(mod 5) for all a, b Z. Show
for all a S. Therefore, the identity element is that 1 is the identity element with respect to *
zero.
ii. The Inverse Property
Operation Associative Commutative
Consider the statements below;
Addition Yes Yes
5+ = 0, -14 + = 0, + = 0, a + = 0,
Multiplication Yes Yes
In all cases, the sum of the addends is zero
Subtraction No No
under the operation +. This means that the
Division No No
known number added to the unknown is zero,
where zero is the identity element of addition.
Exercises 3.8 The truth sets are as follows;
1. The operation * is defined by a * b denotes 5 + , - = 0, -14 + , - = 0,
, where a, b {-2, 0 2} +0 1 = 0, a+, -=0
i. Construct the operation table for *
ii. State the identity element for * Hence, it is conclusive that for each given
number, there is another number which
2. The operation ○ is defined on the set S = combines with it to give the identity element
{ 1, 3, 5} by the table below. zero. That special number which combines with
a given number to give the identity element is
○ 1 3 5 called the additive inverse of that number.
1 3 1 5
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 68
Thus, the additive inverse of 5 is – 5, - 14 is 14, i. 7 ii. - 11
a is – a and vice – versa.
Solution
Likewise, consider the following; a. a * b = a + b + 5.
5× = 1, -14 × = 1, × = 1, a × =1 a * e = a …………………..(1)
a * e = a + e + 5…………..(2)
In each case, the product of the known and the
unknown number is one under the operation ×,
eqn (1) = eqn (2);
where 1 is the identity element of
⇒a+e+5=a
multiplication.
The truth sets are as follows;
Solving for e,
5 × 0 1 = 1, -14 × 0 1 = 1, e+5=a–a
× 0 1 = 1, a×0 1=1 e+5=0
e=-5
Hence, we can conclude that for each given
Now,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
number, there is another special number which
a* = e………………(3)
multiplies with it to give the identity element
a* =a+ + 5…..(4)
one, where the special number is called the
multiplicative inverse of that number. Thus, the eqn (3) = eqn (4);
multiplicative inverse of 5 is , - 14 is , a is ⇒a+ +5=e
and vice – versa. But e = - 5
Solving for
These special properties can be extend to binary
a+ +5=-5
operations. Now, if is the inverse of a, then
a+ = - 10
for the operation *, a * = e, where e is the
= - 10 – a
identity element.
b. = - 10 – a
To find the inverse of a binary operation,
i. = - 10 – 7 = - 17
1. find the identity element of the binary
operation a * e = a ii. = - 10 – (-11) = 1
2. substitute the value of the identity
2. The operation * is defined on the set R, of
element, e, in a * =e
real numbers by a * b = a + b – ab. Find the
3. Workout for
inverse element and use your results to find the
inverse of 4.
Worked Examples
1. a. A binary operation * is defined by a * b = Solution
a + b + 5. Find the inverse element. a * b = a + b – ab.
b. Use your results to find the inverse of ; a * e = a……………….(1)
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 69
a * e = a + e – ae………(2) x + e + xe = x
e= =0
b. Let be the inverse of x.
Now, By definition,
a* = e……………………(3) x* = e…………………(3)
a* =a+ –a ….…(4) x* =x+ +x ………………..(4)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a+ –a =e x+ +x =e
But e = 0
But e = 0
x+ +x =0
a+ –a =0
Solving for ,
Solving for ,
+x =-x
–a =-a
(1 + x) = - x
(1 – a) = - a
= , x ≠ -1
=
= =
= =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. A binary operation * is dfined on Q by (a, b) Therefore, c is the identity element.
* (c, d) = (ac, ad + b). Find :
i. the identity element of * Now,
ii. the invertible (inverse) element of * From the first row,
a * b = c.
The Inverse Element on the Binary Table Therefore, the inverse of a is b
1. Carefully read the rows and columns to
identify the identity element. From the second row,
2. Read the inverse of an element x, by b * a = c.
selecting a row that contains the element x. Therefore, the inverse of b is a.
3. Check if this row contains the identity
element. From the third row,
4. Read off the element which combines with x c * c = c.
to give the identity element as the inverse of x. Therefore, the inverse of c is c.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
G E E G G
H E F G H operation on addition defined on I, find unique
inverse element for each of the set.
b. i. The identity element for the operation ∪
x∪e =x 3. A set P = {2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12}. The operation *
From the table, there is no identity element for is defined as follows: if a and b are any
the operation ∪, none of the rows or columns elements of P, then a * b denotes the remainder
obeys the identity rule given by: when the results of multiplying a by b is
x∪e =x divided by 14; For example, 6 * 12 = 2
a. Find the identity element of P, that is the
ii. The inverse of the element G element e, such that e * a = a for every element
of the set.
Exercises 3.10 b. Find the inverse of 10, that is the element y
1. The operation * is defined by a * b denotes such that y * 10 = e where e is the identity
element.
, where a, b {-2, 0, 2}
c. Solve the equation 10 * x = 4, by multiplying
i. Construct the operation table for * both sides of the equation by the value of y
ii. State the identity element for * above.
iii. For each element, state its inverse or write d. Use similar technique to solve the equation
“none” as the case may be . 6*x=2
e. Find two solutions of the equation x * x = 4
Consider the rule “is one – third of” for the Here, the first number is an element of the
domain {6, 12, 33, 45}, the co-domain is domain and the second number, the
obtained by planting the elements of the corresponding element in the range.
domain in the rule. Thus, the rule “is one –
third of” is mathematically expressed as : Exercises 4.1
y= x 1. If A = {10, 14, 12} and B = {2, 3, 4, 5}.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Draw an arrow diagram to show the relation
When x = 6, y = (6) = 2
“has as factor” from set A to set B. Also, write
When x = 12, y = (12) = 4 the relation as a set of ordered pairs of
When x = 33, y = (33) = 11 numbers.
When x = 45, y = (45) = 15 2. Given that set P = {8, 10, 14} ans Q = {4, 5,
Co domain = {2, 4, 11, 15} 7}. The relation from set P to set Q is “a factor
of”. Represent the above relation by using:
This is shown in the diagram below: i. an arrow diagram;
x y ii. ordered pairs.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. From the diagram, find the range. Domain = * , , , +
2. Rule: “ ”
Solution Domain = * , , , , +
i. Odd prime factors of 30 = {2, 3, 5} 3. Rule: “three less than one – fourth”, Domain
Domain = {2, 3, 5} =* , , , +
. / ( ,
3. x y
( , . /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B. Identify the rule of relations;
1. x y
Domain Co-domain
( + ( +
4. Many – to – many Relations
It is the type of relation in which more than one
member of the domain match to many members 2. x y
of the co-domain as shown below for the
relation, “is less than” ( , ( ,
x y
3.
( + ( +
( , ( ,
Domain Co-domain 8
4.
Exercises 4.3
Identify the type of relation:
8
1. ( , ( ,
x y
( , ( ,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put the elements of the codomain in x = to ( , ( ,
8
obtain the elements of the domain.
When y = 20, x = =4
3. The rule of a relation is “four exponent of”.
When y = 30, x = =6 If the domain = {1, 2, 3, 4}, find the co-domain
When y = 40, x = =8 and show the relation in a diagram.
When y = 50, x = = 10
Solution
The rule is “is four exponent of” : y = 4x
Domain = {4, 6, 8, 10} Domain is * , , , 8, , +.
Codomain = {20, 30, 40, 50} Let x represent the elements of the domain.
Rule : y = 4x,
This can be represented diagrammatically When x = 1, y = 4 = 4
as; When x = 2, y = 42 = 16
“5 times of” When x = 3, y = 43 = 64
x y When x = 4, y = 44 = 256
( , ( ,
8
( , ( ,
Worked Examples
1. The rule of a relation is “is one-third of”. Domain Co-domain
Given the domain, {12, 15, 18, 24}, find the co-
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
between two or more variables. For example,
4. The co-domain of a relation is {25, 49, 81,
the equation y = 2x defines the set of ordered
100}. If the rule of the relation is “is a square
pairs such that the y – value is twice the x –
of”, determine the domain of the relation, for
value.
all positive integers and draw a diagram of the
relation.
When a function is defined by an equation, a
function notation is used. For example, the
Functions
equation y = 2x can be written in function
A function is a special kind of relation in which
notation as: f(x) = 2x, where f is the name of the
each element of the domain matches to one and
function, x is an input from the domain of the
only one element of the co – domain. Thus,
function, and f(x) is the function value (y –
function f from set x to a set y is a
axis) corresponding to x.
correspondence that assigns to each element of
x, exactly one element of y. For example, to
f(x) is read as “f of x” or the “value of the
each book in the library, there corresponds a
function f at x”.
number of pages in the book and to each human
being there corresponds a birth date. The names of functions are often given by a
lowercase or uppercase letters, such as f, g, h, p,
Each correspondence in the above examples k and M.
involves two sets x and y.
x denotes the set of books in the library Representation of Functions
and y, the number of pages. The element 1. Formulas (rule).
of x is the argument of f. The set y is the 2. Ordered pairs (x, y).
domain of the function. 3. Set builder notations. e.g. {x, y: x + y = 6}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
f(y) =
One to one simply means we never get the
same “y” value twice. For one – to – one function
f(x) = f(y) ⇒ x = y
Illustrative Examples =
The function below is one – one.
(x – 3) (y + 2) = (x + 2) (y – 3)
xy + 2x – 3y – 6 = xy – 3x + 2y – 6
2x – 3y = – 3x + 2y
( ,
2x + 3x = 3y + 2y
5x = 5y
( )
This function below is not one – one. x=y
The functuion is one- to – one.
( + . /
3. Why is f : R → R given by f(x) = x2 not a one
This is because as ordered pairs, we have: – to – one?
(1, a), (2, a), (3, b). “a” appears twice as y
Solution
value and that is a violation of the one – to –
f(x) = x2
one rule.
f(y) = y2
Proof of one - to - one functions
Worked Examples For one – to – one function;
1. If f : R →R is given by f(x) = 3x + 7, proof it f(x) = f(y) ⇒ x = y
is one to one. x2 = y2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( + ( , Exercises 4.6
1. If f(x) = 3x + 2, proof graphically and
algebraically that f is one – to – one.
A B
As ordered pairs, the function can be expressed 2. If g(x) = x2 – 3, proof graphically and
as (3, 1), (4, 3), (5, 5). Since no y value appears algebraically that g is not one – to – one.
twice, the function, f(x) = 2x – 5 is a one – to –
one function. Onto Functions
A function f : X →Y is said to be onto
Exercises 4.5 (subjective) if for every y in Y, there is an x in
Determine whether f is one – to one. X such that f(x) = y. This can be restated as a
1. f(x) = 3x – 7 2. f(x) = 3 function f from a set X to a set Y is surjective
2
3. f(x) = x – 9 4. f(x) = x2 + 4 (or onto) if every element y in Y has a
5. f(x) = 2x3 – 4 6. f(x) = corresponding element x in X, such that f(x) = y
B. Determine whether f is one – to one. Generally, a function is onto when its image
1. f(x) = 3
2. f(x) = - x + 3x – 22 equals to its range, meaning all elements in the
co domain are used .i. e. f(X) = Y.
3. f(x) = √ 4. f(x) = √
5. f(x) = √ 5. f(x) = ( )
: ; ( +
Horizontal Line Test for One – to – one
A function f is one – to – one if and only if A Onto B
every horizontal line intersects the graph of f in
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 4.7
Which of the following diagrams represents If we can‟t plot the graph to see whether it is
a one to one function or onto function or increasing or decreasing, then we need an
both? algebra test.
1.
( + . / For a function y = f(x);
When x1 < x2 then f(x1) ≤ f(x2), then the function
2. is an increasing function..
( + ( + When x1 < x2 then f(x1) < f(x2), then the function
is strictly increasing function.
: ; ( ,
x
Interval
Note
1. A function is increasing on an interval if it
f(x1 f(x) goes “uphill” from left to right.
- 2. A function is decreasing on an interval if it
)f(x2
) goes “downhill” from left to right.
x1 x2 x
3. A function is constant on an interval if it is
+
“level” or “flat”.
For a function y = f(x);
When x1 < x2 then f(x1) ≥ f(x2), then the function Even Functions
is a decreasing function.. A function f is even if the graph of f is
symmetric with respect to the y – axis. This
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
When x1 < x2 then f(x1) > f(x2), then the function means the graph remains unchanged after
is strictly decreasing function. reflection about the y – axis.
A function that is decreasing throughout its
domain is one – to – one. f(x) = x2 is an example of an even function.
A function may also decrease within a certain
interval.
Constant Function
A constant function is a horizontal line.
y
Algebraically, f is even if and only if f(-x) = f(x)
C f(x) = C or f(x) – f(-x) = 0, for all x in the domain of f.
This test can also be done with numbers. If f(x)
and f(-x) gives the same value , then the
x x function is even.
2
Intervals over which a function is Increasing, Other examples of even functions are /x/, x4,
Decreasing or Constant. cos x, cosh (x)
Let I be an open interval in the domain of a
function, f. then; Odd Functions
1. f is increasing on I if f(a) < f(b) for all a < b A function, f is odd if the graph of f has
on I. rotational symmetry with respect to origin. This
means that its graph remains unchanged after
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
signs then the function is odd. = -2x3 + 4x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
So the function is not even. f(-x) = (-x3 ) – (-x)2
f(-x) = - x3 – x2
Comparing f(x) and f(-x), the signs are not Comparing f(x) and f(-x),
switched. Therefore the function is not odd. f(x) ≠ f(-x). Therefore , the function is not even.
Also, f(x) + f(-x) ≠ 0, therefore the function is
Method 3 not odd.
f(x) = 2x3 – 3x2 – 4x + 4
f(-2) = 2(-2)3 –3(-2)2 – 4(-2) + 4 Exercises 4.8
= -16 – 12 + 8 + 4 Determine algebraically whether f(x) is even,
= -16 odd or neither.
1. f(x) = 2. f(x) = x6 + x4 – x2
3 2
f(2) = 2(2) – 3(2) – 4(2) + 4 3. f(x)= x /x/ 4. f(x) = /x/ – 1
= 16 – 12– 8 + 4
= -32 5. f(x) = 6. f(x) =
f(x) is neither even nor odd.
B. Determine whether f is even, odd, or
4. Determine whether f(x) is even, odd or neither even nor odd.
neither. 1. f(x) = 5x3 +2x 6. f(x) = 7x5 – 4 x3
a. f(x) =3x4 – 2x2 + 5 2. f(x) = 8x3 +3x2 7. f(x) = 12
b. f(x) = 2x5 – 7x3 + 4x 3. f(x) = 3x + 2x – 5 8. f(x) = 3x2 – 5x + 1
4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
function can also be written as f(x) = -2x + 7
f(x) = ax2 + bx + c , where a, b and c are
where m = -2 and c = 7.
constants and a ≠0 . The graph of a quadratic
function is in the shape of a parabola. The
4. f(x) = is a linear function because it is
leading coefficient, a, determines the direction
of the parabola. written in the form f(x) = mx + c. The function
can also be written as f(x) = x + where m =
If a > 0, the parabola opens upward. In normal and c = 1.
language, it is said to have a ∪ shaped curve or
a minimum curve. For example, f(x) = x2 Exercises 4.9
Determine if the function is linear, quadratic
If a < 0, the parabola opens downward. In or constant,
normal language, it is said to have an ∩ shaped 1. f(x) = -x2+ 4x + 12 2. f(x) = 2x2+ 3x + 11
curve or a maximum curve. For eg. f(x) = -x2 3. f(x) = - 3x – 7 4. f(x) = -x – 3
a<0 a>0 5. f(x) = -x2+ 4x + 12 6. f(x) =
Maximum curve Minimum curve
7. f(x) = + 8. f(x) = –3
9. f(x) = x + 10. f(x) = √
Constant Functions
1. The domain of every quadratic function is R. A constant function is a function f that is given
2. The range is [k, ) if a > 0 and (- , k] if by f(x) = c, where c is a constant (real number).
a < 0, where k is the y – coordinate of the 1. The domain of every constant function is R
vertex. 2. The range is a singleton: {c}
x x x Exponential Function
1 2 Let b be a positive real number different from
Polynomial Functions 1. The exponential function with base b,
A function f given by f(x) = anxn + an - 1 xn - 1 denoted by expb, is the function given by;
+… + a1x + a0, where a0, a1…an are constants expb (x) = bx
with an ≠ 0, is called a polynomial function of 1. The domain of every exponential function is R.
degree n. 2. The range of every exponential function is
(0, ).
3. The y – intercept of the graph of every
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
If n = 0, f is a constant function.
If n = 1, f is a linear function. exponential function is (0, 1). This is because
If n = 2, f is a quadratic function. b0 = 1.
1. The domain of every polynomial function is R.
2. The are three possibilities for the range Graphs of Function
a. if the degree is odd, then the range of f is R. Every graph represents a set of ordered pairs,
b. if the degree is even and positive, then; but not every graph is a graph of a function. For
i. ran(f) = [k, ) if an > 0; example, the circle below is not a graph of a
ii. ran(f) = (- , k] if an < 0; function.
where k is the y – coordinate of the lower point y
1
Rational Functions x
-3 -2 -1 1 2 3
A rational function is a function f in the form; -1
( ) -2
f(x) = ;
( )
-3
where p and q are polynomial functions.
e.g. f(x) = This is because the ordered pairs (0, 3) and
(0, -3) on the graph have the same first
Square - root Function coordinate and different second coordinate.
The principal square root of x , denoted by √ , is
defined to be the positive square root of x. On the other hand, the graph below represents a
function.
5.
y
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
y coordinate and so the graph is not a graph of a
function. If every possible vertical line does not
cross the graph more than once, then the graph
is a graph of a function. Domain and Range of a Function
Consider a function defined by the equation
Worked Examples y = f(x). The domain of f is the set of all x –
Which of the following is a graph of a values that when substituted into the function,
function? produce a real number. The range of f is the set
y
1. of all y – values corresponding to the values of
x in the domain.
x
To find the domain of a function defined by
y = f(x);
y I. Exclude values of x that make the
2. denominator of a fraction zero.
x II. Exclude the value of x that makes a negative
value within the square root. That is to say that
y the number under a root sign must be positive.
3.
Worked Examples
x
Type 1 : Without root sign
1. Find the domain of the function and write
your answer in interval notation.
a. f(x) = b. h(x) = c. g(t) = t2 – 3t
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 86
Solution ii. g(x) =
a. The function will be undefined when the
x–2=0
denominator is zero.
x=2
2x – 1 = 0
When x = 2, g(x) ceases to exist.
2x = 1
Therefore, the domain of g(x) is all real
x= numbers except x = 2
Domain of f is {x : x R, x ≠ } Domain of g is {x : x R, x ≠ 2}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
for all real numbers x, and the number 9 is Worked Examples
positive. The denominator of the function, 1. Find the domain of the function k(t) = √
h(x) = can never be zero.
The domain is the set of all real numbers. Solution
Domain of h is {x : x R} 1. The function defined by k(t) = √ will
not be a real number when t + 4 is negative;
Interval notation : ( , ) hence the domain is the set of all t values that
make the radicand greater than or equal to
-3 -2 -1 0 1 2 zero.
t+4≥0
c. The function defined by g(t) = t2 – 3t has no t≥-4
restrictions on its domain because any real Domain = {t : t R, t ≥ - 4 }
number substituted for t will produce a real Interval notation [- 4, ]
number. The domain is the set of all real
numbers. [
-4 -3 -2 -1 0 1
2. For each of the following functions, find its 2. Determine the domain of the function
domain. f(x) = - √
i. f(x) = x2 + 3 ii. g(x) =
Solution
Solution f(x) = - √
i. Since f(x) = x2 + 3 is defined for all real Set the inside greater than or equal to zero,
numbers x, the domain of f is R. -2x + 3 ≥ 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Interval notation = [ , )
1. f(x) = x2 + 2
Put y = f(x) = x2 + 2
Exercises 4.10
y = x2 + 2; (Solve for x)
A. Write the domain of the function.
x2 = y – 2
1. f(x) = 4. p(x) =
x=±√
2. f(x) = 5. h(x) = x + 6
Note that x can be solved if and only of
3. k(x) = 6. f(p) =
y – 2 ≥ 0.
y≥2
B. Write the domain in of each function. The range of f is {y R : y ≥ 2}
1. f(p) = 4. g(x) = √
2. f(x) = √ 5. f(x) = √ 2. g(x) =
3. f(t) = 2t2 + t – 1 6. h(t) = t3 + t – 1 Put y = g(x) =
y= (Solve for x)
C. Find the domain of each .
1. f(x) = x2 – 5 5. f(x) = x–2 =
√
2. f(x) = 6. f(x) = –√ x = +2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
yx2 – 2x + (y – 1) = 0
√ ( )
x= Exercises 4.11
A. Find the range of the following.
√
x= 1. f(x) = x2 – 5 4. f(x) = 3 -
√
x= 2. f(x) = 5. f(x) =
√
√ 3. f(x) = 6. f(x) =
x=
Note that x can be solved if and only if B. Find the range defined by the following
1 – y2 – y ≥ 0. That is y2 – y – 1 ≥ 0 1. f(x) = x2 – 2x – 3
The range of f is {y R, y2 – y – 1 ≥ 0 or y ≥ 0} 2. f(x) = 2x2 – 10x + 19
3. f(x) = 2x2 +10x + 16
4. Find the range of the function defined by
f(x) = - 2x2 + 4x – 7 Evaluating a Function
A function may be evaluated at different values
Solution of x, by substituting x – values from the domain
f(x) = - 2x2 + 4x – 7 into the function. For example, to evaluate the
Worked Examples ( )
f(- 4) = = =7
1. Given the function defined by g(x) = x – 1,
find the function values; ( )
i. g(4) ii. g(-2) f(x – 1) = = =
( )
Solution ii. =3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. g(x) = x – 1, 4x + 1 = 3(x + 2)
g(4) = (4) – 1, 4x + 1 = 3x + 6
=1 4x – 3x = 6 – 1
x=5
ii. g(-2) = (-2) – 1
4. Given that f(x) = (x – 1)2 (x + 3) – 30,
= -2 evaluate ;
i. f(3) ii f(4)
2. Given the functions defined by f(x) = x2 – 2x iii. Hence estimate the value of x for which f(x) = 0
and g(x) = 3x + 5, find the function values:
i. f(t) ii. g(w + 4) iii. f(-t) Solution
f(x) = (x – 1)2 (x + 3) – 30 , evaluate ;
Solution f(3) = (3 – 1)2 (3 + 3) – 30 ,
i. f(x) = x2 – 2x = 22 × 6 – 30
f(t) = t2 – 2t = 4 × 6 – 30
=-6
ii. g(x) = 3x + 5
g(w + 4) = 3(w + 4) + 5 f(4) = (4 – 1)2 (4 + 3) – 30 , evaluate ;
= 3w + 12 + 5 = 32 × 7 – 30
= 3w + 17 = 9 × 7 – 30
= 33
iii. f(x) = x2 – 2x
f(-t) = (-t)2 – 2(-t) f(x) = (x – 1)2 (x + 3) – 30
= t2 + 2t f(x) = 0
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 90
⇒ (x – 1)2 (x + 3) – 30 = 0 i. g(-x) ii. g(x + h)
(x – 1)2 (x + 3) = 30
(x – 1)2 = 30 or (x + 3) = 30 2. Given that f(x) = x2, express as simply as
x–1=±√ or x + 3 = 30 possible:
( ) ( )
x = 1 + √ or x = 1 – √ or x = 30 – 3 = 27 a. f(5 + h) b.
5. Let g(x) = x2 – 3x + 7. Find the following: 3. Given that f(x) = x2, find :
i. g(10) ii. g(a +1 ) iii. g(r2) i. f. / ii. f(5a) iii. f. /
( ) ( )
iv. g(x + h) v.
4. A. f(x) is defined by f(x) = 1 + – x. Write
Solution down the values of ;
g(x) = x2 – 3x + 7. i. f(1) ii. f(1.5) iii. f(2)
i. g(10) = 102 – 3(10) + 7 iv. Hence, estimate correct to one decimal
= 77 place, the value of x between 1 and 2 for which
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
f(x) = 0
ii. g(a +1 ) = (a + 1)2 – 3(a + 1) + 7
= (a + 1) (a + 1) – 3(a + 1) + 7
= a2 + 2a + 1 – 3a – 3 + 7 B. 1. Let f(x) = , find the following;
= a2 + 2a – 3a + 1 – 3 + 7 a. f(2) b. f(3.5) c. f(a + 1)
= a2 – a + 5 d. f(√ ) e. f(a2) f. f(a) + f(1)
iii. g(r2) = (r2)2 – 3r2 + 7 2. Let f(x) = and g(x) = √ . Find the
= r4 – 3r2 + 7
following:
iv. g(x + h) = (x + h)2 – 3(x + h) + 7 a. f(1) + g(1) d. f(a – 1) + g(a + 1)
= (x + h) (x + h) – 3(x + h) + 7 b. f(2)g(2) e. f(a2 + 1)g(a2 + 1)
( )
= x2 + 2xh + h2 – 3x – 3h + 7 c. ( )
( ) ( ) ( )
v. = 3. Let f(x) = x2 – 3x + 4. Find and simplify the
following:
= ( ) ( )
i. f(a + b ) ii.
= ( ) ( )
iii.
= 2xh + h – 3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
by 5. Given that k = 4, write down the value of:
Sometimes, a function may be stated and i. R(3k) ii. R(5k) iii. R(k2)
defined in words. Carefully identify the
function and work out for the required value. Solution
i. R(3k)
Worked Examples When k = 4, R(3×4) = R(12)
1. The height (in feet) of a ball that is dropped R(12) denotes the remainder when 12 is divided
from an 80 – ft building is given by; by 5. Hence, R(12) = R(3k) = 2
h(t) = -16t2 + 18, where t is the time in seconds
after the ball is dropped. ii. R(5k)
a. Find h(1) and h(1.5). when k = 4, R(5 × 4) = R(20)
b. Interpret the meaning of the function R(20) denotes the remainder when 20 is divided
values obtained in (a). by 5. Hence, R(20) = R(5k) = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the object. 1. If f(x) =3x – 2 and g(x) = x2, find;
i. (f + g)(2) ii. (f – g)(2)
4. Michael walks an average of 5.9km/hr. The
iii. (fg)(2) iv. . / (2)
distance that he walks can be represented by
d(t) = 5.9t, where t is the time in hours.
a. Find d(1) and d(2) Solution
b. Interpret the meaning of the function If f(x) =3x – 2 and g(x) = x3,
values obtained in (a). i. (f + g)(2) = f(2) + g(2)
= [3(2) – 2] + [23]
B. 1. F(x) denotes the number of factors of a = 6 – 2 + 8 = 12
positive integer x, including 1 and x itself. For
example, 1, 2, 3, 6 are the factors of 6. Hence ii. (f – g)(2) = f(2) – g(2)
F(6) = 4. Write down any x, 10 < x < 100, for = [3(2) – 2] – [23]
which: i. F(x) = 2 ii. F(x) = 3 = 6–2–8=-4
2. R(x) denotes the remainder when x is divided iii. (fg)(2) = f(2) g(2)
by 7. Given that k = 9, write down the value of = [3(2) – 2] [23]
= (6 – 2)(8) = 32
i. R(3√ ) ii. R(8k) iii. R(2k2)
( ) ( )–
Operations on Functions iv. . / (2) = = = = =
( )
In general, if f and g are any functions, the
terminology and notations in the following 2. If f(x) = √ and g(x) = 3x + 1, find;
chart are used. i. (f + g)(2) ii. (f – g)(2) iii. (fg)(2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
For the domain of , we exclude each number 5. f(x) = , g(x) =
x in -2 ≤ x 2 such that g(x) = 3x + 1 = 0
6. f(x) = , g(x) =
(namely x = . Thus we have the following;
i. (f + g)(x) Composite Function
= f(x) +g(x) The composite function f○g of two functions
=√ + (3x + 1), -2 ≤ x 2 f and g is defined by (f○g)(x) = f(g(x)).
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
f(2) = 3(2) – 2 = 4 = 3x2 – 3 + 5
(g○f )(2) = g(f(2)) = 3x2 + 2
= g(4) Domain of g○f = {x : x R}
= 42 + 2(4)
= 24 c. Method 1
f(g(2))
b. (f○g )(2) = f(g(2)) First, find g(2)
g(2) = 22 + 2(2) = 8 g(2) = 3(2) + 5 = 11
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= g(x2 – 16)
=√
iii. f(x + y) = f(x) + f(y) – 1
By definition, the domain of g○f is the domain
Consider the L.H.S.
of g. Therefore;
f(x + y) = 3 (x + y) + 1
domain of g○f = {x : x R, x 4 or x - 4}
= 3x + 3y + 1
4. Two functions f and g are defined on the set of
Consider the R.H.S.;
real numbers by f : x → 2x + 3 and g : x →3x – 1
f(x) + f(y) – 1
i. Find the composite function of ;
(3x + 1) + (3y + 1) – 1
a. f○g b. g○f
3x + 3y + 1 + 1 – 1
ii. Find the image of 7 under the composite
3x + 3y + 1
function of f○g
Solution L.H.S. = R. H. S
f : x → 2x + 3 and g : x →3x – 1 . f(x + y) = f(x) + f (y) – 1 = 3x + 3y + 1
i. a. f ○ g = 2(3x – 1) + 3 g(f(x)) – f(g(x)) = 9
= 6x – 2 + 3 g(f(x)) = 4(3x + 1) – 3
= 6x + 1 = 12x + 4 – 3
= 12x + 1
b. g ○ f = 3(2x + 3) – 1
= 6x + 9 – 1 f(g(x)) = 3(4x – 3) + 1
= 6x + 8 = 12x – 9 + 1
= 12x – 8
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ( )) = x x ≥ -1
Domain = {x : x R, x ≥ -1}
f (g (x)) = = [-1, )
. /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. f(x) = in the example below.
3. f(x) = x2 g(x) =
Worked Examples
4. f(x) = g(x) = 1. Several values of two functions f and g are
5. f(x) = g(x) = listed in the following tables.
6. f(x) = g(x) =
x 1 2 3 4
f(x) 3 4 2 1
E. Let f(x) = 2x – 3 and g(x) = x2 + 3x and
h(x) = . Find the following; x 1 2 3 4
1. (g○f)(1) 5. (f○f)(4) 9. (h○f)(5) g(x) 4 1 3 2
2. (f○g)(-2) 6. (g○h)(-1) 10. (f○h)(0)
3. (f○g)(1) 7. (h○g)(-1) 11. (g○h)(-1) Find:
4. (g○f)(-2) 8. (h○h)(3) 12. (f○g)(2.36) i. (f○g)(2) ii. (g○f)(2) iii. (f○f)(2) iv. (g○g)(2)
x 5 6 7 8 (f○g)○h = 6(x + 5) – 3
f(x) 8 7 6 5 = 6x + 30 – 3
= 6x + 27
x 5 6 7 8
g(x) 7 8 6 5 Consider the R.H.S;
f○ (g○h)
Find:
g○h = g{h(x)}
i. (f○g)(6) iii. (f○f)(6)
= 3(x + 5) – 2
ii. (g○f)(6) iv. (g○g)(6)
= 3x + 15 – 2
= 3x + 13
2. Several values of two functions T and S
are listed in the following tables:
f○ (g○h) = 2(3x + 13 ) + 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 6x + 26 + 1
x 0 1 2 3
T(t) 2 3 1 0 = 6x + 27
= 5x + 24 = 6(x + 5) (x + 5) – (x + 5) – 2
= 6(x2 + 10x + 25) – (x + 5) – 2
Consider the R.H.S; = 6x2 + 60x + 150 – x – 5 – 2
( f○h) + (g○h) = 6x2 + 59x + 143
f ○h = 2(x + 5) + 1
= 2x + 10 + 1 Consider the R. H. S;
= 2x + 11 ( f○h) . (g○h)
( f○h) = 2(x + 5) + 1
g○h = 3(x + 5) – 2 = 2x + 10 + 1
= 3x + 15 – 2 = 2x + 11
= 3x + 13
g○h = 3(x + 5) – 2
= 3x + 15 – 2
( f○h) + (g○h) = (2x + 11) + (3x + 13)
= 3x + 13
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 2x + 3x + 11 + 13
= 5x + 24 ( f○h) . (g○h) = (2x + 11) (3x + 13)
= 2x (3x + 13) + 11 (3x + 13)
Since L. H. S. = R. H. S; = 6x2 + 26x + 33x + 143
⇒(f + g)○h = ( f○h) + (g○h) = 5x + 24 = 6x2 + 59x + 143
Composition of functions is distributive on the left
over multiplication. That is; Since L.H.S. = R. H. S.
(f . g) ○ h = ( f ○ h) . (g ○ h)
. .
(f g)○h =( f○h) (g○h) = 6x2 + 59x + 143
Worked Examples
Three functions are defined on the set of real Decomposing a Composite Function
numbers by f(x) = 2x + 1, g(x) = 3x – 2 and h(x) We can go the other way and break up a
= x + 5. Show that (f . g)○h =( f○h).(g○h) function into a composition of other functions.
This is called decomposing a function. For
Solution
f(x) = 2x + 1, g(x) = 3x – 2 and h (x) = x + 5 example, in . / , the function can be
made from these two functions:
Consider the L.H.S.;
f(x) = g(x) = x2
(f . g)○h =
f . g = (2x + 1) (3x – 2) g○f (x) = g(f(x) = g . /=. / ,
= 2x(3x – 2) + 1(3x – 2)
= 6x2 – 4x + 3x – 2 Worked Examples
= 6x2 – x – 2 1. If f(x) = 2x – 3 and f(g(x) = 2x + 1, find g(x)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution B. 1. Find g(x) if f(x) = x + and fog(x) = 3x + 1
(g○f ) (x) = g(f(x) =
2. Find two functions f and g such that fog (x) =
g(f(x) = ( )
h(x); h(x) = Ans f(x) = g(x) = x + 1
But f(x) = x2 + 1
g(f(x) = ( ) 3. Find two functions f and g such that h(x) can
be expressed as a function h(x) = 4x + x2; f – g
Substitute f(x) = x Ans: f(x) = x2, g(x) = - 4x
g(x) =
Functional Equations
⇒ g(x) = I. Identify the given functions.
II. Workout the composite functions at the
3. Write f(x) = √ as composition of two L.H.S and equate to the value at the R.H.S.
functions. III. Solve the equation to obtain the value of the
involving variable.
Solution
f(x) = √ Worked Examples
For g and h, f(x) = g(h)(x) 1. a. Given that f(x) = (x – 2) (x – 3), solve the
equation f(x) = 6.
Now look for a function inside f(x); b. Describe briefly the range of values of x for
5 – x2 and the square root function. which f(x) 0.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3k = 72
x 2 or x 3
k=
2. The function f is given by f(x) = 3x2 and the k = 24
function g is given by g(x) = x – 4
i. Write down f{g(x)} ii. Put k = 24 in f(x) = +
ii. Write down g{f(x)}
f(x) = +
iii. Find the value of p if f{g(p)} = g{f(p)}
f(4) = + = + = = 11
Solution
i. f {g(x)} = 3(x – 4)2 Exercises 4.18
f {g(x)}= 3(x – 4) (x – 4) Solve the equation (f○g)(x) = 0
f {g(x)}= 3(x2 – 8x + 16) 1. f(x) = x2 – 2 g(x) = x + 3
f {g(x)}= 3x2 – 24x + 48 2
2. f(x) = x – x – 2 g(x) = 2x – 1
ii. g{f(x)} = 3x2 – 4
Inverse of a Function
iii. f{g(p)} = g{f(p)} The inverse of a one – to – one function f is the
3(p – 4)2 = 3p2 – 4 function , which is obtained from f by
3(p – 4) (p – 4) = 3p2 – 4 interchanging the coordinates of each ordered
3(p2 – 8p + 16) = 3p2 – 4 pair of f. For example given f = (2, 8), (3, 27)
3p2 – 24p + 48 = 3p2 – 4 (4, 64) the following is true:
- 24p = - 4 – 48 1. f is a function because no first (x) coordinates
- 24p = - 52 are the same.
p=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
1. f(x) = 3x and g(x) =
1. In f = {(2, 4), (-2, 4), (3, 9)}
{(2, 4) and (-2, 4) have the same y – coordinate. (g○f)(x) = g(f(x) = g(3x) = =x
Therefore f is not one- to – one and as such not
(f○g)(x) = f(g(x) =f. / 3× =x
invertible.
Therefore g = or (x) =
2. In g = 2. , / , . , / , . , /3, no y value is
the same.
2. f(x) = 2x – 1 and g(x) = x + 1
Therefore g is invertible and one – to – one.
(g○f)(x) = g(f(x)
= 2. , / , . , / , . , /3,
= g(2x – 1)
= (2x – 1) + 1
3. In h = {(3, 5), (7, 9)}, y values are not the
same. Therefore h is invertible and one – to – =x+
one. = {(5, 3), (9, 7)} Since (g○f)(x) ≠ x, the functions f and g are not
inverse of each other.
Exercises 4.19
Which of the following is invertible? 3. f(x) = x2and g(x) = √
1. f = {(-3, 3), (-2, 2), (0, 0), (2, 2)} (g○f)(x) = g(f(x)
2. f = {(1, 1), (2, 8), (3, 27)} = g(x2) = √ = /x/
3. f = {(16, 4), (9, 3), (0, 0)} The functions f and g are not inverses of each
4. f = {(0, 5), (5, 0), (6, 0)} other. Note f(x) = x2 has no inverse.
5. f = {(-1, 1), (-3, 81), (3, 81)}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. f(x) = – 4, x ≤ 0 g(x) = √ ,
x= (Interchange x and y and solve for y)
Switch – and – solve Strategy x(y – 3) = y + 1
If an invertible function is defined by a xy – 3x = y + 1
formula, then the inverse function must undo or xy – y = 3x + 1
reverse what the function does. Because the y(x – 1) = 3x + 1
inverse function interchanges the roles of x and
y=
y, we interchange the x and y in the formula and
then solve the new formula for y to undo what (x) =
the original function did.
3. If f : x → 3x + 2, find;
The switch – and – solve strategy for finding i. f(1) ii. f(- 4)
is as follow. iii. determine the inverse function
1. Replace f(x) by y.
2. Interchange x and y. Solution
3. Solve the equation for y. i. f : x → 3x + 2
4. Replace y by (x). f(1) = 3(1) + 2 = 5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Let y = 3x + 1 Find the inverse of each function.
x = 3y + 1 (Interchange x and y and solve for y) 1. f(x)= (x – 2)2 for x ≥ 2
2
3y = x – 1 2. f(x)= (x + 5) for x ≥ -5
2
3. f(x)= x + 3 for x ≥ 0
y= 2
4. f(x)= x – 5 for x ≥ 0
= 5. f(x) = √
6. f(x) = √
iv. (- 10) = =
Challenge problems
Exercises 4.21 Find the inverse of each function.
A. Determine for each function. 1. f(x)= x2 – 6x, x≥3
2
1. f(x) = 2. f(x) = 2. f(x)= x – 4x+3, x≤2
3. f(x)= ( )
3. f(x) = 4. f(x) =
4. f(x)= √ , 0≤x≤2
5. f(x) = 6. f(x) =
7. f(x) = 8. f(x) = Type 2
If two functions are inverses of each other, then
9. f(x) = 10. f(x) =
their composite function is always x ( if x is the
involving variable). (f○f 1)(x) = x
B. Find the inverse of each function
1. f(x) = √ 2. f(x) = √ Worked Examples
3. f(x) = √ 4. f(x) = √ 1. Show that (f○g)(x) = x for each pair of
5. f(x) = √ 6. f(x) = √ + 1 functions.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and g(x) = x + 2 are inverses of each other.
For example, consider f(x) = x2 for x 0 and
Solution (x) = √ . Their graphs are shown below:
f(x) = 3x – 2 and g(x) = x + 2 y
(f○g)(x) = f( ( )) y=x
= f. / 5
4 f
(b, a)
=3. / 2 3 (a, b)
=x+6–2 2
=x+4 1
Since the answer is not x, f(x) and g(x) are not x
-3 -2 -1 1 2 3 4 5
inverses of each other
-2
Exercises 4.23 y
A. Show that (f○g)(x) = x and (g○f)(x) = x for
y=x
each pair of functions. 2 5
f(x) = x ,
1. f(x) = 3x + 5 and g(x) = x≥ 0 4
3
2. f(x) = 3x – 7 and g(x) =
2
3. f(x) = x3 – 9 and g(x) = √ 1 f--1(x) = √
4. f(x) = x3 + 1 and g(x) = √ x
-3 -2 -1 1 2 3 4 5
B. Determine whether f(x) and g(x) are -2
inverses of each other.
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 106
Exercises 4.21 Solution
A. Find the inverse of each function and f(x – 1) = 2x + 3
sketch graph of f and on the same pair of Let y = x – 1
axes.
Inverse of y ,
1. f(x) = 2x + 3 4. f(x) = x2+ 3 for x ≥ 0 x= y–1
2. f(x) = -3x + 2 5. f(x) = √ y=x+1 (Interchange x and y)
3. f(x) = x2– 1 for x ≥ 0 6. f(x) = √ y=x+1 (Solve for y )
f (x) = f (x + 1)
B. For each pair of functions, find: = 2(x + 1) + 3
( ○ f)(x) = 2x + 2 + 3
1. f(x) = x3 – 1 and (x) = √ = 2x + 5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(x) = x + 3
Solution
C. For each pair of functions, find: i. f(2x + 1) = 6x + 2
( ○ f)(x)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The vertex of a parabola is the point of roots of the function or the truth set or the
intersection of the line of symmetry and the solution set or the zeros of the function.
parabola itself. The vertex is the turning point:
y
either maximum (highest) or minimum (lowest)
Line of symmetry
4
point of the parabola. ax2 + bx + c
When the parabola is U – shaped, it is said to =0
have a minimum or least turning pointand x
-m n
when it is ∩ – shaped, it is said to have a
Minimum point
maximum or greatest turning point.
Fig. I
Values of x and y at the Turning Point From the diagram above (Fig. I), the intercept
For all equations of the form: on the x – axis is -m and n. Therefore the truth
y = ax2 + bx + c, a , at the turning point, set is x = - m or x = n
y
x=–
To get the value of y at the turning point, Maximum point
Line of symmetry
Worked Examples From the diagram above (Fig. II), the intercept
1. What is the value of x and y at the turning on the x – axis is -e and f. Therefore the truth
point of y = 2x2 – 8x + 3 set is x = e or x = f
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 108
Drawing the Graph of f(x) = ax2 + bx + c = 0, to have no roots or no zeros as shown below;
To draw the graph of f(x) = ax2 + bx + c = 0, a ≠ 0 y
I. Prepare a table of values for a given range of
values of x. x
II. Plot the points (x, y) on a graph sheet, using
a given or a convenience scale;
III. Join the points to make a free hand sketch
of the required parabola/curve; In both diagrams, the functions have no roots
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
line of symmetry. For all quadratic equations
determine with cognizance to the nature of the of the form, y = ax2 + bx +c, a ≠ 0, the line of
parabola in relation to the x – axis;
symmetry has the equation, x = –
I. Whether U or ∩ – shaped, the points at which
the parabola cuts the x – axis is the roots or
The Minimum and Maximum Points
zeros of the equation as shown below.
y The vertex of a parabola is the point of
intersection of the line of symmetry and the
parabola itself. The vertex is the turning point:
x either maximum (highest) or minimum (lowest)
a b point of the parabola.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
f(x) = 2[x2 + 3x + . / – . / ] + 5 ⇒ The vertex (h, k) is at the point . , /
2. Find the vertex and maximum or minimum B. i. Complete the square in the following,
value of the function f(x) = -2x2 + 4x + 1 ii. find the maximum or minimum value of
the function,
Solution iii. sketch the graph of the function f
f(x) = -2x2 + 4x + 1 1. f(x) = x2 – 6x + 8
f(x) = -2(x2 – 2x) + 1 2. f(x) = x2 + 16x – 36
f(x) = -2[(x2 – 2x + ( ) – ( ) ] + 1 3. f(x) = (x – 4)(x + 2)
f(x) = -2[( ) –1]+1 4. f(x) = (3 – x)(x – 5)
f(x) = -2( ) +2 +1 5. f(x) = (x – 1)(x + 2) (-1)
f(x) = -2( ) +3
The vertex is at the point (1, 3) and the Quadratic Equations
minimum value is 3. Any equation that can be written in the form:
The truth set or solution set or the root of the Worked Examples
1. Find the truth set of x2 – x − 6 = 0
quadratic equation is found by using any of the
following methods.
Solution
1. Factorization
x2 – x − 6 = 0,
2. Completing the square
x2 + 2x – 3x – 6 = 0
3. The quadratic formula
(x2 + 2x) – (3x – 6) = 0
4. Graphical method
x (x + 2) – 3(x + 2) = 0
Method of factorization (x + 2) (x – 3) = 0
x + 2 = 0 or x – 3 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
This method makes use of the idea of the
product of real number. x = – 2 or x = 3
Let a and b be real numbers. If ab = 0 ⇔ a = 0 Truth set = * or +
or b = 0
2. Solve x2 − 13x + 36 = 0
Equations the form: x2 + b x + c = 0 , Solution
To solve quadratic equations of the form: x2 – 9x – 4x + 36 = 0
x2 + b x + c = 0 , (x2 – 9x) − (4x + 36) = 0
I. Find two factors of the constant term, c, that x ( x − 9 ) – 4( x − 9) = 0
sum up to the coefficient of x, as illustrated (x – 4) (x – 9) = 0
below = (x − 4) = 0 or (x − 9) = 0
x2 + b x + c = 0… …….. (1) x = 4 or x = 9
The truth set = {x : x = 4 or x = 9}
m + n mn 3. Solve 2x2 + 5x − 3 = 0
II. Substitute mx + nx = bx in eqn (1) to obtain
four terms as: Solution
x2 + mx + nx + mn = 0 2x2 + 5x – 3 = 0
2x2 – x + 6 x – 3 = 0
III. Group the terms and factorize completely as (2x2 – x) + (6x – 3) = 0
shown below; x (2x – 1 ) + 3 (2 x – 1 ) = 0
(x2 + mx) + (nx + mn) = 0 (2 x – 1) = 0 or x = - 3
x(x + m) + n(x + m) = 0 2x = 1 or x = -3
(x + n) (x + m) = 0.
x = or x = − 3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x2 + 10x = 96, evaluate (p + q) 2. Copy and complete the statement
Solution ( ) = – +
x2 + 10x = 96
x2 + 10x – 96 = 0 Solution
x2 + 16x – 6x – 96 = 0 Comparing the statements:
(x2 + 16x) – (6x – 96) = 0 ( ) = – + and
x(x + 16) – 6( x + 16) = 0 ( ) = – 2ab + it is seen that
(x – 6) (x + 16) = 0
i. ( ) =( )
x – 6 = 0 or x + 16 = 0
x = 6 or x = -16 Therefore a = and =
Truth set (6, -16) = (p, q)
⇒( p + q ) = 6 + (-16) = - 10 ii. – 2ab = – x, but a =
Worked Examples
3. If m, n Z, find m and n such that
1. Complete the squares in the following;
x2 + 12x + m = ( )
( ) = 25 + +
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= x + 12x + 36 = ( ) x2 + 8x + 15 = 0
Therefore m = 36 and n = 6 x2 + 8x = – 15
x2 + 8x + . / = – 15 + . /
Exercises 4.25
1. The truth set of the equation ax2 + bx = 4 is x2 + 8x + = – 15 +
{-3, 2}. Find the numerical values of the ( ) = – 15 + 16
constants a and b. ( ) =1
x+4= √
Solving Quadratic Equations by Method of x = – 4 + √ or x = – 4 – √
Completing Squares x = – 4 + 1 or x = – 4 – 1
A. Quadratic equations of the form: x = – 3 or x = – 5
x2 + b x + c = 0 Truth set = * or +
To complete the squares of quadratic equations
of the form: x2 + bx + c = 0 B. Quadratic equations of the form:
I. Transpose the constant, c, to the right side of ax2 + b x + c = 0, a > 1
the equation to assume the opposite sign i.e. x2 To complete the squares of quadratic equations
+ bx = – c of the form: ax2 + bx + c = 0,
II. Divide the coefficient of x (number attached i. Transpose the constant, c, to the right side of
to x) by 2. i.e. the equation to assume the opposite sign
i.e. ax2 + bx = – c
III. Square to get . / and add . / to both ii. Divide through the equation by a, which is
sides of the equation the coefficient of ,
i.e. x2 + bx + . / = – c + . / i.e. + =–
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
values of x that satisfies the equation; x2 + +. / = +. /
x=– √– c . / x2 + +. / = +. /
Worked Examples . / = +
1. Find the truth set of 3x2 + 8x + 5 = 0 . / =
Solution x+ = √
3x2 + 8x + 5 = 0
3x2 + 8x = – 5 x+ =
x2 + =– x=–
x2 + +. / = – +. / x=– or x = –
x= or x = –
x2 + +. / = – +. /
x = 1 or x = –
2
x + +. / = – +. /
Truth set = 2 – 3
. / =– +
Exercises 4.26
. / =
A. Complete the squares in the following;
x+ = √ 1. ( ) = + x+9
2. ( ) = – +
x+ = 3. ( ) = – +
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
II. Divide through by a; (real) solutions.
+ . /x = – . /
Worked Examples
III. Add . / to both sides of the equation; 1. Find the truth set of 2x2 – 9x + 10 = 0
+ . /x + . / = . / – . / Solution
2x2 – 9x + 10 = 0 and ax2 + bx + c = 0
+ . /x + . / = –
compared, a = 2, b = -9 and c = 10
√
IV. Factorize the left – hand side; Substitute in x =
√( ) ( )( )
. / = x= ( )
√
x+ = √. / ( * x=
√
√( ) x=
x+ = 4 5
√( )
x=
x=–
x= or x =
So if ax2 + bx + c = 0, then
x= or x =
√
x= x = or x = 2
Truth set = {x : x = or x = 2}
Using the Quadratic Formula
√
The formula x = is used to solve 2. Solve the quadratic equation x2 + 2x + 3 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the problem and solve it, taking note of the fact
k2 – 4 (1) (k + 3) = 0 that the problem does not end with solving the
k2 – 4(k + 3) = 0 quadratic equation. You should therefore go
k2 – 4k – 12 = 0 (Solving by quadratic formula) back to the word problem and answer the
a = 1, b = - 4 and c = -12 question it demands.
√
Substitute in x =
Worked Examples
( ) √( ) ( )( )
x= 1. The sum of two numbers is 18. The sum of
( )
√ the squares of the numbers is 194. Find the
x=
numbers.
√
x=
x= or x = Solution
Let x be the number
x= or x =
Then the other number is (18 – x).
x = 6 or x = - 2 Sum of squares = x2 + (18 – x)2.
Truth set = {x : x = 6 or x = - 2} But this is given as 194
x2 + (18 – x )2 = 194
Exercises 4.27 x2 + x2 – 36x + 324 = 194
A. Solve with the quadratic formula 2x2 − 36x + 130 = 0
1. 24x2 + 108x + 120 = 0 x2 − 18x + 65 = 0
2. x2 + 13x –7 = 15 x2 – 5x – 13x + 5 = 0
3. 18x2 + 61x = 50 (x2 − 5x) – (13x + 65) = 0
4. x2 + 30x = -132 x ( x − 5) – 13 ( x − 5 ) = 0
5. x2 + x – 72 = 0 (x −13) (x − 5) = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⇒B = 24 – L……….(1)
x – 6 = 0 or x + 7 = 0
But area of rectangle x = 6 or x = -7
= L × B = 128cm2 Since the breadth of a rectangle cannot be
L × B = 128cm2…….(2) negative, the breadth of the rectangle is 6cm.
Put eqn (1) into eqn (2); 4. The present ages of a man and his son are 44
⇒L(24 – L) = 128cm2 and 13 years. How many years ago was the
24L – L2 = 128 product of their ages 140?
L2 – 24 L + 128 = 0
Solution
L2 − 8L – 16L + 128 = 0
Let the number of years ago be x
(L2 − 8L) – (16L+ 128) = 0 (44 – x ) (13 – x ) = 140
L(L – 8) – 16 (L – 8) = 0 44(13 – x ) – x (13 – x ) = 140
(L – 16) (L – 8) = 0 572 – 44x – 13x + x2 = 140
L − 16 = 0 or L− 8 = 0 x2 – 57x + 572 = 140
L = 16 or L = 8 x2 – 57x + 572 – 140 = 0
x2 – 57x + 432 = 0
When L =16, B = 24 – 16 = 8 Now, a = 1, b = -57 and c = 432
When L = 8, B = 24 – 8 = 16 √
Substitute in x =
Therefore, the length and breadth of the
( ) √( ) – ( )( )
rectangle are 16cm and 8cm respectively.
Substitute in x = ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution 4. Find two consecutive positive integers whose
Let x km/h be the original speed product is 168.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Challenge Problems x2 - (sum of roots)x + (product of roots) = 0
1. A number on base ten has two digits, the
second one being two more than the first. The
number itself is 22 more than the product of its This can be used to obtain a new quadratic
digits. Find the number. equation whose roots are known or are given as
functions of and .
2. Due to the fault, the speed of train was
reduced by 10km/h over a journey of 100km. Proofs
The journey took 20 minutes longer. Find the 1. + = =
usual speed of the train.
A
2. α2 + β2
3. What value must be
⇒( ) = α2 + β2 + 2αβ
chosen for x so that < 2x+
B 2 x+8
is a right angle?
α2 + β2 = ( ) – 2αβ
B x C
6. = √( )
vi. + = ( )
But ( )=( ) –2α β
– . /
α = √( ) = = = 32
. / ⁄
α = √( )
vii. α3 + β3
7. α3 + β3
=( ) (α2 – αβ + β2)
=( ) (α2 – αβ + β2)
=( ) [(α2 + β2) - αβ]
=( ) [(α2 + β2) – αβ]
= (3)[(8) – ]
Worked Examples = (3)(7.5)
1. If α and β are the roots of the equation = 22.5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2x2 – 6x + 1 = 0, find the value of :
i. α + β ii. α β iii. α2 + β2 2. One root of the equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 is
iv. α3 β + α β3 v. /α – β/ vi. + five times the other. Show that 5b2 = 36ac, a ≠ 0
vii. α3 + β3 Solution
Let the roots be α and 5α
Solution ax2 + bx + c = 0
2x2 – 6x + 1 = 0
2
x2 + x + = 0 (let coefficient of x2 equal to 1)
x – 3x + = 0
α + 5α = and (α ) (5α) =
i. α + β = 3
6α = ……….(1)
ii. α β = 5α2 = ……….(2)
= (8) = 4 α=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. One root of the equation x2 – px + q = 0 is
twice the other. Show that 2p2 = 9q.
α2 + β2 = ( ) – 2αβ
2 2
α +β = – 2q 4. The equation x2 – 2px + q = 0 has roots α and
α + 2. Verify that p2 = q + 1
ii. ( ) =( ) – 2αβ –2α β
=( ) – 4αβ 5. The equation x2 – 12x + k = 0 has roots α and
2
= p – 4q α2. Find two possible values of k.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the roots respectively. α2 β2 = ( ) =. / =
3. Then respectively substitute in:
x2 – (sum of roots)x + (product of roots) = 0 to
Substitute in:
obtain the quadratic equation.
x2 – (sum of roots)x + (product of roots) = 0
x2 – x+ =0
Worked Examples
1. If the roots of 3x2 – 5x + 2 = 0 are α and β, = 9x2 – 13x + 4 = 0
form equations whose roots are The equation is 9x2 – 13x + 4 = 0
i. , ii. α2 , β2 iii. + , +
3 3
iii. + , +
iv. +1, +1 v. ,
Sum of roots;
= + + +
Solution
3x2 – 5x + 2 = 0 = + + +
2
x – x+ =0 = + +
α = and = ⁄
= + = + =
⁄
i. ,
Sum of roots;
Product of roots;
⁄
= + = = = = . /. /
⁄
= . / . /
Product of roots;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=( ) [( ) ]
Sum of roots; = [. / – 3. / ]
+1+ +1 = . /
= + +2 =
= +2 =
( )
( )
= +2
( ) Product of roots;
( ⁄ ) . / 3 3
= +2 =( ) =. / =
. /
= Substitute in;
x2 – (sum of roots) x + (product of roots) = 0
Product of roots; x2 – x+ =0
. /. / 27x2 – 35x + 8 = 0
The equation is 27x2 – 35x + 8 = 0
= . / . /
ii. = √( ) Solution
Sum of roots;
= √. ⁄ /
(3 + 2√ ) + (3 – 2√ )
3 + 2√ + 3 – 2√ = 6
= √. ⁄ /
= √ Product of roots ;
(3 + 2√ ) (3 – 2√ )
B. Forming from an Irrational root –( √ )
In a quadratic, irrational and imaginary roots 9 – (4) (3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
occur in conjugate pairs. Thus, if a root of a 9 – 12 = - 4
quadratic equation is given as: Substitute in;
1. a – b √ , then the other root is a + b √ x2 – (sum of roots) x + (product of roots) = 0
2. a + i, then the other root is a – i x2 – 6 x – 4 = 0
Find the sum of roots and the product of roots 3. Determine the quadratic equation whose one
and substitute in : root is - 4 – √
x2 – (sum of roots)x + (product of roots) = 0
Solution
Worked Examples Sum of roots;
1. Form an equation with roots √ + 2, √ – 2, = (- 4 – √ ) + (- 4 + √ )
=-4–√ –4+√
Solution =-8
Let = √ + 2, and = √ - 2,
+ =√ +2+ √ –2 Product of roots ;
= 2√ = (- 4 – √ ) (- 4 + √ )
= ( ) – (√ )
= (√ ) (√ – ) = 16 – 6
= √ (√ – ) (√ – ) = 10
Substitute in;
= 5 – 2√ + 2√ – 4
x2 – (sum of roots) x + (product of roots) = 0
=1
x2 + 8x + 10 = 0
Substitute in;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Substitute in;
x2 – (sum of roots) x + (product of roots) = 0 2. The roots of the equation 2x2 + 6x + 3 = 0 are
x2 + 4 x + 5 = 0 and . Find the values of:
i. + ii. iii. 3 + 3 iv. 2 + 2
Exercises 4.31 The roots of the equation 2x2 + px + q = 0 are
1. What is the quadratic equation that has 2 + and 2 + . Find the values of p and q.
one of the following as its root;
1. 5 + √ 2. 4 + √ 3. 4 – 5i Solution
4. -2 – √ 5. 3 – 4 √ 6. √ From 2x2 + 6x + 3 = 0
7. 3 √ 8. 5 √ 9. - 4 3 √ x2 + x + = 0
i. + = - =-3
Two Unknowns from the Roots of an equation
Steps:
1. Identify the given equation as equation (1). ii. =
2. Form a new equation from the given roots as
equation (2) iii. 3 +3 =3( + )
3. Compare equations (1) and (2) to obtain the = 3( - 3 ) = - 9
value of the unknowns.
2 2
iv. + = ( + )2 - 2
Worked Examples = (-3)2 – 2. / = 9 – 3 = 6
1. If the root of the equation is x2 + ax + b = 0
are x = and x = 3, find the values of a and b. From 2x2 + px + q = 0
x2 + x + = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 2 (2 + ) + (2 + ) Products of roots =
=4 +2 2+2 2 + From the roots; ( )and ( )
= 4 + 2( 2 + 2) +
Product of roots
By substitution, =( )( )
= 4. / + 2(6) +. / = ( ) ( )
= –2 -2 +4
= + 12 +
= +4–2 -2
= = +4–2( + )
⇒ = ⇒ +4–2( + )=
q = 39
But + =7
3. The roots of a quadratic equation 2x2 – 6x +
+ 4 – 2 (7) =
5 = 0 are ( ) and ( )
i. Find the value of: + 4 – 14 =
a. α b. – 10 =
ii. Form a quadratic equation, with integer
= + 10
coefficient, with roots and .
=
Solution Substitute in:
i. a. 2x2 – 6x + 5 = 0 x2 – (sum of roots)x + (product of roots) = 0
x2 – 3x + = 0 x2 – 7x + =0
2α – +2 –
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Nature of Root of a Quadratic Equation
2 +2 – – Consider the quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c =
2 +2 –. / 0, a ≠ 0. The roots of the equation are given
√
2( + ) – . / by: x=
. – /– . – / y
4 – – +
4 –2–2 +
x
1 3
x
No real roots (1)2 – 3(1) ≥ 0
-2 ≥ 0 False
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
b2 – 4ac < 0
Therefore, the solution is not between 0 and 3
Solution is k ≤ 0 or k ≥ 3.
Note:
For real roots, we combine the first two
2. Show that the roots of the equation,
conditions:
(k – 2)x2 – (2 – 3k )x + 2k = 0 are always real,
k R
If b2 – 4ac ≥ 0, the roots are real.
Two equal roots are also called “repeated
Solution
roots”.
(k – 2)x2 – (2 – 3k )x + 2k = 0
a = (k – 2), b = (2 – 3k), c = 2k
You can also make use of the fact that (any real
b2 – 4ac = (2 – 3k)2 – 4(k – 2) (2k)
number)2 ≥ 0.
= (4 – 12k + 9k2 – 4(2k2 – 4k)
= 4 – 12k + 9k2 – 8k2 + 16k
Worked Examples
= k2 + 4k + 4
1. Find the value of k for which the equation
= (k + 2) (k + 2)
(5k + 1)x2 –8kx + 3k = 0 has real roots.
= (k + 2)2
Solution
(k + 2)2 cannot be negative, as it is a square, for
(5k + 1)x2 – 8 k x + 3k = 0
any value of k R.
a = (5 k + 1), b = -8, c = 3 k
Therefore, b2 – 4ac ≥ 0 and so the roots are
always real.
Condition for real roots is;
b2 – 4ac ≥ 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
7 x2 + qx + q2 = 0 2. Verify that the roots of the equation:
8 x2 – 3x + (2 – k2) = 0 x2 – (a + b)x + (ab – c2 ) = 0 are real for all a,
9 x2 – 2(k – 1)x + (k – b, c R.
1)2 = 0
1 px2 + (p + 1)x + 1 3. Show that the roots of the equation:
0 =0 x2 – (2p + 5)x + 2 (2p + 3 ) = 0 are real for all
values of p R. Verify that one of the roots is
independent of p and the other is not
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
monomial, binomial or trinomial and state its
The degree of a polynomial is the highest degree.
power of the variable in the polynomial. Thus, 1. 5x2 – 10x3 + 6 2. x7 – x4 3. 8x 4. -15
2x + 3 has degree 1, x4 – 3x has degree 4, 2x2 –
3x + 5 has degree 2. Solutions
1. 5x2 – 10x3 + 6 is a trinomial with degree 3
The degree of a term is the power of the 2. x7 – x4 a binomial with degree 7
variable on the term. For example in 2x2 – 3x + 3. 8x is a monomial with degree 1
5, 2x2 is the first term with degree 2, -3x is the 4. -15 is a monomial with degree 0
second term with degree 1 and 5 is the third
term with degree 0. Evaluating Polynomials
Like other algebraic expressions involving
A number without a variable is called a variables, a polynomial has no specific value
constant term. Thus in 2x2 – 3x + 5, the unless the variables are replaced by numbers.
constant term is 5. The number preceding the
variable in each term is called the coefficient of A polynomial can be evaluated with or without
that term. In 2x2 – 3x + 5, 2 is the coefficient of the function notation, f(x).
x2, -3 is the coefficient of x.
Worked Examples
In general a polynomial is written in decreasing 1. Find the value of -3x4 – x3 + 20x + 3, when
order of exponent of the variable. Therefore, x = 1.
instead of - 4x2 + 1 + 5x + x3, we write:
x3 – 4x2 + 5x + 1. Solution
-3x4 – x3 + 20x + 3
When a polynomial is written with decreasing When x = 1,
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 130
= -3(1)4 – (1)3 + 20(1) + 3 Worked Examples
= -3 – 1 + 20 + 3 Perform the following:
= 19 1. (x2 – 6x + 5) + (-3x2 + 5x – 9)
2. (x2 – 5x – 3) – (4x2 + 8x – 9)
2. Find the value of x3 + x2 + x – 4 when x = -2. 3. (-5a3 + 3a – 7) + (4a2 – 3a + 7)
4. (4x3 – 3x + 2) – (5x2 – 7x – 6)
Solution
x3 + x2 + x – 4, Solutions
When x = -2, Method 1( Horizontal)
= (-2)3 + (-2)2 + (-2) – 4 1. (x2 – 6x + 5) + (-3x2 + 5x – 9)
= -8 + 4 – 2 – 4 = x2 – 6x + 5 – 3x2 + 5x – 9 (Remove brackets)
= -10 = x2 – 3x2 – 6x + 5x + 5 – 9 (Group like terms)
= -2x2 – x – 4 (simplify)
3. If f(x) = 3x2 – 4x + 2, find f(-3).
Method 2 (Vertical)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
x2 – 6x + 5
f(x) = 3x2 – 4x + 2, +
-3x2 + 5x – 9
f(-3) = 3(-3)2 – 4(-3) + 2,
= 27 + 12 + 2 -2x2 – x – 4
= 41
2. (x2 – 5x – 3) – (4x2 + 8x – 9)
Exercises 5.1
Evaluate the following: Solution
1. f(x) = 3x4 – 2x3 + 7, f(-2) Method 1( Horizontal)
2. f(x) = -2x3 + 5x2 – 12 , f(5) 1. (x2 – 5x – 3) – (4x2 + 8x – 9)
3. 1.2x3 – 4.3x – 2.4, f(1.45) x2 – 5x – 3 – 4x2 – 8x + 9
4. -3.5x4 – 4.6x3 + 5.5, f(-2.36) = x2 – 4x2 – 5x – 8x – 3 + 9
5. 2x2 – 3x + 1, x = -1 = – 3x2 – 13x + 6
6. -3x3 – x2 + 3x – 4, x=3
3. (-5a3 + 3a – 7) + (4a2 – 3a + 7)
Addition and Subtraction of Polynomials
To add or subtract two or more polynomials: Solution
1. Identify the like terms and regroup them. Method 1
2. Create in missing terms. -5a3 + 3a – 7 + 4a2 – 3a + 7
3. Add or subtract the like terms accordingly. -5a3 + 0a2 + 3a – 7 + 0a3 + 4a2 – 3a + 7
Polynomials can be added or subtracted (create missing terms)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 5.2
A. Perform the following: Worked Examples
1. (4x – 1) + (x3 + 5x – 6) 1. Find the product 3x2 (x3 – 4x)
2. (3x – 7) + (x2 – 4x + 6)
3. (x2 – 3x + 1) + (2x2 – 4x – 5) Solution
4. (x2 – 9x – 3) + (x – 4x + 8) 3x2 (x3 – 4x)
= (3x2 ) (x3 ) – (3x2 ) (4x)
5. (x3 – x2 – 5x) + (6 – x – 3x2)
= 3x5 – 12x3
6. (5.76x2 – 3.14x –7.09) + (3.9x2 + 1.21x + 5.6)
2. Find the product; (y3 – 3y + 4) (-2y)
B. Perform the following:
1. (2x2 – 3x) – (3x2 – 5x) Solution
2. (x5 – x3) – (-x4 + x4) (y3 – 3y + 4) (-2y)
3. (x2 – 3x + 4) – (x2 – 5x – 9) = (-2y) (y3 – 3y + 4)
4. (4 – 5x + x3) – (2 – 3x + x2) = (-2y) (y3) – (-2y) (3y ) + (-2y) (4)
5. (9 – 3x – x2) – (2 + 5x – x2) = -2y4 + 6y2 – 8y
Note;
Solution
The opposite of a + b ≠ b + a because, (a + b)
a. . /. / + (a – b) = 2a. Rather the opposite of (a + b) =
- (a + b) = - a – b
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
. /–2 . /
x2 + – x–2 Worked Examples
2 Find the opposite of each polynomial
x – x–2
1. 9 – y2 2. a + 4 3. – x2 + 6x – 3
b. (x – 1) (x + 3) (x – 4)
Solution
= [(x – 1) (x + 3)] (x – 4)
1. 9 – y2
= x (x + 3) – 1 (x + 3)] (x – 4)
= -(9 – y2)
= (x2 + 3x – x – 3) (x – 4)
= - 9 + y2
= (x2 + 2x – 3) (x – 4)
= y2 – 9
= x2 (x – 4) + 2x(x – 4) – 3(x – 4)
= x3 – 4x2 + 2x2 – 8x- 3x + 12 2. a + 4
= x3 – 2x2 – 11x + 12 = -(a + 4)
= -9 – 4
Note:
Generally, to multiply polynomials, multiply
3. – x2 + 6x – 3
each term of the polynomial by every term of
= - (– x2 + 6x – 3)
the other polynomial, then combine like terms
= x2 – 6x + 3
if any.
Word Problems Involving Popynomials
Exercises 5.3 i. Decide if the problem involves addition,
Find the following product: subtraction or multiplication.
1. (7x2 – 6x – 6 ) (2x – 4) ii. If polynomials are given, add, subtract or
2. (x2 – 6x – 5 ) (7x2 + 6x – 5) multiply like normal.
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 133
iii. If polynomials are not given, use formula: Length of the new garden = x + 7
Area = L × B Width of the new garden = x – 2
Perimeter = Addition of all sides
Area of new garden;
Worked Examples = Length × Width
1. A parking space is 20 yards wide and 30 = (x + 7) (x – 2)
yards long. If the length and width is increased = x (x – 2) + 7 (x – 2)
by the same amount to handle an increasing = x2 – 2x + 7x – 14
number of cars, = x2 + 5x – 14
i. What polynomial represents the area of the
new space? Exercises 5.4
ii. What is the new area of the increase is 15 1. A triangle has threes sides with lengths 8x +
yards? 6, 5x – 5 and – 6x + 12. What is the perimeter
of the triangle?
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. Let the amount of increase be x. Then; 2. The dimensions of a window are 3x + 10 and
New length = x + 30 yards 2x + 6. What is the area of the window?
New width = x + 20 yards
3. Find the area of the figure below.
Area = Length × Width 15 x
= (x + 30) (x + 20) 4
= x (x + 20) + 30 (x + 20)
= x2 + 20x + 30x + 600 x
= x2 + 50x + 600
Division of Polynomials
2
ii. If x = 15, substitute in x + 50x + 600 There are two main methods of performing
⇒ (15)2 + 50(15) + 600 division of polynomials:
= 1575 square yards 1. The long division method.
2. The synthetic method.
2. Granny has a square garden with sides of
length x meters. If he increases the length by 1. The long Division Method
7m and decreases the width by 2m, then what If g(x) is a factor of f(x), then f(x) is divisible by
trinomial represents the area of the new garden? g(x). For example, if 2 is a factor of 6, then 6 is
divisible by 2. Likewise, x4 – 16 is divisible by
Solution x2 – 4, x2 + 4, x + 2, x – 2.
x
The polynomial x4 – 16 is not divisible by x2 +
x+7
3x + 1; however, the process of long division
x can be used to find a quotient and a remainder.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked Examples
1. Divide x3 – 5x2 + 4x – 3 by x – 2 under the remainder and subtract to obtain
another remainder as shown below;
Solution x2 – 3x
(x3 – 5x2 + 4x – 3) ÷ x – 2 x–2 x-3 – 5x2 + 4x – 3
Step 1: Organize the work as shown below: 6 -3 x3 – 2x2
0 3
x – 2x x3 – 5x2 + 4x – 3 -3x2 + 4x – 3 R
6
-6 -3 -3x3 + 6x
0 Perform
Step 2: 3 x3 ÷ x = x2 and record the -2x – 3 R
6 on top of the table as shown below:
answer
Step 6. Divide the remainder by the divisor by
x2 performing -2x ÷ x = -2 and record the answer
x–2 x3 – 5x2 + 4x – 3 on top of the table as shown below.
x2 – 3x – 2
Step 3 : Multiply x2 (answer recorded) by the x–2 x-3 – 5x2 + 4x – 3
divided (x – 2). That is x2 (x – 2) = x3 – 2x2, 6 -3 x3 – 2x2
then record the answer at the bottom of the 0 3
dividend, and subtract from the dividend to -3x2 + 4x – 3 R
6
obtain the remainder as shown below. -3x3 + 6x
-2x – 3 R
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Multiply through by x – 2;
Synthetic division is used only for dividing a
x3 – 5x2 + 4x + 3 = (x2 – 3x – 2) (x – 2 ) + (-7) polynomial by a binomial x – c, where c is a
constant. For instance, if the binomial is x – 7,
2. Perform x4 – 16 ÷ (x2 + 3x + 1) then c = 7, and if the binomial is x + 7, then c = -7
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5 2
Quotient 5. f(x) = 3x + 6x + 7; p(x) = x + 2
4
From the bottom read the quotient and 6. f(x) = -2x + 10x – 3; p(x) = x – 3
remainder. Since the degree of the quotient is 7. f(x) = 4x4 – 5x2 + 1; p(x) = x –
one less than the degree of the dividend, the
8. f(x) = 9x3 – 6x2 + 3x – 4; p(x) = x –
quotient is 1x2 – 3x – 2. The remainder is – 7
Because the degree of the dividend is 4, the This provides an easy way of determining the
quotient has a degree 3. remainder when a polynomial is divided by
The quotient is 2x3 – 4x2 + 3x and the x–c
remainder is -9.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
f(x) = x4 + 4x2 + 3x – 7 2. g(x) = 2x3 – 5x2 + 8, h(x) = 2x – 1
From (x + 3) = 0, x = -3 3. g(x) = 4x3 + 5x2 + 6x – 1, h(x) = x + 2
f(-3) = (-3)4 + 4(-3)2 + 3(-3) – 7 4. g(x) = -5x3 – x2 – 10x + 9, h(x) = 5x + 1
= 81 + 36 – 9 – 7
5. g(x) = x4 + 5x2 + 2x – 8, h(x) = x + 1
= 101
6. g(x) = 3x5 – 8x4 + x2 + 2, h(x) = 2 – x
3 2
3. Find the remainder when f(x) = 2x – 5x + x
– 3 is divide by (x – 1) Using the Remainder Theorem to find One
Unknown Variable of a Polynomial
Solution If the given polynomial f(x), involves one
f(x) = 2x3 – 5x2 + x – 3 unknown variable, then one given divisor of
From (x –1) = 0, x = 1 f(x) can help to determine the value of the
f(1) = 2(1)3 – 5(1)2 + (1) – 3 unknown variable (constant).
=2–5+1–3=-5
If the polynomial f(x) divided by (x - c) gives a
3
4. Determine the remainder when f(x) = 3x + remainder, R, then form an equation involving
5x2 – x + 1 is divided by (2x – 1) f(c) = R and solve to obtain the value of the
unknown variable (constant).
Solution
f(x) = 3x3 + 5x2 – x + 1 Worked Examples
(2x – 1) = 0, x = 1. Determine the value of p if 18x3 + px2 – 8x +
9, is divided by 2x – 1 and gives a remainder of 6.
f. / = 3. / + 5. / – . / + 1
f. / = 18. / + p. / – 8. / + 9
3. Calculate the value of m if 2x3 – 7x2 + mx – 26
= 18. / + p. / – 8. / + 9 is divided by x – 2, and gives a remainder of – 24.
= + – +9 Solution
= + –4+9 Let f(x) = 2x3 - 7x2 + mx – 26
x – 2 = 0, x = 2 and R = -24
= + +5
f(2) = 2(2)3 – 7(2)2 + 2m – 26
= 16 – 28 + 2m – 26
But f. / = 6
= 2m – 38
+ +5=6
But f(2) = -24
=6–5–
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⇒2m – 38 = -24
=1– 2m = -24 + 38
= 2m = 14
m=7
p=
p = -5 4. If x5 – 2x3 – kx – 1 is divided by x – 1 and the
remainder is , find the value of k.
3 2
2. If x + x – x + b is divided by x – 2 and the
remainder is 2 , calculate the value of b. Solution
Let f(x) = x5 – 2x3 – kx – 1
Solution x – 1 = 0, x = 1 and R =
Let f(x) = x3 + x2 – x + b f(1) = (1)5 – 2(1)3 – k(1) – 1
x – 2 = 0, x = 2 and R = 2 =1–2–k–1
f(2) = (2)3 + (2)2 – 2 + b = -2 – k
=8+4–2+b
= 10 + b But f(1) =
⇒ -2 – k =
But f(2) = 2
-2(2) – (2)k = 1
10 + b = 2 -4 – 2k = 1
10 + b = -2k = 1 + 4
-2k = 5
2(10) + 2b = 5
20 + 2b = 5 k=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
9 is divided by 2x – 1 and gives a remainder of 6. Determine the values of p and q.
Put eqn (1) into eqn (2); eqn (1) – eqn ( 2);
-124 = 16(6 + q) + 4q 2q = 8
-124 = 96 + 16q + 4q q=4
-124 – 24 = 16q + 4q
-220 = 20q Put q = 4 in eqn (1);
q = -11 p+4=9
p=9–4
Put q = -11 in eqn (1); p=5
p = 6 + (-11)
p = -5 Exercises 5.8
1. When the polynomial 3x3 + ax2 + bx – 9 is
2. If 3x3 + px2 + qx + 1 has a remainder 7x + 6 divided by x – 2 the remainder is -5. When it is
when divided by x2 – 1, find the values of p and q. divided by (x + 1) the remainder is -16. Find the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
values of a and b.
Solution
Let f(x) = 3x3 + px2 + qx + 1 2. When the polynomial x4 – 4x3 + ax2 + bx + 1
x2 – 1 = (x – 1) ( x + 1 ) = 0 is divided by x – 1 the remainder is 7. When it
is divided by (x + 1) the remainder is 3. Find
When x = 1 the values of a and b.
f(1) = 3(1)3 + p (1)2 + q(1) + 1
=3+p+q+1 3. When the polynomial f (x) = x3 – px2 + qx + 2
=4+p+q where p and q are constants is divided by
(x – 2) the remainder is 2. When divided by
But f(1) = 7x + 6 (x + 1) the remainder is – 10.
= 7(1) + 6 = 13 a. Find the values of p and q.
⇒ 4 + p + q = 13 b. Hence, find f (-2)
p + q = 9……………(1)
4. Let f (x) = x3 – 2x2 + ax + b, where a and b
When x = -1 are constants. When f (x) is divided by (x – 2),
f(-1) = 3(-1)3 + p(-1)2 + q(-1) + 1 the remainder is 1 and when f (x) is divided by
= -3 – p – q + 1 (x + 1), the remainder is 28. Determine the
= -2 + p – q values of a and b.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
form ax + b
2. If (x – k) is a factor of f(x), then f (k) = 0
f(x) = Q(x) (x – 1) (x – 2) + ax + b
f(1) = Q(1) (0) (x – 2) + a(1) + b = 5 The factor theorem can be extended to include
a + b = 5 ……….(1) the following:
f(2) = Q(1) (x – 1 ) (0) + a(2) + b = 7 1. If . / = 0, then (ax – b) is a factor of f(x).
2a + b = 7 ……….(2)
2. If (ax – b) is a factor of f(x), then f . / = 0.
Solving eqn (1) and (2); 3. If (x + a) and (x + b) are both factors of a
a = 2 and b = 3 polynomial f (x), then so is their product, (x +
a) and (x + b) = x2 + abx + ab, also a factor,
Substitute in R(x) = ax + b and vice versa.
R(x) = 2x + 3
The remainder is 2x + 3 The factor theorem can be used to factorize
polynomials or to find unknown coefficients in
Exercises a polynomial. Here are some examples:
1. When the polynomial f (x) is divided by (x –
1) and (x – 2), we get a remainder of 2 and 1 Factor Put factor = Factor
respectively. Find the remainder when f(x) 0 and solve theorem
divided by (x – 1) ( x – 2)? x+5 x = -5 f (-5)
x–2 x=2 f (2)
3x + 1 x=- f (- )
2. The remainder of a polynomial f(x) in x are
10 and 15 repectively when f(x) is divided by
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. Verify that (x – 1) is a factor of 2x3 – 15x2 +
Method 2 (Synthetic Division) 34x – 24 and find the other two factors.
x3 – 4x2 + 3x + 2 ÷ (x – 2) = 0
Coefficients = 1, - 4, 3, 2 Using the Factor Theorem to find one
2 1 -4 3 2 Unknown Variable of a Polynomial
If the given polynomial f(x), involves one
2 -4 -2
unknown variable, then one factor of f(x) can
1 -2 -1 0 help to determine the value of the unknown
variable.
Since the remainder is 0, x – 2 is a factor of
f(x) = x3 – 4x2 + 3x + 2 If (x – c) are factors of the polynomial f(x), then
form an equation involving the f(c) = 0 and
Exercises 5.9 solve it to obtain the values of the constants.
A. Use the factor theorem to show that x – c
is a factor of f(x). Worked Examples
1. f(x) = x3 + x2 – 2x + 12, c = -3 1. If (2x – 1) is a factor of the polynomial
3 2
2. f(x) = x + x – 11x + 10, c=2 f(x) = 2x3 – 5x2 – kx + 3, find the value of k.
3. f(x) = x12 – 4096, c = -2 Hence, find the other two factors.
4. f(x) = x4 – 3x3 – 2x2 + 5x + 6, c = -2
Solution
f(x) = 2x3 – 5x2 – kx + 3
B. Use synthetic division to show that c is a
If (2x – 1) is a factor,
zero of f(x).
⇒ 2x – 1 = 0
1. f(x) = 3x4 + 8x3 – 2x2 – 10x + 4, c = -2
2x = 1
3 2
x2 + 2x – 3
Substitute k = 4 in f(x) = 2x – 5x – kx + 3
x+2 x3 + 4x2 + x − 6
⇒ f(x) = 2x3 – 5x2 – 4x + 3
x3 + 2x2
Now, divide 2x3 – 5x2 – 4x + 3 by (2x – 1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2x2 + x
x2 – 2x – 3
2x2 + 4x
2x – 1 2x3 – 5x2 – 4x + 3
-3x – 6
2x3 - x2
-3x – 6
- 4x2 – 4x
0
- 4x2 + 2x
x3 + 4x2 + x − 6 = (x + 2)(x2 + 2x − 3).
-6x + 3
-6x + 3
Now, factorizing (x2 + 2x − 3);
0 (x2 + 2x − 3) = (x + 3) (x – 1)
Now factorize x2 – 2x – 3
Therefore p(x) = (x + 2)(x + 3)(x − 1).
= x2 – 2x – 3
= (x2 – 3x) + (x – 3) 3. If (x – k) is a factor of the polynomial f(x) =
= x(x – 3) + 1(x – 3) 4x3 – (3k + 2)x2 – (k2 – 2)x + 3, find the
= (x + 1) (x – 3) possible values of k.
Thus, the other two factors are: (x + 1) (x – 3)
Solution
2. Let p(x) = x3 + kx2 + x − 6. Suppose that f(x) = 4x3 – (3k + 2)x2 – (k2 – 2)x + 3,
(x + 2) is a factor of p(x). If x – k is a factor, then x = k
i) Find the value of k ⇒ f(k) = 4(k)3 – (3k + 2) (k)2 – (k2 – 2) (k) + 3,
ii. With the value of k found in (1), factorize = 4k3 – (3k + 2)k2 – (k2 – 2) k + 3
p(x). = 4k3 – 3k3 – 2k2 – k3 +2k + 3
= - 2k2 +2k + 3
Solution
Since f(k) = 0
p(x) = x3 + kx2 + x − 6
Exercises 5.10
Worked Examples
1. If (x + 2) is a factor of the polynomial
1. Let f(x) = 2x3 + mx2 + nx + 2 where m and n
f(x) = 6x3 + kx2 + 11x – 6, find the value of k.
are constants. Given that x – 1 and x + 2 are
Hence, find the other two factors.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
factors of f(x), find the value of m and the value
2. If (2x + 1) is a factor of the polynomial of n.
f(x) = 2x3 + 7x2 + kx + 2, find the value of k.
Hence, find the other two factors. Solution
f(x) = 2x3 + mx2 + nx + 2
3. If x + 2 is a factor of ax2 + 4x, find the value If (x – 1) is a factor, then f(1) = 0
of a. f(1) = 2(1)3 + m(1)2 + n(1) + 2
f(1) = 2 + m + n + 2
4. Consider the polynomial function P(x) = x4 – But f(1) = 0
3x3 + ax2 – 6x + 14, where a is an unknown real ⇒m+n+4=0
number. If x – 2 is a factor of P(x), what is the m + n = - 4 ……………(1)
value of a?
If (x + 2) is a factor, then f(-2) = 0
5. Find the values of a, b and c so that the given f(-2) = 2(-2)3 + m(-2)2 + n(-2) + 2
linear expressions are factors of the following f(-2) = 2(-8) + 4m – 2n + 2
polynomials: = -16 + 4m – 2n + 2
a. x3 –7x2 – x + a, x–1 = -14 + 4m – 2n
3 2
b. 4x + bx + 3x + 2, 2x – 1
3 2
c. 8x – 2x + cx + 6, 2x + 3 But f(-2) = 0
⇒ -14 + 4m – 2n = 0
Challenge Problems 4m – 2n = 14 ……………(2)
Find all the values of k such that f(x) is
divisible by the given linear polynomial. m + n = - 4 ……………….(1)
1. f(x) = k2 + x3 – 4kx + 3; x–1 4m – 2n = 14 …………….(2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
p(x) = , where a, b, c , m and k are
constants. But k = - 4
i. If the truth set of p(x) = 0 is {1, 2}, find the ( ) ( )
( )
=-2
values of a, b and c.
ii. If p(0) = - and p(3) = -2, using your results =-2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the value of q. p – q = 1…………..(1)
x2 + x – 2
3 2
f(-3) = (-3)3 – 3a + b
x + 1 x + 2x – x – 2 f(-3) = - 27 – 3a + b……….(iv)
x3 + x2
x2 – x eqn (iii) = eqn (iv)
x2 + x - 27 – 3a + b = 25
-3a + b = 25 + 27
-2x - 2
-2x - 2 - 3a + b = 52……………….(2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x(x + 2) – 1 (x + 2) Put a = -12 in eqn (1)
(x – 1) (x + 2) 2(-12) + b = - 8
⇒ x3 + 2x2 – x – 2 = ( x + 1) (x – 1) (x + 2) - 24 + b = -8
b = - 8 + 24
2. (x – 2) is a factor of the polynomial f(x) = x3 b = 16
+ ax + b, where a and b are constants. The
Put a = -12 and b = 16 in f(x) = x3 + ax + b
remainder when f(x) is divided by (x + 3) is 25.
f(x) = x3 – 12x + 16
Find;
a. the values of the constants a and b.
b. f(x) = x3 – 12x + 16
b. the remainder when f(x) is divided by (x – 3).
f(3) = 33 – 12(3) + 16
c. the truth set of the equation f(x) = 0
= 27 – 36 + 16 = 7
The remainder when f(x) is divided by
Solution
(x – 3) is 7.
a. f(x) = x3 + ax + b
x2 + 2x – 8
If (x – 2) is a factor of the polynomial f(x)
⇒f(2) = 0…………………..(i) x – 2 x3 + 0x2 – 12x +16
x3 - 2x2
But f(2) = 23 + 2a + b 2x2 – 12x
f(2) = 8 + 2a + b…………..(ii) 2x2 - 4x
-8x + 16
eqn (i) = eqn (ii); -8x + 16
8 + 2a + b = 0
0
2a + b = -8 …………………(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
For x – 3 = 0, x = 3 Put q = 3 in eqn (5);
f(3) = p(3)3 + q(3)2 + r(3) – 12 - 5p + 5(3) = 10
= 27p + 9q + 3r – 12 - 5p + 15 = 10
- 5p = 10 – 15
But f(3) = 30 -5p = -5
27p + 9q + 3r – 12 = 30 p=1
27p + 9q + 3r = 42……………(1)
Put p = 1 and q = 3 in eqn (1);
Now, by factorization; 9(1) + 3(3) + r = 14
If x2 + x – 6 = (x + 3) (x – 2) 9 + 9 + r = 14
⇒ x + 3 and x - 2 are factors of f(x) r = 14 – 9 – 9
For x + 3 = 0, x = -3 r=-4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
factor theorem to show that (x – 2) is a factor of Solving Cubic Equations
f(x). Any equation of the form ax3 + bx2 + cx + d =
b. Given that f(x) = (x – 2) (2x2 + bx + c), find 0, a ≠ 0 is called a cubic equation. The factor
the values of b and c. theorem is used to find one root, and hence one
c. Hence prove that f(x) = 0 has only one real factor.
solution.
Steps in Solving a Cubic Equation
3 2
6. Let f(x) = x + (p + 1)x – 18x + q, where p 1. Find the first root, k, by trial and error
and q are integers. Given that (x – 4) is a factor method. i.e try f(1), f(-1), f(2), f(-2) etc
of f(x); 2. If x = k is a root, then c – k is a factor.
a. Show that 16p + q + 8 = 0 3. Divide f(x) by (x – k) which always gives a
b. Given that (x + p) is also a factor of f(x), and quadratic expression.
p > 0; show that p2 + 18x + q = 0. 4. Let the quadratic equal to zero and solve by
c. Hence find the value of p and the factorization or formula.
corresponding value of q.
d. factorize f(x) completely. Worked Examples
1. Solve the equation 2x3 + x2 – 13x + 6 = 0
Finding a Polynomial with Prescribed Zeros
Worked Example Solution
1. Find the polynomial with degree 3 that has Let f(x) = 2x3 + x2- 13x + 6
zeros 2, -1 and 3. The first root will be a factor of the constant
term, 6 = 1, 2, 3, 6
Solution f(1) = 2(1)3 + (1)2- 13(1) + 6
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
remainder is not 0.
2x3 - 4x2
Test x = 3;
5x2 - 13x
5x2 - 10x 3 1 -4 -17 60
-3x + 6 3 -3 - 60
-3x + 6
1 -1 - 20 0
0
3 is a solution to the equation because the
2
Let 2x + 5x – 3 = 0 remainder is 0.
Solving by factorization, ⇒ x – 3 is a factor of the polynomial.
(2x – 1) (x + 3) = 0 Now x3 – 4x2 – 17x + 60 ÷ ( x – 3)
⇒ 2x – 1 = 0 or x + 3 = 0
x= or x = -3 x2 – x – 20
x - 3 x3 – 4x2 – 17x + 60
The three roots of the equation are : -3, , 2.
x3 – 3x2
3 2 - x2 – 17x
2. The equation x – 4x – 17x + 60 = 0 is
known to have a solution that is between -3 and - x2 + 3x
3 inclusive. Find the solution set. - 20x + 60
- 20x + 60
Solution
{-3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3} contains one of the ⇒ (x – 3) (x2 – x – 20 ) = 0
solution set. By using synthetic division, Let x2 – x – 20 = 0
Test x = 1 (x2 – 5x ) + (4x – 20) = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2x3 – 5x2 – 4x + 3 = 0 and find the other two
Challenge problems
roots.
1. Verify that – 4p is the root of the equation
4. Show that x = 2 is the root of the equation x3 x3 + 3px2 – 6p2x – 8p3 = 0. Hence or otherwise,
+ 4x2 – 11x – 2 = 0 and find the other two roots, find the three roots of x3 + 3px2 – 6p2x – 8p3 = 0
in terms of p. Ans;- 4p, -p, 2p
giving your answer in the form a b√ .
2. Factorize the following;
5. If x = - is a root of the equation 2x3 – 9x2 + a. a3 – b3 b. a3 + b3
kx + 6 = 0 , find the value of k . Find the other
two roots of the equation. 3. Solve each of the following given that at
least one of the solutions is an integer between
6. Let p(x) = ax3 – 5x2 - bx + 18 = 0. -5 and 5.
If -2 and 3 are the roots of the equation p(x) = a. x4 – 4x3 + 3x2 + 4x – 4 = 0.
0, find the values of a and b. b. x4 + x3 – 7x2 – x + 6 = 0
If p(k) = 0, k ≠ -2, -3, find the value of k.
Factorizing Cubic Expressions of the form:
7. If k is the root of the equation 3x3 – (k + 3)x2 x3 + cx + d
+ (7 – k – 4k2)x - 4 = 0, find the values of k. Given x3 + cx + d, where d is the constant of the
polynomial.
8. Find the values of the constants p , q and r 1. Assuming a is a factor of d, such that x - a or
for which (x – 4)(x – 2)(x + p) = x3 – 7x2 + qx + x = a is a factor of x3 + cx + d, then
r for all values of x R. Using these values of x3 + cx + d, factorizes as :
q and r, solve the equation x3 – 7x2 + qx + r = 0 = (linear factor) (quadratic factor)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
When x = 1 When x = -3
x3 + 9x – 10 = 0 (x3 + 27) = 0
(x – 1) . ( ) / (x + 3) . /
(x – 1) ( ) (x + 3) ( )
4
x + 27x = x(x + 3) ( )
Definition x=
( )
A function f is rational if f(x) = ( )
, where g(x) Domain = {x is real except x = }
and h(x) are polynomials. In other words, a
rational function is a ratio of two polynomials
2. f(x) =
in which the denominator is not zero.
Let 2x + 1 = 0
Rational Functions and their Domain 2x = - 1
The domain of f(x) consists of all real numbers x=
except the zeros of the denominator h(x). In
other words, the domain is the set of all real 3. f(x) =
numbers that can be used in place of the
Let 9x + 1 = 0
variable.
9x = -1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Steps; x=
1. Equate the denominator, h(x) to zero and Domain = {x is real except x ≠ }
solve for the value of x.
2. The value of x (or the involving variable)
4. f(x) =
obtained is not part of the domain if it makes
the denominator zero. Let x2 – 4 = 0
x2 – 22 = (x + 2) (x – 2) = 0
In a rational function, the denominator cannot ⇒x = 2 or x = -2
be equal to zero because that would be Domain = {x is real except x = 2 or x = -2)
undefined. Find which numbers that make the
fraction undefined by creating an equation The Range
The range of a rational function is the same as
whose denominator is not equal to zero.
the domain of the inverse function. Hence to
find the range:
Worked Examples
1. Find the inverse of the function.
Determine the domain of the following:
2. Find the domain of the inverse function.
1. f(x) = 3. f(x) =
2. f(x) = 4. f(x) = Worked Examples
Determine the range of the following:
Solution 1. f(x) = 2. f(x) =
1.
Let 3x – 8 = 0 Solutions
3x = 8 f(x) =
Worked Examples
Now, let 3y – 4 = 0
3y = 4 1. Find the value of f(x) = for x = -3
y=
Solution
Range = { y : y R, y ≠ }
f(x) =
When x = -3
4. f(x) =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )
f(x) = ( )
= = 13
Let y = (Solve for x)
y= (Change subject to y)
y (x – 2 ) = 1 Solution
x y – 2y = 1 R(x) =
x y = 2y + 1 ( )
R(4) = ( )
=2
y=
Range = {y : y R, y ≠ 0} Exercises 6.2
A. Evaluate each of the following.
Exercises 6.1
1. f(x) = for x = -2
A. Find the domain of the following rational
functions. 2. f(x) = for x = 5
1. f(x) = ( )(
4. f(x) = +5
)
3. R(x) = , find R(3)
2. f(x) = 5. f(x) =
4. f(x) = , find R(-1)
3. f(x) = 6. f(x) = √
B. Find the range.
B. 1. If R(x) = , find R(3), R(5), R(2.05)
1. f(x) = 4. f(x) = +5
and R(1.999)
2. f(x) = 5. f(x) =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )( )
f(x) = = = = 3. f(x) = 6. f(xy) =
( ) ( )
= Solution
f(x) = and g(x) =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Given that f(xy) = and g(xy) = ,
find f(xy) . g(xy) f(x) ÷ g(x) = ÷
= ×
Solution
f(xy) = and g(xy) = , = ×
( )
f(xy) . g(xy) = . , ( )( ) ( )( )
= ×
( ) ( )
= .( )(
,
) ( )( ) ( – )
= ×
= . ,
( )( )
= =
( )
=
Exercises 6.4
In each of the following, find the product of =
f(x) and g(x)
1. f(x) = x2 – 6x + 9 and g(x) =
Exercise 6.5
2 ( )
2. f(x) = and g(x) = 4x + 20x + 25 In each of the following, find ( )
( )
3. f(x) = and g(x) = 1. f(x) = and g(x) =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
f(x) + g(x)
= + ,
( )
Solution
f(x) = and g(x) = , = ( )(
+ ,
) ( )
( )
f(x) + g(x) = + = = =2 =
( )
( )( )
Solution
2. Given that f(x) = and g(x) = , find:
f(x) = ( and g(x) = (
)( ) )( )
f(x) – g(x)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B. Find the domain and zeros of the functions )( )
defined in questions 1 to 6 of A 3. 4.
( )( )( )
Partial Fractions
Consider the identity below: Solutions
= + 1. ( = +
)( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
32 = 4B =
B=8 18A = 36
A=2
Now, when x = 0 and B = 8 Substitute A = 2, B = -2 and C = 1
3(0)2 – 16 = A(0 – 4) + 8(0)
in = + +
-16 = - 4A ( )( )( )
A=4 = + +
( )( )( )
Substitute A = 4 and B = 8 in
= +( The partial fraction decomposition is;
( ) )
⇒ = +( = – –
( )( )( )
( ) )
3. = + + 4.
( )( )( )
( )( )( )
11x + 12 = +
Factorize the denominator to obtain a quadratic
( )( )( ) ( )( )( ) expression;
+
x3 – 2x2 – 3x = x (x2 – 2x – 3)
11x + 12 = A(x + 2)(x – 3) + B(2x + 3)(x – 3) +
C(2x + 3)(x + 2) By factorization,
When x = -2, x2 – 2x – 3 = (x + 1) (x – 3)
11(-2) + 12 = B[2(-2) + 3](-2 – 3) x3 – 2x2 – 3x = x (x + 1) (x – 3)
- 22 + 12 = B(- 4 + 3)(- 5) = + +
( )
-10 = 5B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4(-1)2 + 13(-1) – 9 = 0 + B[-1(-1 – 3)] + 0 = +
( )( )
4 – 13 – 9 = 4B
- 18 = 4B
.Exercises 6.7
B=
A. Express in partial fractions:
1. ( 2. (
When x = 0, )( ) )( )
4(0)2 + 13(0) – 9 = A (0 + 1) (0 – 3) + 0 + 0 3. 4. ( )( )
- 9 = A (1) (-3)
-9 = - 3 A
A=3 B. Resolve into partial fractions:
1. 4.
Substitute A = 3, B = and C = in
2. 5.
= + + ( )( )
( )
3. ( 6.
)( )( ) ( )( )
⁄ ⁄
⇒ = + +
( )
The partial fraction decomposition is; Challenge Problems
Resolve into partial fractions :
= – +
( ) ( ) ( )
1. 3. ( )( )( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
following:
+( x(x – 3)2
)
1. ( 2.
) ( ) ⇒x2 + 10x – 36 = A(x – 3)2 + Bx(x – 3) + Cx
x2 + 10x – 36 = A(x2 – 6x+ 9) + B(x2 – 3x) + Cx
Solution x2 + 10x – 36 = Ax2 – 6Ax+9A + Bx2 – 3Bx + Cx
1. = +( x2 + 10x – 36 = Ax2 + Bx2 – 6Ax –3Bx + Cx+ 9A
( ) )
By regrouping;
x2 + 10x – 36 = (A + B)x2 + (–6A –3B + C)x+ 9A
(x – 1)2 = (x – 1)2 + (x – 1)2
( ) ( )
2x + 3 = A(x – 1) + B Equating coefficients, the following is obtained;
A + B = 1……………………(1)
When x = 1 - 6A – 3B + C = 10………….(2)
2(1) + 3 = A(1 – 1) + B 9A = - 36…………………….(3)
5=0+B
B=5 From equation 3,
9A = -36
Now, when x = 0, and B = 5 A=-4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3x + x + 1 = A(x + 1) + B (x – 2) (x + 1)2 + C
3 3
3x3 + Bx3 + 9x2 + Cx2 + 10x – 3Bx – Cx – 2B –
(x – 2) (x + 1) + D (x – 2) 2C + 1
( ) (
= +( + 3. ( 6.
) )
) ( )
2
9 = A(x + 1) (x – 2) + B(x – 2) + C(x + 1)
B. Express in partial fractions;
When x = -1
9 = A(-1 + 1) (-1 – 2) + B(-1 – 2) + C(-1 + 1)2 1. ( 2.
) ( )( )
9 = -3B 3. ( 4. (
)( ) )( )
B = -3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
9 = A(2 + 1) (2 – 2) + B(2 – 2) + C(2 + 1)2 1. Find the values of A, B, C, D, if
9 = C (3)2 = + +( +(
( )( ) ) )
9 = 9C
C=1
Type III: A Partial fraction decomposition
containing an irreducible quadratic factor
When B = -3 and C = 1;
A rational expression whose denominator
9 = A(x + 1) (x – 2) + -3(x – 2) + 1(x + 1)2
contains an irreducible quadratic factor is
9 = A(x2 – 2x + x – 2) – 3x + 6 + (x2 + 2x + 2)
decomposed on the R.H.S. as shown below;
9 = A (x2 – x – 2) – 3x + 6 + x2 + 2x + 2
9 = Ax2 – Ax – 2A – 3x + 6 + x2 + 2x + 2 1. = +
( )
9 = Ax2 + x2 – Ax – 3x + 2x – 2A + 6 + 2
2. ( =( +
9 = Ax2 + x2 – Ax – x – 2A + 8 )( ) )
9 = x2 (A + 1) – x (A + 1) – 2A + 8
Worked Examples
9 = -2A + 8 1. Find the partial fraction decomposition of
2A = 9 – 8
2A = 1
A=
Solution
The partial fraction decomposition is:
⁄
= +( +
( ) ( ) ) x3+ 2x = x(x2 + 2) (Factorize the denominator)
( ) (
= –( + = + ( Decompose the expression)
) ( ) )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4+B=9 Now, equating coefficients in
B=9–4 x2 – x – 21 = (2A + C)x2 + (-A + 2B)x – B + 4C
B=5 2A + C = 1 ……………(1)
-A + 2B = -1……………(2)
Substitute A = 4, B = 5 and C = -3 into - B + 4C = -21………….(3)
= +
From eqn (1);
⇒ = + C = 1 – 2A…………….(4)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⇒ = + From equation (2);
Substitute A = 2 and B = 1
= = +
2(2) – 5(1) + C = 0
4–5+C=0
The partial fraction of the expression is; -1 + C = 0
C=1
=2+ -
Substitute A = 2, B = 1 and C = 1
3. Express the rational function ( )( )
( )(
= +
)
in partial fractions.
Exercises 6.9
Solution
A. Resolve into partial fractions:
= +
( )( ) 1. 5. ( )( )
( )
Substitute x = 5 4. ( )( )
8. ( )( )
3 × 52 + 9 = A(52 + 2 × 5 + 7).
84 = 42A B. Express in partial fractions;
A = 2.
1. 2. ( )( )
3.( )( )
( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
The degree of the numerator is 3 and the degree D=0
Substitute A = 5, B = -3, C = 2 and D = 0 in
of the denominator is 4. Long division is not = +(
( ) )
required.
= +( = +(
) ( ) )
( )
Binomial Expansion
The Pascal‟s Triangle
Consider the following binomial expansions:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
From the table, the coefficients of expansion form a pattern. This triangular array of coefficients for
the binomial expansion is called Pascal‟s triangle.
1
1 1
1 2 1
1 3 3 1
1 4 6 4 1
1 5 10 10 5 1
1 6 15 20 15 6 1
…………………………….
Notice that each line starts and ends with 1 and that each entry of a line is the sum of the two entries
above it in the previous line. For instance, 4 = 3 + 1, 10 = 6 + 4 and 20 = 10 + 10. Following this
pattern, the eighth rows of coefficients are :
1 6 15 20 15 6 1
2
x – 6x + 5
1 7 21 35 35 21 7
2
3x + 5x – 9
Pascal‟s triangle gives an easy way of obtaining the coefficients for the binomial expansion with
small powers, but it is impractical for larger powers. For large powers, use the formula involving
factorial notation or combinatorial notation.
Solution
Number of terms = n +1 = 5 + 1 = 6 terms
Therefore, there will be 6 terms involving
a5, a4b1, a3b2, a2b3, a1b4, b5 each with degree 5.
From Pascal‟s triangle, the coefficients are respectively: 1 5 10 10 5 1
Therefore, the expansion of(a + b)5in descending powers of a is
(a + b)5= a5 + 5a4b1 + 10 a3b2 + 10a2b3 + 5a1b4 + b5
Solution
(2x + 3y)3 = (a + b)3
⇒a = 2x and b = 3y and the number of involving terms is 3 + 1 = 4 terms
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(2x)3, (2x)2 (3y), (2x) (3y)2 (3y)3
From the Pascal‟s triangle, the coefficients obtained for row four are: 1 3 3 1
Therefore, the expansion of (2x + 3y)3 in descending powers of x is
(2x + 3y)3 = (2x)3 + 3(2x)2 (3y) + 3(2x) (3y)2 + (3y)3
= 8x3 + 36x2y + 54xy2 + 27y3
Solution
Let . / = ( )
⇒ a = 2x and b = -
5. Expand . √ /
Solution
In . √ / number of terms is 5 + 1 = 6
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= . / + 5. / (-2√ )1 + 10 . / (-2√ )2 + 10. / (-2√ )3 + 5. / (-2√ )4 + (-2√ )5
⁄
= – ⁄ + – ⁄ + 80x – 32
Exercises 7.1
A. Use Pascal‟s triangle to expand:
1. (p + q)6 2. (x – y)7 3. (x + 2a)3
4. (a + 3b)4 5. (x2 – 2)4 6. (x2 + a2)5
5. . / 6. . / 7. (√ √ ) 8. ( √ )
Factorials
Definition Consider 8! = 8.7.6.5.4.3.2.1 = 40,320, it can be
The product of all positive whole numbers from seen that:
n down to 1 is called “factorial n” and it is 8! = 8.7.6.5.4.3.2.1 = 8.7! = 8.7.6! = 8.7.6.5!
denoted by n!. (and so on)
Generally,
Thus n! = n(n – 1)(n – 2) …3.2.1 1. if 5! = 5.4! = 5.4.3!( and so on), then
By definition, 0! = 1 n! = (n(n – 1)! = n(n – 1) (n – 2)! and so on
2. If 7.6! = 7!, then (n +1) n! = (n + 1)!
Baffour Ba Series , Further Mathematics for Schools Page 170
Note: ( )
2. If = n2 + pn + q, find the value of p and
)
When simplifying factorials, it is a good
the value of q.
practice to start with the larger factorial and
work down to the smaller one.
3. If (n + 1)! + n2(n – 1)! = (an + b)n!, find the
value of a.
Worked Examples
1. If ( = k, find the value of k
) 4. If ( = k, find the value of k.
)
Solution ( )
5. If = an, find the value of a.
=k ( ) ( )
( )
( ) ( )
= = =8 C. Solve the following:
( ) ( ) ( )
k=8 ( )
1. 9(n – 4)! = (n – 3)! 4. =
( )
( ) ( ) ( )( )
2. Solve = 2. ( = 30 3. =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
) ( )
Solution
( ) Combinatorial Numbers
=
( ) 1. By definition, ( ) =
= ( )
( )( )
( )( ) ( )
= 2. In practice,( ) =
( )
⇒n(n – 1 ) = 56
n2 – n – 56 = 0 Both give the same results; but the second is
easier to use in practical questions.
Solving by factorization
(n -8)(n + 7) = 0 For example:
n = 8 or n = -7 1. ( ) = = = = 15
( )
n = -7 is rejected as n! is defined for natural
,
number only. 2. ( ) = ⇒ = 15
,
Exercise 7.2
Memory Aid:
A. Evaluate the following:
( ) ( )= =
( ) ( )
1. 10! 2. 3. 4.
( )is pronounced as “n-c-r” or “n-choose-r”
( )
B. 1. If = n2 + an + b, find the value of a
( ) Other Results
and the value of b. 1. ( ) = 1 and ( ) = 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A. Evaluate the expressions:
The following occur quite frequently when 1. 2 6 2. 3 4 3. 7 0 4. 5 0
solving equations involving combinatorial 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
( )
numbers:
1. ( ) = n ( )
( ) B. 1. If ( = n2 + an + b, find the values of a
2. ( ) = )
( )( )
and b.
3. ( ) =
( )
2. If = n2 + pn + q, find the values of p
( )
Worked Examples
and q.
Solve:
1. ( ) = 21, n N
3. If (n + 1) + n2(n – 1 ) = (an + 1)n , find the
( )
2. 4( )= ,n N value of a
4.If ( = k, find the value of k.
)
Solution
1. ( ) = 21, n N ( )
( ) 5. If = an, find the values of a.
( ) ( )
= = 21
( )
= 21 C. Solve each of the following;
2 ( )
n + n = 2 × 21 1. 9(n – 4 ) = (n – 3) 2. ( = 30
)
n2 + n = 42 ( )( ) ( )
n2 + n – 42 = 0 3. = 4. =
( ) ( )
Notes
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. The expansion contains (n + 1) terms (one more than the power).
2. The power of a decreases by 1 in each successive terms.
3. The power of b increases by 1 in each successive term.
4. In each term, the sum of the indices of a and b is n.
5. The power of b is always the same as the lower number in the combination bracket
6. If the binomial is a difference, (a – b) the signs will be alternately +, - , +, -,…
Worked Examples
1. Write out all the terms in the expansion of (a + b)5
Solution
Method 1 (using Combinatorial method)
The power is 5, so there are six terms.
Step 1: Write down six pairs of the variable as shown below:
ab + ab + ab + ab + ab + ab
Step 2: Put in powers, starting with the highest power of a: sum of powers = 5 in each term)
a5b0 + a4b1 + a3b2 + a2b3 + a1b4 + a0b5
Step 3 : Put in combinatorial numbers
( )a5b0 + ( )a4b1 + ( )a3b2 + ( )a2b3 + ( )a1b4 + ( )a0b5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
First note that:
(A + B)5 = A5 + 5A4B + A3B2 + A2B3 + AB4 + B5.
That is,
(A + B)5 = A5 + 5A4B + 10A3B2 + 10A2B3 + 5AB4 + B5.
That is,
(2 − x)5 = 32 − 80x + 80x2 − 40x3 + 10x4 − x5.
Solution
(A + B)3 = A3 + 3A2B + AB2 + B3
= A3 + 3A2B + 3AB2 + B3.
Solution
(x – 3y)4, the number of terms = 4 + 1 = 5 terms
(x – 3y)4= ( ) (x)4(-3y)0 +( ) (x)3(-3y)1 + ( )(x)2(-3y)2 + ( ) (x)1(-3y)3 + ( ) (x)0(-3y)4
= (1)(x4) (1) + (4)(x3)(-3y) + 6(x2) (9y2) + (4) (x) (-27y3) + (1)(1)(81y4)
= x4 – 12x3y + 54x2y2 –108xy3 + 81y4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
6. Expand using binomial theorem . / . Show that one of the terms is independent of p.
Solution
In . / the power is 4 and the terms are 5.
= p4 + 8p2 + 24 + +
The third term, 24 is independent of p (meaning the term does not contain p or the power of p is 0)
Exercises 7.4
A. Expand the following:
1. ( ) 2. ( ) 3. ( )
4. ( ) 5. ( ) 6. ( )
This form of binomial theorem is used to expand a binomial to any power when the first term of the
binomial is 1.
Type 1
Worked Examples
1. Expand, using the binomial theorem, (1 + 2x)5. Hence, expand (1 – 2x)5.
Solution
(1 + 2x)5 =( ) + ( ) (2x) + ( )(2x)2 + ( )(2x)3 + ( )(2x)4 + ( )(2x)5
= (1) + (5)(2x) + (10)(4x2) + (10)(8x3) + (5)(16x4) + (1)(32x5)
= 1 + 10x + 40x2 + 80x3 + 80x4 + 32x5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The only difference between the expansion of (1 + 2x)5 and (1 – 2x)5 is that the signs alternate :
+, –, + , – …
⇒(1 – 2x)5= 1 – 10x + 40x2 – 80x3 + 80x4 – 32x5
Solution
Method 1
(1 + x)3 + (1 – x)3
(1 + x)3 = ( ) + ( ) (x) + ( )(x)2 + ( )(x)3
=1 + 3x + 3x2 + x3
⇒(1 – x)3 = 1 – 3x + 3x2 – x3
Exercises 7.5
A. Expand:
Learners can use the Pascal‟s triangle or the binomial theorem, unless stated.
Worked Examples
1. Expand (3 + √ )5, and write your answer in the form a + b√
Solution
Method 1:(Using Binomial Theorem)
In (3 + √ )5, there are 6 terms;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(3 +√ )5
=( )(3)5(√ )0 + ( )(3)4(√ )1 + ( )(3)3(√ )2 + ( )(3)2(√ )3 + ( )(3)1(√ )4 + ( )(3)0(√ )5
Solution
(1 + √ )4 + (1 – √ )4 = k
Using Pascal’s triangle,
(1 + √ )4 = 1 + (4)(√ )1 + (6)(√ )2 + (4)(√ )3 + (1)(√ )4
(1 – √ )4 = 1 – 4√ + (6 )(3) – 12√ +9
= 1 + 18 + 9 – 16√
= 28 – 16√
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. Use your results to simplify (1 + √ )5 + (1 – √ )5
Solution
i. (1 + x)5 + (1 – x)5
(1 + x)5 = 15 + 5x + 10x2 + 10x3 + 5x4 + x5
= 1 + 5x + 10x2 + 10x3 + 5x4 + x5
(1 + x)5 + (1 – x)5 = [1 + 5x + 10x2 + 10x3 + 5x4 + x5] + [1 – 5x + 10x2 – 10x3 + 5x4 – x5]
= 1 + 1 + 5x – 5x + 10x2 + 10x2 + 10x3 – 10x3 + 5x4 + 5x4 + x5 – x5
= 2 + 20x2 + 10x4
Exercises 7.6
A. Evaluate the following leaving your answer in the form a + b√ ;
1. (1 + √ )4 2. (1 – √ )5 3. (1 + √ )6 4. (2 + √ )4
5. (1 + √ )4 6. (1 -2√ )6 7. (2 + √ )6 8. (√ – √ )5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. i. Use Pascal‟s triangle to expand (a + b)5
ii. Hence, expand (1 + 2x)5 – (1– 2x)5
iii. Hence, write (1 + 2√ )5 – (1 – 2√ )5 in the form k√ , k N
Challenge Problems
1. i. Use Pascal‟s triangle or binomial theorem to expand (p +q)4 + (p – q)4
ii. Hence, or otherwise, write (x +√ )4 – (x – √ )4 as a polynomial in x
iii. Hence, evaluate (4 + √ )4 + (4 – √ )4
Substitution
Identify the number and its substitute. Perform the binomial expansions and substitute the values at
the final stage .
Worked Examples
Given that √ = 1.414, √ = 1.732, √ , evaluate without using tables;
3 4
(1 –√ ) (√ + √ ) correct to three decimal places.
Solution
(1 – √ )3 (√ + √ )4
(1 – √ )3 = 1 + 3(1)(-√ ) + 3(1) (-√ )2 + (-√ )3
= 1 – 3√ + 15 – 5√
(1 –√ )3 (√ + √ )4 = (1) × (2)
= -1.888 × 97.9810
= -184.188 (3 decimal places)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 7.7
Given that √ = 1.414, √ = 1.732, √ , evaluate the following correct to three
decimal places:
1. (1 +√ )3 2. (1 – √ )3 3. (√ + √ )4 4. (√ – √ )4
5. (1 –√ )4– (1 + √ )3 6. (√ + 1)4 + (√ + √ )3 7. (√ + 1)4 (√ – √ )3
Related Application
This involves application of the binomial theorem to evaluate an exponential value. This is done as
follows:
I. Express the given value as a sum of two numbers, (usually a natural number plus a decimal
fraction, preceded by zero(s) with the same exponent). Consider the following instances:
a. As far as binomial theorem is concern, (2.01)3 is expressed as:
(2.01)3 = (2 + 0.01)3
Incorrect
(1.997)3 (1 + 0.997)3
Correct
(1.997)3 (2 – 0.003)3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
c. As far as binomial expansion is concerned (0.9)4 (0 + 0.9)4. This is because the first part of the
summation is not a natural number. Therefore, if 1 – 0.9 = 0.1, then 0.9 = 1 – 0.1
⇒ (0.9)4 = (1 – 0.1)4
Incorrect
(0.9)4 (0 + 0.9)4
Correct
(0.9)4 = (1 – 0.1)4 x
II. Use any suitable method to expand the sum of the binomial.
Worked Examples
1. Evaluate (2.01)5 to two decimal places:
Solution
Method 1:(Using Pascal‟s triangle)
(2.01)5 = (2 + 0.01)5
From the Pascal‟s triangle, the respective coefficients are: 1, 5 , 10, 10 , 5, 1
(2 + 0.01)5
(1)(2)5(0.01)0 + (5)(2)4(0.01)1 + (10) (2)3(0.01)2 + (10)(2)2(0.01)3 + (5)(2)1(0.01)4 + (1)(2)5 (0.01)0
32 + 0.08 + 0.008
32.808
32.81 (2 decimal places)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Method 2: (Combination method)
(2.01)5 = (2 + 0.01)5
(2 + 0.01)5
= ( )(2)5 (0.01)0 + ( )(2)4(0.01)1 + ( )(2)3(0.01)2+ ( )(2)2(0.01)3+ ( ))(2)1(0.01)4+ ( )(2)0(0.01)5
(1)(2)5 + (5)(16)(0.01)1 + (10) (8)(0.01)2 + (10)(4)(0.01)3 + (5)(2)1(0.01)4 + (1)(1) (0.01)5
32 + 0.08 + 0.008
32.808
32.81(2 decimal places)
2. Use Pascal‟s triangle to obtain the value of (1.002)5, correct to six places of decimals.
Solution
(1.002)5 = (1 + 0.002)5
From Pascal‟s triangle, the respective coefficients are: 1, 5, 10, 10, 5, 1
(1 + 0.002)5 (1)(0.002)0 + (5) (0.002)1 + (10) (0.002)2 + …
1+ 0.01 + 0.000040
1.010040
⇒ (1.002)5 = 1.010040 (6 decimal places)
Solution
(1.997)4 = (2 – 0.003)4
From Pascal‟s triangle, the respective coefficients are: 1, 4, 6, 4, 1
(2 – 0.003)4
(1)(2)4(-0.003)0 + (4)(2)3(-0.003)1 + (6)(2)2(-0.003)2 + (4)(2)1(-0.003)3 + (1)(2)0(-0.003)4
(1)(16)(-0.003)0 + (4)(8)(-0.003)1 + (6)(4)(-0.003)2 + (4)(2)1(-0.003)3 + (1)(1)(-0.003)4
16 + 32(- 0.003) + 24(-0.003)2…
16 – 0.096 +… (Ignore the other terms since they involve more than 3 decimal places)
15.904
(1.997)4 = 15.90 (2 decimal places)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
(0.9)4 = (1 – 0.1)4
From the Pascal‟s triangle, the respective coefficients are 1, 4, 6, 4, 1
(0.9)4 =14 (-0.1)0 + (4) (-0.1)1 + (6) (-0.1)2 + (4)(-0.1)3 + (-0.1)4
1 – 0.4 + 0.06 – 0.004 +….
0.656 (3 decimal places)
Exercises 7.8
Use any suitable method to evaluate the following correct to two decimal places.
1. (1 – 0.1)5 2. (2 – 0.001)4 3. (1 + 0.01)5 4. (1.03)4
5. (2.001)3 6. (1.999)6 7. (2.998) 8. (1.01)10 9. (0.998)6
Type 2
It involves expanding a given binomial and applying the results to evaluate a given exponential
value. This is usually refered to as appproxinations.
Worked Examples
1. Expand (2 + x)5 and hence, find the value of (1.9)5
Solution
(2 + x)5
Coefficient of expansion are 1, 5, 10, 10 5, 1
(2 + x)5 = 25 + (5) 24x + (10)23x2 + (10)22x3 + (5)2x4 + x5
(2 + x)5 = 32 + 80x + 80x2 + 40x3 + 10x4 + x5
2. a. Find the first four terms of the binomial expansion of (1 – 2x)6 in ascending powers of x.
b. Using the expansion in a. calculate to four decimal place the value of (0.98)6
Solution
(1 – 2x)6 = (1 + (– 2x))6
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(0.98)6 = (1 + ( - 0.02 ))6
Let (1 + ( - 0.02 ))6 = (1 + (– 2x))6
- 0.02 = - 2x
x = 0.01
3. Expand (x + 2y)5 by the binomial theorem and apply your results to evaluate (1.02)5, correct to
four decimal places.
Solution
(x + 2y)5
= ( )(x)5(2y)0 + ( )(x)4(2y)1 + ( )(x)3(2y)2 + ( )(x)2(2y)3 + ( )(x)1(2y)4 + ( )(x)0(2y)5
= (1)(x)5 + (5)x4(2y)1+ (10) x34y2+ (10)x28y3+ (5)x116y4+ (1)32y5
= x5 + 10x4y+ 40x3y2+ 80x2y3+ 30xy4+ 32y5
Now, (1.02)5 = (1 + 0.02)5 = (x + 2y)5
⇒x = 1 and 2y = 0.02,
x = 1 and y = = 0.01 substitute in x5 + 10x4y + 40x3y2+ 80x2y3 + 30xy4 + 32y5
4. Write down the expansion of (1 + x)4. Taking the first three terms of the expansion, put x = 0.1,
and find the value of (1.025)4 correct to three places of decimals.
Solution
(1 + x)4
Using Pascal‟s triangle, the respective coefficients are 1, 4, 6, 4, 1
(1 + x)4 =14 ( x)0 + (4) ( x)1 + (6) ( x)2 + (4)( x)3 + ( x)4
= 1 + x + x2 + x3 + x4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
When x = 0.1, substitute in 1 + x + x2 (the first three term of the expansion)
(1 + (0.1))4 = (1 + 0.025)4
= 1 + (0.1) + (0.1)2
= 1 + 0.1 + 0.00375
= 1.10375
(1 + 0.025)4 1.104 (three decimals places)
Exercises 7.9
1. Write down the expansion of (2 + x)5 in ascending powers of x. Taking the first three terms of the
expansion, put x = 0.001, and find the value of (2.001)5
2. Expand (2 – x)6 in ascending powers of x. Taking x = 0.002, and using the first three terms of the
expansion, find the value of (1.025)4, correct to three places of decimals.
Type 3
Worked Examples
1. By expressing (1 + x – 2x2)3 as a power of a binomial, obtain its full expansion.
Solution
(1 + x – 2x2)8 = [1 + (x – 2x2)]8
= 1 + 8 (x – 2x2) + (x – 2x2)2 + (x – 2x2)3 + …
= 1 + 8 (x – 2x2) + 28 (x2 – 4x3 + 4x4) + 56 (x3 + other terms)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 1+ 8x – 16x2 + 28x2 – 112x3 + 56x3 + terms in x4
= 1 + 8x + 12x2 – 56x3 (as far as the term in x3)
Exercises 7.10
A. Using binomial theorem, expand the following:
1. (1 + x + 2x2)4 2. (1 – x – x2)3 3. (2 – x + x3)3 4. (1 + x – x3)4
5. . / 6. (3 – x + 2x2)5 7. (1 + 2x + x2)4 8. (1 – x + x2)5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
6n – 6 = 5n 3. The first three terms of the expansion of
n=6 (1 + ax)n are 1 + 28x + 336x2. Find the value of
From eqn (1), a = = = n and the value of a.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the coefficient of x2 is k. Find the value of n, Method 1
n > 2. General term: Ur + 1 = ( )(a2)n – r( )
There are 8 terms in the expansion. Thus,
Selecting a Particular Term U6 = Ur + 1⇒ r = 5
In some problems, only particular term is
U6 = ( )(a2)7 – 5( )
required. For example, the middle term, the
fifth term or the term independent of x (no x U6 = ( )(a2)2 ( )
term or power of x is zero).
U6 = (21) (-32) (a4) b5
Method 1 U6 = - 672a4b5
In these cases, we use the “general term”.
The general term in the binomial expansion of Method 2
(a + b)n is: Ur + 1 = ( ) k = 6 and n = 7
Substitute in:
( )( )
an – k + 1 bk - 1
(Sum of powers = n – r + r = m × n
= ( ) ( )6 – 1
( )( )
Ur + 1 = ( )
=( ( ) ( )5
)( )
(Same) = 21a4(-32b5)
+ = - 672a4b5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
U6 = 8064x5y5
= (-1)(84)(26) (x0)
= -5371
3. Find, and simplify the third term in the
expansion of . / 5. i. Write down the general term in the
binomial expansion of (2x + 5y2)n
ii. if k is a constant and kx3y4 is a term in the
Solution
binomial expansion of (2x + 5y2)n find the
. / values of n and k
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x= 1. If k is a constant and kxy6 is a term in the
expansion of (2x+ 3y2)n, find the values of n
and k.
2. When . / is expanded in ascending
powers of x, find: 2. If h is a constant and hx4y6 is a term in the
i. the coefficient of x4, when y = 1 expansion of (3x – 4y2)n, find the values of n
ii. the sum of the first three terms when and h.
x = 0.1, y = 0.02
3. i. Write down the binomial expansion of
C. Find the middle term : (1 + 2x)n in ascending powers of x as far as the
1. (1 + 2x)10 2. (a + 2b)8 term containing x3.
3. (p – 2q)10 4. (a – 3b)6 ii. Given that the coefficient of x3 is twice the
coefficient of x2 and that both are positive, find
5. . / 6. . /
the value of n.
7. . / 8.. /
4. Write down the first three terms of the
binomial expansion, in ascending powers of x,
D. Find the term independent of x in the
of (1+ ax)n where a ≠ 0 and n N.
binomial expansion of each:
Worked Examples
1. Evaluate the sum of the coefficients in the expansion of (x + 3)8
Solution
(x + 3)8= ( )x8+ ( )x7(3) + ( )x6(3)2 +…+ ( )(3)8
Let x = 1 on both sides
(x + 3)8= ( ) + ( )(3) + ( )(3)2 +…+ ( )(3)8
= 48
Thus, the sum of the coefficients is 48 = 65,536
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Evaluate ( ) + ( ) + ( ) +…+ ( ) + ( )
Solution
( ) + ( ) + ( )+…+ ( ) + ( ) = 212 = 4,096
Exercises 7.13
A. Evaluate the sum of the coefficients in the expansions of the following:
1. (x + 2)7 2. (x + y)12 3. (3x + 1)12
2. ( ) + ( ) + ( ) +…+ ( ) + ( ) = 216
3. ( ) + ( ) + ( ) +…+ ( ) = ( ) + ( ) +…+ ( )
( ) etc. In this case, the expansion is said to be infinite because it does not terminate. The
factorial method is applicable in this type of expansion. That is;
It is always advisable to express the binomial in the form ( ) , where n is a rational number.
That is: ( ) = an . / , where a > 1. However, expansion is still possible without this
form.
Worked Examples
Type 1 (Negative exponents)
1. Use binomial theorem to expand ( ) in ascending powers of x, up to and including the
term in x3.
Solution
( ) ( )( )
(1 + x)n = 1 + nx + x2 + x3 + …
( ) ( )( )
( ) = 1 + (-3)x + x2 + x3 + …
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) = 1 – 3x + 6x2 – 10x3 + …
Solution
( ) =, ( )-
. /. / . /. /. /
= 1 + (- 6x) + (- 6x)2 + (- 6x)3
= 1 – 3x – x2 – x3
Solution
( )
Now,
4 + 3x = 4 . /
( ) = 0 . /1
= . /
= . /
= 2 3
= – x +…
Worked Examples
State the values of x for which the following series expansion converge.
1. ( ) 2. ( ) 3.
√
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. ( ) = . / , which converges for -1 < < 1. Multiplying through by 2, the
series converges for -2 < x < 2
2. ( ) converges for -1 < 4x < 1. Dividing through by 4, the series converges for
<x<
4. Expand (2 − x)−3 as far as the term in x3 stating the values of x for which the series is valid.
Solution
We first convert the expression (2 − x)−3 to one in which the leading term in the bracket is 1. That
is,
(2 − x)−3 = 0 . /1 = 0 . /1
= 0 1
The expansion is valid for −1 < < 1. That is −2 < x < 2.
Worked Examples
1. Obtain the first four terms of the expansion of ( )
in ascending powers of x.
Solution
Method 1
( )
=( ) = . /
= . /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )( ) ( )( )( ) ( )( )( )( )
= [ . / . / . / ]
( ) ( )( ) ( )( )( )
= [ . / . / . / ]
= 0 1
= + x– x2 + x3
( )
= + x– x2 + x3
Method 2
( )
=( )
( )( ) ( )( )( )
= 2-3 + (-3)(2)-3 – 1(x) + (2-3 – 2)(-x)2 + (2-3 – 3)(-x)3
( )( ) ( )( )( )
= + (-3)(2)-4(x) + (2)-5 (-x)2 + (2)6 (-x)3
= + x– x2 + x3
( )
= + x– x2 + x3
Solution
( )
=( )
( ) = . /
( )( ) ( )( )) )
( . /* = [ ( ). / . / . / ]
= 0 1
= + + +
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
( )(
= (3 – 2x) ( ) ( )
)
= (3 – 2x) ( ) 0 . /1
= (3 – 2x) ( ) . /
= (3 – 2x) ( ) . /
= (3 – 2x) ( ). /
= (3 – 2x) . /. /
= – x+ x2 – x3…
Type 3
Solution
√ =( )( )
. /. / . /. /. /
( ) = 1 + (-x) + (-x)2 + (-x)3 + …
= 1 – x – x2 – x3 + …
Type 4
Express the number as a rational or negative exponent and write it as a product of 10 . Simplify
where possible, and expand the binomial using the factorial method.
Solution
Using 1.02 = 1 + 0.02,
√ =( )
. / . /. /
( ) = 1 + (0.02) + (0.02)2 + (0.02)3 + …..
= 1 + 0.01 − (0.0004) + (0.000008) - …..
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 1 + 0.01 − 0.00005 + 0.0000005 − . . .
1.010001 − 0.000050
= 1.009951
Hence √ = 1.00995
Solution
=( )
= 1 + 2(0.005) + 3(0.005)2 + 4 (0.005)3 + …
= 1 + 0.01 + 0.000075 + …
1.010075
= 1.01 (3 s.f)
Solution
√ 8 = ( 8) = ( 8 )
= ( 8) ×( )
= 0( 8) 1 ( )
= ( ) ( )
. /. / . /. /. /
But ( ) = 1 + . /( ) + ( ) + ( )
=1+ +. / +
= 1.1215
( ) ( ) = ( ) (1.1215)
= (1.25992) (2.15443) (1.1215)
= 3.0442
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
√ =( )
=. /
= . /
. /. / . /. /. /
= 24 . /. / . / . / 5
=2+ – +…
= 2. 0125 – 0.000004… + …
= 2.012 (4 s.f)
Type 5
Worked Examples
1. i. Find the first four terms of the expansion ( ) in ascending powers of x.
ii . use the expansion, to determine the value of √8 to five decimal places.
Solution
. /. / . /. /. /
( ) = 1 + . / (3x) + ( ) + ( )
( ) 2
=1+x+ x + x3
= 1 + x – x2 + x3
=8 . /
=8 ( )
But ( ) =( )
3x = 0.03
x = 0.01
Put x = 0.01 in 8 ( )
8 ( ) =8 . – /
=2. ( )– ( ) ( ) /
=2( ( )– )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 2 (1.009601)
= 2.019202
= 2.01920 (5 decimal places)
2. Write down the expansion of ( ) up to and including the term in x3. By setting x = , use
this expansion to find ans approximation to √ to eight places of decimals.
Solution
. /. / . /. /. /
( ) =1+ ( )+ ( ) + ( ) +…
= 1 – x – x2 – x3 ……..
Setting x = ,
( . /* = ( )
= 1– – . / – . / ……..
Now, 0.98 = =
√ = 0.9899495
7√ = 10 0.9899495
√ =
√ = 1.41421357 (8d.p.)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. correct to four decimal places. D. Use binomial theorem to obtain the find
√ four terms of the expansion of the
4. ( ) correct to four decimal places. expressions:
( )
B. Expand the following as far as the term in x3, 1. 2. 3.
stating the values of x for which the expansions ( ( )
are valid: 4. ( 5. √ ( 6. √ (
) ) )
(a) (3 + x)−1 (b) ( ) ⁄ (c) (2 + x)− 4.
Challenge Problem
C. 1. i. Expand ( ) in ascending powers 1. Obtain the expansion in ascending powers of
of x as far as the term in x2 and hence find the x, up to the term in x3, of for | | < . By
( )
approximation for √ 8
putting x = 0.004, deduce an appropriate value
ii. Deduce that √ = 3.464
of , giving your answer to three decimal
√
2. Determine the series expansion of ( places.
) up to and including the term in x3. By
setting x = , determine without calculator, the 2. Write down the binomial series for √ up
approximate value of √ , giving your answer to and including the term in x4.
to 7 decimal places.
Solution
. /. / . /. / . /
( ) = 1 + . / (kx) + ( ) + ( )
= 1 + kx + ( ) +. /( )
= 1 + kx + ( ) ( ) – ( ) ( )
Now,
A + Bx + x2 + Cx3 comparaed to 1 + kx + ( ) ( ) – ( ) ( )
A = 1…………………....(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Bx = kx
B = k………………….(2)
= ………….…..(3)
2
3k = 27
k2 = 9
k=3
C= …………..(4)
Solution
( )( ) ( )( )( )
( ) = 1 + n (- x) + (- x)2 + (- x)3
( ) ( )
= 1 – nx + (- x)2 + (- x)3
( ) )
= 1 – nx + (- x)2 + (- x)3
( ) )
Comparing 1 – nx + (- x)2 + (- x)3 to 1 – 6x + ax2 + bx3
nx = 6x
n=6
ax2 = . /
a= = = = 15
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
)
(-x)3 = bx3
( ) ( )
b= = 0 1 = -20
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
> Is greater than
Is greater than or equal Intervals
to The following nine types of subsets of R are
called intervals.
1. [a, b] = {x R : a ≤ x ≤ b}
In algebra, the size (greater or lesser) of a 2. (a, b) = {x R : a < x < b}
number is determined only by its position on 3. [a, b) = {x R : a ≤ x < b}
the number line. Thus, the following 4. (a, b] = {x R : a < x ≤ b}
conclusions can be made: 5. [a, ) = {x R : a ≤ x}
1. For two numbers a and b, we say that a is 6. (a, ) = {x R : a < x }
less than b if and only if a is to the left of b on 7. (- , b] = {x R : x ≤ b}
the number line. For example, to compare -3 8. (- , b) = {x R : x < b}
and -7 , locate each point on the number line as 9. (- , ) = R
shown below:
Meaning of - and
Intuitively, you may imagine that that is a point
-7 -3 0 , denoted by very far away on the right and
Because -7 is to the left of -3 on the number (- in the left). So (a, ) is the set whose
line we say that -7 is less than -3, symbolically elements are the points between a and , that is
written as -7 < -3. real numbers greater than a.
x >k (k, )
(
k
[
x k [k, ) k
x <k [- , k) )
k
x k (- , k] ]
k
x
Note: Write the solution 3 set to each inequality in
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A parenthesis is always used on the infinite end x
of the interval because is not a number that Solution 2
might or might not be in the interval. The solution set to the inequality x > - 5 is
+
{x : x > -5}. The solution set is the set of all
1. Interval in the form (a, b), [a, b], (a, b] and numbers to the right of -5 on the number line.
4
[a, b) are called bounded intervals and those in The set is expressed in the interval notation as
x
the form (- , b), (- , b], (a, ), [a, ) and (- (-5, )
–
, ) are called unbounded intervals. ( 3
-7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4
2. Interval in the form (a, b), (- , b), (a, ) and
(- , ) are called open intervals. For each of 2. The solution set to the inequality x 2 is {x :
such intervals the end point(s), if there is any x 2}. The solution set includes 2 and all real
does not belong to the interval. numbers to the left of 2 on the number line. The
set is expressed in the interval notation as (- ,
3. Interval in the form [a, b], (- , b], [a, ) and 2]
(- , ) are called closed intervals. For each of
such intervals the end point(s), if there is any ]
belongs to the interval. -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4
4. Interval in the form [a, b], are called closed Exercises 8.1 x
and bounded intervals. Write the solution set in interval notation
and graph it. y
Worked Examples 1. x 1 2. x -7 3. -5 > x
4. 3 5. x >20 6. x 4.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 203
Solving Linear Inequalities state the solution set.
A linear inequality in one variable x, is any
inequality of the form ax + b < 0, where a and b Solution
are real numbers, with a 0. In place of < we 2x – 7 < -1 (Original equation)
may also use , > or . 2x < 6 (Add 7 to both sides)
x < 3 (Divide both sided by 2)
Properties of Inequality The solution set is {x : x < 3}, expressed in
1. Property of Addition interval notation as ( - , 3)
If the same number is added to both sides of an
inequality, the solution set to the inequality is )
-3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4
unchanged. The result is an equivalent
inequality. 2. Solve the inequality 5 – 3x < 11. Graph and
state the solution set.
2. Property of Multiplication
If both sided of an inequality are Solution
multiplied by the same positive number, 5 – 3x < 11(Original equation)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the solution set to the inequality is -3x < 6 (Subtract 5from both sides)
unchanged. x > -2 (Divide both sided by-3, and sign reverses)
If both sided of an inequality are The solution set is {x : x > -2}, expressed in
multiplied by the same negative interval notation as ( -2, )
number, and the inequality symbol
reversed, the solution set to the
-3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4
inequality is unchanged.
Worked Examples ]
-2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5
1. Solve the inequality 2x – 7 < -1. Graph and
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Draw a solid line and shade below it as shown
[ below: y
-7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2
6
Exercises 8.2 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a. (4, 1) b. (3, 0) c. (3, -2) coordinate systems that satisfy the inequality.
1
Solution x
0
1. In 2x – 3y < 6, solve for y -2 -1- 1 2 3 4
0
-1
-3y < 6 – 2x 3x
-3y < -2x + 6 3
-3
y> + (divide by -3 and reverse the inequality) –
y> –2 x2
2. In y + 2x 3, solve for y.
Now, in y = – 2; y -2x + 3
Intercept on x – axis,
Now in y = -2x + 3;
When y = 0, 0= –2 Intercept on x – axis;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3(0) = 3. / –3(2) When y = 0, 0 = -2x + 3
2x = 3
0 = 2x – 6
x=
-2x = -6
x = 1.5
x=3 Intercept on x axis is (1.5, 0)
Intercept on x – axis is(3, 0)
Intercept on y – axis;
Intercept on y – axis, When x = 0, y = - 2(0) + 3
When x = 0, y = -2 y=3
Intercept on y – axis is (0, -2) Intercept on y – axis is (0, 3)
x 0 3 x 1.5 0
y -2 0 y 0 3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Now, in y = x
3++1 x In 3x + 5y 30,
3
+ solve for2 y,
– x 0
Intercept on x – axis; 5y 30 – 3x -
3x
4 x
When y = 0, 0–x= +1 5y -3x + 30 23
x
2
3(0) = (3) + (3)1 y + 03 - +
– 4
0 = +3 y +6 -
x
x = -3 42 6
3 is (-3, 0)
Intercept on x axis 0
Now, in y = x + + 6,
2
(0, 6) Solution
First find the intercept on the x – axis as (3, 0)
and the intercept on the y – axis as (0, -2). Draw
the boundary line and select any point on one
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(10, 0) side of the line, say (0, 1), to test the inequality
as follows: y
2(0) – 3(1) < 6
Exercises 8.4
⇒ -3 < 6.
Graph each inequality: 2
Test point
1. y < x + 4 3. y < -2x + 5 1 (0, 1)
2. y < 2x + 2 4. y > - x + 3 x
0
-2 -1 1 2 3 4
0
-1
B. Graph each inequality:
-2
1. y > x – 3 3. y - x+3
-3
2. y < x + 1 4. y - x+2
The Test Point Method Since the statement is true, the whole of that
The test point method can be used to graph an region of the line satisfies the inequality so the
inequality. With this method, it is not region is shaded as the solution set of the
necessary to solve the inequality for y. inequality.
y
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The only point that satisfies both inequalities of
inequality.
the system is (0, 0). This means that every point
II. The region of intersection of all the
in the region containing (0, 0) also satisfies
inequalities is the region that satisfies all the
both inequalities.
inequalities.
For y = x – 2
Method 2
Intercept on x – axis is (2, 0) and
To determine the region which contains the
Intercept on the y – axis is (0, -2)
points that satisfies a system;
I. Draw the boundary line of each inequality to
x 2 0
divide the plane into four arts, using the
y 0 -2
intercept method.
II. Check one point in each of the region to see
For y= - 2x + 3
whether it satisfies both inequalities.
Intercept on x – axis is (1.5, 0) and
III. Shade the satisfactory region to indicate the
Intercept on the y – axis is (0, 3)
solution of the inequality.
x 1.5 0
Worked Examples
y 0 3
1. Graph all ordered pairs that satisfy the
following system of inequalities:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
d , For 2y – x = 2
o
y
m Solving for y;
5
5a 2y = x + 2
4i y= +
)
3n
y= +1
2
1
Intercept on x – axis
0
x When y = 0, 0 = + 1
-2 -1 1 2 3 4 5
-1
6 0
(2) 0 = (2) + (2) 1
-2
0=x+2
-3 x = -2
-4 Intercept on the x – axis is (-2, 0)
-5
Intercept on y – axis
1
Check (2, 1) in y > -3x + 4 and 2y – x > 2
1 > -3(2) + 4 (correct) and 2(1) – (2) > 2 (Incorrect) 0
x
-2 -1 1 2 3 4 5
-1
6 0
y x
The only point that satisfies both inequalities of
-2
the system is (1, 4). Shade all the region
-3
containing the point (1, 4) as shown below.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
-4
-5
-4 Intercept on y – axis
-5 When x = 0, y = 0 + 4
y=4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
y
3. 3x – 5y < 15 and 3x + 2y < 12
5 4. x – 4y < 0 and x + y > 0
4 5. 3x + 2y < 2 and – x – 2y > 4
3
2 6. On a diagram, shade the area where the
following are all true:
1
x + y > 3, x + 2y < 8, x < 0
0 x
- 4 -3 -2 -1 1 2 3 4 5
-1 0 C. Graph each system of inequalities.
1. x > 5 and y>5
-2
2. x < 3 and y>2
-3
3. y < - 1 and x > -3
-4
4. y > -2 and x<1
-5
5. y < 2 and 2x + 3y < 6
6. x > 1 and y – 2x < 3
2
A graph in the coordinate plane is used to x + 2y = 8
1
indicate the points that satisfy all of the
constraints. x
-1 0 1 2 3 (4, 0) 5 6 7 8 0
-1
Worked Examples -2
1. Graph the solution set to the system of -3
inequalities and identify each vertex of the
region:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x 0, y 0, 3x + 2y 12 and x + 2y 8 The vertices of the region are identified as (0,
0), (4, 0) and (0, 4). To find the fourth vertex,
Solution solve 3x + 2y = 12 and x + 2y = 8
Graph the line 3x + 2y = 12 using the intercepts simultaneously:
(0, 6) and (4, 0). The points on or below the 3x + 2y = 12 ………..(1)
line 3x + 2y = 12 satisfy 3x + 2y 12. x + 2y = 8 ……..……(2)
Graph the line x + 2y = 8, using the intercepts eqn (1) – eqn (2)
(0, 4) and (8, 0). The point on or below the line 2x = 4
x + 2y 8 x=2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. x 8, y 6, x + 4y 8, 2x + y > 8 ⇒x + 2y 48……………(2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Small dog 8 6
y = 24 house (x)
The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 24) Large dog 16 3
house (y)
x 48 0
y 0 24 A small dog house requires 8sq feet (ft2) of
y
plywood and a large dog house requires 16ft2 of
44 plywood. Since only 48ft2of plywood is
40 available, we have;
36 8x + 16y 48……………(1)
32
28 A small dog house requires 6 (ft2) of insulation
24 and a large dog house requires 3ft2 of
20 (13, 16 .8) insulation. Since only 18ft2 of insulation is
16 available, we have;
12 6x + 3y 18……………(2)
8
4 Natural constraints
x
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 x 0 …………………..(3)
y 0 …………………..(4)
13g of first kind (x) and 16.8g of second kind (y)
2. Jude is in the business constructing dog Simplify the inequalities to get the following
houses. A small dog house requires 8sq feet constraints:
x + 2y 6……………(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x 6 0 region.
y 0 3 1. x 0, y 0, x + y 5
2. x 0, y 0, 2x + y 4, x + y 3
For the line 2x + y = 6 3. x 0, y 0, 2x + y 3, x + y 2
Intercept on x – axis: 4. x 0, y 0, 3x + 2y 12, 2x + y 7
When y = 0, 2x + 0 = 6 5. x 0, y 0, x + 3y 15, 2x + y 10
x=3
The intercept on the x – axis is (3, 0) Maximum or Minimum Values
Consider the points belonging to the solution
Intercept on y – axis: set of the system of inequalities for which x
When x = 0, 2(0) + y = 6 W and y W. Each member of this set is a
y=6 called a feasible solution of the problem. For
The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 6) example in the diagram below any point in the
shaded region is a feasible solution:
x 3 0
y 0 6 Refer to page . …. example one
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
solutions.
Intercept on y – axis:
To get a solution which is as good as possible, When x = 0, 0 + y = 3
called an optimal solution, the need arises to y=3
find points whose coordinates satisfy the given The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 3)
conditions and which gives a maximum value
of x + y. From the diagram, the values of x + y x 3 0
are investigated at points on, or near the y 0 3
boundary of the polygon formed, especially at
a vertex. The coordinates and the For the line x + 2y = 4
corresponding values of x and y are listed as
follows: Intercept on x – axis:
When y = 0, x + 2(0) = 4
x 0 0 5 10 11 12 15 20 x=4
y 0 24 21 19 18 15 10 0 The intercept on the x – axis is (4, 0)
x+y 0 24 26 29 29 27 25 20
Intercept on y – axis:
Optimal solutions are given by x = 11 and y = When x = 0, 0 + 2y = 4
18 and by x = 10 and y = 19. So the optimal y=2
value of x + y is 29. The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
c. From the table, the points that give the
maximum value of x + y is (3, 0) and (2, 1) A function of the form f(x, y)= Ax + By + C,
where A,B and C are real numbers, is called a
Exercises 8.9 linear function of two variables.
A. 1. Show the solution set of the system of
inequalities; Strategy for Linear programming
x + y 4, 2x + y 6, x 0, y 0 Use the following steps to find the maximum or
b. On the diagram mark with dots the points (3, minimum value of a linear function subject to
0), (2, 1), (1, 2), (2, 2), (0, 3), (1, 3), (0, 4) and linear constraints.
write the value of 2x + y at each point. 1. Graph the region that satisfies all the
c. which points give the maximum value of x + constraints.
y on the solution set , for x, y W? 2. Determine the coordinates of each vertex of
d. Find the maximum value of 2x + y on the the region.
solution set for x, y W? 3. Evaluate the function at each vertex of the
region.
2. Show the solution set of the system of 4. Identify which vertex gives the maximum or
inequalities; the minimum value of the function.
x + y 3, x + 2y 4, x 0, y 0
b. Mark the points (4, 0), (4, 1), (3, 1), (2, 1), Worked Examples
(2, 2), (1, 2), (1, 3) , (0, 3), (0, 4) and write the 1. A small dog house requires 8ft2 of plywood
and write the value of 2x + 3y at each point. and 6ft2 of insulation. A large dog house
c. Deduce the minimum value of 2x + 3y on the requires 16 ft2 of plywood and 3 ft2 of
solution set, for x, y W and the corresponding insulation. Only 48ft2 of ply wood an s18ft of
replacements for x and y. insulation are available. If a small dog house
Solution x 6 0
Let x represent the number of small dog houses y 0 3
and y represent the number of large dog houses.
For the line 2x + y = 6
plywood Insulation Intercept on x – axis:
(ft2) (ft2) When y = 0, 2x + 0 = 6
Small dog house (x) 8 6 x=3
Large dog house (y) 16 3 The intercept on the x – axis is (3, 0)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
plywood. Since only 48ft2 of plywood is y=6
available, we have; The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 6)
8x + 16y 48……………(1)
x 3 0
A small dog house requires 6 (ft2) of insulation y 0 6
and a large dog house requires 3ft2 of
insulation. Since only 18ft2 of insulation is y
available, we have; 6
6x + 3y 18……………(2) 5
x + 2y = 6
4
Simplify the inequalities to get the following (0, 3)
constraints: 2 (2, 2)
x + 2y 6……………(1)
1 2x + y = 6
2x + y 6……………(2)
x 0 ……………… ..(3) x
0 1 2 (3, 0) 4 5 6 0
y 0 …………………(4)
Now, for the line x + 2y = 6 From the graph, the vertices are (0,0), (0, 3), (3,
Intercept on x – axis: 0) and (2, 2)
When y = 0, x + 2(0) = 6 The revenue function is:
x=6 R(x, y) = 15x + 20y
The intercept on the x – axis is (6, 0)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
contains 4g of protein and 3g of carbohydrates. x=6
A dietician wants a meal that contains at least The intercept on the x – axis is (6, 0)
12g of protein and at least 18g of carbohydrate.
If the cost of food A is Gh¢9.00 per serving and Intercept on y – axis:
the cost of food B is Gh¢20.00 per serving, then When x = 0, 0 + 2y = 6
how many serving of each food would y=3
minimize the cost and satisfy the constraints? The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 3)
Solution x 6 0
Let x represent the number of servings of food y 0 3
A and y represent the number of servings of
For the line 2x + y = 6
food B.
Intercept on x – axis:
When y = 0, 2x + 0 = 6
Protein (g) Carbohydrate(g) x=3
Food A (x) 2 6 The intercept on the x – axis is (3, 0)
Food B (y) 4 3
Intercept on y – axis:
Each serving of A contains 2g of protein and When x = 0, 2(0) + y = 6
each serving of B contains 4g of protein. If the y=6
meal is to contain at least 12 of protein, then
2x + 4y 12 ……………(1) The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 6)
From the graph the vertices are (0, 6), (6, 0), The dealer wishes to buy up to 25 cycles for
and (2, 2) stock s:
⇒x + y 25……………..(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The cost of x serving of A and y servings of B
is given by the function, He intends to purchase touring models at
C(x, y) = 9x + 20y Gh¢30.00 each and racing models at Gh¢40.00
each, and has planned an outlay of not more
The cost at each vertex is as follows; than Gh¢840.00
C(0, 6) = 9(0) + 20(6) = Gh¢120 ⇒30x + 40y 840……………(2)
C(6, 0) = 9(6) + 20(0) = Gh¢54
C(2, 2) = 9(2) + 20(2) = Gh¢58 The involving inequalities are:
The minimum cost of Gh¢54 is attained by x + y 25…………….(1)
using 6 servings of A and no servings of B. 3x + 4y 84………….(2)
x 0 ………………….(3)
3. A cycle dealer wishes to buy up to 25 cycles y 0…………………..(4)
for stock. He intends to purchase touring
models at Gh¢30.00 each and racing models at Now, for the line x + y = 25
Gh¢40.00 each, and has planned an outlay of Intercept on x – axis:
not more than Gh¢840.00 When y = 0, x + 0 = 25
a. Suppose he buys x touring models and y x = 25
racing models. Write down four inequalities The intercept on the x – axis is (25, 0)
that must be satisfied by x and y.
b. Show graphically the solution set of the Intercept on y – axis:
system of inequalities, taking replacements for When x = 0, 0 + y = 25
x and y from 0 to 30. y = 25
c. If he expects to make a profit of Gh¢10.00 on The intercept on the y – axis is (0, 25).
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B produced daily, write down two inequalities
x 28 0 in x and y, noting that neither M nor N can work
y 0 21 more that 24 hour a day.
b. b. Assuming that all articles produced are sold,
y if each article A yields a profit of Ghȼ3.00 and
article B yields a profit of Ghȼ5.00, find a
relation giving the daily profit GhȼP;
c. From graphical consideration, find how
45
many of each article should be produced daily
40
35
for maximum profit. Calculate this profit.
30
25 2. An aircraft has seats for not more than 48
x + y = 25
20 passengers. Those willing to pay first – class
15 fares can take 60kg of baggage each, but tourist
10 (16, 9) class passengers are restricted to 20 kg each.
5 3x + 4y = 84 Only 1440kg of baggage can be carried
x together.
5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45
a. If x is the number of first class passengers
and y is the number of tourist passengers, write
c. The function is : down in simplest form, four inequalities
P(x, y) = 10x +12y satisfied by x and y.
From the graph, the vertices are (0,0), (0, 20), b. Illustrate on a squared paper the regions in
(16, 9) and (25,0) which feasible solution of these inequalities can
be found.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
reduce to 2x + y 30 and 2x + 3y 60. tablets containing 2 units of vitamin B1 and 1
b. Show on a Cartesian diagram the solution set unit of vitamin B2 or capsules containing 1 unit
of the above inequalities. of B1 and 3 units of B2.
c. Find replacements for x and y on the solution a. Suppose that the patient uses x tablets and y
set which will maximize x + y, and hence write capsules daily. Write down a system of four
down the number of each kind of cake which inequalities in x and y which must be satisfied.
gives as good a solution as possible. b. Taking a scale of 1 cm to 1 unit on each axis,
show the solution set of this system.
4. Sam and Doris manufacture rocking chairs c. Assuming that a tablet cost Gh¢0.5 and a
and porch swings. Each rocker requires 3 hour capsule Ghȼ1.00, write down the daily cost I
of work from Sam and 2 hours from Doris. terms of x, y and hence find how many of each
Each swing requires 2 hours of work from Sam the patient should take to make the cost as
and 2 hours from Doris. Sam cannot work more small as possible. State the daily cost.
than 48 hours per week, and Doris cannot work
more than 40 hours per week. If a rocker sells 7. Gh¢100 worth of product A needs 30 kg of
for Gh¢160.00 and a swing sells for raw material and 18 hours machine time.
Gh¢100.00, then how many of each should be Product B needs 20 kg of the same raw material
made per week to maximize the revenue? and 24 hours of machine time for Gh¢100
worth. Find, by graphical method, the
5. The parking area in a small car park is maximum value of products that can be made
360m2. The average area for a car is 6m2 and with 720 hours of machine time and 750kg of
for a bus 24m2. Not more than 30 vehicles can raw material. (Let x be the number Gh¢100
be accommodated. worth of A and y, the number of Gh¢100 worth
of B that are required.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
9. A farmer who wishes to grow crop X and Y Hence, find how many sacks of each should be
has kept an area of about 70 hectares of land for taken in order to provide the grestest number of
this purpose. He has 240 man – days of labour meals.
available to work the land, and he spents up to
Gh1800. The requirement of the ccrops are as 11. A contractor hiring earth moving machine
follows: equipment has the choice of two machines.
Type A cost Ghȼ25 per day to hire, needs one
X Y man to operate it, and moves 30 tonnes of earth
Min number of hectares to be sown 10 20 per day. Type B cost Ghȼ10 per day, needs four
Man – days per hectares 2 4 men to operate it and moves 70 tonnes of earth
Cash cost per hectare in Ghȼ 30 20 per day. The contractor can spend up to
Ghȼ500 per day, has a labour force of 64 men
If x and y represent the number of hectares to available, and can use a maximum of 25
be used for the crop X and Y respectively, write machines on the site.
down in their simplest form the inequalities x i. If he hires x machines of type A and y
and y must satisfy. machines of type B, write down three
inequalities, other than x ≥ 0 and y ≥ 0, which
On the graph sheet, using a scale of 2cm to 10 must be satistfied. Show graphically the set of
units on both the x – axis and the y – axis, draw possible values of (x. y)
appropriate straight lines to find the region ii. Write down an expression in terms of x and y
within which the point (x, y) must lie if the for the number of tonnes of earth moved dialy,
inequalities are to be satisfied. Indicate the and hence find the maximum weight of earth
region by thickening its boundaries. the contractor can move in a day.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
need 30 units per day of another ingredients, of minimum cost have been?
which 1 unit occurs in each kilogram of A and 2
units in each kilogram of B. 3. A factory employs unskilled workers who
a. Suppose that xkg of A and y kg of B are earn Ghȼ12.00 a week and skilled workers who
required. Write down three inequalities in earn Ghȼ24.00 a week . The weekly wage bill
addition to x ≥ 0 and y ≥ 0, that must be must not exceed Ghȼ2,160.00. The machine
satisfied by x and y. requires a minimum of 105 operators of whom
b. Illustrate the solution set by inequations by a at least 40 must be skilled. Union regulations
graph . require that the number of skilled workers
c. What is the least mass of A and of B to should be at least half the number of unskilled
provide the necessary diet? workers.
i. If x is the number of unskilled and y is the
3. The composition per tonne (1000kg) of two number of skilled workers, write down the
metal alloys x and y is shown in the following inequalities , other than x ≥ 0 and y ≥ 0 which
table; govern x and y.
ii. Illustrate these results on a diagram, and
Copper Metal A Metal B from your diagram,obtain the range within
kg kg kg which the number of unskilled workers must
Alloy X 500 300 200 lie.
Allow Y 200 300 500
Using the Search Line ax + by = k
Another metal alloy is to be produced as
Consider the shaded region below which shows
cheaply as possible from a mixture of x and y
the solution set of the system of inequalities:
3x + y 9, 2x + y 8, x 0, y 0 for x, y R
x Worked Examples
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Show the solution set of the following system
x + 2y = 0 x + 2y = 2 x + 2y = 4 x + 2y = 7 of inequalities:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x + y 4, x + 3y 6, x 0, y 0 for x, y R
To find the maximum value of the linear form a. on your diagram, draw the set of lines x + 2y
such as x + 2ysubject to the above conditions,
= k, k = 0, 1, 3, 5
consider the set of parallel lines corresponding
to the equation x + 2y = k, given by different b. Deduce the maximum value of x + 2y subject
replacements for k, where k R to the above restriction, and state the
corresponding replacements for x and y.
In the figure, the lines have equations given by (Use scale of 2cm : 1 unit)
k = 0, 2, 4, 7. Notice that the greater the value
of k the further the line is from the origin. Solution
Name the equations as:
Examining the properties of some of these x + y 4…………… (1)
lines: x + 3y 6………… (2)
1. k = 0, gives the line through the origin, x 0 ……………… (3)
x + 2y = 0, which gives minimum value zero of y 0…………………(4)
x + 2y in the region. That is, when x = 0 and y =
0, x + 2y = 0 + 2(0) = 0 For the line x + y = 4
Intercept on x – axis:
2. k = 2, gives the line which cuts off a When y = 0, x + 0 = 4
triangular portion of the feasible region in x=4
which x + 2y is less than or equal to 2. That is, The intercept on the x – axis is (4, 0)
when x = 0 and y = 1, x + 2y = 0 + 2(1) = 2
Intercept on y – axis:
3. To find an optimal value of x + 2y, draw a When x = 0, 0 + y = 4
line parallel to the line x + 2y = 0, through the y=4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
inequalities (x, y R):
x + y 6, 2x + y 3, x 1, x 4, y
x 6 0 ii. Using ruler and set square draw suitable
y 0 2 parallels to the line 4x + y = 0 to show that,
For x + 2y = 0, when x = 0, y=0
subject to the above conditions:
For x + 2y = 1, when x = 0, y = 0.5
ithe minimum value of 4x + y is 5
For x + 2y = 3, when x = 0, y = 1.5
ii. the maximum value of 4x + y is 18.
For x + 2y = 5, when x = 0, y = 2.5
y Quadratic Inequalities
A quadratic inequality is the one that can be
written in the following standard forms:
ax2 + bx + c < 0, ax2 + bx + c 0, ax2 + bx +
4 c > 0, ax2 + bx + c 0
x+y=4
3 To be precise, a quadratic inequality is said to
be in standard form when the inequality is set to
2 zero. For example, 2x2 - 6x + 4 = 0.
(3, 1)
1 Solving Quadratic Inequalities
x + 3y = 6 In general, quadratic inequalities are solved
x
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 40 45
with the following steps:
x + 2y = 5 1. Replace ≥, ≤, < > with = (make it an
x + 2y = 3 equation.
x + 2y = 1
2. Solve the equation to find the roots.
Other methods such as the sign graph of factors 6. Write the solution set and graph it.
and the test point (similar to the generally
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
steps) can also be used. Worked Examples
1. Solve x2 + 2x – 15 < 0, using a sign graph of
Worked Examples factors. Write your answer in interval notation
Using a Sign Graph of Factors and graph it.
This method works if only the quadratic
inequality can be factorized. If not then the test Solution
point method is applicable. x2 + 2x – 15 < 0 (standard form)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
solution set graphically.
4 + 5 = 9 and 4 – 3 = 1
(+, +)
x+5
Solution
x -3 -x2 + 2x + 8 < 0 (original equation)
x2 – 2x – 8 > 0 (standard form)
-5 3
x2 – 2x – 8 = 0 ( Solve by factorization)
2
Product of signs: (x + 2x) – (4x – 8) = 0
Interval one; x ( x + 2) – 4(x + 2) = 0
= (–) (–) = + (x + 2) (x – 4) = 0 (factors)
x = -2 or x = 4 (boundaries)
Interval two; x+2
= (+) (–) = - x -4
When x = 0
(x + 2) and (x – 4)
-2 4
0 + 2 = 2 and 0 – 4 = -4
(+, –)
3. Solve using a sign graph of factors. Write
Test 5 in the third interval: your answer in interval notation and graph the
When x = 5 solution set 17x + 5 - 6x2.
(x + 2) and (x – 4)
5 + 2 = 7 and 5 – 4 = 1 Solution
(+, +) 17x + 5 - 6x2 (original equation)
6x2 + 17x + 5 0 (standard form)
x+2
x -4
6x2 + 17x + 5 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(solve by factorization)
2
(6x + 2x) + (15x + 5) = 0
-2 4
2x(3x + 1) + 5(3x + 1) = 0
Product of signs: (2x + 5) (3x + 1) = 0
Interval one; (2x + 5) = 0 or (3x + 1) = 0
= (–) (–) = + 2x = -5 or 3x = -1
x= or x =
Interval two;
= (+) (–) = – 2x + 5
3x + 1
Interval three;
= (+) (+) = + , ( , ) ,
For x2 – 2x – 8 > 0, the first and third intervals Test -3 in the first interval:
give positive values. 2(-3) + 5 = -1 and 3(-3) + 1 = -8
( , -2) and (4, ) respectively. (–,–)
Steps
Product of signs: 1. Write the inequality in standard form.
Interval one; 2. Solve the quadratic equation, ax2 + bx + c =
= (–) (–) = + 0, to get the boundary points.
3. Use the boundary points found to mark off
Interval two; test intervals on the number line.
= (+) (–) = – 4. Test a point of each test interval in ax2 + bx
+ c = 0, to see which interval is part of the
Interval three; solution set.
= (+) (+) = + If the quadratic expression is less than
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
or less than or equal to (< or ) 0,
For 6x2 + 17x + 5 0, we are looking for the
then the interest is on values that make
expression to be greater than or equal to 0,
the quadratic expression negative.
which requires a positive sign (or 0).
If the quadratic expression is greater
than or greater than or equal to (> or
The only interval in which the quadratic is
) 0, then the interest is on values that
positive is the first and third intervals:
make the quadratic expression positive.
( , - ] and [- , ) respectively.
Solution set = {x : - x - } 5. Write the solution set and graph it.
Worked Examples
Interval notation: ( , - ] ∪ [- , )
1. Solve using the test point method, write your
answer in interval notation and graph the
Graph:
solution set: 5x2 + 2x 0
] [ Solution
5x2 + 2x 0 (original equation)
5x2 + 2x 0 (standard form)
Alternatively;
5x2 + 2x = 0 (solving the equation)
x(5x + 2) = 0
x = 0 or 5x + 2 = 0
x = 0 or 5x = -2
x = 0 or x = -
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
solution set of x2 – 6x > -2
When x = -1,
= 5(-1)2 + 2(-1)
Solution
=5–2=3
x2 – 6x > -2
x2 – 6x + 2 > 0
Since 3 is positive and we are interested in
values that cause the expression to be less than x2 – 6x + 2 = 0
or equal to (negative or 0), (- , - ], would not a = 1, b = - 6 and c = 2
be part of the solution. √
Substitute in x =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
than 0 (positive), (3 – √ , 3 + √ ) would not be 8. 8(x + 1) – 2 < 5(x – 6) + 7
part of the solution.
B. Solve and graph your answer
Test 6 in the third interval; 1. x2 – 6 > -5x 4. 6x2 – 5x + 1 0
x2 – 6x + 2 = 0 2. – x2 + 4 < 0 5. x2 + 12x + 32 0
= (6)2 – 6(6) + 2 3. x2 – x – 6 < 0 6. x2 + 2x – 15 > 0
=2
C. Solve and represent your answer on a
Since 2 is positive and we are interested in number line
values that cause the expression to be greater 1. x2 + 10 + 21 ≥ 0 4. x2 – 6x + 5 > 0
2. x2 + 4x > 12 5. 22 + 9x – x2 > 0
3. x2 + 2x ≤ 8 6. 15 + 8x + x2 < 0
Exercises 9.1
(y1) A. Find /AB/ to the nearest hundredth
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A(x1, y1)
1. A(2, 5) B(-3, 3) 3. A(0, -11) B(8, 2)
(x1) 2. A(-8, -6) B(1, 9) 4. A(6, - 4) B(0, 4)
(x2)
By Pythagoras theorem: Application to Triangles
/AB/2 = (x2 – x1 )2 + (y2 – y1 )2 Determining the Type of Triangle Using the
/AB/2 = √( – ) ( ) Distance Formula
Given the vertices of a triangle as A, B and C,
the type of triangle is verified by finding the
Worked Examples
magnitude of AB, the magnitude of BC and the
1. What is the distance between the points
magnitude of AC. Thereafter, observe the
(-2, 7) and (5, -3).
following:
I. If the magnitudes of the three sides are equal,
Solution
then ∆ ABC is an equilateral triangle.
A (-2, 7) and B (5, -3).
II. If the magnitudes of two sides are equal,
⇒ x1 = -2, y1 = 7, x2 = 5, y2 = -3
then ∆ABC is an isosceles triangle.
/AB/2 = √( – ) ( ) III. If the magnitudes of the three sides are
unequal, then ∆ ABC is a scalene triangle.
/AB/2 = √( – ( )) ( ) IV. If the magnitudes of the three sides form a
Pythagorean triples, the three points form the
/AB/2 = √ ( ) vertices of a right – angled triangle.
/AB/ √( ) ( )
/QR/ = √( – ) ( – )
/AB/ = √ ( )
/QR/ = √( ) ( )
/AB/ =√
/QR/ = √ ( )
/AB/ = √
/QR/ = √
/AB/ = 5 units
/QR/ = √ units
/AC/ √( – ) ( – ) /PR/ = √(
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
– ) ( – )
/AC/ = √( ) ( ) /PR/ = √( ) ( )
/AC/ = √ ( ) /PR/ = √ ( )
/AC/ = √ /PR/ = √
/AC/ = √ /PR/ = √ units
/AC/ = units | |=| | | | = 6 units
Therefore ∆ PQR is an equilateral triangle
/BC/ = √( – ) ( – )
3. What type of triangle is ∆ UVW with vertices
/BC/ = √( ) ( ) U(-2, 2), V(3, 2) and W(- 4, 5)?
/BC/= √( ) ( )
/BC/ = √ Solution
/BC/ = √ U(-2, 2), V(3, 2) and W(- 4, 5)
/BC/ = units
/UV/ = √( – ) ( – )
Since | | | | = 5, triangle ABC is an /UV/ = √( ) ( )
isosceles triangle. /UV/ = √ ( )
/UV/ = √ units
2. The triangle PQR has vertices at P(-3, 4),
Q(3, 4 ) and R(0, 9). Show that ∆ PQR is no
other triangle than an equilateral. /VW/ = √( – ) ( – )
/VW/ = √( ) ( )
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
To determine whether three given points form The points form the vertices of a right triangle.
the vertices of a right triangle;
I. Find the distance between each pair of points Exercises 9.2
using the magnitude formula. Three points that form the vertices of a
II. If the distances between the points form triangle are given below. Show whether any
Pythagorean triples, the three points form the of them forms a right triangle;
vertices of a right triangle. 1. (5, 2), (0, -3), (4, - 4)
2. (7, 0), (-1, 0), (7, 4)
Worked Examples 3. (- 4, 3), (-7, -1), (3, -2)
Determine whether the points (– 8, 1), (-2, 9) 4. (-3, 2) , (-1, 5), (- 6, 4)
and (10, 0) form the vertices of a right triangle
B. 1. Show that the triangle whose vertices are
Solution (1, 1), (3, 2) and (2, -1) is isosceles.
Name the points as A(-8, 1), B (-2, 9) and C(10, 0)
| | √( – ) ( – ) 2. P, Q and R are the points (5, -3), (-6, 1) and
(1, 8) respectively. Show that P, Q, R is
√( 8) ( )
isosceles and find the coordinate of the mid –
√ 8 point of the base .
√
3. The triangle ABC has vertices at the points
| | √( – ) ( – ) A(1, 5), B(4, -1) and C(-2, -4).
√( ) ( ) i. Show that triangle ABC is right – angled.
√ ( ) ii. Find the area of triangle ABC
√
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 237
4. P, Q and R are the points (5, -3), (-6, 1) and Worked Examples
(1, 8) respectively. Show that the triangle PQR 1. Find the area of the following triangles
is an isosceles triangle and find the mid - point whose vertices are (0, 0), (5, 2) , (3, 4)
of the base.
Solution
5. The three points of a triangle are at A(1,1), (0, 0), (5, 2) and (3, 4)
B(4, 5) and C(5, -2). Find the lengths of the ⇒ x1 = 5, y1 = 2 , x2 = 3 and y2 = 4
side of the triangle and show that it is isosceles.
What else can you say about the triangle? A= | |
A = |( )( ) ( )( )|
6. The three points of a triangle are at A(1, 1),
B(4, 5) and C (1, 6). What type of triangle is ∆ A= | |
ABC? A= | |
A = 7 square units
Area of a Triangle
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Case 1 2. Find the area of the triangle with vertices
The area of a triangle with vertices (0, 0), (x1, (-2, 1), (- 4, 9) and (3, -6)
y1) and (x2, y2) is given by the formula;
A= | | Solution
(-2, 1), (- 4, 9) and (3, -6)
Note: Now, translate the point (-2, 1) to (0, 0)
The modulus symbol, / / , is include to make (-2 + 2, 1 – 1) = (0, 0)
sure your answer is positive. Therefore, if the (- 4 + 2, 9 – 1) = (-2, 8)
formula gives a negative answer, simply ignore (3 + 2, - 6 – 1) = (5, -7)
the negative sign.
New points after translation;
Case 2 (0, 0), (-2, 8) and (5, -7)
If none of the vertices is at the origin, simply ⇒ x1 = -2, y1 = 8 , x2 = 5 and y2 = -7
select one of the vertices and move it to the
point (0, 0) by translation. Then apply the same A= | |
translation to the other two vertices to obtain
A = |( )( ) ( )(8)|
(x1, y1) and (x2, y2)
A= | |
Case 3 A= | |
To find the area of a quadrilateral (4 – sided
figure), divide it into two triangles. The A= | |
diagonal of a parallelogram bisects its area. A = 13 square units
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A= | |
Finding an Unknown Coordinate given the
A= | | = 5 square units
Area of a Triangle
1. Identify the three given points and translate
Area of ∆ABD : one of them to (0, 0) not forgetting the effects
A= | | on the other two points. Here, it is always good
A = |( )( ) ( )( )| to choose one of the known coordinates.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
/5k – 2/ = 8 M= . , /
5k – 2 = 8
5k – 2 = 8 or 5k – 2 = -8 Worked Examples
5k = 10 or 5k = - 6 1. Find the midpoint of the line joining the
k = 2 or k = points A(1, -3) and B(4, 5).
Solution
Exercises 9.4
A(1, -3) and B(4, 5)
1. A(-1, -3), B(4, 1) and C(3, k) are vertices of
⇒ x1 = 1, y1 = -3. x2 = 4, y2 = 5
triangle ABC. If the area of triangle ABC is 12
square units, find the two values of k. Substitute in M = . , /
M=. , /
2. The area of the triangle with vertices (0, 0),
(5t, 3t) and (t, 2t) is 14 square units. Find the M = . , / = (2.5, 1)
two possible values of t R.
2. Find the coordinate of the mid- point of the
3. The area of triangle with vertices P(-k, 1), line segment determine by the pints (-2, 4) and
Q(0, 3) and R(2k, -1) is 4 square units. Find the (6, -12)
two possible values of k.
Solution
4. A(1, 3) , B(-3, 1), C(5, -2), P(-1, 1), Q(9, 7), Let A(-2, 4) , B(6, -12) and M(x, y)
R(1, k), k > 0 are six points. If the area of ⇒ x1 = -2, y1 = 4 x2 = 6, y2 = -12
triangle ABC = area of triangle PQR, find the
Substitute in . , /
value of k.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 240
( ) III. Form two separate equations and solve for
M=. , /
the values of x and y to obtain the coordinates
M=. , / of the unknown end point.
M = (2, - 4)
Worked Examples
1. M(4, 7) is the midpoint of the line joining
Exercises 9.5 A(x, y) and B (6, 11). Find the coordinates of
A. Find the coordinates of the mid-point of the point represented by x and y
the line segment ̅̅̅̅
1. A(3, 0) B(0, 0) 4. A(3, -1) B(-5, -7) Solution
2. A(4, 5) B(7, 9)
M(4, 7), A(x, y ) and B (6, 11)
3. A(-2, 6) B(8, - 4) 5. A(4, 5) B(3, - 4) Midpoint of AB = M
. , / = (4, 7)
B. 1. A diameter of a circle has extreme points
(7, 9) and (-1, 3). What would be the coordinate = 4……………(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
of the center?
= 7…………..(2)
4. Show that the line segment joining the points From eqn (2);
(8, 3) (-2, 7) and the line segment joining (11, y + 11 = 7 × 2
-2), (5, 12) bisect each other. y + 11 = 14
y = 14 – 11 = 3
x = 2 and y = 3
Finding an Unknown Endpoint given the
midpoint and an Endpoint Therefore, the coordinates of A is (2, 3)
I. Identify the given end point, the given
midpoint and the unknown end point 2. M(3, 8) is the midpoint of the line AB. A has
II. Represent the unknown end point by the the coordinate (-2, 3). Find the coordinates of
ordered pair (x, y). B.
II. Add the respective x and y components of
the end points divide each sum by 2 and equate Solution
to the respective x and y component of the Let the coordinates of B be (x, y)
midpoint. . , / = (3, 8)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Coordinates of B = (8, 13)
P=. , /
Exercises 9.6
Method 2
1. In the standard x – y coordinate plane, point The coordinates of P can also be found using
M with coordinates (5, 4) is the mid-point of similar triangles.
AB, and B has coordinates (7, 3). What are the
coordinates of A?
Worked Examples
1. Find the coordinates of the point that divides
2. For a line segment DE, one end point is E(6, the lines segment (- 4, 3) and (6, -12) in the
5) and the midpoint M(4, 2). Find the ratio 3: 2,
coordinates of the other point, D. i. Internally, ii. externally.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(x, y) = (26, - 42)
=
Method 2 ⇒-12 – y = 2(3 +12)
i. Internal division -12 – y = 2(15)
3 -12 – y = 30
2
- y = 30 + 12
- y = 42
(-4, 3) (x, y) (6, -12) y = - 42
(x, y) = (26, - 42)
=
2. A(-1, 3) and B(6, -11) are two points. P is a
⇒3(x – 6) = 2(- 4 – x)
point on ̅̅̅̅ such that /AP/ : /PB/ = 3 : 4. Find
3x – 18 = -8 – 2x
the coordinates of P.
3x + 2x = -8 + 18
5x = 10
Solution 4
x=2 3
=
A(-1, 3) P(x, y) B(6, -11)
⇒3(y + 12) = 2(3 – y)
3y + 36 = 6 – 2y Internal division in the ratio 3 : 4
3y + 2y = -8 + 18 ⇒m = 3 and n = 4
5y = -30
y = -6 P (x, y) = . , /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
coordinates of Q.
P(x, y) = . , /
R(x, y) = (7, -1) 9. i. If the point (6, 3) divides the segment of a
line from P(- 4, 10) and Q(x, y) in the ratio 2 :
Exercises 9.8 5, find the coordinates of (x, y) of Q.
1. Find the coordinates of the point that divides ii. What are the coordinates of the midpoint
the line segment A(-2, 5) and B(1, 3) in the ̅̅̅̅?
ratio 3 : 2,
i. internally, ii. externally. Challenge Problems
1. Find the coordinates of the point that divides
2. A(3, 2) and B(18, 12) are two points. AB is the segment (2h, 3k) to (12h, -17k) in the ratio
produced to C such that /AC/ : /BC/ = 7 : 2. 3 : 2;
Find the coordinates of C. i. internally, ii. externally.
3. A(4, 5) and B(7, -1) are two given points and 2. Copy and completed the following table
the point C divides the line segment AB by dividing line segment AB in the given
externally in the ratio 4 : 3. Find the ratio.
coordinates of C.
A B Ratio I E
4. A point divides internally the line segment 1. (3, 1) (3, -7) 2:1
joining the points (8, 9) and (-7, 4) in the ratio 2. (-5, 3) (10, -7) 3:2
2 : 3. Find the coordinate of the point. 3. (-4, 3) (12, -6) 1:3
4. (1, -2) (-20, 12) 4:3
5. (-3, -7) (9, -17) 5:1
5. If A and B are the points (1, 5) and (-4, 7), 6. (-2, 5) (14, -19) 5:3
4. Find the coordinates of the points which Internal division in the ratio 3 : 1
divides the line segment joining the point (a, b) ⇒ m = 3 and n = 1
and (b, a) externally in the ratio (a – b) : (a + b) P (-1, 8) = .
( ) ( )
,
( ) ( )
/
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Observe the type of division, whether - 4 – 5 = 3x
internally or externally in the ratio m : n. -9 = 3x
3. Note the point of division as P(x, y) x = -3
4. Substitute P (x, y), A(x1, y1), B(x2, y2) and m Solving for y;
and n in : 8 × 4 = 3y – 1
32 = 3y – 1
P (x, y) = . , / when
32 + 1 = 3y
division is internal. 33 = 3y
P (x, y) = . , /, when y = 11
division is external. ⇒B(x, y) = (-3, 11)
5. Form two equations involving the x and y 2. A and B are two points. AB is produced to C
coordinates of the unknown end point. such that /AC/ : /BC/ = 7 : 2. Find the
coordinates of A given that the coordinates of B
6. Solve for the respective values of x and y. and C are (18, 12) and (24, 16) respectively.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x=3 accordingly, as the value of m : n is positive or
negative respectively.
16 = (Solving for y)
5 × 16 = 84 – 2y 2. The same ratio is obtained using the
80 = 84 – 2y conditions of either x or y.
80 – 84 = -2y
- 4 = -2y Worked examples
y=2 1. Find the ratio in which the point (-11, 16)
A(x, y) = A(3, 2) divides the line segment joining the points
(-1, 2) and (4, -5).
Exercises 9.9
1. If the point (0, 4) divides the line segment Solution
joining the points (- 4, 10) and (2, 1) internally Let the points be A(-1, 2) and B(4, -5) and the
in a definite ratio, find the coordinates of the line segment AB is divided in the ratio m : n at
point which divides the segment externally in (-11, 16)
( )
the same ratio. -11 = ,
-11(m + n) = 4m – n
2. The straight line joining the points (2, - 2) -11m – 11n = 4m – n
and (4, 6) is extended each way a distance -11m – 4m = 11n – n
equal to half its own length. Determine the -15m = 10n
coordinates of the terminal point.
= =-
3. Find the coordinates of the point of trisection Therefore, the point (-11, 16) divides the line
of the line segment joining (-2, 3) and (3, -1) segment AB externally in the ratio 3: 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=
Therefore, the axis divides the line segment
Gradient of a Line from Two Points
internally in the ratio 4 : 3
If two points are given as A(x1, y1) and B(x2,
Exercises 9.10 y2), then the gradient of the line AB, is
1. Find the ratio in which the point (1, 2) determine by the formula;
– –
divides the line segment joining the points m= or m = ,
– –
(-3, 8) and (7, -7) where m is the gradient
2. Find the ratio in which the point (5, -20) Worked Examples
divides the line segment joining the points 1. A is the point (4, -2) and B is the point (2, 1).
(4, 7) and (1, -2) Calculate the gradient of the straight line
joining the points A and B.
3. Determine the ratio in which the line 3x + 4y
– 9 = 0 divides the line segment joining the Solution
points A(1, 3) and B(2, 7) A(4, 2) and B (2, 1)
Let x1 = 4, y1 = -2, x2 = 2 and y2 = 1
Challenge Problems Gradient of AB;
1. In what ratio the segment joining the points – ( )
(3, 4) and (2, -3) is divided by the x – axis?. m= = =
–
Also find the ratio in which it is divided by the
y – axis. 2. The gradient of a line passing through the
points P(6, 7) and Q(x, 8) is . Find the value of x
2. The line segment ̅̅̅̅ is produced to Q such .
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 9.11 4x + 2y – 5 = 0 compared to ax + by + c = 0
1. Find x if the line through (-2, 4) and a = 4 and b = 2.
(x, 6) has a slope of . By substitution,
m = – = – = –2
2. Find y if the line through (5, 2) and (-3, y)
has a slope of . Method 2
Make y the subject of the equation
Gradient of a Line given its Equation 4x + 2y – 5 = 0
To find the gradient of a line given its equation: 2y = – 4x + 5
y=
Method 1
y= −
Get y on its own such that the equation will be
of the form, y = mx + c, where the gradient is y = –2x − ,
m or the coefficient of x. The gradient can also The co-efficient of x = −2, ⇒m = −2.
be identified simply as the number in front of x.
y = mx + c 2. Find the gradient of the line7x + 4y + 2 = 0,
and its intercepts on the x – axis and y – axis.
y = (slope)x + (where the line cuts the y – axis)
Solution
Express 7x + 4y + 2 = 0 in the form:
Method 2 y = mx + c by making y the subject,
If the equation of the line is in the form: 4y = – 7x – 2
– axis, c = – Note:
If the line rises from left to right, the gradient is
To find the intercept on the x – axis, substitute positive.
y = 0 in 7x + 4y + 2 = 0 and solve for x.
7x + 4(0) + 2 = 0
Positive gradient
7x + 2 = 0
7x = – 2
x=–
If the line falls from left to right, the gradient is
The intercept on the x – axis is –
negative.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Gradient of a Line from a Linear Graph
Negative gradient
Study the diagram below carefully;
y Summary
x
x1 x2
Worked Examples
1. Using a scale of 2cm to 1 unit on both axes,
To find the gradient of the line AB; plot the points A (0, −2) and B (3, 5) on a graph
I. Choose any two points on the line AB. sheet. Join the points with a ruler to form a
II. Draw a triangle to join the two points as straight line and find the gradient of the line.
4
3
2
5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 4 5x
-1
A(0, -2) - 2
-3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
-4
-5
-6
–
Gradient (AB) = = = . Therefore, m = 1
–
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Equation of a Straight Line
Gradient of line AB = Gradient of line BC The equation of a straight line can be found
Gradient of line AB; when given any of the following:
1. two points on the line.
= =
2. the gradient of the line and a point on the
line.
Gradient of line BC; 3. the gradient of the line and the intercept on
= ( )
= the y – axis.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put m = and x1 = 1, y1 = 5 in
y – y1 = m(x – x1) 6 – 5y = 8
5y = 6 – 8
⇒y – 5 = (x – 1)
5y = -2
4(y – 5) = -3(x – 1)
y=
4y – 20 = -3x + 3
4y + 3x – 20 – 3 = 0
3x + 4y – 23 = 0 C. , / and O( , )
Mid point (M) of OC;
Method 2 ⁄
A(1, 5) and B(-3, 8). M= ( , *= . , /
Let P(x, y) be a point on the line
⇒MAB = MBP
A(0, 2 ) and M . , /
=
A . , / and M . , /
4(y – 8) = -3(x + 3)
4y – 32 = -3x – 9
4y + 3x – 32 + 9 = 0 Gradient of AM;
⁄ ⁄
3x + 4y – 23 = 0 M=
The equation of the line is 3x + 4y – 23 = 0 ⁄ ⁄ ⁄
M= = =
2. Solve the simultaneous equations;
3x – 5y = 8, and x + 2y = 10. C is the point of Equation of AM;
intersection of the straight lines whose At C . , /;
equations these are, and O is the origin. The
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. (3, 4) and (5, 4) 4. (1, 1) and (4, -8) (-1)(5) = -2(3) + 5c
-5 = - 6 + 5c
B. Equation of a line given the gradient and a -5 + 6 = 5c
point on the line. 1 = 5c
Given the gradient and a point on the line, : c= ,
1. Identify the gradient of the line as m and the
point through which it passes as (x1, y1).
Substitute m = - and c = in y = mx + c
2. Substitute the value of m and (x1, y1) in
y – y1 = m(x – x1) . y= x+ ,
3. Simplify y – y1 = m(x – x1) to obtain the
The equation of the line is y = x+ .
equation of the line in the form:
ax + by + c = 0 or y = mx + c.
2. Find the equation of the straight line through
the point P(-1, 3) with a slope 3.
Worked Examples
1. Find the equation of a straight line with Solution
gradient , which passes through the point (3, -1) m = 3, (x, y) = (-1, 3)
Substitute in y = mx + c
Solution ⇒3 = 3 (-1) + c
m= , (x1, y1) = (3 , -1) 3 = -3 + c
Substitute in y – y1 = m(x – x1) 3+3=c
6=c
y – (-1) = (x – 3)
y+1= (x – 3) Substitute m = 3 and c = 6 in y = mx + c
C. The equation of a line given the gradient B. Determine the gradient and y – intercept
and the intercept on the y – axis for each of the staright lines in the table
Given the Gradient and the intercept on the y – below.
axis the equation of the line is found as follows:
1. Identify the gradient as m and the intercept Equation Gradient y - intercept
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
on the y – axis as c(when x = 0) y = 3x + 2
2. Substitute the values of m and c in y = mx + y = 5x – 2
c to obtain the equation of the line. y = -2x + 4
y= x-
Worked Examples 2 y – 10x = 8
Find the equation of a line with gradient , x+y+1=0
y = 2x
which passes cuts the y – axis at the point
y = - 4.
Parallel Lines
Two or more lines are said to be parallel if they
Solution cannot converge at a point.
m = and c = - 4
Substitute in y = mx + c Consider the diagram below:
⇒y = x + (- 4) y
y= x–4
The equation of the line is y = x – 4 θ θ x
Alternatively,
Express y = x – 4 in the form ax + by + c = 0 Line AB is said to be parallel to line CD
⇒ 2y = 5x – 2(4) because they make equal corresponding angles
2y = 5x – 8 with the x – axis. Therefore ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ are
2y – 5x + 8 = 0 said to have equal gradients.
To prove whether or not two lines are parallel, 3. Show that the two lines 3x + 5y – 8 = 0 and
do the following: 5x – 3y – 11 = 0 are perpendicular.
1. Find the slope of each line
2. a. If the slopes are the same, the lines Solution
Let L1 = 3x + 5y – 8 = 0 and L2 = 5x – 3y – 11 = 0
are parallel
b. If the slopes are not the same, the lines
From L1 = 3x + 5y – 8 = 0,
are not parallel
m1 = =
Worked Examples
If A(0,3), B(7,2), P(6, -1) and Q(-1, -2) show From L2 = 5x – 3y – 11 = 0,
whether or not is parallel to m2 = = =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
If L1 is perpendicular to L2, then m1 × m2 = - 1
A(0,3) and B(7,2), P(6, -1) and Q(-1, -2)
Let the gradient of AB be × =-1
–
= = =–
–
Perpendicular Lines
Two lines are said to be perpendicular when the
Let the gradient of PQ be
product of their gradient is – 1.That is if is
– ( )
=
–
= = = perpendicular to , then: × = – 1. In
other words, for any two lines and , if the
Therefore, is not parallel to gradient of one is m, the gradient of the other is
2. Given that Q(1, 4), R(6, 6), S(2, -1) and T(12,
3), show whether or not is parallel to . To prove whether or not two lines and are
perpendicular:
Solution 1. Find the slope of each line.
Q(1, 4), R(6, 6), S(2, -1) and T(12, 3) 2. Multiply both slopes.
Let the gradient of QR be 3. a. If the product in step 2 is -1, the
– lines are perpendicular.
= = =
–
b. If the product is not – 1, the lines
are not perpendicular.
Let the gradient of ST be
Note:
– ( )
= = = = Knowing the slope/gradient of a line, the
–
slope/gradient of a line perpendicular to it is
× = × =
Solution
is not perpendicular to
Let = 3, = , = – 6 and =–
The gradient of the line perpendicular to: Exercises 9.15
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= = A. For each of the following, determine
= = =–1× =–4 whether ̅̅̅̅ and ̅̅̅̅ are parallel,
⁄
perpendicular or neither;
= = = 1. A(2, 3) B(5, 6) P(-1, 4) Q(5, 10)
( )
2. A(1, 2) B(4, 5) P(-4, -1) Q(-10, 5)
= = ( ⁄ )
=–1× =
3. A(-2, 3) B(3, -3) P(4, 2) Q(-2, -3)
4. A(2, -3) B(-3, 3) P(2, 3) Q(4, 2)
2. Given A( – 1, – 1), B (0, 4), P(– 4, 3), Q(6,
5. A(3, 5) B(4, -2) P. , /, Q . , /
1), find whether or not AB is perpendicular to
PQ.
Equation of a parallel Line
Solution The Equation of a Line which Passes through
A( – 1, – 1), B (0, 4) P( – 4, 3), Q(6, 1), the Point ( , ) and Parallel to another
Let the gradient of AB be Line,
– –( ) Two or more lines are said to be parallel if they
= = = =5
– –( ) have the same gradient. That is if the gradient
of a line is m, then the gradient of
Let the gradient of PQ be the line parallel to it is m.
– –
= = = =–
– –( )
The equation of a straight line parallel to
=5×– =–1 another line of gradient m, passing through the
AB is perpendicular to PQ point ( , ) is found by making y the subject
of the formula: y – = m( )
3. Given Q(1, 4), R(6, 6), S(2, -1) and T(12, 3),
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
line perpendicular to it is –
y – 3 = – (x + 1)
7(y – 3) = – 2(x + 1)
The equation of the straight line perpendicular
7y – 21 = – 2x – 2
to another line of gradient m, passing through
7y + 2x – 21 + 2 = 0
the point ( , ) is found by making y the
2x + 7y – 19 = 0
The equation is 2x + 7y – 19 = 0 subject of the formula: y – =– ( )
after substituting the values of m and ( , )
Method 2
Make y the subject of 2x + 7y – 8 = 0 Worked Examples
7y = – 2x + 8
1. Find the equation of the line perpendicular to
y = – x + compared to y = mx + c, the line 5x – 2y – 11 = 0, which passes through
gradient, m = – the point (2,–3).
Solution
The line parallel to 2x + 7y – 8 = 0 has a
In 5x – 2y – 11 = 0
gradient of – and passes through ( – 1 , 3)
m=
That is m = – , , The line perpendicular to the line 5x – 2y – 11 =
0, has a gradient of – and passes through (2,–3)
Substitute in y = mx + c
⇒m = – , ,
3=– (– 1) + c
Substitute in y – = m( )
3 × 7 = – 2 (– 1) + 7c
21 = 2 + 7c y – (– 3) = – (x – 2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5x – 2y – 11 = 0, has a gradient of – and
Method 1
passes through (2,–3) A(– 4, 8) and B(0, – 2)
⇒m = – , x = 2 , y = -3 = – 4, = 8, = 0 and = – 2
Substitute in y = mx + c Perpendicular bisector of AB passes through the
–3 = – (2) + c mid – point of AB
( )
–3 × 5 = – 2 (2) + 5c = . , /=. , / = (–2, 3)
–15 = – 4 + 5c The perpendicular bisector passes through the
– 15 + 4 = 5c point (– 2, 3).
– 11 = 5c Gradient of AB
c=– – –
m= = = =–
– –( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
– –( )
Solution
(5, 10) and (4, 7)
Gradient of the perpendicular bisector of AB =
m= = =3
Substitute m = , x = – 2 and y = 3 in y = mx + c
θ= (3)
3 = (– 2) + c
θ = 720
5 × 3 = 2(–2) + 5c
15 = – 4 + 5c 2. Find the angle between the x – axis and the
15 + 4 = 5c line joining the points (3, -1) and (4, -2).
19 = 5c
c= Solution
(3, -1) and (4, -2)
( )
Put c = and m = in y = mx + c m= = =-1
y= x+ or y = ( *
θ= (-1),
0
Exercises 9.17 θ = - 45 ( Meaning 2nd quadrants)
1. Find the equation of the perpendicular θ = 1800 – 450
bisector of the points (2, 4) and (8, 0) in the θ = 1350
form ax + by = c
Application to Parallelograms
2. Find the equation of the perpendicular Given the vertices of a quadrilateral ABCD, it
bisector of the line segment joining points A(6, can be verified whether quadrilateral ABCD is a
-3) and (-2, 5) .
Gradient of ̅̅̅̅;
A D – ( )
mAD = = = =3
–
Take note of the fact that for all parallelograms
(rectangles, squares.. ) with vertices ABCD; Gradient of ̅̅̅̅;
I. ̅̅̅̅ is parallel to ̅̅̅̅ , meaning the gradient – ( )
mBC = = = =3
of ̅̅̅̅ is equal to that of ̅̅̅̅ and the magnitude – –( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
of ̅̅̅̅ is equal to that of ̅̅̅̅ and the magnitude
of ̅̅̅̅ is equal to the magnitude of ̅̅̅̅ . 2. The vertices of a parallelogram are at
III. The diagonals bisect each other, hence the P(2, 1) , Q(6, 3), R(5, 5), S(x, y).
mid-point of ̅̅̅̅ is equal to the mid-point of i. Find the coordinates of S.
̅̅̅̅ ii. What is the length of the diagonal QS?
Mid-point of QS;
Now, gradient of QR = gradient of PS
Gradient of QR; =. , /
–
mPQ = = =
–
Mid-point of PR;
S(x, y) R(5, 5)
Gradient of PS; =. , /
– =. , /
mRS = =
–
P(2, 10) Q(2, 10)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Now ,
mQR = mPS
. , / =. , /
=
2(x – 2) = -1(y – 1) ⇒ = …………….(1)
2x – 4 = - y + 1 = ………………..(2)
2x + y = 4 + 1
2x + y = 5………………...(2)
From eqn (1);
6+x=7
Solving equations (1) and (2) simultaneously;
x=7–6
x – 2y = -5………………..(1)
x=1
2x + y = 5……………….(2)
From eqn (2);
2 × eqn (1);
y+3 =6
2x – 4y = -10……………(3)
y=6–3
y=3
eqn (3) – eqn (2);
S(x, y) = S(1, 3)
- 5y = - 15
y=3
ii. Q(6, 3) and S(1, 3)
/QS/ = √( ) ( )
Put y = 3 in eqn (1);
x – 2(3) = - 5 /QS/ = √
x – 6 = -5 /QS/ = √
x=-5+6 /QS/ = 5 units
x=1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
respectively. Prove that the diagonals bisect
Therefore, the diagonals ̅̅̅̅ and ̅̅̅̅ bisect
each other and hence, find the area of ABCD.
each other at the point (-1, 0.5)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
From the parallelogram,
=
Solution
i. Q (x, y) R(4, 4)
= and =
=
4–b=1
P(2, 1) S(a, b ) b=4–1
b=3
The equation of PQ;
m = , passing through (2, 1) 4–a=3
y–1= (x – 2) a =4–3
a=1
3(y – 1) = (x – 2)
S(1, 3)
3y – 3 = x – 2
x – 3y – 2 + 3 = 0
Exercises 9.19
x – 3y + 1 = 0
A. Find the points of intersection of the
following pair of straight lines:
ii. the equation of PR;
1. y = 3x + 2 and 2x + 3y = 17
P(2, 1) and R(4, 4)
2. 5x + 3y = 2 and x–y=6
= = 3. y = 5x + 2 and y = 3x – 1
m = , passing through (2, 1)
B. 1. L : 2x – 5y – 9 = 0 and K : 3x – 2y – 8 = 0
y–1= (x – 2)
are two lines. L intersects K at the point q.
2(y – 1) = 3(x – 2) i. Find the coordinates of q.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
| ( ) ( ) ( )|
Perpendicular Distance from a Line d= √
The perpendicular distance, d, from the point | |
d= 3x + 4y -17 = 0
(x, y) to the line ax + by + c = 0 is given by: √
| |
| | d=
d= √
√
d=
ax + by + c = 0 d = 2.4 units
(3, 5)
Exercises 9.20
d
In each case, find the perpendicular distance
(x1, y1) from the point P(x, y) to the line L: ax + by +
The formula can also be written without the c=0
modulus bar. 1. P(1, 3) L: 3x + 4y + 10 = 0
2. P(8, 3) L: 5x – 12y + 9 = 0
Worked Examples 3. P(-1, 3) L: 15x – 8y + 5 = 0
Find the perpendicular distance from the point 4. P(3, 2) L: 24x – 7y – 8 = 0
(-2, 4) to the line 3x + y – 8 = 0
5. Show that the point (2, -1) is equidistant
Solution from the lines with equations 4x + 3y – 20 = 0
Point: (-2, 4) and 12x – 5y + 10 = 0.
Line: 3x + y – 8 = 0
a = 3, b = 1, c = -8 , x1 = -2 and y1 = 4 6. Find the shortes distance from the point (5, -
1) to the line y = 2x – 1
Exercises 9.21
x1, y1 ax + by + c = 0 Find the distance between each pair of
parallel lines, L and K.
To find the distance between two parallel lines,
do the following: 1. L : 5x + 12y – 5 = 0 and K : 5x + 12y + 10 = 0
1. Find one point on one of the lines. 2. L: 3x + 4y -12 = 0 and K: 6x + 8y – 9 = 0
2. Find the distance from this point to the other 3. L : 2x + y + 5 and K : 2x + 5 = 0
line. 4. Show that the point (4, - ) is on the line 3x
+ 4y – 10 = 0, and hence find the distance
Worked Examples between the parallel lines 3x + 4y – 10 = 0 and
Find the distance between the pair of parallel 3x + 4y – 15 = 0
lines L : 4x – 3y + 10 = 0 and K : 4x – 3y + 15 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Slope of Two Lines Which Meet at a Point at
Solution a given distance from a given Point.
L : 4x – 3y + 10 = 0 The slope of any two lines which meet at a
K : 4x – 3y + 15 = 0 Point at a given distance from a given Point is
calculated as follows:
From L, when x = 0; 1. Identify the point through which the line
4(0) – 3y + 10 = 0 passes as (x1, y1).
– 3y + 10 = 0
– 3y = -10 2. Substitute the values of (x1, y1) in y – y1 =
y= m(x – x1) and simplify equating to zero on the
right hand side, to obtain the equation of the
The point (0, ) is a point on L
line.
4x - 3y + 15 = 0
K
3. Identify the given distance d, from the given
point as (x1, y1), differ from (x1, y1), in act 2.
4x -3y + 10= 0
L 4. From the equation of the line, find a, b and c
(0, )
and substitute in:
Now, distance between . , / and the line K : d=
| |
√
4x – 3y + 15 = 0
⇒ a = 4, b = -3, c = 15, x1 = 0 and y1 = Worked Examples
Substitute in Find the slope of the lines through the point
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
c = 3m + 2 and d = 2√ , substitute in : contain the point (4, 1) and are a distance 2√
| | units from (1, 2).
d= √
| ( ) ( ) | 7. Find the equation of the two lines which are
2√ =
√ ( ) perpendicular to the line 2x + 3y – 6 = 0 and
| |
2√ = √ which are a distance √ units from (3, 2)
| |
( √ ) = .√ / (Squaring both sides) Points on the same Side or Opposite sides of
a Line
8= To show whether two given points are on the
8( ) same or opposite sides of a given line,
8m + 8 = 1 – 6m + 9m2
2
1. Substitute the coordinates of the given points
0 = 9m2 – 8m2 – 6m + 1 – 8 into the equation of the line.
0 = m2 – 6m – 7 2. Two possibilities arise:
(m – 7) (m + 1) = 0 i. Same signs, then same side of the line.
m = 7 or m = -1 ii. Opposite signs, then opposite side of a line.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
10x – 20y – 1 = 0 as the origin (0, 0)
θ= (1)
0
θ = 45
Angles between Two Lines
The obtuse angle = 1800 – θ
If two lines L1 and L2 have slopes m1 and m2
= 1800 – 450
respectively, and θ is the angle between them,
= 1350
then:
tan θ = L1 2. L: tx – y – 3 = 0 and K : x – 2y – 1 = 0,
t R, are the equations of two lines. Given that
θ the angle between L and K is 450, find the two
possible values of t.
L2
In practice, the best approach is to find the Solution
acute angle θ by using: Let θ be the angle between the lines
tan θ = | | L: tx – y – 3 = 0 and K : x – 2y – 1 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2t + t = -2 + 1
The three medians of a triangle meet at appoint
3t = -1
called the centroid, g.
t=
g divides each median in the ratio 2: 1
3. Find two possible values of p if the lines A(x1, y1)
px – y – 3 = 0 and 3x + y + 1 = 0 intersects at
450.
Solution
B(x2, y2) C(x3, y3)
From px – y – 3 = 0,` m1 = =p
From 3x + y + 1 = 0, m2 = = -3 Coordinate of g = . , /
( )
tan 450 = | |=| ( )
|
2. Circumcenter o
The circumcenter of a triangle is the point of
1=| |
intersection of the perpendicular bisectors of
⇒ = 1 or = -1 the sides.
A
(Take “+” and “– ” separately)
1=
1 – 3p = p + 3
B C
1– 3 = p + 3p
h Note:
In a right angled triangle, orthocentre is the
B C
point where right angle is formed.
The ortho center can be located outside the In an isosceles triangle, all of centroid,
triangle. orthocentre, incentre and circumcentre lie on
the same line.
The Incenter i Orthocentre, centroid and circumcentre are
The incentre of a triangle is the point of always collinear and centroid divides the
intersection of the angle bisectors of angles of line joining orthocentre and circumcentre in
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the triangle. An incentre is also the centre of the the ratio 2:1.
circle touching all the sides of the triangle.
Worked Examples
Note: Find the coordinates of the centroid of a
Angle bisector divides the opposite sides in triangle with vertices A(5, -2) , B(1, 3) and
the ratio of remaining sides. That is: C(6, 2)
= =
Solution
Incentre divides the angle bisectors in the A(5, -2) , B(1, 3) and C(6, 2)
ratio (b + c) : a, (c + a) : b and (a + b) : c. g=. , /
g=. , /=. , /=( , )
The Ex – center
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Also, in the same experiment, if one is
Similarly, the game of football is a random interested in the occurrence of a number more
experiment because; one cannot predetermine than 4, then the event, E = {5, 6}
the outcome (whether win, draw or lose) with
certainty. Definition of Probability
Let S be the sample space of an experiment and
Outcome of an Experiment E, an event. The probability P(E) of E is given
The results we get from an experiment is called by;
Outcome of the experiment. In tossing a coin ( )
P(E) = ,
( )
for instance, either the front (also called head
Where n(E) and n(S) denote the number of
or back also called tail is bound to show up.
elements in the in the event and the sample
Hence there are only two expectations or
space respectively.
outcomes in the toss of a coin namely, head (H)
and tail (T). Likewise, in the game of football,
Since E is a subset of S, it is true that;
only three outcomes are expected namely;
0 ≤ n(E) ≤ n(S)
win , draw or lose ( ) ( )
⇒ ≤ ≤ (Divide through by n(s))
( ) ( ) ( )
The outcome of an experiment deals with 0 ≤ n(P) ≤ 1
numbers.
The first letter of an event is usually used to
Sample Space of an Experiment represent the probability of that event. For
It is the set of all possible outcomes of an instance, the probability of selecting a girl from
experiment. It is denoted by S; For instance, if a class can be written as P(G), and that of a boy
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
paid. 3. A bag contains 12 mangoes of which 4 are
3. Time of the day for greetings are offered. not ripe. What is the chance of picking at
4. Observing the sex of a baby. random a ripe mango from the bag?
5. Playing the game of football.
6. Taking a penalty kick. Solution
7. Tossing a die? n(S) = 12, n(not ripe) = 4,
n(ripe) = n(S) – n(not ripe) = 12 – 4 = 8
( )
Worked Examples P(ripe) = = =
( )
1. A ludo die is thrown once, what is the
probability of scoring; Exercises 10.2
i. a prime number A. 1. What is the probability of an event which
ii. a composite number is certain to happen?
iii. a perfect square
2. What is the probability of an event which is
Solution impossible?
i. Sample space S = * , , , , , +
n(S) = 6, E = {2, 3, 5}, n(E) = 3 3. Given that the probability that an event will
( ) happen is a(0 ), what is the probability
P(E) = = =
( )
that the event will not happen?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
picking a green ball randomly from the box is .
Thus, in the throwing of a die, he probability of
( )
i. Determine the number of green balls in the
scoring the number 1, P(1) = = box.
( )
Likewise, the probability of scoring the number ii. How many blue balls are in the box?
( )
5, P(5) = =
( ) Solution
i. n(S) = 25, n(E) = ?, P(Green) =
P(1) and P(5), are said to have equally likely But n(E) = P(Green) × n(S).
outcomes because they have the same chance n(E) = 25 = 10
of occurrence or probability which is . Two or There are 10 green balls in the box
more of such events are called equally likely
events and they are said to have equally likely ii. n(Green) + n(Blue) = n(S)
outcomes. But n(G) = 10, n(S) = 25 and n(B) =?
n(B) = n(S) – n(G)
Finding n(E), given P(E), and n(S) n(B) = 25 – 10 = 15
To find the n(E), given P(E) and n(S), make Therefore, there are 15 blue balls in the box
( )
n(E), the subject of the formula, P(E) = to
( ) 5. There are 16 white, 20 blue and a number of
obtain, n(E) = P n(S) where, green identical tennis balls in a box. The
probability of picking a green tennis ball from
n(E) = number of event,
the box is .
n(S) = number of sample space
i. Find the total number of balls in the bag
P (E) = probability of obtaining that event.
– Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
+ =
Let the number of balls be x
= n (R) =
18x = 36 × 25 If forty more balls are added, total number of
ball = x + 40
x= = 50
⇒The total number of balls in the bag is 50 Additional 5 red balls;
n (R) = +5
ii. n(S) = 50, n(B) = 20
( ) of all the balls are red;
P(B) = = =
( )
( )= +5
Some Solved Past Questions
20 × ( ) = 20 × + (20)5
1. The probability of picking a footballer from
a group of 120 sportsmen is How many 4( ) = 5x + 100
sportsmen were not footballers? 4x + 160 = 5x + 100
60 = 5x – 4x
Solution 60 = x
Method 1 Therefore, 60 balls were there originally
Let the number of footballers be n(F) and the
number of sportsmen who were not footballers 3. Three blue balls, five green balls and a
be n( ̅ ) number of red balls are put together in a sack.
n(F) = × 120 = 75 One ball is picked at random from the sack. If
( ̅ ) = 120 – 75 = 45 the probability of picking a blue ball is , find:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
red and some blue. The probability of a ball
( ) drawn at random, being red is . Find:
ii. P(G) = = , but x = 10
( )
i. the number of blue balls in the bag,
P(G) = = ii. the number of red balls that should be added
to the bag to change the probability to .
Exercises 10.3
1. Nissan and Benz cars numbered 48 are 7. A bag contains 12 balls of which x are red.
parked for sale. If the likelihood of Mr. White Write down the probability that a ball chosen at
buying a Nissan car is r te s , random from the bag at random is red. When
i. how many Nissan cars are on the park? 18 more red balls are added to the bag the
ii. find the number of cars that are Benz. probability is increased by . Write down an
equation in x and solve it.
2. A box contains 50 pens. The probability of
picking a blue pen at random from the box is . Complementary Events
i. How many blue pens are in the box? Complementary events are complementary sets
ii. If the rest of the pens are red, how many are for which the sample space, S, serve as the
they in the box? universal set.
3. There are 54 identical balls of white and Consider the table below;
green colors in a bag. The probability of
picking a green ball from the bag at random is Sample Event Complementary
. Find the number of white balls in the bag. Space Space Event Space
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
It follows that;
Challenge Problems
P(E) = 1 – P(E1)……………….(2)
1. All possible two – digit numbers are formed
P(E1) = 1 – P(E)……………….(3)
from the digits 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6. Find the
probability that one of these numbers chosen at
For any two events A and B of the same
random will be divisible;
experiment,
i. by 5 ii.by 6
P (A) + P (B) = 1…… (1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Numbers of greater than 4 = {5, 6}, n(G4) = 2
P(F4) =
( )
= =. / +. /
( )
( ) = + =
P(G4) = =
( )
P(F4) or P(G4) = P(F4) + P(G4) v. P(at least one of them will pass);
⇒P(F4∪G4) = + = = P(S and ̅ ) or P( ̅ and Y) or P(S and Y)
=. /+. /+. /
2. The probability that Serwaa will pass a
= + + =
certain examination is and the probability that
her brother, Yaw will pass the same vi. P(at least one of them will not pass);
examination is . Find the probability that: = P(S and ̅ ) or P( ̅ and Y) or P( ̅ and ̅ )
i. both will pass the examination; =. /+. /+. /
ii. both will not pass the examination;
= + + =
iii. only one will pass the examination ;
iv. exactly one of them will pass the
examination. 3. The probablites that Sam, Ken and Tom will
v. at least one of them will pass; hit a target are , and respectively. If all the
vi. at least one of them will not pass. three men shoot at once, what is the probability
that:
Solution i. all of them hit the target;
i. P (S) = and P(Y) = ii. all of them miss the target;
P( ̅) = and P( ̅ ) = iii. only Tom hits the target;
iv. only Sam and Ken hit the target;
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 276
v. exactly one of them hit the target; = + + + + + + =
vi. at least one of them hit the target;
vii. at least two of them will hit the target;
vii. P(at least two of them hit the target);
viii. the target will be hit once.
P(SK ̅ ) or P(S ̅ T) or P( ̅KT) or P(SKT)
Solution = . / + . / + . / +
i. P (S) = , P(K) = and P(T) = . /
P( ̅) = , P( ̅ ) = and P( ̅ ) = = + + + =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= × × =
4. Three men at a shooting range have
iii. P(only Tom hits the target); probabilities , and of hitting a bull‟s eye
= P( ̅ and ̅ and T)
with gun shot. Each man fires one shot. Find,
= × × =
correct to three decimal places, the probability
that only one man hits the bulls eye..
iv. P(only Sam and K hits the target);
= P(S and K and ̅ )
Solution
= × × =
Let the men be A, B and C respectively;
v. P(exactly one of them hits the target); P(A) = , P(B) = and P(C) =
= P(S ∩ ̅ ∩ ̅ ) or P( ̅ ∩ K∩ ̅ ) or P( ̅∩ ̅ ∩ T) P( ̅) = , P( ̅ ) = and P( ̅ ) =
=. / +. /+. /
= + + = P(only one man hits the bulls eye);
P(A ∩ ̅ ∩ ̅ ) or P( ̅ ∩ B∩ ̅ ) or P( ̅∩ ̅ ∩ C)
vi. P(at least one of them hit the target); =. / +. /+. /
P(S ̅ ̅ ) or P( ̅K ̅ ) or P( ̅ ̅ T) or P(SK ̅ ) or = + + =
P(S ̅ T) or P( ̅KT) or P(SKT
=. /+. /+. /+ Exercises 10.4
1. Romeo has four exercise books on his desk.
. / + . / + . / +
They are for Mathematics, Chemistry, Physics
. / theory and Physics Practicals. Juliet also has
four exercise books on his desk; they are for
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. the sum of the numbers on the two tickets is
4. The probability that a player can get a hit is 8 or more;
. Find the probability that he will get a hit ii. the product of these numbers is 8 or more.
three times in a row.
B. 1. The set A = {x : x is an integer such that 1
≤ x ≤ 200}?
5. The probability that a drug will cure a
a. Find how many elements of A contain the
certain disese is . However, if the drug is used,
digit 1 at least twice.
the probability that it will cause side effect is . b. If an element of A is selected at random,
Find the probability that a patient who uses the write down the probability that it contains the
drug will be cured and will suffer no side digit 1 either once or not at all.
effects.
2. A = {1, 2, 3}, B = {4, 5, 6, 7}; C = {(a, b): a
6. Two chess players, A and B, play a match in
A, b B}
which the players have the first move
P = {8, 9}; Q = {10, 11, 12, 13, 14}; R = {(p,
alternatively in successive games. When A has
q): p P, q Q}. Find :
the first move, the probability that A will win is
i. n(C)
and the probability of a draw is . When B
ii. the probability that a member of C∪R,
has the first move, the probability that B will chosen at random, is a member of C.
win is and the probability of a draw is also .
In a match of only two games, what are the 3. i. µ = {1, 2, 3, …100}, A = {multiples of 5},
probabilities that: B = {multiples of 3} and C = {multiples of
a. B will win when he has the first move and 2}. If a member x, of the universal set is
draw when he has the second move? chosen at random, find the probability that:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. If a fair coin is tossed once (same as two Solution
coins tossed together), the possible outcomes i. S = {HH, HT, TH, TT}, n(S) = 4
are, S = {H, T}, and the number of possible
outcomes, n(S) = 2 ii. a. S = {HH, HT, TH, TT}, n(S) = 4
Let A denote the event of obtaining two heads
H T A = {HH}, n(A) = 1
H HH HT ( )
T TH TT P(A) = =
( )
2. Three fair coins are tossed once. 2. If a fair die is thrown twice or two dice are
a. Write down the set of all possible outcomes thrown together, the sample space, S, is
b. What is the probability of obtaining? obtained in a tabular form shown below:
i. exactly two heads? Die 1
ii. an even number of heads 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 1,1 1,2 1,3 1,4 1,5 1,6
iii. not more than one head?
2 2,1 2,2 2,3 2,4 2,5 2,6
Die 2
3 3,1 3,2 3,3 3,4 3,5 3,6
Solution 4 4,1 4,2 4,3 4,4 4,5 4,6
2. a. The set of possible outcomes,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5 5,1 5,2 5,3 5,4 5,5 5,6
S = {HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT, 6 6,1 6,2 6,3 6,4 6,5 6,6
TTH, TTT},
Number of possible outcomes, n(S) = 36
b. i. Let A represent the event of obtaining
exactly two heads; Note:
1. The pair of numbers through which the
S = {HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT, diagonal drawn from n to n passes sum up ton
TTH, TTT},n(S) = 8, 2. The pair of numbers at the left (up) of a
A = {HHT, HTH, THH}, n(A) = 3 diagonal drawn from n to n are less than n
( )
P(A) = = = 3. The pair of numbers at the right (down) of a
( )
diagonal drawn from n to n are greater or
ii. Let B represent the event of obtaining no more than n
tail;
Worked Examples
S = {HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT,
1. Two fair dice, A and B, each with faces
TTH, TTT}, n(S) = 8,
numbered 1 to 6 are thrown together.
B = {HHT, HTH, THH, TTT}, n(B) = 4
( ) i. Construct a table showing all the equally
P(B) = = =
( ) likely outcomes.
ii. From your table, list the pair of numbers on
iii. Let C represent the event of obtaining not the two dice for which the sum is;
more than one head; a. 5 b. 10
S = {HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT, c. more than 10 d. at least 10
TTH, TTT},n(S) = 8, iii. Find the probability that the two dice show:
C = {HTT, THT, TTH, TTT}, n(C) = 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
From the table, the total number of possible n(E) = 6 and n(S) = 36
outcomes, n(S) = 36 ( )
P(E) = = =
( )
ii. a. The pair of numbers for which the sum is
5 = (1, 4), (2, 3), (3, 2), (4, 1) d. Let F represent the pair of numbers that sum
up to at least 10
= (4, 6), (5, 5), (6, 4), (5, 6), (6, 5) and (6, 6)
b. The pair of numbers for which the sum is 10
n(F) = 6 and n(S) = 36
= (4, 6), (5, 5), (6, 4) ( )
P(F) = = =
( )
c. The pair of numbers for which the sum is
more than 10 = (5, 6), (6, 5) and (6, 6) 2. Two fair dice are thrown at the same time.
d. The pair of numbers for which the sum is at a. Draw the sample space for the possible
least 10 = (4, 6), (5, 5), (6, 4), (5, 6), (6, 5) and outcomes.
(6, 6)
b. Find the probability of obtaining:
iii. a. Let A represent the pair of numbers that i. a total score of 6 or 8,
show different scores ; ii. the same number on the two dice,
n(A) = 30 and n(S) = 36 iii. a total not less than 5.
( )
P(A) = = = 1 2 3 4 5 6
( )
1 1,1 1,2 1,3 1,4 1,5 1,6
2 2,1 2,2 2,3 2,4 2,5 2,6
b. Let B represent the pair of numbers that 3 3,1 3,2 3,3 3,4 3,5 3,6
show the same number; 4 4,1 4,2 4,3 4,4 4,5 4,6
= (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (4, 4), (5, 5) and (6, 6) 5 5,1 5,2 5,3 5,4 5,5 5,6
n(B) = 6 and n(S) = 36 6 6,1 6,2 6,3 6,4 6,5 6,6
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. Two dice are thrown together and the scores
P(same number) = = are added. Copy and complete the following
table of total scores;
iii. a total of not less than 5
n (E) = 30 n(s) = 36 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2
P(not less than 5) = =
2
3 7
3. In the throw of two fair dice, what is 4
the probability of throwing? 5
6 12
i. a pair of even numbers;
ii. a pair of prime numbers; i. What is the probability of scoring exactly 9
iii. a total score that is at most 4. ii. What is the probability of scoring an even
iii. What is the probability of scoring either 7
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 1,1 1,2 1,3 1,4 1,5 1,6 or 11
2 2,1 2,2 2,3 2,4 2,5 2,6
3 3,1 3,2 3,3 3,4 3,5 3,6 Solution
4 4,1 4,2 4,3 4,4 4,5 4,6
5 5,1 5,2 5,3 5,4 5,5 5,6 1 2 3 4 5 6
6 6,1 6,2 6,3 6,4 6,5 6,6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
n(S) = 36
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
A pair of even numbers, E; 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
(2, 2), (2, 4), (2, 6), (4,2), (4, 4), (4, 6), (6, 2), 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
(6, 4), (6, 6)
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 282
n(S) = 36 C. Throwing a Coin and a Die Together
i. Probability of scoring exactly 9 If a coin and a die are thrown together or one
ii. Probability of scoring an even number after the other, the outcomes are obtained as
iii. Probability of scoring either 7 or 11 shown in the table below;
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 1,1 1,2 1,3 1,4 1,5 1,6 Worked Examples
2 2,1 2,2 2,3 2,4 2,5 2,6 1. In a game, a player throws a die and tosses a
3 3,1 3,2 3,3 3,4 3,5 3,6 coin. If the coin lands heads, he scores twice
4 4,1 4,2 4,3 4,4 4,5 4,6 the number on the die. If the coin lands tails,
5 5,1 5,2 5,3 5,4 5,5 5,6
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
he scores three times the number on the die.
6 6,1 6,2 6,3 6,4 6,5 6,6
What is the probability of scoring more than 6?
n(S) = 36
Let A be pair with difference of 2 Solution
A = (1, 3), (2, 4), (3, 5), (4, 6),
(3, 1), (4, 2), (5, 3), (6, 4), Dice
n(A ) = 8 1 2 3 4 5 6
Coin H 2 4 6 8 10 12
P(difference of two) =
T 3 6 9 12 15 18
Let B be pairs with product greater than 8;
B = (2, 5), (2, 6), (3, 3), (3, 4), (3, 5) n(S) = 12,
(3, 6), (4, 3), (4, 4), (4, 5), (4, 6) More than 12 = { 8, 9, 10, 12, 12, 15, 18}
(5, 2), (5, 3), (5, 4), (5, 5), (5, 6) n( More than 12) = 7
(6, 2), (6, 3), (6, 4), (6, 5), (6, 6) P( More than 12) =
n(B) = 20
2. A coin is toss twice and a die is rolled once.
P(product greater than 8) = Find the probability of the following events:
A ∩ B = (3, 5) (4, 6), (5, 3), (6, 4)
a. two heads and a 5;
n(A ∩ B) = 4
P(A∩B) = b. exactly one head and a 1 or 2;
P(A or B) = P(A) + P(B) – P(A∩B) c. at least one head and not a 2.
= + – = =
n(S) = 24 Solution
Two heads and a 5;
E = {HH5}, n(E) = 1 2 3 4
P(two heads and a 5) = 1 (1, 2) (1, 3) (1, 4)
3 (3, 2) (3, 3) (3, 4)
5 (5, 2) (5, 3) (5, 4)
b. exactly one head and a 1 or 2;
E = {HT1, HT2, TH1, TH2}, n(E) = 4 n(S) = 9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
P(exactly one head and a 1 or 2) = = Sum of the two numbers less than 7 and greater
than 3 = (1, 3), (1, 4), (3, 2), (3, 3)
c. at least one head and not a 2; n(E) = 4
( )
E = HH1, HH3, HH4, HH5, HH6, P= =
( )
HT1, HT3, HT4, HT5, HT6,
TH1, TH3, TH4, TH5, TH6, ii.sum of the numbers that is a prime number
N(E) = 15 E = (1, 2), (1, 4), (3, 2), (3, 4), (5, 2), n(E) = 5
P(P) =
P(at least one head and not a 2) = =
2. A two digit numeral (base ten) is formed by
Other Related Experiments choosing both digits at random from the set {6,
In some related instances, two setsof elements 7, 8, 9}. The same digit may be chosen twice.
may be provided for an experiment. For Find the probability that the number is;
example, given A = {1, 2, 3} and B = {t, h, e}, a. even, b. divisible by 4, c. prime.
if A and B occur at the same time, then the set
of possible outcomes or sample space is Solution
represented as shown below: i.
6 7 8 9
1 2 3 6 66 67 68 69
t 1t 2t 3t 7 76 77 78 79
h 1h 2h 3h 8 86 87 88 89
e 1e 2e 3e 9 96 97 98 99
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 10.5 ii. List the members of the set P, a subset of ,
1. The following is an incomplete table of such tha x + y = 8 ⇔ (x, y) P.
possible outcomes when a die is thrown twice iii. What is the probability that a total score of
8 will occur.
1 2 3 4 5 6 iv. List the members of the set R, another
1 1, 1 1, 2 1, 3 subset of , such that x and y are both even ⇔
2
3 (x , y) R.
4
5 B. 1. A two digit number is formed as follows.
6
The tens digit is chosen at random from {3, 4,
i. Copy and complete the table. 5} and the ones digit is chosen at random from
ii. Use your table to find the probability of {0, 1, 2}. Find the probability that the number
throwing: will be:
a. no six, a. even; b. prime. c. divisible by 7;
b. at least one five,
c. two sixes. 2. A two digit numeral in base ten is fromed by
choosing the tens digit from the set {4, 5, 6, 7,
2. Two symmetrical dice are thrown together. 8} and the units digits from the set {1, 2, 3, 9}.
what is the probability that one of the dice will Find the probability that the resulting number
show a a perfect square and the other will sjow is:
a prime number? a. even;
b. greater than 50;
3. Two symmetrical dice are thrown together. c. both even and greater than 50;
What is the probability of throwing : d. either even or greater than 50 (or both)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
P(2 or 5) = P(2) + P(5) – P(2 and 5)
5. Suppose that the probability of a child being
= + –0= =
a boy is . Find the probability that a family od
three children will have; 2. Given that X and Y are mutually exclusive
a. at least two boys; events such that P(X) = 0.5, P(Y) = n and
b. exactly two boys; P(X or Y) = 0.8,
c. all girls. i. find the value of n;
ii. what is the probability of X or Y occurring in
6. A two digit numeral (base ten) is formed by
terms of X and Y?
choosing both digits at random from {6, 7, 8,
9}. However, the same digit may not be chosen Solution
twice. Find the probability that the number P(X or Y) = P(X) + P(Y)
will be: But P(X or Y) = 0.8, P(X) = 0.5, P(Y) = n
a. odd, b. divisible by 6; c. a perfect square By substitution,
P(X or Y) = P(X) + P(Y)
7. A boy tosess a coin and throws a die. If the 0.8 = 0.5 + n
coin lands head, he scores the number shown 0.8 – 0.5 = n
on the die. If the coin lands tails, he scores 0.3 = n
double the die number. What is the probability n = 0.3
that he will score an odd number.
ii. P(X or Y) = P(X) + P(Y)
Mutually Exclusive Events:
Mutually exclusive events are those where the 3. Two mutually exclusive events A and B are
occurrence of one indicates the non-occurrence
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution outcome of the first roll doesn‟t affect the
We need to find out P (B or 6) second outcome. These two are independent
Probability of selecting a black card = events.
Probability of selecting a 6 =
Worked Examples
Probability of selecting both a black card and a 1. A coin is tossed twice. What is the
6= probability of getting two consecutive tails ?
P(B or 6) = P(B) + P(6) – P(B and 6)
= + – = = Solution
Method 1
When a coin is tossed twice, the sample space
Exercises 10.6
S = {(H, H), (H,T), (T, H), (T,T)}.
1. If A and B are mutually exclusive events and
n(S) = 4
P(A) = and P(B) = , find the probability E = (T,T) n(E) = 1
of A or B occurring.
( )
P(T, T) = =
( )
2. In a certain study, pupils were classified as
being underweight or overweight or having
normal weight. The probability that a pupil is Method 2
underweight is 0.3 and the probability that a Probability of getting a tail in first toss
pupil has a normal weight is 0.5 and the P(T) =
probability that a pupil is overweight is 0.2. Probability of getting a tail in second toss
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
P(A ∪ B) = P(A) + P(B) – P(A ∩ B)
P(A ∪ B) = P(A) + P(B) – P(A) × P (B) Worked Example
= + –. / 1. What is the probability of the occurrence of
a number that is odd or less than 5 when a fair
= – = die is rolled.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. P(A) = , P(B) = and P(A ∩ B) =
P( ∩ ) = 0.8 + 0.7 – 0.9
P( ∩ ) = 0.6 ii. P(A) = , P(B) = and P(A∩B) =
3. The pages of a book are numbered from 1 to 3. The probability that Tom will solve a
200. If a page of this book is opened at random, problem is and the probability that Jerry will
what is the probability that its number will be; solve the same problem is . Find the
a. divisible by 20 or 50;
probability that at least one of them will solve
b. divisible by 20 or 49.
it.
Solution
4. Three children leave their village to start a
a. n(S) = 200
new life in either Accra or Kumasi. The
A = {numbers divisible by 20}
B = {numbers divisible by 50} probability that May will go to Kumasi is ,
C = {numbers divisible by 49} that Martha will go to Kumasi is and that
n(A) = 10, n(B) = 4 and n(C) = 4
Mary will go to Accra is . Find the probability
P(A) = , P(B) = and P(C) =
that exactly two of them will end up in Accra.
P(divisible by 20 or 50);
5. The administrators of a program to prepare
P (A ∪ B) = P(A) + P(B) – P(A ∩ B)
people for a senior high school exams have
= + –. / founf that 80% of the students require tutoring
= + – = . in mathematics, 60% need help in English, and
45% need help in both maths and English. Find
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Probability of solving B if A is solved,
start is . Find the probability that: ( )
P(A|B) = = = = 0.42
a. all the three will start; ( )
b. none will start;
c. exactly one will start; 3. When two dice are rolled, find the
d. exactly two will start. probability of getting a greater number on the
first die than the one on the second, given that
Conditional Probability the sum should equal 8.
Conditional probability is calculating the
probability of an event given that another event Solution
has already occured . Let the event of getting a greater number on the
first die be G.
The formula for conditional probability P(A|B), There are 5 ways to get a sum of 8 when two
read as P(A given B) is dice are rolled
P(A|B) = P (A and B) / P(B) = {(2, 6), (3, 5), (4,4), (5, 3), (6, 2)}.
Worked Examples And there are two ways where the number on
1. In a class, 40% of the students study maths the first die is greater than the one on the
and science. 60% of the students study maths. second given that the sum should equal 8,
What is the probability of a student studying G = {(5, 3), (6, 2)}.
science given he/she is already studying maths? Therefore,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
probability of selecting a black marble and then kind) from a lot with replacement.
a white marble is 0.34, and the probability of
selecting a black marble on the first draw is Generally, if a selection is done with
0.47. What is the probability of selecting a replacement;
white marble on the second draw, given that 1. The number of items in the various groups
the first marble drawn was black? does not change.
2. The total number of items in the lot (Sample
Solution space) does not change.
( )
P(White/Black) = ( )
Worked Examples
P (W/B) = = 0.72 1. A pack contains 4 blue, 2 red and 3 green
pens. If a pen is drawn at random from the
Exercises 10.8 pack, replaced and the process repeated 2 more
1. The probability that it is Friday and that a times, What is the probability of drawing 2
student is absent is 0.03. Since there are 5 blue pens and 1 green pen?
school days in a week, the probability that it is
Friday is 0.2. What is the probability that a Solution
student is absent given that today is Friday? n(B) = 4, n (R) = 2 and n (G) = 3
n(S) = 4 + 2 + 3 = 9
2. At Prempeh College, the probability that a
P(First B) =
student takes Twi and Science is 0.087. The
probability that a student takes Twi is 0.68. P(Second B) =
What is the probability that a student takes P(one G) =
Science given that the student is taking Twi?
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 291
P(2 blue pens and 1 green pen); ii. P(same colour);
= × × = = P(B and B)
= × =
2. A bag contains 4 red balls and 6 black balls.
A ball is selected from the bag after which it is 4. A bag contains 5 red and 4 white identical
replaced and a second ball selected and balls and a second bag contains 3 red and 6
replaced. What is the probability that both balls white identical balls. If one ball is selected at
are red? randon from each of the bags, find the
probability that the two balls selected will be of
Solution a. different collours;
n(R) = 4 and n (B) = 6, n(S) = 10 balls b. same colour.
P(both ball are red);
= P(R) × P(R) Solution
= × = = i. Let the first bag be bag A and the second be
bag B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. A box A contains 3 white, and 2 blue balls.
Another box B contains 4 green and 5 blue For bag A;
balls. A ball is picked at random from each n(R) = 5, n(W) = 4, n(S) = 9
box, find the probability that:
i. one is green and the other is white; For bag B;
ii. they are of the same colour. n(R) = 3, n(W) = 6, n(S) = 9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
n(S) = 8 + 12 + 15 = 35
i. P(R) = , P (B) = and P (W) = 4. A box contains n balls of which 3 are red, 4
blue and the rest are white balls which are
b. i. P(white and blue) ; identical except for colour. A ball is selected at
= P(W and B) random from the bag. Its color is noted and
= × = = replaced. A second ball is selected from the
bag. If the probability of selecting 2 blue balls
ii. P(Blue and Red) ; is , find:
= P(B and R) i. the value of n;
= × = ii. the probability that one is red and the other
is white.
Exercises 10.9
1. A bag contains 3 green balls and 6 yellow Selection Without Replacement
balls. A person draws a ball at random from the “Selection without replacement” means
bag, notes its colour and puts it back. This is selecting an item from a lot without putting it
done three times. What is the probability of back from where it was taken.
drawing two green balls and one yellow ball
( in any order) Generally, if a selection is done without
replacement,
2. Two white balls and six red balls were 1. The number of balls or items in the various
placed in a bag. A ball was taken at random groups reduces.
from the bag, its colour was noted and the ball 2. The total number of items in the lot (Sample
was replaced. A second ball was then drawn space) reduces.
Worked Examples
3. A box contains 10 red bulbs and 15 green
1. A box contains 4 choco bars and 4 ice
bulbs of the same type and size. A bulb is
creams. Tom eats 3 of them, by randomly
selected at random and is not replaced, a
choosing. What is the probability of choosing 2
second ball is then selected at random, find the
choco bars and 1 ice cream?
probability that:
i. both bulbs are red,
Solution
ii. both bulbs are green,
n (C) = 4, n(I) = 4, n(S) = 4 + 4 = 8
iii. they are of the same colour;
P( 1 chocobar) = = iv. they are of different colours;
v. the first ball is green and the second is red.
Now, n (C ) = 3 , n (I) = 4 and n(S) = 7
P (2nd chocobar ) = Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. n(R) = 10, n (G) = 15 and n(S) = 25
Now, n (C ) = 2 , n (I) = 4 and n(S) = 6 P (First R) =
P (1 icecream) = =
Now, n(R) = 9, n (G) = 15 and n(S) = 24
P(2 chocobars and 1 ice cream); P (Second R) =
= × × = P(both balls are red);
= P( First R and Second R)
2. A pack contains 4 blue, 2 red and 3 green = × =
pens. If 2 pens are drawn at random from the
pack, not replaced and then another pen is ii. Probability that both balls are green;
drawn. What is the probability of drawing 2 n(R) = 10, n (G) = 15 and n(S) = 25
blue pens and 1 green pen?
P (First G) =
= + = = × =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Now, n(R) = 10, n (G) = 14 and n(S) = 24
P (Second R) = = [P( ) ( )- + [P( ) ( )]
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x2 – x – 110 = 0
Solution (x – 11) (x + 10) = 0
i. For Box A; x = 11 or x = - 10
n(W) = 3, n (B) = 2 and n (S) = 5 x = 11
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
balls. A ball is drawn at random from box P
is the probability that the first was lemon and
and dropped into box Q. A ball is then drawn at
the second was coke?
random from box Q. Find the probability that
the ball drawn from box Q is white.
4. Two chips are selected from a box
Solution containing 6 blue chips, 4 red chips and 3 green
i. For Box P; chips. The first chip selected is not replaced
n(W) = 3, n (G) = 4 and n (S) = 7 before the second is drawn. Find P (red, green).
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. a white ball and a blue ball
branches add up to 1.
ii. blue ball first, then a red ball.
iii. both red or both blue or both white.
V. Determine the probability of the final
outcome by finding the route that leads to the
4. A box contains 6 red, 8 black and x yellow
final outcome. Multiply together the
identical balls. Two balls are picked at random
probabilities from any branch as you go along.
one after the other without replacement. If the
probability of selecting one black and the other
Worked Examples
yellow is , find: 1. A fair coin is tossed twice. List all the
i. the value of x; possible outcomes using a tree diagram.
ii. the probability that both are yellow;
iii. the probability that both are black or both Solution
nd
are yellow or both red. 2 Coin
st
1 Coin H
Probability and Tree Diagrams H T
A tree diagram called probability tree diagram, H
can be used to solve problems involving T
combined or compound events. T
Steps: Possible outcomes = {HH, HT, TH, TT}
I. For each action in the problem, show the
possible outcomes (or events) at the end of a 2. With the aid of a tree diagram, list all the
branch of the tree possible outcomes when a coin is tossed three
II. Each action in the problem is shown by a times
R
B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. One element is drawn at random from each
of the three sets, A = {a, b}, B = {c, d, e}, C =
B
{f, g}. Use tree diagram to list all possible
outcomes B
R
Solution
f The probability that both pens are red;
c g P(R∩R) = P(R) × P(R)
f = =
d g
a f
e ii. The probability that both pens are of the
g
same color;
f
c g P(R∩R) or P(B∩B)
f = P(R) × P(R) + P(B) × P(B)
b d
g =. /+. /
f = + =
e
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B iii. From the tree diagram, find the probability
of selecting one red and one yellow ball.
G
i. Probability that both marbles are red; 4. There are 5 red pens and 3 blue pens in a
P(R∩R) box. A pen is chosen at random from the box.
= × = Use tree diagram to find the probability that:
i. both pens are blue,
ii. both pens are of the same color.
ii. Probability that both marbles are of the same
color;
5. A coin is tossed three times in succession.
P(R∩R) or P(B∩B) or P(G∩G)
Draw the probability tree diagram for the
=. /+. /+. / various outcomes and hence write down the
probability of obtaining ;
= + +
i. two heads only,
= ii. one head only,
iii. no heads.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
are called scalar quantities. It is a vector which can be displaced parallel to
itself and applied at any other point.
Vector Representation
Consider the figures below; Position Vector
A vectoer that represents the position of a point
y Q with reference to a fixed point is called a
position vector.
P Negative Vector
x A vector with the same magnitude as another
A vector with initial point P and a terminal(end vector but opposite directions are called
negative vectors.
point) Q is represented as ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ or ⃖⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗. The
u Q
direction of the vector is indicated by placing Q
an arrow head at Q. P -v
P
A vector with no specific end points is also
represented by boldface letters such as u and v. The Null or Zero Vector
In hand written work, notations such as ⃗ and It is a vector whose magnitude is zero and has
is equally accepted. no direction. It is usually obtained by adding or
subtractinh two or more vectors.
Types of Vectors
In general, vectors may divided in to 3 types Like or Parallel Vectors
1. Proper vectors : Examples displacement, They are two vectors with the same magnitude
force, momentum etc but different directions.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
plane. ⁄
a = ( ), b = ( ) and c = ( *,
⁄
Equal Vectors | | = √( ) =√ =√ units
Vectors that have the same magnitude and
direction are said to be equal. Equal vectors are
| | = √( ) ( ) =√ = 2 units
also said to be equivalent.
u Q | | = √. / . / =√ =√ = 1 unit
Q
P v
P Addition of Vectors
Given that a = . / and b = . /, then
In mathematics, a vector is determined only by
its magnitude and direction, not by its location. a + b =. /
Thus, equivalent vectors are regarded as equal a
so the figures above can be written as u = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ , v a
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Q
a Solution
P
x 1. 5a = 5 ( ) = ( )=( )
O
2. b – a = ( ) – ( ) = ( ) = [( ) ( )] = ( )=4 5=( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(b) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
The Zero Vector
=( )−( )=( )=( ) It is a vector with both components zero. For
example a = ( )
(c) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ − ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ − ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
= ( ) −( ) + ( ) − ( ) Worked Examples
=( )+( )= ( ) Given that a = ( ) and b = ( ), what type of
vector is a + b?
2. The position vectors of three points A, B and
C are 2i + 4j, 3i – 4j and 4i + 6j respectively. Solution
Find; a = ( ) and b = ( ),
a. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ b. / ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ / a+b=( )+( )
a+b=( )
Solution
a + b is a zero vector.
2i + 4 j, 3i – 4j and 4i + 6j
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 2i + 4 j = ( )
The Negative of a Vector
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 3i – 4j = ( )
Given that vector a = . / , then the negative of
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 4i + 6j = ( )
a written as; – a = - . / = . /
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ – ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ The negative of a vector is also called the
inverse or opposite vector.
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) – ( ) = ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
u = ( ) and v = ( )
m = 4u – v Solution
1. (5, 2) = 5i + 2j
m = 4( ) – ( ) = ( ) – ( ) = ( )
2. (4, -3) = 4i + (- 3)j = 4i – 3j
3. (0, - 4) = 0i + (- 4)j = - 4j
m= ( )=( )
- m=–( )= ( ) Exercises 11.2
Express the following in i and j form.
1. (7, 3) 2. (-10, -3) 3. (1, - 1)
ii. | | = √( ) ( ) 4. (0, -5) 5. ( 9, 0) 6. (0, 0)
=√
=√ Linear Combination of i and j Vectors
Below are the rules for addition, subtraction
The i and j Form of Vectors and multiplication by scalar k, given that a =
A unit vector is a vector of magnitude 1. The (x1 i + y1 j) and b = (x2 i + y2 j):
vectors i and j are unit vectors as in the vector c 1. (a + b) = ( x1 i + y1j) + (x2 i + y2 j):
= . , /, since it has a magnitude of 1. = (x1 + x2) i + (y1 + y2) j :
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
direction because they indicate the quadrant in
= 15 i – 8 i + 3j + 14j which the vector falls.
= 7 i + 17j 5. Take measurement from the north pole in the
clockwise direction. The angle turned through
3. Two vectors are given by a = ( ) and to locate the vector gives the direction of the
b = ( ) . Find | | vector.
Worked Examples
Solution
1. If p = 3i + j and q = -5i + j, find the
a = ( ) and b = ( ) .
magnitude and direction of (p + q).
a – 2b = ( ) – 2 ( ) Solution
a – 2b = ( ) – ( ) p = 3i + j and q = -5i + j,
a – 2b = ( ) p + q = 3i + j + -5i + j
p + q = 3i + j - 5i + j
| | = √8 ( ) p + q = 3i – 5i + j + j
| |=√ p + q = -2i + 2 j
| |=√
| | = 10.63 (2 d.p) Magnitude of p + q;
/p + q/ = √( )
Exercises 11.3 /p + q/ = √
1. Given that a = i + 2j and b = 3i – 5j, find the
/p + q/ = √8
following;
/p + q/ = 2.8284 units
i. 4a – 5b ii. /a – b/
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
/v/ = √ ( )
Let v = - 5i + 12j
/v/ = √
/v/ = √( )
/v/ = 10 units
/v/ = √
/v/ = √ v Direction of v;
/v/ = 13 units From the diagram,
θ Direction of v = 900 + θ
From the diagram,
But θ = . /
Direction of v ,
0
= 900 + 900 + 900 + θ θ=0
But θ = . /
Therefore, direction of v;
0
θ = 67 v = 900 + 00
v = 900
Therefore, direction of v ; v = (10 units, 900)
v = 900 + 900 + 900 + 670
v = 3370 Exercises 11.4
v = (13 units, 3370) Find the magnitude and direction of the
following vectors.
3. Find the direction of vector PQ whose initial 1. a = - 4 i + 5j 4. a = - 2 i – 2√ j
point P is at (2, 3) and end point Q is at (5, 8)
2. a = 10 i – 10 j 5. a = 3 i – 3 j
3. a = - 18 j 6. a = - 5i
Solution 4. i – j 8. a = - 12j
P (2, 3) and Q (5, 8)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked Examples (m, n) = . , /
1. The position vectors of the points P, Q, R
and S relative to a fixed point O are p = 2i + 3j, Exercises 11.5
q = 6i + 23j, r = 2i – 7j, s = 7i + 4j. Find the 1. If p = ( ), q = ( ) and r = ( ), find the
scalars m and n such that s = mp + nq + r values of the constants x and y such that
2p = 5xy – 3yr
Solution
s = mp + nq + r 2. If a = 2i + 3j, b = 4i + 7j and c = 8i + 11j ,
7i + 4j = m (2i + 3j) + n (6i + 23j) + (2i – 7j) find:
( ) = m ( ) + n ( ) + ( ), i. m and n such that c = ma + nb, where m
( ) – ( ), = m ( ) + n ( ) and n are scalars.
( )= m( )+n( ) ii. if d = c – 2a
( )= m( )+n( )
3. The vectors p = 2i + 3j, q = 2i + 5j and
( )= ( )+( )
r = ( q- p)
eqn (2) × 2;
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 308
a. m and n, such that r = mp + nq, where m and a = /a/ (cos θ i + sin θ j)
n are scalars.
b. find│g│, if g =3q + r Method 2
Consider the diagram below:
Horizontal and Vertical Components of a
y
Vector a = . /
(x, y)
Method 1
Consider the diagram below: a
y
y θ
(x, y) x x
,
a Let θ be an angle in standard position measured
θ
from the positive y – axis in the clockwise
x direction to the vector;
a = (x, y) = x i + y j
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Let θ be an angle in standard position measured From the diagram, (when the right triangle is
from the positive x – axis in the anticlockwise obtained at the right), we consider θ as the
direction to the vector; acute angle the vector makes with the x – axis
a = (x, y) = x i + y j in the very quadrant that the vector falls.
Hence,
From the diagram,
cos θ = …………………...(1)
cos θ = …………………..(1)
sin θ = ……………………(2)
sin θ = ………………….(2)
But from the diagram; a = / a /
But from the diagram; a = / a / eqn (1) and eqn (2) becomes;
eqn (1) and eqn (2) becomes; cos θ = ………………….(1)
cos θ = ………………….(1)
sin θ = ………………….(2)
sin θ = ………………….(2)
From eqn (1) and eqn (2);
From eqn (1) and eqn (2); x = /a/ cos θ
x = /a/ cos θ y = /a/ sin θ
y = /a/ sin θ
Using these formulas,
Using these formulas, 1. a = (x, y) in the first quadrant;
a = (x, y) a = (/a/ cos θ, /a/ sin θ)
a = (/a/ cos θ, /a/ sin θ) a = (/a/ cos θ i + /a/ sin θ j)
a = (/a/ cos θ i + /a/ sin θ j) a = /a/ (cos θ i + sin θ j)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Method 3 of the position of an object. The magnitude of a
Worked Examples velocity vector gives the speed of an object
1. Express v = (12km, 0630) as a standard basis while the vector direction gives its direction.
vector.
Worked Examples
Solution If the wind is blowing at 12m/h in the direction
Method 1 S500E, express its velocity as a vector v.
v = (12km, 0630)
v = (12 cos 270) i + (12 sin 270) j Solution
v = 10.6921 i + 5.4479 j θ = 900 + 400 = 1300
v 11i + 5j
Using the formula for horizontal and vertical
Method 2 component,
v = (12 sin 630) i + (12 cos 630) j v = (x, y) = (x i + y j)
v = 10.6921 i + 5.4479 j But x = /v/ cos θ
v 11i + 5j x = 12 cos 1300
0
40
2. Find the x and y components of a 25m y = /v/ sin θ 500
displacement at an angle of 2100. Express x and y = 12 sin 1300
y in standard basis form. v
⇒v = (x, y)
Solution v = (x i + y j)
Method 1 v = (12 cos 1300) i + (12 sin 1300) j
Let the vector be a = (25m, 2100) v = -7.7 i + 9.2 j
0
Method 2
40
i. Let v represent the velocity
500
Express v in unit vector form;
v = (70 sin 550) i + (70 cos 550) j
From the diagram, the vector falls in the second v = 57.34i + 40.15j
quadrant. Therefore;
v = (-x , y) = (-xi + yj) 4. The vector ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ has magnitude 5 units and its
inclined at 1500 to the x – axis. Express ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ in
Angle the vector makes with x – axis, the form ai + bj, where a , b R.
θ = 500
Solution
But x = – /v/ cos θ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (5 sin 1500) i + (5 cos 1500) j
x = – 12 cos 500
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 2.5i – 4.3j
y = /v/ sin θ
y = 12 sin 500 600
5
⇒v = (- x, y)
v = (- x i + y j)
v = ( -12 cos 500) i + (12 sin 500) j
The Force Vector
v = ( -12 × 0.6428) i + (12 × 0.76600) j
A force has both magnitude and direction.
v = -7.7 i + 9.2 j
Therefore, a force is a vector quantity. Its unit
is Newtons (N).
5. A ball is thrown with initial velocity of 70
feet per second, at an angle 350 with the
Worked Examples
horizontal. Find the vertical and horizontal
A force of 100 N is acting at a point making an
components of the velocity.
angle of 300 with the horizontal. Determine the
components of this force along X and Y
Solution
directions.
Method 1
i. Let v represent the velocity
Solution
Express v in unit vector form;
Force, F = 100 N
V = 70 ( cos 350) i + 70 (sin 350) j
Angle made by F with horizontal, θ = 30°
V = 57.34i + 40.15j
Let Fx = Component along x-axis
Since the scalars are the horizontal and vertical
Fy = Component along y-axis
components of v, it implies that the horizontal
Fy = F sin θ
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked examples
Fy = 100 sin 30°
1. Given the vector = 12i - 5j, find the unit
Fy = 100 × 0.5
vector of a in component form.
Fy = 50 N.
Solution
Exercise 11.6
= 12i – 5j ,
1. Consider two forces of magnitudes 7N and
= (12, - 5)
8N acting on a particle as shown in the diagram
below; / /=√ ( )
/ /=√
7 / /=√
/ / = 13
8
⃗ ( , )
̂= ⃗
= =. , /
What is the magnitude and direction of the
resultant force? Ans 11N, 2210
2. Given the vector ⃗ = (-2, - 4), find the unit
7 vector of a in component form.
2. Consider two forces 9
of magnitudes 7N and 9 N
Solution
acting on a particle as 600 300
⃗ = (-2, - 4)
shown in the diagram above;
What is the magnitude and direction of the / ⃗ / = √( ) ( )
resultant force? /⃗ / = √
/⃗ / = √
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Given the vector = (x, y), the vector, ̂ in the
The unit vector in the opposite direction is;
opposite direction to vector is calculated as:
̂=– ⃗ = ( , )
=. , /
1. Find the magnitude of the vector as ⃗
/⃗ / = √
Now, multiply ̂ by 6 to obtain a vector of
2. The unit vector ̂ in the opposite direction to magnitude of 6 in the opposite direction of a.
, calculated as; ⇒ 6̂
⃗
̂= = 6̂ = 6 . , /
⃗
̂=. , /
Worked Examples
1. Find the unit vector in the opposite direction 3. Find the unit vector of magnitude 3 in the
to vector given by its components = (-1, 0) opposite direction of A(4, 0) and B(2, 1).
Solution
Solution
= (-1, 0)
A(4, 0) and B(2, 1).
/ / = √( ) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ – ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
/ /=√ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) – ( )
/ /=1
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( )
⃗ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (-2, - 1)
̂=– ⃗
( , )
̂= – /⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ / = √( )
̂= . , /
√ √
= √( ) (– )
̂ =. , /
√ √
=√
= 7.8N
The unit vector with a magnitude of 3 in the
opposite direction implies 3 ̂;
Exercises 11.8
3̂ = . , /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
√ √ Find the unit vector that has;
3 ̂ = 3. , /=. , / i. the same direction as the vector a.
√ √ √ √
ii. opposite direction of the vector a.
1. -8i + 15j 4. a = (0, 6)
Solved Past Question 2. 5i – 3j 5. a = (-2, 3)
Three forces of magnitude 2N, 5N and 3N act 3. a = (2, -5) 6. a = (- 4, 4)
along the vectors i, i – j and i + j respectively. 4. a = (- 4, -2) 8. a = (3, -3)
Calculate, correct to one decimal place, the
magnitude of the resultant force. B. 1. Find the vector of magnitude 6 that has
the opposite direction of a = 4i – 7j
Solution
Let the force 2N along i be ; 2. Find the vector of magnitude 4 that has the
= 2 . / = 2 . / = 2i opposite direction of a = (2, -5)
√
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. a . (b + c) = a . b + a . c
Solution 4. (ka) . b = k(a . b)
i. a = (-5, 3) and b = (2, 6) 5. 0 . a = 0
a . b = (-5, 3) . (2, 6)
cos θ = | || | cos θ =
√ √
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )( ) ( )( )
cos θ = cos θ = 0.0535
√ √
θ= (0.0535)
cos θ =
√ √ θ= (0.0535)
cos θ = θ = 87 0
√
√
cos θ =
Exercises 11.9
√
θ= . / A. Find the dot product of the two vectors
θ = 100.30 and the angle between the two vectors.
1. 4i – j and -3i + 2j
2. Find correct to the nearest whole number, the 2. 6j and - 4i
angle between vectors p and q if p = 2a – b and 3. 8i – 3j, and 2i – 7j
4. 9i and 5i + 4j
q = b + 3a, given that a = i + j and b = 3i – 4j
5. 4i – 7j and - 2i + 3j
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Finding the Constants of a Vector given the 7m2 – 48m = 0
Angle Between two Vectors. m (7m – 48) = 0
1. Given that the angle between p = 4i + 3j and m = 0 and 7m – 48 = 0
q = -2i + mj is . /, find the constant m. m = 0 and 7m = 48
m = 0 and m =
Solution
Let θ be the angle between p and q 2. The cosine of the angle between the vectors
⇒θ= . /, x = 3i – j and y = 2i + mj is
√
. Find the values
cos θ = of m.
cos θ = | || |
………………..(1)
Solution
But p . q = ( 4i + 3j) (-2i + mj)
Let θ be the angle between x and y
p . q = -8i + 3m
√
cos θ =
| |=√ cos θ = | ………………..(1)
|| |
| |=√ But x . y = ( 3i – 3j) (2i + mj)
| |=5 x.y=6–m
| | = √( ) | |=√ ( )
| |=√ | |=√
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Reduce to: a = ( , - 3) and b = (-2, 12)
m2 + 12m – 28 = 0
(m – 2 ) ( m + 14) = 0 . /( ) ( )( )
cos θ =
m = 2 or m = - 14 √ √
cos θ =
Parallel and Orthogonal Vectors √ √
y
cos θ =
A( , )
B( , ) cos θ = - 1
a θ= (-1)
0
θ b θ = 180 ( )
O x
ii. Since a and b are parallel, there is a scalar k
Let θ be the angle between two non-zero such that b = ka
vectors a and b. That is; - 2i + 12j = m. /
1. a and b are parallel if θ = 0 or θ =
= m i - 3mj
2. a and b are perpendicular if θ =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
6. Given that a = 4i + 3j and b = 5i + xj, find
the value of x if a and b are parallel.
Solution
a = 3i + xj and b = xi + 6j
Theorem on Orthogonal Vectors
The vectors a and b are orthogonal a = ( ) and b = ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Method 1
P(-2, 3), θ P(2, 1) , Q(6, 3), R(5, 5), S(x, y).
S(4, 0)
Q(6, 3) R(5, 5)
From the diagram ,
⃗⃗⃗⃗ . ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = / ⃗⃗⃗⃗ /. /⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ / cos θ
But ⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ – ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ P(2, 1) S(x, y)
⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) – ( ) = ( )
If PQRS is a parallelogram, then diagonals
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ – ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ bisect each other;
⇒Mid-point of QS = mid-point of PR
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) – ( ) = ( )
Mid-point of QS;
/ ⃗⃗⃗⃗ / = √( ) =√ =. , /
/⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ / = √
/⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ / = √ Mid-point of PR;
=. , /= . , /
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
cos θ =
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ Now ,
( )( )
cos θ = . , / =. , /
(√ ) (√ )
⇒ = …………….(1)
cos θ =
(√ ) (√ )
= ………………..(2)
θ=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. Q(6, 3) R(5, 5) . /
M θ = 126.8699
θ = 1270 (nearest degree)
P(2, 1) S(1, 3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
̃ is the angle at C and c is the length of the a=c–b
side opposite ̃ b=c–a
C
̃
a Now,
b b × a = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | sin C
̃
B c × a = ⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | sin B
̃ c c × b = ⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | sin A
A
But
Proof of Cosine Rule b × a = (c – a) × a
Consider the figure below. =c×a–a×a
C
=c×a
c × b = c × (c – a)
q
=c×c–a×c
B =-c×c+a×c
̃ p = a×c
A =c×a
Let ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = p and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = q
b×a=c×a=c×b
Then BC = q – p
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ . ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (q – p) (q – p) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | sin C = ⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | sin B = ⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
| | sin A
= q.q. – p.q – q.p + p.p ⇒ = =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
C
c a 5
4
θ α 3
A b C 1 A B
From the diagram; 2
1 2 3 4 5
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
From the diagram, ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ . ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ is
c=a+b
said to be the resultant vector of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ .
ii. c = a + b ⇒⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
c.c = (a + b) (a + b)
c.c = a.a + a.b + b.a + b.b Similarly, if ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ then, ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ is the
c.c = a.a + b.b + 2a.b resultant vector of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ .
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked Examples
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ – ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ 1. P, Q, R and T are points in the Cartesian
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = b – a plane. The coordinates of P and Q are (4, 1) and
(-3, 2) respectively. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ), ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ).
For all free vectors such as ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ , ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ etc, the
Find ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ .
following generalizations can be made:
(i) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ − ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
Solution
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = b – a P(4, 1), Q(-3, 2), ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( )
(ii) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ − ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = r – t
But ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = r – q,
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = q – p
( )=r–( )
( )+( )=r
Worked Examples
Given that a = (3, 6), b = (-7, 2), c = (2, 5) ( )=r
and d = ( ). Find: ( ) =r
(1) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ (2) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ (3) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = t – p, by substitution
(4) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ (5) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
( )=t–( )
Solution ( )+( )=t
(1) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ − ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
( )=t
=( )–( )=( )=( )
( ) =t
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
8. PQRS is quadrilateral with P (2, 2), S (4, 4)
iv. Calculate the length of AB, leaving your
answer in surd form. and R (6, 4). If ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ , find the coordinates
of Q.
3. A and B are the points (–1, 1) and (3, 4)
respectively, Parallelogram Law of Vectors
i. write down the components of the position Consider the parallelogram ABCD below;
vectors a and b . D C
ii. write down the components of the vector
represented by ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ .
iii. calculate the magnitude of b – a
A
B
4. A (4, 7) is the vertex of triangle ABC. /AD/ = /BC/ and /AB/ = /DC/
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ). ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
a. find the co-ordinates of B and C.
b. if M is the midpoint of the line ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ , find ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ . Where the diagonal ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ is the resultant vector.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Since ABCD is a parallelogram,
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (2i – 4 j) + (- 3i – j)
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 2i – 4 j – 3i – j
( )=. / ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 2i – 3i – 4j – j
⇒ -5 = - 4 – x ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = - i – 5j
x=-4+5
x=1
b. Unit vector in the direction of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
-1 = -2 – y = × ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
|⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ |
y = -2 + 1 = × (2i – 4j )
y = -1 √ ( )
= × (2i – 4j)
√
2. ABCD is a parallelogram such that ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 3i √
= × (2i – 4j)
+ j and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 5i – 3j. Find:
√
a. i. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ii. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = × (2i – 4j)
√
b. the unit vector in the direction of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = × (2i – 4j)
ii. A (2, 6) and C (4, 3) The position vectrors of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ are a and
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = c – a b respectivey. Write down the position vectors
=( )–( )=( ) of P and Q in terms of a and b
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked Examples
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
Given A (1, 6) and B(1, 3), find the position
vector of the point which divides AB in the ratio
2:1 ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ – ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ – ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
Solution
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = . /–b
A (1, 6) and B(1, 3), A 2
m:n=2:1 P ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( )–b
a
Let OP = r r 1 ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = a + b
O ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = a + b
r= b B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
: YC = 1 : 3, find y , the positin vector of Y in
b
terms of b and c.
O a A iii. Given that Z is the mid point of AC, show
that X, Y and Z are collinear.
Find in terms of a and b;
a. i. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ii. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ iii. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ iv. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ v. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
5. The position vectors of three points A, B and
b. From (iv) and (v), what can you deduce
C relative to the origin O are p, 3q – p and 9q –
about O, T and C?
5p respectively. Show that the points A, B and
a
C lie on the same straight line, and state the
Challenge Problems ratio AB : BC.
From an origin O, the points A, B and C have
Given that OBCD is a parallelogram and that E
position vectors a, b and 2b respectively. The
is the point such that ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ , find the
points O, A and B are not collinear. The mid =
point of AB is M, and the point of trisection of position vectors of D and E relative to O.
AC nearer to A is T. Darw a diagram to show O,
A, B, C, M, T. Application
Find in terms of a and b, the position vectors M Using Vector Approach to Solve Bearings
and T. Use your resukts to prove that O, M and I. Make a sketch or accurate drawing of the
T are collinear and fins the ratio in which M diagram representing the problem.
divides OT.
2. Apply the triangular law of vectors which
3. The vertices A, B and C of a triangle have states that ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ , for a right triangle
position vectrprs a, b and c respectively, with vertices, A, B and C.
relative to an origin O. The point P is on BC
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
measurement from the north pole of C to the
line A (direction of A). ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ), falls in the third quadrant
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
R
2. Three schools, P, Q and R are situated as = 900 + 900 + ( 900 – θ0 ) 61
0
0
follows: Q is on a bearing of 5km, 1430 from P 29
= 900 + 900 + ( 900 – 610 )
and R is on the bearing 11 km, 0530 from P. = 2090 Q
i. Find the distance between school Q and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (12km, 2090)
School R, to the nearest kilometer,
ii. Find the bearing of school Q from school R 3. The bearing of P from X, 10km away is 0250.
to the nearest degree. Another point Q is 6km from X and on a
bearing of 1620. Calculate:
Solution
i. the distance PQ;
i. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (5km, 1430) ii. the bearing of P from Q.
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (11km, 0530)
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ……… Solution
i. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (10km, 0250)
From the triangular law of vectors; ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (6km, 1620)
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ………
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
114km
Bearing of K from F;
P = 900 – 690 0
Bearing of P from Q; 68
= 210
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
15km
= 900 – θ0 0
9
F
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (114km, 0210) 5
= 900 – 810 Q 81
0
= 0090
Solved Past Questions
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (15km, 0090)
1. Two ships A and B leave a port
simularaneously. A steam at 10 on the
4. From Kwadaso, I travelled 100km on a 0
bearing of 1580, and then 80km on a bearing of bearing 160 while B steams on the bearing of
2600. Find the distance and bearing from my 2150. After one hour, the bearing of B from A is
finishing point. 2600. Find the speed of B, correct to the nearest
whole number.
Solution
O
i. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (100km, 1580) Solution
700
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (80km, 2600) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (10 , 1600) 0
35 200
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ……… ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (x, 2600)
10
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
bearing of P from R is 0150. If Q and R are
650 A
24km and 32 km respectively from P:
i. calculate the distance between Q and R,
400
correct to twodecimal places;
B
ii. find the bearing of R from Q, correct to the
Using the sine rule; nearest degree.
=
4. An aircraft leaves an airport and flies 50 km
OT = = 31 on a bearing of 1300. It then flies 80 km on a
bearing of 0850.
ii. Using the sine rule; i. How far is it from the airport?
= ii. Find the bearing of the position of the
aircraft from the airport.
AB =
AB = 33 5. Two ships leave a harbor at the same time.
The speed form A to B = 33 One sails at 18 on a bearing of 0100.
The other sails at 15 on a bearing of
0
Distance from A to B; 065 . How far apart are the ships after one
= speed × time hour?
= 33 ×1
= 33 × 6. A and B are two survey points; A is 2.3 km
due north of B. A third point C lies on a bearing
= 49.5km
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A
B a ( )( ) ( )( )
a compb a = | |
= = = 6.10
b √ ( √
( )( ) ( )( )
θ Q compa b = | |
= = = 2.04
√ √
l O
Exercises
Referring to the diagrams above, the Given that a = (2, -3), b = (3, 4) and c = (-1,
component of a along b is found by projecting 5), find the following:
the endpoint of a onto the line l containing b. 1. compc b 2. Compb c
For this reason, /a/ cos θ is often called the 3. compc c 4. compa (a + c)
Scalar Vector
Physical quantities having magnitude Physical quantities having magnitude and
only but no direction direction
These quantities are completely described
These quantities are completely described
by: a number and a suitable unit by numbers, a suitable unit and by certain
direction.
These quantities are added, subtracted, These quantities cannot be added,
multiplied and divided by simple subtracted, multiplied and divide by simple
arithmetic rules. arithmetical rules.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Mass, weight, speed, work, power Energy, ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ……………(2)
force, torque, displacement distance
But /AC/ = /OB/, put in eqn (2)
The Resultant Vector, Parallelogram Law and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ……………(3)
Triangular Law of Vectors
Consider the figure below;
eqn (1) and eqn (2) are called the triangular
y law of vectors.
C
A (x1, y1)
eqn (3) is called the parallelogram law of
vectors.
B(x2, y2)
θ In both laws, ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ is called the resultant vector.
O x
V1 = + 9.3969 i + 3.4202 j
CASE II
V2 = (-14. 7721) i + (- 2 . 6047) j
If the angle between ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ is 900, then the
cosine rule is reduced to the Pythagoras
R = V1 + V2
theorem. Hence, the magnitude of the resultant
R = (9.3969 – 14.7721)i + (3.4202 – 2.6047) j
vector ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ , |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ | = |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ | + |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ | R = – 5.3752 i + 0.8155 j
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Let ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (10m, 0700) and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (15m, 2600)
Method 3
From the diagram,
A V1 = (10 cos 200) i + (10 sin 200) j
10 V2 = (-15 cos 100) i + (-15 sin 100) j
O 200
15 800 V1 = 9.3969 i + 3.4202 j
B
V2 = (-14. 7721) i + (- 2 . 6047) j
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F = ma
F = 1000 × 5 Solution
F = 5,000N F = ?, m = 50 kg and a = 2
F = ma
2. An object has a mass of 19.53 kg and an F = 50 × 2 = 100 N
acceleration of 12.2 . What is the force on
The Resultant Force
the object?
The resultant force is the single force which
represents the vector sum of two or more
Solution
forces. For example, two forces of magnitude
F = ?, m = 19.53 kg and a = 12.2
and acting upon a particle have a
F = ma
resultant as shown below.
F = 19.53 × 12.29
F = 240.02 N
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
analytical method or by graphical method. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (8 cos 250) i + (8 sin 250) j
Resolution of Forces
But ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗
Two forces acting at a point
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (5 cos700) i + (5 sin700) j + (8 cos 250) i
Force is also represented by a vector. If two
forces are acting on an object, the resultant + (8 sin 250) j
force experienced by the object is the vector ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (5 cos 700 + 8 cos 250) i + (5 sin 700 + 8
sum of the two forces. sin 250) j
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 8.9606 i + 8.0794 j
Worked Example ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 9 i + 8 j
1. Two forces ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ of magnitude 5 kg
and 8 kg respectively act at a point O. The Magnitude of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ;
direction of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ is N200E, and the direction of |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ | = √ 8
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ is N650E. Approximate the magnitude and |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ | = √8
direction of the resultant ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ . |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ | = √
|⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ | = 12kg
Solution 135
0
C
8
Method 1 B
From the diagram, Direction of |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ |; 0
20 12 5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
20
θ y
θ= . / 8
A F
θ = 420 (at x – axis) O
F2
⇒ the direction of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ F1
0
=N E 150
450
x
But = 900 – 420 = 480 P
P
Hence the direction of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = N 480 E
Magnitude and direction of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (12kg, 0480)
Find the resultant force acting at P.
Method 3: (using the cosine rule)
Magnitude of ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ ; Solution
From the diagram, Method 1
< AOB = 650 – 200 = 450 Let F1 = 20 and F2 = 40
< OBC = 1350 Resolving along the x – axis,
i.e. < AOB + < OBC = 1800 F1 = . /=( )
F2 = . /=( )
Considering ∆OBC,
/OB/ = 8, /BC/ = 5 and < OBC = 1350
/OC/2 = 82 + 52 – 2(8) (5) cos 1350 F = F1 + F2
/OC/2 = 145.6 F=( ) +( )
/OC/ = √ F=( )
/OC/ = 12.1 kg F=( )
Direction of |⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ |, F = -12i + 29j
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F = (10 √ i + 10 √ j) + (- 15 √ i + 15 j)
F = (10 √ - 15 √ ) i + (10 √ + 15) j
F = - 12 i + 29 j Considering ∆OBC,
/OB/ = 4, /BC/ = 3 and < OBC = 1200
3. Consider two forces of magnutudes 5N and 7 /OC/2 = 42 + 32 – 2(4) (3) cos 1200
N acting on a particle with an angle of 900 /OC/2 = 16 + 9 – 2(4) (3) (0.5)
between them. What is the magnitude and /OC/ = √
direction of the resultsnt force. /OC/ = 3.6056 N
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Coplaner Forces Acting at a Point
Resultant of Coplanar Forces F1 F2 F3
When a number of coplanar forces are acting
on a rigid body, then these forces can be
Their resultant R is the sum of these forces
replaced by a single force which has the same
given by:
effect on the rigid body as that of all the forces
R = F 1 + F2 + F3
acting together. This single force is known as
If any one of these forces (say force F2 ) is
the resultant of several forces. Hence a single
acting in the opposite direction, as
force which can replace a number of forces
shown below.
acting on a rigid body, without causing any
change in the external effects on the body, is
known as the resultant force.
F1 F2 F3
The resultant of coplanar forces may be
determined by the following two methods :
Then, their resultant will be given by:
1. Graphical method
R = F1 - F2 + F3
2. Analytical method.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
R = 200 + 100 + 300
F1 F2 F3 R = 600 N
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F1 F2 F3
a 2 c 1 b 3 3. In the diagram below, resolve the forces into
horizontal and vertical components to find the
Resultant = /ad/ resultant force on the object.
By measurement, /ad/ = 2 – 1 + 3 = 4 cm
0
:. Resultant = /ad/ × chosen scale 30
10N
= 4 × 100
= 400 N 3N
2. Determine the magnitude and direction of the Resultant of Concurrent Coplanar Forces.
resultant of the forces 1.3N and 2.7 N having Concurrent coplanar forces are those forces
the same line of action and acting in the same which act in the same plane and they intersect
direction. or meet at a common point. We will consider
the following two cases:
i. When two forces act at a point.
Solution
ii. When more than two forces act at a point.
Let F1 = 1.3N and F2 = 2.7N
F = F1 + F2 1. When two forces act at a point
F = 1.3 + 2.7 = 4N in the direction of the (a) Analytical method
original forces When two forces act at a point, their resultant
is found by the law of parallelogram of forces.
3. Determine the magnitude and direction of the
The magnitude of resultant is obtained from the
resultant of the forces 470N and 538 N having
the same line of action but acting in the equation /R/ = √ and the direction of
opposite direction.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
diagonal through the point O gives the resultant C
R, determined as:
R
R = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ + ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ Q
R=. /+ ( ) α θ
O P A
The magnitude of resultant is given by: Magnitude of resultant,
R=√ cos R = Length OC × chosen scale.
The above method of determining the resultant The direction of resultant is given by angle α.
is also known as the cosine law method. Hence measure the angle α.
The direction of the resultant with the force P is Type 1: (known angle at the y – axi)s
Worked Examples
given by θ = . / 1. Forces of 7.6N at 320 and 11.8N at 1430 act
at a point. Calculate the magnitude and
(b) Graphical method direction of their resultant.
i. Choose a convenient scale to represent the
forces P and Q. F1 = 7.6N 0
Solution 69
ii. From point O , draw a vector OA = P. Let F1 = 7.6N 320 11.8
iii. Now from point 0, draw another vector OB F2 = 11.8N 580
O 0 θ
53 N
F
= Q and at an angle of θ as shown below.
R
iv. Complete the parallelogram by drawing
lines AC parallel to ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ and BC parallel to ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ . F2 = 11.8N
7.6N
690
v. Measure the length OC.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
FR sin θ = 0.9527
Direction of the resultant;
From the diagram, the direction of the resultant θ= (0.9527)
0
force = 900 + θ θ = 73
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (11.52N, 1050)
But θ = . /
From the diagram, the direction of the resultant
θ = 150 (nearest degree)
force;
= 320 + θ
Direction of the resultant force
= 320 + 730
= 900 + 150
= 1050
= 1050
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (11.52N, 1050)
2. Two forces with magnitude 150N and 100 N
act on an object at angles of 400 and 1700
Method 2
respectively. Find the magnitude and direction
Conesider one part of the parallelogram which
of the resultant force, (round to 2 decimal
gives the triangle beow
palces in all intermediate steps and the final
F1 answer)
690
0
32 Solution
O Let F1 = 150 N and F2 = 100 N
θ
F2
FR
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
FR = F1 + F2 200 N
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0
θ = 47 If the two forces are P and Q, and the angle
F = (102.66N, 0470) between them is θ, then the resultant force;
R = ∑Fx + ∑Fy
4. Force A (8 N, 0300) and B (10 N, 1500) act Where ∑Fx = P + Q cos θ
on a particle. Find the magnitude and direction ∑Fy = Q sin θ
of the resultant force.
Worked Examples
Solution 1. Two forces of 3N and 4N are acting at a
A (8 N, 0300) and B (10 N, 1500) point such that the angle between them is 600.
Let the resultant force be F Find the :
F= + i. resultant force,
=. /=( ) ii. magnitude of the resultant force,
ii. direction of the resultant with the force 4N
=. /=( )
Solution
F=( )+( ) i. Let P = 3N, and Q = 4N, θ = 600
F=( ) ∑Fx = 3 + 4 cos 600 y
C
=5 A
∑Fy = 4 sin 600
Magnitude of the force; 3N
= 3.4641 0 B
| | = √( ) ( ) 60 4N
x
| |=√ O
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
R = 6.08N
ii. Direction of the resultant with force 4N; The magnitude of resultant R;
| |= √ )
θ= . /
| |= √ )
θ = ( 8) | | = 113.58 kN
θ = 350 (with force P that is 3N)
Alternatively;
Direction of resultant with force Q or 4N; Let ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = R (Magnitude of the resultant force).
= 600 – 350 R2 = 502 + 802 – 2(50) (80) cos 1200
= 250 R R2 = 2500 + 6400 – 8000 cos 1200
3N
0 R2 = 12900
35 0
25 R=√
4N
R = 113.58
R = 114kN
2. Find the resultant of two forces 80 N and 50
N acting at a point with an included angle of Exercises 12.2
60° by analytical method. Also draw the free 1. Use the cosine and sine rules to determine
body diagram. the magnitude and direction of the resultant of
the force 13N at 00 and 25N at 300.
Solution
Method 1: Resolving the forces 2. Use the parallelogram law to determine the
magnitude and direction of the resultant of the
force 9N at 1260 and 14N at 2230.
5. Two force with magnitudes of 70N and 40N Angle Between the Resultant Force and a
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and an angle of 1300 between them are applied Force Vector
B Q C
on an object. Find the magnitude of the
resultant force to the nearest whole number.
R
P β P
6. Two force with magnitudes of 77N and 45N θ α
and an angle of 450 between them are applied O Q A
on an object. Find the magnitude and direction
of the resultant force to the nearest whole 1. Consider triangle OAC,
number. Then by cosine rule;
P2 = Q2 + R2 – 2(Q)(R) cos α
B. 1. Determine the magnitude and direction It follows that:
of the resultant force. α= . /
( )( )
a. 0 b.
10 ⃖⃗
20
0 2. Consider triangle OBC,
3N 20N Then by cosine rule;
2N
Q2 = P2 + R2 – 2(P)(R) cos β
15N
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Make a sketch of the problem
312 = 402 – 422 + 2(31)(42) cos α. 2. Resolve the forces (usually along the vertical
961 = 1600 – 1764 + 2604 cos α axis), to obtain the sum of the forces in terms of
961 – 1600 + 1764 = 2604 cos α the uknown.
1125 = 2604 cos α 3. Equate the sum obtained in (2), to the
cos α = magnitude of the resultant force to obtain the
original force. i.e. F2 = F12 + F22
α= . /
4. Evaluate F2 and find the sum of F12 and F22,
α = 640 using binomial expansion ( where necessary)
5. Solve to obtain the value of the unknown
Exercises 12.2C force.
1. Two forces with magnitudes of 15N and 10N
are applied to an object. The magnitude of the Worked Examples
resultant is 24 N. Find the measurement of the 1. A body at rest is acted upon by two forces
angle between the resultant vector and the
(40N, 0450) and (QN, 1350).
vectore of the 10 N force to the nearest whole
number. i. Express each of the forces as a column
vector.
2. Two forces with magnitudes of 6N and 18N
ii. If the magnitude of the resultant force is
are applied to an object. The magnitude of the
resultant is 13 N. Find the measurement of the 50N, find the force Q and the direction of the
angle between the resultant vector and the resultant force to the nearest degree.
vector of the 18 N force to the nearest whole
number.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
point is found analytically by a method which
F12 = (28.2843 + 0.7071Q)2 is known as rectangular components methods.
= 28.28432 + 2(28.2843)(0.7071Q) + In this method, all the forces acting at a point
0.7071Q)2 are resolved into horizontal and vertical
= 800 + 1131.3623Q + 0.4999Q2 components and then algebraic summation of
horizontal and vertical components is done
F22 = (28.2843 – 0.7071Q)2 separately. The summation of horizontal
= 28.28432 – 2(28.2843)(0.7071Q) + component is written as ΣFx and that of vertical
0.7071Q)2 as ΣFy. Then resultant R is given by:
= 800 – 1131.3623Q + 0.4999Q2 R= +
F2 = F12 + F22
502 = (800 + 1131.3623Q + 0.4999Q2 ) + (800 The magnitude of the resultant force;
– 1131.3623Q + 0.4999Q2)
| |=√
2500 = 1600 + 0.9999Q2
2500 – 1600 = 0.9999Q2
900 = 0.9999Q2 The angle made by the resultant with horizontal
Q2 = is given by: tan θ =
2
Q = 900
Q = 30N Illustration
Let four forces F1, F2, F3 and F4 act at a point 0
Put Q = 30 N in equation 1 as shown below.
( )
F=. ( )
/……….(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F = F1 + F2 + F3 + F4
parallel to force OF1. Cut ab = force F1 to the
The angle (θ) made by resultant with x-axis is scale.
III. From point b, draw be parallel to OF2. Cut
given by tan θ =
be = force F2:
IV. From point c, draw cd parallel to OF3. Cut
b. Graphical method. cd = force F3.
The resultant of several forces acting at a point V. From point d, draw de parallel to OF4 . Cut
is found graphically with the help of the de = force F4 .
polygon law of forces, which may be stated as VI. Join point a to e. This is the closing side of
“If a number of coplanar forces are acting at a the polygon. Hence ae represents the resultant
point such that they can be represented in in magnitude and direction.
magnitude and direction by the sides of a
polygon taken in the same order, then their Magnitude of resultant R = Length ae × scale.
resultant is represented in magnitude and The resultant is acting from a to e.
direction by the closing side of the polygon
taken in the opposite order. Worked Examples
1. Three forces A, B and C of magnitude 30 N,
Let the four forces F1, F2, F3 and F4 act at a 25 N and 45 N respectively act at a point. The
point O as shown below. angle between the forces A and B is 35o and the
F1
force C makes an angle of 130° with the force A
F2
in the anticlockwise direction. Find the
O magnitude of the resultant force and its
direction.
F3 F4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F = FA + FB + FC
the value of 25 N in the same direction as that
F=. / +. /+. / of B as shown in figure.
F=( )+( )+( )
4. Similarly, draw the line parallel to the force
F=( )
vector C. Now, we have obtained three sides of
a polygon and the polygon is in open state.
The resultant force, R,
The direction of the resultant, 2. The four coplanar forces are acting at a point
900 + 900 + 900 + θ as shown in the diagram below.
F2 156N y
θ= . /
0 0 F1 104
θ = 47 (with the horizontal) 24
N
0
10
3
0 x
O
The direction of the resultant,
= 900 + 900 + 900 + 470 F3 252 9
0
= 3170 N
F4 288
N
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The direction of resultant;
II. Consider force F2 = 156 N. θ= . / 0
17
F2
730
156N 0
θ = 170 (at x – axis)
24
R 260N
0
66 Direction of the resultant force;
= 900 + 900 + (90 – θ)0
= 900 + 900 + (90 – 17)0
F2 = . /=( ) = 900 + 900 + 730
= 2530
III. Consider force F3 = 252 N. R = (260 N, 2530)
3
0 Method 2 : Graphical method.
F3
F2 156N y
252 N
F3 = . /=( ) 0 F1 104
24
0 N
10
3
0 x
IV. Consider force F4 = 228 N. O
F3 252 9
0
81
0 N
0 F4 288
9
288N N
The figure above shows the point at which four
F4
forces 104 N, 156 N, 252 N and 228 N are
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and direction of the resultant force F.
cm. Force 156 N will be represented by =
6.24 cm, force 252 N will be represented by = Solution
= 10 . 08 cm and the force 228 N will be = (2i + 3j) N, = (-5i + j) N and = 6i N
Resultant force F;
represented by = 9.12 cm.
F= + +
F = (2i + 3j) + (-5i + j) + 6i
II. Take any point a. From point a, draw vector
F = (2i – 5i + 6i) + (3j + j )
ab parallel to line of action of force 104 N. Cut
F = 3i + 4j
ab = 4.16 cm. Then ab represents the force 104
N in magnitude and direction.
Magnitude of the resultant force;
| |=√
III. From point b, draw vector be parallel to
force 156 N and cut be = 6.24 cm. Then vector | |=√
be represents the force 156 N in magnitude and | |=√
direction. | |=5N
The magnitude of the force is 5 N
IV. From point c, draw a vector cd parallel 252
N force and cut cd = 10.08 cm. Then vector cd Direction of the force;
represents the force 252 N in magnitude and F = 3i + 4j (first quadrant) F
direction. θ=
θ
θ = 370
V. Now from point d, draw the vector de
parallel to 228 N force and cut de = 9.12 cm. 4. A body is acted on by three forces = (10N,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Magnitude of the resultant force;
| |=√ ( ) 3. Force 23N acts at 800 to the horizontal, force
| |=√ 30N acts at 370 to the force one, and force 15N
act at 700 to the force two. Find the magnitude
| |=√
and direction of the resultant force.
| | = 15.8N (3 s.f)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Resultant force F;
i. = (2i - j) N, = (-5i + 3j) N and = 6i – j
F = (– 63j) + (32.14i + 38.3j) + (14i – 24.25j)
Resultat force F;
F = (32.14i +14i) + (38.3j – 24.25j – 63j)
F= + +
F = 46.14i – 48.95j
F = (2i – j) + (-5i + 3j) + 6i – j
F = (2i – 5i + 6i) + (-j + 3j – j)
Magnitude of the force;
F = 3i + j
| | = √( ) ( 8 )
F = ma; | |=√ 88
a= = = (3i + j) = 1000 (3i + j) | |=√
| | = 67.3N
ii. the acute angle between the resultant force
Direction of the resultant force;
on the particle and the vector i + j
= 900 + θ
Let V = i + j = ( ) and F = 3i + j = ( )
F = 46.14i – 48.95j
FV = ( ) ( ) (dot product)
F=( ) (lies in the fourth quadrant)
FV = 3 + 1 = 4
θ= . /
0
Angle between F and V; θ = 47
cos θ =
Direction of the resultant in the 4th quadrant
cos θ = = 900 + 470
(√ ) (√ )
= 1370
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
necessary to determine the resultant force of the
coplanar forces to know this effect. There are
Resultant force, F;
many methods to determine the resultant force.
F= +
F= ( )+ ( )
Equilibrium of Forces
F=( ) In general, an object can be acted on by several
forces at the same time. If the size and direction
Magnitude of the resultant force; of the forces acting on an object are exactly
| |=√ ( ) balanced, then there is no net force acting on
| |=√ the object and the object is said to be
| | = 12N in equilibrium. In other words, for forces in
equilibrium, the sum of the component of the
Direction of resultant force; forces in any direction must be zero. That is:
F = F1 + F2 + F3……….+ Fn = 0
F=( ) (lies in the first quadrant)
Because there is no net force acting on an
θ= . / object in equilibrium, then from Newton's first
0
θ = 30 law of motion, an object at rest will stay at rest,
The resultant force is (12N, 0300) and an object in motion will stay in motion.
F = ma Polygon of Forces
a= = =2 For equilibrium, forces are represented in
Since acceleration acts in the same direction of magnitude and directin to form a polygon
the force shape.
At equilibrium,
No equilibrium
Equilibrium F1 + F2 + F3 + G = 0
R But F1 + F2 + F3 = F = ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
values of m and n?
Solution Solution
Let F1 = 3i – 4j , F2 = -14i – 3j and F3 be the At equilibrium (at rest), all the forces add up to
third force that will keep the body in zero.
equilibrium. (2i + 3j) + (mi + 6j) + (- 4i + nj) = 0
⇒ F1 + F2 + F3 = 0 (2 + m – 4) i + (3 + 6 + n) j = 0
( ) + ( ) + F3 = ( )
The scalar multipliers of each unit vector equals
( ) + F3 = ( ) zero
F3 = ( ) + ( ) 2+m–4=0
m=4–2
F3 = ( ) m=2
F3 = 11i + 7j
3+6+n=0
2. Three forces 4i + 3j, -2i – 3j and 5i + 2j act n=-3–6
at a point O. Find the net force F and the n=-9
additional force G, such that equilibrium m = 2 and n = -9
occurs.
4. A particle at rest has an unknown force F and
Solution two other forces (2i – 5j), (-3i + j), acting on it.
Let F1 = 4i + 3j, F2 = -2i – 3j, F3 = 5i + 2j Find the magnitude of F to two decimal places.
F1 = ( ), F2 = ( ) , F3 = ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
/F/ = 4.12 N
Method 2 Direction of F3 = ( ),
Let F1 = 2i – 5j, F2 = -3i + j and F be the F3 lies in the second quadrant;
unknown force.
θ= . /
F3
θ = 450 4.14
At equilibrium (at rest) ,
0
45
F1 + F2 + F = 0
(2i – 5j) + (-3i + j) + F = 0 Direction of F3;
= 900 + 900 + 900 + 450
2i – 3i – 5j + j + F = 0
= 3150
-i – 4j + F = 0
F3 = (4.14N, 3150)
F = i + 4j
F=( ) 3. In the diagram below, find the force F, that
will keep the forces F1, F2 and F3 acting at point
/F/ = √ =√ = 4.12 N O in equilibrium.
y
F2 F1
5. A body of mass 2kg is at rest under the
7N
action of three coplaner forces F1, F2 and F3, 8N
where F1 = (8N, 0600) , F2 = (8N, 2100). Find 800 0
70 0 50
the magnitude and direction of the force F3. x
5N
Solution F3
m = 2 kg, F1 = (8N, 0600) , F2 = (8N, 2100)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F1 + F2 + F3 + F = 0 F2
Solution
F1 = 3i – 4j, F2 = -14i – 3j, F3 = ?
⇒ F1 = ( ), F2 = ( ), F = ? α
B
At equilibrium (at rest) , C
F1 + F2 + F = 0 By Lami‟s theorem,
( ) +( ) + F = ( ) = =
( )+F=( )
F=( ) This is further illustrated as shown below
F = 11i + 8j
mg
Now let α + β = θ Using sine rule;
=
= = T1 =
T1 = 14.64 N
Worked Examples
1. A 2 kg mass is suspended by two light Using the sine rule;
inextensible strings inclined at 600 and 450 to =
the vertical. What are the tensions in the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
strings? (g = 10m/s2) T2 =
T2 = 17.93 N
Solution The tensions in the strings are 14.6N and 17.9N
F = ma
F = 2 × 10 = 20N Method 3 : Using the vector method
600 450 0
45
600
T1 T2 T1 600 0 T2
1050 45
300 450
20N
Method 1
Using the sine rule; 20N
At rest,
=
T1 + T2 + W = 0
T1 =
T1 = 14.46 N Resolving along the horizontal axis;
. / +. /+ ( ) =( )
Using the sine rule;
. / +. / =( )
=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
100N
The tensions in the strings are 14.6N and 17.9N 300 T2
A B T2 = 86.6 N
0
30 The tensions in the strings are 50N and 86.6N
600
T1 T2
3. An object of mass 2kg is suspended by
P means of an inextensible string. The object is
then drawn aside by means of a horizontal force
of magnitude F newtons until the string makes
100N an angle of 300 with the downward vertical. If
Method 1 T is the tension in the string,
Using sine rule; i. express as vectors in component form all the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F = ma
T2 =
F = 20 × 10 = 200N
T2 = 100 N
X Y
0
60 The tensions are 173.2N and 100N
300
T1 T2
2. A bucket of water of mass 20kg is being
P pulled out of a well. Find the magnitude of the
tension in the rope when:
i. it is moving with a constant speed;
200N ii. it has an acceleration of 0.3 ( g = 9.8 )
Solution T
Method 1: Using the sine rule
Using sine rule; i. Let T be the tension in the
= rope
For the bucket to move up,
T1 = a
T > mg
T1 = 173.2 N
Net force on the bucket of
Using the sine rule; water;
mg
= = T – mg
T2 = But F = ma
T2 = 100 N ⇒ ma = T – mg
The tensions are 173.20N and 100.00N At constant velocity, a = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
T1 T2
strings.
T3 P
2. A two legged string and hoist chain used for 5kg M
lifting machine parts is shown below.
Determine the forces in each leg of the sling if 600
b.
T1
parts exerting a downwad force is 15kN are
lifted. T2
T3
3. Three chords are knotted at point P, with two
10kg
of thses chords fastened to the ceiling making
angles of θ1 and θ2 and a block of mass m hangs
from the third one as shown below: 6. A mass of 100 g is hanging from two
M N massless ropes attached to the ceiling. One rope
θ1 θ2 makes an angle of 600 with the ceiling , while
the other make an angle of 290. Find the tension
P in the two ropes.
M
a. Find the magnitude of the tension in each 7. There are two strings, one with an angle of
chord in terms of θ1, θ2 and m, so that the 250, and the other with an angle of 650, and a
system is at rest. mass 5 kg. Label the tension from the strings as
b. Find the numerical values of the three T1 and T2 respectively and find their values.
tensions found above for θ1 = 450 and θ2 = 300 (Ans 20.7N; 44.4N)
and m = 1 kg
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= ×
Note:
Sum of clockwise moments;
1. The weight of a body is concerntrated at the
= ×
center.
2. The resultant force on the body must to zero.
3. The resultant moment of the forces on the 0 1=0 1
body about all points must to zero. × = ×
Solution
F = 20N, d = 0.50m Sum of anti - clockwise moments;
0.5 = ×
m
Sum of clockwise moments;
Turning
point =( )+( )
20N
Mo = Fd 0 1=0 1
Mo = 20 × 0.5
Mo = 10 Nm × =( )+( )
Solution W N 5N 8N 20N
Taking moments about C;
Sum of anticlockwise moments;
∆ = (W × 15) + (5 × 10)
54 N
Sum of anti clockwise moments;
Sum of clockwise moments; = 20 × 15
=( )+( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0 1=0 1
Sum of anti - clockwise moments; (w × 15) + (5 × 10) = 20 × 15
= 54 × 40 15W + 50 = 300
15W = 300 – 50
0 1=0 1 15W = 250
( )+( ) = 54 × 40 W = 16.7N
350 + 60W = 2160
60 W = 2160 – 350 3. A uniform bar PR of length 100 cm and
60W = 1810 weight 25 N rest on a support at its midpoint Q.
A force of 10N acts vertically downwards at R
W=
and another force of 10N acts vertically at S. If
W = 30.17N the bar is in equilibrium, and the force x acts at
W = 30N (Nearest whole number) P, find x.
100 cm
2. In the figure below, find the value of the P S Q R
weight W if AD is a uniform rod of length 30m
25cm
and C is the mid-point of AD. x 10N 10N
C Solution
A B D
100 cm
5m P S Q R
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Illustration
Consider the diagram below and observe the Solution
following:
M N
10 cm ∆ 20 cm 15 cm ∆ 15 cm
X Y
10N 20N 15N
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. Total upward force = Total downward force
0 1=0 1
+ 100 = 80 + (10 × 14.4)
+ 100 = 80 + 144
(10 × 45) + (20 × 15) = (15 × 15) + ( × 35)
= 80 + 144 – 100
450 + 300 = 35 + 225
= 124 N
450 + 300 – 225 = 35
525 = 35
3. A uniform beam has length 8m and mass 60
= 15N
kg. It is suspended by two ropes as shown in
the diagram below:
Total upward force = Total downward force
T1 T2
+ = 10 + 20 + 15
1m 3m 2 2m
15 + = 10 + 20 + 15
= 10 + 20 + 15 – 15
W
= 30 N Find the tension in each rope.
The reactions at X and Y are 15N and 20 N
respectively. Solution
W = mg = 60 × 9.8 = 588 N
2. A uniforn plank AB, 10 m long and of mass
m kg, rests on two supports A and B. A load of
5m
8 kg is placed on the plank at point C, such that
/AC/ = 3.5 cm. The reaction at B is 100 N. If the
1m 3m 2m 2m
system remains in equilibrium under the action
of these forces, calculate: 4m 4m
i. the value of m;
588 N
ii. the reaction at A. (g = 10 )
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 369
Taking moments about : Taking moments about :
5 × = 3 × 588 Clockwise moments
5 = 3 × 588 2× = 1.5 × 490
= = 352.8N 2 = 1.5 × 490
= 353N ( 3 s.f. ) = = 367.5N
= 368N ( Nearest whole number )
Taking moments about :
5 × = 2 × 588 Taking moments about :
5 = 2 × 588 2× = 0.5 × 490
= = 235.2N 2 = 0.5 × 490
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
+ = 588N + = 122.5 + 367.5
+ = 490 N
3. A beam of mass 50 kg and length 5 m rest on
two supports as shown in the diagram below . ii. Let consider the greatest mass that can be
placed at the left end of the beam .
1m 2m
∆ 2m
1m 1.5m 0.5m 2m
i. Find the magnitude of the reaction force
exerted by each support. 2.5m 2.5m
ii. Find the maximum mass that could be placed mg 490N
at either end of the beam if it is to remain in
equilibrium.
Taking moments about :
Solution 1 × mg = 1.5 × 490
W = mg = 50 × 9.8 = 490 N 1 × m × 9.8 = 1.5 × 490
m= = 75kg
2m
1m 1.5m 0.5m 2m Consider the greatest mass that can be placed at
the right end of the beam.
2.5m 2.5m
Taking moments about :
490N 2 × mg = 0.5 × 490
2 × m × 9.8 = 0.5 × 490
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
from Q. Find the distance from P where a mass W 650 N
of 20 kg should be attached so that the man‟s
support is twice that of the boy, if the system is 3. The diagram below shows a metre stick
in equilibrium (g = 10 ) pivoted at the centre.
0 10 m 50 m 80 m 100 m
Solution
R 2R 90 g M
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
displacement vector represents the length and Given any three of these values, the other two
direction of the straight path. can be found using these equations.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution ii. the velocity with which it hits the ground.
Initial velocity (u) = 0 m/s (body at rest)
final velocities (v) = 20m/s Solution
displacement (s) = ? i. s = 20 – 10 = 10m, u = 0, v = ?, g = 10 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )
√
1. A car is moving along a straight horizontal
t= road with a velocity of u. It accelerates
t=
√
or t =
√ uniformly at a rate of 15 for 25m giving a
velocity of 30 . What is the value of u?
t = 1.8481 or t = -5.5215 (ignore –ve answer)
t = 1.85s ( 3 signicant figures) 2. A bullet is fired horizontally with an initial
velocity of 550 m/s at a target located 100m
5. A bullet is fired horizontally with a velocity from the riffle. How much time is required for
of 60 from the top of a building 80m the bullet to reach the target?
high. Calculate, how far from the foot of the
building will the bullet be assumed to touch the 3. A bullet is fired horizontally at a velocity of
ground. (Assume g = 10 ) 300 m/s from a tower 20 m high. At what
distance did the bullet travel? A = 2.02s, 606m
Solution
u = 60 , h = 80m Motion Under Gravity
h = gt², Gravity always act downward, so when an
object is moving upward, that is, in upward
direction, the acceleration of the upward
substitute h = 80m, g = 10 and t =?
moving object is moving in opposite direction
calculate t, {time taken to reach the ground}
of acceleration due to gravity. In other words,
and substitute t in h = gt² to obtain the range.
acceleration due to gravity is coming down and
h = gt², acceleration of the moving upward object is
moving upward, hence, a negative sign comes
80 = (10)t²,
in. That is, accceleration of the moving upward
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 375
object = − acceleration due to gravity (because T = 2t
of the retarding effect of gravity as the object T = 2 × 7.5
rises). T = 15s
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Note :
The negative sign will not reflect in the solution Using v2 = u2 + 2as
but only if you are using the three equations (0)2 = (20)2 + 2(-10)s
of motion under the influence of gravity . 0 = 400 – 20s
20s = 400
At maximum height reached: s = 20
Final velocity, v = 0. The ball will attain a mximum height of 20m.
v2 = u2 + 2as
0 = u2 + 2gh b. Time taken to reach the maximum height;
-u2 = 2gh using v = u + at
( ) v = 20 + (-10)t
h= = = = 281.25 281.3m
( )
- 20 = - 10t
t = 2s
b. Time to reach the maximum height t:
From v = u + at c. Total time for the journeys
= 2s up + 2s down
v = u + gt = 4s
t= = = 7.5s
The velocity at the time of reaching the ground
c. Time of flight is two times the time to reach is:
maximum height. v = ?, u = 0, t = 2s
v = 0 + (-10) (2)
Time of flight, v = - 20
T = 2 × time to reach maximum height, t. v = 20 ( in the downward direction)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. the position of the particle after 4s.
4. A particle is projected vertically upwards
ii. the maximum height reached;
from a point O with speed of 40 . Find:
iii. the time taken to reach the maximum height.
i. the maximum height reached;
iv. the time when the particle is 30m above the
ii. the time when the particle is 30m above the
ground. (g = 10 )
point O, correct to the nearest whole number.
Solution
Solution
i. s = ? u = 25, a = - g = - 10, t = 4
i. v = 0 , u = 40 , a = -g = -10
2 2
using v = u + 2as Using s = ut + at2
02 = 402 + 2(-10) s s = 20 (4) + (-10) (4)2
0 = 1600 – 20s
s = 100 – 80
20s = 1600
s = 20
s= = 80 The position of the particle after 4s is 20m
The maximum height reached is 80m
ii. the maximum height reached;
ii. s = 30m, u = 40, a = -10 u = 25, a = - 10, s = ?, v = 0 (at the max height)
Using s = ut + at2 v2 = u2 + 2as
02 = (25)2 + 2(-10) s
30 = 40t + (-10) t2
0 = 625 – 20s
30 = 40t – 5t2 20s = 625
6 = 8t – t2
s= = 31.25m
t2 – 8t + 6 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
incline. Although gravity pulls an object
t2 – 5t + 6 = 0 straight down, the presence of the slope
(t – 2) ( t – 3) = 0 ( By factorization) prevents this. Because objects can't move
t = 2s or t = 3s through the solid surface of the incline, the
object is limited to movement along the surface
Exercises 13.3 of the incline.
1. A ball is thrown vertically upwards with an
initial velocity of 30 . What is the Inclined plane problems involving
maximum height that the ball will reach? gravity, forces of friction , moving objects etc.
require vector representations of these
2. A ball is thrown upwards with a velocity of
quantities. Components are better in
100 . When will the ball reach the
representing forces using rectangular system of
ground?
axes since they make calculations such as
the addition of forces easier. Free body
3. A ball is thrown vertically upwards with a
diagrams are also used as well as Newton's
velocity of 20 . Find the:
second law to write vector equations.
a. Find the time it reaches the maximum height.
b. Calculate the maximum height reached.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F = W sin θ ii. Determine the acceleration a of the box
F = mg sin θ down the plane.
iii. Determine the magnitude of the force
By substitution; exerted by the inclined plane on the box.
R
F Solution R
i. R F
θ
mg sin θ
mg cos θ θ
θ W mg sin θ
mg cos θ
For all inclined planes: 270 W
1. Weight always acts vertically (straight) mg
downward. Weight (W) = mg = where is Two forces act on the box: the weight W of the
the force of gravity. box and R, the force normal to and exerted by
the inclined plane on the box.
2. Objects move in the direction of net force,
ma ii. Down the plane,
F = mg sin θ
3. Objects on an angle have a force parallel to F = 2(10) sin 270
the surface, F = mg sin θ. The parallel force
F = 9.098N
acts down the plane.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a= = =
Solution
i. R ii. Reaction between the particle and the plane;
R F R = mg cos θ
θ R = 8 (10) cos 300
mg sin θ R = 69.28N
mg cos θ
270 W
mg 4. A body of mass 3kg is placed on a smooth
Force that moves the sphere down the plane; inclined plane at angle of 400 to the horizontal.
F = mg sin θ Find, correct to one decimal place, the
F = 2 (10) sin 300 magnitude of the force required to keep the
F = 10 N body in equilibrium. (take g = 10 )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
30 0
W A bullet is fired at an angle of 45° to the
mg horizontal with a velocity of 490m/s.
If the book does not slides, Calculate,
F = mg sin θ 1. The time taken to reach maximum height.
F = 0.8 (10) sin 300 a) 0.345s b) 48s c) 4.8s
F=4N d) 34.6s e) 3.54s
ii. If the book slides, then mg sin θ > F 2. The maximum height attained;
Net force acting on the book a) 610000 b) 61000 c) 600
= mg sin θ – F d) 61200 e) 6000
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
perpendicular component of 390 N? What is the in equilibrium ;
angle of inclination of the hill? F = mg sin θ
F = 15 (10) sin 400
6. A block slides down an inclined plane with F = 96.418 N
increasing speed. The force on the block are
shown in the diagram below, and the net force ii. The coefficient of friction;
is 5N. F=µR
⃗
µ=
θ
0
F = mg sin θ
45
F = 15 (10) sin 400
20N F = 96.418
a. Draw a vector diagram to show the addition
R = mg cos θ
of the two forces to give the net force.
F = 15 (10) cos 400
b. Find the magnitude and direction of ⃗ F = 114.907
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. Find the magnitude of the force of friction
R = 50 cos 450 acting on the particle.
µ=
3. A 100 kg box is to be lowered at constant
speed down an inclined plane 4 meters long
F = (50 cos 450)
from the back of a lorry 2 meters above the
F = 17.677N ground. The coefficient of kinetic friction is
equal to 0.45. What is the magnitude of the
Let P be the minimum force required; force Fa to be applied parallel to the inclined
P + F = mg sin 450 plane to hold back the box so that it is lowered
P = mg sin 450 – F at constant speed?
P = 5 (10) sin 450 – 17.677
P = 35.355 – 17.677 Box
P = 17.7N 4m
2m Lorry
Exercises 13.5
1. A particle of mass 5 kg rests on a 30°
inclined plane with the horizontal. A force Fa of 4. i. If the coefficient of kinetic friction
magnitude 30 N acts on the particle in the between a 35-kg crate and the floor is 0.30,
direction parallel and up the inclined plane. what horizontal force is required to move the
i. Draw a free body diagram including the crate to the right at a constant speed across the
particle, the inclined plane and all forces acting floor?
on the particle with their labels. ii. Suppose the same 35 kg crate was not
moving at a constant speed, but rather
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and the ramp. examples, if the first object travels at 30
c. At what angle will the crate just begin to slip in the direction oppsite to the first object‟s
direction, multiply the velocity by -1 , giving
Momentum and Impulse the second object a velocity of – 30
Momentum
If the mass of an object is m and it has a III. Multiply the second object‟s nmass by its
velocity v, then the momentum of the object is velocity. For example, if it weighs 1,000 and
defined to be its mass multiplied by its velocity. has a velocity of – 30 , then its
That is momentum = mv. momentum will be 30,000 kgm/s.
Momentum has both magnitude and direction IV. Add the two velocities together to
and thus, it is a vector quantity. The units of determine which way the object will move after
momentum are kg m or newton seconds, collision. For example, a collision between an
(Ns). This is often referred to as linear object with a momentum of 10,000 kg
momentum in order to distinguish it from and an object with momentum of -30,000 kg
angular momentum. gives a result of – 20,000 kg . A
negative results means the object will move in
When two objects collide, their total the second object‟s original direction after the
momentum does not change. The total collision.
momentum, before and after the collision,
equals the sum of the objects' individual Worked Examples
momenta. For each object, this momentum is 1. A cyclist and his bike have a combined mass
the product of its mass and its velocity, of 100 kg and are travelling along a straight
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. A cyclist and his bike have a combined mass
= − 6300 kg m of 100 kg and are travelling along a straight
horizontal road at 9 . A motorcyclist and
2. Three forces are given by F1 = (5N, 0900), her bike, which have a combined mass of 300
F2 = 8N, 1200) and F3 = (4N, 2100). kg, travel in the opposite direction at 21 .
i. Write down the three forces as column What is the momentum of the cyclist and what
vectors. is the momentum of the motorcyclist?
ii. Find the magnitude and direction of the
resultant force, F, for the three forces , correct Solution
to the nearest degree. If the direction of the cyclist is defined as
iii. If F acts on a particle of 2 kg which is positive, then:
initially at rest, find the momentum acquired by Momentum of cyclist;
the particle after moving through a distance of = 100 × 9
3 meters. = 900 kg
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
direction,
4. A particle of mass 2kg is moving in a straight
line with a velocity 2i – 3j. It is given a push
Solution
which causes it to move with a velocity 5i + j.
a.
3kg 3kg Find the change in momentum.
u=2 v=4
Solution
Momentum before blow;
Momentum before push;
= mu
= mu
=3×2
= 2 (2i – 3j)
= 6 kg
Momentum after push;
Momentum after blow;
= mv
= mv
= 2 (5i + j)
=3×4
= 12 kg Change in momentum;
= mv – mu
Change in momentum; = 2(5i + j) – 2 (2i – 3j)
= final momentum − initial momentum = 2[(5i + j) – (2i – 3j)]
= mv – mu = 2[(5i – 2i) + (j + 3j)]
= 12 – 6 = 2[(5 – 2)i + (1 + 3)j]
= 6 kgm/s = 2[3i + 4j]
b. = 6i + 8j
3kg 3kg
u=2 v = -4 Magnitude of change in momentum;
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 386
=√ 8 v = 12i + 3j
=√
= 10 kg in the direction of 3i + 4j Change in momentum;
= final momentum − initial momentum;
Some Solved Past Questions = mv – mu
1. A body of mass 0.5kg is moving in a straight = m(v – u)
line with a velocity - 2i + 6j. It is hit by an = 0.8 [( ) ( – )]
object which causes it to move with velocity = 0.8 ,( )-
4i – 3j. Find the: = 0.8 ,( )-
i. change in momentum; = 0.8 ( )
ii. magnitude of the change in momentum. = 6.4i + 4.8j kg
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= final momentum − initial momentum; = 8 kg
= mv – mu
= m(v – u)
Exercises 13.6
= 0.5 [( ) ( – )] A. Calculate the momenta of the following in
= 0.5 ,( )- newton – seconds:
= 0.5 ,( )- 1. A table tenis ball of mass 4g moving at 20 m/s.
= 0.5 ( 8)
= -3i + 4j kg 2. A stone of mass 15kg moving at 5m/s
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
on it. Mathematically, it is expressed as:
– = +
= (mv)dt = m = ma = Fnet
Observe the following in the calculation of the
If the net external force acting on a body is common velocity, v, after impact;
zero, then the rate of change of momentum is 1. If the particles move together after impact,
also zero, which means that there is no change then:
in momentum. + =( + )v
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
car of mass 3 × 103 kg travelling with a velocity =( ) (express as distance bearing)
of (5 , 2700). If the velocity of the first car
= (5 m/s, 0900)
immediately after the collision is (4 ,
0
090 ), find the velocity of the second car
3. Two masses 20 kg and 15 kg moving with
immediately after collision.
velocities 25 and 20 respectively
Solution collide. They move together after collision.
Before collision Find their common velocities if they were
m1 = 5 × 103 kg , u1 = (10 , 0900) moving in;
m2 = 3 × 103 kg , u2 = (5 , 2700) i. the same direction;
ii. opposite direction.
After collision
m1 = 5 × 103 kg v1 = (4 , 0900) Solution
m2 = 3 × 103 kg v2 = ? i. In the same direction,
= 20 kg, = 25 , = 15 kg
By law of conservation of momentum, = 20 and v = ?
m1 u1 + m2 u2 = m1 v1 + m2 v2 Before impact
Now,
20
u1 = . /=( ) 20kg 25 15kg
L.H.S.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 389
Let v be the common speed after collision. Solution
Momentum before impact; i. In the same direction,
+ =( )v Before impact
20(25) + 15(20) = (20 + 15)v (same direction)
8 5
500 + 300 = 35v 3kg 5kg
800 = 35v
v= After impact
v = 22.86 8kg
v
ii. In the opposite direction,
Before impact Let v be the common speed after collision.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
After impact
24 + 25 = 8v
35kg 49 = 8v
v
v=
v = 6.125
Let v be the common speed after collision.
Momentum after impact; ii. In the opposite direction,
Before impact
– =( )v
20(25) – 15(20) = (20 + 15)v (opp direction) 5
kg 8
320kg 5kg
500 – 300 = 35v
200 = 35v After impact
v= 8kg
v = 5.71 v
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
After impact
places, the magnitude of their common
10kg velocity.
v
Solution
= 8 kg, = (12 i + 8j) , = 5 kg
If they move in opposite direction; = (3i + 18j) and v = ?
– =( )v
4( ) – 6( ) = (6 + 4)v By law of conservation of momentum;
+ =( + )v
( ) – ( ) = 10v
– ( ) = 10v
By substitution,
v= – ( ) 8( ) + 5( ) = (8 + 5)v
v= ( ) ( ) + ( ) = 13v
v= ( ) ( ) = 13v
v= ( )
Magnitude of the common velocity;
v= ( )
/ v / = √( ) ( )
/v/=√
Magnitude of the common velocity;
/ v / = 6.08
/ v / = √(8 ) ( 8 )
/v/=6 (Nearest whole number)
/v/=√
ii. Direction of the velocity; / v / = 14.6066
/ v / = 14.61 (2 d. p)
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 391
2. A body of mass 1.5kg moving with a Exercises 13.7
velocity of 20 , collides with another 1. A truck of mass 3 × 104 kg travelling at 15
body of mass 3.5kg moving with the velocity 6 collides with another truck of mass 2 ×
4
, along the same line but in opposite 10 travelling at 10 . They moved together
direction. after collision. Find their common velocity, if
i. if they moved together after collision, find the trucks were travelling;
their common velocity. i. in the same direction;
ii. If the velocity of the 1.5 kg mass changes to ii. in the opposite direction.
3.4 , but moves in the opposite direction,
find the velocity of the 3.5 kg mass correct to 2. A truck of mass 3 × 104 travelling at 15
the neasres whole number. . collided with another truck of mass 2 ×
4
10 travelling at 10 . Assuming that they
Solution move on together, find their commom velocity
i. By law of conservation of momentum, if the if the truckd were travelling:
particles move together after impact, in the i. the same direction
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
opposite direction, then: ii. opposite directions
– =( + )v
= 1.5kg, = 20 , = 3.5 kg 3. A car of mass 750 kg was coating along a
=6 v=? horizontal road at 8 when it ran into a
By substitution; sheep of mass 50 kg standing on the road. Fter
1.5(20) – 3.5(6) = (1.5 + 3.6)v the collision, the sheep, the sheep stuck to the
30 – 21 = 5v front of the car. Find the speed of the car
9 = 5v immediately after collision. Ans 7.5m/s
v=
4. A car of mass 1000 kg travelling at (20
v = 1 .8 , 0090) collides with a lorry of mass 5000
Their common velocity is 1 .8 kg travelling at (15 , 0000) . Find the
magnitude and direction, to the nearest degree,
ii. By law of conservation of momentum; of the common velocity with which the vehicles
If the smaller mass moves in the opposite begin to move on together immediately after
direction after collision, then: the collision.
– = – +
1.5(20) – 3.5(6) = – 1.5 (3.4) + 3.5 5. A spaceship of mass 200t travelling at
30 – 21 = – 5.1 + 3.5 8005m/s was guided into the back of another
9 + 5.1 = 3.5 spaceship of mass 100t travelling in the same
14.1 = 3.5 direction at 7990 . The two space ships
= = 4.03 locked together after impact. Find their
common velocity immediately after locking
=4 (Nearest whole number)
together.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
velocity, find the magnitude and direction (to
6m/s in the same direction. If after impact, the the nearest degree), the common velocity.
particles stick together and eventually come to iii. Find the magnitude in newtons and the
rest after travelling 1.8m, magnitude of the constant force of resistance
i. find their common velocity after impact and which would bring the combined lorries to rest
their subsequent retardation. in a distance of 100m.
ii. What would have been the magnitude ot the
common velocity of the particles after impact , 6. A bullet of mass 0.02kg travelling
if they had been moving at right – angles to horizontally at 200 hits a stationary block
each other instaed of the same straight line of wood of mass 5kg, passes through it and
emerges horizontally with a speed of 50 .
3. A ball of mass 50 g has a velocity of ( ) If the block is free to move on a smooth
m/s. It collides with a ball of mas 40 g moving horizontal plane, find the speed with which it is
with a velocity of ( ) moving after the bullet passes through it .
i. If the two balls moved with the same velocity
after the collision, find that velocity. Velocity-Time graph
ii. What are the velocities of the two balls after It is a graph plotted with time on x – axis and
the coliision if the 50 g ball is then moving velocity on y – axis.
parallel to the y – axis and then the 40 g ball is
moving parallel to the x – axis. In case of motion with uniform acceleration,
the velocity time graph consist of staright lines.
4. A ball of mass 40 g rolling at a speed of 9 This graph can be used to find uknowns like
collides with a ball of mass 30 g rolling distance travelled, acceleration, time and
in the same directionat 4 . As a results of velocity.
X Y Z
O 6 12 18
v2 21 t(s)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Acceleration = = i. Acceleration =
Acceleration in the interval OX ;
Worked Examples A= =2
1. A bus traveled along astaright road for 600m.
Acceleration in the interval XY ;
It travels at a constant velocity for the whole
journey, which takes 90 seconds. A= =0
i. Sketch the displacement time graph;
ii. What was the velocity of the bus? Acceleration in the interval XZ ;
A= =4
Solution A=-4 since the moped decelerates
S (m)
ii. Total distance travelled;
600
= Area of ∆ + Area of □ + Area of ∆
400 = bh + LB + bh
200 = (0.5 × 6 × 12) + (12 × 12) + (0.5 × 3 × 12)
t (s) = 36 + 144 + 18
3 6 9 = 198m
(s)
0 0 0
ii. Velocity = = 6.7m/s
Exercises 13.8
1. A toy car is placed on the floor of a sports
2. The figure below shows the velocity time
hall. It moves in a starght line starting from
graph for a moped, which travelled between
rest. It travels with constant acceleration for 4
two sets of traffic lights on a starght road.
seconds reaching a velocity of 5m/s. It then
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
V
5
50 T(s)
Work out the average acceleration during the
50 seconds. 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
OP2 = OQ2 + QP2
But OP = r, OQ = x – 0 and QP = y – 0
x Substitute in /OP/2 = /OQ/2 + /QP/2
The distance formula or the Pythagoras /OP/2 = /OQ/2 + /QP/2
theorem can be used to find the equation of a r2 = (x – 0 )2 + (y – 0)2
circle with center (a, b) and radius r. r2 = x2 + y2
If P(x, y) is a point on the circle, then its This is the standard equation of a circle radius,
distance from the center is: r, with its center at the origin.
OP2 = OQ2 + QP2
But OP = r, OQ = x – a and QP = y – b Note:
Substitute in /OP/2 = /OQ/2 + /QP/2 1. That the graph of the equation r2 = (x – a )2
/OP/2 = /OQ/2 + /QP/2 + (y – b)2 with r > 0, is a circle with center (a,
r2 = (x – a )2 + (y – b)2 b) and radius r.
↓ 2. That the circle centered at the origin with
This is called the standard form for the radius, r , (r > 0) has the standard equation;
equation of a circle, with center (a, b) . r2 = x2 + y2
The equation of a circle can be found from the A. Finding the equation of a circle, given the
following: center and the radius
1. a given cenrtre and radius Steps
2. a given center and a point on the circle 1. Identify the given center as (a, b) and the
3. a given end points of the diameter radius as r.
4. any given three points on the circle. 2. Substitute (a, b) and r in;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
of 10.
4 = x2 + y2 standard equation
2 2
x +y –4=0
3. State the equation of a circle in standard
form which has a center at (-5, 4) and a radius
b. center = (-1, 2), radius = 4
of 9.
center = (a, b) = (-1, 2) and r = 2
Substitute in r2 = (x – a )2 + (y – b)2
4. State the equation of a circle in standard
42 = (x – (-1))2 + (y – 2)2
form which has a center at (-16, 9) and a radius
42 = (x + 1)2 + (y – 2)2 standard equation
2 2 of 13.
16 = x + 2x + 1 + y – 4y + 4
x2 + y 2 + 2x – 4y + 1 + 4 – 16 = 0
5. State the equation of a circle in standard
x2 + y 2 + 2x – 4y – 11 = 0 General equation
form which has a center at (-7, 5) and a radius
of 18.
Exercises 14.1
A. Use the given information to write a
B. Finding the equation of a circle, given the
standard equation of a circle.
center and a point on the circle
1. Identify the given center as C(a, b) and the
Center Radius
given point on the circle as P(a1, b1).
1. (2, 2) 5
2. Find the length of CP, which is the radius of
2. (-3, -1) 4
the circle, by the relation:
3. (0, - 4) 1
/CP/ = r = √( ) ( )
4. (-6, 2) 10
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
r = 5 units P(1, 2)
At this point, replace − a by g and − b by f.
2 2 2
Put (5, -1) and r in r = (x – a ) + (y – b) This gives:
⇒ 52 = (x – 5)2 + (y – (-1))2 x 2 + 2gx + y 2 + 2fy + g 2 + f 2 − r 2 = 0 .
52 = (x – 5)2 + (y + 1)2
(x – 5)2 + (y + 1)2 = 52 Now look at the last three terms on the left-
hand side, are g 2 + f 2 − r 2 . These do not
Exercises 14.2 involve x or y at all, so together they just
A. Write a standard equation of the circle represent a single number called c. Substituting
the respective centers and a point on the this into the equation finally gives x2 + 2gx +
circle. y2 + 2fy + c = 0 . This is the general equation of
Center Point on the Circle a circle.
1. (0, 0) (0, 3)
2. (1, 2) (4, 6) Properties of the General Equation of a
3. (3, 2) (5, 2) Circle: x2 + 2gx + y2 + 2fy + c = 0
4. (-5, 3) (1, 4) 1. It is quadratic in both x and y .
2. There is no term in xy.
B. 1.Write the center – radius equation of a 3. The coefficient of x2 is the same as the
circle with a center at (4, 11) and passes coefficient of y2. (In fact, if the equation has
through the point (5, 3). both coefficients equal to 1, it can always be
multiplied by a non-zero constant to obtain
2. Write the center – radius equation of a circle another valid equation.
with a center at (20, 10) and passes through the
point (9, -8). The centre of the circle is at (a, b) = (- g, - f)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. When - g = a and - f = b, then;
If the equation of the circle is of the form;
r2 = c – a2 + b2
r2 = (x – a )2 + (y – b)2, then (a, b) is the center
and r is the radius. This is called the center –
Note;
radius form of the equation of a circle.
Ensure that the coefficients of x2 and y2 of the
given equation of the circle is 1.
Worked Examples
1. Give the center and radius of the circle,
Method 2
(x – 5)2 + (y – 1)2 = 25
Given the general format x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c
= 0, the center and radius of the circle is found
Solution
by completing the square for each variable and
(x – 5)2 + (y – 1)2 = 25
express in the center – radius form (refer to
Express in standard form
type 1).
(x – a )2 + (y – b)2 = r2
⇒(x – 5 )2 + (y – 1)2 = 52
Worked Examples
1. i. Express the equation r2 = (x – a )2 + (y –
Compared to the standard equation,
b)2 in the form x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
Center (a, b) = (5, 1) and radius r = 5
ii. Write down g, f, c in terms of a, b, r.
Exercises 14.4
A. Give the center and radius of the circle; Solution
1. (x – 5)2 + (y – 1)2 = 25 r2 = (x – a )2 + (y – b)2
2. (x + 2)2 + (y – 3)2 = 36 By expansion,
3. (x + 5)2 + (y + 3)2 = 1 x2 – 2ax + a2 + y2 – 2by + b2 = r2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
-b=f . / +. /
b=-f x2 – 8x + ( ) + y2 + 2y + 12 = - 13 +
Therefore, the coordinates of the center (- 4)2 + 12
(a, b) = (- g, - f )
2 2 2
(x – 4)2 + (y + 1)2 = -13 + 16 + 1
a +b –r =c (x – 4)2 + (y + 1)2 = 4
but a = -g and b = -f (x – 4)2 + (y + 1)2 = 22
(-g)2 + (-f)2 – r2 = c Center = (a, b) = (4, -1)
Radius = 2
2. Determine the coordinates of the center and
radius of the circle x2 + y2 – 8x + 2y + 13 = 0 3. State the center and radius of the circle
x2 – 8x + y2 – 8y – 12 = 0
Solution
x2 + y2 – 8x + 2y + 13 = 0 Solution
2g = - 8 x2 – 8x + y2 – 8y – 12 = 0
g=-4 x2 + y2 – 8x – 8y – 12 = 0
2f = 2 2g = - 8
f=1 g=-
Center = (-g, -f) = (4, -1) g=-4
2f = - 8
From x2 + y2 – 8x + 2y + 13 = 0
c = 13 and (-g, -f) = (4, -1) f=
c = (-g)2 + (-f)2 – r2 f=-4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
radius of the circle.
2f =
Solution
x2 – 7x + y2 + 16y + 43 = 0 f=
x2 + y2 – 7x + 16y + 43 = 0 Center = (-g , -f) = . , /
2g = - 7
g= From x2 + y2 – 4x + y + 5 = 0
c = 5 and (-g , -f) = . , /
2f = 16
But c = (-g)2 + (-f)2 – r2
f=
By substitution;
f=8
5=( ) +. / – r2
Center = (-g, -f) = ( , -8)
5=4+ – r2
From x2 + y2 – 7x + 16y + 43 = 0 5–4– = – r2
c = 43 and (-g , -f) = . , 8/
- = - r2
2 2 2
But c = (-g) + (-f) – r
By substitution; r2 = =√ = units
43 = . / + (-8)2 – r2
Exercises 14.5
43 = + 64 – r2
1. A certain circle is represented by the
43 – – 64 = – r2 equation x2 + y2 + 16x – 14y + 49 = 0. Find the
center and radius of the circle .
4. Find the coordinates of the center and radius Thus, ̅̅̅̅ is perpendicular to ̅̅̅̅. This implies
of the circle represented by x2 – 8x + y2 − 5y – that the product of the gradient of AP and BP is
13 = 0. – 1. That is; × = -1
5. Determine the co-ordinates of the centre and Simplify × = -1 to obtain the general
the value of the radius of the circle whose equation of the circle.
equation is x2 + y2 − 2x + 4y − 11 = 0.
Method 2
6. Determine the co-ordinates of the centre and
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Given the end points of the diameter as A(x1,
the value of the radius of the circle whose y1) and B (x2, y2),
equation is 36x2 + 36y2 − 36x − 24y − 131 = 0. 1. Find the mid-point of AB as O, where O is
the center of the circle. That is:
B. State the center and radius of each circle
O=. , /
1. x2 + 24x + y2 + 10y + 160 = 0
2. x2 + 26x + y2 + 28y + 364 = 0 2. Now use the fact that /OA/ = /OB/ = r, to
3. x2 – 6x + y2 – 32y = - 264 obtain the radius of the circle.
4. – 6x + x2 = 97 + 10y – y2 3. Using the coordinates of the center , O, and
5. x2 + 24x + y2 + 10y + 160 = 0 the radius, r, obtain the standard equation and
expand to obtain the general equation of the
C. Identify the centre and radius of each. circle.
1. x2 + y 2 − 2x − 4y − 20 = 0,
2. x2 + y 2 − 4x + 6y + 4 = 0, Method 3
3. x2 + y 2 + 2x − 3 = 0, 1. If A(x1, y1) and B (x2, y2) is the diameter of
4. x2 + y 2 + 6x + 7y – 14 = 0, the circle, then the equation of the circle is
2 2 (x – x1)(x – x2) + (y – y1)(y – y2) = 0.
5. 3x + 3y − 6x + 9y + 5 = 0.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Center of AB = mid-point of AB
Since AP is perpendicular to BP;
Center of AB = . , /
⇒ × = -1
= (5, 3)
. /. / = -1
( )( )
( )(
= -1 ⇒ center, C = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (5, 3)
)
(y – 4) (y − 2) = -1[ (x − 8) (x – 2)]
y (y – 2) – 4(y – 2) = - 1[x(x – 2) – 8(x – 2)] Let AC be the radius, r, of the circle;
y2 – 2y – 4y + 8 = -[x2 – 2x − 8x + 16] /AC/ = √( 8) ( )
y2 – 6y + 8 = - (x2 – 10x + 16) /AC/ = √( ) ( )
y2 – 6y + 8 = - x2 + 10x – 16 /AC/ = √
x2 + y2 – 10x – 6y + 8 + 16 = 0
/AC/ = √
x2 + y2 – 10x – 6y + 24 = 0
⇒r=√
Hence, the equation of the circle is
x2 + y2 – 10x – 6y + 24 = 0
Alternatively;
From x2 + y 2 – 10x – 6y + 24 = 0 (x – a )2 + (y – b)2 = r2
2gx = -10x Let x = 8 , y = 4, a = 5 and b = 4
g = -5 (8 – 5)2 + (4 – 3)2 = r2 P(x, y)
2fy = - 6y 32 + 12 = r2
y = -3 r2 = 10
r=√ A(8, 4) B(2, 2)
Center = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (5, 3) O (5, 4)
c = a2 + b2 – r2
But c = 24
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put in (x – x1)(x – x2) + (y – y1)(y – y2) = 0.
x2 – 2x – 8x + 16 + y2 – 2y – 4y + 8 = 0
⇒ (x + 2)(x –10) + (y – 6)(y + 10) = 0.
x2 – 10x + 16 + y2 – 6y + 8 = 0
x2 – 10x + 2x – 20 + y2 + 10y – 6y – 60 = 0
x2 + y2 – 10x – 6y + 16 + 8 = 0
x2 – 8x – 20 + y2 + 4y – 60 = 0
x2 + y2 – 10x – 6y + 24 = 0
x2 + y2 – 8x + 4y – 20 – 60 = 0
2. AB is the diameter of a circle. Find the x2 + y2 – 8x + 4y – 80 = 0
equation of the circle through the points A(-2,
6) and B(10, -10) 2. If A(-8, 1) and B(2, 1) is the diameter of a
circle, find the equation of the circle.
Solution
A(-2, 6) and B(10, -10) Solution
Let P(x, y) be a point of a circle. A(-8, 1) and B(2, 1)
Let P(x, y) be a point of a circle.
P(x, y)
Gradient of AP; P(x, y)
=
A(-2, 6)
B(10, -10) A(-8, 1)
B(2, 1)
Gradient of BP;
= Gradient of AP;
= =
( )
Since AP is perpendicular to BP;
⇒ × = -1 Gradient of BP;
. /. / = -1 =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Equation of a Circle through 3 given Points
Solution Method 1
Center = (-10, 3) = (a, b) 1. Identify the three given points (x, y)
C= d=8 2. Substitute each point (x, y) in x2 + y2 + 2gx +
2fy + c = 0 to obtain three equations.
Diameter (d) = 2r = 8 3. Solve the three equations simultaneously to
radius r = = 4 obtain the values of g, f and c. Note that c is
obtained by substituting (g, f) in either eqn (1)
r2 = (x – a)2 + (y – b)2 or eqn (2) or eqn (3).
42 = (x + 10)2 + (y – 3)2 4. Substitute the values of g, f and c in x2 + y2 +
16 = x2 + 20x + 100 + y2 – 6y + 9 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 to obtain the equation of the
x2 + y2 + 20x – 6y + 100 + 9 – 16 = 0 circle.
x2 + y2 + 20x – 6y + 93 = 0
Method 2
Exercises 14.6 1. Using the center – radius formula;
A. ̅̅̅̅ is the diameter of a circle. Find the (x – a )2 + (y – b)2 = r2, substitute each given
equation of the circle through the following point (x, y) and simplify to obtain three
points. equations.
1. A(-5, 3) and B(13, -7) 2. Take note of the fact that the center of the
2. A(3, 8) and B(1, 4) circle to any of the given point on the circle
3. A(8, -2) and B(2, 8) forms the radius of the circle. Therefore, equate
4. A(- 4, 3) and B(16, -7) equations (1) and (2), (2) and (3) to obtain
5. A(-7, 7) and B(9, -5) equation (4) and equation (5) respectively.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
from C to P and name them L1 and L2 through the mid-points of AB and BC
respectively as shown below. respectively. Thus, the midpoints must be
A calculated first.
2. Find the point of intersection of L1 and L2 to
obtain the coordinates of the center O (x, y) =
(a, b) of the circle.
3. Find the distance OA = OB = OC to obtain
B
B C the radius of the circle.
4. With the center and radius of the circle,
P(x, y)
L2 L1 obtain the standard or general equation of the
3. A Line from A to P passes through the center circle.
of the circle, thus AP is the diameter, such that
A and P are the endpoints of the diameter not Worked Examples
forgetting that AP subtends an angle of 900 at 1. A circle passes through the points A(-5, 2),
< ABP and < ACP. B(-3, - 4) and C(1, 8). What is the equation of
4. Find the equations of L1 and L2 using the fact the circle?
that AB is perpendicular to P(x, y) is the point
of intersection of L1 and L2 obtained by solving Solution
equations of L1 and L2 simultaneously. A(-5, 2), B(-3, - 4) and C(1, 8)
5. With A(x1, y1) and P(x, y) = (x2, y2), obtain Substitute each point (x, y) in x2 + y2 + 2gx +
the general equation of the circle by 2fy + c = 0
substituting and simplifying;
(x – x1)(x – x2) + (y – y1)(y – y2) = 0. When (x, y) = (-5, 2)
(-5)2 + 22 + 2g(-5) + 2f(2) + c = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
When (x, y) = (-3, - 4);
eqn (3) – eqn (2); (-3 – a)2 + (- 4 – b)2 = r2
40 + 8g + 24f = 0……………(5) 9 + 6a + a2 + 16 + 8b + b2 = r2
a2 + b2 + 6a + 8b + 25 = r2 …………(2)
Reduce eqn (4) and eqn (5);
-1 + g – 3f = 0 ……………..(4) When (x, y) = (1, 8);
5 + g + 3f = 0 ……………….(5) (1 – a )2 + (8 – b)2 = r2
1 – 2a + a2 + 64 – 16b + b2 = r2
eqn (4) + eqn (5); a2 + b2 – 2a – 16b + 65 = r2 …………(3)
4 + 2g = 0
2g = -4 Since the radius of the circle is the same;
g = -2 equate eqn (1) and eqn (2);
a2 + b2 + 10a – 4b + 29 = a2 + b2 + 6a + 8b + 25
Put g = -2 in eqn (4); 10a – 4b + 29 = 6a + 8b + 25
-1 – 2 – 3f = 0 0 = 10a - 6a – 4b – 8b + 29 – 25
-3 – 3f = 0
10a – 6a – 4b – 8b + 29 – 25 = 0
-3f = 3
4a – 12b + 4 = 0…………(4)
f = -1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Substitute (a, b) = (2, 1) in eqn (1); ⇒ =. /= =1
a2 + b2 + 10a – 4b + 29 = r2………..(1)
22 + 12 + 10(2) – 4(1) + 29 = r2 Gradient of L2 = 1 and passes through C(1, 8)
4 + 1 + 20 – 4 + 29 = r2
50 = r2 Equation of L2;
y - 8 = - 1(x – 1)
From any point P(x, y) on the circle, to the y – 8 = -x + 1
y+x–8–1=0
center (a, b) = (2, 1) and r = √
The equation of the circle is:
P(x, y) is the point of intersection of L1 and L2
(x – 2)2 + (y – 1)2 = √ x – 3y – 9 = 0 ……………(1)
x2 – 4x + 4 + y2 – 2y + 1 = 50 x + y – 9 = 0 …………… .(2)
x2+ y2 – 4x – 2y + 4 + 1 – 50 = 0
x2 + y2 – 4x – 2y – 45 = 0 eqn (2) – eqn (1);
- 4y = 0
Method 3 A(-5, 2) y=0
A(-5, 2),
B(-3, - 4) Put y = 0 in equation (1)
C(1, 8) x=9
⇒P(x, y) = (9, 0)
B(-3, -4)
C(1, 8)
A(-5, 2) and P(9, 0) are the ends of the
L2 P(x, y) diameter;
L1
Method 4 = = =3
A(-5, 2), B(-3, - 4) and C(1, 8) Gradient of L2 =
L2
Equation of L2 passing through (-1, 2);
L1
y–2= (x + 1)
A(-5, 2) 3(y – 2) = - (x + 1)
C(1, 8) 3y – 6 = - x – 1
B(-3, -4) x + 3y – 6 + 1 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x + 3y – 5 = 0
L1 is perpendicular to AB and Passes through
x + 3y = 5 …………………(2)
the mid-point of AB. L1 is therefore, the
perpendicular bisector of AB.
Point of intersection of L1 and L2 is the center
O(x, y)
Mid-point of AB;
=. , / = (- 4, -1) Solving equations (1) and (2);
x – 3y = -1 ……………(1)
Gradient of AB; x + 3y = 5..……………(2)
= = = -3
eqn (2) – eqn (1);
Gradient of L1 = 6y = y
y=1
Equation of L1 passing through (- 4, -1);
y + 1 = (x + 4) Put y = 1in equation (1);
x – 3 = -1
3(y + 1) = x + 4
x = -1 + 3
3y + 3 = x + 4
x=2
x – 3y + 4 – 3 = 0
Center O(x, y) = (a, b) = (2, 1)
x – 3y + 1 = 0
x – 3y = - 1 …………………(1)
But radius r = /OA/ = /OB/ = /OC/
If r = /OA/;
L2 is perpendicular to BC and Passes through
the mid-point of BC. L2 is therefore, the r = √( ) ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and (5)
Reduce eqn (4) and eqn (5);
Worked Examples 2 + g + f = 0……….(4)
1. Find the equation of the circle which passes 12 + g – f = 0……….(5)
through the points P(2, 3), Q(-1, 0) and R(12,
-13) eqn (5) – eqn (4);
10 – 2f = 0
Solution -2f = - 10
P(2, 3), Q(-1, 0) and R(12, -13) f=5
Substitute each point (x, y) in x2 + y2 + 2gx +
2fy + c = 0 Put f = 5 in eqn (5);
2+g+5=0
When (x, y) = (2, 3) 7+g=0
22 + 32 + 2g(2) + 2f(3) + c = 0 g = -7
4 + 9 + 4g + 6f + c = 0
13 + 4g + 6f + c = 0 ……….(1) Put f = 5, g = -7 in eqn (1);
13 + 4(-7) + 6 (5) + c = 0
When (x, y) = (-1, 0) 13 – 28 + 30 + c = 0
(-1)2 + 02 + 2g(-1) + 2f(0) + c = 0 15 + c = 0
1 + 0 – 2g + c = 0 c = - 15
1 – 2g + c = 0 ……….(2)
Now, substitute g = -7, f = 5 and c = -15 in
When (x, y) = (12, -13) x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a2 + b2 + 2a +1 = r2 …………(2) 72 + (-5)2 – 4(7) – 6(-5) +13 = r2
49 + 25 – 28 + 30 + 13 = r2
When (x, y) = (12, -13); 89 = r2
(12 – a )2 + (-13 – b)2 = r2
144 – 24a + a2 + 169 + 26b + b2 = r2 From any point P(x, y) on the circle, to the
a2 + b2 – 24a + 26b +313 = r2 …………(3) center (a, b) = (7, -5) and r = √8
The equation of the circle is:
Since the radius of the circle is the same;
(x – 7)2 + (y – (-5))2 = √8
equate eqn (1) and eqn (2);
a2 + b2 – 4a – 6b +13 = a2 + b2 + 2a +1 (x – 7)2 + (y +5)2 = √8
- 4a – 6b + 13 = 2a + 1 x2 – 14x + 49 + y2 + 10y + 25 = 89
0 = 2a + 4a + 6b + 1 – 13 x2+ y2 – 14x + 10y + 49 + 25 – 89 = 0
6a + 6b – 13 + 1 = 0 x2 + y2 – 14x + 10y – 15 = 0
6a + 6b – 12 = 0…………(4)
Exercises 14.7
equate eqn (2) and (3); A. Find the equation of a circle which
a2 + b2 + 2a +1 = a2 + b2 – 24a + 26b +313 contains:
2a + 1 = - 24a + 26b + 313 1. (2, 2), (6, 4) and (4, 8)
2a + 24a – 26b + 1 – 313 = 0 2. (-3, -4) (-5, 2) and (1, 8)
26a – 26b – 312 = 0……….(5) 3. (0, 0) (4, 0) and (6, -2)
4. (4, 1) (-2, 1) and (2, 3)
Reducing eqn (4) and eqn (5); 5. (-2, -1) (0, -5) and (1, -2)
a + b – 2 = 0…………(4) 6. (3, 1) (8, 2) and (2, 6)
A = r2 O
A= √
C
A=√
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A
2. What is the area of the circle 9x2 + 9y2 = 25? In the diagram above, ̅̅̅̅ is the tangent to the
circle center O, ̅̅̅̅ is the radius of the circle
Solution and C is the point of tangency. ̅̅̅̅ is
9x2 + 9y2 = 25 perpendicular to ̅̅̅̅, meaning they meet an
x2 + y2 = angle of 900.
A= Steps:
1. Identify the equation of the circle and the
Exercises 14.8 given point (x, y) assumed to be on the circle.
Find the area of the following circles, leaving 2. Substitute the values of (x, y) into the
your answer in terms of equation of the circle.
1. x2 + y2 = 16? 2. x2 + y2 = 100 3. If the L.H.S. of the equation is equal to the
3. x2 + y2 = 13 4. 4x2 + 4y2 = 9 R.H.S. of the equation, then the point lies on
5. 16x2 + 16y2 = 1 the circle, if not the point does not lie on the
circle.
B. What is the area of the following circles?
1. x2 + y 2 − 2x − 4y − 20 = 0, Worked Examples
2. x 2 + y 2 − 4x + 6y + 4 = 0, 1. Verify that the point (3, 2) lies on the circle
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
i. x2 – 4x + y2 – 6y = 4 Worked examples
x2 + y2 – 4x – 6y – 4 = 0 1. i. Find the coordinates of the center of the
Compared to x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 circle whose equation is x2 – 4x + y2 – 6y = 4.
2gx = - 4x ii. Show that the point T(6, 4) lies on the circle.
g = -2 iii. Find the gradient of CT and hence deduce
the gradient of the tangent at T.
2fy = - 6y
f = -3 Solution
Center = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (2, 3) i. x2 – 4x + y2 – 6y = 4
x2 + y2 – 4x – 6y – 4 = 0
ii. x2 – 4x + y2 – 6y = 4 Compared to x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
LHS = ?, R. H. S = 4 2gx = - 4x
g = -2
Substitute T(x, y) = T(6, 4)
62 – 4(6) + 42 – 6(4) = 4 2fy = - 6y
L.H.S. = R. H. S f = -3
Center = (a, b) = (- g, - f) = (2, 3)
Finding the Gradient of the Tangent
The gradient of the tangent can be obtained ii. x2 – 4x + y2 – 6y = 4
once the gradient of the radius is known. This is L.H.S. = ?, R. H. S = 4
because, the radius is perpendicular to the Substitute T(x, y) = T(6, 4)
tangent at the point of tangency. As a result, 62 – 4(6) + 42 – 6(4) = 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
general form: ax + by + c = 0, because the
2fy = - 6y
tangent is a straight line.
f = -3
Center = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (2, 3)
Steps:
1. Identify the equation of the circle in the
ii. x2 – 4x + y2 – 6y = 4
form: x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0, the center of
LHS = ?, R. H. S = 4
the circle (-g, -f) = (x1, y1) and a point on the
Substitute T(x, y) = T(6, 4)
circle as (x2, y2).
62 – 4(6) + 42 – 6(4) = 4
2. Find the gradient of the radius through the
L.H.S. = R. H. S
points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) using = Therefore the point T(6, 4) lies on the circle.
3. Obtain the gradient of the tangent as:
=– iii. Diagram
3. Substitute the coordinates of the point of C(2, 3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
g=-4
C(4, -1) m=–
2fy = 2y Now, substitute x2 = 4, y2 = 3 and m = –
f=1 P(3, 2)
y – y2 = m (x – x2)
Center = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (4, -1)
y–3= (x – 4)
C(4, -1) and P(3, 2) 4(y – 3) = - 3(x – 4)
⇒ x1 = 4, y1 = 1, x2 = 3, y2 = 2 4y – 12 = - 3x + 12
( ) 3x + 4y – 12 – 12 = 0
= = = -3
3x + 4y – 24 = 0
Hence, the gradient of the tangent at P, m = The equation of the tangent is 3x + 4y – 24 = 0
Now, substitute x2 = 3, y2 = 2 and m =
4. Find the equation of the tangent to the circle
y – y2 = m (x – x2)
x2 + y2 – 6x + 4y + 5 = 0 at the points where it
y – 2 = (x – 3) meets the x – axis.
3(y – 2) = (x – 3)
3y – 6 = x – 3 Solution y
x – 3y – 3 + 6 = 0 x2 + y2 – 6x + 4y + 5 = 0
x – 3y + 3 = 0 2g = - 6
Therefore, the equation of the tangent to the g=-3
circle at (3, 2) is x – 3y + 3 = 0
2f = 4
x
3. Find the equation of the tangent to the circle f=2
x2 + y2 + 4x + 10y – 71 = 0 at the point P(4, 3).
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
y=0
8. Find the points where the circle x2 + y2 − 10x
Exercises 14.9 − 10y + 40 = 0 and the line y + 2x = 10
A. Verify that the given points lie on the intersect. Find the equation of the tangent to the
respective circles and find the equation of circle at each of the points of intersection. Find
the tangent to the circles at the given points. the point of intersection of these two tangents.
1. x2 + y2 + 2x – 2y – 8 = 0 (2, 2)
2 2
2. x + y + 2x + 4y – 12 = 0 (3, -1) Challenge Problems
2 2
3. x + y – 8x – 2y = 0 (3, 5) 1. Find the equation of a circle with center
2 2
4. x + y + 6x – 2y = 0 (0, 0) (- 4, 7) which has the x – axis as a tangent
2 2
5. 2x + 2y – 8x – 5y – 1 = 0 (1, -1)
2 2
6. x + y − 6x − 8y − 49 = 0 P(-2, -3) 2. Write down the equation of a circle that has
x = - 4 , x = 8, y = - 2 and y = 10 as tangents.
B. 1. A circle has the equation x2 + y2 − 4x − 8y
− 5 = 0. Write down the equation of the tangent 3. Show that the points (7, 12), (-3, -12), and
to this circle at the point A(-3, 4). (14, -5) lie on a circle with a centre (2, 0)?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
l2 = d2 – r2 2
Put in l = ,( ) ( ) - – r2
l2 = ,(8 ) ( ) - – 52
But d2 = (x – a)2 + (y – b)2
l2 = ,( ) ( ) - – 52
l2 = ,( ) ( ) - - r2
l2 =36 + 4 – 25
Substitute the values of (x, y), (a, b) and r to
l2 = 40 – 25
obtain l, the length of the tangent.
l2 = 15
By simple algebraic manipulation, the l=√
length, L, of the tangent is calculated by : l = 3.87 units
L=√
2. Find the length of the tangents to the circle
x2 + y2 – 8x + 10y + 5 = 0 from the point (5, 7).
Worked Examples
1. Find the length of the tangents from the point
Solution
(8, 2) to the circle x2 + y2 – 4x – 8y – 5 = 0
x2 + y2 – 8x + 10y + 5 = 0
Compared to x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
Solution
2gx = - 8x
x2 + y2 – 4x – 8y – 5 = 0
g=-4
Compared to x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
2fy = 10y
2gx = - 4x
f=5
g = -2
2fy = - 8y Centre = (a, b) = (- g, - f) = (4, -5)
f=-4 But c = 5
c = a2 + b2 – r2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
l2 = ,( ) ( ) - – 36
2
l =1 + 144 - 36 eqn (1) now becomes;
l2 = 145 – 36 x2 – 6x + 25 + 5 = x 2 – 2x + 10
l2 = 109 x2 – 6x + 30 = x2 – 2x + 10
l=√ - 6x + 30 = - 2x + 10
l = 10.44 units -6x + 2x = 10 – 30
- 4x = -20
3. The tangent to the circle x2 + y2 – 2x – 6y + 5 x=5
= 0 at the point (3, 4) meets the x – axis at M. But distance of M from C;
Find the distance of M from the center of the d2 = x2 – 2x + 10
circle.
Put in x = 5
Solution d2 = 52 – 2(5) + 10
From x2 + y2 – 2x - 6y + 5 = 0 d2 = 25 – 10 + 10
2gx = -2x d2 = 25
g = -1 d=√
2fy = - 6y d=5
y = -3
Center = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (1, 3) Exercises 14.10
Find the length of the tangent from the given
But from the equation of the circle; points to the following circles;
c = 5, a = 1, b = 3 1. x2 + y2 + 4x – 6y + 10 = 0 (0, 0)
⇒a2 + b2 – r2 = c 2 2
2. x + y + 6x + 10y – 2 = 0 (-2, 3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Tangent
m= = =
⇒ Gradient of normal =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. Find the equation of the tangent and normal Exercises 14.11
1. Find the equation of the tangent and normal
to the circle x2 + y2 – 8x + 6y + 8 = 0 at the
to the circle x2 + y2 – 4x – 10y – 71 = 0 at the
point (3, 1)
point (10, 11).
Solution
2. Find the tangent and normal line to the circle
x2 + y2 – 8x + 6y + 8 = 0
x2 + y2 = 5 at the point (-2, 1).
2gx = -8x
g=-4
3. Find the tangent and normal line to the circle
2fy = 6y
x2 + y2 – 6x – 10y – 82 = 0 at the point k (-1, -5).
f=3
center = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (4, -3)
Condition of Tangency
This simply refers to the condition for a line to
Gradient of radius through C(4, -3) and P(3, 1)
be a tangent to a circle.
x1 = 4 and y1 = -3, x2 = 3 and y2 = 1
( )
m= = = =-4 A. Circle centered at the origin O (0, 0)
A line touches a circle if the distance, d of the
⇒ gradient of tangent =
center of the circle to the line is equal to the
radius, r of the circle. That is d = r.
Substitute x1 = 4 and y1 = -3 and m = in The distance of the center (0. 0) of the circle
y – y1 = m(x – x1) x2 + y2 = r2 from the line Ax + By + C = 0 or
y – (-3) = (x – 4) y = mx + c is given by;
4(y + 3) = x – 4 d=r= √
……….(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) ( ) 1. Show that the line 3y = 2x – 8 is a tangent to
D=r= √ the circle x2 + y2 – 4x – 6y = 0
( ) ( )
D=r=
√( )
Solution
r=√
3y = 2x – 8 (Straight line)
r(√ )=c x2 + y2 – 4x – 6y = 0 (circle)
From the 3y = 2x – 8
Squaring both sides; y= -
, (√ )- = c2
⇒m= and c =
r2(m2 + 1 ) = c2
This is the condition for the line y = mx + c to
be a tangent to the circle x2 + y2 = r2 From x2 + y2 – 4x – 6y = 0
c=0
B. Circle centered at (a, b) 2g = - 4
Circle centered at (a, b) has the general g = -2
equation (x – a)2 + (x – b)2 = r2.
Here, the distance of the circle center (a, b) to 2f = - 6
the line – mx + y – c = 0 must be equal the f = -3
radius of the circle. (-g, -f) = (a, b) = (2, 3)
Similarly, from y = mx + c;
y – mx – c = 0 But a2 + b2 – r 2 = c
- mx + y – c = 0 compared to Ax + By + C 22 + 32 – r 2 = 0
A = - m, B = 1 and C = - C 4 + 9 = r2
Substitute in equation (1) r2 = 13
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution T1 = x – and T2 = x+
-3x + y + 1 = 0
y = 3x – 1 Points Inside , On or Outside a Circle
Gradient of the line , m = 3 To find whether a point is inside, on or outside
Gradient of tangent = a circle:
From x2 + y2 – 6x – 4y + 3 = 0
Method 1
2gx = - 6x
Calculate the distance from the center to the
g = -3
point and compare this distance to the radius.
2fy = - 4y
Three cases arise;
f = -2
1. Distance from the center, to the point is less
than the radius.
Center of circle = (a, b) = (-g, -f) = (3, 2)
c = a2 + b2 – r2
But c = 3, (a, b) = (3, 2)
⇒ 3 = 32 + 22 – r2
r2 = 9 + 4 – 3 2. Distance from the center , to the point is
r2 = 10 equal the radius.
Tangency condition;
r2(m2 + 1 ) = (b – ma – c )2
Substitute r2 = 10, m = - , (a, b) = (3, 2)
Exercises 14.12
A. In each of the following determine
Method 2 whether the given point is inside, on or
If the coordinates of a point satisfies the outside the given circle.
equation of a circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0, 1. (3, -2), x2 + y2 = 13
then the point is on the circle. Otherwise the 2. (5, 3), (x – 3)2 + (y – 2)2 = 20
point is either inside or outside the circle. By 3. (4, -1), x2 + y2 + 6x – 4y – 3 = 0
substituting the coordinates into the equation of 4. (-1, 5), x2 + y2 + 4x – 6y – 25 = 0
a circle, one of the following equations may 5. (4, 3), x2 + y2 – 4x + 2y – 15 = 0
6. (-1, 4), x2 + y2 + 10x – 6y + 21 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
arise:
1. L.H.S < RHS, the point is inside the circle.
2. LHS = RHS, the point is on the circle. B. 1. The equation of a circle with radius length
3. LHS > RHS, the point is outside the circle. 4 is x2 + y2 – 6x + 2y + k = 0. Find the value of
k, k Z
Worked Examples
Determine whether the points (-3, -2) (5, -1) 2. The equation of a circle with radius length 6
and (-2, 1) are inside, on or outside the circle is x2 + y2 – 2kx + 4y – 7 = 0, k Z.
x2 + y2 – 2x + 8y – 8 = 0 i. Find the centre of the circle and the radius
length in terms of k.
Solution ii. Find the values of k.
Method 2
x2 + y2 – 2x + 8y – 8 = 0 3. The equation of a circle with radius length 5
is x2 + y2 + 2x – 4ky + 12 = 0, k Z. Find the
Substitute (-3, -2) values of k
(-3)2 + (-2)2 – 2(-3) + 8(-2) – 8
= 9 + 4 + 6 – 16 – 8 4. A(k, 1) and B(-7, -k) are the end points of the
= -5 < 0 dianmeter of circle C. If the centre of C is (2,
Therefore, (-3, -2) is inside the circle -5) , find the value of k and the radius length of C.
Substitute (5, -1) 5. A(-2, 0) and B(6, 2) are points of a circle of
(5)2 + (-1)2 – 2(5) + 8(-1) – 8 center C(2k, k).
= 25 + 1 –10 – 8 – 8 i. Express in term of k:
=0 a. | | b. | |
Therefore, (5, -1) is on the circle.
Note:
If the equation of the line is in the form x = a,
substitute the value of a in the circle equation.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
y=x+1
Solution
x2 + y2 + 18x + 20y + 81 = 0……(1)
y = x + 1………………………..(2)
In this case, there is only one point of
intersection Put eqn (2) into equation (1)
x2 + (x + 1)2 + 18x + 20 (x + 1) + 81 = 0
3. The line misses the circle. x2 + x2 + 2x + 1 + 18x + 20x + 20 + 81 = 0
2x2 + 40x + 102 = 0
x2 + 20x + 51 = 0
(x + 3) (x + 17) = 0 (Factorization)
x + 3 = 0 or x + 17 = 0
In this case, there is no point of intersection. x = -3 or x = -17
Regardless of the case, the three situations can Put x = -3 in eqn (2)
be verified algebraically using the substitution y = -3 + 1= -2
method. (x, y) = (-3, -2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put y = -10 in eqn (1)
x2 + (-10)2 + 18x + 20(-10) + 81 = 0 (5x – 1) (x – 3) = 0 (Factorization)
x2 + 100 + 18x – 200 + 81 = 0 ⇒x = or x = 3
x2 + 18x – 19 = 0 (Factorization)
x=1 Put x = in eqn (2);
The point of intersection is (x, y) = (1, -10)
y = 2( ) + 1 =
3. Show whether or not the line y = -x + 3 (x, y) = ( , )
intersects with the circle x2 + y2 + 18x + 20y +
81 = 0
Put x = 3 in eqn (2);
y = 2(3) + 1 = 7
Solution
(x, y) = (3, 7)
x2 + y2 + 18x + 20y + 81 = 0……(1)
Therefore the line intersects the circle at the
y = - x + 3………………………..(2)
points ( , ) and (3, 7)
Put eqn (2) into eqn (1);
x2 + (-x + 3)2 + 18x + 20 (- x + 3) + 81 = 0 Exercises 14.13
x2 + x2 – 6x + 9 + 18x – 20x + 60 + 81 = 0 A. Find the coordinates of the point, or
2x2 – 8x + 150 = 0 points of intersection of the given line and
x2 – 4x + 75 = 0 circle. State wheteher or not the line is a
Since the equation cannot factorize, find the tangent to the circle.
discriminant; 1. x – 3y = 0, x2 + y2 = 10
b2 – 4ac 2. x + 3y – 5 = 0, x2 + y2 = 5
= (- 4)2 – 4(1) (75) 3. x + 2y – 5 = 0, x2 + y2 = 10
B. 1. Show that the line 3y = 2x – 8 is a tangent It is also possible that one circle may be inside
to the circle x2 + y2 – 4x – 6y = 0 and determine another as shown;
the point of contact.
3. Find the point of intersection of the circle Unlike the point of intersection of a straight
with the line given their equations (x – 2)2 + (y line and a circle, it is not possible to substitute
+ 3)2 = 4 and 2x + 2y = -1. one equation into the other. Instead, length is
investigated to see whether the two circle meet
C. 1. Show that the line y = -3x – 10 is a
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
or not.
tangent to the circle equation circle x2 + y2 – 8x
+ 4y – 20 = 0 and find the point of contact. If one circle has radius R and a second has
radius r and the distance between their centers
2. Show that the line y = 2x + 1 does not
is d, then;
intercept the circle with equation x2 + y2 – 2x +
1. If d > R + r , then the two circles do not
4y + 1 = 0
intersect.
3. i. A circle has center (a, 0), a > 0 and radius
4 units. Write down the equation of the circle.
ii. Show that if y = x is a tangent to the circle,
then a = 4√ .
2. If d = R + r, the two circles intersect in one
point.
4. A circle with center (5, 6) touches the line
2y + 3x. Find the equation of the circle.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put x = 1 – y in eqn (1); 2x + 8 y = 7 + 3 + 8
(1 + y)2 + y2 – (1 + y) + y = 4 2x + 8 y = 18
1 + 2y + y2 + y2 – 1 – y + y = 4
2y2 + 2y = 4 x + 4y = 9 (Reduced )
2y2 + 2y – 4 = 0 Make x the subject to obtain;
y2 + y – 2 = 0 x = 9 – 4y
(y + 2) (y – 1) = 0 Put x = 9 – 4y in eqn (1)
y = - 2 or y = 1 (9 – 4y)2 – 4(9 – 4y) + 4 + y2 – 6y + 9 = 9
81 – 72y + 16y2 – 36 + 16y + 4 + y2 – 6y = 0
Put y = - 2 or y = 1 in x = 1 + y 17y2 – 62y + 49 = 0
When y = - 2,
x = 1 – 2 = -1 Solving by quadratic formula;
√ √
y= = 2.49 or y = = 1.16
When y = 1,
x=1+1=2 Substitute y = 2.49 and y = 1.16 in x = 9 – 4y
The points of intersection are (- 1, 2) and (2, 1)
When y = 2.49, x = 9 – 4(2.49) = - 0.96
2. Find the point of intersection of the circles
given by the equations (x – 2)2 + (y – 3)2 = 9 When y = 1.16, x = 9 – 4(1.16) = 4.37
and (x – 1)2 + (y + 1)2 = 16
Therefore, the two points of intersection of the
Solution two circles are (- 0.96, 2.49) and (4.37, 1.16)
(x – 2)2 + (y – 3)2 = 9
Loci
If a point moves on a plane satisfying some
geometrical conditions, then the path traced out
by the point is called its locus, plural loci.
Conditions Locus is determined when some geometrical
1. If two circles are cut orthogonally, then it conditions are given. Likely, the conditions of
must satisfy the following condition:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
all points on the locus will satisfy the given
2 +2 = + geometrical conditions.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 14.15
(x – x1)2 + (y – y1)2 = r2 1. Show that the equation of the locus of a point
that moves in such a way that its distance from
2. The equation of the locus of a moving point a fixed point (3, -1) is 6 units, is given by x2 +
P(x, y) which is always at a constant distance y2 – 6x + 2y – 26 = 0
(r) from a two fixed point (x1, y1) and (x2, y2)
with a ratio m : n respectively is: 2. Find the equation of the locus of a moving
( ) )
= point P(x, y) which is always at a distance of 5
( ) ( )
units from a fixed point Q(2, 4)
3. The equation of the locus of a moving point
P(x, y) which is always equidistance from two Locus of a Point Equidistance from Two fixed
fixed point A(x1, y1) and B(x2, y2) is the Points
perpendicular bisector of the straight line AB, Worked Examples
such that AP = PB or PA = PB 1. Find the equation of the locus of a moving
point which is always equidistance from the
Steps in finding plane loci: points (2, -1) and (3, 2). What curve does the
1. Choose a coordinate system that will make locus represent?
computations and equations very simple.
2. Identify the given conditions and write it in Solution
mathematical form involving the coordinates Let the point be P(x, y), A(2, -1) and B(3, 2).
(x, y). PA = PB
3. Simplify the resulting equations. Since we need /AP/ and /PB/ in terms of x and y;
4. Identify the shape of the equation if the need
be. PA2 = PB2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(Divide through by 2;)
Solution
Let the point be P(x, y), A(-2, 1) and B(3, -2)?
x + 3y – 4 = 0
PA = PB
The equation of locus of P is x + 3y – 4 = 0
Express /AP/ and /PB/ in terms of x and y;
This represents a straight line.
PA2 = PB2
2. Find the equation of locus of point P which
PA2 = (x + 2)2 + (y – 1)2
moves so that it is equidistance from two fixed
PA2 = x2 + 4x + 4 + y2 – 2y + 1
points A and B whose coordinates are (3, 2) and
PA2 = x2 + y2 + 4x – 2y + 4 + 1
(5, -1).
PA2 = x2 + y2 + 4x – 2y + 5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. Find the equation of the locus of a moving 9PB2 = PA2
point P(x, y) which is always equidistance from
points A(-2, 3) and B(4, -1). 9PB2 = 9[(x – 5)2 + (y – 1)2]
= 9[x2 – 10x + 25 + y2 – 2y + 1]
6. A is the point (2, -5) and B is the point (4, = 9[x2 + y2 – 10x – 2y + 26]
-9). Find the mid-point of AB and the locus of = 9x2 + 9y2 – 90x – 18y + 234
the point equidistant from A and B. = 9x2 + 9y2 – 90x – 18y + 234
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= x2 + y2 + 4y + 4 Perpendicular to PB, where A and B are
= x2 + y2 + 4y + 4 constants
Worked Examples
But 4PA2 = PB2 1. A point P(x, y) moves so that AP and BP are
⇒ 4x2 + 4y2 – 16x + 16 = x2 + y2 + 4y + 4 perpendicular. Given A(3, 2) and B(- 4, 1) Find
4x2 – x2 + 4y2 – y2 – 16x – 4y + 16 – 4 = 0 the equation of the locus of P.
3x2 + 3y2 – 16x – 4y + 12 = 0
Solution
Since the product of slopes of perpendicular
Exercises 14.17
lines is -1,
1. P is a moving point such that its distances
from the point A(2, 5) and B (0, 3) is in the ratio . /. / = -1
2 : 1. Find the equation of locus P. ( )( )
( )(
= -1
)
(y – 2)(y – 1) = - (x – 3)(x + 4)
2. Given A(5, -2) and B(2, 1) are two fixed
y(y – 1) – 2(y – 1) = - [x(x + 4) – 3 (x + 4)]
points Point Q moves such that the ratio of AQ
: QB = 2 : 1. Show that the equation of locus of y2 – y – 2y + 2 = - [x2 + 4x – 3x – 12]
the point Q is x2 + y2 – 2x – 4y – 3 = 0 y2 – 3y + 2 = - [x2 + x – 12]
y2 – 3y + 2 = - x2 – x + 12
x2 + y2 + x – 3y + 2 – 12 = 0
3. A and B are two given points whose
coordinates are (-5, 3) and (2, 4) respectively. A x2 + y2 + x – 3y – 10 = 0
point moves in such a manner that PA : PB = 3
: 2. Find the equation of the locus traced out by Locus of a Point p(x, y) that is always at a
P. What curve does it represents? Constant Distance Units from a given Line
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x – 2 = 0 or x – 8 = 0 Let the point be P(x, y), A(1, 0) and B(-1, 0)
x = 2 or x = 8 (Two vertical lines) By the given condition;
PA – PB = 2
2. Find the locus of a point which is PA = 2 + PB
equidistance from the origin and the line x = -1.
PA2 = (2 + PB)2 (Square both sides)
Solution PA2 = 4 + 4PB + PB2
Let the point be P(x, y), A (0, 0) and B(-1, y) PA2 – PB2 – 4 = 4PB……..(1)
By the given condition,
PA = PB PA2 = (x – 1)2 + (y – 0)2
PA2 = PB2 PA2 = x2 – 2x + 1 + y2
PA2 = x2 + y2 – 2x + 1
PA2 = (x – 0)2 + (y – 0)2
PA2 = x2 + y2 PB2 = (x – 1)2 + (y – 0)2
PB2 = x2 + 2x + 1 + y2
PB2 = (x + 1)2 + (y – y)2 PB2 = x2 + y2 + 2x + 1
PB2 = x2 + 2x + 1 + 0
PB2 = x2 + 2x + 1 PA2 – PB2
PA2 = x2 + y2 – 2x + 1 – [x2 + y2 + 2x + 1]
But PA2 = PB2 PA2 = x2 + y2 – 2x + 1 – x2 – y2 – 2x – 1
⇒x2 + y2 = x2 + 2x + 1 PA2 = - 4x
x2 – x2 + y2 = 2x + 1
y2 = 2x + 1 Now, substitute PA2 – PB2 in eqn (1)
Therefore, the locus of the points is y2 = 2x + 1 ⇒- 4x – 4 = 4PB
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
By the given condition,
PA2 + PB2 = 26
PA2 = (4 – PB)2 (square both sides)
2 2
PA = 16 – 8PB + PB PA2 = (x + 2)2 + (y – 0)2
PA2 – PB2 – 16 = -8PB……..(1) PA2 = x2 + 4x + 4 + y2
PA2 = x2 + y2 + 4x + 4
PA2 = (x – 1)2 + (y – 0)2
PA2 = x2 – 2x + 1 + y2
PB2 = (x – 2)2 + (y – 0)2
PA2 = x2 + y2 – 2x + 1
PB2 = x2 – 4x + 4 + y2
PB2 = (x – 1)2 + (y – 0)2 PB2 = x2 + y2 – 4x + 4
PB2 = x2 + 2x + 1 + y2
PB2 = x2 + y2 + 2x + 1 But PA2 + PB2 = 26
⇒ x2 + y2 + 4x + 4 + x2 + y2 – 4x + 4 = 26
PA2 – PB2 2x2 + 2y2 + 8 = 26
PA2 = x2 + y2 – 2x + 1 – [x2 + y2 + 2x + 1] 2x2 + 2y2 = 26 – 8
PA2 = x2 + y2 – 2x + 1 – x2 – y2 – 2x – 1 2x2 + 2y2 = 18
PA2 = - 4x x2 + y2 = 9
The locus of the point is x2 + y2 = 9
Now, substitute PA2 – PB2 in eqn (1)
⇒- 4x – 16 = -8PB Exercises 14.20
⇒(- 4x – 16)2 = (-8PB)2 (Squaring both sides) 1. Find the locus of a point which moves so that
16x2 + 128x + 256 = 64PB2 the sum of the squares of its distances from the
16x2 + 128x + 256 = 64(x2 + y2 + 2x + 1) point (3, 0) and (-3, 0) is always equal to 50.
16x2 + 128x + 256 = 64x2 + 64y2 + 128x + 64
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. Simplify the resulting equations. Therefore, the locus of the point P is;
4. Identify the shape of the equation if the need 3x2 + 3y2 – 2x + 4y – 5 = 0 (circle)
be.
3. Find the equation of the locus of the point
Worked Examples which moves so that its distance from (4, -3) is
1. A point moves in such a manner that three always one – half its distance from (-1, -1).
times of its distance from the x – axis is greater
by 7 than 4 times of its distance from the y – Solution
axis. Find the equation of its locus. Let the point be P(x, y), A(4, - 3) and B(-1, -1)
By the given condition;
Solution PA = PB
Let the point be P(x, y),
2PA = PB
Then by the given conditions, the distance of P
(2PA)2 = PB2
from the x – axis is:
4PA2 = PB2
3x = 4y + 7
3x – 4y – 7 = 0 (circle)
4PA2 = 4[(x – 4)2 + (y + 3)2]
= 4(x2 – 8x + 16 + y2 + 6y + 9)
2. Find the locus of a point P, whose distance
= 4(x2 + y2 – 8x + 6y + 25)
from A(-1, 2) is twice its distance from the
= 4x2 + 4y2 – 32x + 24y + 100
origin.
PB2 = (x + 1)2 + (y + 1)2
Solution
= x2 + 2x + 1 + y2 + 2y + 1
Let the point be P(x, y), A(-1, 2) and B(0, 0)
= x2 + y2 + 2x + 2y + 2
By the given condition;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
its distance from the point A(-2, 0) is three 5. The difference of its distances from (3, 0)
and (-3, 0) is 2.
Meaning of a Parabola √( ) = x + a.
It is the set of all points (x, y) in a plane that are
the same distance from a fixed line, called Squaring both sides gives;
directrix and a fixed point or focus not on the (x − a)2 + y2 = x2 + 2ax + a2,
directrix. or
x2 − 2ax + a2 + y2 = x2 + 2ax + a2.
The Standard Equation of a Parabola This reduces to:
A parabola is the path traced out by (or “locus” y2 = 4ax
of) a point, P, whose distance, SP, from a fixed This is called the standard equation of a
point, S, called the “focus”, is equal to its parabola with “vertex” at the origin, focus at
perpendicular distance, PM, from a fixed line, l, (a, 0) and axis of symmetry along the x-axis.
called the “directrix”.
All other versions of the equation of a parabola
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
M P which shall be considered is based on this
version.
S
l Note
(i) If a is negative, the bowl of the parabola
For convenience, take the directrix, l, to be a faces in the opposite direction towards negative
vertical line - with the perpendicular onto it x values.
from the focus, S, being the x-axis. The y – axis
can be taken to be the directrix itself, but the (ii) Any equation of the form y2 = kx, where k is
equation of the parabola turns out to be simpler a constant, represents a parabola with vertex at
using a different line; namely the line parallel the origin and axis of symmetry along the x-
to the directrix passing through the mid-point of
axis. It‟s focus will lie at the point . , /; it is
the perpendicular from the focus onto the
directrix. This point is one of the points on the worth noting this observation for future
parabola so that the curve can pass through the reference.
origin. y
P Other Forms of the Equation of a Parabola
M
(a) Vertex at (0, 0) with focus at (0, a)
x y
S(a, 0)
x = -a
l (0, a)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Find the equation of a parabola with focus at
With reference to the original axes, therefore, (0, 4) and vertex at (0, 0)
the parabola has equation:
(y − k)2 = 4a(x − h). Solution
Vertex at (0, 0) and focus at (0, 4)
Notes: Distance between the vertex and focus
(i) Such a parabola will often be encountered in | | = √( ) ( )
the expanded form of this equation, containing | |=√
quadratic terms in y and linear terms in x. | |=4
Conversion to the stated form by completing
the square in the y terms will make it possible Vertex at (0, 0) and focus at (0, 4) implies that
to identify the vertex and focus. the parabola opens up on the y – axis. The
equation of the parabola is given by:
(c) Vertex at (h, k) with focus at (h, k + a) x2 = 4ay
y x2 = 4(4)y
x2 = 16y
(h, k + a)
k 2. Find the equation of a parabola with vertex at
(h, k) ) (0, 2) and focus at (0, 6)
x
Solution
Vertex at (0, 2) and focus at (0, 6)
Considering a temporary change of origin to the
Distance between the vertex and focus
Vertex at (0, 2) and focus at (0, 6) means that 2. Find an equation for the parabola with focus
the parabola opens up on the y – axis at (-8, - 4) and vertex at (6, - 4)
The equation of a parabola with vertex at (h, k) 3. If a parabolas vertex is at (4, -2) and its
is given by : (x – h)2 = 4a(y – k) focus at (4, 4), write the equation of this
parabola.
Vertex at (h, k) = (0, 2) ⇒ h = 0, k = 2
By substitution, the equation of the parabola is 4. Find the equation of the parabola whose
(x – 0)2 = 4(4)(y – 2) coordinates of vertex and focus are (-2, 3) and
(1, 3) respectively.
x2 = 16(y – 2)
x2 = 16y – 32
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Equation of a Parabola given Focus and
Directrix
3. Find the equation of a parabola with vertex at 1. The equation of a parabola with focus (a, b)
(-2, -2) and focus at (-2, -8). and directrix y = c is
(x – a)2 + b2 – c2 = 2 (b – c) y
Solution
Vertex at (-2, -2) and focus at (-2, -8). 2. The equation of a parabola with focus (a, b)
and directrix x = c is
Distance between the vertex and focus
(y – b)2 = (x – c)2 – (x – a)2
| | = √( ) ( 8 )
| |=√ Worked Examples
| |=6 1. If the focus of a parabola is (2, 5) and the
directrix is y = 3, find the equation of the
The vertex and the focus are on the same parabola.
vertical line x = -2, with focus below the vertex.
Therefore, the parabola opens downward, so Solution
a = - 6. Its equation is given by: Focus = (2, 5) = (a, b) , ⇒ a = 2, b = 5
(x – h)2 = 4a(y – k) Directrix y = 3, ⇒ c = 3
The equation of a parabola with focus (a, b)
Vertex at (h, k) = (-2, -2) ⇒ h = -2, k = -2 and directrix y = c is given by :
By substitution, the equation of the parabola is (x – a)2 + b2 – c2 = 2 (b – c) y
(x – (-2)2 = 4 (-6) (y + 2)
By substitution;
(x + 2)2 = -24 (y + 2)
(x – 2)2 + 52 – 32 = 2 (5 – 3) y
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The equation of a parabola with focus (a, b)
and directrix x = c is 2. x2 = 4ay; vertex at (0, 0) with focus at (0, a)
(y – b)2 = (x – c)2 – (x – a)2
3. (y − k)2 = 4a(x − h), vertex at (h, k) with
By substitution, focus at (h + a, k)
The equation of a parabola with focus (a, b) when a > 0, the parabola opens to the
and directrix x = c is right
(y – 0)2 = (x – 2)2 – (x – 8)2 when a < 0, the parabola opens to the
y2 = x2 – 4x + 4 – [x2 – 16x + 64] left.
y2 = x2 – 4x + 4 – x2 + 16x – 64
y2 = 12x – 60 4. (x − h)2 = 4a (y − k), vertex at (h, k) with
focus at (h, k + a)
Exercises 15.2 when a > 0, the parabola opens up.
1. Write an equation for a parabola with focus when a < 0, the parabola opens down
(5, -2) and directrix y = - 5.
Worked Examples
2. Write an equation for a parabola with focus 1. Find the focus and the directrix of the
(-2, 5) and directrix y = 3. parabola y2 = 16x
The directrix is represented as x = - p 4. Find the directrix of the parabola with the
Directrix, x = - 4 equation x2 – 4x + 16y – 76 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Vertex (h, k) = (5, 0)
(x – 2)2 = - 16y + 80
20y = 4ay (x – 2)2 = - 16 (y – 5) ……….(1)
20 = 4a
(x − h)2 = 4a (y − k)…………(2)
a=5
By comparison;
Since a > 0, the parabola upens up.
Vertex = (2, 5)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
That is (-5, -2 + 1). Worked Examples
The focus is then located at (-5, -1) 1. A Parabola y2 = 12x passes through the point
P(3, 6). Find:
Exercises 15.3 i. equation of the tangent;
1. Find the directrix of the parabola with the ii. equation of the normal to the parabola at the
equation (x – 5)2 = 4(y + 1) point P.
4. Find the directrix of the parabola with the The general equation of a tangent is :
equation (y – 4)2 = - 8(x + 1) yy1 = 2a (x + x1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the point . , /
y2 = 6x compared with y2 = 4ax
Solution 6 = 4a
i. Line 2y + 3x – 6 = 0 a= =
parabola y2 = 6x
Equation of the normal is given by;
Point of intersection = (K, M)
2y + 3x – 6 = 0………………..(1) y- = ( )
y2 = 6x………………………..…..(2) ( , ) = . , / and a =
y–2= . /
From eqn (1); . /
3x = 6 – 2y
y–2= . /
x= ……………………(3)
3(y – 2) = . /
From eqn (2); 3y – 6 = - 2x +
x= ………………………..(4) (3) 3y – (3) 6 = - (3) 2x + (3)
9y – 18 = - 6x + 4
eqn (3) = eqn (4); 9y + 6x – 18 – 4 = 0
= 6x + 9y – 22 = 0
3y2 = 6(6 – 2y )
Sequence un = a + (n − 1)d
A sequence is a collection of numbers arranged un = 15 + (n − 1)(-3)
in a definite order, connected by a simple rule. un = 18 − 3n.
For example, perfect squares are listed as 1, 4, The n-th term is un = 18 − 3n.
9, 16, 25, 36…Other examples of sequences are
even numbers: 2, 4, 6,.. odd numbers: 1, 3, 5… 2. Determine the n-th term of the arithmetic
progression 8, 8.125, 8.25, 8.375, 8.5, ...
Series
When the numbers or terms of a sequence are Solution
added or considered as a sum, it is called a 8, 8.125, 8.25, 8.375, 8.5, ...
series. Thus we have a series of even number as a = 8 , n = ? d = 8.125 – 8 = 0.125
2 + 4 + 6 + 8… and the series of odd numbers un = a + (n − 1)d
as 1 + 3 + 5 + 7 … un = 8 + (n − 1)(0.125)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
un = 7.875 + 0.125n.
A series may end after a definite number of The n-th term is un = 7.875 + 0.125n.
terms. Such a series is called a finite series. e.g.
2 + 4 + 6 + 8. On the other hand, a series may 3. The 13th term of an arithmetic progression is
not end and it is then called an infinite series. 10 and the 25th term is 20; calculate:
e.g. 2 + 4 + 6 + 8… a. the common difference;
b. the first term;
Arithmetic Progressions c. the 17th term.
The “sequence” of numbers, a, a + d, a + 2d,
a + 3d, ... is said to form an “arithmetic Solution
progression”. a. Letting a be the first term and d be the
common difference,
The symbol a represents the “first term”, the a + 12d = 10……………..(1)
symbol d represents the “common difference” a + 24d = 20……………..(2)
and the “n-th term” is given by the expression
eqn (2) – eqn (1);
Un = a + (n − 1)d
12d = 10,
Worked Examples d= =
1. Determine the n-th term of the arithmetic
progression 15, 12, 9, 6,... b. Put d = in eqn (1);
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Common difference, d;
By changing the subject to n, the number of
1– = -1 terms of an A.P, given the last term can be
( ) calculated.
=
= Worked Examples
= Determine the number of terms in the sequence;
5, 11, 17….77 and hence find the 30 the term.
(m – 1) (m + 2) = m (4 – m)
m2 + 2m – m – 2 = 4m – m2
Solution
m2 + m – 2 = 4m – m2
5, 11, 17….77
m2 + m2 + m – 4m – 2 = 0
a = 5, d = 6 , L = 77
2m2 – 3m – 2 = 0
=5+6(n–1)
(m – 2) (2m + 1) = 0
=5+6n–6
m = 2 or m = = 6n–1
⇒ 6 n – 1 = 77
Exercises 16.1
1. Write down the first five terms of the A.P. But =L
with first term 8 and common difference 7. 6n = 77 + 1
6n = 78
2. Write down the first five terms of the A.P.
n = 13 terms
with first term 2 and common difference - 5.
= 6 (30) – 1
3. What is the common difference of the A.P.
= 179
11, - 1, - 13, - 25, . . . ?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(x1 , y1) and (x2, y2) , put in m =
Set y = mx + c
3. Substitute the values of m and (x1 , y1) in
(x1 = 7, y1 = 17) and (x2 = 20, y2 = 82) , put in
equation y = mx + c to obtain the value of the
intercept on y – axis. m=
4. Substitute the values of m and c in y = mx + c. m= –
5. Now, let = y and n = x. Then by
substitution, = mn + c, where m and c are m=
constants. m=5
Solve the resulting system: 2. Find the common difference, first term
eqn (2) – eqn (1) and nth term rule for the arithmetic sequence in
19d – 6d = 82 – 17
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put d = -2 in eqn(1)
a + 10(-2) = -13 thirtieth term is - 54?
a = -13 + 20 ii. Use the above information to find the value
a=7 of . /
Put a = 7 and d = -2 in = a + (n − 1)d 4. Find the nth term rule for the arithmetic
= 7 + (n − 1)(-2) sequence with = 23 and = 65. Hence
= 7 – 2n + 2 determine the value of the sum of and .
= – 2n + 7 + 2
= – 2n + 9 6. Find a fifth of the sum of and of the
arithmetic sequence with = - 3n + 7 and
ii. = – 2n + 9 = - 3n −16
= – 2(26) + 9
= – 52 + 9 7. Find the nth term and the nineth term for the
= – 43 arithmetic sequence whose sixth term is
−13 and fifteenth term is - 40.
Exercises 16.2
A. Use the two given terms to find Inserting Arithmetic Means
an nth term rule for the sequence. The arithmetic mean of two numbers a and b is
1. = 23 and = 85 defined as . This is also called the average
2. =-6 and =-3
of a and b.
3. = 24 and =9
4. = - 27 and = - 47
The three numbers a, , b form a
5. = 37 and = 85
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
2d] + [a + d] + a……………….(2)
Let the three arithmetic means between 2 and 9
be , and such that the arithmetic (finite)
Adding the two equations gives
sequence is: 2, , , , 9
2Sn = [2a + (n − 1)d] + [2a + (n − 1)d] + ... +
[2a + (n − 1)d] + [2a + (n − 1)d],
From the sequence, first term a = 2 and =9
where, the R.H.S, are n repetitions of the same
= a + (n – 1) d
expression. Hence,
9 = 2 + (5 – 1) d
2Sn = n[2a + (n − 1)d]
9 = 2 + 4d
Sn = [2a + (n − 1)d]..……………(a)
9 – 2 = 4d
7 = 4d
This version of the formula is suitable if the
d=
values of a, n and d are known;
An alternative version can also be used if only
=a+d=2+ = the first term, the last term and the number of
= +d= + = terms are known. In this case,
Sn = [FIRST + LAST]
= +d= + =
Sn = [a + l ]…………………….(b)
Exercises 16.3 which is simply n times the average of the first
1.Insert three arithmetic means between 2 and 10. and last terms.
2. Insert 3 arithmetic means between 3 and -5. Comparing equations (a) and (b);
l = a + (n − 1)d
Solution
Sn = (a + ℓ)
a = 1 and l = 100 (last term), n = 100
The sum is given by : S41 = (1 + 101)
Sn = [FIRST + LAST] S41 = (102)
Sn = [1 + 100] S41 = 41 × 51
Sn = 5050. S41 = 2091 .
2. Find the sum of all odd numbers between 4. Find the sum of the first 50 terms of the
100 and 200? sequence 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, . . . .
Solution
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1, 3, 5, 7, 9, . . . .
101,103,105...........199
a = 1 , d = 2 , n = 50 .
a = 101 d = 2 = l = 199
= a + (n – 1)d Sn = [2a + (n − 1)d]
199 = 101 + (n – 1) 2 S50 = [2(1) + (50 − 1)2]
199 – 101 = (n – 1) 2 S50 = 25 × (2 + 49 × 2)
=n–1 S50 = 25 × (2 + 98)
49 + 1 = n S50 = 2500 .
n = 50
5. Find the sum of the series + 3 + + …+
= (a + l)
Solution
= (101 + 199)
+ 3 + + …+
= 25 × 300
= 7,500 a= ,d=3- = ,l= .
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Sn = [2a + (n − 1)d]
= [a + (a + 9d)]
= [2a + (12 − 1)d] = 5 [a + a + 9d]
= 6[2a + 11d] = 5 [2a + 9d]
= (a + (3 − 1)d
Sum of first ten terms = (Sum of next ten terms;)
= a + 2d
But =7 5 [2a + 9d] = ( , - )
a + 2d = 7 ………………………..(2) (2a + 9d) = ( )
2(2a + 9d) = ( )
eqn (2) × 2;
4a + 18d = 2a + 29d
2a + 4d = 14……………………..(3)
4a – 2a = 29d – 18d
2a = 11d
eqn (2) – eqn (3);
a= d………………………………..(1)
11d – 4d = 28 – 14
8d = 16
d=2 Also, 100th term is 95
= a + 99d
Put d = 2 in eqn (2) But = 95
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
First term is 5 and the common difference is i. How many terms are there in the sequence?
ii. If the even numbers are removed from the
Exercises 16.4 sequence, calculate the sum of the terms of the
1. Find the sum of the first 23 terms of the A.P. remaining sequence.
4, - 3, - 10, . . ..
4. Consider the arithmetic sequence:
2. An arithmetic series has first term 4 and - 8, - 2, 4, 10…
common difference 1. Find: i. Write down the next four terms of the
i. the sum of the first 20 terms, sequence
ii. the sum of the first 100 terms. ii. If the nth term of the sequence is 148,
determine the value of n.
3. Find the sum of the arithmetic series with iii. Calculate the smallest value of n for which
first term 1, common difference 3, and last the sum of the first n terms of the sequence will
term 100. be greater than 10140.
4. The sum of the first 20 terms of an arithmetic 5. Given the arithmetic sequence:
series is identical to the sum of the first 22 y – 3, 2y – 4 and 23 – y
terms. If the common difference is - 2, find the i. Determine the value of y.
first term. ii. Find the sum of the first 26 terms of the
sequence.
Exercises
1. 3x + 1, 2x and 3x – 7 are the first three terms 6. The first three terms of an arithmetic
of an arithmetic sequence. sequence are 2k – 7, k + 8 and 2k – 1.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
504 = n [20 + 2n − 2] Sn = [2a + (n − 1)d]
504 = n [18 + 2n ]
S8 = [2(3) + (8 − 1)d]
504 = 18n + 2n2
n2 + 18n − 504 = 0 S8 = 4 (6 + 7d)
n2 + 9n − 252 = 0 S8 = 24 + 28d
(n – 12) ( n + 21) = 0
n = 12 or n = - 21 (Ignore negative answer) S5 = [2(3) + (5 − 1)d]
n = 12 S5 = (6 + 4d)
S5 = 15 + 10d
2. Find the number of terms of the arithmetic
series 4 + 6 + 9 + 11 ... needed to make a
Given the fact that S8 = 2S5,
total of 126. 24 + 28d = 2(15 + 10d )
24 + 28d = 30 + 20d
Solution 28d – 20d = 30 – 24
a = 4 and d = 6 - 4 = , Sn = 126, n = ? 8d = 6
Sn = [2a + (n − 1) d]. d= =
126 = [8 + (n − 1)].
4. The first and third terms of a linear sequence
252 = n [ 8 + n − ]. (A. P.) are 25 and 19 respectively. If the sum of
252 = 8n + n2 − n ] all the terms in the sequence is 82, calculate the
number of terms in the sequence.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2d = - 6 42n = 840
d = -3 n = 20
The number of terms is 20.
a = 25 and d = -3, Sn = 82, n = ?
Sn = [2a + (n − 1) d]. ii. The common difference;
82 = [50 + (n − 1) × (-3)] Put n = 20 in eqn (1);
164 = n [50 - 3n + 3] 2a + (20 − 1) d = 42
164 = n (53 - 3n) 2a + 19 d = 42…………………(iii)
164 = 53n – 3n2
3n2 – 53n + 164 = 0 The second term is 4;
(n – 4) (3n – 41) = 0 =4
n = 4 or 3n – 41 a + d = 4……………………….(iv)
n = 4 or 3n = 41
n = 4 or n = (Ignore n = ) Solving eqn (iii) and (iv);
2 × eqn (iv)
n=4
2a + 2d = 8……………………..(v)
5. The sum of the first and last terms of a linear eqn (iii) – eqn (v);
sequence (A. P.) is 42. If the sum of all the
17d = 34
terms is 420 and the second term is 4, find: d = 2.
i. number of terms; The common difference is 2
ii. common difference;
iii. last term of the sequenece. iii. The last term of the sequence;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Form two equation from the two given terms
Solution
using the equation = a + (n − 1)d
= a + (n − 1)d
2. Solve the two equations simultaneously to
= a + (13 − 1)d
obtain the values of a and d.
3. Substitute the values of a and d obtained in
But = 27
Sn = [a + (n − 1) d]
⇒a + (13 − 1)d = 27
a + 12d = 27…………………..(1)
Worked Examples
1. The 6th and 12th terms of a linear sequence The seventh term is three times the second
(A.P.) are 17 and 42 respectively find the sum =3
of the first 20 terms. a + (7 − 1)d = 3[ a + (2 − 1)d ]
a + 6d = 3( a + d )
Solution
a + 6d = 3a + 3d
= 17
6d – 3d = 3a – a
a + 5d = 17………………………..(1)
3d = 2a
= 41
a + 11d = 41……………………….(2) a= ………………………..(2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. What is the nth term rule for the sequence
Exercises 16.5
represented by this situation?
A. 1. The third term of an arithmetic series is
ii. What is the outstanding balance after the 20th
34 and the 17th term is - 8. Find the sum of the
payment?
first 20 terms.
Solution
2. Find the common differencse of an A.P.
= 17,500 and = 12,000 =?
whose first term is 5 and the sum of the first
four terms is half the sum of the next four For the nth term of an A.P of two given tems,
terms. Set y = mx + c
(x1 = 5, y1 = 17,500) and (x2 = 16, y2 = 12,000)
3. The sum of the first 13 terms of an A.P. is 21
, put in
and the sum of the first 21 terms is 13. Show
m=
that the sum of the first 34 terms is -34
, ,
m= –
= = − 500
4. An A.P. is given by k, , , 0, . . ..
i. Find the sixth term. Use the point (x1 = 5, y1 = 17,500) to find
ii. Find the n th term. the y-intercept:
iii. If the 20th term is equal to 15, find k. 17,500 = - 500 (5) + c
17,500 = − 2,500 + c
5. The first and second terms of an arithmetic 17,500 + 2,500 = c
sequence are 10 and 6 respectively. c = 20,000
i. Calculate the 11th term of the sequence;
Put m = − 500 and c = 20,000 in y = mx + c
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a = 2.70 , d = 0.15, n = 250 Exercises 16.6
The cost of the last metre is the 250-th term of 1. A contest will have 5 cash prizes totalling
the series and therefore Ghȼ5,000.00 and there will be a Ghȼ100.00
un = [a + (n − 1) d]. difference between successive prizes. Find the
U250 = [2.70 + (250 – 1) × 0.15] first prize.
Sn = Ghȼ5,343.75
3. A body falls 8m in the first second of its
motion, 24 meters in the second, 40 m in the
3. A man started a project with Ghȼ1,160.00. If
third and so on. Howlong will it take to fall
he increases this value with Ghȼ450.00 every
2048 meters?
month until he last invested Ghȼ1,7760.00,
calculate the total amount he invested in the
4. A factory produced 1,100 cars in the third
project at the time he invested Ghȼ1,760.00
year and 2,700 cars in the eleventh year.
Assuming production increases by a fixed
Solution
number every year, find the production of cars
a = 1,160, d = 40 , l = 1,740
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked Examples
7. Ataa Afua repays her total loan of
1. Determine the n-th term of the geometric
Ghȼ118,000.00 by paying every month starting
progression 3, - 12, 48, - 192, ...
with the first instalment of Ghȼ1,000.00 If she
increased the instalment by Ghȼ100.00 every
Solution
month,
a = 3, r = = - 4, n = 7
i. what amount will be paid by her in the 30th
n−1
instalment? = ar
ii. what amount of loan does she have to pay = 3(- 4)n−1
after the 30th instalment? The progression has n-th term, = 3(- 4)n−1
8. A sum of Ghȼ700.00 is tob used to give 7 2. Determine the seventh term of the geometric
cash prizes to students of a school for their progression 3, 6, 12, 24, ...
overall academic performance. If each price is
Ghȼ20.00 less than its preceeding prize, fins the Solution
value of each of the prizes. a = 3, r = = 2, n = 7
= arn−1
9. A woman takes up a job of Ghȼ8,000.00 per
= 3( )
month with an annual increment of Ghȼ100.00 6
= 3(2 )
What will she earn over a period of 10 years?
= 192.
10. The houses on Bantama high street are The seventh term is 192.
made in such a way that they all lie in one row.
The houses are numbered consecutively from 1 3. The third term of a geometric progression is
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and common ratio 1.
U9 =
2. Find the 10th and 20th terms of the G.P. with U9 =
first term 3 and common ratio 2. But U9 = 256
3. Find the 7th term of the G.P. 2, - 6, 18, . . ., ⇒ 256 = ………………..(2)
4. Find the 12th term of the geometric sequence eqn (2) ÷ eqn (1);
-1, 2, - 4, 8… =
5. Find the 7th term of the geometric sequence 16 =
2, , , … r= √
r=2
6. The first term of a G. P. is 2 and the
commom ratio is 3. Find the 5th term. Put r = 2 in eqn (1);
7. The first term of a G. P. is 16 and the 16 = ( )
commom ratio is . Find the 4th term. 16 = 16a
a=
Finding a and r of a G.P. from Two given a=1
Terms The first term is 1 and the common ratio is 2
Given the values of two terms of a G. P. the
first term, a, and the common ratio, r, can be b. The seventh term,
calculated as follows: U7 =
I. Identify the values of the given terms. U7 =
U8 = . /
2. The third and sixth terms of an exponential
sequence are and respectively. Find: U8 =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. Un =
⇒ = ar2……….(1) U2 =
U2 = ar
U6 = But U2 = 9
U6 = ar5 ⇒ 9 = ar ……….(1)
But U6 =
U4 =
⇒ = ar5……….(2)
U4 = ar3
But U4 = 4
eqn (2) ÷ eqn (1); ⇒4= ……….(2)
÷ =
eqn (1) ÷ eqn (2);
=
=
. / =
=
⇒r =
r=√ =
Put r = into eqn (1);
ii. Put r = into eqn (1);
= a. /
9= (a)
= a
4a = 4 9 × 3 = 2a
a=1 a= = 13.5
The first term is 1 and the common ratio is Therefore the first term is 13.5
2. The sixth term of a G.P is 25 and the eighth This version of the formula is most commonly
term is 6.25. Write the first five terms of the used when r < 1 .
geometric sequence.
The alternative version of this formula is :
3. Find the 8th term of a geometric sequence ( )
Sn = and it is most commonly used
whose 3rd term is and whose 6th term is
when r > 1.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. Consider the geometric sequence: 4, -2, 1 … Note:
i. Determine the next three terms of the Either version of the formula may be used with
sequence. disregard to the value of r.
ii. Determine n, if the nth term is
Worked Examples
5. A geometric sequence has = 20 and = 1. Find the sum of the geometric series
40. Determine: 2 + 6 + 18 + 54 + . . . where there are 6 terms in
i. the common ratio and the first term. the series.
ii. a formula for
Solution
a = 2, r = 3 and n = 6.
Geometric Series ( )
If the terms of a geometric progression are Sn =
added together, a “geometric series” is ( )
Sn =
obtained. ( )
Sn =
The total sum of a geometric series with n Sn = − (-728)
terms may be denoted by Sn such that Sn = 728 .
Sn = a + ar + ar2 + ar3 + ... + arn−1…..(1)
2. Find the sum of the geometric series
Like the arithmetic series, this is not the most 8 − 4 + 2 − 1 + . . . where there are 5 terms in
practical formula for evaluating Sn. the series.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Find the sum of the first four terms of the
4. The 3rd term of a geometric series with a
geometric sequence that begins with 1 and a
positive common ratio is 18 and the fifth term
common ratio of 3.
is 162. Find:
i. the common ratio;
ii. the sum of the first ten terms. Geometric Means
If A and C are positive real numbers, then a
positive number B is called the geometric mean
Solution
of A and C if ABC is a geometric sequence.
= 18 and = 162
=
If the commom ratio is r, then :
=
= r= =
18 = ……………………..(1) ⇒ B2 = AC
Taking the square root of both sides, the
= geometric mean of the positive number A and C
= is √ .
162 = ……………………..(2)
In general, k real numbers B1, B2 …Bk are k
eqn (2) divided by eqn (1); geometric means between A and C, if A, B1, B2
= …Bk, C is a geometric series.
9 = r2
Worked Examples
r=√ 1. If 20, A and 45 form a geometric sequence,
r=3 find the value of A.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
lg 1.1n > lg3 (take logarithms of both sides)
512.
n lg 1.1 = lg 3
n=
Finding the Number of Terms of G. P.
For all finite geometric progressions; n = 11.5267 . . .
Un = arn−1 = L The smallest whole number value of n is 12.
Where L is the last term of the sequence.
3. What is the smallers number of terms of the
Worked Examples geometrical progression, 8 + 24 + 72 + …, that
1. How many terms are there in the geometric will give a total greater vthan 6,000,000?
progression 2, 4, 8, . . . , 128 ?
Solution
Solution 8 + 24 + 72 + …,
a = 2 and r = 2, Un = 128. a = 8 and r = 24 ÷ 8 = 3
Un = arn−1
128 = 2 × 2n −1 To find the smallest value of n such that
64 = 2n −1 Sn > 6,000,000.
26 = 2n −1 Sn =
( )
6=n−1 ( )
n=7. > 6,000,000
( )
There are 7 terms in this geometric progression. > 6,000,000
4( ) > 6,000,000
2. How many terms in the geometric , ,
progression 1, 1.1, 1.21, 1.331, . . . will be 3n – 1 >
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
with first term 3 and common ratio 1.5.
d = 0 or d – 14 = 0
3. How many terms in the G. P; 4, 3.6, 3.24,... d = 0 or d = 14 (ignore d = 0)
are needed so that the sum exceeds 35? d = 14
4. The sum of the first 3 terms of a geometric 2. The 2nd , 4th and 8th terms of an arithmetric
sequence (A. P.) form three consecutive terms
series is . The sum of the first six terms is
of a geometric sequence.The sum of the third
. Find the first term and common ratio. and fifth terms of the A.P. is 20. Find:
i. the first four terms;
5. The first term of a G. P is 3 and the eight ii. the sum of the first ten terms of the
term is 384. Find the common ratio, the sum arithmetic sequence.
and the product of the first 8 terms.
Solution
6. Calculate the product of the first five terms = a + (n – 1) d
of the sequence 3, 6, 12, … =a+d, = a + 2d, = a + 4d and
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
d= For a G.P, common ratio;
r= =
d=
r= =
⇒a=
= a, = a + d, = a + 2d and
(a + 4d) (a + 4d) = a ( a + 9d)
= a + 3d
(a + 4d)2 = a ( a + 9d)
a2 + 8ad + 16d2 = a2 + 9ad
= , 16d2 = 9ad – 8ad
= + =5 16d2 = ad
16d = a…………………………..(1)
= + 2. / =
= + 3. / = 10 Sum of 2nd and 8th term trems of the AP is 30
+ = 30
The first four terms of the A.P. are: , 5, , 10
⇒ (a + d) + (a + 7d ) = 30
a + d + a + 7d = 30
ii. = , ( ) - 2a + 8d = 30
n = 10, a = , and d = , a + 4d = 15 …………………(2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
II. Use the appropriate formula whether ( )
> 20,000
( )
= or Sn = 200 (1 – 4n) > - 60,000
,
(1 – 4n) > -
Worked Examples
1 – 4n > - 300
1. The expenses of a company are
1 + 00 = 4n
Ghȼ200,000.00 a year. It is decided that each
301 = 4n
year they shall be reduced by 5% of those for
lg 301 > lg 4n
the preceding year. What will be the expenses
lg 301 > n lg 4
during the fourth year, the first reduction taking
place at the end of the first year ? n>
n > 4.1168
Solution n=5
Geometric progression with a = 200,000 and His saving would first exceed Ghȼ20,000.00 in
r = 0.95. the fifth month.
=
Exercises 16.11
The expenses during the fourth year will thus 1. Every year, a gardner takes 4 runners from
be the fourth term of the progression; each of his one year old strawberry plants in
= 200,000 ×(0.95)4 – 1 order to form 4 additional plants. If he starts
= 200,000 ×(0.95)3 with 5 plants, how many new plants will he
= Ghȼ171,475.00 take at the end of the 6th year and what will
then be his total number of plants ?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the amount of vegatables the truck transport geometric series 5 − 1 + – …
increased 15% per day. What is the total
amount of vegetables the truck transport every Solution
week, to the nearest whole number. 5 − 1 + –…
a = 5, r =
5. In 2013, the number of student in a small
school was 284. It is estimated that the student The sum to infinity is
population will increased by 4% every year. = = = = = = 4.17
. / ⁄
i. Write a formula for the student population.
ii. Estimate the student population in 2020.
2. Find the sum to infinity of the geometric
6. Jack has purchased 20 books. The first book progression 1, , , …
cost Ghȼ 1.00, the second cost Ghȼ2.00, the
third Ghȼ4.00, the fourth Ghȼ8.00 and so on. Solution
How much did Jack pay for the 20 books? 1, , , …
a = 1 and r = for −1 < r < 1
Challenge Problems
1. A superball is dropped from a height of 10m. = = = =
⁄ ⁄
At each rebound, it rises to a height which is
90% of the height from which it has just fallen. 3. The sum to infinity of an exponential
What is the total distance through which the sequence is 9. If the second term is 2, find the
ball will have moved before it finally comes to values of :
rest ? i. the first term
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
25(1 – r) = a
a = ………………….(2)
a = 25 – 25r ………………(1)
eqn (1) = eqn(2); The sum of the first two terms is 16;
9 – 9r = + = 16
9r – 9r2 = 2
9r2 – 9r + 2 = 0 But = arn−1
(3r – 1) (3r – 2) = 0 =
r= or r = =a
=
Put r = in eqn (1) =
a = 9 – 9. / = ar
a=6
+ = 16
Therefore, when a = 6, r = ⇒ a + ar = 16……………….(2)
r=√ = Put x = 5 in r =
r= = =
( )
Put r = in eqn (1);
c. For an infinite exponential sequence;
a = 25 – 25. / = 25 – 15 = 10
=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Now a = 10 and r = , = arn−1
Given a = (2x – 1) = 2(5) – 1 = 9 and r =
i. = . / = = =
⁄ ⁄
= . / = . /= = 27
( ) Exercises 16.12
ii. =
1. Find the sum to infinity of the G.P. with first
( . / *
term 3 and common ratio .
= = 189.3990
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and = + 5, find . = =3+
=3+
Solution
= +5 =3+1
=3 =4
= = +5 Common difference, d = –
= +5 d=4–1=3
=3+5
= , ( ) )-
=8
= , ( ) ( ) )-
= = +5
=5, ( )-
= +5
=8+5 =5, -
= 13 = 145
Solution Solution
=3 –4 = 2n2 – n – 1
=3 = 2(n – 1)2 – (n – 1) – 1
= 2(n2 – 2n + 1)2 – n + 1 – 1
= =3 –4
= 2n2 – 4n + 2 – n + 1 – 1
=3 –4
= 2n2 – 4n – n + 2 + 1 – 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
recurrence relation = + for n =
2, 3, 4, …and suppose that = 3 and = 5. = = = =1
What are the values of and ?
2. Express 0.1 ̇ as an infinite geometric series
3. Let { } be a sequence that satisfies the and find the sum of the geometric series.
recurrence relation = + 3 for n = 1, 2,
3, 4, …and suppose that = 2 , what rae the Solution
values of , and ? 0.1 ̇ = 0.1666666…
= 0.1 + 0.06 + 0.006 + 0.0006 + …
4. Let { } be a sequence that satisfies the = + + + ….
recurrence relation = – for n =
2, 3, 4, … and suppose that = 3 and = 5. From the series, the term after form a
What are the values of and ?
geometric series; with a = and
Recuring Decimals as Geometric Series r= ÷ =
A geometric series converges to
if | |< 1. This means that the common ratio of Sum of the geometric series ;
the geometric series should be less than one, ⁄ ⁄
= = =
else the series will not converge. ⁄ ⁄
0.1 ̇ = + =
Steps:
1. Express the recurring decimal as a sum in the 3. Convert 0. ̇ ̇ to an infinite converging
decimal or fractional form. geometric series.
= and r = ÷ = Solution
The total output, in cedis, for subsequent years
Sum of the geometric series ; = 25000 × 0.75 + 25000 × (0.75)2 + 25000 ×
⁄ ⁄
= = = = (0.75)3 + ...
⁄ ⁄
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution If the general term of a series with n terms is
0.45 + 0.0045 + 0.000045 + known, then the complete series can be written
= + + +… down in short notation as indicated by the
, , ,
following illustrations:
1. a + (a + d) + (a + 2d) + ... + (a + [n − 1]d)
The series is an infinite series with a = and
= ( , - )
r= ÷ =
,
2. a + ar + ar2 + ...ar n−1 =
Notes:
Exercises 16.14
I. It is sometimes more convenient to count the
A. Find the sum of the following infinite
terms of a series from zero rather than 1.
geometric series, if it exist.
For example:
1. 1.5 + 0.015 + 0.00015 + … 3. , …
a + (a + d) + (a + 2d) + ......a + [n − 1]d
2. 8 + 4 + 2 + 1 … 4. 0. 3 ̇ ̇
= ( ) and
5. 1+ + +… 6. 0. ̇ ̇
a + ar + ar2 + ar3 + ......ar n−1 =
B. 1. Calculate the fraction that is equivalent to
0.181818…. In general, for a series with n terms starting at u0,
2. What fraction that is equivalent to 3. 2777… + + + +…+ =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=0 which are either arithmetic progressions or
geometric progressions:
2. Evaluate . / 1. 40, 29, 18, 7, ...; 2. , , 7, ...;
3. 5, 15, 45, ...; 4. 10, 9.2, 8.4, ...;
Solution
5. 81, −54, 36, ...; ; 6. , , …..
. /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
called the base and m is called the index or 1. Least prime factors of 32 = {2}
exponent or power and it is read as “a 32 = 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 = 25
exponent m” or “a to the power of m”.
2. Least prime factors of 81 = {3}
Laws of indices 81 = 3 × 3 × 3 × 3 = 34
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. Simplify, 6 4
3. , 4. ( )
6 4 4 2
Solution 5. ( ) ( )
=
= 8–0 10 – 9 Zero Power of a Natural Number
Study the pattern below carefully with
= 28 × 9
reference to the division rule:
am ÷ an = am – n
4. Evaluate 24
Solution
=
= 8–0 10 – 9
= 28 × 9
= 256 × 9
= 2,304
Since the value of = 1, it follows
that , so (a≠0)
5. Simplify
Worked Examples
Solution Simplify the following;
= = × = × 1.
Worked Examples
2. 0
1. Evaluate ⁄
Solution Solution
4 × 690 = 4 × 1 = 4 ⁄
=( ) ⁄
= = 3 × 3 × 3 = 27
Exercises 17.2 ⁄
Evaluate each of the following: 2. Evaluate . /
1. 2.
Solution
11 0 ( ) ⁄ ( ) ⁄
3. 4. (8 8 8) 8 ( ⁄ ) ⁄
=( =( = =
) ⁄ ) ⁄
6 4 5 5
5. Show that; (13 ) ( )=1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. Simplify ( )
Rational Indices
By the law of indices, Solution
⁄ ⁄ ⁄ ⁄
………….(1) ( ) =
2 × 2 = 4…………………..(2) = ( ) ⁄
×( ) ⁄
=2×7
Comparing eqn (1) and eqn (2)
⁄
=2
4. Evaluate ( )
⁄
But √ = 2. Therefore, we define as the
square root of 4 written as√ = ⁄ Solution
⁄ ⁄
⁄
( ) =
In general,√ = ⁄ ⁄
⁄ = ( ) × ( )
For e.g.√ = ⁄ ( ) =3
=3×5
⁄ ⁄ ⁄
= 15
Similarly, = =a
⁄
We define as the cube root of a written ⁄ ⁄
⁄ 5. Evaluate
as; √ =
⁄ Solution
In general, √ = Method 1
⁄ ⁄
For e.g. √ =( ) =3 ⁄ ⁄ ( ) ⁄ ⁄ ( )
⁄
= = = = =
⁄
Generally, if is taken to be the nth root
⁄
Method II
of , then =√
1. 2. 3.
Worked Examples
1. Express as a negative index.
ii. Write the following in exponent form;
1. √ 4 2. √ 5 3. √ 6
Solution
B. Find the values of the following: 1. =
⁄
1.8 4. ( 8) 7.
2. 5. 8 8. 2. Write in the form
⁄ ⁄
3. 6. 9.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
C. Evaluate the following; = = =
⁄ ⁄ ⁄
1. . / 2. . / 3. . /
⁄ ⁄ ⁄ 3. Simplify
4. . / 5. . / 6. . /
7. 8. (8 ) Solution
= = = =
Find x if
1. (x + 1)5 = 243 2. (x – 1)5 = ⁄8) ⁄
4. Find the value of (
and = 2 ⁄ ⁄
⁄ ( )
(8⁄ ) = ⁄ = = =
( ) ⁄
By substitution,
1 = = and therefore, is taken to ⁄
5. Find the value of . /
be equal to
Similarly, = = , where is the Solution
⁄
reciprocal of . / = (8 ) ⁄
=( ) ⁄
=3
In general,
Exercises 17.4
More Examples A. Express as negative exponents;
Simplify the following without calculator: 1. 2. 3.
1. + +8 2. 4. = 3x 5. 6.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. ( ) 4. 1. . / 2. . / 3. . /
⁄ ⁄ ⁄
4. . / 5. . / 6. . /
Solution
1. + +8 C. Find the values of the following;
⁄
=( ) +( ) +( ) 1. 2. 8 ⁄ 3. ⁄
⁄
= 52 + 23 + 2 – 2 4. ⁄
5. ⁄
6. ⁄
= 25 + 8 +
D. Simplify the following;
= 25 + 8 + ⁄ ⁄ ⁄ ⁄
1. 5.
= 33 + 2. ⁄
8 ⁄
6. ⁄ ⁄
= 33 ⁄ ⁄ ⁄ ⁄
3. ⁄ 7. ⁄
⁄ ⁄ ⁄ ⁄
2. 4. ⁄ 8. ⁄ ⁄
( ) ( )
= = = + = 1 + = Exponential Equations 1
( ) An equation involving powers of numbers, is
called an exponential equation. For example,
3. ( ) 8, are exponential equations.
=. / =. / =. / = =
The steps in solving exponential equations are;
⁄
Solution 5. Solve . / – . / =0
=
Solution
= (Equating exponents)
⁄
3x – 1 = -1 . / – . / =0
3x = - 1 + 1 – ⁄
=0
3x = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )
– =0
x=0
( )
– =0
2. Solve for x given that = 49 ( )
=
-3x = - (Equating exponents)
Solution
-3x× 2 = - × 2 (Multiply through by 2)
2 -6x = -3
(Equating exponents)
x=
3 x=
( )
3. If = 256, determine the value of x 6. Solve =
Solution Solution
= 256 = ( )
2x + 3 = x2 (Equating exponents)
= x2 – 2x – 3 = 0
= (Equating exponents) (x 2 – 3 x) + (x – 3) = 0 (By quadratics formula)
– 5x = 8 x (x – 3) + 1 (x – 3) = 0
x=– (x + 1) (x – 3) = 0
x + 1 = 0 or x – 3 = 0
4. If ×8 , find the value of x x = -1 or x = 3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. . /x = 5. = a2 – 4a – a + 4 = 0
a(a – 4) – 1 (a – 4) = 0
2. . / = 6. . / = . /
(a – 1) (a – 4) = 0
3. 4 × =. / 7. . / = a = 1 or a = 4
4. . / =8 8. . / =. /
But a = 2x
⇒ 2x = 1 or 2x = 2
D. Find the ruth set of the following: 2x = 20 or 2x = 2
1. 82x. . / = .. / x = 0 or x = 1
3. 92x. . / = 27 . ( )
Solution
4. 27 × =8 2(2 + 2x) + 3(2x) – 1 = 0
( )
5. = 22. 22x + 3(2x) – 1 = 0
6. = 0.1× (4) 22x + 3(2x) – 1 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
52x . 31 – 126 . /+1=0
Now,
2x = 1 or 2x = 4
Let a = 5x
When 2x = 1, 5a2 – a+5=0 (Multiply through by 5)
2x = 20, 2
25a – 126a + 5 = 0
x=0
(a – 5) . / = 0 (By factorization)
When 2x = 4, a = 5 or a =
2x = 22,
x=2 But a = 5x
Therefore, x = 0 or x = 2
⇒ 5x = 5 or 5x =
3. Solve 32x + 1 – 28(3x- 1) + 1 = 0 5x = 5 or 5x =
5x = 5 or 5x = 5 – 2
Solution x = 1 or x = -2
32x + 1 – 28(3x- 1) + 1 = 0
32x . 31 – 28(3x . )+1=0 Exercises 17.6
2x 1
3 . 3 – 28 . /+1=0 A. Solve the following equations :
1. 32x – 30 (3x – 2) + 1 = 0
Let a = 3x 2. 32(1+ x) – 3x = 3x + 3 – 3
3a2 – a+1=0 (Multiply through by 3) 3. 22x – 3 – 2x – 2 – 1 = 0
9a2 – 28 + 3 = 0 4. 22x + 2 – 9 (2x) + 4 = 0
1. 32x + 3 – 3x + 2 – 3x + 1 + 1 = 0
2. 22x + 6 – 65(2x + 3) + 64 = 0 Worked Examples
3. 5x – 24 = (52 – x) 1. Express = 16 in logarithmic notation
4. 3x . 9x – 1 = 27
5. 4x + 2x = 23 + x Solution
6. 3x + 1 – 3x – 1 = 24√ In a = ,log b a = c
If = 16, then log2 16 = 4
C. Solve:
⁄
1. 22x – (2x) + = 0 2. Write 8 = in logarithmic form
2. 22x – (2x) + = 0
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x–2 –x
3. 2 – (2 )= If 8 ⁄
= , then log8 = ⁄
4. 4x + 1 + 2x + 1 + . / =
3. Express in index notation log2 32 = 5
5. = 2 – 3x – 1
6. . / . = Solution
If log2 32 = 5, then 32 =
Logarithms
Exercises 17.7
From the calculator, it is seen that the log of
A. Write the following in logarithm form:
100 to the base 10 is 2. This is stated
1. 125 = 4. 0.01 =
mathematically as log10 100 = 2. This means
⁄ ⁄
that 100 = , where 10 is the base and 2 is 2. =7 5. =5
⁄
the index (logarithm). Note that log10 is written 3. = 64 6. =
simply as log.
B. Express in exponential form:
Relating Indices and Logarithms 1. log 4 2 = 3. log 27 3 =
In general, if a = then the logarithm of a is
2. log 5 625 = 4 4. log (0.1 × 108) = 7
expressed as: logb a = cread as“the logarithm of
a to the base b is c” Laws of Logarithms
Thus: Logarithms and their operations are govern by
some basic properties and laws as shown below
If a = , then =c for a, b and x belonging to the set of real
numbers;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. loga1 =0 log 10 1 = 0
loga . / = b – c……………(2)
2. Express log 3 (2z) – log3 x as a single 6. Express lga√ in terms of log of x, y and z
logarithm.
Solution
Solution
log 3 (2z) – log3 x . lga √
= log3 ⁄
= lga . /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
loga(x2 – 1) – loga y – 4 loga z = (2 lga x + 3 lga y – 4 lga z)
) – loga y – loga z4 = lg x + lg y – 2 lg z
= loga(
= loga √ – (loga y + loga z4)
Exercises 17.8
= loga √ – loga (yz4)
A. Express as a single logarithm:
√
= loga 1. log 2 + log 12 – log 6
2. log 3 + log 16 – log 4 – log 6
4. Write loga 6xy3 – 2 loga 3xy2z as a single 3. (log6 4 + log6 9)2
logarithm. 4. (log525 + log5 15 – log5 75)4
5. 4 lg 5 – 2 log 5 + 2
Solution
loga 6xy3 – 2 loga 3xy2z B. Write each as a single logarithm.
= loga 6xy3 – ( loga 3xy2z)2 1. 5 log 4 – 3 log 4 + 1
2. 4 log 2 + log 2 – 1
= log ( ) 3. 3 log 4 + log 4 – 2
= log 4. 3 log 4 – log 4 – 2
√
C. Write each as a single logarithm.
5. Express loga in terms of logarithms of x,
1. lga x – 2 log ay + loga z
y and z.
2. lga 18x2 + 3 log a z – loga 6y
Solution 3. lg a x2y + 2 log a 5xy3 – loga 10 x2 y2
√ ⁄ 4. lga x3 y4 – 2 loga 4 y2z + loga 8 x2yz
loga = loga ( ) – loga z2
3. log a √ 4. log a √
(a + b)2 = 7ab + 2ab
(a + b)2 = 9ab
A common Logarithm a+b =√
A common logarithm is a logarithm of base 10.
This is expressed as log10 but usually written as a+b=( )
log. a+b=3( )
=( )
Proof of Logarithmic Identities
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Equations that are true for all values of the
variable are called identities. Equations with Take log on bothe sides;
lofarithms are logarithmic identities. log . / = log ( )
Solution Solution
loga (x + y ) – loga (x – y ) = loga (x2 – y2) loga (x + 1) – loga 2 = logax
L. H. S. R. H. S
2[log ( ) – log ] = logax
2 2
Consider the L.H.S; loga (x + 1) – loga 2 = logax
loga (x + y ) – loga (x – y ) loga (x + 1)2 – loga 4 = logax
= loga (x + y ) (x – y ) loga (x + 1)2 – loga 4 – logax = 0
( )
= loga (x2 – xy + xy – y2) log =0
= loga (x2 – y2) ( )
= a0
L. H. S = R. H. S
( )
=1
2 2
2. If log a + b = 7ab where a > 0, b > 0. Show (x + 1)2 = 4x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B. 1. Let p = loga x and q = loga y. Express logx = 3 + 2 log2 3
a and logy a in terms of p and q respectively.
Hence, show that logxy a = 2. Simplify log 540
Solution
2. If x = loga (bc), y = loga (ca) and z = loga
log 540 = log5 (5 × 8)
(ab), prove that x + y + z = xyz – 2
= log5 5 + log5 8
= 1 + log5 23
Logarithmic Expressions
= 1 + 3 log5 2
A logarithmic expression is a logarithm
statement that is not equated or does not
Exercises 17.9
contain an equal sign.
Simplify;
1. log372 2. log 363 3. log 5150
To evaluate a logarithmic expression is to find
the value of the expression by applying the 4. log 8120 5. log 2√ 8 6. log √ 8
laws of indices. Hence, answers should not
Type II: Involving Addition and Subtraction
contain the word “log”.
1. Ensure that all the logs are of the same base
2. Express the given expression as a single
To simplify a logarithmic expression is to apply
logarithm of the form log ab.
the laws to the extend that no law is applicable. 3. Go throught the processes of type I to
Hence, a simplified answer should contain the complete simplification, only if a is a factor of b.
4. If a is a not a factor of b, then leave your
word“log”
answer in the form: log ab
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= log210 1. 3 + 5 log ₃ 5
= log2 (2 × 5) 2. log ₃ . / + log ₃ . /
= log2 2 + log 2 5 3. log ₅ 5 + log ₅ 20 – log ₅24 + log ₅ 25 – 3
= 1 + log 2 5 4. 2 log ₄2 + 3 log ₂ 5 – log ₂ 15 + log ₂ 7
( )
3. Simplify log 2 Evaluating Logarithmic Expressions
Type I: Form loga b
Solution Given a logarithmic expression of the form
( ) loga b to determine its value:
log 2 I. Equate the expression to any preferred
= lg 2 (x + y)3 – lg 2 (x2 y2) variable, say x. i.e. loga b = x
= 3 lg 2 (x + y) – [ lg 2 (x2) + lg 2 (y2)] II. Write the logarithmic expression as an
= 3 lg 2 (x + y) – lg 2 (x2) – lg 2 (y2) exponential equation. That is: b =
= 3 lg 2 (x + y) – 2 lg 2 x – 2 lg 2 y III. Express the exponential equation as
equation with a common base, if possible.
4. Simplify 3log2(x) – 4log2(x + 3) + log2(y). IV. If not possible, take the log on both sides of
the equation. log b = log
Solution V. Simplify the variable side of the equation.
3log2(x) – 4 log2(x + 3) + log2(y) i.e.log b = x log a
= log2(x3) – log2 (x + 3)4 + log2(y) VI. Make the variable the subject and work out
= log2(x3) – log2(x + 3)4 + log2(y) to obtain the value of the variable. i.e. x=
= log2 (x3) + log2(y) – log2 (x + 3)4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Let log2 64 = x 5. Evaluate log3 27√
64 =
= (equating exponents) Solution
x=6 Let log3 27√ = x
27√ =
3. Evaluate log381 × =
=
Solution
Method 1 =
log3 81 x=
= log334
6. Find the value of log 5
= 4 × × log3 3, (log3 3 = 1)
=4× ×1 Solution
=2 log 5
= log 5
Method 2 = log 5 ( )
log381 = log 5
= log38 ⁄ = - 2 log 5 5
⁄ =-2×1
= log3 ( )
=-2 (Try an alternative method)
= log3 9
Solution E. Evaluate :
log 9 1. 3. = 10x
2. 4. = 50 –
Let log 9 = x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. Solve for the value of the variable in the
=( ) = 23 = 8 exponential equation as in type I.
Solution
D. Evaluate to 2 significant figures: Method 1
1. log √ 3. log √ log 6 (4 × 9)2
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 488
log 6 (36)2
= log . / – log . / +log . /
log 6 1296
= log . / – log . / + log . /
Let log 6 1296 = y
1296 = = log . /
log1296 = log = log . /
log1296 = y log ,
= log . /
y=
= log 1010
y=4 =1
Method 2
5. Without using Mathematical tables or
2 log 6 (4 × 9)
calculators , simplify;
= 2 log 6 36
= 2 log 6 62 log10 . / – 2 log10 . / + log10. /
= 2 × 2 log
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=2×2×1 Solution
=4 log10 . / – 2 log10 . / + log10. /
⁄
3. Evaluate log 4 9 + log 4 21 – log 4 7 log10 . / – log10. / + log10. /
log10 . / – log10 . / + log10. /
Solution
log 4 9 + log 4 21 – log 4 7 lg . /
= log 4 . / lg . /
= log 4 27 lg ( )
lg 10
Let log 4 27 = x
⇒
Exercises 17.12
log 27 = log
Find the values of the following:
log 27 = x log 4
1. log√ + log√ – log√
x=
2. log 6 24 + log 6 15 – log 6 10
x = 2.3775 3. log 7 98 + log 7 30 – log 715
4. log 3 – log 15 + log 50
4. Evaluate without using tables or calculators: 5. log 5 + log 16 – log 4 – log 10
log 10. /– 2 log 10. / + log 10. /
Division of Logarithms
Solution To simplify expressions involving division of
log 10. / – 2 log 10. / + log 10. / logarithms
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Simplify –
3. (log 16 − log 2) † log 2 4.
Solution
√
5. 6.
√
√
Make log 6 – log 2 a single log
⇒log . / Solving Exponential Equations
= log 3 In an exponential equation, when the exponent
Substitute in place of log 6 – log 2 of a number at a side of the equation is a
variable, as in 3x = 2
⇒
I. Take the log on both sides of the equation.
= = II. Simplify the variable part of the equation.
III. Make the variable the subject and work out
(evaluate) to obtain the value of the variable to
3. Simplify the given approximation.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
representation.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
2x – 27(2 – x) = 6
6(9x) + 3x – 1 = 0
6(32x) + 3x – 2 = 0
Solution
Let 3x = a
2x – 27(2–x) = 6
6a2 + a – 2 = 0 (Factorization)
2x – 27. =6
a = or a = (Ignore a = )
Let 2x = a
x
When 3 =
a– = 6a
x
lg 3 = lg a2 – 6a – 27 = 0
x lg 3 = lg , (a – 9) (a + 3) = 0 ( Factorization)
a = 9 or a = -3 (Ignore a = - 3)
x=
x = - 0.63 (2 d.p) Now,
Therefore, x = - 0.63 2x = 9
x lg 2 = lg 9 (Take log on both sides)
3. Solve for x, given 33x – 3(x + 1) – 3x + 3 = 0 x=
x = 3.12 (2.d.p)
Solution
33x – 3x.3 – 3x + 3 = 0
5. Solve the equation = 3 and
Let a = 3x
a3 – 3 a – a + 3 = 0 approximate the answer to three significant
a3 – 4 a + 3 = 0 figures.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⇒ 5x = 3 + √ Solution
log 5x = log (3 + √ ) 23x – 6(22x) + 11(2x) – 6 = 0
x log 5 = log (3 + √ ) Let 2x = a
( √ ) a3 – 6a2 + 11a – 6 = 0
x= (a – 1) (a – 3) (a – 2) = 0
x = 1.1299 a = 1 or a = 3 or a = 2
x = 1.23 (3 s.f) 2x = 1 or 2x = 3 or 2x = 2
Exercises 17.15 2x = 1
A. Find the solution to 2 decimal places 2x = 20
where appropriate x =0 or
1. 5x + 125( ) = 30
2. 3( ) + 9( ) = 28 2x = 3 (Different bases)
x
3. 4 – 3( )=8 lg 2x = lg 3 (Take log on both sides)
x
4. 2 – 6( )=6 x lg 2 = lg 3
2x x
5. 2 + 4(2 ) – 32 = 0 x= 2 or
6. – 12( ) + 27 = 0
2x = 2
Challenge Problems
x=1
1. Find the truth set of 4x + 2 = 3(2x) where x R
Truth set is x = 0 or x = 2 or x = 1
2. Solve :
2. Solve 9(33x) – 91 (32x) + 91 (3x) – 9 = 0
a. = 125 c. = 0.125
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution expression and simplify
23n + 2 - 7 (22n + 2 ) – 31 × 2n – 8 = 0
23n . 22 – 7(22n . 22) – 31 × 2n – 8 = 0 Worked Examples
4(23n) – 28 (22n) – 31 × 2n – 8 = 0 Given that log 2 = 0.3010, find without using
tables or calculators the values of;
Let a = 2n i. log 8 ii. log 8
4a3 – 28a2 – 31a – 8 = 0
. / (a – 8) = 0 Solution
i. log 8 = log
a= or a = 8
= 3 log 2,
a=8 (Ignore negative answer)
Substitute log 2 = 0.3010
n
2 =8 = 3 × 0.3010
2n = 23 = 0.9030
n=3
The truthset is n = 3 ii. log 80 = log ( 8 × 10)
= log 8 + log 10
Exercises 17.16 = log 23+ log 10
A. Find the truthset of the following: = 3 log 2 + log 10
1. 33x – 7 (32x) + 15 (3x) – 9 = 0 = 3 × 0.3010 + 1
2. 43x – 7 (42x) + 8 (4x) + 6 = 0 = 1.9030
Substitutlog 3 5 = 1.465
Solution
⇒2 × 1.465 + 1 + 1.465
log10 x = 0.5 and log10 y = 1.5
= 5.395
x= and y =
⁄
x+y= +
3. If log 5 = 0.6990, find log = 34.8
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
log 600 = log (6 × 100)
= log 6 + log 100
Substitute log 5 = 0.6990 = log 6 + log
= 0.6990 = log 6 + 2 log 10
= 0.4660 = log 6 + 2(1)
= log 6 + 2
Some Solved Past Questions Substitute log 6 = 0.778
1. If log x 3 = 0.5283 and log x7 = 0.9358, find 0.778 + 2 = 2.778
logarithm to base x of ;
i. 27 ii. √ 4. Given that log 10 2 = 0.3010 and log 10 5 =
0.6990, evaluate log 10 50 – log 10 40
Solution
log x3 = 0.5283 and logx7 = 0.9358,
Solution
i. log x 27
log 10 50 – log 10 40
= 3 log x33
= log10 (5 × 10) – log10 (4 × 10)
= 3log x3
= log10 (5 × 10) – log10 (22 × 10)
But log x3 = 0.5283
= log10 5 + log 10 10 – 2 log10 2 + log10 10
⇒ 3 × 0.5283= 1.5849
But log10 2 = 0.3010 and log10 5 = 0.6990
ii. log x√ ⇒ (log5 + log10 ) – (2 log 2 + log 10)
⁄
= log x = (0.6990 + 1) – (2 × 0.3010 + 1)
= log x7 = 1.6990 – 1.6020
= 0.097
But log x7 = 0.9358
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
II. Express the logarithm of b to base c to the
log 10 0.24
logarithm of a to base c as a common ratio to
= log 10 . /
complete the process. i.e. loga b =
= log 10 24 – log 10 100
III. Simplify or evaluate (as stated) where
= log 10 (23 × 3) – log 10 (102)
possible.
= log 10 23 + log 10 3 – log 10 102
= 3 log 10 2 + log 10 3 – 2 log 10 10
Proof
= 3 (0.3010) + (0.4771) – 2 (1)
For y = logb M,
= - 0.6199
⇒by = M in exponential form .
(Take base – a logarithm of both sides)
Exercises 17.17
It follows that loga (b y) = logaM
A. Given that log 2 = 0.3010 and log3 =
( Apply power property of logarithms)
0.4771, find the values (correct to 4 s.f)
y logab = loga M,
1. log √ 3. log 18
2. log 1.5 4. 2 log 21 – log 98 y= (Divide by )
Solution
Exercises 17.18
1. lga 64 =
A. If f(x) = 2 log 5 x , evaluate:
⁄
64 = ( )
1) f(5) 2) f(25) 3) f. / 4) f(√ )
B. Use the change of base method to simplify 642 =
the following; ( ) =
1. log 6 45 2. log2 30 3. log4 128 ( ) =
4. log 1272 5. log8 2 6. log30 100 ( ) =
2
4 =a
C. From the change of base formula, a = 16
evaluate the following:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. log 2 7; 2. log3 0.04;
2. lg4 x =
3. log5 3; 4. 3 log3 2 − log3 4 + log3
x=
Logarithmic Equations x=( )
A logarithmic equation is a logarithm statement x=
that is equated or contains an equal sign. In x=
other words, it is an equation involving
x=
logarithms.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
7. Find x when 6 log (10x) = 30 II. Equate the expressions and solve for the
value of the variable i.e. write the equation in
Solution the form: logb x = logb y ⇒x = y and solve .
log (10x) = 30
Method 2
log (10x) = I. Get a single log in the equation,
log (10x) = 5 II. Change from logarithmic form to
10x = 105 exponential form. i.e. write the equation in the
x= form: log b a = c as a =
x = 10000
Note:
1. Make sure that all logs have the same base.
Exercises 17.19
If necessary, use the change of base law to
A. Find the value of the variable:
1. 2 = lg3 x 5. lga 125 = -3 write logs to the same base
2. 4 = lga 625 6. lg 3 x = - 4
2. Logs are defined for only positive numbers.
3. 3 = lg2 x 7. lg 9 x =
Therefore reject any solution that give rise to
4. lg 4 x = 8. lg x2 = - 4 log (negative number) in the original equation
Solution
3. log √ = 6. log6 (4x + 8) = 2
Method 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
log 2 ( ) = log 28 = 27
x = 33
3
8
x=3
8
( )( ) 2. Solve log (8x + 1) – log (2x + 1) = log (x + 2)
or
or Solution
Reject x = – 2. Therefore, x = 4 log (8x + 1) – log (2x + 1) = log (x + 2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. =1
( )
4. Solve lg3 (1 – x) = lg3 (x + 16 – x2)
5. =5
Solution
lg3 (1 – x) = lg3 (x + 16 – x2) Challenge Problems
(1 – x) = x + 16 – x2 1. Solve the equations:
(1 – x) – (x + 16 – x2) = 0 a. log3 (x – 2) = log3 27 – log3(x – 4) –
1 – x – x – 16 + x2 = 0
b. log2 (x + 3) = log2 (x – 3) – log3 9 –
-2x – 15 + x2 = 0
x2 – 2x – 15 = 0 2. Evaluate without using tables
(x + 3) (x – 5) = 0 (a) log10 27 ÷ log10 3;
x = -3 or x = 5 (b) (log10 16 − log10 2) † log10 2.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
log x (2 – log x ) = 0 x = 1 or x = 10000
log x = 0 or 2 – log x = 0
log x = 0 or log x = 2 ( )
3. Solve =1
x = 100 or x = 102
x = 1 or x = 100 Solution
( )
=1
Method 2
log (x2) = (log x)2 lg2 (9 – 2x ) = 3 – x
log (x × x ) = (log x)2 9 – 2x = 23 – x
log x + log x = (log x)2 9 – 2x =
9 – 2x =
Let log x = a
⇒ a + a = a2
Let y = 2x
2a = a2
a2 – 2a = 0 9–y=
a(a – 2) = 0 9y – y2 = 8
a = 0 or a – 2 = 0 y2 – 9y + 8 = 0
a = 0 or a = 2 (y – 8) (y – 1) = 0
y = 8 or y = 1
⇒log x = 0 or log x = 2
x = 100 or x = 102 ⇒ 2x = 8 or 2x = 1
x = 1 or x = 100 2x =23 or 2x = 20
x = 3 or x = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. 4 log . / + log . / = 2 log x
Solution
2. 2 log x – 2 log (x + 1) = 0
log ( )=2
2
x – 2x – 65 = (5 – x )2 3. log x =
x2 – 2x – 65 = 25 – 10x + x2 4. log ( ) – 3 log (4 – x) = 0
10x – 2x = 65 + 25 5.
( )
=3
8x = 90 ( )
x=
C. Solve:
1. log ( ) + log ( )=1
6. Solve log . √ /=0 2. log x + =2
3. log7 x + log8 7 = 2.5
Solution 4. log ( ) – log ( )=1
log . √ /=0 5. √log + 2 log √ = 2
. √ / = 100 6. log7 2 + log 49 x = log √
. √ /=1
D. Solve:
√ = 1. log16 x + log4 x + log 2 x = 7
⁄ 2. log4(x + 2) . logx 2 = 1
( ) =
3. log x2 – 3 log x = log x2 – 4
( ) = . / 4. (log3 x)2 – log3 x3 + 2 = 0
5. log(log x) = log (log x3 – 2)
= ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
log (5x – y ) = log 9 and log (3x + 2y) = log 8 From eqn ( 1);
x=y–1
Solution
log (5x – y ) = log 9………………..(1) Put x = y – 1 in eqn (2);
log (3x + 2y) = log 8 ………………(2) y2 = 21 + (y – 1)
y2 = 21 + y – 1
Divide both sides by log y2 – y – 20 = 0
5x – y = 9……………(1) (x – 5) (x + 4) = 0
3x + 2y = 8………….(2) x = 5 or x = - 4
eqn (1) × 2
Put x = 5 in eqn (1);
10x – 2y = 18………(3)
y–5=1
eqn (2) + eqn (3) y=6
(3x + 10x) + (2y – 2y) = 8 +18
13x = 26 Put x = - 4 in eqn (1);
x=2 y – (- 4) = 1
y +4=1
Put x = 2 in eqn (1) y = -3
5(2) – y = 9 The truth sets are (5, 6) and (- 4, -3)
10 – y = 9
y = 10 – 9 3. Solve the simultaneous equation:
y=1 ab = 52 and log4 a – log4 b = 3
Therefore, x = 2, y = 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⁄
b=. / y = 2. / + 3
√ y= +3
b=
7y = 3 + 21
√
7y = 24
Put b = in eqn (3);
y=
√
a = 64 . / (x, y) = . , /
a = 16 (√ )
√ Exercises 17.22
(a, b ) = . (√ ), /
Solve the pair of equations;
1. log 2(2x + y) = 3and log 2 (3x – 4y) = 0
4. Solve these equations simultaneosly
2. log3 (3x – y) = log3 (y + 1) and log3 2 + log 3
8y = 42x + 3 and log2 y = log2 x + 4
(x + y) = 2
Solution 3. log x2 = log y and log (2x + y) – log 3 = 0
8y = 42x + 3…………………(i)
4. log x + log y = 1 and y = 2x + 1
log2 y = log2 x + 4………….(ii)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. The population of a certain country in a
Solution certain year was ,,000 and increases at a rate of
2x = 6y 4 percent per anum. If the population after t
lg 2x = lg 6y years is p (1 + r)t, where p is the initial
lg 2x = y lg 6 population and r is the rate of increase. Find;
lg6 2x = y lg6 6 (change of base) i. the population after 10 years.
lg6 2x = y ii. when the population will double
t= 2.5 = . /
t = 17.71 log 2.5 = log . /
t 18 years
Therefore, the population will double in 18 log 2.5 = 360 log . /
years = log . /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
paying an annual percentage rate (quoted rate) =1+
compound daily (based on a bank year of 360 –1=
days) and you wanted to have Ghȼ2,500 in your
360 ( – 1) = r
account at the end of your investment time,
r = 0.9129
what interest rate would you need if the
r 91.29%
investment time were 1 year, 10 years?
To find the rate for 10 year:
Solution
Substitute 10 for t in the equation
Use the formula
2,500 = 1,000 . / to derive r:
2,500 = 1,000 . /
( )
where Ghȼ2,500 is the balance at the end of a 2,500 = 1,000 . /
certain time period, Ghȼ1,000 is the beginning ,
investment, t is the number of years, and r is =. /
,
the annual percentage rate. The annual rate of 2.5 = . /
r% is converted to a daily interest rate since the
compounding is daily (360 times per year). log 2.5 = log . /
log 2.5 = 3600 log . /
Take the annual interest rate of 4% and divide
by 360 to obtain the daily interest rate. The = log . /
exponent is 360t because there are 360
compounding periods in every year. Therefore, 0.00011 = log . /
360t represents the number of compounding
periods during t years. =1+
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
more than Ghȼ60.00 Ans 23 yrs skyrocketed in rural areas. The chemical by-
products of creating the drug are a big
2. Use the compound interest formula to environmental hazard, and toxic spill cleanup
determine how long it will take for a sum of crews are often called in to clean up abandoned
money to double if it is invested at a rate of 6% meth labs. The table below shows the number
per year compounded monthly. of meth labs cleaned by toxic spill crews in
Washington State alone.
3. If Ghȼ1,000 is invested at a rate of 12% per
year compounded quarterly, what is the years Population (billions)
principal after one year? 1995 42
1996 146
4. A person invests Ghȼ 4000 in an account at 1997 208
5% interest compounded annually. Let V = f(t) 1998 350
represent the value (in cedi) of the account after 1999 792
"t" years or any fraction thereof. 2000 1458
a) The equation for "f" is f(t) = 2000 (1.05t).
b) The V-intercept is (0, 2000). a) Find an equation for "f."
When will the balance be Ghȼ3000? b) Use "f" to predict in which year the number
of meth labs cleaned by toxic spill crews will
5. The equation f(t) =1.197(1.0163t) models the equal the number of households in
world population (in billions) at "t" years since Washington. Assume there are 2.2 million
1900. households in Washington.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
it in this example.
Experimental Laws
Expressions Reducible to Linear Form Type 3: xy = ax + b.
Experimental laws which are not linear can Method
sometimes be reduced to linear form. To do this Two alternatives are available here as follows:
1. Rewrite the equation in terms of new (a) Letting xy = Y , giving Y = ax + b, we
variables so that there is a straight line could plot a graph of Y against x.
relationship between the new variables.
(b) Writing the equation as y = a + , we could
2. From this straight line graph, take the usual
two sets of readings (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) let = X, giving y = a + bX, and plot a graph
3. Then substituted them into the form of the of y against X.
experimental equation which occurs
immediately after taking logarithms of both Type 4 : y = axb
sides. Method
This kind of law brings in the properties of
Note logarithms since, if we take logarithms of both
It will not matter which base of logarithms is sides (base 10 will do here), we obtain
being used since logarithms to two different log10 y = log10 a + b log10 x.
bases are proportional to each other anyway.
The logarithmic graph paper does not, Letting log10 y = Y and log10 x = X, we have
therefore, specify a base. Y = log10 a + bX,
so that a straight line will be obtained by
plotting Y against X.
Note: Type 2
In all 5 of the above examples, it is even more 2. y = abx.
important not to try to read off the gradient and Method
the intercept from the graph drawn. As before, i. Taking logarithms (base 10),
take two sets of readings for x (or X) and y (or log y = log (abx)
Y ), substitute them in the straight-line form of log y = log a + log bx
the equation and solve two simultaneous linear
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
log10 y = log10 a + x log10 b.
equations for the constants required. ii. Plot a graph of y against x with y on a
logarithmic scale and x on a linear scale.
Ploting the Logarithm Graph iii. Estimate the position of the best straight
Type 1 line.
1. y = axb iv. Read off from the graph two sets of co-
Method ordinates, (x1, y1) and (x2, y2), as far apart as
i. Taking logarithms (base 10), possible.
log10 y = log10 a + b log10 x. v. Solve for a and b the simultaneous equations:
ii. Plot a graph of y against x, both on log10 y1 = log10 a + x1 log10 b,
logarithmic scales. log10 y2 = log10 a + x2 log10 b.
iii. Estimate the position of the “best straight If it is possible to choose zero for the x1 value,
line”. so much the better, but this is not essential.
iv. Read off from the graph two sets of co-
ordinates, (x1, y1) and (x2, y2), as far apart as
possible.
Worked Examples
1. Below is a table of values for y = 3x2
x 5 10 15 20 25 30 35
y 75 300 675 1200 1875 2700 3675
Draw a straight line graph from the table and use your graph to obtain the slope of the line.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5
x 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
y 14 56 126 224 350 504 686 895 1132 1400
From the graph of log x, find the values of the constants a and b to two significant figures.
Solution
x 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
y 14 56 126 224 350 504 686 895 1132 1400
log x 0.301 0.602 0.778 0.903 1.000 1.079 1.146 1.200 1.255 1.300
log y 1.146 1.748 2.100 2.350 2.540 2.70 2.836 2.952 3.054 3.146
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
log y
From y = axb
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. Find correct to one significant figure, the values of k and a in the relation, y = kax given by the
following table.
x 1 2 3 4 4.5 5
y 2 7 22 65 112 194
Solution
y = kax
x 1 2 3 4 4.5 5
y 2 7 22 65 112 194
x 1 2 3 4 4.5 5
log y 0.301 0.845 1.342 1.813 2.049 2.288
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1 2 3 4 5 6 x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The following table gives the approximate
6. The coefficient of self induction, L, of a coil,
values of y for corresponding values of x.
and the number of turns, N, of wire are related
by the formula L = aNb, where a and b are
x 5 10 15 20 25 30 40
constants. For the following pairs of observed
y 17 47 87 134 188 246 379 values, use a straight line graph to calculate
approximate values of a and b:
i. By drawing the appropriate straight line
graph, determine the values of k and n. N 25 35 50 75 150 200 250
ii. Use your graph to estimate the values of y L 1.09 2.21 5.72 9.60 44.3 76.0 156.0
for x = 60 and x = 200.
7. Measurements taken, when a certain gas
3. The table below gives the approximate undergoes compression, give the following
values of y for given values of x in an
values of pressure, p, and temperature, T:
experiment.
P 10 15 20 25 35 50
x 1 2 3 4 5 6
T 270 289 303 315 333 353
y 3 6 11 22 45 90
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Radians are often called „circular measure‟ radians = 1800
and are denoted by rads. ⇒R=θ× ,
Let θ = 2250
The number of radians in one complete
revolution is given by the ratio:
radians = 1800
= = 2 radians
⇒ R = 2250 ×
R= radians
Relationship Between Radians and Degrees
One complete revolution = 2 radians = 3600
Some Common angles
0
Thus, 2 radians = 360
radians = 1800 Degree Radians
00 0
300
Note:
You can write = 1800, omitting the word 450
„radian‟ , where means „ radians.‟ 600
0
Mathematically, ≠ 180
900
Changing from Degrees to Radians 1200
Using the relation; 1500
radians = 1800
1800
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Worked Examples
3 radians = 3 × multiply by
1. Convert radians to degrees
171.88730 approximate
⇒θ= × ,
Changing Minutes and Seconds as Decimal
θ= Degrees
θ = 3000 = . / , and =. / =. /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. θ = 1520 12‟ 4‟‟ 4. θ = 15.90 θ = 143.240 4cm
θ 10cm
Length of a Circular Arc ii. A = r 2 θ
If an arc of length l on a circle of radius r
A = (4)2 (2.5)
subtends a central angle of radian measure θ,
then: l = rθ A = 20cm2
From the diagram below; 2. The radius of a circle is 20cm. find the angle
subtended at the center by an arc of length 8 .
l = ×2 r
r
l = rθ θ l Solution
r r = 20 , l = 8 and θ = ?
l = rθ
8 = 20θ
Area of a Circular Sector
If θ is the radian measure of a central angle of a θ= =
circle of radius r and if A is the area of the
circular sector determined by θ, then: 3. The area of a sector of a circle of radius r is
A = r2 θ 30cm2. If the angle subtended at the center of
the circle by this sector is radians, calculate r.
r
θ
r Solution
A = 30 , θ = radians, r = ?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Find the length of the arc that subtends the 9cm 450
given central angle θ on a circle of diameter d.
ii. Find the area of the sector determined by θ.
a. θ = 500 , d = 16 m b. θ = 2.2 , d = 120cm
angle of . θ
a
6. The area of a sector of a circle, or radius r is Six ratios that can be obtained using the sides
24 cm2. If the angle subtended at the center of a, b and c are ;
the circle by this sector is , calculate r, the , , , , ,
radius of the circle.
For each θ, the six ratios are uniquely csc θ = sec θ = cot θ =
determined and hence are functions of θ. They
are called Trigonometric functions and are Trigonometric Ratios of 300 and 600
identified as sine, cosine, tangent, cotangent, , The trigonometric ratio of 300 and 600 are
secant and cosecant functions, abbreviated as derived from an equilateral triangle of
sin, cos, tan, cot, sec, and csc respectively. dimensions 2 – units as shown below;
From the above right triangle; H
1. sin θ = = 4. csc θ = =
0 0
30 30
2. cos θ = = 5. sec θ = = 2 2
3. tan θ = = 6. cot θ = = 0 0
60 60 Fig. II
1 A 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Note By Pythagoras theorem,
1. The domain of each of the six trigonometric 22 = | |2 + 12
functions is the set of all acute angles. | |2 = 22 – 12
2. The values of the six trigonometric functions | |2 = 3
are positive for every acute angle θ. This is
| |=√
because , the sides of a triangle are positive real
The dimensions of fig. II can be shown below:
numbers.
3. The hypotenuse is always greater than H
adjacent or opposite side an hence sin θ < 1,
0 0
cos θ < 1, csc θ > 1, and sec θ > 1 for every 30 30
acute angle θ. 2
√
2
0 0
60 60 Fig. II
Reciprocal Identities
1 A 1
Consider the following pair of ratios;
1. sin θ = and csc θ = From this figure, the trigonometric ratios of 300
and 600 are obtained as follows:
2. cos θ = and sec θ =
√
sin 300 = , cos 300 = tan 300 = ,
3. tan θ = and cot θ = √
√
sin 600 = cos 600 = tan 600 = √
It can be seen that sin θ and csc θ, cos θ and sec csc 300 = 2 sec 300 = √
cot 300 = √
θ and tan θ and cot θ are reciprocals of each √
csc 600 = sec 600 = 2 cot 600 = √
other.
C csc – 2 √ √ 1
450 cot – √ 1 √ 0
√
1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Fig. III
A 1 B The Unit Circle
From this fig. III, the trigonometric ratios of The unit circle has its center at the origin(0, 0)
450 are obtained as follows; and the length of the radius is 1.
√ Take any point p(x, y), on the circle, making an
cos 450 = = csc 450 = √ angle of Ɵ, from the center.
√
√ y
sin 450 = = sec 450 = √
√
·
P ( x, y)
0 0
tan 45 = cot 45 = 1
1 y
0 θ
The trigonometric ratios of 90 are obtained as x x
follows
cos 900 = = 0, csc 900 = 1
√
√ √
sin 900 = = 1, sec 900 = = undefined
√
θ
√ cosθ = = x, sinθ = = y, tanθ = , tan θ =
tan 900 = = undefined cot 900 = =0 θ
√
·
P ( cos Ɵ, sin Ɵ)
any point p on the circle.
··
0
1 Sin Ɵ ( cos 900, sin 90 )
P ( cos Ɵ, sin Ɵ)
Ɵ
Cos Ɵ
x
· ·
1 Sin Ɵ
0 0
( cos180 , sin 180 ) ( cos 00, sin 00)
θ
Cos Ɵ ( cos 3600, sin 3600)
··
As the point p rotates, θ changes. These (0, 1)
definitions of cos θ and sin θ in terms of the P (x, y)
1
·
coordinates of a point rotating around the unit y
(-1, 0) Ɵ (1, 0)
circle apply for all values of the angle θ0,
x
Memory Aid: (Christian name, Surname)
= ( cos θ , sin θ ) = ( x, y)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(0, -1)
(cos 00, sin 00) = (cos3600, sin 3600) = (1, 0) (cos 900, sin 900) = (0, 1)
cos 00 = cos 3600 = 1 cos 900 = 0
sin 00 = sin 3600 = 0 sin 900 = 1
tan 00 = tan 3600 = = 0 tan 900 = ( undefined)
(cos 1800, sin 1800) = (-1, 0) (cos 2700, sin 2700) = (0, -1)
cos 1800 = cos 3600 = -1 cos 2700 = 0
sin 1800 = 0 sin 2700 = -1
tan 1800 = =0 tan 2700 = tan 3600 = (undefined)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
can be found. Worked Examples
Find without using tables or calculators
Summary of Signs 1. sin (- 600) 2. cos (- 300) 3. tan(- 2250)
y
Solutions
S A √
x 1. sin (- 600) = - sin 600= –
T C √
x 2. cos (-300) = cos 300 =
x 3. tan (- 2250) = - tan 2250 = - tan 450 = - 1
+ tan are ALL positive
1st quadrant: sin cos and
2nd quadrant: sin is positive, cos and tan are Exercises 18.5
y
negative. - 1. tan (-1500) 2. tan (- 2100)
3rd quadrant: tan is positive, sin and cos are 3. cos (-1200) 4. cos (-1350)
negative. - 4. sin (-2700) 6. sin (-1350)
4th quadrant: cos is positive, sin and tan are
y
negative. - Methods for Finding the Trigonometric Ratio
for Any Angle between 00 and 3600
A very useful memory aid, CAST, in the Method 1
diagram above shows the ratios that are I. Draw a rough diagram for the angle in the x –
positive for the angles between 00and 3600. y plane, taking measurement in the
anticlockwise direction from the positive x -
Negative Angles axis
Consider the unit circle showing angles θ and –θ II. Determine in which quadrant the angle lies
T C
4. In the fourth quadrant, (2700 < θ < 2700),
Note: sin2 A = ( ) etc subtract the given angle , from 3600 to obtain
the related angle. That is, Related angle = (3600
Method 2 –θ). Only cos is positive. That is explained
If θ is the general angle, then below:
1. In the first quadrant, (00 < θ < 900), all the a. sin ( 3600 - θ) = - sin θ
trigonometry ratios are positive e.g. Sin 3000 = sin (3600 – 3000)
2. In the second quadrant, (900< θ < 1800), only
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
√
= – sin 600= –
sin is positive. That is:
a. sin (180 – θ) = sin θ b. cos ( 3600 – θ) = cos θ
eg. sin 1200 = sin (1800 – 1200) E.g. cos 3000 = cos (3600 – 3000)
= sin 600 = cos 600 =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Method 2
tan is negative in 300
Let θ = 2100 0
the 2nd quadrant 60
2100is in the 3rd quadrant where only tan is
tan 1200 = - tan 60
positive
=-√
Related angle = (θ – 1800)
= (2100 – 1800) = 300 Related angle
Method 2
⇒ 2100 is related to 300
Let θ = 1200
√
sin 2100 = – cos 300 = – 1200 is in the 2nd quadrant, where only sin is
positive
2.Find sin 3150, leaving your answer in surd Related angle = (1800– θ)
form: = (1800 – 1200) = 600
⇒ 1200 is related to 600
Solution √
sin 1200 = sin 600 = ,
Method 1
3150 lies in the 4th quadrant as shown
Simplifying and Evaluating Trigonometric
in the diagram below; Expressions
Replace each angle with it‟s ratio and perform
the included operation. If answer is required as
450 Related angle
0 a surd, do so by rationalizing the denominator
45
Worked Examples
1. Evaluate sin 300 + 2 tan 450 without using
sin is negative in the fourth quadrant
calculators or tables
sin 3150 = – sin 450 = –
√
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Consider the triangle below;
Solution
sin 1350 – sin 3150
√ √ √ √ √ 2
–.– /= + = =√ √
θ
2 0 0 1
4. cos 45 + sin 30
√ Ratio Angle
=. / + = + =1 √ √
sin θ = θ = sin
cos θ = θ = cos
Exercises 18.6
A. Find the reference angle or related angle tan θ = √ θ=t n √
given the following measure.
1. 2400 2. 3400 3. 1650 4. 2750 5. -1100 However, a problem arises with the sin-1x, cos-1
x and tan-1 x notation.
6. 7. 8. 9. 10 .
Consider the following equations;
B. Evaluate, leaving your answer in surd
If sin θ = , then θ = sin = …,-3300,
form where necessary.
1. cos 1200 + cos 2250 -2100, 300, 1500, 3900, 5100,…
2. sin2 600 + cos2 450 If tan θ = , then θ = t n 1 =…,-3150,
3. 1 + cos2 30 -1350, 450, 3150, 4050, 6750, …
4. sin 600cos 450 + cos 600 sin 450 Hence, if there is no restrictions on the value of
5. tan 2400– tan 3300 θ, then the equation sin θ = and tan θ = 1 have
6. tan2 300– sin2 600 an infinite number of solutions.
The angles within this range are often called 3. If A and B are acute, tan A = and tan B = ,
“principal values”. Using these restrictions for
find the value of A + B .
θ, we often obtain a single value for our
√
answer. Thus,sin = 600, not also 1200, as Solution
0 0 0
120 is not in the range -90 to 90 tan A = and tan B = ,
⇒A= . / = 26.56500
Domain and Range of the Inverse
Trigonometric functions B= . / = 18.43500
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
[- , ] 0 , 1
[-1, 1] , , -
4. Evaluate tan ( . /*
Worked Examples
1. Find the principal values of each of the Solution
following; tan ( . /*
i. sin ii. cos iii. t n . /
√ √ Let A = 13
5
⇒ Sin A = ⇒ A
Solution
a
i. sin = sin ( ) = 300 a=√ ( )
a=√
ii. cos = cos ( ) = 450 a = 12
√
4. sin . / Solution
√ √
sin θ = and csc θ =
Challenge Problem cos θ = and sec θ =
Prove that;
tan θ = and cot θ =
1. sin . / = sin . /
2. sin ( )= 2. Find the exact values
√ 8 x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. 2 x= of x and y.
Solution 600
Application to Right Triangles y
From the diagram,
Case 1
sin 600 =
Give three sides of the triangle, any of the six
ratios can be used to calculate the value of the x = 8 sin 600
interior angles. x = 6.9282
x=7
Case 2
Given two sides of the right triangle, the third cos 600 =
side can be calculated by using Pythagoras y = 8 cos 600
theorem. y=4
Case 3 Alternatively;
Given two sides and an interior angle of the By Pythagoras theorem,
right triangle, apply the appropriate functions 82 = x2+ y2
that links the two sides and the given angle. 82 = x2 + 42 But y = 4
x2 = 82 – 42
Case 4 x2 = 64 – 16
Given an interior angle, and two unknown x2 = 48
sides , apply the appropriate functions that x=√ 8
links the unknown sides and the given angle. x = 6.9282
x=7
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4
sec θ and cot θ
300 600 VI. Obtain the unknown side using Pythagoras
y y
theorem.
VI. Find the required trigonometric function,
3. 10 300
y not forgetting the CAST system.
Obtuse Acute
x
S A
Finding Trigonometric function value given
one trigonometric function
Draw a right – angled triangle and name one T C
acute angle as θ. Reflex
Reflex
Worked Examples
θ 1. In a right – angled triangle, if θ is an acute
Then label the dimensions of the triangle by angle sin θ = . Find the values of the
observing the following; trigonometric functions of θ and the perimeter
I. Given sin θ = , a is the side that faces of the triangle
θ (opposite) and b is the side that faces the right
angle (hypotenuse) Solution
( )
i. sin θ = = .
a b ( )
Ɵ O = 3 and H = 5, Adjacent (A) = ?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4 α = 530
The interior angles of the triangle are ;
2. If θ is an obtuse angle and cos θ = . 370, 530 and 900
i. Find the values of the trigonometric functions
of θ. 3. In a right triangle, tan A = where A is a
ii. Find the perimeter of the triangle. reflex angle,
iii. Find the interior angles of the triangle i. Determine the other trigonometric functions
of A.
Solution ii. What is the perimeter of the triangle?
y 10
cos θ = iii. What are the interior angles of the triangle?
θ
Since θ is obtuse, 8
it falls in the second quadrant. Solution
tan A = where A is a reflex angle
From the diagram, 10
6
102 = y2 + 82 Since θ is reflex, 12
θ θ
y2 = 102 - 82 it falls in the
8
y2 = 100 – 64 fourth quadrant. h
5
y=√
y=6 From the diagram,
12
h2 = 122 + 52
θ
In the second quadrant, only sin is + ve; h2 = 144 + 25 5
The values of the trigonometric function of θ h=√ 13
are; h = 13
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A = 67.3801 3. tan θ = 6. csc θ = 4
A = 670 (Nearest degree)
The Fundamental Identities
α = 1800 – 900 – 670
1. The reciprocal identities
α = 230
The interior angles of the triangle are ; csc θ = sec θ = cot θ =
230, 670 and 900
2. The tangent and cotangent identities:
4. In a right triangle, sec θ = , where θ is tan θ = cot θ =
reflex. Find the values of the trigonometric
functions of θ . 3. The Pythagorean identities:
24 a. sin2 θ + cos2 = 1
θ
Solution b. 1 + tan2 θ = sec2 θ
7 c. 1+ cot2 θ = csc2 θ
If sec θ = , then 25
cos θ = Proofs
Since θ is reflex, Consider the diagram below;
it falls in the third quadrant.
24
From the diagram, c
θ b
252 = y2 + 242 y 25
y2 = 252 – 242 θ
a
y2 = 625 – 576
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 530
The tangent and cotangent identities: + =
From the diagram,
Sin θ = , cos θ = and tan θ = . / +. / =. / ………..(2)
⁄
1. = ⁄
=
But cot θ = and csc θ =
Substitute in eqn (2)
2. cot θ = = ⁄
= 1+ cot2 θ = csc2 θ
. / + . / = . / ……….(2)
Worked examples
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
But = cos θ and = sin θ 1. Let θ be an acute angle.
a. Express sin θ in terms of cos θ
Substitute in eqn (2) b. Express tan θ in terms of sin θ.
(cos ) + (sin ) = 1
cos2 θ + sin2 θ = 1 Solution
a. cos2 θ + sin2 θ = 1
sin2 θ = 1 – cos2 θ
2. From cos2 θ + sin2 θ = 1 ……………(1)
Divide through by cos2 θ
sin θ = √
=
b. tan θ = ………(1)
+ = From cos2 θ + sin2 θ = 1
cos θ = √
. / +. / =. / ………..(2)
Put cos θ = √ in eqn (1)
But tan θ = and sec θ = ⇒ tan θ = √
Substitute in eqn (2)
1 + tan2 θ = sec2 θ 2. Prove + = 2 sec2 A
Solution
sec A – cos A = sin A tan A
L. H. S R. H. S
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
L.H.S = R. H. S
= sin A . /
4. Prove that cot θ + = csc θ = sin A tan A
LHS = R.H.S
Solution
6. Verify the identity sec θ = sin θ (tan θ + cot θ)
cot θ + = csc θ
L.H.S R. H. S Solution
sec θ = sin θ (tan θ + cot θ)
Consider the L.H.S; L.H.S R. H. S
cot θ +
Consider the R. H. S
cot θ = sin θ (tan θ + cot θ)
⇒ + = sin θ . /
( ) = sin θ . /
= ( )
= sin θ . /
= ( ) =
=
2 2
But cos A + sin A = 1
= sec θ
⇒ = L. H. S = R. H. S
( ) ( )
Worked Examples =
1. Verify the identity =
Exercises 18.10
Solution A. Prove each of the following identities;
= 1. = sec θ + cot θ
2. (sec θ + tan θ) (1 – sin θ) = cos θ
= . 3. sec A sin A = tan A
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) 4. (1 – cos A) (1 + cos A) = sin2 A
= 5. (1 + tan2 θ) ( 1 – sin2 θ) = 1
=
( ) 6. tan θ √ = sin θ
( )
= B. Prove the following;
1. csc θ – sin θ = cot θ cos θ
= 2. sin x + cos x cot x = csc x
3. tan t + 2 cos t csc t = sec t csc t + cot t
L.H.S = R. H. S
4. tan2 A – sin2 A = tan2A sin2 A
5. = csc θ – sec θ
2. Show that (tan θ – sec θ)2 =
6. = cot2 θ
Solution
(tan θ – sec θ)2 = Compound Angles
L. H. S = R. H. S A compound angle is an angle which is written
as a sum of or difference of two or more angle.
Consider the L.H.S For example, (A + B) , ( A – B) and (A – B – C)
(tan θ – sec θ)2 are compound angles.
= (tan2 θ – 2 tan θ sec θ + sec2 θ )
Addition and Subtraction Formulas for
=. / –2. /. /+. / Cosine Sine and Tangent
1. cos (A + B) = cos A cos B – sin A sin B
= – + 2. cos (A – B) = cos A cos B + sin A sin B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
cos 300 = sin (900 – 300)
cos (A + B) = cos A cos B + sin A sin (-B)
cos 300 = sin 600
cos (A + B) = cos A cos B - sin A sin B
Worked Examples
Co-function Formulas 1. If sin (x + 300) = cos 400, find x where
Consider the diagram below;
00 < x <
–A Solution
c
a Method 1
Expressing cos 400 as a sin
A sin (x + 300) = cos 400…………..(1)
b
sin (900 – 400) = cos 400………..(2)
If A is the radian measure of an acute angle,
then the angle with – A is complementary to
eqn (1) = eqn (2)
A (add up to 900). From the above triangle, the sin (x + 300) = sin (900 – 400)
following ratios can be obtained; sin (x + 300) = sin 500
sin A = = cos . / x + 300 = 500
x = 500 – 300
cos A = = sin . /
x = 200,
tan A = = cot . /
Method 2
These 3 formulas and their analogues for sec A, Expressing sin (x + 300) as a cos
csc A and cot A state that the function value of sin (x + 300) = cos 400 ……………….(1)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Check in the equation;
⇒2x – 230 = 430 The solution set is x = 210, x = 3390
2x = 230 + 430
2x = 660 3. Without, using tables or calculators, find the
x= value of – .
0
x = 33
Solution
cos is positive in the first and fouth quadrants –
x = 330, x = 3600 – 330 = 3270
x = 330, 3270
But cos 500 = sin (900 – 500)
= sin 400
Check in the equation;
cos 220 = sin (900 – 220)
The solution set is x = 330
= sin 680
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
for Sine and Tangent
Addition formula for Tangent
1. sin (A + B) = sin A cos B + cos A sin B ( )
2. sin (A – B) = sin A cos B – cos A sin B tan (A + B) = ( )
3. tan (A + B) = =
4. tan (A – B) = If cos A cos B ≠ 0, then divide each numerator
and denominator by cos A cos B to obtain;
Addition formula for sine . /. / . /. /
tan (A + B) =
sin (A + B) = sin A cos B + cos A sin B . /. / . /. /
Using the co – function formula,
tan (A + B) =
sin (A + B) = cos . ( )/
= cos . / Subtraction formula for tangent
tan (A – B) =
= cos 0( ) 1
tan (A + B) = ………(1)
From cos (A – B) = cos A cos B + sin A sin B Let B = (-B) and substitute in eqn (1)
( )
cos 0( ) 1 tan (A +(- B) = ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
tan 1050 = tan ( 600 + 450)
√
= ( ). / – ( ). / =
√
=0– √
= (√ ) ( )
√
=– √
=
√
3. Express cot 150 in surd form
6. Without using tables or calculator, find the
Solution value of sin ( 1200 + 450 )
cot 150 = cot (45 – 30)0
But cot 150 = = Solution
( )
sin (120 + 45)0
Now,
But sin (a + b) = sin a cos b + cos a sin b
tan(45 – 30)0 = ⇒ sin (120 + 45)0
√ √
√ = sin 1200 cos 450 + cos1200 sin 450
= √
= √
= √ √ √
√
( ) =. /. / +. /. /
√ √
0 √
= –
cot 15 = = √
=
( ) √
√
7. Simplify cos (45 – 30)0
4. Express sec 150 in surd form
Solution
Solution cos (α – β) = cos α cos β + sin α sin β
cos (45 – 30)0 = cos 450 cos 300 + sin 450 sin 300
=
√
+
√
=
√ √ sin (A – B) = sin A cos B – cos A sin B
= . /. / – . / . /
8. Find the value of tan A when tan (A – 45) = . = –
Solution =
tan (A – 45) = .
Execise 18. 12
=
A. Express the following as a trigonometric
= = ratio of one angle.
3 (tan A – 1) = 1 + tan A 1. cos 480 cos 230 + sin 480 sin 230
3 tan A – 3 = 1 + tan A 2. cos 130 cos 500 – sin 130 sin 500
3tan A – tan A = 1 + 3 3. cos 100 sin 0 – sin 100 cos 50
(3 – 1) tan A = 4 4. sin 570 cos 40 + cos 570 sin 40
2 tan A = 4 5. cos 30 sin (-2) – cos 20 sin 30
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
tan A = 2 6. sin (-5) cos 20 + cos 50 sin (-2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
c . /. /
From sin A =
m
Let h be the unknown side; tan (A + B) = = = × =
8c
h2 = 52 - 42
m ⇒ cot (A + B) = = =
h=√ 5 ( ) ⁄
4
h=3
A
3 4. If cos A = and tan B = , where A and B
If A is obtuse, then; 8c are both reflex angles, find the values of ;
cos A = and tan A = m i. sin (A – B) ii. tan (A – B) iii. cos (A + B)
From cos B = k
13 Solution
B cos A = (reflex) and tan B = ( reflex)
Let the unknown side be k; 12
k2 = 132 – 122 From cos A = 3
A
k=√ 13 h
5
k=5 5
B
Let h be the unknown side;
h2 = 52 – 32
If B is acute, then 12
h=√ 3
sin B = and tan B = A
h=√ 4
h=4 5
sin A = , cos A = and tan A =
If A is reflex, then;
cos B = , sin B = and tan B =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
tan B = , sin B = and cos B =
5. Find the values of the following;
i. sin (A – B) = sin A cos B – cos A sin B i. sin (30 + 45) ii. cos (120 + 45)
ii. cos (450 – 300) iv.
sin (A – B) = . /. /-. /. /
sin (A – B) = + = 6. If tan (A + B) = 3 and tan B = 2, find the
value of tan A.
ii. tan (A – B) =
7. If sin A = and cos B = , where A is obtuse
Substitute tan A = and tan B =
and B is acute, find the exact value of sin (A +
B)
tan (A + B) =
. /. /
8. If α and β and acute angles such that csc α =
tan (A + B) = = = × = and cot β = , find
i. sin (α + β) ii. tan (α + β)
iii. cos (A + B) = cos A cos B – sin A sin B iii. the quadrant containing α + β
=. /. /–. /. /
9. If α and β and acute angles such that cos α =
= – =
and tan β = , find
i. sin (α + β) ii. cos (α + β)
Exercises 18 .14
iii. the quadrant containing α + β
1. If sin A = and cos B = , where A and B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4
Type 4 =
Worked Examples
⇒ cot (A – B ) = = =8
1. A and B are acute angles such that tan A = 4 ( )
and tan (A + B) = 5. Find tan B. = =8
Solution =8
tan A = 4, tan (A + B) = 5, tan B = ? 1 + 4 tan B = 8(4 – tan B)
tan (A + B) = 1 + 4 tan B = 32 – 8 tan B
4 tan B + 8 tan B = 32 – 1
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 541
tan B (4 + 8) = 31 written as a fraction of a single angle. For
12 tan B = 31 example, , , are sub – multiple angles.
tan B =
Double Angle Formulas
But cot B = = = 1. sin 2A = 2 sin A cos A
⁄
2. i. cos 2A = cos2 A – sin2 A
ii. cos 2A = 1 – 2sin2 A
Exercises 18.15
iii. cos 2A = 2 cos2 A – 1
1. If A and B are acute, such that tan A = and
3. tan 2A =
0
tan B = , find (A + B) ans 45
Proofs
2. If tan A = , 1800 ≤ θ ≤ 3600 and tan B = , 1. sin (A + B) = sin A cos B + cos A sin B
Now , let B = A
-900 ≤ θ ≤ 900, find A – B ans 2250
sin (A + A) = sin A cos A + cos A sin A
sin (2 A) = sin A cos A + cos A sin A
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. If tan A = , and tan B = , where A is
obtuse and B is acute, find the value of A – B By factorization
0
ans 135 sin (2A) = sin A cos A (1 + 1)
sin 2A = 2 sin A cos A
4. sin θ = and θ is obtuse, find the value of 2. i. cos (A + B) = cos A cos B - sin A sin B
Let B = A
.
cos (A + A) = cos A cos A – sin A sin A
cos 2A = cos A cos A – sin A sin A
5. If sin x = , where 00 x 900, find the cos 2A = cos2 A – sin2 A
value of :
i. 1 – cos2 x, ii. 1 + cos2 x, ii. cos 2A = cos2 A – sin2 A …...(1)
iii. ( ) , iv. ( ) But sin2A + cos2A = 1…………..(2)
6. If cos x = 0.8, find the value of the following From eqn (2);
for 00 x 900: cos2 A = 1 – sin2 A
i. cos2x – sin2x ii. – Substitute in eqn (1);
cos 2A = (1 – sin2 A) – sin2 A
Multiple Angles cos 2A = 1 – 2 sin2 A
A multiple angle is an angle which is written as
a multiple of a single angle. For example 2A, iii. cos 2A = cos2 A – sin2 A …...(1)
2B , 3θ are multiple angles. But sin2A + cos2A = 1……….…..(2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. tan 6θ = 4
l=√
A
l=3 3
tan 2A = cos A =
2. cos 2A = cos 2A = . / – . / = – =
= Solution
cos 3θ = cos (2θ + θ)
= (Multiply top and down by cos2 A) Using the addition formula;
= cos 2A cos (A + B) = cos A cos B - sin A sin B
cos 3θ = cos (2θ + θ)
3. sin 2A = cos (2θ + θ) = cos2θ cos θ – sin 2θ sin θ
= (2 cos2 θ – 1 ) cos θ – (2 sin θ cos θ ) sin θ
= Double angle formula
= 2 cos θ – cos θ – 2 cos θ sin2 θ (expand)
3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
,
and cos A. Let the unknown side be h;
h2 = 12 + 72 √
7
Solution h=√
A
1
sin 2A = , Since A is acute,
sin 2A = sin A = and cos A =
√ √
⇒ =
,
2. If tan θ = , 0 < θ < , without using tables
Now, let tan A = t or calculator find the value of:
,
= i. sin 2θ ii. cos 2θ iii. tan 2θ
7(1 + t2) = 2t × 25
7 + 7t 2 = 50t Solution
7t 2 – 50t + 7 = 0 tan θ = , 0 < θ < , 20 h
tan θ = = θ
Solving by factorization;
21
(7t – 1) (t – 7) = 0
Let the unknown side be h;
7t – 1 = 0 or t – 7 = 0
h 2 = 202 + 212
t = or t = 7
h h = √8
1 29
h = 29 20
But t = tan A A
θ
7
21
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 18.16 5. cos 3 A = 4 cos3 A – 3 cos A
A. Without using tables or calculator, find 6. tan 3θ =
the exact values of sin 2θ, cos 2θ and tan 2θ
for the given value of θ. Half – Angle Identities
1. cos θ = 00 < θ < 900 1. sin2 A =
2. cot θ = 1800 < θ < 2700 2. cos2 A =
3. sec θ = - 3 900 < θ < 1800
0 0
3. tan2 A =
4. sin θ = 270 < θ < 360
Proofs
B. 1. If cos x = , find the value of cos 2x 1. cos 2A = 1 – 2sin2 A (double angle formula)
√
without using tables or calculator. 2 sin2 A = 1 – cos 2A
sin2 A =
2. A and B are acute angles such that tan B =
and tan (A – B) = 2. Find: 2. cos 2A = 2 cos2 A – 1
i. tan A ii. sin 2A 1 + cos 2A = 2 cos2 A
cos2 A =
3. If cos 2A = , find the two values of cos A
3. tan2 A = (tan A)2 = . / =
without using tables or calculator.
Substitute identities (1) and (2) to obtain;
4. If cos 2A = , find the two values of tan A tan2 A =
OR
Taking square root of both sides of each
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⁄ ⁄
equation, we obtain the following formulas tan = = = =
⁄
called half – angle formulas.
2. Without using mathematical tables or
1. sin = √
calculator, find in surd form, (radicals) the
value of tan 22.50
2. cos = √
Solution
3. i. tan = √ tan =
ii. tan = tan = tan 22.50
√
Solution = ×
√
Diagram ( √ )
=
√
3 √ √
A = ×
√ √
4 √ ( √ )
h = ( √ )( √ )
√
=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. cos2 3x – sin2 3x = cos 6x L.H.S. = R.H.S.
3. 4 sin cos = 2 sin x sin (A + B) – sin (A – B) = 2 cos A sin B
cos A sin B = [sin (A + B) – sin (A – B)]
4. = 4 – 4 sin2 A
5. (sin t + cos t)2 = 1 + sin 2t
Formulas 3 and 4 are derived in a similar
function using addition and subtraction
Product to Sums and Differences Formulas
formulas for the cosine function.
1. 2 cos A cos B = cos (A + B) + cos (A – B)
2. 2 sin A cos B = sin (A + B) + sin (A – B)
Try
3. 2 sin A sin B = cos (A – B) – cos (A + B)
Prove that :
4. 2 cos A sin B = sin (A + B) – sin (A – B)
1. 2 sin A sin B = cos (A – B) – cos (A + B)
2. 2 cos A sin B = sin (A + B) – sin (A – B)
Proofs
Formula 1
sin (A + B) = sin A cos B + cos A sin B….(1) Worked Examples
sin (A – B) = sin A cos B – cos A sin B…….(2) 1. Express sin 4θ cos3θ as a sum
eqn (1) + eqn (2);
Solution
L.H.S Method 1
sin (A + B) + sin (A – B) . sin 4θ cos3θ
Let 4θ = A and 3θ = B
R. H. S sin (A + B) + sin (A - B) = 2 sin A cos B
= sin A cos B + sin A cos B sin (4θ + 3θ) + sin (4θ - 3θ) = 2 sin 4θ cos 3θ
= 2 sin A cos B sin 7θ + sin θ = 2 sin 4θ cos 3θ
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Let 3x = A and x = B 2. 2 cos 3θ cos θ 6. 2 cos 7θ sin 6θ
2 sin A sin B = cos (A – B) – cos (A + B) 3. 2 cos 4θ cos θ 7. cos x sin 5x
2 sin 3x sin x = cos (3x – x) – cos (3x + x) 4. 2 cos 6θ sin 3θ 8. sin 2A sin A
2 sin 3x sin x = cos 2x – cos 4x
sin 3x sin x = (cos 2x – cos 4x ) Sums and Differences to Product Formulas
The product to sum formulas are used to
express a sum or difference as a product.
3. Express cos 3θ sin 5θ as a sum or difference
Now, let A + B = m and A – B = n. Then :
of two trigonometric functions.
i. (A + B) + (A – B) = m + n
⇒A+B+A–B=m+n
Solution
A+A+B–B=m+n
cos 3θ sin 5θ
2A = m + n
3θ = A and B = 5θ
2 cos A sin B = sin (A + B) – sin (A – B) A=
2 cos 3θ sin 5θ = sin (3θ + 5θ) – sin (3θ – 5θ)
2 cos 3θ sin 5θ = sin 8θ – sin ( –2θ) ii. (A + B) – (A – B) = m – n
2 cos 3θ sin 5θ = sin 8θ + sin 2θ ⇒A+B –A+B=m–n
A–A+B+B=m–n
cos 3θ sin 5θ = (sin 8θ + sin 2θ)
2B = m – n
B=
4. Express as 2 cos 3θ cos θ a sum or
difference.
By substituting in the product to sum formulas,
the following is obtained as sum and
Solution
differences to product formulas.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Multiply though by -1; sin A + sin B = 2 sin cos
- cos n + cos m = - 2 sin sin sin 5x + sin 3x = 2 sin cos
cos m – cos n = - 2 sin sin = 2 sin cos
⇒ cos A – cos B = - 2 sin sin = 2 sin 4x cos x
4. 2 cos A sin B = sin (A + B) – sin (A – B) 3. Find the exact value of sin 1050 – sin 150
2 cos sin = sin m – sin n
Solution
sin m – sin n = 2 cos sin sin 1050 – sin 150
Let A = 1050 and B = 150
⇒ sin A – sin B = 2 cos sin
sin A - sin B = 2 cos sin
Summary sin 1050 – sin 150 = 2 cos sin
Sums and Differences to Product Formulas
sin 1050 – sin 150 = 2 cos sin
1. cos A + cos B = 2 cos cos
= 2 cos 60 sin 450
0
( )
= B. Express as a product.
( )
1. sin 6θ + sin 2θ 4. cos 5t + cos 6t
( )
= ( )
2. sin 4θ – sin 8θ 5. sin 3t – sin 7t
3. cos 5x – cos 3x 6. cos θ – cos 5θ
=
= cot t C. Find the exact value of the following.
1. sin 750 – sin 150 4. 2 sin 750 sin 1050
2. cos 1050 – cos 150 5. 2 cos 750 cos 150
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. Prove that = tan 2θ
3. sin 2550 – sin 150 6. cos 37 0
sin7 0
Solution
= tan 2θ D. 1. If sin θ = 0.65, find the following for
00 x 900;
L.H. S R.H.S
i. θ ii. tan θ iii. iv. . /
Consider the L.H.S;
A
2. tan θ = √ 5. tan2 θ =
S
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3. sin θ = 0 6. 2 sin2 θ – 1 = 0
T C
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
√
= 3600 – 850 = 2750 2. cos (θ – 450) = 5. cos (3θ + 150) =
θ + 600 = 2750 3. tan (θ + 300) = - √ 6. tan . /=
√
θ = 2750 – 600
θ = 2150 B. 1. If 10 sin (x – 45)0 = 5, where 00< x < 900,
find the value of x.
The truth set is θ = 250 , 3350
2. Given that 2 cos x = √ , where 00 < x < 900,
3. If 1.5 cos x = 0.75, find x if 00 < x < 900 find the value of x.
Let . /= θ
Solution
√
sin θ = cos 3 A = 0 ≤ A≤ 3600
√
θ= . / A=
θ = - 600 A = 600
sin is – ve in the third and fourth quadrants. cos is + in the 1st and 4th quadrants
Thus θ = 2400, 3000
⇒. / = 2400 or . / = 3000 In the first quadrant;
Given 0 ≤ A ≤ 3600 0
x + 300 = 2400 or x + 300 = 3000 0 60
⇒ 0 ≤ 3A ≤ 1080
x = 2400 – 300 or x = 3000 – 300
Thus, we go as far as A + 10800
x = 2100 or x = 2700
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Therefore, in the first quadrant;
Exercises 18.22
3A = 600, 600 + 3600, 600 + 7200, 600 + 10800
Find the solution of the equation that are in
3A = 600, 4200, 7800, 11400
the interval [0, 2 ]
1. cos . /=0 4. cos . /=-1 A = 200, 1400, 2600, 3800
2. sin . /=1 5. sin . /=
In the fourth quadrant;
√
3. sin . /= 6. cos . /= 3A = 3000, 3000 + 3600, 3000 + 7200,
3000 + 10800
Involving Multiples and Sub-multiples 0
60
1. Find the value of the angle θ by using the 3A = 3000, 6600 , 10200 , 13800
inverse. A = 1000, 2200, 3400, 4600
2. Identify the quadrant in which the
trigonometric function falls using the CAST Given 0 ≤ A≤ 3600
method. A = 200, 1000, 1400, 2200, 2600, 3400
2. Given kθ, the number of angles required is (k
+ 1) angles. For example, 3θ means 4 angles 4. Solve cos x =
√
0 ≤ x ≤ 3600
are required.
3. Add the upper range value consecutively to
Solution
the first (related) angle to obtain the other
√
angles. cos x =
4. Select the angles within the given range as √
x= . /
the answer.
x = 1350
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x = 2250 , 1350 , 450 , - 450 , - 1350 2. Find the solution of 4 sin2 x tan x – tan x = 0
x = 4(2250) , 4(3150), 4(450) , 4(- 450) , 4(1350) that are in the interval [0, 2 ]
x = 9000 , 12600, 1800, -1800, 5400
Solution
For the given interval, 4 sin2 x tan x – tan x = 0
x = 1800 tan x ( 4 sin2 x – 1 ) = 0
tan x = 0 or 4 sin2 x – 1 = 0
Exercises 18.23 tan x = 0 or 4 sin2 x = 1
A. Solve the following for 00 ≤ θ ≤ 3600 tan x = 0 or sin2 x =
√
1. tan 3θ = 1 4. cos x =
tan x = 0 or sin x = √
2. sin 2θ = 5. 2 sin 3θ + √ = 0
√ tan x = 0 or sin x =
3. cos = 6. 2 cos 2θ - √ = 0
For tan x = 0, tan is + ve in the first and third
Trigonometric Equations 2
quadrants.
In more complicated trigonometric equations,
x = 0, 1800
reduce the given equation to one or more
simple trigonometric equation by factorization
For sin x = , sin is + ve in the first and second
and rearranging.
quadrants.
Worked Examples x = 300, 1500
1. Solve the equation sin θ tan θ = sin θ For sin x = , sin is - ve in the third and
fourth quadrants.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
tan θ = or sin θ = 2
θ= . / or θ = (2) For sin A = , sin is positive in the first and
θ= (2) has no solution because for every second quadrants
θ, -1 ≤ sin θ ≤ 1
A = 300, 1500
θ= . / Therefore, A = 300, 900, 1500 for the given
range
θ = 30 . 9638
θ = 310 (neareast degree)
2. Solve the equation 2 sin2 t – cos t – 1 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
in the interval [0, 2 ]
1. 2 sin2 u = 1 – sin u 2. 2 tan θ – sec2 θ = 0
2. 2 cos2 t + 3 cos t + 1 = 0 3. cot θ + tan θ = csc θ sec θ
3. tan2 x sin x = sin x 4. sec θ csc θ = 2 csc θ
4. sin2 θ + sin θ – 6 = 0 5. tan2 θ = 1 + sec θ
5. 2 sin2 θ + sin θ – 6 = 0 6. 2 sin θ + 1 = csc θ
6. 2 cos2 A + cos A = 0
B. Solve each for 0 ≤ θ ≤ 3600
B. Find the solution of the equations that are 1. tan2 + 4 tan = 0
in the interval [0, 2 ] 2. 6 sin2 – 5 sin + 1 = 0
1. 2 – 8 cos2 t = 0 3. cot2 – 3 cot + 2 = 0
2. cot2 θ – cot θ = 0 4. sec2 + 4 sec – 5 = 0
3. 1 – sin t = √ cos t
4. √ sin t + cos t = 1 Domain and Range of Trigonometric
5. cos α + sin α = 1 Function.
6. cos θ – sin θ = 1 Function Domain Range Period
f(x) = sin x All real 2
C. Solve each of the following for 0 ≤ θ ≤ 3600 numbers [-1, 1]
1. sin2 θ + 3 cos2 θ – 2 = 0 f(x) = cos x All real [-1, 1] 2
2. 3 – 3 cos θ = 2 sin2 θ numbers
f(x) = tan x All real All real
3. sin θ (2 sin θ – 1 ) = 0
numbers numbers
4. √ sin θ = 2 cos2 θ – 2
except +
5. √ sin θ cos θ – cos θ = 0
k , where k
6. (2 cos θ – 1) (cos θ + 1) = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Domain and Range of Inverse Trigonometric
Notation
Function.
The diagram below shows the usual notation
for a triangle in trigonometry.
Function Domain Range
f(x) =
Angles: A, B, C
(x) {-1 ≤ x ≤ 1} 2 3 Length of sides: a, b, c
f(x) = {-1 ≤ x ≤ 1} * +
(x) A
f(x) = {-1 ≤ x ≤ 1} 2 3
c b
(x)
y 0 B C
f(x) = {-1 ≤ x ≤ 1} * + a
(x) y
The length of the sides are donated by a lower
f(x) = All real 2 3
numbers
case letters, and named after the angle they are
(x)
f(x) = All real * + opposite. i. e. a is opposite to angle A, b is
(x) numbers opposite to angle B and c is opposite to angle C
Cosine Rule (for length of sides): 4. The largest angle of a triangle is opposite the
= + – 2bc cos A largest side and the smallest angle is opposite
= + – 2ac cos B the shortest side. There can be only one obtuse
angle in a triangle.
= + – 2ab cos C
Tackling Problems in Trigonometry
Alternatively (for size of angles);
I. If not given, draw a diagram, and put in as
cos A = much information as possible.
II. If two, or more, triangles are linked redraw
cos B =
the triangles separately.
III. Watch for common sides which link the
cos C =
triangles (i.e. carry common values from one
triangle to another triangle).
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Area of ∆ abc IV. Use the sine or cosine rule as needed.
A = ab sin C = ac sin B = bc sin A
Worked Examples
1. In ∆ abc, /ab/ = 3, /ac/ = 5 and /bc/ = 7.
When to Use the Sine Rule
Calculate:
Use the sine rule if you know:
i. the measure of the greatest angle of the
1. Two angles and one side.
triangle.
2. Two sides and an angle opposite one of these
ii. the area of ∆ abc, leaving your answer in the
sides.
√
form , where bis a prime.
When to Use the Cosine Rule
Use the cosine rule if you know: Solution
1. Two sides and an included angle. i. The largest angle is opposite the largest side
2. The lengths of the three sides. Using the cosine rule,
= + – 2bc cos A b
Note: = 52 + 32 – 2(5)(3) cos A
1. As a general rule, if you cannot use the sine 49 = 25 + 9 – 30 cos A 7
3
rule then use the cosine rule. 30 cos A = 25 + 9 – 49
A
30 cos A = - 15
2. If two angles are given, workout the third c 5 a
angle straight away, as the three angles in a cos A = =–
triangle add up to 1800. A= . /
3. The sine and cosine rules and the area of the
A = 1200
triangle formulas also apply to a right – angled
B 17cm D C
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution p
Work on the two angles 4 Solution
5
triangles separately Let x represent /CD/ A
R
q 6 r
I. Consider ∆ pqr, 24cm
Given three sides, 13cm
use the cosine rule;
B 17cm D x C
cos R =
4 5 cos D = D
B 17 D
138.590
41.41 0 220
q r s A
6 p D= . / 0
r 0 15
II. Consider ∆ prs, D = 105 24cm
5 13cm
Having two angles 138.590 0 0
0 105 75
r
22 tan 150 = B
s 17cm D x C
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B = 210 below, correct to 2 places of decimals
p
C = 1220
q 4 r
Area of ∆ABC;
2. In the triangle below, cos A = . Without
= ab sin 1220
using tables or calculator, find the area of the
0
= (5) (3) sin 122 triangle.
6.4cm2
9cm
Exercises 18.25 A
Unless otherwise stated, where necessary, 10cm
give the lengths of sides and areas correct to
2 decimal places and give angles correct to 3. The area of the triangle below is 6cm2.
one place of decimals Find the value of x.
A. 1. In ∆ pqr, p = 7 cm, P = 300, Q = 840. Find
R, q and r
x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
I. Draw a diagram to represent the problem.
II. If the triangle formed is not a right angled C = 460(nearest degree)
triangle, use cosine rule or sine rule to
determine the value of an unknown side and the 350 + 450 + C + = 1800
values of unknown angles. 350 + 450 + 460 + = 1800
III. To find the bearing of say A from B, is to = 1800 – 1260 = 540
find the total angle turned through in the
clockwise direction from the north pole of B to But + θ = 900
the direction of A. 54 + θ = 90
θ = 90 – 54
Worked Examples θ = 360
1. B is 48km south – west of A, and C is 66km
from B on a bearing of 0800. Find, the distance Bearing of C from A;
and bearing of C from A. = 90 + θ
= 90 + 360 = 1260
Solution ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = (38km, 1260)
A
0
y 2. A ship sails on a bearing of 1380 from a port
45
48km C P for a distance of 15km to a port Q and then
0
sails on a bearing of 0120 to a port R. If the
45 350 66km
bearing of R from P is 0530, find:
B i. the distance from Q to R;
ii. the ships final distance from P.
Let the distance of A to C be y
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
bearing of town R from Q is 1400. If R is 8km
ii. Let the ships final distance from P be ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ from Q, calculate;
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ a. the bearing of R from P, to the nearest
= degree.
( ) R
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ θ b. how far north of P, R is, correct to two
= significant figures.
0
53 370
P
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 48
0
4. Kaya rides a bicycle to school every day.
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 18.4972km 23km From home, he rides for 3.5km on a bearing of
15km
0370 and then 1.4 km on a bearing of 3350
0
0 12
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 18km 42
before arriving at school.
Q a. What is the total distance Kaya rides from
home to school?
Alternatively; b. How far (i) north (ii) east is Kaya‟s school
Using the cosine rule; from home?
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 152 + 22.7768)2 – 2(15)(22.7768) cos 540 c. find the bearing and distance of Kaya‟s
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 743.7826 – 401.6360 school from his home.
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 342.1466
5. Two ships leave port at the same time, one
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = √ sailing in the direction N 230 E at a speed of
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 18.4972 11mi/hr and the second ship sailing in the
⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 18km direction S 670 E at 15mi/hr. Approximate the
bearing from the second ship to the first, one
hour later.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 562
Challenge Problems Worked Examples
1. An aircraft flies 100 km from port A to port 1. Copy and complete the table of values for y
B on a course 0750, then 200 km from port B to = 1 – 4 cos x, to one decimal place for 00 x
port C on a course 3430. How far north and 3000
how far east are ports B and port C from port A.
X 00 300 600 900 1200 1500
Graphs of Trigonometric Functions Y -3.0 1.0
X 1800 2100 2400 2700 3000
Here is the graph of y = sin :
Y 4.5 -1.0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
In y = 1 – 4 cos x
When x = 300, y = 1 – 4 cos 300
y = - 2.5
When x = 60 , y = 1 – 4 cos 600
0
y = - 1.0
When x = 120 , y = 1 – 4 cos 1200
0
y = 3.0
When x = 150 , y = 1 – 4 cos 1500
0
y = 4.5
The graph of y = cos x is the graph of y = When x = 1800, y = 1 – 4 cos 300
sin shifted, or translated y = 5.0
The graph of y = tan When x = 240 , y = 1 – 4 cos 2400
0
y = 3.0
When x = 2700, y = 1 – 4 cos 2700
y = - 1.0
5
Solution
4 a. When x = 00, y = 9 cos 00 + 5 sin 00
y= 9.0
3
When x = 600, y = 9 cos 600 + 5 sin 600
2 y = 8.8
1
When x = 900, y = 9 cos 900 + 5 sin 900
y = 5.0
0 When x = 00, y = 9 cos 1500 + 5 sin 1500
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240 270 300
-1 y = -5.3
-2
X 00 300 600 900 1200 1500
-3 Y 9.0 10.3 8.8 5.0 -0.2 -5.3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
-4
b.
Comparing 1 – 4 cos x = 0 to y = 1 – 4 cos x,
12
y=0
10
From the graph;
8
when y = 0, x = 750 and x = 2850
6
ii. From the graph, when x = 1050, y = 1.9
4
2
iii. From the graph, when y = 1.5, x = 970 and
0
x = 2640
-2 0 30 60 90 120 150 180
-4
2. a. Copy and complete the table of values for
-6
y = 9 cos x + 5 sin x to one decimal place
c. i. comparing 9 cos x + 5 sin x = 0 with y = 9
x 00 300 600 900 1200 1500 cos x + 5 sin x , y = 0
y 10.3 -0.2 From the graph, when y = 0, x = 1190
b. Using a scale of 2 cm to 300 on the x – axis ii. comparing 9 cos x + 5 sin x = 3.5 with y = 9
and a scale of 2 cm to 2 units on the y – axis, cos x + 5 sin x , y = 3.5
draw the graph of y = 9 cos x + 5 sin x for 00 ≤ From the graph, when y = 3.5, x = 990
x≤ 1500
c. Use your graph to solve the equations d. From the graph, when x = 720, y = 7.6
i. 9 cos x + 5 sin x = 0
ii. 9 cos x + 5 sin x = 3.5 3. Using a scale of 1 cm to on the x – axis and
Solution
Table of values for 3 sin x + 2 cos x
x 0 2
sin x 0 0.50 0.87 1 0.87 0.50 0 -0.50 -0.87 -1 -0.87 -0.5 0
sos x 1 0.87 0.50 0 -0.50 -0.87 -1 -0.87 -0.50 0 0.50 0.87 1
3sin x 0 1.50 2.61 3 2.61 1.50 0 -1.5 -2.6 -3 -2.6 -1.5 0
2 cos x 2 1.7 1.0 0 -1.0 -1.7 -2 -1.7 -1.0 0 1 1.7 2
f(x) 2 3.2 3.6 3 1.6 -0.2 -2 -3.2 -3.6 -3 -1.6 0.2 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
6
0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240 270 300 330 360 390
-1
-2
-3
-4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x 0 30 60 90 y = 2 sin x
y 2.2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. y = - 4 sin x 5. y = sin (- 4x)
3. y = 2 sin x 6. y = sin x
The value of α can be found by dividing
equation (2) by equation (1) to give;
B. Find the amplitude and period of the
following equations. = ⇒ =
1. y = 3 cos x 4. y = cos x
Hence, tan α =
2. y = cos 3x 5. y = cos (- 3x)
α =
3. y = 2 cos x 6. y = cos x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
tan α = √ cos x + sin x = 1 and a cos x + b sin x
compared, then a = √ and b = 1
α=
α= But R = √
0
α = 67
R = √(√ )
2. 3 cos x – sin x compared to a cos x + 12 sin b R=√
a = 3 and b = -1
But R = √ Also,
R=√ ( ) Rcos α = a and Rsin α = b
R=√ Therefore, cos α = and sin α =
√
cos α = and sin α =
tan α = √ √
Therefore, Rcos(x − α) = √ cos (x – 350). The fact that sin α is negative and cos α is
√ cos x + sin x = 1⇔ √ cos (x – 350 ) = 1 positive mean that α is an angle in the fourth
quadrant.
From √ cos (x – 350 ) = 1 tan α =
cos (x – 350) = α=
√
0
x – 35 = √
√ α=
0 0
x – 35 = 55 α = - 600
x = 550 + 350
x = 900 Therefore, R cos (x − α) = 2 cos (x − (− 60◦)
= 2 cos (x + 60◦).
Now if x lies in the interval − < α < , then
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
So the equation cos x − √ sin x = 2 becomes;
x = - 600, 1200
2 cos (x + 60◦) = 2
x − 0.615 = − 0.955, 0.955 cos (x + 60◦) = 1
x = − 0.955 + 0.615, 0.955 + 0.615 x + 60 = 1
x = − 0.340, 1.570 x + 60 = 0
x = - 60
2. Solve the equation cos x − √ sin x = 2 for
cos is positive in the first and fouth quadrants.
values of x in the interval 00 ≤ x ≤ 3600.
In the interval 0◦ < x < 360◦, x is – 600 in the
Solution first quadrant.
First express cos x − √ sin x = 2 in the form R
In the fourth quadrant , the only angle in the
cos (x − α).
interval with cosine equal to 1 is 360◦. It
Comparing cos x − √ sin x = 2 with follows that;
a cos x + b sin x , we see that; x + 60◦ = 360◦
a = 1 and b = − √ x = 300◦
Thus x = - 600 , 3000.
R=√ The only solution lying in the given interval is
x = 300◦.
R=√ ( √ )
R=√ Exercises 18.30
R=2 Solve the following equations for 0 < x < 2
1. 2 cos x + sin x = 1 4. 2 cos x − sin x = 1
But R cos α = a and R sin α = b 2. - 2 cos x − sin x = 1 5. cos x − 2 sin x = 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
α= 3. f(x) = a cos x b cos x
α= Max value = √
α = 370 Min value = - √
Now the maximum value of the cosine function B. f(x) = (sin x cos x)n
is 1 and this occurs when the angle Min value = . /
x − α = 0, i.e. when x = α. Max value can go up to infinity
So the maximum value of f(x)
= 5 cos (x − α) − 3 , if cos (x – α) = 1 Worked Examples
=5×1−3 1. Find the maximum and minimum values of
= 2. f(x) = 3 sin x 4 cos x
Therefore, the maximum value of the f(x) is 2
and it occurs at x = 370 Solution
Max value = √ =5
The minimum value of the cosine function is
Min value = - √ =-5
−1 and this occurs when x − α = , i.e. when
x = + α.
2. Find the minimum value of f(x) = sin4x cos4 x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a = 4 and b = 9
a = 3 and b = 5
Minimum value = 2√( )
a<b
Maximum value = 5 Minimum value = 2√( )
Minimum value = 3 Minimum value = 2√( )
Minimum value = 2 (6) = 12
D. 1. f(x) = a sin2 x b cosec2 x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. lim = k , where k is a constant
= lim +3
2. lim = 0, where P is a positive constant =0+3
=3
3. lim = 0, where k is a constant greater
Type 2
than 1.
When the limits of the numerator and the
denominator do not exist, rule 7 cannot be
4. lim ( ( ) ( )) = lim ( )
applied. In this case, divide the numerator and
lim ( ) This result is valid for sums and denominator by the highest power of x, so that
difference of finitely many functions. limits at infinity of the new numerator and
denominator exist.
5. lim ( ( ) ( )) = lim ( )
lim ( ). This result is valid for product In general, for all rational functions, limits at
of finitely many functions. infinity can be found by dividing the numerator
and the denominator by a suitable power of x
6. lim ( ( )) = k . lim ( ), (usually the highest power).
( ) ( )
7. lim = , where Worked Examples
( ) ( )
lim ( ) ≠0 1. Evaluate lim
2. lim 7. lim
2. Find the lim , if it exists.
3. lim
4. lim √
Solution 5. lim ( )
= lim
B. Evaluate each of the following limits.
1. lim 4. lim
= lim ,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. lim 5. lim
. /
= ,
. /
3. lim 6. lim
=
Challenge Problem
= =0 The concentration C of a drug in a patient‟s
bloodstream t hours after it was injected is
3. Find the lim , if it exists. given by C(t) =
a. Find lim ( )
Solution b. Interpret the results in (a)
= lim
Rules for Limits of Functions at a Point
1. lim = k , where k is a constant, k R.
= lim ,
2. lim = , where a R and n is a
( * positive integer.
= ,
. /
5. lim ( ( ) ( )) = lim ( ) = =
lim ( ). The result is valid for sums and
difference of finitely many functions. 3. Evaluate lim
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) ( )
lim ( ) ≠ 0. Solution
lim
Note: Put in 1 for x;
1. Let p(x) be a polynomial and let a be a real ( )
= = =
number, then lim ( ) = p(a). Hence, the
limit of polynomial functions at any real
number can be found by substitution. Indeterminate Forms of Limit
If a rational function is undefined at x = a, it
2. Let p(x) and q(x) be polynomials and let a be means that a does not belong to the domain of f.
a real number. Suppose that q(a) ≠ 0. Then we Thus, when we substitute x = a in the
( ) ( ) numerator and denominator, the result is . The
have lim = .
( ) ( )
limit is said to be in the indeterminate form .
Worked Examples For example in lim , when x =1 in
1. Find lim ( ) , if it exists.
both the numerator and denominator is
Solution obtained. In this case , it is advisable to either
lim ( ) , if it exists. factorized the numerator or denominator first,
= lim + lim then simplify and take the limit at the given
= 1 + 42 point.
= 17
Worked Examples
2. Find lim , if it exists. 1. Find lim , if it exists.
= lim
= = 4. Evaluate lim
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
lim
Solution
lim Put in x = 1; = (indeterminate form)
Put in 5 for x; Factorizing numerator and denominator will not
= (indeterminate form) work. Thus, use long divison to find the
quotient
Thus, factorize numerator and denominator
( )( ) x2 + x + 1
lim
x – 1 x3 + 0x2 + 0x – 1
lim x3 – x2
Put in 5 for x x2 + 0x – 1
x2 – x
= 5 + 5 = 10
x–1
x–1
3. Evaluate lim
= x2 + x + 1
Solution
lim
lim = lim ( )
Put in 2 for x; = 12 + 1 + 1
= (indeterminate)
=3
2. lim ( 8)
√ ( )( √ )
3. lim . / 4. lim = lim
( )( √ )
5. lim 6. lim = lim ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Evaluating Limits that Contain Surds
If the limit is initially indeterminate, multiply By substitution;
√
the numerator and denominator by the lim =
conjugate surd and then divide the numerator
and the denominator by the common factor. As Rationalize the numerator;
you proceed however, do not multiply out the (√ )(√ )
surd and the non-surd parts, as this will prevent lim ( )(√ )
you from finding the common factor. √
lim
( )(√ )
Worked Examples lim ( )(√ )
1. Evaluate lim
√ lim
√
Solution
By substitution;
lim
√ = =
√
lim = (indeterminate)
√
Multiply top and bottom by 1 + √ (the conjugate of Exercises 19.3
the numerator) Evaluate each of the following limits:
√ √
lim = lim . 1. lim 4. lim
√ √ √ √
( )( √ )
= lim 2. lim
√
5. lim
( √ )( √ ) √
( )( √ ) √
= lim 3. lim 6. lim
(√ ) √
( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
lim ( ) = =4
lim ( ) = 12.5 lim =4
Differentiation from the first Principles of a line will give the rate of change of y with
Differentiation or differential calculus, is the respect to (the change in) x.
branch of mathematic measuring rate of
change. Slope of a Curve
Consider the curve below and the tangents that
Slope of a Line are drawn on it.
Below is the graph of line y = 3x
y
9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
along the curve, the slope of each tangent
x
1 2 3 changes. In other words, the rate of change of y
There is a relationship between x and y. For with respect to x changes. We need to find a
every increase in x, there is three times increase method of finding the slope of the tangent at
in y. each point on the curve. The method of finding
the slope of a tangent to a curve at any point on
Rate of change of y = 3 times rate of change the curve is called differentiation.
of x.
Notation
From coordinate geometry, the slope of y = 3x We will now develop a method for finding the
is 3. slope of the tangent to the curve y = f(x) at any
Slope = 3 point (x, f(x)) on the curve.
⇒ Rate of change = slope
The graph shown below represent the function
The key word here is slope. The slope of a line y = f(x).
will give the rate of change of the variable on y
the vertical axis with respect to the variable on
the horizontal axis. Therefore, to find the rate (x + h, f(x + h)
of change is to find the slope.
f(x + h) – f(x)
Slope = Definition
The slope of a tangent to the curve y = f(x) at
( ) ( )
= ( ) any point on the curve is given by :
( ) ( )
( ) ( ) = f’(x) = lim
=
This would be a good approximation of the Differentiation from the first principles
slope of the tangent T, at the point (x, f(x)), if (x involves four steps:
+ h, f(x + h)) is very close to (x, f(x)). By letting Find:
h get smaller, the point (x + h, f(x + h) moves 1. f(x + h)
closer to (x, f(x)). 2. f(x + h) – f(x)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) ( )
3.
The result is that the slope of S gets closer to ( ) ( )
the slope of T. In other words, as h approaches 4.
0, the slope of S approaches the slope of T.
Mathematically speaking, we say that the slope There are six functions, x2, x3, √ , , sin x, cos
of T is equal to the limit of the slope of S as h x on our course that we can be asked to
approaches 0. It is important to realize that h differentiate from the first principles.
approaches 0, but never actually becomes equal
to zero. Worked Examples
( ) ( )
This is usually written lim Differentiate from the first principles with
The process of finding this limiting value is respect to x :
called “differentiation”. For neatness, this i. x2, ii. x3, iii. √ , iv. , v. sin x, vi. cos x
limit is written as (pronounces as dee y, dee
x) of f’(x), pronounce “f dash of x” of “f prime Solution
of x”. f(x) = x2
f(x + h) = (x + h)2
or f’(x) is called the “differential coefficient
= x2 + 2xh + h2 – x2
“ or “first derivative of y with respect to x” = 2xh + h2
( ) ( )
= 2x + h
Note:
( ) ( )
It is important to understand that does not lim = lim
mean dy dx. It means the derivative of y with = 2x
Thus (x) = 2x
=-
( ) ( ) 2 2 2
= 3x h + 3xh + h Thus (x) = -
( ) ( )
= lim
= lim ( ) v. f(x) = sin x
= 3x2 f(x + h) = sin (x + h)
Thus, (x) = 3x2 f(x + h) – f(x) = sin (x + h) – sin x
= 2 cos . / sin . /
iii. f(x) = √
= 2 cos . / sin . /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
f(x + h) = √
( )– ( ) . /
f(x + h) – f(x) = √ -√ = 2 cos . /
√ √ √ √
= × ( )– ( )
√ √
lim =
(rationalise the numerator)
. /
=
√
lim cos . /
√
= = (cos x) (1)
√ √
( ) ( ) = cos x
= h
√ √ Thus, (x) = cos x
=
√ √
( ) ( ) vi. f(x) = cos x
lim = lim
√ √ f(x + h) = cos (x + h)
= f(x + h) – f(x) = cos (x + h) – cos x
√ √
= = -2 sin . / sin . /
√
Thus (x) = = -2 sin . / sin . /
√
( )– ( ) . /
= -2 sin . /
iv. f(x) =
. /
f(x + h) = = -sin . /
f(x + h) – f(x) = - ( )– ( )
( )
lim =
= ( )
= (- sin x) (1) = + +
= -sin x = 2x + h + 4
Thus, (x) = - sin x ( )– ( )
lim = lim
( )– ( )
Let f(x) = x2 + 3 . Find lim
= 2x + 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 2x + h
f(x + h) – f(x)
( )– ( ) = x3 + 3x2 h + 3xh2 + h3 + x + h – (x3 + x)
lim = lim
= x3 + 3x2 h + 3xh2 + h3 + x + h – x3 – x
= 2x + 0 = x3 – x3 + 3x2 h + 3xh2 + h3 + x – x + h
= 2x = 3x2 h + 3xh2 + h3 + h
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )– ( )
lim = 9x2 + 2x Worked Examples
Differentiate with respect to x.
Exercises 20.1 1. y = x5 5. y = 6 √
A. For each of the following f, find 2. y = -3x2 6. y =
√
( )– ( )
lim 3. y = 5x 7. y = ⁄
2
1. f(x) = 4x – 13 4. f(x) = 2x – 4x = 1 4. y = 8. y = 7
2. f(x) = x4 5. f(x) = 1 – 3x2
3. f(x) = 3x2 - 4x A 6x – 4 6. f(x) = √ Solution
1. y = x5 =5 = 5x4
B. Find the derivatives of each of the
following functions by the first principles. 2. y = -3x2 = 2 × -3 = - 6x
1. f(x) = 2x + 5 4. f(x) = 3x – x2
2. f(x) = (x – 1)2 + 1 5. f(x) = 6x2 – 3x – 1 3. y = 5x =1×5 = 5x0 = 5
3. f(x) = x3 + 3x2 + 5 6. f(x) = - 3x2 + 4x
4. y = = -2 × 8 = -16
C. For each of the following, find the =-
derivative using first principles.
⁄ ⁄
1. f(x) = + 3 4. f(x) = +x 5. y = 6 √ = × 6 =3
2. f(x) = = ⁄ =
√
2
3. f(x) = 5. f(x) = x 6. y = = × 2 ⁄
√
7. y = = × 6 ⁄ = lim
⁄
= lim
⁄
= -2 = ⁄ =1
8. y = 7 =0×7 =0 Geometrically, this means that the graph of the
identity function is the line given by y = x. At
Derivative of a Constant every point on the line, the slope is 1.
The derivative of a constant is zero. Take for
instance, the line y = 7. This line is a horizontal Power Rule for Differentiation
line with slope 0. Therefore, its derivative (also (Positive Integer Version)
known as slope) equals 0. Let n be a positive integer, then the power
function xn differentiable on R is given by
In general, the derivative of a constant is =n , where x is the identity function.
always 0. That is:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 0, where c is a constant Worked Examples
Let y = x123. Find
Proof
Let f(x) = c Solution
( ) ( )
= lim y = x123
= lim =
= lim = 123
= lim = 123
=0
Constant Multiple Rule for Differentiation
Geometrically, this means that the graph of a Let f be a function and k be a constant. Suppose
constant function c is the horizontal line given f is differentiable, then the function kf is also
by y = c. At every point on the line, the slope is 0. differentiable. Moreover, we have;
(kf) (x) = k ( ),
Derivative of Identity Function
The derivative of an identity function is the
Proof
constant function 1, that is;
Let f(x) = x
= 1, where x is the identity function. ( )( ) ( )( )
( ) ( ) = lim
Let f(x) = x ( ) ( )
( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) = lim
= lim
, ( ) ( )- , ( ) ( )-
Worked Examples = lim
( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
Let y = 3x4. Find = lim
( ) )( ) ( ) ( )
= lim . /
Solution ( ) )( ) ( ) ( )
y = 3x4. = lim + lim
= 3x4 = (x) + (x)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 20.2 This result for difference can be proved similar
Differentiate each of the following with to that for sum.
respect to x.
Term by term differentiation can be applied to
1. x3 2. 3x4 3. -5x2 4. 3x 5. -2x
sums and difference of finitely many terms.
6. 5 7. -3 8. 9. 10.
Worked Examples
B. Differentiate each of the following with 1. Find (x) for each of the following:
respect to x. a . f(x) = x + b. f(x) = – +5
⁄ √
1. 6 2. 3. √ 4. 5. ⁄
√
Solution
Derivative of Sum or Difference 1. a. f(x) = x +
If the expression to be differentiated contains
f (x) = x +
more than one term, just differentiate,
(x) = 1 –
separately, each term in the expression.
(x) = 1 –
1. Let f and g be functions with the same
denominator. Suppose that f and g are b. f(x) = – +5
√
differentiable. Then the function f + g is also f (x) = 2 ⁄
– +5
differentiable. Moreover, we have; ⁄
=- –
(f + g) (x) = ( )+ ( )
= ⁄ +
y = x2 + 3 2. y = + + ⁄ 6. y = x4 –
= (x2 + 3) 3. y = 2x2 – 7. y = 6 √ –
√
2
= x + 3 4. y = + 8. y = 2√ –
= 2x + 0
Evaluating Derivatives
= 2x
1. Differentiate the equation.
2. Substitute the value of the given variable in
3. Let f(x) = x5 – 6x7. Find (x) the differential equation.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(x) = (x5 – 6x7)
t = 2.
5 7
= x – 6x
= 5x – 6 (7x6)
4 Solution
= 5x4 – 42x6 s = 3t2 + 5t – 7,
= 6t + 5
3 2
4. Differnetiate y = 5x – 4x + 12x – 8
At t = 2,
Solution = 6(2) + 5
y = 5x3 – 4x2 + 12x - 8
( ) = 12 + 5 = 17
= (5x3) – (4x2) + (12x) -
( )
=5 (x3) – 4 (x2) + 12 (x) -
2. If f(x) = √ + 3x, evaluate (4)
2
= (3) (5) x – (2) (4) x + 12 - 0
Solution
= 15x2 – 8x + 12
f(x) = √ + 3x
f(x) = ⁄ + 3x
Exercises 20.3
⁄
A. Differentiate each of the following with = +3
respect to x. = +3= +3=3
√
1. y = x3 – 5x 4. y = x2 + 5x – 7
2. y = 1 – x2 5. y = x (x – 1)
5 4 3 3. Let f(x) = 2x(x2 – 5x + 7). Find the derivative
3. y = x + x – 5x 6. y = 2x9 + 3x
of f at 2.
The derivative of f at 2;
Worked Examples
(2) = 6(2)2 – 20(2) + 14
1. If f(x) = x + , find (x) and (2).
(2) = 24 – 40 + 14
(2) = - 2
Solution
Exercises 20.4 f(x) = x + ,
A. 1. If A = 3r2 – 5r, find the value of f(x) = x +
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
, when
r=3 (x) = 1 –
(x) = 2
2. If V = 3h – h2 – 3h3 , find , when h = 1.
=
3. If A = r2, find , when = 1
4. If V = r3, find , when 2r – 5 = 0 (2) = =
5. f(x) = 3x – 4x . If
2
(k) = 8, find the value of k.
3 2
6. If s = t – 2t , evaluate at t = 3.
2. If h = 10 + 30t 2 – 4t3, evaluate when
2 3
7. If θ = 3t – t , evaluate at t = 2. t = 3.
8. If V = r3 , evaluate at r = 5.
Solution
h = 10 + 30t 2 – 4t3,
B. For each of the following f, find (a) for
= 60t – 12t2
the given a.
1. f(x) = x3 – 4x . a=1 = 60 – 24t
⁄ ⁄
2. f(x) = 3 - a = 27
3. f(x) = + a=2 At t = 3
4. f(x) = r2 – 2√ a=4 = 60 – 24(3) = - 12
Solution
y = x4 In words,
First by the derivative of the second + second
= 4x3
by the derivative of the first.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 12x2
Worked Examples
1. If y = (x2 – 3x + 2) (x2 – 2), find
Substitute in . /–. /
= ( )-( ) Solution
= 16 x6 – 16x6 y = (x2 – 3x + 2) (x2 – 2),
=0 Let u = (x2 – 3x + 2) and v = (x2 – 2),
= 2x – 3 and = 2x
Exercises 20.5
1. If f(x) = 3x2 – 4x – 7 , evaluate ; =u +v
i. (2) ii. (-1)
= (x2 – 3x + 2) (2x) + (x2 – 2) (2x – 3)
2. If f(x) = - 4√ , find . (9) = 2x3 – 6x2 + 4x + 2x3 – 3x 2 – 4x + 6
= 4x3 – 9x2 + 6
3. If s = 3t – 2t2, find the value of:
i. ii. when t = 2
3. Let y = √ (x + 1). Find
1. y = (2x + 3) (x – 4) y=
2. y = (x + 5) (x2 – 3x + 2) Let u = x2 and let v = x – 2
3. y = (3x – 4) (x 2 – 2x + 3) = 2x and =x
4. y = (x + 3) (x 2 – 6x + 8)
5. y = (5x 2 – 3x) (x2 – 5x) =
6. y = (3x 3 – 2x2 + 4) ( 2x – 1) ( )( ) ( )( )
= ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B. Use product rule to find = ( )
1. y = (2x – 3) (5 – 6x )
=(
2. y = (5x – 2) (2x + 3) )
3. y = (x – 2) (x + 1)
( )
4. y = (x3 – √ ) (x3 – √ ) 2. Differentiate and simplify y = ( )
5. y = √ (√ + 1)
6. y = . / . / + 3p2, where p is a Solution
( )
constant y= ( )
Solutions
Exercises 20.7 1. y = (x2 – 3x) 4
A. Find in each of the following. Let u = (x2 – 3x), n = 4, n – 1 = 3 , = 2x – 3
1. y = 4. y = Substitute in ;
2. y = 5. y = =
3. y = 6. y = = 4( – ) (2x – 3)
= 4(2x – 3) ( – )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B. Use quotient rule to find . = ( 8x – 12) ( – )
1. y = 5. y =
2. y = (3x + 2)4
2. y = 6. y = Let u = (3x + 2), n = 4, n – 1 = 3 , =3
√
3. y = 7. y = Substitute in ;
√ =
4. y = 8. y =
= 4( ) (3)
Function of a Function = 12( )
Consider the example, y = (x + 5)3, here we say
y is a function of x. 3. y = (x2 + 3x)7
Let u = (x + 5)…………(1)
Let u = (x2 + 3x), n = 7, n – 1 = 6, = 2x + 3
⇒ y = u3………………(2)
Substitute in ;
From eqn (1) and eqn (2), we say y is a function =
of u, and u is a function of x. The variable u, is = 7( ) (2x + 3)
a link between the two expressions.
= 7(2x + 3)( )
Chain Rule = (14x + 21)( )
Suppose u is a function of x.
If y = , then = B. Differentiate the following;
The chain rule should be done in one step. 1. y = √
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= Using chain rule;
( )
= ×
=
√
By substitution;
2. y = (4x + 6 ) (x2 + 3x) = ×
y = 3( ) 2(4x + 6 ) (x2 + 3x) =
Let u = (2x + 5), n = - 1 , n – 1 = - 2 , =2
= 2(4x + 6 ) (x2 + 3x)
Substitute in ;
= At x = 2;
= 3 (-1) ( ) (2) = 2[(4(2) + 6) (22 + 3(2)]
= - 3(2) ( ) = 2 [(8 + 6) (4 + 6)]
= -6( ) = 2 [(14) (10)] = 280
=( )
Exercises 20.8
A. Find
3. y = . /
1. y = (3x + 2)4 5. y = (x2 + 5)3
y=( )
2. y = (x2 + 2x)3 6. y = (5 – 2x)2
Let u = ( ), n = 3, n – 1 = 2 ,
3. y = (2x2 + 1)5 7. y = 2(3x + 4)4
= 2x - 4. y = (1 – x3)2 8. y = ( )
2. y = (3 – 4x) – 3 7. y = ( ) ⁄
= 2x and = 3(x + 1)2 (1)
3. y = (3x – 4) – 2 8. y = ( ) ⁄
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. y = ( 8. y = √ Solution
) ⁄
y = x(x2 + 1)4.
D. Differentiate the following; Let u = x and v = (x2 + 4)4
y = uv
1. y = √ 4. y = x2 √
=u +v (product rule)
2. y = (3√ )3 5. y = x √
= 1 and = 4(x2 + 1)3 (2x) = 8x (x2 + 1)3
3. y = √ 6. y = . /
By substituition;
Challenge Problems
= (x)8x(x2 + 1)3 + (x2 + 4)4 (1)
1. If f(x) = √ , find the value of (1)
= 8x2 (x2 + 1)3 + (x2 + 4)4
4. Find for y = x√ =v +u
= (x3 + 1)2 6x(x2 + 1)2 + (x2 + 1)3 6x2(x3 + 1)
Solution
= 6x(x3 + 1)2 (x2 + 1)2 + 6x2(x2 + 1)3 (x3 + 1)
y = x√
y=x( ) ⁄ = 6x(x3 + 1) (x2 + 1)2 {(x3 + 1) + x (x2 + 1)}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= (x) . ( ) ⁄
(-2x) + ( ) ⁄
(1) = 6x(x3 + 1)(x2 + 1)2{(x3 + 1) + (2x3 + x + 1)}
(chain rule here)
⁄ ⁄
= -x ( ) + ( ) 7. Differentiate y =
√( )
=√ +√
Solution
y=
5. Given y = √ , find thedrivative of y √( )
y=
( ) ⁄
Solution y=x( )
y=√ Let u = x and v = ( )
⁄ = 1 and = (2x) ( )
y =. /
⁄ ( )( ) ( )( ) = 2x( )
= . / 0 1
( )
⁄
=u +v (Product rule)
= . / 0 1
( )
↑ By substitution;
(Chain rule followed by quotient rule) = x (-2x)( ) +( )
( ) ⁄ = -2x2( ) +( )
= ( ) ⁄ – ( )
= +
=( ) ⁄ ⁄ ( ) ( )
( )
5. y = x √ 6.y=√ Note:
Remember that, by the chain rule;
( ) = 2y and ( ) = 3y2 as y is
B. Differentiate the following functions with
respect to x considered as a function of x.
1. 2. ( 3. √
) In general,
4. (1 + x2)2 (1 – x2) 5. (1 – x2)2 (1 – x3)
( )=n . /
2 2 √
6. y = -3x (2x – 3) 7. y =
√
Worked Examples
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
C. 1. If f(x) = √ , find the value of (1) For each of the following curves, express in
terms of x and y.
2. If f(x) = √ , find the value of . / 1. x2 + y2 = 4 2. x2 + 2y – y2 = 5
x3 + (y3) = x +y
Solved Past Questions
3x2 + 3y2 = x . (1) + y (1) 1. If x2 + y2 = 2pxy, where p is a constant, find
3x2 – y = x – 3y2 .
3x2 – y = (x – 3y2)
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= x2 + y2 = 2pxy
2x + 2y = 2p . /
4. Find the derivative of x3 + 4xy2 – 7 = y3
2x + 2y = 2px + 2py
xy(1 + x2) = (1 + x2) (1 + y2) – x2 (1 + y2) 2. Evaluate at the given point (x, y) by
substituting the values of (x, y) in .
xy(1 + x2) = (1 + y2) [ (1 + x2) – x2 ]
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Worked Examples
1. Find the slope of the tangent to the circle
xy(1 + x2) = (1 + y2) as required. x2 + y2 = 4 at the point (√ , √ )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2x + y =
= 9 – 14x
=
=0
At the point (-1, 1) 0 = 9 – 14x
( ) ( ) 14x = 9
=( = = =1
) ( )( )
x=
Exercise 20.11
A. For each of the following curves, find the Put x = in y = 5 + 9x – 7x2
slope at the indicated point.
y=5+9. /–7. /
1. 2y3 + y2 – x = 0 (3, 1)
2 3
2. xy – 3y + 8 = 0 (4, 2) y=5+ –7. /
2 2
3. x – 3xy + 2y – 2x = 4 (1, -1)
2 2
4. 2x + 3y = 14 (1, -2) y=5+ –
2 2
5. y + 3xy +2x = 6 (2, 1)
y=
B. Find the value of at the specified point. At the point . , /, the gradient is zero.
2 2
1. x + y = 25 (3, - 4)
2. x2 + 4xy – 2y2 – 8 = 0 (0, 2)
2. Find the coordinates of the points on the
3. x2 + xy + 2y2 = 28 (2, - 4)
curve y = x2 where the gradient is 8.
4. x3 + y2 + 3x2y = 21 (2, 1)
=8 Solution
8 = 2x y = x3 + 2x + 4
x=4 = 3x2 + 2
Put x = 4 in y = x2 At x = 2
y = (4)2
= 3(2)2 + 2
y = 16
At the point (4, 16), the gradient of the curve is 8. = 14
The gradient of the tangent at x = 2 is m = 14
Exercises 20.12
1. Find the coordinates of the points on the 2. Determine the gradient of the tangent of the
following curves at which the gradient has graph of f(x) at x = -2, if f(x) = x(3 – 2x)2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the given values;
1. y = x3, m = 12 Solution
2
2. y = x – 3x + 1 , m=0 f(x) = x(3 – 2x)2
3 2
3. y = x – 6x + 4, m = -12 f(x) = x(9 – 12x + 4x2)
4 3
4. y = x – 2x + 1, m=0 f(x) = 9x – 12x2 + 4x3
2
5. y = x(x – 3) m=0
6. y = x(2 – x) m=2 = 9 – 24 + 12x2
(-2) = 9 – 24 + 12(-2)2
Challenge Problems (-2) = 105
A curve is given by the equation x2 + 4xy = 2y2
– 8. Find the coordinates of the points on the Equation of a Tangent to a Curve at a Point
on the Curve.
curve at which =1
= the slope of a tangent to a curve at any
Application of Differentiation point on the curve.
Evaluating Gradient at a Point To find the equation of the tangent to a curve at
To find the gradient of a curve at a point (x1, y1) a point (x1, y1) on the curve;
on the curve; 1. Find (using the appropriate rule)
1. Find (using the appropriate rule) 2. Evaluate at x = . This gives m, the slope
2. Evaluate at x = . This gives m, the slope of the tangent.
of the tangent. 3. If the equation of the curve is given
implicitly, use at x = and y = .
Solution Solution
y = 3 + 2x – x2 y = (2x + 3)3 at (-1, 1)
= x – 2x Let u = 2x + 3, n = 3, n – 1 = 2 =2
Substitute in ;
At (2, 3) =
= 2 – 2 (2)
= 3( ) 2
=-2
= 6( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
m = -2
At (-1, 1)
Equation of tangent;
= 6( ( ) )
y – 3 = -2(x – 2)
y – 3 = -2x + 4 = 6( )
2x + y – 3 – 4 = 0
=6
2x + y – 7 = 0
m=6
2. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve
y = 4x2 – 12x + 3 at the point (2 , -1) Equation of tangent;
y – 1 = 6 (x + 1)
Solution y – 1 = 6x + 6
y = 4x2 – 12x + 3 6x – y + 6 + 1 = 0
6x – y + 7 = 0
= 8x – 12
At x = 2, 4. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve
= 8(2) – 12 y= at . , /
= 16 – 12
Solution
=4
y= at . , /
m = 4, (2 , -1)
=( m = 15, (3, - 9)
)
Equation of tangent;
At . , /; y – (-9) = 15 (x – 3)
y + 9 = 15 (x – 3)
=, y + 9 = 15x – 45
( ) -
= 15x – y – 45 – 9 = 0
15x – y – 54 = 0
=
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
m= Equation of a Tangent to a Curve at the point
where the Curve meets the line y = mx + c
i. Solve the two equations simulatanously to
Equation of tangent;
obtain the values of x and y.
y – = (x – 1)
ii. Find to obtain the gradient m, of the curve
3y – = 2 (x – 1) at x.
6y – 3 = - 4 (x – 1) iii. Put the values of m and (x, y), in the
6y – 3 = - 4x + 4 equation: (y – y1) = m (x – x1), where (x, y) =
4x + 6y – 3 – 4 = 0 ( , )
4x + 6y – 7 = 0
The equation of the tangent is 4x + 6y – 7 = 0 Worked Examples
1. Find the equations of the tangents to the
5. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve curve y = x2 – x – 2 at the point where the curve
y = x (x2 – 12) at the point of where x = 3 . meets the line y = x + 1
Solution Solution
y = x (x2 – 12) y = x2 – x – 2 ………………..(1)
y = x3 – 12x y = x – 1…………………….(2)
= 3x2 – 12
eqn (1) = eqn (2);
x2 – x – 2 = x + 1
At x = 3
x2 – x – 2 – x – 1 = 0
= 3(3)2 – 12 x2 – 2x + 3 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= -3 ⇒m = -3 Put x = 0 in eqn (2);
y = -1
(0, -1)
Equation of the tangent with m = -3 passing
through (-1, 0)
Put x = in eqn (2);
y - 0 = -3 (x – (-1))
y = -3 (x + 1) y= –1
y = -3x – 3
y=
3x + y + 3 = 0
. , /
At x = 3,
= 2(3) – 1 Now, gradient of the curve;
= 5 ⇒m = 5 = (3x2 + 5x – 1)
= 6x + 5
Equation of the tangent with m = 5 passing
through (3, 4) At x = 0,
y – 4 = 5 (x – 3) = 6(0) + 5
y – 4 = 5x – 15
5x – y + 4 – 15 = 0 = 5 ⇒m = 5
5x – y – 11 = 0
Equation of the tangent with m = 5 passing
2. Find the equations of the tangents to the through (0, - 1)
curve y = 3x2 + 5x – 1 at the point of y + 1 = 5(x – 0)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
9x + 3y + 7 + 12 = 0 Worked Examples
9x + 3y + 19 = 0 1. Find the values of x for which the gradient
The equations are y = 5x – 1 and 9x + 3y + 19 = 0 function of the curve y = 2x3 + 3x2 – 12x + 3 is
zero. Hence find the equation of the tangent to
Exercises 20.13 the curve which are parallel to x – axis.
A. Find the equation of the tangent to the
curve at the indicated points; Solution
1. x3 – 2x2 – 4x + 1 (-1, 2) y = 2x3 + 3x2 – 12x + 3
2 2
2. x + y – 10y = 0 (4, 2) = 6x2 + 6x – 12
3 3
3. y – xy – 6x (1, 2)
When x = 1; When x = √ ,
y = 2(1)3 + 3(1)2 – 12(1) + 3 y = (√ )4 – 4(√ )2 + 6
y = 2 + 3 – 12 + 3
y=4–8+6
y=-4
y=2
(1, - 4) is a point of tangency.
(√ , 2) is a point of tangency.
Equation of the tangent parallel to the x – axis
at (1, - 4); Equation of the tangent at the point (√ , 2)
y + 4 = 0 (x + 2) (at the x- axis m = 0) which is parallel to the x- axis;
y+4=0 y – 2 = 0 (x – √ )
y–2=0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve
y = x4 – 4x2 + 6 parallel to x – axis. When x = - √ ,
y = ( √ )4 – 4( √ )2 + 6
Solution y=4–8+6
y = x4 – 4x2 + 6 y=2
= 4x3 – 8x ( √ , 2) is a point of tangency.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A. Find the equation of the tangent to the cuts the x - axis. Find the point of intersection
following curves at the indicated points; of these tangents.
1. y = x2 at x=2
2 3. Find the equation of the two tangents to the
2. y = 3x + 2x at x=4
2 curve y2 + 3xy + 4x2 = 14 at the point where x = 1.
3. y = 3x – x + 1 at x=0
2
4. y = 3 – 4x – 2x at x=1
2 4. Find the coordinates of the point on y = x2 at
5. y = 9x – x at x = -3
which the gradient is 2. Hence find the equation
of the tangent to y = x2 whose gradient is 2.
Type 2: Involving Implicit Functions
Worked Examples
5. Find the coordinates of the point on y = x2 –
1. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve
5 at which the gradient is 3. Hence, find the
x2 + xy + y2 = 3.
value of c for which the line y = 3x + c is a
tangent to y = x2 – 5
Solution
x2 + xy + y2 = 3 (Apply implicit differentiation)
6. Find the equation of the tangent to y = 2x2 –
2x + x + y(1) + 2y =0 (use product rule on xy)
3x which has gradient of 1 Ans y = x – 2
x + 2y = - 2x – y
Challenge Problems
(x + 2y) = -2x – y
1. Find the coordinates of the point on the curve
= y= at which the tangents to the curve are
parallel to the line x – y + 8 = 0 . Find the
At (x, y) = (1, 1); equations of the tangents at these points.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Find the value of a and the value of b.
q=4
Solution Therefore, p = 3 and q = 4
y = ax3 + bx + 4
3. The equation of the tangent to the curve f(x)
= 3ax2 + b = 21
= ax3 + bx at x = -1 is y – x – 4 = 0. Calculate
the values of a and b.
At x = 2,
3a(2)2 + b = 21 Solution
12a + b = 21………….(1) f(x) = ax3 + bx
(x) = 3ax2 + b
Given (2, 14) on the curve; (-1) = 3a(-1)2 + b
14 = a(2)3 + b(2) + 4 (-1) = 3a + b
14 = 8a + 2b + 4
8a + 2b = 14 – 4 Equation of tangent;
8a + 2b = 10 …………….(2) y–x–4=0
y=x+4
Solving eqn (1) and (2) simultaneously;
a = 2 and b = -3 Now, at x = -1
y = -1 + 4
2. The slope of the tangent to the curve px2 + 1 y =3
at the point (1, q) is 6. Find the value of p and Point of tangency = (-1, 3)
the value of q.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put a = 2 in eqn (1)
1 = 3(2) + b
1=6+b
1–6=b Normal
b = -5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
y – y1 = (x – x1)
y–6= (x – 2) the x – axis.
2(y – 6) = -1 (x – 2)
Solution
2y – 12 = - x + 2
y = (x2 + x + 1)(x – 3)
x + 2y – 12 – 2 = 0
when y = 0
x + 2y – 14 = 0
⇒ (x2 + x + 1)(x – 3) = 0
But (x2 + x + 1) has no real roots
2. Find the coordinates of the point Q where the
So (x – 3) = 0
tangent to the curve y = x2 + 3x + 2 is parallel to
x=3
the line 2x + y + 2 = 0.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
+ 2 which has a gradient of .
(x) = ( ) . 2x
(x) = √ 4. Find the value of k for which y = 2x + k is a
normal to y = 2x2 – 3
At the point (-1, 2)
5. Find the equation of the tangent to y = (x – 5)
(-1) =
√( ) (2x + 1) which is parallel to the x – axis.
(x) =
√
6. Find the equation of the tangent and normal
(x) =
to the curve y = x2(x – 3) at the point where it
cuts the x – axis.
The equation of the normal;
y – y1 = 2(x – x1) Rates of Change 1 (Linear Kinematics)
y – 2 = 2(x + 1) Displacement (Position), Velocity and
(y – 2) = 2(x + 1) Acceleration
y – 2 = 2x + 2
The derivative is called the rate of change of
2x – y + 2 + 2 = 0
2x – y + 4 = 0 y with respect to x. It shows how changes in y
are related to changes in x. For instance, if =
Exercises 20.17 3, then y is increasing three times as fast as x
A. Find the equation of the normal to the increases. Similarly, if = - 5, then y
given curve at the given point on the curve.
decreases five times as fast as x.
1. y = x2 at x = 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
v= = 3t2 – 18t + 15
iii. the acceleration after 3 seconds
iv. the time at which the acceleration is 6m/s2,
At t = 4,
and the velocity at this time.
v = 3(4)2 – 18(t) + 15
Solution v = 42 – 72 + 15
i. s = t3 – 9t2 + 15t – 3 v = -9m/s
This means that after 4 seconds, the particle
v= = 3t2 – 18t + 15
moves in the opposite direction to where it
a= = = 6t - 18 started.
At t = 3 v= = (3) t2 + (2) t
a = 6. / – 18 v = t2 + t
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. the velocity of the particle at 5 seconds
iii. the acceleration of the particle at time 5 When t = 3,
seconds. h = 10.5(3) – 4.9(3)2.
h = 31.5 – 44.1
Solution h = -12.6m
i. s = 12t2 – 5t3 The stone is going down at an increasing speed.
v= = 24t – 15t2
v = 24t – 15t2 ii. v = = 10.5 – (2) (4.9)t
v = 10.5 – 9.8t
2
ii. v = 24t – 15t At t = 1, v = 10.5 – 9.8 (1) = 0.7m/s
At t = 5; At t = 3, v = 10.5 – 9.8 (3) = - 18.9m/s
v = 24(5) – 15(5)2 a= = -9.8
v = 120 – 375
The stone is going up at a decreasing speed.
v = - 255 m/s
5. A ball is thrown vertically upwards and its
iii. a = = 24 – 30t height after t seconds in s meters where
a = 24 – 30t s = 25.2t – 4.9t2. Find;
i. its height and velocity after 3 s,
At t = 5; ii when it is momentarily at rest,
a = 24 – 30(5) iii. the greatest height reached,
a = -126 m/s2 iv. the acceleration when t = 2 .
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. When it is momentarily at rest, v = 0 7. The displacement s meters and the time t
0 = 25.2 – 9.8t
9.8t = 25.2 seconds of a particle is given by the relation
t= s = ut + gt2. Find in terms of u and g ;
t = 2.6s i. the velocity of the particle at time t seconds,
ii. the velocity of the particle at 10 seconds;
iii. At the greatest height reached, t = 2.6s iii. the acceleration of the particle at time t
s = 25.2(2.6) – 4.9(2.6)2 seconds.
s = 65.52 – 33.124
s = 32.4 m Solution
i. s = ut + gt2
iv. At t = 2 . v= = u + gt
a= v = u + gt
a = - 9.8 m/s
ii. v = u + gt
6. The relation the displacement s meters and At t = 10
the t seconds of a particle is given by the v = u + 10g
relation s = 10t + 16t3. Find at a time t = 15s;
iii. v = u + gt
i. the velocity of the particle,
ii. the acceleration of the particle. a= =g ( u is a constant)
a =g
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The rate of change of the population 15 months i. the velocity with which the stone was thrown
from now will be: up;
ii. the time the stone has zero velocity ( that is
P1(15) = 2(15) + 20 reached its highest point in the air);
iii. the velocity of the stone at twice the time in (ii);
= 50 per month
iv. the time the stone reached the bottom of the
b. Change in population; coconut tree;
= P(16) – P(15) v. the velocity of the stone at the time in (iv);
But vi. the greatest height the stone reached.
P(16) = 162 + 20(16) + 8000
= 8,576 4. A particle is moving in a straight line. It‟s
distance, s meters from a fixed point O after t
P(15) = 152 + 20(15) + 8000 seconds is given by s = t3 – 9t2 + 15t + 2.
= 8,525 Calculate;
i. the velocity at any time t;
P(16) – P(15) ii. its velocity after 6 seconds;
= 8,576 – 8,525 iii. the distance of the particle from o when it is
= 51 people instantly at rest;
iv. its acceleration after 4 seconds.
Exercises 20.18
1. Suppose a ball is thrown up into the air and 5. A car , starting at t = 0 seconds, travels a
its height after t seconds is s = 5 + 24t – 16t2 distance of s meters in t seconds where s = 30t
feet. Determine how long it will take the ball to – t2 .
7. A parachutist jumps out of an aero plane. This result can be used to find solutions to
The distance h meters through which she falls problems of the type:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
after t seconds is given by h = . Find; 1. If the radius of a circle is increased by a%
i. the distance she falls in the first second; what will be the corresponding change in the
ii. her velocity after 2 seconds . area?
8. A particle moves in a straight line so that its 2. If the radius of a circle is measured to be
distance s meters from a fixed point o at a time 10.0 ± 0.2 what will be the maximum error in
t is given by s = 1.5t3 – 10.5t2 – 4t + 10. calculating the area?
i. If the velocity after k seconds is 3.5m/s, find
the value of k. For problems involving rate of change;
ii. If its acceleration after q seconds is 6 m/s2, Identify the given rate, the given side (length,
find the value of q. height or radius) and the unknown rate. Set out
the formula for the unknown rate and
9. A particle moves along the x – axis in such a
way that the velocity v m/s after t seconds is differentiate the formula implicitly. Here, two
given by v = 2t3+ 9t2 – 5t . If the particle is at conditions arise.
the point (4, 0) at a time t = 0, find;
i. the position when t = 2. A. If the problem involves area (A) and radius
ii. the average velocity during the third seconds. (r), then it is likely that after implicity
iii. the acceleration when t = 3. differentiation of the formula of the unknown
rate, the given rate and the given side will
10. A ball is thrown vertically upwards from remain. In this case, substitute their values to
ground level and its height after t seconds is complete the work.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 30
viii. Simplify, where possible to complete the
The area is increasing at 30 cm2 per second.
work.
At r = 5 and =3
Method 2
= 2 (5) (3) r = 12cm, =? = 0.2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Solution Let l represent side of the cube
Let V be the volume of the cube;
L be the length of a side, = 2 = 2.5 , = ? and l = 2
V be the volume,
A be the surface area.
V=
=3 (implicit diff)
= 9, = ? and l = 10
⇒3 = 2.5
Volume of a cube; =
V=
=3 At l = 2
= ( )
But =9 = 0.2083
⇒3 =9
= ………………...(1) 5. The volume of a sphere is increasing at a rate
of 3 cm3/s. Find the rate of increase of its
surface area, when the radius is 2 cm.
Surface area of a cube;
A=6
Solution
= 12 …………...(2)
=3, = ? and r = 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put eqn (1) in eqn eqn (2);
r= √
=8 . /
=2. / r= √
=
Put r = √ in eqn (1);
At r = 2;
=
= 4√ 5
=3 = 0.0163
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
surface area when its volume is cm3.
0.25 cm/s, what is the radius of the sphere?
2. If the radius of a sphere starts to increase at a 11. The volume of a cube is increasing at a rate
rate of 0.1 cm/s, what will be the rate of change of 300cm3/min at the instant when the edge is
of volume, at an instant when the radius is 10 20cm. Find the rate at which the edge is
cm? changing.
Then A = x2 ⇒ = 2x and x = 5
Note that whenever an error occurs, there is a
change. Therefore, the small change formula is
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
From = 2x; helpful here.
set out the small change formula as A change in volume is indicated as ∆v;
A change in surface area is indicated as ∆s;
where ∆A is the change in area
A change in area is indicated as ∆a;
∆x is the change in side
A change in radius is indicated as ∆r and so on.
∆A = ?, ∆x = 0.01 , = 2x and x = 5
, , indicate % error in volume, surface
∆A ≈ ∆x area and radius respectively;
∆x = (2) (5) (0.01) = 0.1
The increase in area ≈ 0.1 cm2 Worked Examples
1. A 2% error is made in measuring the radius
Method 2 of a sphere. Find the percentage error in the
A = x2 =? volume.
= (x2) Solution
= 2x Let the radius be r and the volume be V .
V= r3
But x = 5, and = 0.01 = 4πr2
= 2(5) (0.01) Error in radius ∆r = 2% r = = 0.02r
= 0.1 Error in volume ∆v = ?
The increase in area ≈ 0.1 cm2
Set out the small change formula as;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
V=
2. A 2% error is made in measuring the radius
of a sphere. Find the percentage error in surface =3×
area. =4
Solution
% error in volume = 9% = 0.09
Let the surface area be S and the radius be r,
S = 4 r2 Error in radius ∆r = ?
=8 r
Set up the small change formula as;
=
Error in radius, ∆r = 2% r = 0.02r
Error in surface area ∆s = ? ∆v = × ∆r
∆v = 4 × ∆r
Set out the small change formula as ;
= =
⁄
8 r= =
∆s ≈ 8 r (0.02r)
Percentage error in Volume, = 9%
∆s ≈
∆s ≈ 0.16 9% =
=
The percentage error in surface area;
= 3%
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=
⁄
2. An error of 2.5% is made in the measurement
= of the area of a circle. What is the percentage
error in :
Percentage error in volume, = 6% a. the radius of the circle?
b. the circumference of the circle?
6% =
3. The error in the measurement of the radius of
= a sphere is 2%. What will be the error in the
= 2% calculation of its volume?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Greatest and Least Values y=2
Curves of the form ax2 + bx + c = 0, produce a At the point (1, 2) the gradient is zero.
∪ or ∩ shape depending on the nature of the
coefficient of x2. When it is positive, we have a ii. The greatest value is y = 2
minimum curve ∪ and when it negative, we
have a maximum curve ∩. 2. i. At what point on the curve y = 4x2 – 6x + 2
is the gradient zero?
A ∪ – shaped curve decreases from left to the ii. Find the greatest or least value
minimum or least point where its gradient is
zero and starts increasing to the right from the Solution
minimum point. At the least point, the gradient y = 4x2 – 6x + 2
is zero.
At the least point =0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(max curve )
y = 13
At the maximum point; The curve y = -3x2 + 12x + 1 is maximum at the
=0 point (2, 13)
= - 2x + 12
Exercises 20.22
- 2x + 12 = 0 A. Find the turning points on the following
- 2x = - 12 curves and determine whether y has a
x=6 maximum or minimum value at each;
1. y = x3 – 12x 2. y = x2 (3 – x )
Maximum value of A;
3. y = x(x – 8) (x – 15)
A = - x2 +12x + 39
A = - (6)2 + 12(6) + 39 4. y = x3 – 5x2 + 3x + 2 5. y = 4x2 +
A = 75 (maximum curve)
4. i. Given that the curve, y = ax2 + 12x + 1 has B. Find the maximum or minimum values.
a turning point at x = 2, calculate the value of a. 1. f (x) = 4x – 3x3
ii. Show whether the point is maximum or 2. f (x) = 2x3 – 3x2 – 12x – 7
minimum? 3. f (x) = x + 4. f (x) = x2 (x – 4)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. a maximum
y=0
2. a minimum
Stationary point (1, 0)
3. a point of inflection
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
By substitution, Observations
( ) ( ) ( ) 1. If the second derivative is positive, then the
gradient of the graph is always increasing. The
( )
stationary point is a minimum. That is > 0.
( )
2. If the second derivative is negative, then the
) gradient of the graph is always decreasing. The
stationary point is a maximum. That is <0
( )( )
3. If the second derivative is zero, then the
gradient of the graph is neither increasing nor
decreasing. Further investigation is required at
At the turning point, =0
( )( ) this stage. That is =0
0=
(x – 1) (x + 1) = 0 If = 0, pick a point on either side of the
x = 1 or x = - 1 stationary point and observe if any of the
following conditions exist;
( ) a. Both y – coordinates less than that of
When x = 1, y= =0
( ) the stationary point ⇒ maximum
When x = -1, y = =4
The stationary points occur at (1, 0) and (-1, 4) b. Both y – coordinates greater than that of
the stationary point ⇒ minimum
Exercises 20.23
Find the coordinates of the stationary points.
=0
Solution
⇒ 3x2 – 3 = 0 y = 3x3 – 5
3(x2 – 1) = 0 = 9x2
3(x – 1) (x + 1) = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x = 1 or x = - 1 =0
This means that we have an x – coordinate of 1 ⇒ 9x2 = 0
and another x – coordinate of -1. x=0
At x = 0, y = 3(0)2 – 5
y = -5
At x = 1, y = 13 – 3 (1) + 2 The stationary point is (0, -5)
y=1–3+2
y=0 To classify the stationary point,
Stationary point (1, 0) = (9x2 )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3x2 = 3y2
12x3 – 12x2 = 0
x=y
12x2 (x – 1) = 0
x = 0 or x = 1
iii. At (1, -1)
When x = 0 , y = 0 =
When x = 1 , y = -1 ( ) ( )
=
The stationary points are (0, 0) and (1, -1) ( ) ( )( )
=0
To investigate the stationary point;
y + 1 = 0 (x – 1)
= 36x2 – 24x y+1=0
The equation of the normal is y + 1 = 0
At x = 0, =0
The point (0, 0) is a point of inflection 4. Let y = x3 – x2 – 9x + 9 be the equation of a
curve.
At x = 1, = 36 – 24 = 12 i. determine the intercepts the coordinates make
The point (1, -1) is a local minimum point. with the x – axis.
ii. find the turning point on the curve,
3. A function is given as y3 + 3xy2 – x3 = 3. distinguishing between them.
i. Find an expression for .
Solution
ii. Find the stationary point.
y = x3 – x2 – 9x + 9
iii. Find the equation of the normal at the point
(1, -1) On the y – axis, x = 0
On the x – axis, y = 0
When x = 2.1,
0 = x3 – x2 – 9x + 9
= 6 (2.1) – 2 = 10.6 > 0
Using factor theorem, Hence, (2.1, -5.05) is a minimum point.
x3 – x2 – 9x + 9 = 0
(x – 1) (x – 3) ( x + 3) = 0 When x = -1.4,
x = 1 or x = 3 or x = - 3 . = 6 (-1.4) – 2 = 10.4 < 0
Hence, and (-1.4, 16.9) is a maximum point.
Intercept on the x – axis are the points (1, 0),
(3, 0) and (-3, 0) Exercises 20.24
A. Classify the stationary points of the
ii. y = x3 – x2 – 9x + 9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
following curves.
= 3x2 – 2x – 9 1. y = x9 4. y = 10x – x2
2
2. y = x + 3x + 4 5. y = 12(x + 1)3 + 6
At the turning point ; 3. y = x2 – 2x + 5 6. y = 3x2 + 6x – 5
=0
3x2 – 2x – 9 = 0 B. Locate the position and nature of the
a = 3, b = -2 and c = - 9 turning points of the following functions.
1. y = x2 – 2x 4. y = -3x2 + 3x + 1
x=
( ) √( ) ( )( ) 2. y = x2 + 4x + 1 5. y = x4 + 2
( ) 3. y = 12x – 2x2 6. y = 7 – 2x4
( ) √
x=
√
C. Locate the position and nature of the
x= turning points of the following functions.
x=
√
or x =
√ 1. y = 2x3 – 9x2 + 12x
2. y = 4x3– 6x2 –72x + 1
x = 2.1 or x = -1.4
3. y = - 4x3 + 30x2 – 48x – 1
When x = 2.1, y = (2.1)3 – (2.1)2 – 9(2.1) + 9
y = -5.05 Appliction of Maxima and Minima
Steps
When x = - 1.4, y = (-1.4)3 – (-1.4)2 – 9(-1.4) + 9 1. Read the problem carefully.
y = 16.9 2. If possible, make a sketch of the problem.
The turning points are (2.1, -5.05) and 3. Define variables to be used and carefully
(-1.4, 16.9) label the diagram with the variables.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
is 9 and so that the product of one number and Let variable x be the length of one edge of the
the square of the other number is a maximum. square base and variable y be the height of the
box.
Solution
Let x and y represent the two nonnegative
numbers. The sum of the two numbers is given
to be:
9=x+y x y
y=9–x
x
= 12 – x2 x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4 + x = 0 or 4 – x = 0
A = 500x – x2
x = - 4 or x = 4 (ignore negative answer)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x x
x 4 – 2x x V = - 0.44
4 Therefore, x ≠ 1.77, since volume cannot be
negative.
After removing the corners and folding up the
flaps, we obtain an ordinary rectangular box. When x = 0.56 ,
V = [4 – 2(0.56)] [3 – 2(0.56)]) (0.56)
V = (2.88) (1.88) (0.56)
x
V = 3.03
Therefore, the largest possible volume of the
3 – 2x box is 3.03cm3 which occurs at x = 0.56 cm
4 – 2x
Maximizing the volume of the box; 5. A container in the shape of a right circular
V = LWH cylinder with no top has surface area 3 ft 2.
V = (4 – 2x) (3 – 2x) (x) What height h and base radius r will maximise
V = (4 – 2x) (3x – 2x2) the volume of the cylinder?
V = 4 (3x – 2x2) – 2x (3x – 2x2)
V = 12x – 8x2 – 6x2 + 4x3 Solution
V = 4x3 – 14x2 + 12x Let r be the radius of the circular base and h be
the height of the cylinder.
= 12x2 – 28x + 12
Total surface area of the cylinder = 3
At the maximum point; (area of base) + (area of curved side) = 3
Solution
Maximizing the volume of the cylinder ; x x
V = r2 h x x
But h = – a – 2x
V = r2 . / x x
3 x a – 2x x
V= r– r
a
= – r2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Let the side length of the small squares be x cm.
= (1– r2)
The side length of the open box is (a – 2x) cm
and the height is x cm. Here a is a constant, and
At the maximum point; x is a variable to work with.
=0
0 = (1– r2) From (a – 2x) = 0;
a = 2x
3 (1– r2) = 0
x=
3 (1– r) (1 + r) = 0
(1– r) = 0 or (1 + r) = 0 0≤x≤
r = 1 or r = -1 (ignore negative answer)
r=1 The volume of the box is given by ;
Since the base of the box is a circle and there V = x(a – 2x)2
are 3 cm2 of material, it follows that 0 < r ≤ V = x(a2 – 4ax + 4x2)
√ . Hence the possible values for V to be V = 4x3 – 4ax2 + a2x
maximize are r = 1 and r = √ = 12x2 – 8ax + a2
= (2x – a) (6x – a)
When r = 1, V = (1)2 . /=
( )
√ =0
When r = √ , V = (√ )2 . /=
(√ ) 0 = (2x – a) (6x – a)
(2x – a) (6x – a) = 0
The maximum or largest possible volume of the 2x – a = 0 or (6x – a) = 0
cylinder is ft2, occurring at r = 1ft 2x = a or 6x = a
= 24. / – 8a x
x
= 4a – 8a Surface area, A
= - 4a < 0 (maximum) A = x2 + 4xh (open top)
1200 = x2 + 4xh
Hence , x = is a local maximum point. 4xh = 1200 – x2
This means that the maximum value of the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
h=
function is at x = .
h=. / cm
Put x = in V = x(a – 2x)2
b. V = x2h
V = . / 0 – . /1
But h =
V=. /0 – 1
V = x2 . /
V=. /0 – 1 V = 1200x – x3
V=. /0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. Find, correct to the nearest whole number,
V = - 2.0303
the maximum possible volume of the box.
V = - 2m3
Therefore, x ≠ 2.06, since volume cannot be
Solution
negative.
a a
a a When x = 0.61 ,
V = 4(0.61)3 – 16(0.61)2 + 15(0.61)
3 – 2a
V = 0.9079 – 5.9536 + 9.15
a a V = 4.1043
a 5 – 2a a
V = 4m3
5 Therefore, the largest possible volume of the
(5 – 2a )m box is 4m3 which occurs at a = 0.61m
(3 – 2a )m
2. A chemical industry manufactures closed
cylindrical metal containers to hold 50 cm3 of a
a
chemical. The total surface area, S cm2 of the
container is S = . r / cm2, where r is
Volume of the box; the radius of the cylinder. Find the value of r
V = lbh that will give the minimum surface area.
V = (5 – 2a) (3 – 2a) (a)
Solution
V = (15 – 16a + 4a2) (a)
V = 4a3 – 16a2 + 15a S=. r / cm2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
7. Find the dimensions of the rectangle of area
Exercises 20.25 100 square units that has the least perimeter.
A. 1. The figure below represents a rectangular
sheet of metal 8 cm × 5cm. 8. An open top box is to have a square base and
a volume of 13500 cm3. Find the dimension of
the box that minimize the amount of material
used.
2. Find two positive real numbers whose sum is 10. Build a rectangular pen with three parallel
50 and whose product is a maximum. partitions using 500 ft of fencing. What
dimensions will maximize the total area of he
3. Find two non negative numbers whose sum pen?
is 10 and that the sum of their squares is a
maximum. B. 1. A storage container is to be made in the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
available. Find the dimension of the cylinder a. How much material is wasted in making each
that give the maximum volume and find the soup can?
value of the maximum volume. b. Find the ratio of the height to diameter for
the most economical can (that is requiring the
4. A chemical factory wishes to make a least amount of material for manufacture.
cylindrical container, of thin metal, to hold c. Use either the first or second derivative test
10cm3, using the least possible area of metal. If to verify that you haveminimized the amount of
the outside surface is S cm2, and the radius is r material used r making each can.
cm, show that S = 2 r2 + and hence find the
required radius and height for the container. 3. A closed rectangular box is made of very
(leave in the answer) thin sheet metal, and its length is three times its
width. If the volume of the box is 288 cm3,
5. A cylinder with open top with radius, r and show that its surface area is equal to:
height h has a surface area of 8 cm2. Find the . / cm3, where x is the width of the
largest possible volume of such a cylinder.
box. Find by differentiating the dimensions of
Challenge Problems the box of least surface area.
1. An open top box is to have a square base and
a volume of 10m3. The cost per square meter of Curve Sketching
material is Ghȼ5 for the bottom and Ghȼ2 for The follwing steps are involed in curve
the four sides. Let x and y be the lengths of the sketching.
box‟s width and height respectively. Let C be 1. Find the intercept on x and y axis. On the x –
the total cost of materaila required to make the axis, let y = 0 and solve for x. On the y – axis,
box. let x = 0 and solve for y.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution = 3x2 – 3
y = x2 – 4x – 5
At the x – intercept, y = 0
0 = x2 – 4x – 5 At the stationary point , =0
(x – 5) (x + 1) = 0 (factorization) 3x2 – 3 = 0
x = 5 or x = -1 3(x2 – 1) = 0
The points (5, 0) and (-1, 0) are the intercept on 3(x + 1) (x – 1) = 0
the y – axis. x = 1 or x = -1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
∫ dx = ∫ 2x dx = x2 In words, increase the power by one and divide
by the new power.
∫ and dx go hand in hand and indicate the
integration of the function with respective to x. If a is a constant,
Likewise, ∫ s dt indicate the integration of s ∫ axn dx = a ∫ xn dx = + c, (n ≠1). This
with respect to t. The outcome of the
means that aconstant factor of the integrand can
integration is called integral.
be taken outside the symbol of integration.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B. Find the following: Solution
1. ∫ dx 2. ∫ dx 3. ∫
√
dx ∫. / dx
√
⁄
= ∫ xdx - ∫ 11dx + ∫ dx
Solution ⁄
= - 11x + 3 ∫ dx
1. ∫ dx
⁄
= +c = - 11x + 3 . +c
⁄
= x3 + c = x2 – 11x + 3 (2) ⁄
+c
⁄
= x2 – 11x + 6 +c
2. ∫ dx
= x2 – 11x + 6 √ + c
=∫ +c
= +c 2. Find ∫(2x – 3) (x2 + 1) dx
3. ∫ dx Solution
√
∫(2x – 3) (x2 + 1) dx
∫ ⁄ dx = ∫ 2x (x2 + 1) – 3(x2 + 1) dx
∫ dx = ∫ (2x3 + 2x – 3x2 – 3) dx
= ∫ (2x3 – 3x2 + 2x – 3) dx
= +c = ∫ 2x3 dx – ∫ 3x2 dx + ∫ 2x dx – ∫ 3 dx
= 2∫ x3 dx – 3 ∫ x2 dx + 2 ∫ x dx –3x
= +c =2. –3. +2. – 3x + c
⁄
⁄
= +c = – x3 + x2 – 3x + c
∫(x + 2)2 dx = + ⁄
+c
⁄
∫ (x2 + 4x + 4) dx ⁄
⁄
=6 + +c
= + + 4x + c
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
∫ (x . +2 dx
⁄
=∫ +2 dx ii. (x) = √
=
⁄
+2
⁄
+c (x) = ⁄
⁄ ⁄
⁄
= 2 +4 ⁄
+c f(x) = +c
Solution f(x) = +c
(x + 1)( x – 2)
Let y = (x + 1)( x – 2) Exercises 21.2
y = x2 – 2x + x – 2 A. Perfom the following integration:
y = x2 – x – 2 1. ∫ 2x5 dx
∫ =∫ dx 2. ∫ x7 – 3x + 2 ) dx
= – – 2x + c 3. ∫ (x2 – √ + 3) dx
4. ∫ (x2 – 5x + 1) (2 – 3x ) dx
6. Find ∫ dx 5. ∫ dx
√
=∫ . / dx 5. f(x) = x5 + 5 6. f(x) = x – x2
√ √
When y = 10, x = - 2
The General Solution 10 = 4(-2) + c
If = xn , then dy = (xn ) dx 10 = - 8 + c
Integrating both sides; 10 + 8 = c
∫ = ∫( ) dx c = 18
y = ∫( ) dx ⇒ y = 4x + 18
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Given the gradient function and a point where
it occurs on a line or a curve, the actual
This is called the general solution
equation of the line or the curve can be
= xn is called differential equation obtained.
Steps:
Worked Examples
1. Find all the possible formula for y , given 1. Set = (x)
that = x3 – 3x dy = (x) dx
∫ y = ∫ (x) dx
y = ∫ (x) dx
Solution
= x3 – 3x
2. Obtain y = f(x) + c
dy = (x3 – 3x) dx 3. Substitute the values of the given point (x, y)
y = ∫( ) dx in y = f(x) + c to obtain the value of c
y= – +c (consatant of integration)
4. Substitute the value of c in y = f(x) + c to
obtain the equation of the line or curve.
2. i. If = 4, find y in terms of x, given that
y = 10 when x = -2. Worked Examples
ii. What does the solution represents 1. The gradient of a curve y = f(x) at any point
graphically? is x – x2. If the curve passes through the point
(3, 5), find its equation.
Solution
y–6= (x – 2 )
5– + =c
6 (y – 6) = x – 2
c= 6y – 36 = x – 2
6y = x – 2 + 36
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Put c = in eqn (1) 6y = x + 34
y= – + y= +
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
between a certain range of the variable.
Solution ∫ (x) dx = , ( ) -
∫( ) =6
= (f(b) + c) – (f(a) + c)
+x+c=6
= f(b) – f(a)
At x = 2,
+ 2+ c = 6 The constant disappears; this is the definite
+c=6
Note
c=6– 1. The dx indicates that limits a and b are x
c= limits.
2. The constant a is called the lower limit of the
2. Find the function y = f(x), given that (x) = integral .
5 – 2x and that the graph of y = f(x) passes 3. The constant b is called the upper limit of the
through the point (1, 7). integral.
4. There is no constant of integration when
Solution definite integrals are evaluated, as they cancel
Let y = f(x), out each other.
(x) = 5 – 2x
Worked Examples
f(x) = 5x – +c
1. Find ∫ dx
f(x) = 5x – x2 + c
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) ( ) ∫ ( ) dx
= 0 1– 0 1
= 0 1 –, - = 0 1
= 8.6 = ,( )-
= ,( ( )- – ,( ( )-
3. Evaluate ∫ ( )dx
= (, -–, -)
Solution = (10 – 0)
∫ ( )dx =5
=0 1 Exercises 21.4
Evaluate each of the following:
=0 1
1. ∫ dx 2. ∫ dx 3. ∫ dx
( ) ( )
=0 ( ) ( )1 – 0 ( ) ( )1
4. ∫ √ d dx 5. ∫ dx 6. ∫ dx
=. /– . / =. /=9
B. Evaluate each of the following:
4. Evaluate ∫ ( )dx 1. ∫ ( )dx
2. ∫ ( )dx
Solution
3. ∫ ( )dx
∫ ( )dx
4. ∫ ( ) dx
∫ ( )dx
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
u, the integrand is simpler than when written
∫ ( ) dx = , ( )- = F(b) – F(a) interms of x.
2. Transform the integral with respect to x into
Let us consider; an integral with respect to u by replacing g(x)
∫ ( ) dx = , ( )- everywhere by u and g’(x) dx by du.
= [ ( ) – ( )] 3. Integrate the resulting function of u.
= F(a) – F(b) 4. Substiute back u = g(x) to express the results
in trems of x.
= ∫ ( ) dx
Worked Examples
∫ ( ) dx = ∫ ( ) dx 1. Find ∫ ( ) dx
0 1 =9
Substitute dx= in ∫ ( ) dx
⇒0 1–0 1=9 ⇒∫ ( )
0 1 –0=9 = ∫( ) du
( ) = +c
= +c ⁄
⁄
= +c
4
2. Find ∫ (2x + 3) dx = ⁄
+c (substitute u = 1 - x2)
⁄
Solution = ( ) +c
∫ (2x + 3)4 dx
Let u = 2x + 3 4. Find ∫ . / dx
=2
dx = Solution
∫. / dx
4
Put u = 2x + 3 and dx = in ∫ (2x + 3) dx ∫( ) dx
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4
= ∫ (u)
Let u =
=∫
=
= +c du = dx
( )
= +c du = dx
3. Perform ∫ √ dx Substitute dx = du in ∫( ) dx
Solution ⇒∫( ) du
∫ √ dx =∫ ( ) du
2
Let u = 1 – x =∫ ( ) du
= -2x
= +c (substitute u = )
du = - 2x dx
dx = = +c
( )
( )
= +c
( )
Put u = 1 - x2 and dx = in∫ √ dx
⇒∫ √ ( ) Exercises 21.6
A. Find each of the following:
⇒∫ √ du
⁄ 1. ∫( ) dx 2. ∫ ( ) dx
= ∫ du
3. ∫ ( ) dx 4. ∫ ( ) dx
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. The differential dx changes to an expression
involving du. ⁄
=
3. The bounds of integration changes forn from
⁄
values of x into values of u. =0 1
⁄
=0 1
To change the bounds,
1. Use the expression that relate x and u. =0 ⁄
1
2. Put in the original lower bound for x and
⁄ ⁄
solve for u to obtain new lower bound. =0 ( ) 1– 0 ( ) 1
3. Put in the original upper bound for x and = ( 27 – 1 )
solve for u to obtain new upper bound.
=
Note:
Changing the limit or bound to that of u is 2. Evaluate ∫ dx
√
matter of choice, but that makes the
substitution easier. Solution
Worked Examples ∫ √
⁄ ⁄ ∫ cot ln |sin | + c
=[ ⁄
] ∫ sec ln |sec t n |+c
⁄
∫ csc ln |csc cot | + c
⁄ ⁄
=0 1
=0 ( ) ⁄
( ) ⁄
1-0 ( ) ⁄
( ) ⁄
1 Worked Examples
Compute the following:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
⁄ ⁄
=0 ( ) 1 1. ∫ sin
= 4.7140
2. ∫ t n
= ∫ sin
Integration of Simple Trigonometric Function
= ( cos ) + c
Integral General Rule =– cos u + c
∫ cos sin x + c
=– cos 3x + c
∫ sin - cos x + c
∫ tan x + c
2. ∫ t n
∫ csc - cot x + c
Let u = 5x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
cos2 A = (1 + cos 2A)
dx = du
If x = A;
cos2 x = (1 + cos 2x)
∫ cos( ) = ∫ cos
= ∫ cos
∫ x= ∫( cos ) dx
= sin u + c
= [∫ cos ∫ ( ) ]
= sin (2x – 6) + c
= 0 sin( )1 + c
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
∫ sin2 x dx = ∫ (1 − cos 2x) dx most cases.
= ∫ (1 − cos 2x)dx
Type 3(Combination of sine and cosine)
= 0. sin /1 + c Worked Examples
= x – . sin /+c Find ∫ sin 3x cos 2x dx.
= x – ( sin cos ) + c
Solution
= x – sin x cos x + c ∫ sin 3x cos 2x dx.
Use the identity;
2. Evaluate ∫ x dx 2 sin A cos B = sin (A + B) + sin (A − B) to
express the integrand as the sum of two sine
Solution functions.
∫ x dx sin A cos B = [sin (A + B) + sin (A− B)]
Substitution wont work because this integral ∫sin A cos B = ∫ [sin (A + B) + sin (A− B)]
do not have the cosine
∫sin A cos B = ∫ [sin (A + B) + sin (A− B)]
∫ x dx
=∫ x sin x dx (strip out sin x)
) sin x dx……………(1) Let A = 3x and B = 2x we have
= ∫(
∫ sin 3x cos 2x dx
From trigonometry, cos2 x + sin2 x = 1 = ∫ [sin (3x + 2x ) + sin (3x - 2x)] dx
sin2 x = 1 – cos2 x = ∫ (sin 5x + sin x)dx
= ∫( – ) sin x dx……………(1) = . cos cos / + c
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Let u = sin x
Type 1: Integrals in which m is odd. ∫ cos x dx
In this integral, if the exponent on the sines (m) = ∫ du
is odd ,strip out one sine, convert the rest to = +c
cosines using the identity cos2 x + sin2 x =
1 and then use the substitution , u = cos x
Type 2: Integrals in which m is even and n is
.
odd.
Likewise, if the exponent on the cosines (n) is
In the case when m is even and n is odd, use the
odd strip out one cosine and convert the rest to
identity cos2 A = 1 − sin2 A and the substitution
sines and the use the substitution u = sin x
u = sin x.
.
Worked Examples Worked Examples
1. Find ∫ sin3 x cos2 x dx. 1. Find ∫ sin 4 x cos 3x dx
Solution Solution
∫ sin3 x cos2 x dx. ∫ sin4 x cos3 x dx
Rewrite the term sin3 x as sin x sin 2 x, and use ∫ sin4 x (cos2 x ·cos x) dx.
the identity sin2 x = 1 − cos2 x.
Using the identity cos2 x = 1− sin2 x
The reason for doing this will become apparent. ∫ sin4 x (cos2 x cos x) dx
∫ sin3 x cos2 x dx = ∫ sin4 x (1 − sin2 x) cos x dx
= ∫ (sin x· sin2 x) cos2 x dx = ∫ (sin4 x cos x − sin6 x cos x) dx
= ∫ sin x (1 − cos2 x) cos2 x dx
= − +c = sin ( ) +c
= − +c
Exercises 21.9
A. Find the following integrals.
2. Find the integral ∫ dx 1. ∫ cos3 x dx
2. ∫ cos5 x dx
Solution 3. ∫ sin5 x cos2 x dx.
∫ dx
=∫ dx B. 1. Evaluate ∫ sin2 x cos2 x dx by using the
=∫ ( ) dx double angle formulae
sin2 x = , cos2 x =
Let u = sin x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=∫ ( ) du 2. Using the double angle formulae twice find
= ∫( ) du ∫ sin4 x cos2 x dx.
= sin x – sin x + c
Kinematics
Type 3 : Integrals in which m and n are even A. Motion in a Straight Line
In the case when both m and n are even, try Under differentiation, when the displacement s
using the double angle formulae: is differentiated the velocity v, is obtained.
When velocity v, is futher differentiated, the
cos2 x = (1 + cos 2x);
acceleration a , is obtained. That is:
sin2 x = (1 – cos 2x); If s denotes the displacement (position) of a
particle from a fixed point, at a time t, then;
Worked Examples 1. Velocity , v = , the rate of change of
1. Evaluate ∫ sin 2 x cos 2 x dx
position with respect to time.
Solution
∫ sin 2 x cos 2 x dx 2. Acceleration , a = =
= ∫ (1 − cos 2x) (1 + cos 2x) dx
Since integration is the reverses of
= ∫ (1 − (2x) dx differentiation, we integrate acceleration a, to
obtain the velocity v, and v is further integrated
Using the half – angle formular for cos2 to obtain displacement s.
That is: cos2 2x = (1 + cos 2x)
If a particle moving in a straight line with
= ∫ (1 − (1 + cos (4x) dx acceleration a, is a function of t , then:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. v = ii. the distance it has covered within that time.
v dt = ds
Solution
⇒ ds = v dt
a = 3 + 2t
Integrating both sides, a= = 3 + 2t
∫ds = ∫v dt = 3 + 2t
s = ∫v dt
dv = (3 + 2t) dt
v = ∫( ) dt
Worked Examples
1. A particle P is moving along a staright line v = 3t + +c
2
from a fixed point O on it. The acceleration of v = 3t + t + c
P after t seconds is given by 3t2 + 2t .
Find an expression for the velocity of P at any Before the truck starts from rest;
time t and find the velocity after 3 seconds. t = 0, and v = 0
⇒ 0 = 3(0) + (0)2 + c
Solution c=0
a= = 3t2 + 2t
2 v = 3t + t2
dv = (3t + 2t) dt
At v = 18,
v = ∫ (3t2 + 2t)
18 = 3t + t2
v= + +c t2 + 3t – 18 = 0
v = t3 + t2 + c (t – 3) (t + 6) = 0
t = 3 or t = - 6 (ignore – ve answer)
At rest, v = 0 and t = 0; t = 3s
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 653
ii. v = = 3t + t2 48t where S is measured in meters and t in
seconds.
= 3t + t2 i. Find the velocity of the particle at time t.
ds = (3t + t2) dt ii. The particle stops moving twice, once when
ds = ∫ (3t + t2) dt time A and again when t = B, where A< B.
s= + +c Determine A and B.
iii. What is the position of the particle at time
12s?
when t = 0, s = 0
( ) ( ) iv. What is the total distance the particle travels
0= + +c between time 0 and time 12?
c=0
4. A particle moves along a staright line such
s= +
that its displacement at any time is given by
S = t3 – 6t2 + 3t + 4. Find the velocity when the
At t = 3
( ) ( )
acceleration is zero.
s= +
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
s= + B. Motion under Constant Acceleration
Consider a body moving under a constant
s = 22.5m
acceleration, a. If the initial velocity is given
Exercises 21.10 as u, the velocity after time t is v and the
1. A particle moves along a straight line so that displacement from the initial point after time t
at the end of t second the its acceleration a m/s2 is s. Then
is give by the relation a = t + 2. If the particle a=
started from rest , find its velocity at the end of a dt = dv
3 seconds and the distance covered during the dv = a dt
next second. v = ∫ a dt
v = at + c
2. A train runs between two consecutive
stations with a velocity given by . / At t = 0;
where t seconds is the time after passing v=c
through the first station. The velocity is Let u = v = c
measured in kilometer per second. Find: Then v = at + u
i. the time taken between the two stations. v = u + at ……………..(1)
ii. the maximum velocity attained.
Also,
iii. the distance between the two stations.
v=
3. A particle moves along a straight line and the v dt = ds
position at time t is given by S = 2t3 – 18t2 + ds = v dt
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
s = (v – u) + ( )
Solution
( ) ( )
s= + Initial velocity u = 6m/s
Final velocity v = 9m/s
Factorize out Time t = ?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. u = 0, v = 14, a = g = 9.8, s = 10, t = ?
From v = u + at
t=
t=
When calculating the area under a curve f(x),
t= seconds follow the steps below:
1. Sketch the area.
Exercises 21.11 2. Determine the boundaries a and b,
1. A stone is projected vertically upwards from 3. Set up the definite integral,
a height 5m above the ground. It takes 3.2s for 4. Integrate.
it to return to the point of projection. Find the
total distance covered. A. Area between a curve and the x – axis
The area between a curve and the x-axis is the
2. A car travels in a straight line under a definite integral of the function of the curve
constant acceleration. In the 5th second, the car within the given range of x.
tarvels 15m, and in the 6th second, it travels y
12m. Find the speed of the car at t = 0. f(x)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
y
Worked Examples
1. Find the area under the curve, f(x) = x2, for
-1 ≤ x ≤ 2.
A>0
x
a b A<0 c
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
boundary at a. The value x = -2 is a solution
to the equation above but it is not bounding the
area.
A1 = ∫ ( – 8) dx
A1 = 0 8 1
( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ab
A1 = 0 8( )1 – 0 8( )1
-4
A1 = 0 1–0 81
A=0 1
A2 = ∫ ( – 8) dx
( ) ( )
A=0 ( )1 – 0 ( )1
A2 = 0 8 1
( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) A=0 1 –0 81
A2 = 0 8( )1 – 0 8( )1
A= 8
A2 = 0 1–0 1
square units.
A2 = –. /
A2 = square units 3. Find the under the curve, f(x) = x(x – 2) (x +
2), for -1 ≤ x ≤ 1.
Solution
y = x3 – 5x2 + 6x
Solution
Solving for the x – coordinates of the
To avoid the error, we have to integrate it in
intersection points of the curve and the x- axis
two parts:
x3 – 5x2 + 6x = 0
from x = -1 to x = 0 and x = 0 to x = 1.
x(x2 – 5x + 6) = 0
Area of the left part A1 x(x – 2) (x – 3) = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x = 0, or x = 2 or x = 3
=∫ x(x – 2)(x + 2) dx
x1 = 0, or x2 = 2 or x3 = 3
=∫ x3 – 4x dx
=0 1
y = x3 – 5x2 + 6x
=0 1
( ) ( )
=0 ( ) 1–0 ( ) 1 A1
= [0 – . /] 0 2 A2 3
=
The required area is:
Area of the right part A2 ; A = A1 + A2
= ∫ x(x – 2)(x + 2) dx A1 = 0 ≤ x ≤ 2 , the curve above the x- axis
= ∫ x3 – 4x dx A2 = 2 ≤ x ≤ 3 , the curve below the x- axis
=0 1 A1 = ∫ ( – ) dx
=0 1 A1 = 0 1
( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
=0 ( ) 1–0 ( ) 1 A1 = 0 1-, -
= A1 =
Since area cannot be negative, the value is A2 = ∫ ( – ) dx
A2 = 0
( ) ( ) ( )
1–0
( ) ( ) ( )
1 B =0 1
A2 = . / B=0 1
A2 = ( ) ( )
B=0 ( ) ( ) 1 – 0 ( ) ( ) 1
B= square units
A = A1 + A2
A= + B = square units (ignore –ve sign)
A= square units
A = A+ B
A= +
5. Calculate the areas of the segments
contained between the x-axis and the curve y = A = square units
x(x − 1)(x − 2).‟
4. Find the area between the curve y = x(x − 3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution and the ordinates x = 0 and x = 5.
y = x(x − 1)(x − 2)
Solution
On the x – axis, y = 0
x(x − 3) = 0,
x = 0 or x = 3.
The curve cuts the x-axis at x = 0 and x = 3.
A
0 1 B 2 When x = 0, y = 0
When x = 3, y = 0
Area A, is given by the integral from x = 0 to x
= 1 of the curve y = x(x − 1)(x − 2) = x3 − 3x2 + Intercepts = (0, 0) and (0, 3)
2x; The x2 term is positive, and so the curve forms
A=∫ a U-shape as shown below. y = x(x − 3)
A =∫ ( ) A=∫
A =∫ ( )
A=0 1
A=0 1
A=0 1
( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
( ) ( ) A=0 1–0 1
A=0 ( ) ( ) 1–0 ( ) ( ) 1
A=. /–0
A1 = square units
A=
Total area = A + B
y = x2 + x + 4
Total area = +
Total area = square units
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A
5. Find the area of the region that is bounded 1 3
by the curve y = √ , the line x = 1 and the x –
axis. A=∫
A =∫ ( )
Solution
y=√ , y=√ , A=0 1
⁄
A=∫ dx ( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
A=0 ( )1 - 0 ( )1
⁄ A
A= [ ⁄
] A=0 1–0 1
⁄ 1 A= square units
A=
( ) ⁄ ( ) ⁄
A= 0 1–0 1 C. Area between two curves
1. Find the point of intersection of the two
A= 0 1 – , -
curves.
A = square units 2. Subtract the areas under the curves between
the points of intersection.
6. Find the area bounded by the curve y = x2+ x
+ 4, the x-axis and the ordinates x = 1 and x = 3. This can be done by the evaluation of one
integral using the x – coordinates of the point
Solution of intersection as the limits.
y = 0 to obtain the quadratic equation:
First, find the point of intersection of the curve So, the area of the shaded region;
and the line. A = A1 - A2 + A3
A= – +
At the point of intersection,
x(x – 2) = x A= square units
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x2 – 2x –x = 0
x2 – 3x = 0 2. Find the area of the region bounded by the
x(x – 3) = 0 parabola y = x2 and the line y = x + 2.
x = 0 or x = 3
Solution
Area below the x-axis A1; y = x2 and y = x + 2
Solve for the x – coordinates point of
A1 = ∫ (x2 – 2x) dx
intersection of the curve and the x – axis.
A1 = 0 1 x2 = x + 2
x2 - x + 2 = 0
A1 = 0 1 (x – 2) (x + 1) = 0
A1 = 0 1 x = 2 or x = -1
Now, let x1 = -1 and x2 = 2
A1 = y=x+2
A1 =
A2 = 0 1 -1 2
3. Calculate the area of the segment cut from The area under the straight line is
the curve y = x(3 − x) by the line y = x.
=∫
Solution =∫
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=0 1
y=x
P
( ) ( )
=0 1–0 1
=, -
y = x(3 – x)
= 2 square units
Worked Examples ⁄
A=0 1
1. Find the first quadrant area bounded by the
following curves: y = x2 + 2 , y = 4 and x = 0 . ( ) ⁄ ( ) ⁄
A=0 1–0 1
Solution A = 1.8856 square units
A=∫ ( ) dy
2
y = x + 2 , y = 4 and x = 0 . Area of a Rectangle
y
Determine the boundary values of c and d.
On the y – axis, x = 0 y=a
a
y = (0)2 + 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
y=2
0 b x
The boundary values of c = 2 and d = 4
From y = x2 + 2, express x in trems of y The equation of the line is y = a
x2 = y – 2
So, the area under the line that forms the
x= √ (ignore negative in the first quadrant)
rectangle = ∫ a dx
d
Area = , -
A Area = ab
Area = length × width
c
Area of a Triangle
x= √ y
h
A = ∫ (√ ) dy y = mx
⁄
A=∫ ( ) dy
0 b x
Using u – substitution;
Let u = y – 2 The equation of the line is y = mx, where m is
=1 the gradient.
So, the area under the line that forms the
dy = du
triangle = ∫ mx dx
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Explain your answer.
y = mx + a
b
P Q
2. The diagram shows the graph of y = 4x – x2. 5. The diagram shows part of the graph of
y = 3 – 3x2.
y = 4x – x2.
y = 3 – 3x2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Calculate the area between the curve and the x- Calculate the shaded area.
axis.
6. The diagram shows the graph of
3. The diagram shows part of the graph y = x2 – 2x – 12.
of y = 6x + 2x2.
y = x2 – 2x – 12.
2
y = 6x + 2x
A 1 4
4. The dagram shows part of the graph of 7. The diagram shows part of the graph of
y = 2x2 – 18. y = 10 – 4x – 3x2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a. Find the coordinates of A and B.
b. Calculate the shaded area.
a. Find the coordinates of A and B.
b. Calculate the shaded area.
9. The diagram opposite shows part of the
graph of y = x3 – 3x2 + 2x.
12. The diagram shows the graph of
y = x4 – 5x2 + 4.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=
2
Now imagine that a curve, for example y = x ,
=
is rotated around the x-axis so that a solid is
formed. The volume of the shape that is formed =
can be found using the formula:
Volume = ∫ dx Rotation about the y-axis
If the body is rotated about the y-axis rather
Worked Examples than the x-axis, then we use the formula:
1. The graph of y = x2 between x = 1 and x = 3 Volume = ∫ dy
is rotated completely about the x – axis. Find
the volume generated. Worked Examples
Solution 1. Find the volume of a solid generated by
y = x2 , a = 1 and b = 3 rotating about the y – axis the area bounded by
Volume = ∫ dx the y – axis , the line y = 2x + 2 and the lines
y = 4 and y = 7.
Volume = ∫ ( ) dx (substitute y = x2)
Volume = ∫ dx Solution
y = 2x + 2, a = 4 , b = 7
=0 1
Volume = ∫ dy
( ) ( )
=0 1–0 1
From y = 2x + 2,
= – 2x = y – 2
= x=
x2 =
5. Find the volume of the solid generated by
2 2
x = (y – 4y + 4) rotating about the y – axis the area bounded by
the y – axis, the line 2x – y – 2 = 0 and the lines
Volume = ∫ dy y = 2 and y = 6.
Volume = ∫ ( – ) dy
6. A conical funnel is formed by rotating the
= ∫ ( – ) dy curve y = about the y-axis. The radius of the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 0 1 rim of the funnel is to 6 cm. Find the depth of
the funnel and its volume.
= 0 1
7. Sketch the curve y2 = x(x − 4)2 and find the
= 0. 8 8/ – . /1 volume of the solid of revolution formed when
= . / the closed loop of the curve is rotated about the
x-axis.
= ( )
= B. Find the volume of the solid of revolution
generated when the area described is rotated
about the x-axis.
Exercises 21.13
1. The area between the curve y = x and the
A. 1. The equation of the line k is 3x + 2y – 6 =
ordinates x = 0 and x = 4.
0. Find the volume of the cone generated by
2. The area between the curve y = x3/2 and the
rotating the areas bounded by k and the axes
ordinates x = 1 and x = 3.
about:
3. The area between the curve x2 + y2 = 16 and
i. the x – axis ii. the y – axis
the ordinates x = −1 and x = 1.
4. The area between the curve x2 − y2 = 9 and
2. The area cut off by the x-axis and the curve
the ordinates x = − 4 and x = −3.
y = x2 − 3x is rotated about the x-axis. Find the
5. The area between the curve y = (2 + x)2 and
volume of the solid of revolution formed.
the ordinates x = 0 and x = 1.
3. The area between the curve y = , the y-axis The Trapezium Rule
and the lines y = 1 and y = 2 is rotated about the To find the area under a curve,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
yn – 2 yn – 1 yn 3.25 y5 = 0.3077
y0 y1 y2
3.5 y6 = 0.2857
a b x 3.75 y7 = 0.2667
4 y8 = 0.2500
If we looked at the total area of the trapeziums,
you would get: Write out the formula.
A= (yfirst + y1)h + (y1 + y2)h + (y2 + y3)h + (y4 A = × h (yfirst + ylast + 2(sum of the rest )
+ ylast)h
yfirst + ylast = 0.5000 + 0.2500
Factorise the common factors, to obtain = 0.7500
A = × h (yfirst + y1 + y1 + y2 + y2 + y3 + y3 + y4 + y4 (sum of the rest )
+ ylast = 0.4444 + 0.4000 + 0.3636 + 0.3333 + 0.3077
+ 0.2857 + 0.2667
This can s further be simplified to obtain the = 2.4014
formula:
A = × h (yfirst + ylast + 2(y1 + y2 + y3 + y4 ) Substitute in
A = × h (yfirst + ylast + 2(sum of the rest )
This formula can be made more general for any
A = × (0.25) (0.7500 + 2(2.4014)
amount of trapeziums.
A = × (0.25) (0.7500 + 4.8028)
A = × h (yfirst + ylast + 2(sum of the rest )
A = × (0.25) (5.5528)
A = 0.6941 square units (4 decimal places)
This is called the trapezium rule:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 4 + 5 + 7 = 16
A1 = × (0.2) (28.00 + 73.60)
Substitute in
A1 = × (0.2) (101.60)
A = × h (yfirst + ylast + 2(sum of the rest )
A1 = 10.16 (2 decimal places)
A = × (1) (4 + 2(16)
y= =( )
( )
A = × (1) (4 + 32)
A = × 36 x y=( )
A = 18 square units 3 1.0000
3.2 0.3644
3.4 0.1715
3. Use the trapezium rule with ordinates at x = 3.6 0.0939
3, 3.2, 3.4, 3.6, 3.8, and 4.0 to find, correct to 3.8 0.0569
two decimal places, the finite area enclosed by 4 0.0370
the curves: y = (2x – 5)3, y = and the
( )
lines x = 3 and x = 4. A1 = ∫ ( ) dx, n = 5, h = = 0.2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution 1.9 2.1471
y = 6x – x2 2.3 2.5080
At the x – axis , y = 0 2.6 2.7857
6x – x2 = 0 2.9 3.0676
x (6 – x ) = 0
x = 0 or 6 – x = 0 A = × h (yfirst + ylast + 2(sum of the rest )
x = 0 or x = 6
A=∫ ( – ) dx, n = 6, h = =1 yfirst + ylast = 1.4142 + 3.0676
= 4.4818
x 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 (sum of the rest )
y 0 5 8 9 8 5 0 = 1.6401 +1.8868 + 2.1471 + 2.5080 + 2.7857
= 10.9677
A=∫ ( – ) dx, n = 6, h = =1
A = × (0.3) (4.4818 + 2 (10.9677)
A = × h (yfirst + ylast + 2(sum of the rest )
A = × (0.3) (4.4818 + 21.9354)
4. Use the trapezium rule to estimate the area 3. a. Draw the graph of y = 4x2 from x = 0 to x
unser the curve given by : = 5, using a scale of 2cm to 1 unit on the x –
axis and 1cm to 10 units on the y – axis.
x 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 b. Draw ordinates at x = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5. Use
y 6 12 18 15 30 25 10 trapezium rule to estimate the area under the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
curve.
5. Copy and complete the table below for the
parabola y = 4x – x2 Challenge Problems
1. a. Copy and complete the table below, giving
x 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 values for √( ) to 3 decimal places.
y 0 1.8 3.0
X 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3
Use trapezium rule to estimate the area cut off
Y 1.414 1.957 3.000
between parabola abd the x – axis.
y
B. 1. A curve passes through the points given
by the following table:
x 0 2 4 6 8 10
y 4 4 3.5 4 5 6.5 R
0 3 x
a. Construct the curve on a graph sheet taking a
scale of 1 cm to 1 unit on each axis. Shade the The figure above shows the region R , bounded
area enclosed by the curve, the x – axis and the by the curve with equation
two end ordinates. y = √( ), the x – axis and the line x = 0
b. Estimate the area by the trapezium rule, and x = 3. Use trapezium rule with all the
taking 5 strips. values from your table to find an
approximation for the area of R
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ordered arrangements is ab.
Now, out of four or more different objects,
listing all the permutations could be a bit Worked Examples
tedious. Thus, the fundamental counting 1. Find the number of arrangements if a die is
principle for calculating the number of rolled;
permutation is used. a. 2 times b . 4 times c. r times
For four different objects ABCD;
= (4)(3)(2)(1) Solution
= 24 Outcomes on a die = 6
a. 2 times = 62 = 6 × 6 = 36
For five different objects ABCDE; b. 4 times = 64 = 6 × 6 × 6 × 6 = 1,296
= (5) (4)(3)(2)(1) c. r times =
= 120
2. a. How many car number plates are possible
In an arrangement or permutation, the order of with three letters followed by 3 digits?
the object chosen is important. b. How many of these number plates begin with
ABC?
The Multiplication Rule
If one event can occur in a ways, a second Solution
event in b ways and a third event in c ways, a. Number of English alphabets = 26
then the three events can occur in a × b × c. Number of digits ranges from 0 – 9
= 10 numbers
Worked Examples
Car number plates possible with three letters
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Using factorial notation, express the number ( )( )( )( )
of arrangements of the letters in the following Number of permutation = =( )( )( )( )
=6
words:
a. Maths b. Length c. Objects 2. Find the number of permutation of the letters
of the word “ILLINOIS”
Solution
a. Maths = 5! Solution
b. Length = 6! In “ILLINOIS”, number of words = 8
c. Objects = 7! Number of permutations = 8!
I = 3! L = 2!
2. In how many ways can 6 people be arranged Number of permutation;
in a row? ( )( )( )( )( )( )( )( )
= = ( )( )( )( )( )
= 3,360
Solution
3. How many different arrangement of the word
Number of ways = (6) (5) (4) (3) (2) (1)
PARRAMATTA are possible?
= 6!
= 720 ways
Solution
PARRAMATTA = 10 letters
Exercise 22.1
Number of permutation = 10!
Using factorial notation, express the number
A = 4! R = 2! T=2
of arrangements of the letters in the
following words: Number of permutation;
1. HISTOGRAM 2. RHOMBUS
=
3. FACTORS 4. CARGO
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 676
( )( )( )( )( )( )( )( )( )( ) 1. The first position (President) is being
= ( )( )( )( )( )( )( )( )
( )( )( )( )( )( )
contested by 6 candidates.
= ( )( )( )( ) 2. If one is elected president, then there is 5
candidates to contest for the vice president.
=
3. After the vice – president is elected; there are
= 37,800
four candidates to contest for the secretary.
4. After the secretary is elected, there are three
Exercises 22.2
people to contest for the treasure.
A. Find the number of different permutation
of the letters of the word
The number of ways of filling these four
1. MATHEMATICS
positions can be described as:
2. STATISTICS
(6) (5) (4) (3) = 360 ways.
3. ALABAMA
The notation 6P4 is used to denote the
4. HIPOPOTAMUS
permutation of 6 objects taken 4 at a time.
5. PARALLELOGRAM
6. ERROR
To evaluate 6P4,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Find 6!
B. How many distinguishable arrangements
2. Then divide by the part of 6! that were not
can you contain from each of the following
counted, that is 2!
sets; ( )( )( )( )( )( )
1. {1, 8, 8, 6, } ⇒ 6P4 = = ( )( )
= 360 ways
2. (2, 2, 3, 5, 5, 9}
3. {4, 5, 6, 6, 7, 7, 7, 8, 9} Worked Examples
1. Find the number of ways to seat 3 people in
Rule : 3 a row of three chairs selected from a group of
The number of permutation of r objects 15 people.
chosen from n objects where 0 ≤ r ≤ n is :
n
Pr = ( Solution
)
n = 15 , r = 3
15
When n = r, P3 = ( = = (15) (14) (13) = 2,730
)
n
Pr = ( =( = = n! (0! = 1)
) )
2. Consider 8 participants in a contest with
four winning positions. In how many ways
Explanation
could there be four winning positions?
Take for instance, four positions, namely;
President, Vice – president, Secretary and
Solution
Treasure are to be contested among six
n = 8 and r = 4
candidates. Observe the following; 8
P4 = ( = = (8) (7) (6) (5) = 1,680
)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
3 of them are chosen? taken is given by: n – 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Total number of ways = 3! × 2! = 12 ways 3. How many arrangement of the letters of the
word ENZYME are possible if;
iv. Total number of letters = 5! = 120 i. they have EN together in order?
If all the vowels come together, then we have: ii. they have ENZ together in any order?
(O, E, A), M, G. These can be arranged in 3! iii. E, Z and M are not to be together?
ways
But (O, E, A) can be arranged in 3! ways. Solution
i. If they have EN together in order;
Number of ways when vowels come together; (EN)_ _ _ _ = 5P5 = 5! = 120
= 3! × 3!
= 36 ways ii. If they have ENZ together in any order;
(ENZ) _ _ _ = 4P4 or 3P3 = 3! × 4! = 144
Number of ways, when vowels being never
together; iii. E, Z and M are not to be together;
= 120 – 36 Total – ENZ together in any order
= 84 ways = 6! – 144
= 576
2. How many arrangements of the letters of the
4. There are six boys who enter a boat with 8
word ENZYME are possible if:
seats, 4 on each side. In how many ways can
i. there are no restriction.
i. they sit anywhere?
ii. they begin with EN?
ii. two boys A and B sits on the port side and
another boy C, sit on the starboard side.
iii. They do not begin with EN?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. boys and girls are in separate groups PTCL(OIA)
iv. Abi and Joe wish to stay together.
PTCL(OIA) = 5 letters
Solution Number of ways of arranging 5 letters;
i. Total number of boys and girls; 5 ! = 120
= 5 boys + 4 girls = 9
Number of ways of arranging the vowels (OIA)
If there are no restrictions; = 3! = 3 × 2 × 1 = 6
n = 9 and r = 9
9
P9 = ( = = 9! Required number of ways;
)
= 5! × 3!
ii. Boys and Girls alternate; = 120 × 6
BGBGBGBGB = 720 different ways.
= 5P5 × 4P4
7. In how many different ways can the letters of
iii. boys and girls are in separate groups; the word “CORPORATION” be arranged so
Boys and girls in separate groups or girls and that the vowels always come together?
boys separate groups; A. 47200 B. 48000 C. 42000 D. 50400
Boys and girls or girls and boys;
= 5P5 × 4P4 + 4P4 × 5P5 Solution
= 5! × 4! + 4! × 5! “CORPORATION” = 11 letters
= 120 × 24 + 24 × 120 Vowels = OOAIO and these five vowels shoud
= 2,880 + 2,880 come together. Hence they can be grouped and
= 5,760 considered as a single letter, giving us
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
with any of the letters K, G, N, S arranging the
Solved Past Question four letters taking one at a time.
4
1. A pupil tried to arrange the letters of the =( = = 4ways
)
word DUCKLINGS; taking four letters at a
time. Find the number of ways of the
Number of ways of arranging the 8 letters
arrangement if :
taking 3 at a time
a. any of the letters can be used; 8
=( = = 336 ways
b. it must begin with a vowel; )
c. it must end with any of the letters K, N, G
and S. Required number of ways;
=4 ×8
Solution = 4 × 336
a. DUCKLINGS = 9 letters = 1,344 ways
If any of the letters can be used:
Number of ways of arranging 9 letters taking 4 Exercises 22.4
at a time 1. A, B, C, D, E and F are six students. In how
9 many ways can they be seated in a row if:
=( = = 3,024 ways
) i. there are no restrictions on the seating.
ii. A and B must sit beside each other;
b. If it must begin with a vowel: iii. A and B must not sit beside each other,
(UI) = 2 letters iv. D, E and F must sit beside each other,
(UI)DCKLNGS = 8 v. A and F must sit at the end of each row?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. How many arrangements begin with B and A number of digits can be formed from a given
end in L? set of digits with some conditions likely to be
iii. How many arrangements begin with a “repetition of digits” or “without repetition of
vowel? digits”
iv. How many arrangements end with LIN?
v. How many arrangements begin with D and Find possibilities for first position digit, second
end in LIN? position digit, third position digits etc, not
forgetting the conditions or restrictions.
5. Taking all the letters of the word ALGEBRA,
in how many arrangements are the two As Multiply possibilities for each first and
together? subsequent digits to obtain the required total
number of possibilities and the total digit
6. Six children can be seated in a row on a numbers that can be formed
bench.
i. How many arrangements are possible? With Repetitions of Digits
ii. How many arrangemets are possible if the Worked Examples
youngest child sit at the left-hand end and the 1. How many four digit numbers greater than
oldest child must sit at the right-hand end? 6,000 can be formed using the digits (1, 2, 4, 5,
iii. If two of the children are twins, in how 6, 7) if repetitions are allowed?
many ways can the children be arranged if:
a. the twins are together, Solution
b. the twins are not together? (1, 2, 4, 5, 6, 7)
ABCD > 6,000
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Each of the remaining three digits can occupy
can be formed from the digits (1, 2, 3, 4, the third position giving 3 possibilities
5, 6, 7) if repetition of the digits is allowed?
Number of digits remaining is 2.
Solution Each of the remaining two digits can occupy
Let the 4 digits be ABCD, the fourth position giving 2 possibilities
ABCD > 4300 Number of digits remaing is 1.
A ≥ 4 (4, 5, 6, 7) = 4 possibilities The remaining digits can occupy the fifth
position giving 1 possibility
B ≥ 3 (3, 4, 5, 6, 7) = 5 possibilities
C ≥ 1 (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7) = 7 possibilities
Total five digit numbers that can be formed
D ≥ 1 (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7) = 7 possibilities
= 5 × 4 × 3× 2 × 1
= 120 different five digit numbers
Total possibilities = 4 × 5 × 7 × 7
= 980 possibilities
Type 2 :
Here, the digits to be formed are limited to a
Without Repetition of Digits
given value.
The use of the the word “distinct” means
without repetition. In this case, make sure each
Worked Examples
digit is used once.
1. How many 4 digit numbers greater than
Type 1: 5,000 can be formed using the digits (3, 4, 5, 6,
Here, the digits to be formed are not limited to 7) without repetition of the digits?
any given value.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
the fourth position = 2 possibilities 7,000. This means that:
First position can be occupied by any one of (3
Total possibilities = 3 × 4 × 3 × 2 and 6) = 2 possibilities
= 72 possibilities Remaining digits = 3 digits
2. How many four digit numbers greater than Second position can be occupied by any one of
6,000 can be formed using the digits (1, 2, 4, 5, (3 or 6) or any one of (1, 8)
6, 7) if no digit can be repeated? = 3 possibilities
Remaining digits = 2 digits
Solution
ABCD > 6,000 Third position can be occupied by any one of (3
Any one of the two digits (6, 7) can take the or 6) or any one of (1, 8) = 2 possibilities
first position = 2 possibilities Remaining digits = 1 digits
The second digit can take any one of the Remaining digits = 7
remaining 4 digits = 4 possibilites Any one of the seven remaining digits can take
Remaining digits = 3 the fourth position = 7 possibilities
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The third digit can take any one of the Total possibilities = 4 × 7 × 7 × 7
remaining 3 digits = 3 possibilites = 1,372 possibilities
Remaining digits = 2
ii. No repetition allowed
The fourth digit can take any one of the
1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8
remaining 2 digits = 2 possibilites
Let the 4 digits be ABCD,
Remaining digits = 1
ABCD < 5000
Any one of the four digits (1, 2, 3, 4) can take
The four digit numbers greater than 2,000 that
the first position = 4 possibilities
can be formed = 3 × 4 × 3 × 2 = 72
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. Repetition allowed
Solution 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
{1, 2, 3, 4, 5} Let the 4 digits be ABCDE,
i. 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 ABCDE > 20,000
= 120 different five digit numbers. Any one of the four digits (2, 3, 4, 5) can take
the first position = 4 possibilities
ii. 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1
= 120 different five digit numbers. Remaining digits = 5
Any one of the five remaining digits can take
iii. 5 × 4 × 3 the second position = 5 possibilities
= 60 different five digit numbers.
Remaining digits = 5
iv. five digit numbers greater than 20,000 Any one of the five remaining digits can take
{1, 2, 3, 4, 5} the third position = 5 possibilities
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Remaining digits = 3 last (unit) digit of the number is a multiple of
Any one of the three remaining digits can take that number. For example, for all multiples of
the third position = 3 possibilities 5, the last digit must be 0 or 5. Likewise, for
multiples of 2, the last digit must be 0 or 2.
Remaining digits = 2
Any one of the two remaining digits can take It is always advisable to check the multiples
the fourth position = 2 possibilities being formed so as to choose a correct last or
units digit. Here, it important to fill in the last
Total possibilities = 4 × 4 × 3 × 2 digit first.
= 96 possibilities
Worked Examples
ii. Repetition allowed 1. How many different five digit numbers can
1, 2, 3, 4, 5 be formed from the digits 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5 if:
Let the 4 digits be ABCD, i. the number is odd and no repetitions are
ABCDE < 3,000 allowed;
Any one of the two digits (1, 2) can take the ii. the number is even and repetitions are
first position = 2 possibilities allowed;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 24 possibilities
Remaining digits = 3
Any one of the three remaining digits can take
ii. Even and repetitions are allowed;
the third position = 3 possibilities
Any one of the two digits (2, 4) can take the
last position = 2 possibilities
Remaining digits = 2
Any one of the two remaining digits can take
Remaining digits = 5
the fourth position = 2 possibilities
Any one of the five remaining digits can take
the first position = 5 possibilities
Total possibilities = 3 × 4 × 3 × 2
Remaining digits = 5 = 24 possibilities
Any one of the five remaining digits can take
the first position = 5 possibilities b. Four digit numbers that would be even;
Even ends with 2, 4, 6 = 3 digits
Remaining digits = 5
Any one of the five remaining digits can take ii. Even without repetitions;
the first position = 5 possibilities Digits = 2, 3, 4, 5, 6
Any one of the two digits (2, 4, 6) can take the
Remaining digits = 5 last position = 3 possibilities
Any one of the five remaining digits can take
the first position = 5 possibilities Exercises 22.5
1. How many three different three digit
Total possibilities = 5 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 2 numbers can be formed using the digits 0, 1, 2,
= 1,250 possibilities 3, 4 if 0 cannot be the first digit and if;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4,000 can be made with the digits1, 2, 3, 4 if no DABC
C
digit may be repeated?
Shifting ABCD one position in anti – clockwise
4. How many numbers between 100 and 1,000 direction we obtain the following
can be made with the digits 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6 if B A D
no digit may be repeated? C A B D A C
i. repetitions are allowed
D C B
ii. repetitions are not allowed.
If 4 persons are sitting at a round table, then
they can be shifted four times, but these four
5. i. How many different numbers each with 3 – arrangements will be the same, because the
digits or fewer n be formed from the digits 2, 3, sequence ABCD is the same.
4, 5, 6? Each digit can be used once in each
number. Linear Arrangements;
ii. How many of the above numbers are odd? If ABCD are sitting in a row, and they are
shifted, then the four linear aranegemnts will be
6. How many odd numbers between 4,000 and different as shown below;
6,000 can be made from the digits 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 ABCD, DABC, CDAB, BCDA
and 8, if no digit may be repeated?
There are two cases of circular permutations
7. How many three – digit numbers can be a. If clockwise and anti – clockwise orders are
formed using the digit 0 to 9 inclusive, if no different, then total number of circular
digit can be used more than once and 0 cannot permutations is given by (n – 1) !
be the first digit?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
6 men + 6 women = 12
Number of circular arrangement n = 12
= 1 (number of linear arrangement)
Ways = (n – 1) !
n=
Ways = (12 – 1) !
Circular permutation = (n – 1) !
b. men and women alternate;
b. If clockwise and anti – clockwise orders sre Arbitrarily fix one man and alternate the rest of
taken as not different, then total number of the group
( – )
circular permutations is given by (6 – 1)! × 6!
= 5! × 6 !
Proof = 120 × 720
When clockwise and anti – clockwise = 86400
arrangements are not different, then
observations can be made from both sides , and 2. How many necklace of 12 beads each can be
this will be the same. Here two permutations made from 18 beads of different colors?
will be counted as one . So total permutations
Solution
will be half, hence in this case;
Here clockwise and anti - clockwise
( – )
Circular permutations = arrangements are the same.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. ( ) (definition)
( )
( )( ) ( ) Similarly ( ) = ( ) as 17 + 3 = 20 and
2. ( ) (in practice)
( ) =( ) as 98 + 2 = 100
Both give the same result; however, the second
is easier to use in practical questions. If r is large, the calculator may not be able to
For example: calculate. Thus use ( ) = ( )
1. ( ) = = = = 15
( )
( ) = is sometimes written as nCr or nCr
,
2. ( ) = ⇒ ,
= 15 In general :
Number of combination of n different things
Memory Aid: taken r at a time is given by :
n
( )= = Cr =
( ) ( ) ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( )= = 45
( )= = 210
2. In a class, there are 27 boys and 14 girls. The Therefore, from a panel of 10, 210 different
teacher wants to select 1 boy and 1 girl to committees of 4 people can be formed.
represent the class for a function. In how many
ways can the teacher make this selection? ii. One particular person must be on the
committee.
Solution n = 9 r = 3 ( one person chosen already)
Here the teacher is to perform two operations: ( )= = 84
i. Selecting a boy from among the 27 boys and
Therefore, from a panel of 10 people, 84
ii. Selecting a girl from among 14 girls.
different committee of 4 people can be formed
The first of these can be done in 27 ways and if one particular person of the 10 must be on
second can be performed in 14 ways. By the every committee.
fundamental principle of counting, the required
number of ways is 27 × 14 = 378 ways iii. one particular person must not be on the
committee;
Restricted Combination n = 9 (one person cannot be chosen)
a. Number of combination of n different things r = 4 (4 people required on the committee)
taken r at a time , when p particular things are ( )= = 126
always included Therefore, from a panel of 10 people, 126
= n - p Cr – p different committee of 4 people can be formed
if one particular person of the 10 must not be
b. Number of combination of n different things on the committee.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 692
2. A committee of 5 persons is to be formed Number of ways of selecting any doctor;
from 5 men and 4 women. Find the number of = 7 C3
ways of forming the committee if: Number of ways of selecting any nurse;
a. there must be only two men. = 5 C2
b. one particular woman must be included.
Number of ways of selecting any doctor and
Solution any nurse ;
Number of men = 5 = 7C3 × 5C2
Number of women = 4 = 35 × 10
n=9 = 350 ways
Number of ways of selecting only 3 women
= 4 C3 ii. One particular doctor must be on the
committee.
Number of ways of selecting only 2 men This means one doctor is already chosen, so
= 5 C2 remaining 6 doctors.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Number of ways of selecting 2 doctors from 6
Number of ways of forming the committee; doctors = 6C2
= Only 2 men + Only 3 men
= 4 C3 × 5 C2 Number of ways of selecting 2 nurses from 5
= 4 × 10 nurses = 5C2
= 40 ways
One particular doctor must be on the committee
b. If one particular woman is included;
= 6C2 × 5C2
(one person is already chosen)
= 15 × 10
n=8,r=3
= 150 ways
= 8 C3
= 56 ways
4. How many ways can a student answer 8 out
of 10 questions, if he must answer the first five
3. A committee of 3 doctors and 2 nurses is to
questions.
be formed from 7 doctors and 5 nurses. In how
many ways can this be done if :
Solution
i. any doctor and any nurse can be included;
Number of ways of answering the first five
ii. One particular doctor must be on the
questions = 5C5
committee.
Number of ways of answering 3 out of the
Solution
remaining five questions = 5C3
i. Number of doctors = 7
Number of nurses = 5
Number of ways a student can answer 8 out of
Total n = 12
10 questions, if he must answer the first five
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Number of choices if he must answer the first Number of ways = 2C2 × 11C8
two questions = 2C2 × 6C4 = 1 × 165
= 1 × 15 = 165
= 15 choices
b. Number of ways of answering the first
b. To answer at least three of the first four question (neglecting the second question)
questions, the possible combinations are: = 1 C1
(3 from first four questions and three from the Remaining questions = 11
remaining four) or (4 from first four questions
Number of ways of answering 9 out of 11
and two from the remaining four )
question = 11C9
(3 from first four questions and three from the
remaining four) = (4C3 × 4C3) Number of ways of answering the first question
(neglecting the second question) and 9 out of
(4 from first four questions and two from the 11 question = 1C1 × 11C9
remaining four) = (4C4 × 4C2) = 1 × 55 = 55
Number of ways of answering 7 out of the 8 Number of ways of arranging 5 letters among
questions = 8C7 themselves = 5! = 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 120
Hence required number of ways = 210 × 120
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Number of ways of answering exactly 3 out of = 25200
the first 5 questions and 7 out of the remaining 2. In a group of 6 boys and 4 girls, four children
8 questions = 5C3 × 8C7 are to be selected. In how many different ways
= 10 × 8 can they be selected such that at least one boy
= 80 should be there?
A. 159 B. 209 C. 201 D. 212
d. The possible combinations for answering
atleast three of the first five questions are : Solution
(3 from first five, 7 from remaining 8) OR Four children are to be selected, such that at
(4 from first five, 6 from remaining 8) OR least one boy should be there?
(5 from first five, 5 from remaining 8) We have 4 options listed below:
Therefore, number of ways; 1. Selecting 4 boys = 6C4
= (5C3 × 8C7) + (5C4 × 8C6) + (5C5 × 8C5) 2. Selecting 3 boys and 1 girl = 6C3 × 4C1
= ( 10 × 8) + ( 5 × 28) + (1 × 56) 3. Selecting 2 boys and 2 girls = 6C2 × 4C2
= 80 + 140 + 56 4. Selecting 1 boy and 3 girls = 6C1 × 4C3
= 276
Total number of ways
Combination Solved Examples = 6C4 + 6C3 × 4C1 + 6C2 × 4C2 + 6C1 × 4C3
1. Out of 7 consonants and 4 vowels, how many = 15 + 80 + 90 + 24
words of 3 consonants and 2 vowels can be = 209
formed?
A. 24400 B . 21300 C. 210 D. 25200 3. From a group of 7 men and 6 women, five
persons are to be selected to form a committee
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4. In how many ways a committee consisting of Therefore, required number of letters
3 men and 2 women, can be chosen from 7 men = Total number of words – Total number of
and 5 women? words in which no letter is repeated
A 45 B. 350 C. 4200 D. 230 = 105 – 10P5 = 69760. (A) is correct choice.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. How many different choices are possible?
4 × 4 × 4 = 64. Out of these possible answer ii. How many choices include French?
only one will be correct and hence the iii. How many choices do not include French?
number of ways in which a student can fail to iv. How many choices include Accounting and
get correct answer is 64 – 1 = 63. Biology?
v. How many choices include Applied Maths
Exercises 22.7 but not Chemistry?
1. In how many ways can a committee of 4
people be chosen from 7 people?
5. Three delegates to form a committee are to
be selected from 8 members of a club. How
2. There are 15 pupils in a class. How many
many different committees can be formed if:
teams of 11 can be selected from the class?
i. three are no restrictions?
i. If one person in the class is made captain, and
ii. a certain member must be on each
must always be included in each team,
committee?
ii. how many teams can now be selected if 2
iii. two particular members cannot both be on
puplis in the class refuse to play,
the committee?
Solution
i. n = 9, r = 5
( )= = 126
ii. If two particular people cannot be included, then calculate the number of ways of selecting 5
people with this particular two always included. That is 7 to chose 3 (because two are already
selected)
n = 7, r = 3
( )= = 35
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ,= : ;+( ,
= 126 – 35
= 91
2. How many ways may 10 people be divided into three groups of 5, 3 and 2 people?
Solution
The first group of 5 can be selected in ( ) = 252 ways
After the first selection, 5 people are left.
The total number of ways 10 people can be divided into groups of 5, 3 and 2;
=( )×( )×( )
= 252 × 10 × 1
= 2,520
Solution
i. n = 9, r = 4
( ) = = 126
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(There are 5 consonats and we want to select 4, thus n = 5, r = 4)
In every other selection, there must be at least one vowel.
Thus the number of selections containing at least one vowel ;
= (total number of selections) – (number of selections containing no vowel)
= 126 – 5
= 121
There are two key words when applying the fundamental principle of counting
1. „AND‟ is understood to mean „multiply‟. Thus, and = (×)
2. „OR‟ is understood to mean „add‟. Thus, or = (+)
Worked Examples
There are 5 women and 4 men in a club. A team of 4 has to be chosen. How many different teams
can be chosen if there must be either exactly one woman or exactly two women in the team .
Solution
AND means “ ×” OR means “ +”
5 women and 4 men. These are always the upper numbers in the combination bracket. A team must
consit of 4 people. Thus, exactly one womwn on the team means „1 woman and 3 men; and exactly
2. How many bundles of 5 different books can be nade from 8 maths books and 6 physics books, if
the number of maths books must always be greater than the number of physics books?
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
We have 8 maths books and 6 physics books and these are always the upper numbers in the
combination bracket. A bundle must consist of 5 books. We need to nave more maths books than
physics books. Therefore, the choice is:
(5 Maths and 0 Physics books) or (4 Maths and 1 Physics books) or (3 Maths and 2 Physics books)
Let M stands for Maths books and P stands fro Physics books.
(5 M and 0P) or (4 M and 1 P) or (3 M and 2 P)
↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓
( ) × ( ) + ( ) × ( ) + ( ) × ( )
= 56 × 1 + 70 × 6 + 56 × 15
= 56 × 420 × 840
= 1.316
2. In how many ways can 12 different objects 4. i. Find the number of different selections of 4
be divided into groups of 6, 4 and 2? letters that can be nade from the letters of the
word SPHERICAL.
3. 5 Irishman, 3 frenchmen and 4 Germans are ii. How many of these selections cannot contain
available for selection to a European committee a vowel?
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 700
ii. How many of these selections contain at 11. A team of 5 players is to be chosen from 6
least one vowel? boys and 5 girls. If there must be more boys
than girls, how many different teams can be
5. Find the number of different selection of 5 formed.
letters that can be made from the letters of the
word CHEMISTRY. How many of these 12. A group consist of 5 men and 7 women. A
selections contain at least one vowel? commitee of 4 must be chosen from the group.
How many commitees can be chosen in which
6. A team of 6 players is to be chosen from a there are an odd number of men?
group of 10 players . One of the 6 is then to be
elected as captain and another as vice – captain. 13. A club has only 5 women and 4 men as
In how many ways can this be done? (Hint: members. A team of 3 is to be chosen to
select and arrange) represent the club. In how many ways can this
be done if :
7. In how many ways can a committee of 7 i. there are no restrictions.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
people be selected from 4 men and 6 women, if ii. the club captain must be on the team?
the committee must have at least 4 women on iii. there must be atleast one woman on the
it? team?
iv. there must be more women than men on the
8. A committee of six is to be formed from team?
eight students and five teachers. How many
different commitees can be formed if there are Challenge Problems
to be more teachers than students? Twelve distinct points are taken on the
circumference of a circle.
9. An examination consist of ten questions, four i. a. Calculate the number of different chords
in section A and the rest in section B. A that can be formed using these points as end
candidate must attempt 5 questions, at least two points.
of which must be from each section. How many b. How many different triangles can be formed
different ways may the candidate select the five using these points as vertices?
questions? ii. a. Calculate the number of different
quadrilaterals that can be formed using these
10. In how many ways can a committee of six points as vertices.
be selected from five men and four women, if b. Two of the vertices are labeled x and y
each committee consist of : respectively.
i. an equal number of men and woman? c. How many of the above quadrilaterals have
ii. at least three men? x and y as vertices?
The Binomial Probability Distribution “goodness” here. Thus, for example, when
A binomial experiment is one that possesses the looking at births, the statistician might label the
following properties: birth of a boy as a “success” and the birth of a
1. The experiment consists of n repeated trials; girl as a “failure,” but it wouldn‟t necessarily
Each trial results in an outcome that may be mean the same thing to the parents. The usual
classified as a success or a failure (hence the notation is :
name, binomial); p = probability of success,
q = probability of failure = 1 – p.
The probability of a success, denoted by p, Note that p + q = 1.
remains constant from trial to trial and repeated
trials are independent. A Bernoulli trial
The number of successes X in n trials of a In statistical terms, a Bernoulli trial is each
binomial experiment is called a binomial repetition of an experiment involving only 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
random variable. outcomes.
The probability distribution of the random Most atimes, the interest is in the result of
variable X is called a binomial distribution, and independent, repeated bernoulli trials, i.e. the
is given by the formula: nCx q n − x px. number of successes in repeated trials.
1. Independent - the result of one trial does not
where affect the result of another trial.
n = the number of trials 2. Repeated - conditions are the same for each
x = 0, 1, 2, ... n trial, i.e. p and q remain constant across trials.
p = the probability of success in a single trial This is refers to as a stationary process. If p
q = the probability of failure in a single trial and q can change from trial to trial, the process
(i.e. q = 1 − p) is nonstationary. The term identically
distributed is also often used in this case.
P(X) gives the probability of successes
in n binomial trials. A binomial distribution gives the probabilities
associated with independent, repeated Bernoulli
For example, many experiments share the trials.
common element that their outcomes can be
classified into one of two events, e.g. a coin can In a binomial distribution, the probabilities of
come up heads or tails; a child can be male or interest are those of receiving a certain number
female; a person can die or not die; a person of successes, x, in n independent trials each
can be employed or unemployed. These having only two possible outcomes and the
outcomes are often labeled as “success” or same probability, p, of success. For example,
“failure.” Note that there is no connotation of using a binosmial distribution, the probability
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 702
of getting 4 heads in 10 coin tosses can be are carried out (that is, independent events).
determine as follows:. Then what is the probability that, in n
First, determine the probability of one possible successive trials, exactly x will be successful ?
way the event can occur, and then determine
the number of different ways the event can General Analysis of the problem
occur. That is, P(Event) Build up the solution in simple stages:
= (Number of ways event can occur) × P(One a. If p is the probability of success in a single
occurrence). trial, then the probability of failure is q = 1− p
b. In the following table, let S stand for success
In trying to find the probability of getting 4 and let F stand for failure. The table shows the
heads in 10 tosses, call getting a heads a possible results of one, two or three trials and
“success.” Also, in this case, n = 10, the their corresponding probabilities:
number of successes is x = 4, and the number of
failures (tails) is n – x = 10 – 4 = 6. No. of Possible Results Respective
Trials Prob.
One way this can occur is if the first 4 tosses 1 F,S q, p
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
are heads and the last 6 are tails, i.e. the
binomial distribution is S S S S F F F F F F 2 FF,FS,SF,SS q2, qp, pq, p2
The likelihood of this occurring is :
P(S) × P(S) ×P(S) × P(S) × P(F) × P(F) × P(F) 3 FFF, FFS, FSF, q3, q2p, q2p, qp2,
FSS, SFF, SFS, q2p, qp2, qp2, p3
× P(F) × P(F) × P(F)
SSF, SSS
More generally, if p = probability of success
and q = 1 – p = probability of failure, the
Summary
probability of a specific sequence of outcomes
i. In one trial, the probabilities that there will
where there are r successes and n – x failures is
be exactly 0 or exactly 1 successes are the
respective terms of the expression q + p.
In this particular instance, p = q = 0.5, x = 4,
ii. In two trials, the probabilities that there will
n – x = 6, so the probability of 4 straight heads
be exactly 0, exactly 1 or exactly 2 successes
followed by 6 straight tails is:
4 are the respective terms of the expression : q2 +
0.5 0.56 = 0.0009765625 (or 1 out of 1024). 2qp + p2 = (q + p)2.
Finding the probability that in n successive iii. In three trials, the probabilities that there
trials, exactly x will be succesful will be exactly 0, exactly 1, exactly 2 or exactly
Statement of the problem 3 successes are the respective terms of the
Suppose that the probability of success in a expression:
single trial is unaffected when successive trials
q3 + 3q2p + 3qp2 + p3 = (q + p)3.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
p= = 0.1, q = 1 – 0.1 = 0.9, n = 12,
Solution The required probabilities (added together) of
q = 0.5, p = 0.5, n = 6, x = 4. exactly 9, 10, 11 or 12 defective items and
P(exacty 4 heads); these are the last four terms in the expansion of
= P(X = 4) (q + p)n. That is,
= 6 C4 ( ) ( ) = 12C9.(0.1)9.(0.9)3 + 12C10.(0.1)10.(0.9)2 + 12C11.
(0.1)11.(0.9) + (0.1)12
=
= 1.658 ×
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Method 1 number of times a student is caned.
The phrase “at most 2 sixes” means exactly 0, p= ,q=1– = ,n=5
or exactly 1, or exactly 2.
p = and q = P(caned in 2 days);
n = 6, x = 2. = P(X = 2)
P(X = x) = nCx = 5 C2 . / . /
= 0.346
P (at most 2 sixes);
= P(X = 0) + P(X = 1) + P(X = 2)
ii. P(no caning);
6 6 6
= C0 . / . / + C1 . / . / + C2 . / . / = P(X = 0)
= 0.3349 + 0.4019 + 0.2009 = 5 C0 . / . /
= 0.9377
= 0.078
Method 2
The phrase “at most 2 sixes” means exactly 0, iii. P(by all means caned);
or exactly 1, or exactly 2. Hence, add together = 1 – P(no caning)
the first three terms in the expansion of: = 1 – 0.078
= 0.922
(q + p)6, where q = and p =
Note:
It may be shown that
The use of the “binomial distribution” becomes
(q + p)6 = q6 + 6q5p + 15q4p2 + ......
very tedious when the number of trials is large
By substituting for q and p, the sum of the first
and two other standard distributions (called the
three terms turns out to be :
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 705
“normal distribution” and the “Poisson c. at least 2, students buy text books.
distribution”) can sometimes be used.
Solution
Solved Past Questions a. p = = 0.2
1. In an examination, 90% of the candidates
q = 1 – 0.2 = 0.8, n = 5
passed. If 8 of the candidates are selected at
Using P(X = x) = nCx , where x is the
random, calculate the probability that;
number of students;
a. exactly 5 passed;
b. at most 3 failed.
P(exacty 3);
= P(X = 3)
Solution
= 5C3 ( ) ( 8)
a. Probability of candidates who passed;
= 0.0512
= 0.9
= 0.051 (3 d.p)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 0.1 = P(X ≤ 4)
= 1 – P(X ≥ 4)
Using P(X = x) = nCx = 1 – [P(X = 4) + P(X = 5) ]
For p = 0.9, q = 0.1, n = 8 = 1 – [5C4 ( ) ( 8) + 5C5 ( ) ( 8) ]
= 1 – [0.0064 + 0.00032]
P(exacty 5 passed) = 1 – 0.00672
= P(X = 5) = 0.993 (3 d. p)
= 8 C5 ( ) ( )
= 0.00331 c. P(at least 2 students);
= P(X = 2) + P(X = 3) + P(X = 4) + P(X = 5)
b. P( at most 3 failed); = 5C2 ( ) ( 8) + 5C3 ( ) ( 8) + 5C4
= P(X = 0) + P(X = 1) + P(X = 2) + P(X = 3) ( ) ( 8) + 5C5 ( ) ( 8)
= 8C0 ( ) ( ) + 8C1 ( ) ( ) + 8C2 = 0.2048 + 0.0512 + 0.0064 + 0.00032
( ) ( ) + 8 C3 ( ) ( ) = 0.26272
= 0.43047 + 0.38264 + 0.14880 + 0.033067 = 0.263 (3 d. p)
= 0.995
Method 2
2. A survey carried out among a group of P(at least 2 students);
secondary school students showed that 2 out of = P(X ≥ 2 )
every 10 students buy text books. If 5 students = 1 – P(X < 2)
are randomly selected from the group, find, = 1 – [P(X = 0) + P(X = 1)]
correct to 3 decimal places, the probability that: = 1 – [5C0 ( ) ( 8) + 5C1 ( ) ( 8) ]
a. exactly 3; = 1 – [0.32768 + 0.4096]
b. less than 4; = 1 – 0.073728
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
P(exactly 3 females) = 0.3967
= P(X = 3)
= 5 C3 . / . / 5. For every 10 persons in the city, one is left
handed. If 6 persons are selected at random
= = 0.3292 from the city, find the probability that;
i. exactly three;
P (at least 4 females); ii. more than half;
= P(X = 4) + P(X = 5) iii. at least 2.
= 5 C4 . / . / + 5 C 5 . / . /
Solution
= + = i. P (left handed) = = 0.1
= 0.4609
P (right handed) = = 0.9
4. A bag contains 4 red and 5 black identical p = 0.1, q = 0.9 and n = 6
balls. If 5 balls are selected at random from the
bag, one after the other without replacement, P(exactly three are left handed)
find the probability that; = P(X = x) = nCx ,
6
i. a red ball was picked three times; = C3 ( ) ( )
ii. a black ball was picked at most two times. = = 0.0146
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
b. a majority of those interviewed favoured the
1. A coin is tossed six times. What is the environmental party.
probability of getting exactly four heads? c. at most 3 of the people interviewed favoured
the environmental party.
2. What is the probability of throwing at least
four 7‟s in five throws of a pair of dice ? 8. In the long run, Thomas wins two out of
every 3 games. If Thomas plays five games,
3. In a roll of five dice, what is the probability
find the probability that he will win:
of getting exactly four faces alike ?
a. exactly 4 games.
b. at most 4 games.
4. If three dice are thrown, determine the
c. no more than 2 games.
probability that:
d. all 5 games.
a. all three will show the number 4;
b. all three will be alike;
9. A tenis player finds out that he wins 3 out of
c. two will show the number 4 and the third,
7 games he plays. If he plays 7 games straight,
something else;
find the probability that he will win:
d. all three will be different;
a. exactly 3 games.
e. only two will be alike.
b. at most three games.
5. Hospital records show that 10% of the cases c. all 7 games.
of a certain disease are fatal. If five patients d. no more than 5 games.
suffer from this disease, determine the
probability that: 10. The births of males amd females are
a. all will recover; assumed to be equally likely, find the
b. at least three will die; probability that in a family of 6 children;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
P, Q, R, S Rings and Roundabouts
n=4 1. The number of ways of arranging n unlike
There are four spaces to be filled: objects in a ring when clockwise and
, -, , -, , -, , - = 4! = 24. anticlockwise arrangements are different is:
(n – 1)!
Explanation
The first space can be filled by any one of the 2. When clockwise and anti-clockwise
four letters. = 4 possibilities arrangements are the same, the number of ways
is : (n – 1)!
The second space can be filled by any of the
remaining 3 letters = 3 possibilities Worked Examples
1. Ten people go to a party. How many
The third space can be filled by any of the 2 different ways can they be seated?
remaining letters = 2 possibilities
Solution
The final space must be filled by the one Anti-clockwise and clockwise arrangements are
remaining letter = 1 possibility the same. Therefore, the total number of ways
The total number of possible arrangements is is (10 – 1)! = 181 440
4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 4!
Permutations
Rule 2 A permutation is an ordered arrangement. The
The number of ways of arranging n objects, of number of ordered arrangements of r objects
which p of one type are alike, q of a second taken from n unlike objects is:
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 709
n
Pr = ( 3. Suppose we have 12 adults and 10 kids as an
)
audience of a certain show. Find the number of
ways the host can select three persons from the
Worked Example
audiences to volunteer. The choice must
1. In the Match of the Day‟s goal of the month
contain two kids and one adult.
competition, you had to pick the top 3 goals out
of 10. Since the order is important, it is the
Solution:
permutation formula which we use.
As order does not matter here so choosing 2
10
P3 = = 720 kids and an adult,
There are therefore 720 different ways of = 10C2 × 12C1
picking the top three goals. = ×
( ) ( )
= 45 × 12
Combinations
= 540
The number of ways of selecting r objects from
There are 540 ways in which the host can
n unlike objects is:
choose the volunteers containing two kids and
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) = nCr = ( ) an adult.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The combination formula for selecting r items P(4R) = = = 0.0110
n
from n is : Cr = ( )
iv. Let the probability of selecting 1 white and
Also the probability of an event A is : 3 black balls be P(1W∩3B)
P(A) =
Favorable cases = 1 white from the 9 white
i. Let the probability of selecting 2 white balls balls and 3 black balls from the 6 black balls.
= P(2W) This can be done in 9C1 × 6C3 ways.
Favourable outcomes = 2 balls from 9 white Total outcomes 9 + 6 = 15 balls, the total
balls. This can be done in 9C2 ways. P(1W∩3B) = selecting 4 balls from the 15
balls. This can be done in 15C4 ways.
Total number of outcomes = 9 + 6 = 15 balls,
P(2W) = selecting 2 balls from the 15 balls.
P(1W∩3B) = = = 0.1319
This can be done in 15C2 ways.
ii. Let the probability of selecting 3 white balls Favorable cases = select 4 white from the 9
be P(3W) white balls and 3 black balls from the 5 black
Favourable outcomes = selecting 3 balls from balls. This can be done in 9C4 × 6C5 ways.
9 white balls. This can be done in 9C3 ways.
2. There are 4 men and 5 women. Find the iii. Let the probability of selecting at least one
probability of selecting 3 of which: woman P(At least 1W)
i. exactly two are women;
ii. no woman; Since we have to select three people, at least
iii. at least one women; one women means 1 women or 2 women or 3
iv. at most one women; women. That is 1 woman and 2 men or 2
v. no men. women and 1 man or all three woman.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. Let the probability of selecting exactly two = 5C1 × 4C2 + 5C2 × 4C1 + 5C3 ways.
women be P(2W)
Total outcome = 4 + 5 = 9 people,
The choice is to select three people. Exactly P(Atleast 1W) = selecting 3 people from the 9
two women means two women and one man people. This can be done in 9C3 ways.
Favorable cases = selecting 2 women from the
P(Atleast 1W)
5 women and 1 man from the 4 men. ( )
This can be done in 5C2 × 4C1 ways. = = = 0.9524
Total outcome = 4 + 5 = 9 people, iv. Let the probability of selecting at most one
P(2W) = selecting 3 people from the 9 people. woman be P(At most 1W)
This can be done in 9C3 ways.
P(2W) = = = 0.4762 To select three people, at most one women
means 0 women or 1 women. That is 0 woman
and 3 men or 1 woman and 2 men.
ii. Let the probability of selecting no woman
4
ne P(R1) Favorable cases = C3 + 5C1 × 4C2 ways.
Solution
3. A bag contains 20 small identical objects, 8
n(W) = 4, n(M) = 5, n(S) = 9
of them are balck, 7 are red and the rest are
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The probability that there will be few women
white. If three of the objects are selected at
than men on the committee.
random the bag at once, find the probability
P(1W and 4M) or P(2W and 3M)
that :
4 5 4 5
i. one is black, one is blue and the remaining is +
= 9 9
white.
ii. exactly two are red.
= + = = 0.635
iii. none of them is white.
= + = =
b. P(a boy and a girl) = P(BG)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 10 +
10
5. A coin is tossed 16 times. What is the
= + = = probability of obtaining?
i. exactly five heads;
b. P(Different nationality) ; ii. 10 or more tails
= P(1 N, 1 G)
=6 4 Selection Without Replacement
10 “Selection without replacement” means
selecting an item from a lot without putting it
= + =
back from where it was taken.
= = Exercises 23.3
1. A bag contains 4 yellow, 5 green and 6
ii. P(no ball is red); orange candies. Two candies are drawn one
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
There are 11 none red ball (6B + 5W) out of after the other without replacement. Find the
which 3 is to be selected. probability that both candies are green.
11
= 11 = = 2. A jar contains 10 blue balls and 11 red balls.
15 Two balls are drawn at random one after the
11
other without replacement. What is the
2. A 1box contains 5 black, 4 yellow and 3 white
probability of drawing two red balls?
balls. Three are picked at random one after the
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
examination.
Array: It refers to data which has been arranged
4. The distance travelled by a day student to
in ascending or descending order of magnitude.
school each school day.
5. The amount of pocket money given to
Grouped Data: It is a data which has been
students.
arranged into classes like 0 – 9, 10 – 19 etc.
Sources and Collection of Data
Discrete data: It is data that can be counted, for
A data or information can be collected from
example the number of people, cattle, sheep,
many sources such as schools, hospitals and
table, chair etc. The count of discrete data is
business.
whole numbers, since we cannot get half a
person, or 2 sheep on a farm. Similarly, the In schools, records such as attendance, personal
number which appears on a die when thrown records, results of an examination and others
can only be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6. Other examples of are kept. At the hospitals, records of
discrete data are vehicles passing a station, and attendance, diseases treated number of patients
the grade obtained by a student in a class. treated etc are also collected and kept.
In order to collect data, a survey must be
Continuous data: It is a data which result from conducted. The result of a survey is called a
measurement, for example, the height of a raw data. For example, 20 students in
person, the height of a tree or the, the time Asuofua D/A J.H.S. one were asked to mention
taken to complete an activity. The count of the days of the week in which they were born
continuous data is not a whole number but and the following results were obtained;
rounded off. For instance, a tree of height 9.8m Thursday, Thursday, Wednesday, Tuesday,
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Sunday /// 3
Monday // 2 Steps in finding the median of a raw data with
Tuesday /// 3 “n” numbers;
Wednesday /// 3 Method I
Thursday //// 4 I. Re – arrange the numbers in either ascending
Friday /// 3
or descending order.
Saturday // 2
II. Count to locate the middle value as the
In this case, one can easily know the number of median.
student born on each day of the week. III. If two numbers, a and b, appear as the
middle values, find the sum of the two and
Measure of Central Tendencies divide by 2 to obtain the median. That is:
(Mode, Median and Mean) median = .
The mode, median, and mean are the three most
common examples of measures of central Method II
tendencies. They are also called averages. They I. Arrange the numbers in order of magnitude
refer to a single digit which enables one to and count to ensure that they are up to “n”
assess the position in which a group is with numbers.
respect to others. II. If n is odd, then the median is the middle
term. That is; ( ) term or position
Mode
III. If n is even, then the median is the
The mode is the most commonly occurring
arithmetic mean of the two middle terms. That
number or the number that repeats itself most in
a set of data.The mode is not a calculated value is: ( ) and ( ) terms or positions
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
term or position
= ( ) term or position The mean is denoted by ̅. Thus, given the set
of values: x1, x2, x3, x4, ..xn,
= (8) = 4th position
the mean,( ̅ )= =
30, 31,43, 44, 47, 55, 56, Where n is the position of the last number of
the entries.
4th Position number
Worked Examples
Therefore, the median is 44.
1. Find the mode, median and mean of the
following numbers: 4, 24, 10, 17, 19, 21, 10
2. Find the median of the following numbers;
4, 5, 4, 6, 7, 5, 7, 4, 6, 5 Solution
Mode = 10 (Most frequently number)
Solution
Method I Median: Ordering the numbers in ascending
Re-arrange the numbers in ascending order to order, 4, 10, 10, 17, 19, 21, 24
get: 4, 4, 4, 5, 5, 5, 6, 6, 7, 7 The middle number is 17. ⇒median = 17
The middle numbers are 5 and 5. Therefore,
median = =5 ̅= = = 15
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
number is multiplied by q, the new mean is qp.
i. Mean ( ̅ ) = That is;
Where n = number of entries = 8 New Mean = Multiplier × old mean
̅=
Worked Examples
̅= = 176.50 cm 1. The mean of 12 numbers is 18. If each of the
numbers is increased by 4. What is the new
ii. To find the median, arrange the numbers in mean?
ascending order to obtain: 170cm, 171cm,
173cm, 174cm, 177cm, 177, 184cm, 186cm. Solution
New Mean = old mean + increment
The two middle values are 174 and 177. = 18 + 4 = 22
Median = = 175. 50 cm
Frequency and Frequency Diagrams
iii. The modal height = 77cm The number of times an event scores in a given
data is called its frequency.
Exercises 24.1
1. The marks scored by 8 pupils in a science Frequency Diagrams for Ungrouped Data
test are 3, 7, 8, 8, 5, 8, 4, 8.What is the median
mark? It is a table that shows the event and the
number of times each event occurs. It is usually
2. The scores of 10 students in an examination divided into four (4) sections as shown below:
are given as follows; 45, 12, 75, 81, 54, 51, 24, Range(x) Tally Frequency(f) fx
67, 19 and 39. What is the median and mean
score? ∑fx=
Column 3 (frequency): is made up of the The grouped frequency table is usually used for
digital representation of the tally. data‟s with many entries. Below is an example
of a grouped frequency table
Column 4 (fx): consist of the product of each
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
event and its corresponding frequency. Class Marks (x) Frequency (f)
is the sum of all the frequencies. 25 – 29 3
is the sum of the product of frequencies 30 – 34 4
and their corresponding events. 35 – 39 7
40 – 44 6
45 – 49 2
Worked Examples
1. The ages 20 school children were recorded as
On the above table, column 1 represents the
follows;
group put into the classes: 25 – 29, 30 – 34,
13 9 15 17 13 17 15 11 9 9
35 – 39, 40 – 44, 45 – 49 and column 2
9 11 9 11 15 11 15 11 11 11
represents the respective frequencies. If the
Make a frequency table for the data.
class 25 – 29 has a frequency of 3, it means that
Solution there are three different or same numbers
within 25 and 29
Age (x) Tally Frequency (f) fx
9 //// 5 45 Class Limits
11 //// // 7 77 Consider the table below;
13 // 2 26
15 //// 4 60
Class Marks (x) Frequency (f)
17 // 2 34
25 – 29 3
= 20 =242
30 – 34 4
35 – 39 7
2. The table below gives family sizes recorded 40 – 44 6
45 – 49 2
by 30 respondents. Construct a frequency table
for the data.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 720
It is seen that the classes contain a range of I. Find the difference between the upper class
values i. e. 25 – 29, 30 – 34, 35 – 39, 40 – 44, limit of a particular class interval and the lower
45 – 49. This means that each class has a class limit of the next class and divide by 2. For
smallest value and a largest value. These two example, the class boundary of 25 – 29, 30 –
values are called Class limits. Thus, we have 34… is determined as (30 – 29) = 0.5
the lower class limit representing the smallest
II. Subtract the answer obtained from the lower
number and the upper class limit representing
class limit of each class and add the answer to
the largest number. For example in the class 25
the upper class limit of each class to obtain the
– 29, the lower class limit is 25 and the upper
class boundaries
class limit is 29
Lower class limit 25 – 29 upper class limit Worked Examples
Copy and complete the table below;
Class Boundaries
It is the point where one class separates itself
Marks Class
from the other. It is also explained as the (x) Boundaries
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
smallest and largest values an item in that class 5–9
can take. For grouped frequency distribution, 10 – 14
each class boundary is usually half way 15 – 19
between the upper limit of one class and the 20 – 24
lower limit of the next class. That is: 25 – 29
= (upper limit of one class + lower limit of the
Solution
next class)
Method 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and upper class limits and dividing the sum by 20 – 24 22
two to get the mid – point of the class. The 25 – 29 27
midpoint is often called class mark. For
example, the class mark of the class 5 – 9 is Class Size/Width
determine as : = =7 The class width or class size or class interval is
the difference between the upper and lower
Worked Example class boundaries of a class. For instance, the
Copy and complete the table below: class width or class size of a class with
boundaries 4.5 and 9.5 = 9.5 – 4.5 = 5
= =
Worked Examples
Below is a record of the marks (out of 50) 39 36 37 42 45 40 41 44 46 44 46
obtained by 22 students in a test. Prepare a group frequency table for the data
14 12 8 19 13 27 22 21 32 30 35 using the intervals 1 – 10 , 11 – 20 …
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1 - 10 0.5 – 10.5 5.5 1 5.5
11 – 20 10.5 – 20.5 15.5 4 62
21 – 30 20.5 – 30.5 25.5 4 102
31 – 40 30.5 – 40.5 35.5 6 213
41 – 50 40.5 – 50.5 45.5 7 318.5
= 22 701
II. Carefully complete the table and accurately The mode can also be calculated by the
compute the values of and formula;
Mode = L1 + . / C, where;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
I. Find half of the total frequency and identify iii. the modal class iv. the median class
the value. v. the median.
II. Count from the top of the table to obtain a
sum of frequencies that equals the value Solution
obtained.
III. Identify the class within which the values Marks Class
falls as the median class. (kg) Mark(x) f fx
20 – 24 22 2 44
A good estimate of the median is best obtained 25 – 29 27 3 81
from a cumulative frequency curve 30 – 34 32 7 224
35 – 39 37 26 962
The median can also be estimated by the 40 – 44 42 29 1218
formula: 45 – 49 47 25 1175
50 – 54 52 6 312
Median = L1 + 4 5C 55 – 59 57 2 114
= =
Where; 100 4130
L1 = the lower class boundary of the median
class;
Mean ( ̅ ) = = = 41.30 kg
N = total frequency;
= sum of frequencies of all classes lower
than the median class; ii. The mode is the mid point of the highest
= frequency of the median class;
C = the size of the median class. frequency = 42
Median = L1 + 4 5C
Marks Class Class
(kg) boundary Mark(x) f
20 – 24 19.5 – 24.5 22 2 Median class = 40 – 44
25 – 29 24.5 – 29.5 27 3
L1 = 39.5
30 – 34 29.5 – 34. 5 32 7
N = 100
35 – 39 34.5 – 39.5 37 26
= 26 + 7 + 3 + 2 = 38
40 – 44 39.5 – 44.5 42 29
= 29
45 – 49 44.5 – 49.5 47 25
50 – 54 49.5 – 54.5 52 6 C = 44.5 – 39.5 = 5
55 – 59 54.5 – 59 .5 57 2 ( )
Median = 39.5 + 4 5×5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
∆2 = 29 – 25 = 4 Median = 39.91 (2 d.p)
C = 44.5 – 39. 5 = 5
2. From the table below, find the estimated
Mode = L1 + . / C, values of the mode, median amd mean, suing
formulas.
= 39.5 + . / × 5,
= 39.5 + Time (S) Frequency
51 – 55 2
= 39.5 + 2.1429
56 – 60 7
= 41.6429
= 42 (nearest whole number) 61 – 65 8
66 – 70 4
iii. From the table, the highest frequency is 29
and falls within the class 40 – 44. Therefore, Solution
the modal class is 40 – 44
T Class Class
(s) boundary Mark(x) f fx
iv. The median class 51 – 55 50.5 – 55.5 53 2 106
= × 56 – 60 55.5 – 60.5 58 7 406
61 – 65 60.5 – 65. 5 63 8 504
= × 100 = 50 66 – 70 65.5 – 70.5 68 4 272
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Median = L1 + 4 5C 60 – 64 86
65 – 69 30
Median Class = ( ) 70 – 74 8
75 – 79 4
= ( )
= 11 th position From the table, determine the mode and mean.
Median Class = 61 – 65
3. A gardener dig up his carrots and measure
L1 = 60.5
their lengths ( to the nearest mm) and grouped
N = 21;
the results as shown below:
=7+2=9
=8
Length (mm) Frequency
C = 65.5 – 60.5 = 5 150 – 154 5
( ) 155 – 159 2
Median = 60.5 + 4 5×5
160 – 164 6
165 – 169 8
Median = 60.5 + . /×5
170 – 174 9
Median = 60.5 + . / × 5 175 – 179 11
180 – 184 6
Median = 60.5 + . / 185 – 189 3
Median = 60.69
Estimate the mode, median and mean using the
Mean ( ̅ ) = = = 61.33 involving formulas. Ans : 170.6, 171.7, 175.9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
I. Choose a suitable scale for both vertical and 2 5 4 1 2 6 1 3 2 6
horizontal axes, when no scale is given. The 3 1 3 5 6 3 2 4 6 4
scale must be large enough to ensure that the 2 1 1 6 1 2 4 2 5 6
histogram covers at least half of the graph 1 6 6 2 1 3 4 2 5 1
sheet. Usually, scales using multiples of 5 or 10 Use the data to draw a histogram
are the best
Solution
II. Draw two axes, the vertical and horizontal
axes. Label the vertical axes for the frequencies Score Tally Frequency
and the horizontal according to the given data. 1 //////// 10
E.g. Ages (years), Marks Height (cm), not 2 //////// / 11
forgetting the units where applicable 3 //// / 6
4 //// // 7
5 //// / 6
III. The bars can be drawn in two ways
6 //////// 10
explained as follows:
a. Using the class boundaries, draw bars using
the lower and upper class boundaries
Marks (%)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Histogram for a Grouped Data
Worked Examples
1. Below is a record of the marks (out of 50) obtained by 22 students in a test.
14 12 8 19 13 27 22 21 32 30 35
39 36 37 42 45 40 41 44 46 44 46
i. Prepare a group frequency table for the data using the intervals 5 – 9 , 10 – 14 …
ii. From the table, determine the mean mark.
iii. Draw a histogram to represent the data.
Solution
i.
frequency
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1
4.5 9.5 14.5 19.5 24.5 29.5 34.5 39.5 44.5 49.5
Marks
Frequency
4
0
4.5 9.5 14.5 19.5 24.5 29.5 34.5 Marks (%)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. Using the class mark
Ages
(yrs) Class Mark Frequency
5–9 7 3
10 – 14 12 2
15 – 19 17 4
20 – 24 22 5
25 – 29 27 3
30 – 34 32 1
Frequency
4
0
7 12 17 22 27 32 Marks (%)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Estimating the Mode from a Histogram b. Draw another straight line from the top left
The class with the highest frequency is called corner of the tallest bar to the left corner of the
the modal class. The actual mode is contained bar to the right.
in the modal class.
III. Draw a perpendicular from the point of
The mode of can be estimated from the intersection of the diagonals onto the horizontal
histogram by following the steps below: axis.
I. Draw the histogram for the data.
IV. Read off the value of the point where the
II. Draw two diagonals from the top corners of perpendicular touches the horizontal axis, as
the adjacent bars the mode.
a. Carefully draw a straight line from the top
right corner of the tallest bar to the top right Worked Examples
corner of the bar on the left 1. Determine the mode of the histogram below:
Marks (%)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution Estimating the Median from a Histogram
The modal class has the tallest bar The Median can be estimated from the
= (55.5 – 65.5) histogram by carefully following the steps
below:
I. Draw the histogram for the distribution
Frequency
Frequency
5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0
4.5 9.5 14.5 19.5 24.5 29.5 34.5 Marks (%)
Solution
Area of each bar = L × B,
B = (9.5 – 4.5) = 5
A1 = 3 × 5 = 15 A4 = 5 × 5 = 25
A2 = 2 × 5 = 10 A5 = 3 × 5 = 15
A3 = 4 × 5 = 20 A6 = 1 × 5 = 5
Total area = 15 + 10 + 20 + 25 +15 + 5 = 90
Half of total area = = 45
Median class = (14.5 – 19.5) and (19.5 – 24.5)
A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6
0
4.5 9.5 14.5 19.5 24.5 29.5 34.5 Marks (%)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Median = 19.5 (shown on the graph)
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
0
0.5 5.5 10.5 15.5 20.5 25.5 30.5 35.5 40.5
Marks (%)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
x
0
0.5 5.5 10.5 15.5 20.5 25.5 35.5 40.5
Marks (%)
A4 = 15 × 5 = 75 A8 = 2 × 5 = 10
16 Total area
14
= 10 + 15 + 30 + 70 + 60 + 35 + 20 + 10
= 255
12
10
Half of total area = = 127.5
8
6
Median class = (18)
4
2
Class boundary = = 2.5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0
3 8 13 18 23 28 33 38
or rectangle = 15 × x = 15x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
minutes was recorded on a number of different ii. the median of the distribution.
occasions. The results were as follows; iii. iii. the upper and lower quartiles.
Cumm. Freq.
5
Midpoint 54.5 64.5 74.5 84.5
Freq. 5 2 2 1 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
each bar as the frequency. I. Frequencies = Height of bars = 3, 5, 2, 4, 1
II. Class boundaries = 4.5 – 9.5, 9.5 – 14.5,
II. For each bar, identify the first and second 14.5 – 19.5, 19.5 – 24.5, 24.5 – 29.5
numbers on the horizontal axis as the lower III. Add 0.5 to lower class boundaries and
class boundary and upper class boundary subtract 0.5 from upper class boundaries of the
respectively, and by this technique, generate all same group to generate the class size.
the class boundaries. ⇒5 – 9, 10 – 14, 15 – 19, 20 – 24, 25 – 29
III. For each class boundaries, add 0.5 to the Class Class
lower class boundary and subtract 0.5 from the Size Boundary Frequencies
upper class boundaries to generate each class 5–9 4.5 – 9.5 3
width or intervals. 10 – 14 9.5 – 14.5 5
15 – 19 14.5 – 19.5 2
Worked Examples 20 – 24 19.5 – 24.5 4
Prepare a frequency distribution table for the 25 – 29 24.5 – 29.5 1
histogram below;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
lower class boundary and subtract 0.5 from the (24.5 – 29.5)
upper class boundaries to generate each class
width or intervals. IV. Add 0.5 to the lower class boundary and
subtract 0.5 from the upper class boundaries
Worked Example (5 – 9) (10 – 14), (15 – 19), (20 – 24)
(25 – 29) to obtain class size/width
Class Class
Cumm. Freq.
5
Size Boundary Frequencies
5–9 4.5 – 9.5 3
4
10 – 14 9.5 – 14.5 5
15 – 19 14.5 – 19.5 2
3
20 – 24 19.5 – 24.5 4
25 – 29 24.5 – 29.5 1
2
7 12 17 22 27 Ages (yrs)
The formula for finding the frequency density The ages of children entering a playground in a
is given by: 1 hour period is recorded as shown below;
Frequency Density = =
0–3 4 – 10 11 – >
Age 18 18
The class frequency of a histogram is basically Frequency 12 14 48 0
the width of the group.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
When drawing the histogram for unequal Draw a histogram to represent the data.
intervals:
1. The frequency density goes along the y – Solution
axis. The class boundaries are; 0, 4, 11 and 19
2. The class width goes along the x – axis.
3. The area of each bar represents the Class width;
frequency. 4 – 0 = 4, 11 – 4 = 7 , 19 – 11 = 8
Frequency Density
5
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
Ages
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. The following table shows the ages of 25 children on a school bus.
Solution
Frequency Density 2
4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
Ages
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. Area = frequency density × class width
Area = 2 × 2
Area = 4.
Therefore, there are 4 children between the ages 16 and 17
Marks 11 – 20 21 – 35 36 – 40 41 – 50 51 – 60
No of candidates 5 7 10 16 12
Solution
2.0
1.5
1.0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0.5
2. Mr. Brown conducted an experiment to see 3. The length of 62 different songs are shown
how far 33 snails would move in 10 minutes. in the frequency table below:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
150.5< h ≤ 155.5 8 III. For each class size subtract 0.5 from the
lower class size and add 0.5 to the upper class
155.5 < h ≤ 160.5 6
size to generate each class boundary.
160.5 < h ≤ 165.5 3
165.5 < h ≤ 180.5 6
IV. From the relation;
Frequency = frequency density × class size,
Draw a histogram to display these data.
calculate the frequency of each bar/ class.
5. The exact ages (in years) of guests at a
V. Copy and complete the table with the
fancy dress party were recorded as shown in
required details
the table below;
class Class Class F F. D
Age (years) Frequency
boundaries Width
15 < A≤ 20 5
20 < A ≤ 23 15
23 < A ≤ 25 20
25 < A ≤ 30 20
30 < A ≤ 40 30
Frequency Density
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5
10 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 20
Marks
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Marks Class Class size Frequency Frequency density
boundaries (c) (f) . /
0 – 30 0.5 – 30.5 30 3 0.1
30 – 40 30.5 – 40.5 10 15 1.5
40 – 50 40.5 – 50.5 10 42 4.2
40 – 60 40.5 – 60.5 10 51 5.1
60 – 65 60.5 – 65.5 5 43 8.6
65 – 75 65.5 – 75.5 10 45 4.5
75 – 90 75.5 – 90.5 15 18 1.2
10
14
12
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
10
8
6
4
2
Measures of Positions values for 25%, 50% and 75% of the data. Q2
Measures of positions are techniques that coincides with the median.
divide a set of data into equal groups. The
different measures of positions are quartiles, Determining Quartiles
deciles and percentiles I. Order or arrange the data from smallest to
largest
To determine measurement of position, the data II. Find the place that occupies every quartile,
must be sorted from the lowest to the highest. using the expression, , where k = 1, 2, 3, for
Q1, Q2, and Q3 respectively
Quartiles
The quartiles are the three values of the
Quartiles of Odd Number of Data
variable that divide an ordered data set into
Quartiles of odd number of data are determined
four equal parts.Q1(lower quartile), Q2(middle ( )
quartile) and Q3(upper quartile) determine the by the formula, , where k = 1, 2, 3 for
Solution Q2 =
Let the lower quartile be Q1, the median be Q2
and the upper quartile be Q3 III. If the data from a to e is an odd number,
Ordering the data: 2, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9 identify the middle number of a to e as the first
n=7 quartile, Q1
( )
Q1= = = 2nd position
a, b, c, d, e, f, g, h, k, l
2, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
↓
Q1
Q1 = 2
IV. If the data from f to l is an odd number,
( ) th
Q2 = = = 4 position identify the middle number of f to l as the third
2, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9 quartile, Q3
↓
Q2 = 4 a, b, c, d, e, f, g, h, k, l
( ) Q1 Q2
Q3 = = = 6th position
2, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9 Case 2
↓ Given a, b, c, e, f, g, h, k, if the data from a to e
Q3 = 6 and f to k are even numbers, identify the
average of the two middle numbers from a to e
Quartiles of Even Number of Data as Q1 and the average of the two middle
Quartiles of even number of data, for example numbers from f to k as Q3.
a, b, c, d, e, f, g, h, k, l are determined by the
following procedure:
a , b, c, e, f, g, h, k,
Case 1
I. Order the data and divide the data into two Q1 = Q2 = Q1 =
equal parts as shown below:
Use the positions to identify the two numbers 2. Find Q1, Q2 and Q3 of the data; 2, 7, 6, 14,
and divide the sum by two to obtain the value 7, 11, 9, 3, 4, 4, 8
of the quartile.
Solution
Worked Examples 2, 3, 4, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 11, 14
1. Determine the quartiles of the data; 2, 2, 5, 6, n = 10
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
7, 7, 9, 3, 3, 4, 8, 9 Q1 position = (10)th and (10)th + 1
Q1 position = 2.5th and 3.5thpositions
Solution
Method 1 Q1 position = . /
Ascending order: = 3rd position
2 2 3 3 4 5 6 7 7 8 99 Q1 = 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
( )
2, 3, 3, 4, 5, 6, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 D8 = = = 12th position
N = 13 ⇒D8 = 11
( )
D4 = = = 5.6th position
Percentiles
It implies that D4 lies between the 5th and 6th
Percentiles are the 99 values of the variable that
positions. But 5thposition = 5 and 6th position =
divide an ordered data set into 100 equal parts
6
⇒ 4 = = 5.5 The percentiles determine the values for 1%,
2%, 3%...99% of the data. D1 = P10, D2 = P20…
( ) The median corresponds to P50
D5 = = = 7th position
⇒D5 = 6
Determining Percentiles
( )
I. Re- arrange the data in ascending order
D7 = = = 9.8th position II. Identify the number of entries as n
III. Find the place or position that occupies
It implies that D7 lies between the 9th and 10th
every percentile, using the relation, P =
positions. But 9th position = 7 and 10th position
=8 ( )
, where k =1, 2, 3…99 for P1, P2, P3 …
P99 respectively.
⇒D7 = = 8.5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
( ) who had marks less than 30.5, and this is found
P84 = = 11.76 th position
by adding the frequency of the previous class to
⇒P84 lies on the 11th and 12th positions
that of itself. i.e. 7 + 3 = 10
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=7
159.5 16 85 c. Students who obtained 69.5% or more?
164.5 9 94
32 – 26 = 6 students
169.5 6 100
Exercises 24.7
b. Number of girls who were 149.5cm tall or
1. The following table gives the masses of 100
more clients of a company to the nearest kilogram.
= Total girls – Number of girls who were not
149.5cm tall or more Mass Mass
(Nearest kg) Freq (Nearest kg) Freq
= 100 – 25 55 – 59 3 85 – 89 11
60 – 64 5 90 – 94 7
= 75
65 – 69 10 95 – 99 4
70 – 74 18 100 – 104 2
2. The following is the records of marks (%) 75 – 79 20 105 – 109 2
obtained by some students in a test 80 – 84 17 110 – 114 1
59 59 64 50 74 79 33 57
57 53 67 49 80 57 32 57 a. Draw up a cumulative frequency table.
76 48 74 24 56 50 56 50 b. Using the frequency table, find how many
60 39 52 57 30 61 73 40 clients had mass more than 79.5kg.
a. Using the class intervals of 20 – 29, 30 – 39,
40 – 49 …construct a cumulative frequency 2. The following table gives the masses of 160
table for the data babies born in a maternity home to the nearest
b. How many students obtained 49.5% or less? tenth of a kilometre.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Steps to follow when drawing the cumulative Draw a cumulative frequency curve for the
frequency curve: data.
I. Prepare a cumulative frequency table.
II. Draw two perpendicular axes on a graph Solution
sheet.
III. Label the two axes, (horizontal axis for Marks
upper class boundaries and vertical axis for Marks Less Frequency Cumulative
than Frequency
cumulative frequencies) 11 – 20 20.5 1 1
IV. Choose a suitable/ given scale and mark of 21 - 30 30.5 1 2
the values. 31 – 40 40.5 2 4
V. Plot the points from the cumulative 41 – 50 50.5 4 8
frequency table drawn up in step I 51 – 60 60.5 6 14
61 – 70 70.5 7 21
VI. Join the points with a smooth curve, but not 71 – 80 80.5 7 28
a ruler. 81 – 90 90.5 4 32
91 – 100 100.5 1 33
30
Cumulative frequency 25
20
15
10
0
10.5 20.5 30.5 40.5 50.5 60.5 70.5 80.5 90.5 100.5 110.5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Marks
2. A class of students obtained the following marks (%) in a test
59 59 64 50 74 79 33 57
57 53 67 49 80 57 52 57
76 48 74 24 56 50 56 50
60 39 52 57 30 61 73 40
Use this information to draw a cumulative frequency table and a cumulative frequency curve, using
the intervals 20 – 29, 30 – 39…
Solution
30
frequency14N1 25
20
Cumulative
15
10
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
19.5 29.5 39.5 49.5 59.5 69.5 79.5 89.5
Marks
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a.
Marks Marks less than Frequency Cumulative frequency
1 – 10 10.5 2 2
11 – 20 20.5 3 5
21 – 30 30.5 4 9
31 – 40 40.5 6 15
41 – 50 50.5 9 24
51 – 60 60.5 6 30
61 – 70 70.5 5 35
71 – 80 80.5 2 37
81 – 90 90.5 3 40
40
35
Cumulative frequency
30
25
20
Upper quartile
15
10 Lower quartile
Median
5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0
0.5 10.5 20.5 30.5 40.5 50.5 60.5 70.5 80.5 90.5 100.5
Marks
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
ii. the number of students that failed, if the pass 5. The following table gives the distribution of
mak for the test is 42; marks obtained by 150 candidates in an
iii. the probability that a student selected at examination in mathematics.
random scored between 20 % and 60 %.
Marks Frequency
3. The table below shows the division by age of 0 – 24 15
a village‟s population. 25 – 49 22
50 – 74 41
75 – 99 38
Age Frequency
100 – 124 24
Under 10 65
125 – 149 9
10 - 19 65
150 – 199 1
20 – 29 61
30 – 39 60
40 – 49 42 Draw a cumulative frequency curve for the
50 – 59 21 distribution and use it to estimate ;
60 and over 8 i. the median
ii. the number of candidates who
i. Form a cumulative frequency table and draw passed if the pass mark was 76
the ogive. iii. the number of candidates who
ii. Use your graph to estimate the median and obtained distinction if the minimum
the quartiles. mark for this grade is 145
4. The tablebelow gives the distribution of 6. The table below shows the distribution of
marksobtained by some students in an marks of candidates in an examination.
examination.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 758
21 – 30 27
Marks Marks Freq. Cumulative 31 – 40 37
less than frequency 41 – 50 63
0–9 9.5 4
51 – 60 78
10 – 19 19.5 7
20 – 29 29.5 5
61 – 70 108
30 – 39 10 71 – 80 78
40 – 49 13 81 – 90 56
50 – 59 20 91 – 80 27
60 – 69 15
70 – 79 13
i. Draw a cumulative frequency diagram for the
80 – 89 3
90 – 99 1 distribution.
ii. Use your diagram to estimate
a. Copy and complete the table. a. the number of students who scored
b. Draw a cumulative frequency curve for the more than 65 marks.
distribution. b. the pass mark, if 60% of the candidates
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
passed
7. The table below show the weight of potatoes c. the interquartile range
obtained from a number of plants.
8. A class of students obtained the following
Weight per plant Frequency marks (%) in a test;
0–2 3 28 35 41 47 51 54 56 57 58 60 61
2–4 8 62 62 64 64 66 67 68 69 70 70 72
4–6 21 73 74 75 76 77 78 80 81 83 88 90
6–8 27 94
8 – 10 19 i. Form a grouped frequency table for
10 – 12 12 this data and draw the ogive. Use
12 – 14 8
the classes 20 – 29, 30 – 39 …
14 – 16 2
ii. Estimate the number of students
who failed if the pass mark was
i. Plot the cumulative frequency curve and from
45%
it obtain the median of the distribution.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution
Data = 6, 7, 10, 12, 13, 4, 8, 12 = = =
Mean = = =9
( ̅)= = = 10.25
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 24.9 Interval 20 30 40
1. The following data represents the age Frequency 8 12 10 8
distribution of 100 people covered by health Class 40 – 50 – 60 –
insurance. Interval 50 60 70
Frequency 3 2 7
Age 25 – 34 35 – 4 4 45 – 54 55 – 64
Number 23 29 28 20 4. The following table shows the distribution of
the number of hours worked each week (on
i. Find the mean deviation about the mean average) for a sample of 100 community
ii. What is the probability of selecting a student college students.
whose age is more that 54?
Hour per Number of
2. From the table below, calculate the mean week students
deviation from the mean. 5, 0–9 24
10 – 19 14
Class 2–4 4–6 6–8 8 – 10 20 – 29 39
Interval 30 – 39 18
Frequqncy 5 6 3 1 40 – 49 5
3. Find the mean deviation about the mean Calculate the mean deviation of the
from the data below. MD = 16 distribution.
5. The heights of 25 boys are measured to the
Class 0 – 10 10 – 20 – 30 – nearest cm and are then grouped as follows:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The Range 129, 135, 136, 137, 138, 140, 143, 143, 143,
The range of the numbers in a group of data is 145, 146, 147, 149, 156, 158
the difference between the greatest number in The range 158 – 129 = 30
the data and the least number in the data. For
example, given the list 11, 10, 5, 13, 21, the ii. n = 15
range of the numbers is 21 – 5 = 16 Q1 =
( )
= = 4th position = 137cm
( )
Worked Examples Q2 = = = 8th position = 143cm
The marks of 8 students in a test are 10, 4, 5, 3, ( )
Q3 = = = 12th position = 147cm
14, 13, 16 and 7. Find the range of the marks.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
differences from the mean. Determine the variance:
1. 9, 3, 8, 9, 8, 9, 18
To calculate the variance, follow the steps 2. 30, 64, 49, 45, 30,
below: 3.22, 30, 17, 25, 18, 27
I. Work out the mean.
II. Then for each number subtract the mean and Properties of Variance
square the results (the squared difference). 1. The variance is always positive or in the
III. Then work out the averages of those event that the values are equal, the variance is
squared differences. zero.
2. If all the values of the variables are added or
Note: reduced by the same number, the variance does
When you have n data values that are: not change.
1. The population: divide by n when 3. If all the values of the variables are
( ̅) multiplied by the same number, the variance is
calculating the variance. That is σ2 = ,
multiplied by the square of that number.
where ̅ is the mean and n is the number of
scores. Standard Deviation
2. A sample (a selection taken from a bigger Standard deviation is the measure of the extent
population): divide by n – 1 when calculating to which the given values or data are spread or
( ̅)
the variance. That is: σ2 = dispersed around the mean. It is the square root
In this work, all data is taken as the population of the variance.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
I. Find the mean ( ̅ ) of the distribution by the = 2.00 (2 d. p)
formula: ̅= = Exercises 24.12
II. Prepare and complete a table of values as 1. The marks scored by 8 pupils in a science
shown below: test are 3, 7, 8, 8, 5, 8, 4, 8.What is the standard
deviation?
x x- ̅ ( ̅)
2. The scores of 10 students in an examination
( ̅) = are given as follows; 45, 12, 75, 81, 54, 51, 24,
67, 19 and 39. What is the standard deviation
II. Carefully identify the values of n and of the score?
( ̅ ) and substitute in the formula:
( ̅) 3. The price of 12 commodities in cedi are
=√ to obtain the standard deviation
recorded as: 5, 2, 5, 3, 3, 5, 3, 2, 4, 3, 3, 2
of the data. Calculate the standard deviation.
Worked Examples
4. The ages in years of 8 boys are: 14, 14, 15,
1. The scores obtained by students in a test are:
15, 12, 11 13, 10. Calculate the standard
21, 25, 27, 25, 27, 21, 24, 23, 23 and 24.
deviation.
Calculate the standard deviation.
Solution
Properties of Standard Deviation
̅= = 24 1. If a certain number (constant) is added or
subtracted from each data value, the standard
x x- ̅ ( ̅) deviation remains unchanged.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
numbers is p. If each number is increased by 2, Variance of { 6, 5, 7, 8, 9, 7} = 1
what will be the new standard deviation?
Variance of {9, 8, 10, 11, 12, 10 } = 1
Solution
Standard deviation of {9, 8, 10, 11, 12, 10 }
When each number is increased by a constant,
the standard deviation remains unchanged. = √ =√
Therefore, the standard deviation is p.
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
(x) (f)
14 4 56 784
1 14 14 14
17 3 51 867
2 30 60 120
19 1 19 361
3 32 96 288
20 2 40 800
4 40 160 640
15
5 52 260 1300
225 3513
6 80 480 2880
7 59 413 2891
From the table, 8 56 448 3584
̅= = = 15 9 21 189 1701
10 16 160 1600
Substitute the values of ̅, and in 400 = =
1880 15018
δ=√ ( ̅)
δ=√ ( ) a. ̅ = = = 4.7
δ = 3.03 (2d.p)
b. Substitute the values of ̅, and in
2. The table below gives the frequency =√ ( ̅)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x f fx fx2
1 1 1 1 ii. = (190 + 3x + 6y)
2 3 6 12 = 190 + 3(6) + 6(7)
3 x 3x 9x = 250
4 10 40 160
5 12 60 300 (1104 + 9x + 36y)
6 y 6y 36y = 1104 + 9(6) + 36(7)
7 6 42 294 = 1410
8 4 32 256
Substitute the values of ̅, and in in
9 1 9 81
= = =√ ( ̅)
(37 + x (190 + 3x (1104 +
+ y) + 6y) 9x + 36y) =√ ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. Calculate the standard deviation. III. Carefully substitute the values of ,
=√ . / ̅= = = 47.9616
̅ = 48 (Nearest whole number)
=√ . /
=√ ii. Standard deviation;
=√
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=√ . /
= 3.20 (2d. p)
=√ . /
2. The table below shos the distribution of
marks in percentages , scored by some students =√
in a test. =√
= 20.5914 (2d. p)
Marks 0 – 20 – 40 – 60 – 80 – = 21 (nearest whole number)
(%) 19 39 59 79 99
No of 7 24 36 17 7 b. number of students who scored between
students 19% and 60% 24 + 26 = 50
P (a student who scored between 19% and 60%
a. Calculate correct ot the nearest whole
=
number, the:
i. mean mark of the distribution;standard
deviation of the distribution. Exercises 24.14
b. Find, correct to two decimal places, the 1. Find the standard deviation for the data
probability of selecting a student who scored below: Ans ̅ = 8.24 S = 3.27
between 19% and 60%.
=√ . /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Calculate the mean and the standard deviation
of the distribution of heights
For ungrouped frequency, complete the table
below:
The Assumed Mean
The assumed mean as the name suggests, is an
x f d= x–A fd fd2
assumption or a guess of the mean. The
assumed mean is usually denoted by the letter
“A”. It doesn‟t need to be correct or even closer
=
to the actual mean and the choice of the
= =
assumed mean is usually at one‟s own
discretion (usually any of the class marks
Worked Examples
estimated to be closer to the mean) except
1. The student body of a certain school were
where the question explicitly states a certain
polled to find out what their hobbies were. The
assumed mean value
number of hobbies of each student was
recorded and the data obtained were grouped
The assumed mean is used to calculate:
into classes as shown on the table below,
1. the actual mean,
2. the variance,
Number of hobbies Frequency
3. the standard deviation. 0–4 45
Given the assumed mean, the actual mean 5–9 58
is calculated by the formula: ̅ = A + 10 – 14 27
15 – 19 30
20 – 24 19
25 – 29 11
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
10 – 14 12 -5 27 -135 675 110 – 119 5
15 – 19 17 0 30 0 0
20 – 24 22 5 19 95 475 i. using an assumed mean of 84.5 kg, calculate,
25 – 29 27 10 11 110 1100 correct to one decimal place;
30 – 34 32 15 8 120 1800 α. the mean of the distribution;
35 – 39 37 20 2 40 800 β. the standard deviation of the distribution.
ii. If a worker is selected at random for a blood
= = test, what is the probability that his mass ia
-1025 20775 between 70 kg and 99 kg.
̅ =A+ Solution
i. Assumed mean, A = 84.5
But A = 17, = 200 and = - 1025
̅ = 17 + Class x f d= x fd fd2
̅ = 17 – 5.125 –A
̅ = 11.88 50 – 59 54.5 10 -30 -300 9000
60 – 69 64.6 8 -20 -160 3200
ii. The variance: 70 – 79 74.5 18 -10 -180 1800
80 – 89 84.5 30 0 0 0
= . / 90 – 99 94.5 20 10 200 2000
100 – 109 104.5 9 20 180 3600
= . / 110 – 119 114.5 5 30 150 4500
= 77.61
= = =
iii. The standard deviation;
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 771
100 -110 24100 44 1 4 4 16
45 1 5 5 25
. ̅ =A+
= = 13 = 67
̅ = 84.5 + 15
̅ = 84.5 – 1.1
̅ = 83.4 kg ̅ =A+
ii. Nmber of workers with mass between 70 kg ii. The standard deviation;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and 99 kg = 18 + 30 + 20 =√ . /
= 68
=√ . /
Total number of workers = 100
=√
P(mass between 70 kg and 99 kg) = = 0.68
̅ = 1.93 kg (2 d. p)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a. A = 12
d d2 Marks 1 – 11 – 21 – 31 – 41 –
-4 16 10 20 30 40 50
3 9 Frequency 2 3 5 x 10
2 4 Marks 51 – 61 – 71 – 81 – 91 –
0 0 60 70 80 90 100
1 1
Frequency 9 6 4 y 1
-3 9
= -1 = 39
If the mean of the distribution is 47.7, find
using an asummed mean of 45.5;
̅ =A+
a. the values of the constants x and y.
̅ = 12 + b. the variance of the distribution.
̅ = 11.8 (3 s. f)
Solution
a. A = 45. 5
Marks x f d=x - ̅ fd f
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 773
1 – 10 5.5 2 - 40 - 80 3200
11 – 20 15.5 3 - 30 - 90 2700
21 – 30 25.5 5 - 20 - 100 2000
31 – 40 35.5 x - 10 - 10x 100x
41 – 50 45.5 10 0 0 0
51 – 60 55.5 9 10 90 900
61 – 70 65.5 6 20 120 2400
71 – 80 75.5 4 30 120 3600
81 – 90 85.5 y 40 40y 1600y
91 – 100 95.5 1 50 50 2500
40 + x + y 110 + (-10x) + 40y 17300 + 100x + 1600y
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x + y = 50 – 40 eqn (1) × 10;
x + y = 10 ……………………(1) 10x + 10y = 100 ……………(3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. the standard deviation of the distribution. No of 8 19 25
participants
2. The test results of 50 students were recorded Age (years) 38 – 42 43 – 47 48 – 52
as follows: No of 23 16 4
participants
Marks 50 – 60 – 70 – 80 – 90 –
59 69 79 89 99 a. Using an assumed mean of 35, calculate:
Freq. 6 11 19 9 5 i. the mean,
ii. the standard deviation of the distribution.
Assuming the mean is 74.5, calculate: b. If a participant is selected at random from
i. the mean mark; the group, what is the probability that she is at
ii. the standard deviation of the distribution. least 38 years old.
3. The table below shows the marks obtained B. 1. Consider the test results of a form three
by students in an examination.
class in Mathematics
Marks 0 – 9 10 – 20 – 30 – 40 –
19 29 39 49 marks 40 – 50 – 60 – 70 – 80 –
Freq 2 3 15 10 10 49 59 69 79 89
Assuming the mean is 15, calculate: Freq. 1 4 19 15 3
i. the actual mean mark of the distribution. Taking the assumed mean as 64.5, find the
ii. the variance of the distribution. standard deviation of the distribution.
4. Calculate the mean, variance and standard 2. The test results of 50 students were recorded
deviation of the following data using the as follows:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
61 – 70 4
= = 55.5
4. The table below shows the distribution of Midpoint of the lowest class
marks of 40 students in a test. = = 5.5
Range = 55.5 – 5.5 = 50
Marks 21 – 31 – 41 – 51 –
30 40 50 60 Method 2
No of 2 7 m 7
From the table, the highest value = 60 and the
students
Marks 61 – 71 – 81 – 91 – lowest value = 1
70 80 90 100 Range = 60 – 1 = 59
No of 8 5 n 2
students Exercise 24.16
Determine the range of the frequency
If the mean of the distribution is 57.5, find distribution table below:
using an asummed mean of 65.5, the
a. values of the constants m and n. 6 and 3 Marks 11 – 21 – 31 – 41 – 51 – 61 –
b. standard deviation of the distribution. 18.51 20 30 40 50 60 70
Frequency 5 21 15 10 7 3
The Range and Interquartile Range from
Frequency Distribution The Interquartile Range
The Range The inter quartile range for data in a frequency
The range can be determined from the distribution is still the difference between the
frequency distribution table in two ways third quartile (Q3) and the first quartile (Q1). i.
e. Q3 – Q1
Worked Example
The following table shows the distribution of the masses of parcels in a local post Office
Marks (kg)20 – 24 25 – 29 30 – 34 35 – 39 40 – 44 45 – 49 50 – 54 55 – 59
Frequency 2 3 7 26 29 25 6 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Find the interquartile range for the data.
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
= 46.1
Cumulative frequencies of all the classes
The interquartile range;
preceding the class containing Q3 is 67, so CF
= Q3 – Q1
= 67 = 46 .1 – 37.0
The frequency of the class containing Q3 is 25. = 9.1
Therefore f = 25
Exercises 24.17
Find the range and interquartile range of each of the data below;
1
Weight 116 – 118 119 – 121 122 – 124 125 – 127 128 – 130
Frequency 7 19 28 16 5
2.
Marks 40 – 44 45 – 49 50 – 54 55 – 59 60 – 64 65 – 69 70 – 74
Frequency 4 11 20 31 19 11 4
1. 0 1 2. 0 1 3. 0 1
Addition and Subtraction of Matrices
The horizontal arrays are called rows and the Two matrices can be added only if they have
vertical arrays are called columns. the same size. To add two matrices, add the
elements in the corresponding positions in each
ROWS
0 1 matrix. For example, given that A = 0 1
COLUMNS
B=[ ] and C = [ ] , then;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Describing a Matrix 1. A + B
A matrix is described by stating the
=0 1 + [ ]
dimensions. For example, , - is a 1 × 2
0 1 [ ] [ ], find;
2×2 3×3
Solution ( ) ( )
=[ ]
P+Q ( )
=0 1
= [ ] +[ ]
A + B is a zero matrix.
=[ ( )] Subtraction of Matrices
( ) Two matrices can be subtracted only if they
have the same size. To subtract two matrices,
=[ ] subtract the elements in the corresponding
8 positions in each matrix. For example, given
that A = 0 1 B=[ ] then;
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Q+P
1. A – B = 0 1 – [ ]
=[ ]+[ ]
=[ ]
( )
=[ ]
( ) 2. B – A = [ ]–0 1
– –
=[ ] =6 7
8 – –
Worked Examples
ii. P + Q = Q + P = [ ]. Therefore
8 1. Given that A = [ ] and B =
P + Q and Q + P are commutative.
Solution Solution
A–B=[ ( )]
( )
Multiplication of Matrices
A. Scale factor
A–B=[ 8]
All the entries of a matrix can be multiplied by
a common factor called scale factor, k, in a
B–A= process called scalar multiplication to obtain a
( ) scalar product. That is if A = 0 1 , then kA
B–A=[ ]
( ) = k0 1=0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B–A=[ 8] Likewise, a matrix with a common factor can
be expressed in the form k0 1 where k is the
A–B≠B–A scale factor or common factor. For example, A
So A – B and B – A are not commutative.
=0 1= 30 1, where k = 3.
8
Exercises 25.1
A. Find A + B and A – B in each Worked Examples
1. A = 0 1 B=0 1 1. If P = 0 1 and Q = 0 1 find ;
3. A = [ ] B=[ ] Solution
i. P = 0 1
8
4. A = 0 1 B= 0 1
-5P = -5 0 1
B. Simplify the following:
-5P = 0 1
1. 0 1+0 1
-5P = 0 1
2. 0 1+0 1
8
8
3. 0 1+0 1+0 1 ii. Q = 0 1
⁄ ⁄ =0 1
Q =[ ]
⁄ ⁄
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=0 1 –0 1
8
3B = 3 0 1=0 1
=0 1–0 1
8 8
8 =0 1
2A + 3B = 0 1+0 1 8
8 =0 1
=0 1
=0 1,
8 5. If A = 0 1 and A – 3B = 0 1 find
B.
3. Given that A = 0 1 and B = 0 1, find
B2 – A. Solution
A=0 1 and A – 3B = 0 1
Solution
A – 3B = 0 1
A=0 1 and B = 0 1, find
0 1 – 3B = 0 1
2
B –A=0 10 1 0 1
3B = 0 1–0 1
=0 1–0 1
8
3B = 0 1
=0 1–0 1
=[ ]
Note:
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 25.2 If A = 0 1 , then
A. In each of the following, find 2A and -3B
1. A2 = 0 10 1
1. A = 0 1 B=0 1
2. 2A = 20 1
2. A = [ ] B=[ ]
⇒ A2 2A
3. A = 0 1 B =[ ] Worked Examples
1. Find the matrix product AB given that
8
B. Given that A = 0 1 and A=[ ] and B = [ ]
8
B=0 1 evaluate;
Solution
1. 3A 2. 2B 3. 3A + 2B 4. 3A – 2B 8
AB = [ ] [ ]
5. Given that A = 0 1 and 8
=
B=0 1, find 5A + 4B 8
[ 8 ]
8 8 8 8
B. Square Matrices
It involves the multiplication of two or more 8 8
[ 8 8 ]
matrices with same number of rows and
8 8
columns. Thus, given the matrices:
equal
Exercises 25.3
A. Find the product AB. Size of AB is m × p
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B. Find the product AB. Note :
The product of a 1 × n row matrix and an
1. A = [ ] B=[ ] n × 1 column matrix is a 1 × 1 marix given by
2. A = [ ] B=[ ]
( , ) =( )
3. A = [ ] B=[ ] ( )
8
1. The number in the row matrix and a column
4. A = [ ] B=[ ] matrix must be equal, else the matrix product
AB is not defined.
2. If A is an m × p matrix and B is a p × n
5. A = [ ] B=[ ]
matrix, then AB is an m × n matrix whose
elements in the ith row and jth column is the
real number obtained from the product of ith
C. Multiplication of m × n matrices by n × p row of A and the jth column of B. If the number
For multiplication, A and B may have different of columns of A does not equal the number of
sizes; however, the number of columns of A rows in B, then the matrix product AB is not
must be the same as the number of rows of B. defined. Hence, it is important to check sizes
Thus, if A is m × n, then B must be n × p. before starting any matrix multiplication.
and B = [ ] Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
AB = (2, 3, 0) ( +
Solution
AB = (2) (-5) + (3) (2) + (0) (2)
A=0 1 and B = [ ] AB = - 10 + 6 + 0
AB = 4
AB = 0 1[ ] Exercises 25.4
Find the matrix product.
AB = 0 1 1. 0 10 1 4. 0 10 1
8
AB = 0 1 2. 0 10 1 5. 0 10 1
8
8 8
AB = 0 1 3. 0 10 1 6. 0 10 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
multiplies another matrix A, such that the result is the identity matrix.
is A.
Solution
instance, if A = 0 1 , then; A2 – 2I = 0 10 1 – 20 1
AI = 0 1 0. 1 =0
8
1–0 1
AI = 0 1 =0 1–0 1
AI = 0 1 =0 1
I= 0 1, then AI = A
Matrix Equality
⇒0 .
1 0 1=0 1 Two matrices A and B are said to be equal if
they have the same dimension and the same
entries. For instance, given A = 0 1 and
Solving Problems Involving Identity
1. Given that [ ] = 2I, wher I is the identity B=[ ], then A = B implies that:
AB = 0 10 1
Solution
AB = 0 1 0 1=0 1
Equate corresponding elements and solve for
AB = 0 1 involving variables
x+3=6
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x=6–3
A+B=0 1+0 1 x=3
A+B=0 1 y = -1
A+B=0 1 z–3=4
z=4+3
z=7
AB = A + B Therefore, x = 3, y = -1 and z = 7
⇒0 1= 0 1
3. If 0 1=0 1, find the values
⇒ 3a = 3 + a
of a and b.
3a – a = 3
2a = 3 Solution
a= 0 1=0 1,
⇒ a – b = 2 ………(1)
3b = b
a + b = 6……….(2)
3b – b = 0
2b = 0
eqn (1) + eqn (2);
b=0
2a = 8
a=
4c = 4 + c
4c – c = 4 a=4
=0 1 and 2A + 3B = 0 1 a. M = 0 1 and N = 0 1
=0 10 1
Solution
=0 1
A + 2B = 0 1 and 2A + 3B = 0 1
= 0 1
A + 2B = 0 1 ……………(1)
2A + 3B = 0 1…………….(2) b. Let P = 0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
eqn (1) × 2; P + MN = 2I
2A + (2)2B = (2) 0 1 0 10 1+0 10 1=20 1
0 1+0 1=0 1
eqn (3) – eqn (2);
B= 0 1–0 1 0 1 =0 1– 0 1
B=0 1 0 1 =0 1
A=[ ] B=< =
Solving eqn (3) and eqn (4); ⁄
- c + 2d = - 5 ………………...(3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
- 4c – d = 3…………………..(4) 4. Find the value of hfor which
eqn (3) × 4; 0 1 0 1 = h0 1
- 4c + 8d = -20………………(6)
5. Find the matrix B such that:
eqn (6) – eqn (4);
B0 1 =0 1
9d = - 23
d=
B. Find the values of x, y and z.
P=< = 8
5. 0 1[ ]=0 1
8
P= 0 1 6. [ ]6 7=6 7
i. A + X = B ii. 2A + X = B
2. Given that B = 0 1, find /B/
iii. A – 3X = B iv. 2X – 3A = 5B
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. 0 1+0 1=0 1
8
6. 0 1+0 1=0 1 Solution
8 8
A=0 1,
Determinants of a 2 × 2 matrices det A = (8) (3) – (5) -2)
Given the matrix A = 0 1, the determinant = 24 + 10
= 34
of A, denoted by /A/ is determine as follows;
i. Find the cross product of the matrix. That is;
Exercises 25.7
ad and bc.
A. Find the determinant of the matrix.
ii. Obtain ad – bc as the determinant of the
1. 0 1 2. 0 1 3. 0 1
matrix. That is: /A/ = | | = ad – bc
4. 0 1 5. 0 1 6. 0 1
8
Worked Examples
Find the determinant of 0 1 B. Evaluate the determinant of each;
1. [ ], p=2
Solution
i. Let A = 0 1 2. 0 1, n = -4
Determinant of A,
3. 0 1 , r=4
/A/ = | |
/A = (5)(1) – (-2)(3) 4. 0 1 „ y = -2
6. 0 1, x=6 Minors
To each element of a 3 × 3 matrix, there
C. Evaluate the following determinants corresponds a 2 × 2 matrix that is obtained by
1. | | 2. | | 3. | | deleting the row and column of that element.
The determinant of the existing 2 × 2 matrix is
called the minors of that element.
Challenge Problem
1. Take A = | | and B = | |, prove that Worked Examples
Find the minors for the elements 2, 3 and - 6 of
det (AB) = det A det B
8
the 3 × 3 matrix[ ].
The Adjoint of a Matrix
If A = 0 1, then the adjoint matrix of A, Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
To find the minors for 2, delete the first row
written as A* is determined as A* = 0 1 and the first column of the matrix.
8
Worked Examples [ ]
1. Find the adjoint of the matrix 0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Find all the minors and cofactors of the
elements in the matrix. The sign is easily remembered by observing
that there is a “+” sign in the upper left position
1. [ ] 4. [ ] and then alternating signs for all the remaining
positions.
It is equally advisable to expand about a
2. [ ] 5. [ ]
column or row that contains zero(s).
Worked Examples
3. [ ] 6. [ ]
1. Find the determinant of the matrix by
expanding by minors about the first column.
Determinant of a 3 × 3 Matrix
[ ]
Method I: (Expansion by minors)
/A/ = | |
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Evaluate along the third row because it contains
/A/ = 2[(3)(9) – (-5)(-7)] + 4[(1)(9) – (0)(-5)] - zero. The signs of the third row are (+, – , +)
6[(1)(-7) – (0)(3)]
| |=0| |–1| |+2| |
/A/ = 2(27 – 35) + 4(9 – 0) – 6(-7 – 0)
/A/ = 2(-8) + 4(9) – 6(-7) = 0[(1)(2) – (3)(2)] – 1 [(4)(2) –
/A/ = -16 + 36 + 42 (1) (2)] + 2[(4)(3) – (1)(1)]
/A/ = 62 = 0(2 – 6) – 1(8 – 2) + 2(12 – 1)
= 0 (- 4) – 1(6) + 2(11)
2. Find the determinant of the matrix
= - 6 + 22
[ ] = 16
Exercises 25.10
Solution A. Find the determinant of the matrix
Let A = [ ] 1. [ ] 4. [ ]
/A/ = | | 3. [ ] 6. [ ]
Solution
2. [ ], x=4
A=0 1 and /A/= 32
But /A/ = (4)(5) – (3x)(-2)
3. [ ] x=3 = 20 + 6x
⇒ 20 + 6x = 32
6x = 32 – 20
4. [ ], g = -2 6x = 12
x=2
5. [ ], b=2
3. Given | | = 0, determine the
value of x.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Equations Involving Determinants
If a given matrix involving a variable is equated Solution
to a real number, the value of the variable can | |=0
be determined as follows;
I. Obtain the determinant of the matrix in terms (x – 2) (x – 3) – (1) (2) = 0
of the variable. x2 – 3x – 2x + 6 – 2 = 0
II. Equate the determinant to the given real x2 – 5x + 4 = 0
number. x = 1 or x = 4 factorization
| | =2 2x2 + 2x + 3x + 3 + 12 = 22
(x) (3x) – (5) (x) = 2 2x2 + 5x + 3 + 12 – 22 = 0
3x2 – 5x = 2 2x2 + 5x – 7 = 0
3x2 – 5x – 2 = 0 ( x – 1) . /=0
(3x +1) (x -2) = 0 Solving by factorization;
x = 1 or x =
⇒ x = – or x = 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
6. Find the value of x for which
Type 2 : Equations involving 3 × 3 matrix
| | has no inverse.
Worked Examples
Solution 1. Solve | | =0
| |
⇒| |=0 | |=0
(x – 3) (x – 4) – 6 = 0
0 | | – (-1) | | + (1)
x2 – 4x – 3x + 12 – 6 = 0
x2 – 7x + 6 = 0 | |=0
(x – 6) (x – 1) = 0
0[(x – 3)(x + 4) – (1) (-1)] + (1) [(5)(x + 4) –
x = 6 or x = 1
(1)(6)] + (1)[(5)(-1) – (6)(x – 3)] = 0
7. Find the value of x such that | | 0[(x – 3)(x + 4) – (1) (-1)] + (1) [(5)(x + 4) –
=0 (1)(6)] + (1)[(5)(-1) – (6)(x – 3)]
5x + 20 – 6 + (-5) – 6x + 18 = 0
Solution 5x + 20 – 6 – 5 – 6x + 18 = 0
| |=0 5x – 6x + 27 = 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4k + 12k – 35 = 13
Where ad – bc is the determinant of M written
4k + 12k = 13 + 35
16k = 42 as | |.
k=3
By factorization,
Exercises 25.12
Solve for the involving variable. = 0 1
1. | | = 54 2. | | =0
Where 0 1 is the adjoint matrix of
AB = 0 10 1
Solution
A=0 1 AB = 0 1
8 8
=( )(
0 1 AB = 0 1
) ( )( )
= 0 1
Determinant of AB;
= 0 1 /AB/ = (14 × -14) – (-11 × 32)
/AB/ = -196 + 352
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
/AB/ = 156
=< ==< =
( ) = 0 1
B. Find the inverse of each, if it exist. 2. Find the value of k for which the matrix
1. . / 2. . /
A=0 1 has no inverse.
8
3. . / 4. . /
Solution
C. Find the inverses of A, B and C Let A = 0 1=0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
A= 0 1 B= 6 7 C= 0 1 If A has no inverse, then ad = bc
⇒ k(k + 1) = (1) (6)
k2 + k = 6
Challenge Problems k2 + k – 6 = 0
Write down the inverse matrix
cos sin Solving by factorization,
1. 0 1 2. 0 1
sin cos k = 2 or k = -3
3. Given X = 0 1, show that x2 – 3x + 8I =
Exercises 25.14
Z. Deduce that = ( ) Identify the singular matrices.
1. 0 1 2. 0 1 3. 0 1
Singular Matrix
It is a matrix that has no inverse. This occurs 4. 0 1 5. 0 1 6. 0 1
when the determinant of the matrix is zero. In
this case, ad = bc. This makes ad – bc = 0 Transpose of a Matrix
The transpose of a matrix, M, is written as .
Worked Examples If the first column of M is the first row of
1. Show whether or not M = 0 1 is a and the second column of M is the second row
singular matrix. of , then is said to be the transpose of M.
Consider M = 0 1, then the M transpose is
Solution
given by =0 1.
M=0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. Write down the transpose of B = 0 1 and Solution
Solution
Minors of A,
If B = 0 1, then B1 = 0 1
( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( ) ( )( )
⇒ (B1)1 = 0 1 <( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( )=
( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( ) ( )( )
Therefore (B1)1 = B = 0 1
=[ ]
Exercises 25.15
Find the transpose of the matrices:
=[ ]
8
1. 0 1 4. 0 1
8
2. 0 1 5. 0 1 Matrix of cofactor;
3. 0 1 6. 0 1 [ ]
Divide transpose matrix by determinant of the What is the total number of points (home and
matrix to obtain the inverse of the matrix. away) scored by each team
[ ] Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The number of goals scored in home matches .
Away Points
W D L
Black 2 1 0 The number of goals scored in away matches .
Red 2 0 1
Green 0 2 1 [ ][ ]=[ ]=[ ]
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a missing entry represented by a variable that
Results for home and away matches makes the matrix equation true. The task of the
student is to find the missing matrix represented
[ ]+[ ]=[ ]
by a variable in the equation.
[ ]=0 1
2=q+2 8
q=2–2
[ ]=0 1
q=0 8
12 – 2y = 8
2y = 12 – 8
2. Given that A = 0 1 and B = 0 1
2y = 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Find the values of m and n such that: y=2
AB = 20 1+0 1
4. Given 0 10 1=0 1
Solution Find the values of x.
A= 0 1 and B = 0 1
Solution
AB = 20 1+0 1 0 10 1=0 1
0 10 1 = 20 1+0 1 0 1=0 1
0 1=0 1+0 1
8 8 0 1=0 1
0 1=0 1 4+x=3
x=3–4
Equating the entries; x = -1
2m – 2 = 14
2m = 16 5. Given that [ ] = 0 1,
8
m=8
find the values of x and y.
- 6 + n = - 14
n = -14 + 6
Solution
n=-8 [ ]=0 1
8
2x + y = 8
2(3) + y = 8
6+y=8 3. [ ]=Y– [ ]
y=8–6
y=2
Y=[ ]+[ ]=[ 8 ]
More Worked Examples
Solve each of the following:
4. 0 1 =0 1 + 4X
1. 5B = [ ]
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
4X = 0 1–0 1
2. A + [ 8] = [ ] ( )
4X = [ ]
( )
8
3. [ ]=Y– [ ] 4X = 0 1
8
X= 0 1
4. 0 1 =0 1 + 4X
8⁄ ⁄
5. [ ] = - 2B + [ ] X=[ ]
8 ⁄ ⁄
X=0 1
Solution 8 8
1. 5B = [ ]
5. [ ] = - 2B + [ ]
8
⁄
B= [ ] = ⁄ =[ ]
⁄ ] 2B = [ ]+[ ] =[ ]
[ 8 8
8
Solution
20 1 – (-5)0 1 + (-1)0 1 = 58
P=0 1 and Q = 0 1
= 2(3 + 2k) + 5 (9 + 2) – 1(3k – 1) = 58
PQ = 0 10 1 6 + 4k + 45 + 10 – 3k + 1 = 58
8 8 k + 62 = 58
PQ = 0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
k = 58 – 62
8 k=-4
PQ = 0 1
Exercises 25.18
A. Solve the following;
QP = 0 10 1
1. 2X = [ ]
QP = 0 1
8
8 2. 0 1 + 4Q = 0 1
QP = 0 1
8
8 + 2d = 18 1. 3 0 1 + 50 1 = -40 1
2d = 18 – 8
2d = 10 2. 2 0 1–40 1 = 30 1
d=5
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 804
3. Find all the values of k for which the matrix ⁄
0 1=[ ]
⁄
M=0 1 is singular.
0 1=0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
IV. Simplify and equate to obtain the values of 0 10 10 1 0 10 1
x and y.
8
0 10 1 = 0 1
Worked Examples
1. Solve 4x + 5y = 3 and 2x + 3y = 1 0 10 1 = 0 1
simultaneously;
0 1=0 1
Solution
4x + 5y = 3 and 2x + 3y = 1 as a single matrix
3. Solve the equations:
equation is; 3x + 4y = 12 and 2x + 6y = 23
0 10 1 0 1
Solution
3x + 4y = 12 and2x + 6y = 23
Inverse of 0 1=0 1
0 10 1 0 1
0 10 10 1 0 10 1
Inverse of 0 1=0 1
0 10 1 = 0 1
8 8 0 10 10 1 0 10 1
0 10 1 = 0 1
8 8
0 10 1 = 0 1
8 8
[ ]=0 1
0 10 1 = 0 1
3. 0 1 0 1= 0 1 4. 0 1 0 1= 0 1
Solution
0 10 1 = 0 1 5. 0 1 0 1= 0 1 6. 0 1 0 1= 0 1
Invserse of 0 1=0 1
B. Write down the following pair of
0 10 10 1 = 0 10 1 equations in matrix form and solve for x and
y in each case.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
8 8 1. 2x + 3y = - 4, 5x + y = 3
0 10 1 = 0 1
8 2. x – y = -7, 3x + 2y = 4
0 10 1 = 0 1 3.7x – 2y = 9, 2x – 4y = 2
8 4. 2x + 8y = 33, y – 3x =-4
[ ]=0
1 5. 3x + 2y = 10, 2x – 7y =10
8
⁄ C. Solve giving x, y correct to 2 significant
0 1=[ ]
8⁄ figures.
8
1. 0 10 1 = 0 1
5. Solve the equations:
8 2. 0 10 1 = 0 1
0 10 1 = 0 1
3. 0 1 0 1= 0 1
Solution
8
0 10 1 = 0 1 4.0 1 0 1= 0 1
8 8 8
Inverse of 0 1=0 1 5. 0 1 0 1= 0 1
8 8 8
0 10 10 1 = 0 10 1
D. 1. What is the inverse of 0 1? Use it to
0 10 1 = 0 1
solve the simultaneous equation:
[ ]=0 1 9x + 16y = - 2 and 5x + 9y = -1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
and y.
3. That is obtained by replacing the first (or Solution
x) column of D by the constants and . 3x – 2y = 4 and 2x + y = -3.
4. That is obtained by replacing the second
0 10 1 = 0 1
(or y) column of D by the constants and .
D=| |
Worked examples
D = (1)(3) – (-2) (2)
1. Use Cramer‟s rule to solve:
D = 3 – (-4)
4x + 5y = 3 and x + 3y = 1
D=7
Solution
From 4x + 5y = 3 and 2x + 3y = 1; =| |
= 4, = 5, = 3 =2 =3, =1 = (4)(1) – (-2)(-3)
=4–6
0 10 1 = 0 1 = -2
x= = =
D=| |=| |
=| |
D = (4)(3) – (5) (2)
D = 12 – 10 = (3)(-3) – (4)(2)
D=2 = -9 – 8
= -17
=| |=| |
Solution Solution
4x – 2y = 10 and 3x – 5y = 11
| |
0 10 1 = 0 1
= 2| | - (-1) | | + 2| |
D=| | = 2(3 – 8) + 1(1 – 4) + 2(2 – 3)
D = (4)(-5) – (-2) (3) = 2(-5) + 1(-3) + 2(-1)
D = -20 + 6 = -10 – 3 – 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
D = - 14 = -15
ii. 2x – y + 2z + 5 = 0
=| | x + y + 4z – 1 = 0
= (-5)(10) – (-2)(11) x + 2y + z + 2 = 0
= -50 + 22
= - 28 2x – y + 2z = -5
x= = =2 x + y + 4z = 1
x + 2y + z = -2
=| |
| | =| | = -15
= (4)(11) – (3)(10)
= 44 – 30 | |= | |
= 14
= -5| | – (-1) | | + 2| |
y= = = -1
(x , y) = ( , ) = -5(3 – 8) + 1(1 + 8) + 2(2 + 6)
= -5 (-5) + 1(9) + 2(8)
Solved Past Question
= 25 + 9 + 16
i. Evaluate | | = 50
x= = = = - 3.33
B. Use Cramer‟s rule to solve; and use your answer to solve the following
1. 0.5x + 0.2y = 8 and 0.4x – 0.6y = -5 x+y+z=2
2. 0.6x + 0.5y = 18 and 0.5x – 0.2y = 7 2x + 3y + 5z = -1
3x + y – 4z = 18
3. x + y = 5 and x – y = -1
3. Use matrices to solve the following :
4. x + y = 4 and x + y = -2.
a. 8p – 15q = 2 and 4p – 7q = 2
b. 13a – 20b = -1 and 7a – 9b = 3
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
C. Use Cramer‟s rule to solve each:
4. Use cramers rule to solve the system of
1. - 8x – y = 19 and -5x – 6y = 28 linear equations for x.
2. – x – 8y = 82 and 2x + 8y = - 76 - x + 2y – 3z = 1
3. 9x – 2y = 83 and -9x – 8y = 17 2x + z = 0
3x – 4y + 4z = 2
4. 8x + 5y = - 10 and 4x + 8y = - 60
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
example, 0 10 1 = 0 1. The 2 × 2 matrix
Given the linear transformation, is regarded as a mapping. In this case, we say
x1 = ax + by and y1 = cx + dy, the matrix of the the image of the point (-1, 2) is (4, 5) under the
linear transformation is expressed as:
mapping represented by M = 0 1.
M=0 1
To find the image of a point under a given
Worked Examples linear transformation;
1. Find the matrix of the linear transformation, I. Identify the given point or the position
x1 = 3x + y and y1 = 2x – 3y
vector, 0 1.
=0 1=0 1
( )
P1 = 0 1= 0 1= 0 1
A1 = (1, 2)
P1 = (-2, -1)
Image of B(2, 0);
( )
⇒0 10 1 = 0 1 Q1 = [ ]= 6 7= 6 7
=0 1=0 1
Q1 = . , /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1
B = (2, 4)
Method 2
Solution
A1 = 0 1=0 1=0 1 B(x, y) →(3x + 5y 2x + y)
Object = (-2, 3)
A1 = (1, 2)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
values of a and b.
0 1=0 10 1
8
0 10 1=0 1 Finding the Transformation given the Matrix
8
Given the matrix 0 1, the linear
[ ] =0 1
8 transformation T, represented by the matrix is
T : (x, y) → (ax + by, cx + dy)
x + 4y = 9……………………….(1)
2x + 3y = 8...……………………(2) Worked Examples
1. Write down the linear transformation defined
eqn (1) × 2;
by the matrix 0 1
2x + 8y = 18………..………….(3)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1
P+T=P
Image = Object + Tv
Worked Examples
1. The image of P(5, 4) under a translation in [ ]=0 1 + 0 1= 0 1=0 1
the xy plane is P = (8, -2).
i. Find the matrix equation of the B. Reflection
transformation. Here, an image is produced by reflecting an
ii. Find the image of Q(-4, 0) under the object or point in either the x – axis or the y –
transformation. axis. Thus, we have:
1. Reflection in the x – axis (or line y = 0).
Solution 2. Reflection in the y – axis (or line x = 0).
Image = Object + Tv 3. Reflection in a given line.
P (8, -2) = P(5, 4) + Tv
8 1. Reflection in the x – axis (or line y = 0).
0 1 = 0 1 + Tv
8 This is represented by the matrix 0 1
Tv = 0 1–0 1=0 1
Image = 0 1 × object
Image = Object + Tv
[ ]=0 1+ 0 1=[ ] Worked Examples
1. Find the image of the point A(-2, 5) in the
x – axis.
The matrix equation is:
=x+3 =y–6
A1 = 0 10 1 Image = 0 1 × object
A1 = 0 1= 0 1= 0 1
Worked Examples
A1 = (-2, -5) 1. Find the image of the point C(5, 7) under
reflection in the line y = x.
2. Find the image of the point P(5, 3) under the
linear transformation M = . / Solution
C(5, 7)
Reflection in the y = x is represented by the
Solution
Image = Matrix × Point matrix 0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
=. /. /
C1 = 0 10 1
=. /=. /=. /
(5, -3) C1 = 0 1=0 1=0 1
C1 (7, 5)
2. Reflection in the y – axis (line x = 0)
This is represented by the matrix 0 1
4. Reflection in the line y = - x or y + x = 0
Image = 0 1× object This is represented by the matrix 0 1
Image = 0 1 × object
Worked Examples
1. Find the image of the point B(-2, 5) in the
y – axis. Worked Examples
1. Find the image of the point D(6, 11) under
Solution reflection in the line y = - x
B(-2, 5)
Reflection in the y – axis is represented by the Solution
D(6, 11)
matrix 0 1 Reflection in the y = -x is represented by the
matrix 0 1
B1 = 0 10 1
=0 10 1
=0 1= 0 1=0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
a. i. Reflection in the line x + y = 0
⇒ a reflection in the line y = -x
⇒ A(x, y) → (-y, -x)
A=. /
A
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
R(450) = . /,
√ √ R(450) = . /,
0
R(45 ) = : ; √ √
√ √
0
R(60 ) = : ;
√ √
Image of P;
√ √
√ Image of (-3, 5);
P1 = : ;4 5 = : ; =: ; √ √
√ √
√
=: ;. /
√ √
Solution = ( √ , √ )
Worked Example =0 10 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Find the image of Q(7, 10) under
=[ ] =0 1
anticlockwise rotation through 1800 about the
origin. = (- q , - q )
Worked Examples
1. Find the image of R(-6, 4) under Q
0
P
anticlockwise rotation through 270 about the P1
origin.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. translate the plane back by 0 1 to its original Solution
P(8, -2) under enlargement with scale factor 2:
position. 8
P1 = 0 10 1
[ ] =0 1 0 1 +0 1
8
P1= 0 1= 0 1= 0 1
OR 8
P1 = (16, - 4)
[ ] =0 1 0 1
Properties of Enlargement
Note: 1. There is a single invariant point, the center of
The second form is more instructive, since it enlargement.
maintains a straight forward rotation with the 2. All other points P map onto their images:P1
point (a, b) as center. so that OP1= kOP, where k is the scale factor of
enlargement.
D. Enlargement
Enlargement is the process of making an object Under enlargement, any figure is mapped onto
bigger than its original size. This is made a similar figure.
possible by the use of a scale factor, k. In some 1. If /k/ > 1, the image is larger than the original
cases, the object is made smaller than its figure but /k/ < 1, it is smaller. To avoid the
original size in a process called reduction or concept of an enlargement producing a smaller
dilatation. figure, the term dilatation is often used.
If k < 0, O lies between P, P1 and the
Enlargement from the origin, with scale factor image figure is inverted.
k, is represented by the matrix identity 0 1
∆2 0 1=0 1
O
0 1=0 1
∆1
∆ b = -2 and d = 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Isometrics The matrix of the transformation is 0 1
Under isometrics, any figure maps onto a
congruent figure. Translation and rotation ii. The coordinate of the image of B(1, 1).
produce directly congruent figures, reflection is
inversely congruent. B1 = 0 10 1 = 0 1
Solution
i. Let the transformation matrix be 0 1
A(1, 0) → A1 (4, 2)
C B
0 10 1 = 0 1
A
0 1=0 1
0 10 1 = 0 1 C1 = 0 1=0 1=0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
0 1=0 1 iii. Determinant of 0 1
a = 2 and c = 2
| | = (2)(5) – (2)(2)
Now, since O is fixed, and the stretched is = 10 – 4
along the line y = 2x, all points in the line y = =6
- x are fixed.
iv. Since the determinant is 6, the area of the
0 10 1=0 1 image is 6 times the area of OABC.
0 1=0 1
Reflection in a Line through the Origin
0 1=0 1 Consider the point P(x, y), a distance of d from
the line y = x tan θ (where θ is the angle
4–b=2 between line and the positive x – axis), and its
b=4–2 image P1( , ) after reflection in this line.
b=2 y
( , )
dθ
4 – d = -1
d
d=4+1 θ
d=5 (x, y)
Substitute a = 2, b = 2, c = 2 and d = 5 θ
x
0 1=0 1
Worked Examples
1. Find the matrix which represent a cos sin
0 1
transformation in the line y = 2x sin cos
√
⇒ cos θ = and sin θ =
Solution
√
y = 2x θ = . / and θ = . /
From y = 2x, the gradient of the line is 2 θ = and θ =
⇒ tan θ = 2
tan θ = 2 √ The matrix represents a roataion about O
through 2100 anti clockwise.
sin θ = 1
√
Exercises 26.3
tan θ =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
√ A. Write down the matrices representing the
following transformations.
Now, from trigonometry, 1. Reflection in the line through the origin
cos 2θ = 2 cos2 θ – 1 which makes an angle of 600 with the positive x
cos 2θ = 2 . / – 1 – axis.
√
2. Rotation through 1350 clockwise about O.
cos 2θ =
3. Rotation through . / clockwise about O.
4. Reflection in the line y = -3x
sin 2θ = 2 sin θ cos θ
sin 2θ = 2 . / . / = B. Decribe geometrically, the plane
√ √
transformation with the following matrices;
By substitution, the required matrix is : √
√ √ √ √
cos sin 1. < = 2. < = 3. < =
√
0 1 =< =
sin cos √ √ √ √
8 8
4. 0 1 5. 0 1
8 8
2. A plane transformation has matrix
√
Inverse of a Linear Transformation
< = . Describe this transformation
√ The inverse transformation of a linear
transformation:
geometrically.
= ax + by = cx + dy is
Solution x= ( )
y= ( ),
x= ( )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
: ; . /=. /
y= ( ),
By substitution; : ;=. /
x= ( )
y= ( ), ⇒ = -2 …………….(1)
= 1 ……………….(2)
x= +
y=2 Reducing the equation;
( ) ( ) = -2 (6)
2. A transformation is defined by T : (x, y) →
(4x + y, 6x + 3y). 3x – y = - 12 ………………..(3)
i. Write down the matrix T of the
transformation. ( ) ( ) = (3)1
ii. Find the inverse , of the matrix T. -3x + 2y = 3………….…….(4)
iii. If the point P is transformed by the matrix
and the imagae is (-2, 1), find the eqn (4) + (3)
coordinates of P. y = -9
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
matrix B, followed by the transformation for
the matrix A. This is calculated as follows: A followed by B;
I. Write the matrix A and B of the linear A○ B = BA
transformation. A○ B = 0 10 1
II. Find the matrix product AB. 8
III. Write the linear transformation for AB. That A○ B = 0 1=0 1
8 8
is AB. /.
IV. Notice that the matrix which represents the 2. Given that M = 0 1 and N = 0 1,
first transformation A is placed on the right and
find the image of the point (2, 3) under the
the second transformation B is placed on the
transformation M ○ N.
left in the matrix product. This is illustrated
below:
Solution
Given A : [ ] = [ ] 0 1 and M=0 1 and N = 0 1,
B : [ ] = [ ] 0 1, if A is applied first, M ○ N = MN
followed by B, we obtain: M○N= 0 10 1,
AB. /: [ ]=[ ][ ]0 1
M○N=0 1= 0 1
Thus, the matrix which represents the
composite transformation A followed by B is
Image of (2, 3) under transformation M ○ N
the matrix product [ ][ ].
=0 1 0 1= 0 1= 0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
B : (x, y) →(3x + 2y, 4y)
Find the matrix representing A○B.
Since B =
Solution
A : (x, y) →(2x – y, 3x + 2y) B=< =
A=0 1
As a linear transformation;
B : (x, y) → . /
B : (x, y) →(3x + 2y, 4y)
B : (x, y) → . /
B=0 1
Exercises 26.5
A ○ B = AB
1. Find the image of the point P(2, 5) under a
=0 10 1= 0 1=0 1 reflection in the y – axis , followed by an anti –
8
clockwise rotation of 1800 about the origin.
Solved Past Question Describe the combined linear transformation.
1. The linear transformations A and B are
defined by A : (x, y) →(x + y, 2x – y) and B : 2. Find the image of the point P(4, -5)
(x, y) →( , ). When a point is transformded under: a rotation through 600 anti clockwise ,
under A, followed by B it remains unchanged. followed by another rotation through 750 anti
Find the point ( , ). clockwise, followed by a reflection in the line
y = -x
Solution
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
they are neither true nor false. the symbol means “not” and P is read as
Sentences 3, 4 and 5 are statements because “not P”. Hence P:“Linda is not a girl”.
they can either be true or false, depending on Obviously, when P is true, the negation of P is
the context. The sixth sentence, is obviously a false and vice – versa.
true statement.
Worked Examples
Exercises 27.1 Write down the negation of the statements
A. Which of the sentences are statements? 1. P : 5 {primes} 2. 7 ∉ {even integers}.
1. Ghana is in Africa. 3. P : x < 2 4. P : 3 < x < 4
2. All primes are odd numbers.
3. Will you go to school tomorrow? Solution
4. 5 = 3 mod 3. 1. P : 5 ∉ {primes}
5. 3 is an even number. 2. P : 7 {even integers}
6. 10 is a multiple of 5. 3. P : x 2, or P: x 2
4. P : x 3, or x 4
B. Which of the following sentences are
statements? If they are statements, state Exercises 27.2
whether they are true or false Write down the negation of each of the
1. Do your mathematics exercises. following statements and state whether the
2. There are 52 weeks in a year. negation is true or false;
3. Drive with care. 1. P : 3 {primes} 2. P : 4 {factors of 10}
4. sin 300 = sin 600. 3. P : 5 < 3 4. P : x > 3
5. All prime numbers can only be divided by 1 5. P : 4 = 2 6. P : - 4 x 5
and itself.
Baffour Ba Series, Further Mathematics for Schools Page 825
Statements and Venn Diagrams 3.R : Every science student studies mathematics
Similar to sets, statements can be represented in but not history.
Venn diagrams. Identify the following from the 4. S : All my friends are intelligent people.
given statements: 5. T : Every multiple of 10 is also a multiple of 5.
1. Universal set.
2. Subsets. B. Illustrate on a Venn diagram.
3. Complement. 1. P : All football players play volley ball.
Q : A volley ball player does not play hockey
Worked Examples Blay plays volleyball but not football.
Represent each of the following statements on a
Venn diagram. 2. P : All my friends are intelligent.
i. P : Kofi is a good boy. Q : Intelligent people are quite people.
ii. Q : 4 is a factor of 100 but 3 is not. R : Dufie is a quite person but not intelligent.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Q : All my friends are vegetarians.
A = {Good boys} R : Jonathan is not a vegetarian but does not eat
k = Kofi meat.
k {Good boys} S : Rosemond eats meat.
U T : Brown is a vegetarian but he is not my
A friend.
K
4. P : Rich men live in big houses.
Q : Mr. Owusu is a rich man.
R : Mr. Owusu lives in a big house.
ii. U = {Integers}
A = {factors of 100} 5. P : All boys play football.
4 *factors of 100} Q : Danny plays football.
U
A1 = {3} R : Danny is a boy.
A
4 Compound Statements
A compound statement is a combination of two
3
or more statements in a single statement. They
are usually formed by the conjunction “and”
Exercises 27.3
and “or”. For example, P : x > – 4, Q : x < 3.
Represent each of the following statements
The compound statement P and Q is the
on a Venn diagram.
statement “x > – 4 ” and “x < 3”written as P
1. P : A square is a quadrilateral.
and Q : - 4 < x < 3
2. Q : Rich people are hardworking people.
A B U
B. From the following pair of statements, form
a compound statement using “or” and
determine whether the compound statement is
true or false.
A∩ 1. P : 4 {primes}, Q : 4 {even numbers}
The compound statement “P and Q” is true 2. P : 3 {factors of 27}, Q : 5 {multiples of
only if both P and Q are true and false only if 10}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
either P or Q is false. 3. P : 2 {odd numbers}, Q : 2 {factors of 15}
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
is true or false
1. P : {integers}, Q : 2 { prime numbers} Worked Examples
2. P : 5 {factors of 14}, Q : 5 {multiples of Which implications are true or false;
10}. 1. x2 > 4, then x > 2
3. P : 3 , Q: 2 3 2. If a number is a perfect square, then it is
4. P : 15 {primes}, Q : 5 { prime} positive
Each of these sentences consist of two clauses – If the arrow is reversed like this “⇐”, the
the “if clause” and the “then clause”. Each of implications appear as follows:
the two clauses is a statement in itself. a. It is a dog ⇐ It is an animal with four legs.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
angle
Equivalent Statements b. Q ⇒P : If an angle is a right angle, then it is 900
Consider the statement below: c. P ⇔Q : If an angle is 900, then it is a right
„If he passed the examination, then he is angle and vice – versa.
promoted‟ Since P ⇒ Q and Q ⇒P are true, P ⇔Q is also
1. The implication is: true and hence P and Q are equivalent.
„He has passed the examination⇒ He is
promoted‟. This is a true statement. 2. Two statements P and Q are defined by
P : x {even numbers}
2. The converse is ; Q : 4x {even numbers }
He has passed the examination⇐ He is Determine whether P and Q are equivalent
promoted. This is also a true statement.
Solution
This implies that the implication as well as its
P ⇒Q : If x is even , then 4x is even
converse is true. The implication and its
converse can be simplified by the use of the Q ⇒P : If 4x is even , then x is even
arrow “⇔”. Thus, the implication appears as: P ⇒Q is true, but Q ⇒ P is false since 4 × 1
„He has passed the examination⇔ He is {even numbers} but 1 ∉ {even numbers}
promoted‟ Hence P ⇔ Q is false. Therefore P and Q are
not equivalent
Generally, when an implication P ⇒ Q and its
converse Q ⇒ P are both true, the statements P Exercises 27.5
and Q are said to be equivalent, expressed as A. For the following pair of statements P and
P⇔Q Q, determine whether P and Q are
equivalent
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
P : x > 7, Q : x > 5, R : x > 3 and the
3. x < 0 ⇒x2 > 0 4. x > 0 ⇒x2> 0
implications P ⇒Q : x > 7 ⇒x > 5
5. x2 > 0 ⇒x > 0
Q ⇒R : x > 5 ⇒ x > 3
6. A polygon has n sides ⇔It has n angles
This can be represented in a Venn diagram as
7. Each angle of a triangle is 600⇔It is an
shown below:
equilateral triangle
∪ = {numbers}
8. is the mediator of ⇐ is
A = {numbers > 7}
perpendicular to B = {numbers > 5}
C = {numbers > 3}
B. Fill in the blank space with ⇒, ⇐ or ⇔
where appropriate, if none is applicable, use C U
B
⇔ A
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Solution iii. Which of the following implications are
i. P : a student studies science subject valid deductions from S1, S2and S3?
Q : a student studies mathematics a. P1 : every voter in an election is over 21
R : a student does not study history years old.
The implications are: b. P2 : every person who pays basic rate can
P ⇒ Q; Q⇒R vote in an election.
The implication P ⇒ R is valid, because P ⇒R : c. P3 : every person who registers as a voter
If a student studies science subjects, he does not pays basic rate.
study history d. P4 : every person over 21 years of age can
register as a voter .
ii. U = {students in the college}
A = {Science students} Truth Tables
B = {mathematics students} A truth table is a table which gives all the truth
C = {non – history students} values of a compound statement. The table is
filled in by considering all possible
C U
B combinations of true and false for P and Q and
A then filling in the results for the various
connectors mentioned above.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. 10 is divisible by 5 and 10 is a multiple of 2. following statement is true or false.
ii. 2 is a factor of 15 and 10 is a multiple of 2. 1. 4 is a perfect square and four is the square
iii. 10 is a multiple of 2and 2 is a factor of 15 root of 16.
iv. 10 is not a multiple of 2 and 2 is a factor of 15 2. x is odd, and x2 is odd.
3. x is a prime number greater than 2 and x is
Solution odd.
i. 10 is divisible by 5 and 10 is a multiple of 2. 4. x is a prime factor of 30 and x is a prime
P : 10 is divisible by 5 = T factor of 40.
Q : 10 is a multiple of 2 = T 5. x is a prime factor of 18 and x is a prime
The statement is true. factor of 24.
Solution P Q P ⇒Q P ⇐Q P⇔Q
2 is either an odd number or a factor of 15 T T T T T
P : 2 is an odd number = F T F F T F
Q : 2 is a factor of 15 = F F T T F F
F F T T T
P Q P˅Q
F F F Note that the P ⇒ Q column can be obtained
from (P⇒Q) ˄ (P ⇐ Q).
The statement is false
Worked Examples
2. A triangle has three sides, or a parallelogram Use truth table to show whether the statement is
has three sides. true or false.
“The product of two numbers is even if and
Solution only if both numbers are even”
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
P : A triangle has three sides = T
Q : A paralellogram has three sides = F Solution
P : the product of two numbers is even
P Q P˅Q Q : both numbers are even ,
T F T
P ⇒Q : If the product of two numbers is even
The statement is true then both numbers are even. T
Exercises 27.8
P ⇐Q : If two numbers are even, then their
Use truth table to show whether each of the
product is even. T
following statement is true or false.
1. An acute angle is 900 or a right angle is
P Q P ⇒Q P ⇐Q P⇔Q
between 900
T T T T T
2. The sum of interior angles of a triangle is
less than 1000, or an octagon has seven vertices The statement is true.
3. x is even or x2 is odd.
4. 6 is a perfect square or eight is the square 2. If 2 is an odd number then 2 is not a prime
root of 16 number.
5. The product of two numbers is even, or the
sum of both numbers is even. Solution
6. 83 is an odd number or 38 is a composite P : 2 is an odd number F
number. Q : 2 is not a prime number F
7. 169 is a perfect square or 255 is a perfect The statement is true
square.
Solution P Q ¬P ¬Q P⇒ Q ¬Q⇒ ¬P
P : 121 is divisible by 11 T T T F F T T
Q : 5 is divisible by 3 F T F F T F F
The statement is false F T T F T T
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
F F T T T T
5. If a triangle is a polygon, then a polygon is a
triangle Exercises 27.9B
A. In the following exercises, P, Q, R,
Solution and S will represent truth statements.
P : A triangle is a polygon T Construct the truth tables for the following
Q : A polygon is a triangle F statements, and give their converse and
The statement is false contrapositive:
1. ¬P ⇒Q
Exercises 27.9 A 2. P ⇒ ¬ Q
Use true or false for each 3. (P ˅ Q) ⇒ R
1. A whole number is divisible by ten if and 4. (P ˄ Q) ⇒ (R˅ S)
only if its decimal numeral ends with zero. 5. (P ⇒ Q) ⇐ (R⇒S)
2. Two lines are parallel if and only if they do
not meet, however far they are extended. B. Negate the following statements:
3. Two figures have the same area if they are 1. P ˄ Q
congruent. 2. (P ˅ Q) ˄ (R˄ S)
4. The product of two numbers is even if and 2. (P ˄ ¬ Q) ˅ (¬R ˅ S)
only if both numbers are even.
Valid Arguments
B.1. If two acute angles are congruent and A valid argument is a series of statements in
complementary then their measure i 450. T which each statement follows logically from
2. If 8 is divisible by 5, then 8 is a factor of 5. T the preceding ones. Thus, an argument begins
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. Determine whether the following statement
K
is valid or not:
If he is a good tennis player, he can run well.
Nana Amoah is a good tennis player. Therefore, From the Venn diagram, we conclude that
Nana Amoah can run well. „Brown is not a science student‟
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
5. P : When it rains , there is no school
Q : Yesterday it rained since there was no
4. All locally manufactured goods are marked school.
“Made in Ghana”
The portable radio is marked, “Made in China” C. Each case, determine by drawing Venn
the portable radio is not manufactured in diagrams whether the statement R is a valid
Ghana conclusion from the statements P and Q
1. P : Rich men live in big houses
5. All squares are rhombuses Q : Mr. Owusu lives in a big house
ABCD is not a rhombus R: Mr. Owusu is a rich man
ABCD is not a square
2. P : Allboys like football
6. All triangles having at least two equal sides Q : Dzifa likes football
are isosceles triangles. R : Dzifa is a boy
An equilateral triangle has three equal sides.
an equilateral triangle is an isosceles triangle. 3. P : Basketball people are tall people.
Q : Neos is a basketball player.
B. In each case,draw a Venn diagram to R : Neos is tall.
determine whether the statement, Q is a
valid conclusion from the statement P. 4. P : Vegetarians do not eat meat.
1. P : Lazy students fail their examination. Q : Hindus are vegetarians.
Q : Aku is lazy since she failed her R : Hindus do not eat meat.
examination.
Introduction to Correlation and Regression between the two variables. It is also known as
Analysis two-way frequency distribution. For example,
Correlation analysis is used to quantify the height and weight of students in a class being
association between two continuous variables collected. In this case one variable is labelled x
(e.g., between an independent and a dependent and the other y.
variable or between two independent variables).
The Scatter Diagram
Regression analysis is a related technique to The scatter diagram is used to graphically
assess the relationship between an outcome display bivariate distributions. One variable is
variable and one or more risk factors or along the x – axis and the other along the y –
confounding variables. The outcome variable is axis.
also called the response or dependent variable
and the risk factors and confounders are called The scatter diagram is a useful tool in
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
predictors or explanatory or independent examining relationships, especially between
variables. two variables.
In regression analysis, the dependent variable is A plot of the sample data on the graph gives a
denoted by "y" and the independent variables
visual indication of the degree of association
are denoted by "x".
between two variables, say x and y. That is, by
Univariate and Bivariate Distributions examininthe scatter diagram, we can :
Univariate Frequency Distribution
1. observe whether the vraiables are indeed
When data is classified on the basis of single
variable, the distribution is known as univariate related or not;
frequency distribution. 2. choose an appropriate regression model for
estimation.
It aims to make description about the particular
variable. It is also known as one-way frequency The pair of observations (x, y) represented by
distribution. For example height of students in a the plot are called scatter points.
class.
x Solution
y
Negative linear Association
y
90
80
70
60
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
x 50
40
Non – linear Association
30
y
20
10
x
10 20 30 40 50 60 70
x 5 0 3 1 2 2 5 5 3 4
y 1 2 1 3 3 4 3 0 4 2
4 ( ̅ , ̅)
3 x
2
Steps (If there is a fair dagree of scatter)
In this case, two regression lines A and B are
1
drawn:
1. A line of regression of x on y, which gives an
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 x extimate of x, given a value of y
2. A line of regression of y on x, which gives an
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
The Line of Best Fit extimate of y, given a value of x.
y
A line of best fit is a straight line that is the
best approximation of the given set of data. It is
used to study the nature of the relation between
two variables.
follows: 70
i. Calculate M( ̅ , ̅), the respective means of x 60 (39, 59)
and y values. 50
ii. Draw a line parallel to the y – axis through 40
M( ̅ , ̅) to divide the points into two groups. 30
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
iii. Let ML be the mean of the numbers above 20
the parallel line drawn in (ii) and hence find ML 10
( ̅ , ̅)
10 20 30 50 60 x
iv. Let MR be the mean of the numbers below 40 70
the parallel line drawn in (ii) and hence find MR
( ̅ , ̅) 2. Given the table below.
iv. Draw a line through M( ̅ , ̅), ML ( ̅ , ̅) and
MR ( ̅ , ̅) as the line of best fit. x 1 3 4 6 8 9 11 14
y 1 2 4 4 5 7 8 9
Worked Examples
The following table shows the examination a. Draw a scatter diagram for the data.
marks of seven students in French (x) and b. Draw the regression line y on x and use it to
English (y). estimatae the value of y corresponding to x =
10.
F 12 24 30 34 47 58 68 b. Draw the regression line x on y and use it to
E 32 44 47 58 73 72 88 estimate the corresponding value of x when
y=6.
Draw a scatter diagram of the data and draw the
line of best fit. Solution
b. ̅= = =7
Solution
F (x) 12 24 30 34 47 58 68 ̅= = =5
E (y) 32 44 47 58 73 72 88 M(7, 5)
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Points below the parallel line
x y x y
8 5 1 1
9 7 3 2
11 8 4 4
14 9 6 4
= 42 = 29 = 14 = 11
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2
x
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
From the graph, when y = 6, x = 8.6 3: Compute the y -intercept of the line by using
the formula:
b. The Least Square Method b= ̅–m ̅
A more accurate way of finding the line of best
fit is the least square method . 4. Use the slope m and the y -intercept b to
form the equation of the line.
The following steps are used to find the
equation of line of best fit for a set of ordered Worked Example
pairs (x1, y1), (x2, y2),...(xn, yn) . 1. Use the least square method to determine the
1. Calculate the mean of the x -values and the equation of line of best fit for the data. Then
mean of the y -values. plot the line using the data below.
̅= and ̅ =
x 8 2 11 6 5 4 12 9 6 1
y 3 10 3 6 8 12 1 4 9 14
2. The following formula gives the slope of the
line of best fit:
( ̅) ( ̅) Solution:
m= Plot the points on a coordinate plane .
( ̅)
̅= =7
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 x
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Paper 1(x) 31 27 30 21 23
Paper 2 (y) 14 14 17 15 17
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
30
of one month. The results over the first 7
25 months are in the table below;
20
Age in Months Mean weight
15 (A) in kg (W)
0 2.50
10 1 3.75
2 4.20
5
3 5.70
4 6.40
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 x
5 7.37
6 8.25
7 9.60
From the graph, when x = 25, y = 15
a. Draw a scatter diagram of the mean weight,
Exercises 28.1 W, against the age, A.
1. The table below shows the marks (out of 10) b. Draw the line of best fit of W on A, and
in a class test as english ans amths of a sample estimate its gradient.
of 10 students selected at random from a class. c. From your graph, estimate the mean weight
of a baby whose age is 5.5 months.
English (x) 3 3 4 5 6 4. The data in the table below shows the years
Maths (y) 4 6 5 4 6 of experience and the salar of 7 eorkers selected
English (x) 7 7 8 9 6 at random from an industry.
Maths (y) 8 9 7 10 9
b. Find:
i. ̅ is the mean of x; Worked Examples
ii. ̅ is the mean of y; 1. The scores for nine students in physics and
c. Draw the line of best fit passing through ( ̅ , mathematics test are as follows:
̅) and find the equation of the line. Physics 35 23 47 17 10 43 09 06 28
d. From your graph estimate the expected Maths 30 33 45 23 08 49 12 04 31
salary of a worker who had 10 years of i. Compute the students rank in the two subjects
experience. and compute the Spearmans rank correlation
coefficient.
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Spearman‟s Rank Correlation Coefficient ii. Interprete your results.
The spearmans correlation coefficient can
take values from +1 to – 1. of + 1 indicates Solution
a perfect association of ranks, of 0 indicates Physics Ranks Maths Ranks
35 3 30 3
no association between ranks and of - 1
23 5 33 5
indicates a perfect negative association of
47 1 45 2
ranks. The closer is to zero, the weaker the 17 6 23 6
association between the ranks. 10 7 8 8
43 2 49 1
The Spearman‟s rank correlation coefficient is 9 8 12 7
calculated by : 6 9 4 9
28 4 31 4
=1– ( )
Where n is the sample size and is the sum P Ranks M Ranks d d2
of the squares of the difference in ranks. 35 3 30 3 2 4
23 5 33 5 2 4
To compute this value, 47 1 45 2 1 1
i. Find the rank for each individual subject. 17 6 23 6 0 0
This is done by ordering the scores from 10 7 8 8 1 1
greatest to smallest; assign the rank 1 to the 43 2 49 1 1 1
highest score, 2, to the next highest and so on. 9 8 12 7 1 1
6 9 4 9 0 0
ii. Copy and complete the table below; 28 4 31 4 0 0
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
by two judges X and Y as shown in the table. 7 1 6 36
2 7 -2 4
Judges Ann Linda Suzy Rose Erica 5 10 -5 25
X 1 4 3 5 2 1 3 -2 4
Y 3 2 4 5 1 8 2 6 36
3 8 -5 25
10 6 4 16
Calculate the Spearmans rank correlation.
4 9 -5 25
Solution
= 188
( )
Rank of X Rank of Y d d2 =1– ( )
1 3 -2 4 =1–
4 2 2 4
3 4 -1 1 = 1 – 1.1394
5 5 0 0 = - 0. 1394
2 1 1 1
ii. There is a low negative correlation between
= 4 + 4 + 1 + 0 + 1 = 10 Mathematics and English.
=1– ( ) Exercises 28.2
( )
=1– 1. Use the data below to calculate the
( )
spearman‟s rank order correlation coefficient
=1–
and interprete your results.
= 0.5
2. On a certain market day, the number of fish i. Calculate the Spearman‟s rank correlation
displayed (fish num) and the rating of fish coefficient.
quality (fishgood) on a 1 – 10 scale is shown in
ii. Interprete your results.
the table below. 4. Jack and Jill were asked to rank their
favourite vocation sports. The table below gives
Fishnum 32 41 31 38 21 17 their ranking.
Fish good 6 5 3 3 7 7
Fishnum 13 17 22 24 11 20 Soccer Hockey Racing Rugby Cricket
Fish good 9 9 8 6 9 8 Jack 2 4 1 5 3
Jill 3 2 1 5 4
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
i. Calculate the Spearman‟s rank correlation
coefficient. Calculate the Spearman‟s rank correlation
ii. Interprete your results. coefficient.
3. The following is a small selection of 5. Show that for the following data = -1
countries ranked according to the Human between the ranking of these two judges. Best
Development Index (HDI) and income per ice cream is given rank 1.
capital.
Country Income HDI Ice
Rank (x) Rank (y)
cream A B C D E F G H I J
Norway 3 1
Judge 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Iceland 2 2
Judge 2 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Sweden 10 3
Belgium 8 4
Japan 5 5
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Ex 2.1 Exercises 2.11
A. 1. 5√ 2. 32√ 3. 26√ 4. 28√ 5. 13 √ 6. 7√ 6. √ √ √
1. 2.
√ –√ 7. -18 √ B. 1. 9√ 2. 6√ B. 1. 13√ 2.
6√ 3. 25 √ 4. 18√ 5. 19√ 6. 4√ + √ Exercises 2.12
A. 1. 3 2. 52 3. 37 4. 5. 3 6. 7 B. 1. -1 2. 10 3. 5 4. - 6
Exercises 2.2
A. 1. 5 2. 8 3. 2 4. 3 √ 5. 6. 2 B. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 4 6. -1.65 C. 1. 3 2. 3. 3 or -5 4. 5 or – 4 5. 1 or -1 6.
5 or -2 7. -2 or -3 8. -3 or -9 9. 4
Exercises 2.3
1. 40√ 2. 16√ 3. 100√ 4. 600√ 5. 500 √ Exercises 2.12B
1. x = 0 2. x = 2.34 3. x = 2 4. x = 2 5. 2 6. 5
Exercises 2.4
Exercises 2.13
1. √ + √ 2. 3√ – √ 3. 10 + 6√ ) 4. 6√ + A. 1. x = 3 y = 2 2. x = -11 y = – 3 3. x = 0, y = -3 4. x = 15,
√ ) 5. 12 – 9 √
y = - 4 5. x = 6, y = 0 6. x = 0, y = 0 B. 1. 2, 2. . , /
Exercises 2.5 3. . , / 4. . , / c. 1. (3, 1) 2. (4, 5) 3. (5, 2) C.P ;
1. 14 + 7 √ 2. 26 + 8 √ 3. 10 - √ + 4√ + 4 √ 4. 1. 179.5555 2. 3.1463
√
(√ – 2 ) (√ – 5) 5. 17 – 7 √ 6. +
Exercises 2.14
Exercises 2.6 1. ( √ ) 2. ( √ ) 3. ( √ ) 4. ( √
1. – 11 2. – 4 3. 3 4. - 4 5. – 2 ) 5. ( √ ) 6. ( √ √ )
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
v. undefined 1. k = 19, (2x + 3) , (3x – 1) 2. k = 7 ; (x + 1) , (x + 2) 3. 2 4.
Exercises 4.13 5. a. 7 b. c. – 17 C. P. 1. k = 2
A. 1.a. 45.1 and 38.9 2. a. 11. 5 and 17.25 B. 1. i. 25, 49 ii.
15, 14, 21, 22, 26 33. 2. i. 2 ii. 2 iii. 1 Exercises 5.11
1. 2, -10 2. 5, 19 3. , 4. x = 2, x = -3; p = 3 , q = 12 5. -
Exercises 4.17 5, 19 C.P 1. a = 2, b = -1 and c= -13
1. a. g(x) = 3x f(x) = 2x + 1 b. g(x) = x2, f(x) = 2x
2. If f (x) = √ , g(x) = x2 + 1 3. f(x) = √ and g(x) = x or f(x) = Exercises 5.12
1. (1, -5) 2. . , , / 3. a. (5, -1) b. (x + 2) (x - 1) (2x + 3)
√ and g(x) =
4. a. – 20 b. – 6 5. a. f(2) = 0 b. (3, 8) c. b 2 – 4ac < 0 6.
Exercises 4.18 Exercises 5.13
1. x2 + 6x + 7 2. 4x2 – 6x 1. x3 - 3x2 + 10x = 0. 2. x3 - 3x2 - 4x + 12 = 0.
3. x4 - 4x3 - 9x2 + 4x + 8 = 0. 4. x4 - 3x3 - 13x2 + 15x = 0.
Exercises 4.30
1. i. 2 ii. 5 iii. 10 iv . -6 v. -30 vi. -16 vii. – 22 viii. 52 Exercises 5.14
ix. x. xi. 5 xii. 2. i. 12 ii. 9 iii. 22 iv. – 75 vii. A. 1.;(x – 3) (x – 2)(x + 4); 3, 2, - 4 2. (2x – 1) (x – 1)(x + 1); ,
– 2 viii. 1, - 1 3. -1, 3 4. -3 2√ . 5. 7; 2, 3 6. a = 2, b = 9; k = 7. k =
4 or . 8. p = -1, q = 14, r = -8;1, 2, 4 B. 1. (x – 1) (x + 2) (x +
Exercises 5.2
A. 1. x3 + 9x – 7 2. x2 – x – 1 3. 3x2 – 7x – 4 4. (x2 – 12x – 5 4) 2. (2x – 3) (x - 2) (2x -1) 3. (x + 2) (2x - 1) (3x + 2) 4. 3x3 +
5. (x3 – 4x2 – 6x + 6 6. (9.6x2 – 1.93x – 1.49 B: 1. - x2 + 2x 2. 7x2 + x – 6 = 0. C. 1. -4, 3, 1 2. 2, -1 , -3 3. , 3, 2 4. -2, ,
x5 – x3 3. 2x + 13 4. + x3 + x2 – 2x + 2 5. – 8x + 7 C.P 1. –
5. 6, , - 4 6. - 2, 5, 4 C. P. 1. - 4p, -p, 2p
3m + 3 2. -13y 3. (-x3 + 3x2 – 6x + 12) 4. -14x2 – 13x + 10 5.
x4 – 3x2 + x + 6 2. a. (a – b)(a2 + ab + b2) b. (a + b)(a2 - ab + b2)
Exercises 9.5
Exercises 6.4 A. 1. (1.5, 0) 2. (5.5, 7) 3. (3, 1) 4. (2, -4) 5. (3.5, 0.5) B. 1. (3,
2. 12x + 30 3. 2 4. ( )( )
5. 3) 2. (0, 1) 3. . , /
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
2. x7 – 7x6 y + 21x5y2 – 35x4y3 + 35x3y4 – 21x2y5 + 7xy6 – y7
3. x3 + 6ax2 + 12a2x + 8a3 4. a4 +12a3b +54a2b2 +36ab3 + 81b4 Exercises 9.10
5. x6 – 8x6 + 24x4 – 32x2 + 16 1. Int 2 :3 2. Ext 3 : 2 C.P. 1. 2: 3 (I), 3 : 2 (E) 2. Ans (-6, 2)
6. x10 + 5a3x8 + 10a4x6 + 10a6x4 + 5a8x2 + a10
Exercises 9.11
Ex 7.5 1. x = 7 2. y = 9
A.
Exercises 9.12
2. (a) 32x5 − 80x4 + 80x3 − 40x2 + 10x − 1; 1. y = 5x – 14 2. y = 4 3. y = -2x – 1 4. y = -3x + 4
(b) 81 + 54x + x2 + x3 + x4;
(c) x3 − 6x + - Exercises 9.13
1. 3x – y + 1 = 0 2. 2x + y – 4 = 0 3. 2x – 5y – 15 = 0
4. y + x = 0
Exercises 8.10
1. a. 2x + 4y ≤ 24, 4x + 2y ≤ 24, b. P = 3x + 5y c. (4, 4) = Exercises 9.14
Gh32 2. a. 12, b. 36, c. Gh3000 5. a. 20, b. 10, c. Gh12.50 6.
a. 3, b. 4 c. Gh5.50 7.a. 10, b. 22.5, c. Gh¢3250 8. 1, 9 9. x + y A.1. 5x + 3, 2. -2x – 1, 3. y = 3x, 4. y = x + 1,
≤ 70 , x + 2y ≤ 120, 3x + 2y ≤ 180, x ≥ 10 , y ≥ 20 10 … 11. i. 5. y = x+
5x + 2y ≤ 100 , x + 4y ≤ 64, x + y ≤ 25, ii. 30x + 70y , 1270 (x B.
= 12, y = 13) C. P 2. 2kg (A) , 14kg (B) 3. x + y 24, 2x + 5y Equation Gradient y - intercept
60 c. 4 tonnes of x, 20 tonnes of Y:Gh5600 d. Gh9600 4. i. x + y = 3x + 2 3 2
2y ≤ 180, x + y ≥ 105, y ≥ 40, 2y ≥ x ii. 30 ≤ x ≤ 90 y = 5x – 2 5 -2
y = -2x + 4 -2 4
Exercises 8.11
1. b. 22, 12 c. 28, 18 y= x- -
2 y – 10x = 8 5 4
Exercises 9.1
x+y+1=0 -1 -1
1. 5.39 2. 17 49 3. 15.26 4. 10 5. 16.28
y = 2x 2 0
Exercises 9.2
Exercises 9.16
B. 1. 2. PQ = PR = √ , . , / 3. i. AB = BC = √ 4. PQ = 1. x – 2y + 5 = 0 2. 2x + 7y – 11 = 0
PR 5. AB = 5, BC = √ AC = 5: isosceles, Right triangle
6. Isoscelles AB = AC = 5 Exercises 9.17
1. 3x – 2y = 1 2. x – y – 1 = 0 3. y = x – 1 4. 2x + y = 5
Exercises 9.3
A. 1. 7 3. 24 6. 12 B. 1. 10 2. 12 3. 7 4. 7 C. 1. 8 3. 10
3. The points (1, 4) (6, 3) (10, 4) and (a, b) form the vertices of B. 1. i. 11 ii. 2. i. 3 ii. 3. a. i. ii. iii.
a kite. Find the possible values for a and b. b. i. ii. iii. 4. i. 10 ii. iii.
Exercises 9.19
Exercises 10.11
A. 1. . , / 2. . , / 3. . , / 1. HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT, TTH, TTT
B. 1. i. (2, -1) ii. 5x +2y – 8 = 0 iii. 5(4) +2(-6) – 8 = 0 2. i. 12 ii. 3. ii. . iii. 4. i. ii. 5. i. ii. iii. 6.
3. (-1, -1) 4. (5, 4)
Exercises 11.1
Exercises 9.21
1. ( ) 2. ( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
Exercises 10.1
1. mon, tue, wed….sun 2. Jan Feb…Dec Exercises 11.4
3. M, A. E 4. Boy and girl 5. Win , lose , draw 1. 6.4, 3210 2. 14.4, 450 3. 18, 1800 4. 1.4, 450 5. 4, 2100
6. Win or lose 7. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 6.9 .450 7. 5, 2700 8. 12, 1800
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. i. 18 ii. 30 2. i. 30 ii. 20 3. 20 4. 20 5. i. 75 ii. 20 iii. . 6. i. Exercise 11.6
1. 11N, 2210 2. 9.9N, 1070
56 ii. 52 7. x = 2 C. P: 1. i. ii. 2. i. ii.
Exercises 11.7
Exercises 10.4 a. i. ( ) ii. ( ) iii. ( ) iv. ( ) v. ( ),
1.a. b. c. 2. 0.99 3. 4. 5.. 6. a. b. c.
b. 2. ii. 1 iii. √ iv. √ v. √ c. ,-j
√
7. i. ii. 8. i. , ii. B. 1. a. 20 b. 2. i. 12 ii. 3. i.
a. b. c. 4. 12, , 5. i. ii. Exercises 11.8
A. i. same direction
Exercises 10.5 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
√ √ √ √ √
1. ii. a. b. c. 2. 3. a. b. c. 4. 7. 8. ii. opp dxn 1. 2. 3. 4.
√ √ √ √ √
5. ii. (6, 2) (5, 3) (4, 4) (3, 5), (2, 6) iii. . iv. (2, 2) (4, 2) (6, 2) 5. 6. 7. 8. B. 1. 2.
√ √ √ √ √
(2, 4) (4, 4), (6, 4) (2, 6), (4, 6) (6,6) B. 1. a. , b. , c. 2. ,
3. i. ii. 4. i. ii.
√ √ √
, , , 3. i. , i. 1 iii. 4. a. , b. , c. 5. a. ,b. ,c. 6. ,
, 0 7. 0 Exercises 11.9
A. 1. – 14, 1600 2. 0, 900 3. 37, 5404. 45, 220 5. – 29, 1760 B.
1. 630 2. 1150 3. i. p = 8.3 units 0160 ii. 1110, 4. 870.
Exercises 10.6
1. 2. 3. Exercises 11.10
A. 1. Parallel 2. Not 3. Not 4. Not 5. 6.
Exercises 10.7
1. i. P(Y) = ii. P(XUY) = 2. i. Not ii. yes 3. Exercises 11.11
4. 5. 10% 6. 0.03 7. a. b. c. d. A. 1. yes 2. Not 3. Yes 4. Not 5. Yes 6. Yes
B. 1. 2. 3. 4.
Exercises 10.8
1. 0.15 2. 0.13 3. 66.7% 4. Exercises 11.12
1. i. ( ) ii. ( ) iii. √ 2. i. ( ) ii. ( ) iii. ( ) iv. √
Exercises 10.9 3. a= ( ) b = ( ) ii. ( ) iii. 5 4. a. B = ( ) C= ( ) b. ( ) 5.
1. 2. a. b. c. 3. a. b. c. d. a. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = ( ) D = ( ) b. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ = 5.1 6. i. Q= ( )
4.i. 9 ii. and S= ( ), ii. PR= √ 8 7. a.i. B= (2, 6) D = (1, -1) ii. ⃗⃗⃗⃗⃗ =
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 12.4
1. 3.06N, 450 2.18.8N, 1500 3.53.5N, 1170 4. 34.6N, 100
Exercises 14.4
Exercises 12.5 1. (5, 1) ; 5 2. (-2, 3) ; 6 3. (-5, -3) ; 1 4. . , /;
1. 47N, 1010 2. 6N, 1010 5. (0, 0) ; 2
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. x2 + y2 – 6x + 2y – 26 = 0 2. x2 + y2 – 4x - 8y – 5 = 0 1. 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 2. 1536 ; 1572864 3. 1458
Exercises 17.4
Exercises 17.20
B. 1. 9 2. 3. 4 4. 2 5. 6. C. 1. 2. 3.
A. 1. 1.67 2. 3 3. 1 4. 5. 8 B. 1. 2. 25.5 3. 307 4.
4. 5. -2.1 5. 9 C. 1. 10 2. 2 3. 6 4. 5.09 D. 1. 1.42 2. 8 3.
1.75 4. 0.75 5. 146.77 C. P . 1. a. 4.15 or 1.84 2. (a) 3
Exercises 17.5 (b) 3 3. (a) 4 (b) 1 (c) 3.71
A. 1. 5 2. 2 3. 2 or 4. 3 5. 6. 7 7. B. 1. 4 2.
Exercises 17.21
3. 4 4. 2 5. 6. 7 -1 8. 6 9. 10. -3 C. 1. 2 2. A. 1. 1 or 109 3. 1 or 103 4. 1 or 10 5. 21.5508 6. 1064
3. 4. 5. 3 6. -3 7. 0 8. B. 1. 2 3. 10 or 5. 1.88 C. 1. 3 2. 10 3. 20.98 4. 1 5.
10 or 104 6. D. 1. 16 2. 2 3. 21.5443 4. 3 or 9 5. 10
Exercises 17.8
A. 1. lg 4 2. log 2 6 3. log6 1296 4. log5 625 5. lg 2500 Exercises 17.22
A. 1. (3, 2) 2. . , / 3. (1, 1) (-2, 4) B. 1. (24.14, 4.14) or
Exercises 17.9
1. 2 + 3 log32 2. 2 + log 37 3. 2 + log 52 + log 53 4. 1 + log 83 + (- 4.14 , -24.14 ) 3. (17.78, 56.23) 4. . , /
log 85 5. + log 27 6. + log 2
Exercises 17.24
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Exercises 17.10 1. 23 yrs 4. a = 0.4, b = 3.3 5. n =1.06, C = 65887
6. a = 1.38 × 10−3, b = 2.08 7. a = 183.95, n = 0.17.
A. 1. lg ₃ 75 2. 3. log₂ . / 4. log ₉ 5. log ₅ (-3) CP: a = 8.0, b = 0.99
6. log ₅ 15 B. 1. 3 + 5 log ₃ 5 2. log ₃ ( ) 3. log ₅ 4. log ₂
Exercises 18.7
Exercises 17.11 A. 1 ,2. , 3. √ , 4. , 5. ,6. B. 1. ,2 , 3. ,4.
√
A. 1. 5 2. 3. 5 4. 5. - 6. -3 B. 1. -2 C. P:
2. – 4 3. 2 log 4.- 5. – 3 6. 2 7. -3 8. 2 C. 1. 2 2. 1
Exercises 18.15
3. 4. 4 5. 6. – 2 7. 1 8. – 1 9. D. 1. 1.3 2. 0.85 1. 450 2. 2250 3. 1350 4. . 5. i. ii. , iii. iv.
3. 0.51 4. 1.5 E. 1. 8 2. 4 6. i. ii.
Exercises 17.12
Exercises 18.17
1. 2. 2 3. 2.7 4. 1 5. 0.3010 √ √
A. 1. , , 3. √ √ , √ √ , √ –1
Exercises 17.13
Exercises 18.26
1. 3; 2. – 2 3. 3 4. 1 5. 6.
5. 3290
Exercises 20.14
Exercises 21.1
A. 1. 4x – y – 4 = 0 2. 26x – y – 48 = 0 3. x + y = 0 4. 8x + y
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
– 5 = 0 5. 15x – y + 9 = 0 A. 1. x3 + c 2. x5 + c 3. + c 4. + c 5. -2
+ c B. 1. + c 2. a + c 3. +c
Exercises 20.15
A. 1. y = 13x – 18 2. 6x – 2y – 3 = 0 3x + y + 3 = 0 . , / Exercises 21.2
3. 2x + y – 4 = 0 ; x + y + 4 = 0 4. y = 2x – 1 5. c = 6. y =
A. 1. + c 2. – + 2x + c 3. – + 3x + c
x – 2 C.P: 1. (0, 0) (-2, 2) ; x – y = 0 x – y + 4 = 0 2.
4. + + + 2x + c 5. x – + c B. 1. x3 – 2 +c
2
Exercises 20.16 2. x – x + c 3. – + 5x + c 4. + 2x – +c
1. 2, -5 2. 2, 15 3. 2, -8 4. – 4 5 . – 5.5 6. 2, 0, - 24
5. – +c 6. – + c C. 1. + +c 2. +
Exercises 20.17
A. 1. x + 2y + 1 = 0 2. x + 3y + 3 = 0 3. y = x 4. x + 8y +49 = +c 3. + + c 4. x – + c 5. 3x – 8 +c
0 5. x + y + 1 = 0 6. x = 0 B. 1. x + 3y + 6 = 0 2. x – y – 2 = 0
and y + x – 3 = 0 3. x – 2y + 1 = 0 4. k = 5. y = Exercises 21.3
6. T: y + 3x = 0; y = 6x - 6√ N: x – 3y = 0; 6y = x + √ A 1. y = x3 + - 2. 4, 0 , 3. y = + – 8 C. 1. x2 – 5x
+ c 2. + + + 10x + c 3. + - + 5x + c 4. –
Exercises 20.18
a. 1. 0.75s, 14 ft 2. i. v = 144 ii. 4.5s iii. 324 3. i. v = 80 + 32t x2 + c 5.
ii. 2.5 iii. 240 4. i. 3t2 – 18t + 15, ii. 15m/s, iii. 9m and 23m
iv. 6m/s2 5. i. 21 ii. 6.67s iii. 21m/s, 300m 6. i , ii. 7. i. Exercises 21.4
2.5 ii. 8. i. k = 5 ii. q = 3 9.i. (26, 0) ii. 77m/s iii. 103m/s 2 A. 1. 7 2. 16 3. 4. B. 1. – 30 2. 3. 4. – 60
10. 12.1 m , 1.6 s C. 1. 2. 0 3. 4. -92 D. 1. -9 2. 5 3. 2.7 4.
Exercises 25.11
Exercises 21.13
1. 3 2. 3 or -2 3. 4 or -5
A. 1. i. 4 ii. 6 2. 3. 4. 2 5. 6. 24 7. 21
B. 1. 2. 20 3. 4. 5. Exercises 25.12
1. 3 2. -1.41, 1.41, 1
Exercises 21.14
Exercises 25.13
A. 1. 156 2. 19 3. 364 4. 540 5. 10.6 B. 1. b. 43.5
2. b. 52 3. b. 170 A. 1. 0 1 3. 0 1 5. 0 1
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
1. 0.47 2. 0.0032 3. 0.019 4. a. A = 0.0046 b. 0.069 c. 0.028 d.
0.56 e. 0.168 5. a. (0.9)5 b. 0.0086 c. 0.0081 d. 0.00081 6. 1. [ ] 3. [ 8 ]
0.17 8
8
Exercise 23.2 5. [ 8 8]
1. i. ii. 2. i. 0.441 ii. 0.973 iii. 0.657 3. i. ii. iii.
iv. Exercises 25.17
Exercises 25.20
Exercises 25.3
8 A. 1. (1, -3) 2. (-2, 5) 3. (1, 1) 4. (-2, -3) 5. . , /
A. 1. 0 1 2. 0 1 3. 0 1 4. 0 1
8
B. 1. (10, 15) 2. . , / 3. . , / 4. . , /
B. 1. [ ] 2. [ ] 3. [ ] C. 1. (-2, -3) 2. (6, -11) 3. (7, -10) 4. (5, -10)
8 8
C.P : 2. [ ]6 7=[ ] 3. a. 4, 2 b.
Exercises 25.4
1. 0 1 2. 0 1 3. 0 1 4. 0 1
8 Exercises 27.1
2. b. 0.973 c. 7.95 kg 4. b. i. 8.3 ii. 15.7 d. 16500
Exercises 25.6
1. 4, - 6, 9 2. 3, -1, 7 3. 4, -6, 9 4. 0 1 5. 0 1 Exercises 28.1
1….. 2. b. 0.973 c. A = 7.95 kg 4. d. 16500
B. 1. (6, 3) 2. 0, 3, -6 3. -6, 9, - 17 4. -5, 4 -1
Exercises 28.2
1. 0.67 2. 3. i. 0.115 4. 0.7.
V. W. Ferris and J. N. Busbridge, Modern Mathematics for Secondary Schools, Book 3, 4 & 5, Evans
Brothers Limited, Ibadan, 1978
Scottish Mathematics Group, Mordern Mathematic for Schools, Second Edition, Butler and Tanner Limited,
1974
New Mathematics for Secondary Schools, West African Editon 4, Afram Publications, Accra, 1981
Uploaded by golearnershub.com
Teacher Education Division, Further Algebra, Ministry of Education Youth and Sports, Accra, 2007
Joint School Project Mathematics, Metric Edition 4S and 5S, Longman Group Limited, 1980
Ghana Senior Secondary School Mathematics, Books 1, 2 and 3, Ministry of Education, Accra,1993
Mathematical Association of Ghana, Mathematics for Senior Secondary Schools Books 1, 2 and 3, Addison
Wesley Longman Limited, 1997
Revise for GSCE Mathematics, Intermediate Tier, University Press, Cambridge 1997
James K. Morton, Richard J. Swinney, GCSE Mathematics, Intermediate Level Key Stage 4